1GCC(1) GNU GCC(1)
2
3
4
6 gcc - GNU project C and C++ compiler
7
9 gcc [-c|-S|-E] [-std=standard]
10 [-g] [-pg] [-Olevel]
11 [-Wwarn...] [-Wpedantic]
12 [-Idir...] [-Ldir...]
13 [-Dmacro[=defn]...] [-Umacro]
14 [-foption...] [-mmachine-option...]
15 [-o outfile] [@file] infile...
16
17 Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
18 remainder. g++ accepts mostly the same options as gcc.
19
21 When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
22 assembly and linking. The "overall options" allow you to stop this
23 process at an intermediate stage. For example, the -c option says not
24 to run the linker. Then the output consists of object files output by
25 the assembler.
26
27 Other options are passed on to one or more stages of processing. Some
28 options control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself. Yet
29 other options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
30 documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
31
32 Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful
33 for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
34 (usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly. If the description
35 for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
36 that option with all supported languages.
37
38 The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called gcc, or
39 machine-gcc when cross-compiling, or machine-gcc-version to run a
40 specific version of GCC. When you compile C++ programs, you should
41 invoke GCC as g++ instead.
42
43 The gcc program accepts options and file names as operands. Many
44 options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter
45 options may not be grouped: -dv is very different from -d -v.
46
47 You can mix options and other arguments. For the most part, the order
48 you use doesn't matter. Order does matter when you use several options
49 of the same kind; for example, if you specify -L more than once, the
50 directories are searched in the order specified. Also, the placement
51 of the -l option is significant.
52
53 Many options have long names starting with -f or with -W---for example,
54 -fmove-loop-invariants, -Wformat and so on. Most of these have both
55 positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo is -fno-foo.
56 This manual documents only one of these two forms, whichever one is not
57 the default.
58
59 Some options take one or more arguments typically separated either by a
60 space or by the equals sign (=) from the option name. Unless
61 documented otherwise, an argument can be either numeric or a string.
62 Numeric arguments must typically be small unsigned decimal or
63 hexadecimal integers. Hexadecimal arguments must begin with the 0x
64 prefix. Arguments to options that specify a size threshold of some
65 sort may be arbitrarily large decimal or hexadecimal integers followed
66 by a byte size suffix designating a multiple of bytes such as "kB" and
67 "KiB" for kilobyte and kibibyte, respectively, "MB" and "MiB" for
68 megabyte and mebibyte, "GB" and "GiB" for gigabyte and gigibyte, and so
69 on. Such arguments are designated by byte-size in the following text.
70 Refer to the NIST, IEC, and other relevant national and international
71 standards for the full listing and explanation of the binary and
72 decimal byte size prefixes.
73
75 Option Summary
76 Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type. Explanations
77 are in the following sections.
78
79 Overall Options
80 -c -S -E -o file -x language -v -### --help[=class[,...]]
81 --target-help --version -pass-exit-codes -pipe -specs=file
82 -wrapper @file -ffile-prefix-map=old=new -fplugin=file
83 -fplugin-arg-name=arg -fdump-ada-spec[-slim]
84 -fada-spec-parent=unit -fdump-go-spec=file
85
86 C Language Options
87 -ansi -std=standard -fgnu89-inline
88 -fpermitted-flt-eval-methods=standard -aux-info filename
89 -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions -fno-asm -fno-builtin
90 -fno-builtin-function -fgimple -fhosted -ffreestanding -fopenacc
91 -fopenacc-dim=geom -fopenmp -fopenmp-simd -fms-extensions
92 -fplan9-extensions -fsso-struct=endianness
93 -fallow-single-precision -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions
94 -fsigned-bitfields -fsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields
95 -funsigned-char
96
97 C++ Language Options
98 -fabi-version=n -fno-access-control -faligned-new=n
99 -fargs-in-order=n -fchar8_t -fcheck-new -fconstexpr-depth=n
100 -fconstexpr-loop-limit=n -fconstexpr-ops-limit=n
101 -fno-elide-constructors -fno-enforce-eh-specs -fno-gnu-keywords
102 -fno-implicit-templates -fno-implicit-inline-templates
103 -fno-implement-inlines -fms-extensions -fnew-inheriting-ctors
104 -fnew-ttp-matching -fno-nonansi-builtins -fnothrow-opt
105 -fno-operator-names -fno-optional-diags -fpermissive
106 -fno-pretty-templates -frepo -fno-rtti -fsized-deallocation
107 -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=n -ftemplate-depth=n
108 -fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit -fno-weak -nostdinc++
109 -fvisibility-inlines-hidden -fvisibility-ms-compat
110 -fext-numeric-literals -Wabi=n -Wabi-tag -Wconversion-null
111 -Wctor-dtor-privacy -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor -Wdeprecated-copy
112 -Wdeprecated-copy-dtor -Wliteral-suffix -Wmultiple-inheritance
113 -Wno-init-list-lifetime -Wnamespaces -Wnarrowing
114 -Wpessimizing-move -Wredundant-move -Wnoexcept -Wnoexcept-type
115 -Wclass-memaccess -Wnon-virtual-dtor -Wreorder -Wregister
116 -Weffc++ -Wstrict-null-sentinel -Wtemplates
117 -Wno-non-template-friend -Wold-style-cast -Woverloaded-virtual
118 -Wno-pmf-conversions -Wno-class-conversion -Wno-terminate
119 -Wsign-promo -Wvirtual-inheritance
120
121 Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
122 -fconstant-string-class=class-name -fgnu-runtime -fnext-runtime
123 -fno-nil-receivers -fobjc-abi-version=n -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
124 -fobjc-direct-dispatch -fobjc-exceptions -fobjc-gc -fobjc-nilcheck
125 -fobjc-std=objc1 -fno-local-ivars
126 -fivar-visibility=[public|protected|private|package]
127 -freplace-objc-classes -fzero-link -gen-decls -Wassign-intercept
128 -Wno-protocol -Wselector -Wstrict-selector-match
129 -Wundeclared-selector
130
131 Diagnostic Message Formatting Options
132 -fmessage-length=n -fdiagnostics-show-location=[once|every-line]
133 -fdiagnostics-color=[auto|never|always]
134 -fdiagnostics-format=[text|json] -fno-diagnostics-show-option
135 -fno-diagnostics-show-caret -fno-diagnostics-show-labels
136 -fno-diagnostics-show-line-numbers
137 -fdiagnostics-minimum-margin-width=width
138 -fdiagnostics-parseable-fixits -fdiagnostics-generate-patch
139 -fdiagnostics-show-template-tree -fno-elide-type -fno-show-column
140
141 Warning Options
142 -fsyntax-only -fmax-errors=n -Wpedantic -pedantic-errors -w
143 -Wextra -Wall -Waddress -Waddress-of-packed-member
144 -Waggregate-return -Waligned-new -Walloc-zero
145 -Walloc-size-larger-than=byte-size -Walloca
146 -Walloca-larger-than=byte-size -Wno-aggressive-loop-optimizations
147 -Warray-bounds -Warray-bounds=n -Wno-attributes
148 -Wattribute-alias=n -Wbool-compare -Wbool-operation
149 -Wno-builtin-declaration-mismatch -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
150 -Wc90-c99-compat -Wc99-c11-compat -Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat
151 -Wc++14-compat -Wc++17-compat -Wcast-align -Wcast-align=strict
152 -Wcast-function-type -Wcast-qual -Wchar-subscripts -Wcatch-value
153 -Wcatch-value=n -Wclobbered -Wcomment -Wconditionally-supported
154 -Wconversion -Wcoverage-mismatch -Wno-cpp -Wdangling-else
155 -Wdate-time -Wdelete-incomplete -Wno-attribute-warning
156 -Wno-deprecated -Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wno-designated-init
157 -Wdisabled-optimization -Wno-discarded-qualifiers
158 -Wno-discarded-array-qualifiers -Wno-div-by-zero
159 -Wdouble-promotion -Wduplicated-branches -Wduplicated-cond
160 -Wempty-body -Wenum-compare -Wno-endif-labels
161 -Wexpansion-to-defined -Werror -Werror=* -Wextra-semi
162 -Wfatal-errors -Wfloat-equal -Wformat -Wformat=2
163 -Wno-format-contains-nul -Wno-format-extra-args
164 -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-overflow=n -Wformat-security
165 -Wformat-signedness -Wformat-truncation=n -Wformat-y2k
166 -Wframe-address -Wframe-larger-than=byte-size
167 -Wno-free-nonheap-object -Wjump-misses-init -Whsa -Wif-not-aligned
168 -Wignored-qualifiers -Wignored-attributes
169 -Wincompatible-pointer-types -Wimplicit -Wimplicit-fallthrough
170 -Wimplicit-fallthrough=n -Wimplicit-function-declaration
171 -Wimplicit-int -Winit-self -Winline -Wno-int-conversion
172 -Wint-in-bool-context -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
173 -Winvalid-memory-model -Wno-invalid-offsetof -Winvalid-pch
174 -Wlarger-than=byte-size -Wlogical-op -Wlogical-not-parentheses
175 -Wlong-long -Wmain -Wmaybe-uninitialized -Wmemset-elt-size
176 -Wmemset-transposed-args -Wmisleading-indentation
177 -Wmissing-attributes -Wmissing-braces -Wmissing-field-initializers
178 -Wmissing-format-attribute -Wmissing-include-dirs
179 -Wmissing-noreturn -Wmissing-profile -Wno-multichar
180 -Wmultistatement-macros -Wnonnull -Wnonnull-compare
181 -Wnormalized=[none|id|nfc|nfkc] -Wnull-dereference -Wodr
182 -Wno-overflow -Wopenmp-simd -Woverride-init-side-effects
183 -Woverlength-strings -Wpacked -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
184 -Wpacked-not-aligned -Wpadded -Wparentheses
185 -Wno-pedantic-ms-format -Wplacement-new -Wplacement-new=n
186 -Wpointer-arith -Wpointer-compare -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
187 -Wno-pragmas -Wno-prio-ctor-dtor -Wredundant-decls -Wrestrict
188 -Wno-return-local-addr -Wreturn-type -Wsequence-point -Wshadow
189 -Wno-shadow-ivar -Wshadow=global, -Wshadow=local,
190 -Wshadow=compatible-local -Wshift-overflow -Wshift-overflow=n
191 -Wshift-count-negative -Wshift-count-overflow
192 -Wshift-negative-value -Wsign-compare -Wsign-conversion
193 -Wfloat-conversion -Wno-scalar-storage-order -Wsizeof-pointer-div
194 -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess -Wsizeof-array-argument
195 -Wstack-protector -Wstack-usage=byte-size -Wstrict-aliasing
196 -Wstrict-aliasing=n -Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=n
197 -Wstringop-overflow=n -Wstringop-truncation -Wsubobject-linkage
198 -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn|format|malloc]
199 -Wsuggest-final-types -Wsuggest-final-methods -Wsuggest-override
200 -Wswitch -Wswitch-bool -Wswitch-default -Wswitch-enum
201 -Wswitch-unreachable -Wsync-nand -Wsystem-headers
202 -Wtautological-compare -Wtrampolines -Wtrigraphs -Wtype-limits
203 -Wundef -Wuninitialized -Wunknown-pragmas
204 -Wunsuffixed-float-constants -Wunused -Wunused-function
205 -Wunused-label -Wunused-local-typedefs -Wunused-macros
206 -Wunused-parameter -Wno-unused-result -Wunused-value
207 -Wunused-variable -Wunused-const-variable
208 -Wunused-const-variable=n -Wunused-but-set-parameter
209 -Wunused-but-set-variable -Wuseless-cast -Wvariadic-macros
210 -Wvector-operation-performance -Wvla -Wvla-larger-than=byte-size
211 -Wvolatile-register-var -Wwrite-strings
212 -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant
213
214 C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
215 -Wbad-function-cast -Wmissing-declarations
216 -Wmissing-parameter-type -Wmissing-prototypes -Wnested-externs
217 -Wold-style-declaration -Wold-style-definition -Wstrict-prototypes
218 -Wtraditional -Wtraditional-conversion
219 -Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign
220
221 Debugging Options
222 -g -glevel -gdwarf -gdwarf-version -ggdb -grecord-gcc-switches
223 -gno-record-gcc-switches -gstabs -gstabs+ -gstrict-dwarf
224 -gno-strict-dwarf -gas-loc-support -gno-as-loc-support
225 -gas-locview-support -gno-as-locview-support -gcolumn-info
226 -gno-column-info -gstatement-frontiers -gno-statement-frontiers
227 -gvariable-location-views -gno-variable-location-views
228 -ginternal-reset-location-views -gno-internal-reset-location-views
229 -ginline-points -gno-inline-points -gvms -gxcoff -gxcoff+
230 -gz[=type] -gsplit-dwarf -gdescribe-dies -gno-describe-dies
231 -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new -fdebug-types-section
232 -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
233 -femit-struct-debug-reduced -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-
234 list] -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always
235 -fno-merge-debug-strings -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm -fvar-tracking
236 -fvar-tracking-assignments
237
238 Optimization Options
239 -faggressive-loop-optimizations -falign-functions[=n[:m:[n2[:m2]]]]
240 -falign-jumps[=n[:m:[n2[:m2]]]] -falign-labels[=n[:m:[n2[:m2]]]]
241 -falign-loops[=n[:m:[n2[:m2]]]] -fassociative-math -fauto-profile
242 -fauto-profile[=path] -fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-probabilities
243 -fbranch-target-load-optimize -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
244 -fbtr-bb-exclusive -fcaller-saves -fcombine-stack-adjustments
245 -fconserve-stack -fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fcrossjumping
246 -fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fcx-fortran-rules
247 -fcx-limited-range -fdata-sections -fdce -fdelayed-branch
248 -fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize
249 -fdevirtualize-speculatively -fdevirtualize-at-ltrans -fdse
250 -fearly-inlining -fipa-sra -fexpensive-optimizations
251 -ffat-lto-objects -ffast-math -ffinite-math-only -ffloat-store
252 -fexcess-precision=style -fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=style
253 -ffunction-sections -fgcse -fgcse-after-reload -fgcse-las
254 -fgcse-lm -fgraphite-identity -fgcse-sm -fhoist-adjacent-loads
255 -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 -findirect-inlining
256 -finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once
257 -finline-limit=n -finline-small-functions -fipa-cp -fipa-cp-clone
258 -fipa-bit-cp -fipa-vrp -fipa-pta -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const
259 -fipa-reference -fipa-reference-addressable -fipa-stack-alignment
260 -fipa-icf -fira-algorithm=algorithm -flive-patching=level
261 -fira-region=region -fira-hoist-pressure -fira-loop-pressure
262 -fno-ira-share-save-slots -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
263 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
264 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute -fivopts
265 -fkeep-inline-functions -fkeep-static-functions
266 -fkeep-static-consts -flimit-function-alignment
267 -flive-range-shrinkage -floop-block -floop-interchange
268 -floop-strip-mine -floop-unroll-and-jam -floop-nest-optimize
269 -floop-parallelize-all -flra-remat -flto -flto-compression-level
270 -flto-partition=alg -fmerge-all-constants -fmerge-constants
271 -fmodulo-sched -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
272 -fmove-loop-invariants -fno-branch-count-reg -fno-defer-pop
273 -fno-fp-int-builtin-inexact -fno-function-cse
274 -fno-guess-branch-probability -fno-inline -fno-math-errno
275 -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 -fno-printf-return-value
276 -fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fno-signed-zeros
277 -fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math
278 -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss -fomit-frame-pointer
279 -foptimize-sibling-calls -fpartial-inlining -fpeel-loops
280 -fpredictive-commoning -fprefetch-loop-arrays -fprofile-correction
281 -fprofile-use -fprofile-use=path -fprofile-values
282 -fprofile-reorder-functions -freciprocal-math -free
283 -frename-registers -freorder-blocks
284 -freorder-blocks-algorithm=algorithm -freorder-blocks-and-partition
285 -freorder-functions -frerun-cse-after-loop
286 -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops -frounding-math
287 -fsave-optimization-record -fsched2-use-superblocks
288 -fsched-pressure -fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
289 -fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=n] -fsched-stalled-insns[=n]
290 -fsched-group-heuristic -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
291 -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic -fsched-rank-heuristic
292 -fsched-last-insn-heuristic -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
293 -fschedule-fusion -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2
294 -fsection-anchors -fselective-scheduling -fselective-scheduling2
295 -fsel-sched-pipelining -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
296 -fsemantic-interposition -fshrink-wrap -fshrink-wrap-separate
297 -fsignaling-nans -fsingle-precision-constant
298 -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -fsplit-loops -fsplit-paths
299 -fsplit-wide-types -fssa-backprop -fssa-phiopt -fstdarg-opt
300 -fstore-merging -fstrict-aliasing -fthread-jumps -ftracer
301 -ftree-bit-ccp -ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch
302 -ftree-coalesce-vars -ftree-copy-prop -ftree-dce
303 -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse -ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre
304 -fcode-hoisting -ftree-loop-if-convert -ftree-loop-im
305 -ftree-phiprop -ftree-loop-distribution
306 -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns -ftree-loop-ivcanon
307 -ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-optimize -ftree-loop-vectorize
308 -ftree-parallelize-loops=n -ftree-pre -ftree-partial-pre
309 -ftree-pta -ftree-reassoc -ftree-scev-cprop -ftree-sink
310 -ftree-slsr -ftree-sra -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge
311 -ftree-ter -ftree-vectorize -ftree-vrp -funconstrained-commons
312 -funit-at-a-time -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops
313 -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops -fipa-ra
314 -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb
315 -fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-linker-plugin --param name=value -O
316 -O0 -O1 -O2 -O3 -Os -Ofast -Og
317
318 Program Instrumentation Options
319 -p -pg -fprofile-arcs --coverage -ftest-coverage
320 -fprofile-abs-path -fprofile-dir=path -fprofile-generate
321 -fprofile-generate=path -fprofile-update=method
322 -fprofile-filter-files=regex -fprofile-exclude-files=regex
323 -fsanitize=style -fsanitize-recover -fsanitize-recover=style
324 -fasan-shadow-offset=number -fsanitize-sections=s1,s2,...
325 -fsanitize-undefined-trap-on-error -fbounds-check
326 -fcf-protection=[full|branch|return|none] -fstack-protector
327 -fstack-protector-all -fstack-protector-strong
328 -fstack-protector-explicit -fstack-check
329 -fstack-limit-register=reg -fstack-limit-symbol=sym
330 -fno-stack-limit -fsplit-stack -fvtable-verify=[std|preinit|none]
331 -fvtv-counts -fvtv-debug -finstrument-functions
332 -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
333 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...
334
335 Preprocessor Options
336 -Aquestion=answer -A-question[=answer] -C -CC -Dmacro[=defn] -dD
337 -dI -dM -dN -dU -fdebug-cpp -fdirectives-only
338 -fdollars-in-identifiers -fexec-charset=charset
339 -fextended-identifiers -finput-charset=charset
340 -fmacro-prefix-map=old=new -fno-canonical-system-headers
341 -fpch-deps -fpch-preprocess -fpreprocessed -ftabstop=width
342 -ftrack-macro-expansion -fwide-exec-charset=charset
343 -fworking-directory -H -imacros file -include file -M -MD -MF
344 -MG -MM -MMD -MP -MQ -MT -no-integrated-cpp -P -pthread
345 -remap -traditional -traditional-cpp -trigraphs -Umacro -undef
346 -Wp,option -Xpreprocessor option
347
348 Assembler Options
349 -Wa,option -Xassembler option
350
351 Linker Options
352 object-file-name -fuse-ld=linker -llibrary -nostartfiles
353 -nodefaultlibs -nolibc -nostdlib -e entry --entry=entry -pie
354 -pthread -r -rdynamic -s -static -static-pie -static-libgcc
355 -static-libstdc++ -static-libasan -static-libtsan -static-liblsan
356 -static-libubsan -shared -shared-libgcc -symbolic -T script
357 -Wl,option -Xlinker option -u symbol -z keyword
358
359 Directory Options
360 -Bprefix -Idir -I- -idirafter dir -imacros file -imultilib dir
361 -iplugindir=dir -iprefix file -iquote dir -isysroot dir -isystem
362 dir -iwithprefix dir -iwithprefixbefore dir -Ldir
363 -no-canonical-prefixes --no-sysroot-suffix -nostdinc -nostdinc++
364 --sysroot=dir
365
366 Code Generation Options
367 -fcall-saved-reg -fcall-used-reg -ffixed-reg -fexceptions
368 -fnon-call-exceptions -fdelete-dead-exceptions -funwind-tables
369 -fasynchronous-unwind-tables -fno-gnu-unique
370 -finhibit-size-directive -fno-common -fno-ident
371 -fpcc-struct-return -fpic -fPIC -fpie -fPIE -fno-plt
372 -fno-jump-tables -frecord-gcc-switches -freg-struct-return
373 -fshort-enums -fshort-wchar -fverbose-asm -fpack-struct[=n]
374 -fleading-underscore -ftls-model=model -fstack-reuse=reuse_level
375 -ftrampolines -ftrapv -fwrapv
376 -fvisibility=[default|internal|hidden|protected]
377 -fstrict-volatile-bitfields -fsync-libcalls
378
379 Developer Options
380 -dletters -dumpspecs -dumpmachine -dumpversion -dumpfullversion
381 -fchecking -fchecking=n -fdbg-cnt-list -fdbg-cnt=counter-value-
382 list -fdisable-ipa-pass_name -fdisable-rtl-pass_name
383 -fdisable-rtl-pass-name=range-list -fdisable-tree-pass_name
384 -fdisable-tree-pass-name=range-list -fdump-debug -fdump-earlydebug
385 -fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-unnumbered-links
386 -fdump-final-insns[=file] -fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph
387 -fdump-ipa-inline -fdump-lang-all -fdump-lang-switch
388 -fdump-lang-switch-options -fdump-lang-switch-options=filename
389 -fdump-passes -fdump-rtl-pass -fdump-rtl-pass=filename
390 -fdump-statistics -fdump-tree-all -fdump-tree-switch
391 -fdump-tree-switch-options -fdump-tree-switch-options=filename
392 -fcompare-debug[=opts] -fcompare-debug-second -fenable-kind-pass
393 -fenable-kind-pass=range-list -fira-verbose=n -flto-report
394 -flto-report-wpa -fmem-report-wpa -fmem-report
395 -fpre-ipa-mem-report -fpost-ipa-mem-report -fopt-info
396 -fopt-info-options[=file] -fprofile-report -frandom-seed=string
397 -fsched-verbose=n -fsel-sched-verbose -fsel-sched-dump-cfg
398 -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose -fstats -fstack-usage
399 -ftime-report -ftime-report-details
400 -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle -gtoggle
401 -print-file-name=library -print-libgcc-file-name
402 -print-multi-directory -print-multi-lib -print-multi-os-directory
403 -print-prog-name=program -print-search-dirs -Q -print-sysroot
404 -print-sysroot-headers-suffix -save-temps -save-temps=cwd
405 -save-temps=obj -time[=file]
406
407 Machine-Dependent Options
408 AArch64 Options -mabi=name -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian
409 -mgeneral-regs-only -mcmodel=tiny -mcmodel=small -mcmodel=large
410 -mstrict-align -mno-strict-align -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
411 -mtls-dialect=desc -mtls-dialect=traditional -mtls-size=size
412 -mfix-cortex-a53-835769 -mfix-cortex-a53-843419
413 -mlow-precision-recip-sqrt -mlow-precision-sqrt
414 -mlow-precision-div -mpc-relative-literal-loads
415 -msign-return-address=scope -mbranch-protection=none|standard|pac-
416 ret[+leaf]|bti -march=name -mcpu=name -mtune=name
417 -moverride=string -mverbose-cost-dump
418 -mstack-protector-guard=guard -mstack-protector-guard-reg=sysreg
419 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset -mtrack-speculation
420
421 Adapteva Epiphany Options -mhalf-reg-file -mprefer-short-insn-regs
422 -mbranch-cost=num -mcmove -mnops=num -msoft-cmpsf -msplit-lohi
423 -mpost-inc -mpost-modify -mstack-offset=num -mround-nearest
424 -mlong-calls -mshort-calls -msmall16 -mfp-mode=mode
425 -mvect-double -max-vect-align=num -msplit-vecmove-early
426 -m1reg-reg
427
428 AMD GCN Options -march=gpu -mtune=gpu -mstack-size=bytes
429
430 ARC Options -mbarrel-shifter -mjli-always -mcpu=cpu -mA6
431 -mARC600 -mA7 -mARC700 -mdpfp -mdpfp-compact -mdpfp-fast
432 -mno-dpfp-lrsr -mea -mno-mpy -mmul32x16 -mmul64 -matomic -mnorm
433 -mspfp -mspfp-compact -mspfp-fast -msimd -msoft-float -mswap
434 -mcrc -mdsp-packa -mdvbf -mlock -mmac-d16 -mmac-24 -mrtsc
435 -mswape -mtelephony -mxy -misize -mannotate-align -marclinux
436 -marclinux_prof -mlong-calls -mmedium-calls -msdata
437 -mirq-ctrl-saved -mrgf-banked-regs -mlpc-width=width -G num
438 -mvolatile-cache -mtp-regno=regno -malign-call -mauto-modify-reg
439 -mbbit-peephole -mno-brcc -mcase-vector-pcrel -mcompact-casesi
440 -mno-cond-exec -mearly-cbranchsi -mexpand-adddi -mindexed-loads
441 -mlra -mlra-priority-none -mlra-priority-compact mlra-priority-
442 noncompact -mmillicode -mmixed-code -mq-class -mRcq -mRcw
443 -msize-level=level -mtune=cpu -mmultcost=num -mcode-density-frame
444 -munalign-prob-threshold=probability -mmpy-option=multo -mdiv-rem
445 -mcode-density -mll64 -mfpu=fpu -mrf16 -mbranch-index
446
447 ARM Options -mapcs-frame -mno-apcs-frame -mabi=name
448 -mapcs-stack-check -mno-apcs-stack-check -mapcs-reentrant
449 -mno-apcs-reentrant -mgeneral-regs-only -msched-prolog
450 -mno-sched-prolog -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -mbe8 -mbe32
451 -mfloat-abi=name -mfp16-format=name -mthumb-interwork
452 -mno-thumb-interwork -mcpu=name -march=name -mfpu=name
453 -mtune=name -mprint-tune-info -mstructure-size-boundary=n
454 -mabort-on-noreturn -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -msingle-pic-base
455 -mno-single-pic-base -mpic-register=reg -mnop-fun-dllimport
456 -mpoke-function-name -mthumb -marm -mflip-thumb -mtpcs-frame
457 -mtpcs-leaf-frame -mcaller-super-interworking
458 -mcallee-super-interworking -mtp=name -mtls-dialect=dialect
459 -mword-relocations -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd -munaligned-access
460 -mneon-for-64bits -mslow-flash-data -masm-syntax-unified
461 -mrestrict-it -mverbose-cost-dump -mpure-code -mcmse
462
463 AVR Options -mmcu=mcu -mabsdata -maccumulate-args
464 -mbranch-cost=cost -mcall-prologues -mgas-isr-prologues -mint8
465 -mn_flash=size -mno-interrupts -mmain-is-OS_task -mrelax -mrmw
466 -mstrict-X -mtiny-stack -mfract-convert-truncate -mshort-calls
467 -nodevicelib -Waddr-space-convert -Wmisspelled-isr
468
469 Blackfin Options -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision] -msim
470 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
471 -mspecld-anomaly -mno-specld-anomaly -mcsync-anomaly
472 -mno-csync-anomaly -mlow-64k -mno-low64k -mstack-check-l1
473 -mid-shared-library -mno-id-shared-library -mshared-library-id=n
474 -mleaf-id-shared-library -mno-leaf-id-shared-library -msep-data
475 -mno-sep-data -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -mfast-fp
476 -minline-plt -mmulticore -mcorea -mcoreb -msdram -micplb
477
478 C6X Options -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -march=cpu -msim
479 -msdata=sdata-type
480
481 CRIS Options -mcpu=cpu -march=cpu -mtune=cpu -mmax-stack-frame=n
482 -melinux-stacksize=n -metrax4 -metrax100 -mpdebug -mcc-init
483 -mno-side-effects -mstack-align -mdata-align -mconst-align
484 -m32-bit -m16-bit -m8-bit -mno-prologue-epilogue -mno-gotplt
485 -melf -maout -melinux -mlinux -sim -sim2 -mmul-bug-workaround
486 -mno-mul-bug-workaround
487
488 CR16 Options -mmac -mcr16cplus -mcr16c -msim -mint32 -mbit-ops
489 -mdata-model=model
490
491 C-SKY Options -march=arch -mcpu=cpu -mbig-endian -EB
492 -mlittle-endian -EL -mhard-float -msoft-float -mfpu=fpu
493 -mdouble-float -mfdivdu -melrw -mistack -mmp -mcp -mcache
494 -msecurity -mtrust -mdsp -medsp -mvdsp -mdiv -msmart
495 -mhigh-registers -manchor -mpushpop -mmultiple-stld -mconstpool
496 -mstack-size -mccrt -mbranch-cost=n -mcse-cc -msched-prolog
497
498 Darwin Options -all_load -allowable_client -arch
499 -arch_errors_fatal -arch_only -bind_at_load -bundle
500 -bundle_loader -client_name -compatibility_version
501 -current_version -dead_strip -dependency-file -dylib_file
502 -dylinker_install_name -dynamic -dynamiclib
503 -exported_symbols_list -filelist -flat_namespace
504 -force_cpusubtype_ALL -force_flat_namespace
505 -headerpad_max_install_names -iframework -image_base -init
506 -install_name -keep_private_externs -multi_module
507 -multiply_defined -multiply_defined_unused -noall_load
508 -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms -nofixprebinding -nomultidefs
509 -noprebind -noseglinkedit -pagezero_size -prebind
510 -prebind_all_twolevel_modules -private_bundle -read_only_relocs
511 -sectalign -sectobjectsymbols -whyload -seg1addr -sectcreate
512 -sectobjectsymbols -sectorder -segaddr -segs_read_only_addr
513 -segs_read_write_addr -seg_addr_table -seg_addr_table_filename
514 -seglinkedit -segprot -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr
515 -single_module -static -sub_library -sub_umbrella
516 -twolevel_namespace -umbrella -undefined -unexported_symbols_list
517 -weak_reference_mismatches -whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull
518 -mmacosx-version-min=version -mkernel -mone-byte-bool
519
520 DEC Alpha Options -mno-fp-regs -msoft-float -mieee
521 -mieee-with-inexact -mieee-conformant -mfp-trap-mode=mode
522 -mfp-rounding-mode=mode -mtrap-precision=mode -mbuild-constants
523 -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -mbwx -mmax -mfix -mcix
524 -mfloat-vax -mfloat-ieee -mexplicit-relocs -msmall-data
525 -mlarge-data -msmall-text -mlarge-text -mmemory-latency=time
526
527 FR30 Options -msmall-model -mno-lsim
528
529 FT32 Options -msim -mlra -mnodiv -mft32b -mcompress -mnopm
530
531 FRV Options -mgpr-32 -mgpr-64 -mfpr-32 -mfpr-64 -mhard-float
532 -msoft-float -malloc-cc -mfixed-cc -mdword -mno-dword -mdouble
533 -mno-double -mmedia -mno-media -mmuladd -mno-muladd -mfdpic
534 -minline-plt -mgprel-ro -multilib-library-pic -mlinked-fp
535 -mlong-calls -malign-labels -mlibrary-pic -macc-4 -macc-8 -mpack
536 -mno-pack -mno-eflags -mcond-move -mno-cond-move
537 -moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar -mscc -mno-scc
538 -mcond-exec -mno-cond-exec -mvliw-branch -mno-vliw-branch
539 -mmulti-cond-exec -mno-multi-cond-exec -mnested-cond-exec
540 -mno-nested-cond-exec -mtomcat-stats -mTLS -mtls -mcpu=cpu
541
542 GNU/Linux Options -mglibc -muclibc -mmusl -mbionic -mandroid
543 -tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld
544
545 H8/300 Options -mrelax -mh -ms -mn -mexr -mno-exr -mint32
546 -malign-300
547
548 HPPA Options -march=architecture-type -mcaller-copies
549 -mdisable-fpregs -mdisable-indexing -mfast-indirect-calls -mgas
550 -mgnu-ld -mhp-ld -mfixed-range=register-range -mjump-in-delay
551 -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls -mlong-load-store -mno-disable-fpregs
552 -mno-disable-indexing -mno-fast-indirect-calls -mno-gas
553 -mno-jump-in-delay -mno-long-load-store -mno-portable-runtime
554 -mno-soft-float -mno-space-regs -msoft-float -mpa-risc-1-0
555 -mpa-risc-1-1 -mpa-risc-2-0 -mportable-runtime -mschedule=cpu-
556 type -mspace-regs -msio -mwsio -munix=unix-std -nolibdld
557 -static -threads
558
559 IA-64 Options -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mgnu-as -mgnu-ld
560 -mno-pic -mvolatile-asm-stop -mregister-names -msdata -mno-sdata
561 -mconstant-gp -mauto-pic -mfused-madd
562 -minline-float-divide-min-latency
563 -minline-float-divide-max-throughput -mno-inline-float-divide
564 -minline-int-divide-min-latency -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
565 -mno-inline-int-divide -minline-sqrt-min-latency
566 -minline-sqrt-max-throughput -mno-inline-sqrt -mdwarf2-asm
567 -mearly-stop-bits -mfixed-range=register-range -mtls-size=tls-size
568 -mtune=cpu-type -milp32 -mlp64 -msched-br-data-spec
569 -msched-ar-data-spec -msched-control-spec -msched-br-in-data-spec
570 -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec -msched-spec-ldc
571 -msched-spec-control-ldc -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
572 -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
573 -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
574 -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
575 -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
576 -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit -msched-max-memory-insns=max-
577 insns
578
579 LM32 Options -mbarrel-shift-enabled -mdivide-enabled
580 -mmultiply-enabled -msign-extend-enabled -muser-enabled
581
582 M32R/D Options -m32r2 -m32rx -m32r -mdebug -malign-loops
583 -mno-align-loops -missue-rate=number -mbranch-cost=number
584 -mmodel=code-size-model-type -msdata=sdata-type -mno-flush-func
585 -mflush-func=name -mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=number -G num
586
587 M32C Options -mcpu=cpu -msim -memregs=number
588
589 M680x0 Options -march=arch -mcpu=cpu -mtune=tune -m68000 -m68020
590 -m68020-40 -m68020-60 -m68030 -m68040 -m68060 -mcpu32 -m5200
591 -m5206e -m528x -m5307 -m5407 -mcfv4e -mbitfield -mno-bitfield
592 -mc68000 -mc68020 -mnobitfield -mrtd -mno-rtd -mdiv -mno-div
593 -mshort -mno-short -mhard-float -m68881 -msoft-float -mpcrel
594 -malign-int -mstrict-align -msep-data -mno-sep-data
595 -mshared-library-id=n -mid-shared-library -mno-id-shared-library
596 -mxgot -mno-xgot -mlong-jump-table-offsets
597
598 MCore Options -mhardlit -mno-hardlit -mdiv -mno-div
599 -mrelax-immediates -mno-relax-immediates -mwide-bitfields
600 -mno-wide-bitfields -m4byte-functions -mno-4byte-functions
601 -mcallgraph-data -mno-callgraph-data -mslow-bytes -mno-slow-bytes
602 -mno-lsim -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -m210 -m340
603 -mstack-increment
604
605 MeP Options -mabsdiff -mall-opts -maverage -mbased=n -mbitops
606 -mc=n -mclip -mconfig=name -mcop -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 -mdc
607 -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax
608 -mmult -mno-opts -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim
609 -msimnovec -mtf -mtiny=n
610
611 MicroBlaze Options -msoft-float -mhard-float -msmall-divides
612 -mcpu=cpu -mmemcpy -mxl-soft-mul -mxl-soft-div -mxl-barrel-shift
613 -mxl-pattern-compare -mxl-stack-check -mxl-gp-opt -mno-clearbss
614 -mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt
615 -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mxl-reorder -mxl-mode-app-model
616 -mpic-data-is-text-relative
617
618 MIPS Options -EL -EB -march=arch -mtune=arch -mips1 -mips2
619 -mips3 -mips4 -mips32 -mips32r2 -mips32r3 -mips32r5 -mips32r6
620 -mips64 -mips64r2 -mips64r3 -mips64r5 -mips64r6 -mips16
621 -mno-mips16 -mflip-mips16 -minterlink-compressed
622 -mno-interlink-compressed -minterlink-mips16 -mno-interlink-mips16
623 -mabi=abi -mabicalls -mno-abicalls -mshared -mno-shared -mplt
624 -mno-plt -mxgot -mno-xgot -mgp32 -mgp64 -mfp32 -mfpxx -mfp64
625 -mhard-float -msoft-float -mno-float -msingle-float
626 -mdouble-float -modd-spreg -mno-odd-spreg -mabs=mode
627 -mnan=encoding -mdsp -mno-dsp -mdspr2 -mno-dspr2 -mmcu
628 -mmno-mcu -meva -mno-eva -mvirt -mno-virt -mxpa -mno-xpa -mcrc
629 -mno-crc -mginv -mno-ginv -mmicromips -mno-micromips -mmsa
630 -mno-msa -mloongson-mmi -mno-loongson-mmi -mloongson-ext
631 -mno-loongson-ext -mloongson-ext2 -mno-loongson-ext2 -mfpu=fpu-
632 type -msmartmips -mno-smartmips -mpaired-single
633 -mno-paired-single -mdmx -mno-mdmx -mips3d -mno-mips3d -mmt
634 -mno-mt -mllsc -mno-llsc -mlong64 -mlong32 -msym32 -mno-sym32
635 -Gnum -mlocal-sdata -mno-local-sdata -mextern-sdata
636 -mno-extern-sdata -mgpopt -mno-gopt -membedded-data
637 -mno-embedded-data -muninit-const-in-rodata
638 -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata -mcode-readable=setting
639 -msplit-addresses -mno-split-addresses -mexplicit-relocs
640 -mno-explicit-relocs -mcheck-zero-division
641 -mno-check-zero-division -mdivide-traps -mdivide-breaks
642 -mload-store-pairs -mno-load-store-pairs -mmemcpy -mno-memcpy
643 -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -mmad -mno-mad -mimadd -mno-imadd
644 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -nocpp -mfix-24k -mno-fix-24k
645 -mfix-r4000 -mno-fix-r4000 -mfix-r4400 -mno-fix-r4400
646 -mfix-r5900 -mno-fix-r5900 -mfix-r10000 -mno-fix-r10000
647 -mfix-rm7000 -mno-fix-rm7000 -mfix-vr4120 -mno-fix-vr4120
648 -mfix-vr4130 -mno-fix-vr4130 -mfix-sb1 -mno-fix-sb1
649 -mflush-func=func -mno-flush-func -mbranch-cost=num
650 -mbranch-likely -mno-branch-likely -mcompact-branches=policy
651 -mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions -mvr4130-align
652 -mno-vr4130-align -msynci -mno-synci -mlxc1-sxc1 -mno-lxc1-sxc1
653 -mmadd4 -mno-madd4 -mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls
654 -mmcount-ra-address -mframe-header-opt -mno-frame-header-opt
655
656 MMIX Options -mlibfuncs -mno-libfuncs -mepsilon -mno-epsilon
657 -mabi=gnu -mabi=mmixware -mzero-extend -mknuthdiv
658 -mtoplevel-symbols -melf -mbranch-predict -mno-branch-predict
659 -mbase-addresses -mno-base-addresses -msingle-exit
660 -mno-single-exit
661
662 MN10300 Options -mmult-bug -mno-mult-bug -mno-am33 -mam33
663 -mam33-2 -mam34 -mtune=cpu-type -mreturn-pointer-on-d0 -mno-crt0
664 -mrelax -mliw -msetlb
665
666 Moxie Options -meb -mel -mmul.x -mno-crt0
667
668 MSP430 Options -msim -masm-hex -mmcu= -mcpu= -mlarge -msmall
669 -mrelax -mwarn-mcu -mcode-region= -mdata-region= -msilicon-errata=
670 -msilicon-errata-warn= -mhwmult= -minrt
671
672 NDS32 Options -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mreduced-regs
673 -mfull-regs -mcmov -mno-cmov -mext-perf -mno-ext-perf -mext-perf2
674 -mno-ext-perf2 -mext-string -mno-ext-string -mv3push -mno-v3push
675 -m16bit -mno-16bit -misr-vector-size=num -mcache-block-size=num
676 -march=arch -mcmodel=code-model -mctor-dtor -mrelax
677
678 Nios II Options -G num -mgpopt=option -mgpopt -mno-gpopt
679 -mgprel-sec=regexp -mr0rel-sec=regexp -mel -meb -mno-bypass-cache
680 -mbypass-cache -mno-cache-volatile -mcache-volatile
681 -mno-fast-sw-div -mfast-sw-div -mhw-mul -mno-hw-mul -mhw-mulx
682 -mno-hw-mulx -mno-hw-div -mhw-div -mcustom-insn=N
683 -mno-custom-insn -mcustom-fpu-cfg=name -mhal -msmallc
684 -msys-crt0=name -msys-lib=name -march=arch -mbmx -mno-bmx -mcdx
685 -mno-cdx
686
687 Nvidia PTX Options -m32 -m64 -mmainkernel -moptimize
688
689 OpenRISC Options -mboard=name -mnewlib -mhard-mul -mhard-div
690 -msoft-mul -msoft-div -mcmov -mror -msext -msfimm -mshftimm
691
692 PDP-11 Options -mfpu -msoft-float -mac0 -mno-ac0 -m40 -m45
693 -m10 -mint32 -mno-int16 -mint16 -mno-int32 -msplit -munix-asm
694 -mdec-asm -mgnu-asm -mlra
695
696 picoChip Options -mae=ae_type -mvliw-lookahead=N
697 -msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings
698
699 PowerPC Options See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
700
701 RISC-V Options -mbranch-cost=N-instruction -mplt -mno-plt
702 -mabi=ABI-string -mfdiv -mno-fdiv -mdiv -mno-div -march=ISA-
703 string -mtune=processor-string -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
704 -msmall-data-limit=N-bytes -msave-restore -mno-save-restore
705 -mstrict-align -mno-strict-align -mcmodel=medlow -mcmodel=medany
706 -mexplicit-relocs -mno-explicit-relocs -mrelax -mno-relax
707 -mriscv-attribute -mmo-riscv-attribute
708
709 RL78 Options -msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=g14 -mallregs
710 -mcpu=g10 -mcpu=g13 -mcpu=g14 -mg10 -mg13 -mg14
711 -m64bit-doubles -m32bit-doubles -msave-mduc-in-interrupts
712
713 RS/6000 and PowerPC Options -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type
714 -mcmodel=code-model -mpowerpc64 -maltivec -mno-altivec
715 -mpowerpc-gpopt -mno-powerpc-gpopt -mpowerpc-gfxopt
716 -mno-powerpc-gfxopt -mmfcrf -mno-mfcrf -mpopcntb -mno-popcntb
717 -mpopcntd -mno-popcntd -mfprnd -mno-fprnd -mcmpb -mno-cmpb
718 -mmfpgpr -mno-mfpgpr -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp -mfull-toc
719 -mminimal-toc -mno-fp-in-toc -mno-sum-in-toc -m64 -m32
720 -mxl-compat -mno-xl-compat -mpe -malign-power -malign-natural
721 -msoft-float -mhard-float -mmultiple -mno-multiple -mupdate
722 -mno-update -mavoid-indexed-addresses -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
723 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -mbit-align -mno-bit-align
724 -mstrict-align -mno-strict-align -mrelocatable -mno-relocatable
725 -mrelocatable-lib -mno-relocatable-lib -mtoc -mno-toc -mlittle
726 -mlittle-endian -mbig -mbig-endian -mdynamic-no-pic -mswdiv
727 -msingle-pic-base -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority
728 -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
729 -mcall-aixdesc -mcall-eabi -mcall-freebsd -mcall-linux
730 -mcall-netbsd -mcall-openbsd -mcall-sysv -mcall-sysv-eabi
731 -mcall-sysv-noeabi -mtraceback=traceback_type -maix-struct-return
732 -msvr4-struct-return -mabi=abi-type -msecure-plt -mbss-plt
733 -mlongcall -mno-longcall -mpltseq -mno-pltseq
734 -mblock-move-inline-limit=num -mblock-compare-inline-limit=num
735 -mblock-compare-inline-loop-limit=num
736 -mstring-compare-inline-limit=num -misel -mno-isel -mvrsave
737 -mno-vrsave -mmulhw -mno-mulhw -mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb -mprototype
738 -mno-prototype -msim -mmvme -mads -myellowknife -memb -msdata
739 -msdata=opt -mreadonly-in-sdata -mvxworks -G num -mrecip
740 -mrecip=opt -mno-recip -mrecip-precision -mno-recip-precision
741 -mveclibabi=type -mfriz -mno-friz -mpointers-to-nested-functions
742 -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions -msave-toc-indirect
743 -mno-save-toc-indirect -mpower8-fusion -mno-mpower8-fusion
744 -mpower8-vector -mno-power8-vector -mcrypto -mno-crypto -mhtm
745 -mno-htm -mquad-memory -mno-quad-memory -mquad-memory-atomic
746 -mno-quad-memory-atomic -mcompat-align-parm -mno-compat-align-parm
747 -mfloat128 -mno-float128 -mfloat128-hardware
748 -mno-float128-hardware -mgnu-attribute -mno-gnu-attribute
749 -mstack-protector-guard=guard -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
750 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
751
752 RX Options -m64bit-doubles -m32bit-doubles -fpu -nofpu -mcpu=
753 -mbig-endian-data -mlittle-endian-data -msmall-data -msim
754 -mno-sim -mas100-syntax -mno-as100-syntax -mrelax
755 -mmax-constant-size= -mint-register= -mpid -mallow-string-insns
756 -mno-allow-string-insns -mjsr -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
757 -msave-acc-in-interrupts
758
759 S/390 and zSeries Options -mtune=cpu-type -march=cpu-type
760 -mhard-float -msoft-float -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp
761 -mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 -mbackchain -mno-backchain
762 -mpacked-stack -mno-packed-stack -msmall-exec -mno-small-exec
763 -mmvcle -mno-mvcle -m64 -m31 -mdebug -mno-debug -mesa -mzarch
764 -mhtm -mvx -mzvector -mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace -mfused-madd
765 -mno-fused-madd -mwarn-framesize -mwarn-dynamicstack -mstack-size
766 -mstack-guard -mhotpatch=halfwords,halfwords
767
768 Score Options -meb -mel -mnhwloop -muls -mmac -mscore5 -mscore5u
769 -mscore7 -mscore7d
770
771 SH Options -m1 -m2 -m2e -m2a-nofpu -m2a-single-only -m2a-single
772 -m2a -m3 -m3e -m4-nofpu -m4-single-only -m4-single -m4
773 -m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al -mb -ml
774 -mdalign -mrelax -mbigtable -mfmovd -mrenesas -mno-renesas
775 -mnomacsave -mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops -misize
776 -minline-ic_invalidate -mpadstruct -mprefergot -musermode
777 -multcost=number -mdiv=strategy -mdivsi3_libfunc=name
778 -mfixed-range=register-range -maccumulate-outgoing-args
779 -matomic-model=atomic-model -mbranch-cost=num -mzdcbranch
780 -mno-zdcbranch -mcbranch-force-delay-slot -mfused-madd
781 -mno-fused-madd -mfsca -mno-fsca -mfsrra -mno-fsrra
782 -mpretend-cmove -mtas
783
784 Solaris 2 Options -mclear-hwcap -mno-clear-hwcap -mimpure-text
785 -mno-impure-text -pthreads
786
787 SPARC Options -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -mcmodel=code-model
788 -mmemory-model=mem-model -m32 -m64 -mapp-regs -mno-app-regs
789 -mfaster-structs -mno-faster-structs -mflat -mno-flat -mfpu
790 -mno-fpu -mhard-float -msoft-float -mhard-quad-float
791 -msoft-quad-float -mstack-bias -mno-stack-bias -mstd-struct-return
792 -mno-std-struct-return -munaligned-doubles -mno-unaligned-doubles
793 -muser-mode -mno-user-mode -mv8plus -mno-v8plus -mvis -mno-vis
794 -mvis2 -mno-vis2 -mvis3 -mno-vis3 -mvis4 -mno-vis4 -mvis4b
795 -mno-vis4b -mcbcond -mno-cbcond -mfmaf -mno-fmaf -mfsmuld
796 -mno-fsmuld -mpopc -mno-popc -msubxc -mno-subxc -mfix-at697f
797 -mfix-ut699 -mfix-ut700 -mfix-gr712rc -mlra -mno-lra
798
799 SPU Options -mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc -msafe-dma -munsafe-dma
800 -mbranch-hints -msmall-mem -mlarge-mem -mstdmain
801 -mfixed-range=register-range -mea32 -mea64
802 -maddress-space-conversion -mno-address-space-conversion
803 -mcache-size=cache-size -matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates
804
805 System V Options -Qy -Qn -YP,paths -Ym,dir
806
807 TILE-Gx Options -mcpu=CPU -m32 -m64 -mbig-endian
808 -mlittle-endian -mcmodel=code-model
809
810 TILEPro Options -mcpu=cpu -m32
811
812 V850 Options -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -mep -mno-ep
813 -mprolog-function -mno-prolog-function -mspace -mtda=n -msda=n
814 -mzda=n -mapp-regs -mno-app-regs -mdisable-callt
815 -mno-disable-callt -mv850e2v3 -mv850e2 -mv850e1 -mv850es -mv850e
816 -mv850 -mv850e3v5 -mloop -mrelax -mlong-jumps -msoft-float
817 -mhard-float -mgcc-abi -mrh850-abi -mbig-switch
818
819 VAX Options -mg -mgnu -munix
820
821 Visium Options -mdebug -msim -mfpu -mno-fpu -mhard-float
822 -msoft-float -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -msv-mode
823 -muser-mode
824
825 VMS Options -mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=prefix -mmalloc64
826 -mpointer-size=size
827
828 VxWorks Options -mrtp -non-static -Bstatic -Bdynamic -Xbind-lazy
829 -Xbind-now
830
831 x86 Options -mtune=cpu-type -march=cpu-type -mtune-ctrl=feature-
832 list -mdump-tune-features -mno-default -mfpmath=unit
833 -masm=dialect -mno-fancy-math-387 -mno-fp-ret-in-387 -m80387
834 -mhard-float -msoft-float -mno-wide-multiply -mrtd
835 -malign-double -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
836 -mincoming-stack-boundary=num -mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe
837 -mcrc32 -mrecip -mrecip=opt -mvzeroupper -mprefer-avx128
838 -mprefer-vector-width=opt -mmmx -msse -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3
839 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx -mavx2 -mavx512f -mavx512pf
840 -mavx512er -mavx512cd -mavx512vl -mavx512bw -mavx512dq
841 -mavx512ifma -mavx512vbmi -msha -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase
842 -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfma -mpconfig -mwbnoinvd -mptwrite
843 -mprefetchwt1 -mclflushopt -mclwb -mxsavec -mxsaves -msse4a
844 -m3dnow -m3dnowa -mpopcnt -mabm -mbmi -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop
845 -madx -mlzcnt -mbmi2 -mfxsr -mxsave -mxsaveopt -mrtm -mhle
846 -mlwp -mmwaitx -mclzero -mpku -mthreads -mgfni -mvaes
847 -mwaitpkg -mshstk -mmanual-endbr -mforce-indirect-call
848 -mavx512vbmi2 -mvpclmulqdq -mavx512bitalg -mmovdiri -mmovdir64b
849 -mavx512vpopcntdq -mavx5124fmaps -mavx512vnni -mavx5124vnniw
850 -mprfchw -mrdpid -mrdseed -msgx -mcldemote -mms-bitfields
851 -mno-align-stringops -minline-all-stringops
852 -minline-stringops-dynamically -mstringop-strategy=alg
853 -mmemcpy-strategy=strategy -mmemset-strategy=strategy -mpush-args
854 -maccumulate-outgoing-args -m128bit-long-double
855 -m96bit-long-double -mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-80
856 -mlong-double-128 -mregparm=num -msseregparm -mveclibabi=type
857 -mvect8-ret-in-mem -mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign
858 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
859 -mcmodel=code-model -mabi=name -maddress-mode=mode -m32 -m64
860 -mx32 -m16 -miamcu -mlarge-data-threshold=num -msse2avx
861 -mfentry -mrecord-mcount -mnop-mcount -m8bit-idiv
862 -minstrument-return=type -mfentry-name=name -mfentry-section=name
863 -mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
864 -malign-data=type -mstack-protector-guard=guard
865 -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
866 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
867 -mstack-protector-guard-symbol=symbol -mgeneral-regs-only
868 -mcall-ms2sysv-xlogues -mindirect-branch=choice
869 -mfunction-return=choice -mindirect-branch-register
870
871 x86 Windows Options -mconsole -mcygwin -mno-cygwin -mdll
872 -mnop-fun-dllimport -mthread -municode -mwin32 -mwindows
873 -fno-set-stack-executable
874
875 Xstormy16 Options -msim
876
877 Xtensa Options -mconst16 -mno-const16 -mfused-madd
878 -mno-fused-madd -mforce-no-pic -mserialize-volatile
879 -mno-serialize-volatile -mtext-section-literals
880 -mno-text-section-literals -mauto-litpools -mno-auto-litpools
881 -mtarget-align -mno-target-align -mlongcalls -mno-longcalls
882
883 zSeries Options See S/390 and zSeries Options.
884
885 Options Controlling the Kind of Output
886 Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
887 proper, assembly and linking, always in that order. GCC is capable of
888 preprocessing and compiling several files either into several assembler
889 input files, or into one assembler input file; then each assembler
890 input file produces an object file, and linking combines all the object
891 files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input) into an
892 executable file.
893
894 For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
895 compilation is done:
896
897 file.c
898 C source code that must be preprocessed.
899
900 file.i
901 C source code that should not be preprocessed.
902
903 file.ii
904 C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
905
906 file.m
907 Objective-C source code. Note that you must link with the libobjc
908 library to make an Objective-C program work.
909
910 file.mi
911 Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.
912
913 file.mm
914 file.M
915 Objective-C++ source code. Note that you must link with the
916 libobjc library to make an Objective-C++ program work. Note that
917 .M refers to a literal capital M.
918
919 file.mii
920 Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
921
922 file.h
923 C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into
924 a precompiled header (default), or C, C++ header file to be turned
925 into an Ada spec (via the -fdump-ada-spec switch).
926
927 file.cc
928 file.cp
929 file.cxx
930 file.cpp
931 file.CPP
932 file.c++
933 file.C
934 C++ source code that must be preprocessed. Note that in .cxx, the
935 last two letters must both be literally x. Likewise, .C refers to
936 a literal capital C.
937
938 file.mm
939 file.M
940 Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.
941
942 file.mii
943 Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
944
945 file.hh
946 file.H
947 file.hp
948 file.hxx
949 file.hpp
950 file.HPP
951 file.h++
952 file.tcc
953 C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.
954
955 file.f
956 file.for
957 file.ftn
958 Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
959
960 file.F
961 file.FOR
962 file.fpp
963 file.FPP
964 file.FTN
965 Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
966 traditional preprocessor).
967
968 file.f90
969 file.f95
970 file.f03
971 file.f08
972 Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
973
974 file.F90
975 file.F95
976 file.F03
977 file.F08
978 Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
979 traditional preprocessor).
980
981 file.go
982 Go source code.
983
984 file.brig
985 BRIG files (binary representation of HSAIL).
986
987 file.d
988 D source code.
989
990 file.di
991 D interface file.
992
993 file.dd
994 D documentation code (Ddoc).
995
996 file.ads
997 Ada source code file that contains a library unit declaration (a
998 declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
999 instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
1000 generic, or subprogram renaming declaration). Such files are also
1001 called specs.
1002
1003 file.adb
1004 Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram
1005 or package body). Such files are also called bodies.
1006
1007 file.s
1008 Assembler code.
1009
1010 file.S
1011 file.sx
1012 Assembler code that must be preprocessed.
1013
1014 other
1015 An object file to be fed straight into linking. Any file name with
1016 no recognized suffix is treated this way.
1017
1018 You can specify the input language explicitly with the -x option:
1019
1020 -x language
1021 Specify explicitly the language for the following input files
1022 (rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the
1023 file name suffix). This option applies to all following input
1024 files until the next -x option. Possible values for language are:
1025
1026 c c-header cpp-output
1027 c++ c++-header c++-cpp-output
1028 objective-c objective-c-header objective-c-cpp-output
1029 objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
1030 assembler assembler-with-cpp
1031 ada
1032 d
1033 f77 f77-cpp-input f95 f95-cpp-input
1034 go
1035 brig
1036
1037 -x none
1038 Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files
1039 are handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if
1040 -x has not been used at all).
1041
1042 If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use -x (or
1043 filename suffixes) to tell gcc where to start, and one of the options
1044 -c, -S, or -E to say where gcc is to stop. Note that some combinations
1045 (for example, -x cpp-output -E) instruct gcc to do nothing at all.
1046
1047 -c Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link. The linking
1048 stage simply is not done. The ultimate output is in the form of an
1049 object file for each source file.
1050
1051 By default, the object file name for a source file is made by
1052 replacing the suffix .c, .i, .s, etc., with .o.
1053
1054 Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly,
1055 are ignored.
1056
1057 -S Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble. The
1058 output is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-
1059 assembler input file specified.
1060
1061 By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
1062 replacing the suffix .c, .i, etc., with .s.
1063
1064 Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1065
1066 -E Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.
1067 The output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is
1068 sent to the standard output.
1069
1070 Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1071
1072 -o file
1073 Place output in file file. This applies to whatever sort of output
1074 is being produced, whether it be an executable file, an object
1075 file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1076
1077 If -o is not specified, the default is to put an executable file in
1078 a.out, the object file for source.suffix in source.o, its assembler
1079 file in source.s, a precompiled header file in source.suffix.gch,
1080 and all preprocessed C source on standard output.
1081
1082 -v Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the
1083 stages of compilation. Also print the version number of the
1084 compiler driver program and of the preprocessor and the compiler
1085 proper.
1086
1087 -###
1088 Like -v except the commands are not executed and arguments are
1089 quoted unless they contain only alphanumeric characters or "./-_".
1090 This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated
1091 command lines.
1092
1093 --help
1094 Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1095 options understood by gcc. If the -v option is also specified then
1096 --help is also passed on to the various processes invoked by gcc,
1097 so that they can display the command-line options they accept. If
1098 the -Wextra option has also been specified (prior to the --help
1099 option), then command-line options that have no documentation
1100 associated with them are also displayed.
1101
1102 --target-help
1103 Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific
1104 command-line options for each tool. For some targets extra target-
1105 specific information may also be printed.
1106
1107 --help={class|[^]qualifier}[,...]
1108 Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1109 options understood by the compiler that fit into all specified
1110 classes and qualifiers. These are the supported classes:
1111
1112 optimizers
1113 Display all of the optimization options supported by the
1114 compiler.
1115
1116 warnings
1117 Display all of the options controlling warning messages
1118 produced by the compiler.
1119
1120 target
1121 Display target-specific options. Unlike the --target-help
1122 option however, target-specific options of the linker and
1123 assembler are not displayed. This is because those tools do
1124 not currently support the extended --help= syntax.
1125
1126 params
1127 Display the values recognized by the --param option.
1128
1129 language
1130 Display the options supported for language, where language is
1131 the name of one of the languages supported in this version of
1132 GCC.
1133
1134 common
1135 Display the options that are common to all languages.
1136
1137 These are the supported qualifiers:
1138
1139 undocumented
1140 Display only those options that are undocumented.
1141
1142 joined
1143 Display options taking an argument that appears after an equal
1144 sign in the same continuous piece of text, such as:
1145 --help=target.
1146
1147 separate
1148 Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate
1149 word following the original option, such as: -o output-file.
1150
1151 Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific
1152 switches supported by the compiler, use:
1153
1154 --help=target,undocumented
1155
1156 The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the ^
1157 character, so for example to display all binary warning options
1158 (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
1159 argument) that have a description, use:
1160
1161 --help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented
1162
1163 The argument to --help= should not consist solely of inverted
1164 qualifiers.
1165
1166 Combining several classes is possible, although this usually
1167 restricts the output so much that there is nothing to display. One
1168 case where it does work, however, is when one of the classes is
1169 target. For example, to display all the target-specific
1170 optimization options, use:
1171
1172 --help=target,optimizers
1173
1174 The --help= option can be repeated on the command line. Each
1175 successive use displays its requested class of options, skipping
1176 those that have already been displayed. If --help is also
1177 specified anywhere on the command line then this takes precedence
1178 over any --help= option.
1179
1180 If the -Q option appears on the command line before the --help=
1181 option, then the descriptive text displayed by --help= is changed.
1182 Instead of describing the displayed options, an indication is given
1183 as to whether the option is enabled, disabled or set to a specific
1184 value (assuming that the compiler knows this at the point where the
1185 --help= option is used).
1186
1187 Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of gcc:
1188
1189 % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
1190 The following options are target specific:
1191 -mabi= 2
1192 -mabort-on-noreturn [disabled]
1193 -mapcs [disabled]
1194
1195 The output is sensitive to the effects of previous command-line
1196 options, so for example it is possible to find out which
1197 optimizations are enabled at -O2 by using:
1198
1199 -Q -O2 --help=optimizers
1200
1201 Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are
1202 enabled by -O3 by using:
1203
1204 gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
1205 gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
1206 diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled
1207
1208 --version
1209 Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC.
1210
1211 -pass-exit-codes
1212 Normally the gcc program exits with the code of 1 if any phase of
1213 the compiler returns a non-success return code. If you specify
1214 -pass-exit-codes, the gcc program instead returns with the
1215 numerically highest error produced by any phase returning an error
1216 indication. The C, C++, and Fortran front ends return 4 if an
1217 internal compiler error is encountered.
1218
1219 -pipe
1220 Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1221 various stages of compilation. This fails to work on some systems
1222 where the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU
1223 assembler has no trouble.
1224
1225 -specs=file
1226 Process file after the compiler reads in the standard specs file,
1227 in order to override the defaults which the gcc driver program uses
1228 when determining what switches to pass to cc1, cc1plus, as, ld,
1229 etc. More than one -specs=file can be specified on the command
1230 line, and they are processed in order, from left to right.
1231
1232 -wrapper
1233 Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program. The name of the
1234 wrapper program and its parameters are passed as a comma separated
1235 list.
1236
1237 gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args
1238
1239 This invokes all subprograms of gcc under gdb --args, thus the
1240 invocation of cc1 is gdb --args cc1 ....
1241
1242 -ffile-prefix-map=old=new
1243 When compiling files residing in directory old, record any
1244 references to them in the result of the compilation as if the files
1245 resided in directory new instead. Specifying this option is
1246 equivalent to specifying all the individual -f*-prefix-map options.
1247 This can be used to make reproducible builds that are location
1248 independent. See also -fmacro-prefix-map and -fdebug-prefix-map.
1249
1250 -fplugin=name.so
1251 Load the plugin code in file name.so, assumed to be a shared object
1252 to be dlopen'd by the compiler. The base name of the shared object
1253 file is used to identify the plugin for the purposes of argument
1254 parsing (See -fplugin-arg-name-key=value below). Each plugin
1255 should define the callback functions specified in the Plugins API.
1256
1257 -fplugin-arg-name-key=value
1258 Define an argument called key with a value of value for the plugin
1259 called name.
1260
1261 -fdump-ada-spec[-slim]
1262 For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada
1263 specs.
1264
1265 -fada-spec-parent=unit
1266 In conjunction with -fdump-ada-spec[-slim] above, generate Ada
1267 specs as child units of parent unit.
1268
1269 -fdump-go-spec=file
1270 For input files in any language, generate corresponding Go
1271 declarations in file. This generates Go "const", "type", "var",
1272 and "func" declarations which may be a useful way to start writing
1273 a Go interface to code written in some other language.
1274
1275 @file
1276 Read command-line options from file. The options read are inserted
1277 in place of the original @file option. If file does not exist, or
1278 cannot be read, then the option will be treated literally, and not
1279 removed.
1280
1281 Options in file are separated by whitespace. A whitespace
1282 character may be included in an option by surrounding the entire
1283 option in either single or double quotes. Any character (including
1284 a backslash) may be included by prefixing the character to be
1285 included with a backslash. The file may itself contain additional
1286 @file options; any such options will be processed recursively.
1287
1288 Compiling C++ Programs
1289 C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes .C, .cc, .cpp,
1290 .CPP, .c++, .cp, or .cxx; C++ header files often use .hh, .hpp, .H, or
1291 (for shared template code) .tcc; and preprocessed C++ files use the
1292 suffix .ii. GCC recognizes files with these names and compiles them as
1293 C++ programs even if you call the compiler the same way as for
1294 compiling C programs (usually with the name gcc).
1295
1296 However, the use of gcc does not add the C++ library. g++ is a program
1297 that calls GCC and automatically specifies linking against the C++
1298 library. It treats .c, .h and .i files as C++ source files instead of
1299 C source files unless -x is used. This program is also useful when
1300 precompiling a C header file with a .h extension for use in C++
1301 compilations. On many systems, g++ is also installed with the name
1302 c++.
1303
1304 When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1305 command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1306 language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1307 languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1308
1309 Options Controlling C Dialect
1310 The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1311 from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1312 accepts:
1313
1314 -ansi
1315 In C mode, this is equivalent to -std=c90. In C++ mode, it is
1316 equivalent to -std=c++98.
1317
1318 This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with
1319 ISO C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling
1320 C++ code), such as the "asm" and "typeof" keywords, and predefined
1321 macros such as "unix" and "vax" that identify the type of system
1322 you are using. It also enables the undesirable and rarely used ISO
1323 trigraph feature. For the C compiler, it disables recognition of
1324 C++ style // comments as well as the "inline" keyword.
1325
1326 The alternate keywords "__asm__", "__extension__", "__inline__" and
1327 "__typeof__" continue to work despite -ansi. You would not want to
1328 use them in an ISO C program, of course, but it is useful to put
1329 them in header files that might be included in compilations done
1330 with -ansi. Alternate predefined macros such as "__unix__" and
1331 "__vax__" are also available, with or without -ansi.
1332
1333 The -ansi option does not cause non-ISO programs to be rejected
1334 gratuitously. For that, -Wpedantic is required in addition to
1335 -ansi.
1336
1337 The macro "__STRICT_ANSI__" is predefined when the -ansi option is
1338 used. Some header files may notice this macro and refrain from
1339 declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the ISO
1340 standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1341 programs that might use these names for other things.
1342
1343 Functions that are normally built in but do not have semantics
1344 defined by ISO C (such as "alloca" and "ffs") are not built-in
1345 functions when -ansi is used.
1346
1347 -std=
1348 Determine the language standard. This option is currently only
1349 supported when compiling C or C++.
1350
1351 The compiler can accept several base standards, such as c90 or
1352 c++98, and GNU dialects of those standards, such as gnu90 or
1353 gnu++98. When a base standard is specified, the compiler accepts
1354 all programs following that standard plus those using GNU
1355 extensions that do not contradict it. For example, -std=c90 turns
1356 off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO C90,
1357 such as the "asm" and "typeof" keywords, but not other GNU
1358 extensions that do not have a meaning in ISO C90, such as omitting
1359 the middle term of a "?:" expression. On the other hand, when a GNU
1360 dialect of a standard is specified, all features supported by the
1361 compiler are enabled, even when those features change the meaning
1362 of the base standard. As a result, some strict-conforming programs
1363 may be rejected. The particular standard is used by -Wpedantic to
1364 identify which features are GNU extensions given that version of
1365 the standard. For example -std=gnu90 -Wpedantic warns about C++
1366 style // comments, while -std=gnu99 -Wpedantic does not.
1367
1368 A value for this option must be provided; possible values are
1369
1370 c90
1371 c89
1372 iso9899:1990
1373 Support all ISO C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that
1374 conflict with ISO C90 are disabled). Same as -ansi for C code.
1375
1376 iso9899:199409
1377 ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1378
1379 c99
1380 c9x
1381 iso9899:1999
1382 iso9899:199x
1383 ISO C99. This standard is substantially completely supported,
1384 modulo bugs and floating-point issues (mainly but not entirely
1385 relating to optional C99 features from Annexes F and G). See
1386 <http://gcc.gnu.org/c99status.html> for more information. The
1387 names c9x and iso9899:199x are deprecated.
1388
1389 c11
1390 c1x
1391 iso9899:2011
1392 ISO C11, the 2011 revision of the ISO C standard. This
1393 standard is substantially completely supported, modulo bugs,
1394 floating-point issues (mainly but not entirely relating to
1395 optional C11 features from Annexes F and G) and the optional
1396 Annexes K (Bounds-checking interfaces) and L (Analyzability).
1397 The name c1x is deprecated.
1398
1399 c17
1400 c18
1401 iso9899:2017
1402 iso9899:2018
1403 ISO C17, the 2017 revision of the ISO C standard (published in
1404 2018). This standard is same as C11 except for corrections of
1405 defects (all of which are also applied with -std=c11) and a new
1406 value of "__STDC_VERSION__", and so is supported to the same
1407 extent as C11.
1408
1409 c2x The next version of the ISO C standard, still under
1410 development. The support for this version is experimental and
1411 incomplete.
1412
1413 gnu90
1414 gnu89
1415 GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features).
1416
1417 gnu99
1418 gnu9x
1419 GNU dialect of ISO C99. The name gnu9x is deprecated.
1420
1421 gnu11
1422 gnu1x
1423 GNU dialect of ISO C11. The name gnu1x is deprecated.
1424
1425 gnu17
1426 gnu18
1427 GNU dialect of ISO C17. This is the default for C code.
1428
1429 gnu2x
1430 The next version of the ISO C standard, still under
1431 development, plus GNU extensions. The support for this version
1432 is experimental and incomplete.
1433
1434 c++98
1435 c++03
1436 The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus the 2003 technical corrigendum
1437 and some additional defect reports. Same as -ansi for C++ code.
1438
1439 gnu++98
1440 gnu++03
1441 GNU dialect of -std=c++98.
1442
1443 c++11
1444 c++0x
1445 The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. The name c++0x is
1446 deprecated.
1447
1448 gnu++11
1449 gnu++0x
1450 GNU dialect of -std=c++11. The name gnu++0x is deprecated.
1451
1452 c++14
1453 c++1y
1454 The 2014 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. The name c++1y is
1455 deprecated.
1456
1457 gnu++14
1458 gnu++1y
1459 GNU dialect of -std=c++14. This is the default for C++ code.
1460 The name gnu++1y is deprecated.
1461
1462 c++17
1463 c++1z
1464 The 2017 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. The name c++1z is
1465 deprecated.
1466
1467 gnu++17
1468 gnu++1z
1469 GNU dialect of -std=c++17. The name gnu++1z is deprecated.
1470
1471 c++2a
1472 The next revision of the ISO C++ standard, tentatively planned
1473 for 2020. Support is highly experimental, and will almost
1474 certainly change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1475
1476 gnu++2a
1477 GNU dialect of -std=c++2a. Support is highly experimental, and
1478 will almost certainly change in incompatible ways in future
1479 releases.
1480
1481 -fgnu89-inline
1482 The option -fgnu89-inline tells GCC to use the traditional GNU
1483 semantics for "inline" functions when in C99 mode.
1484
1485 Using this option is roughly equivalent to adding the "gnu_inline"
1486 function attribute to all inline functions.
1487
1488 The option -fno-gnu89-inline explicitly tells GCC to use the C99
1489 semantics for "inline" when in C99 or gnu99 mode (i.e., it
1490 specifies the default behavior). This option is not supported in
1491 -std=c90 or -std=gnu90 mode.
1492
1493 The preprocessor macros "__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__" and
1494 "__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__" may be used to check which semantics are in
1495 effect for "inline" functions.
1496
1497 -fpermitted-flt-eval-methods=style
1498 ISO/IEC TS 18661-3 defines new permissible values for
1499 "FLT_EVAL_METHOD" that indicate that operations and constants with
1500 a semantic type that is an interchange or extended format should be
1501 evaluated to the precision and range of that type. These new
1502 values are a superset of those permitted under C99/C11, which does
1503 not specify the meaning of other positive values of
1504 "FLT_EVAL_METHOD". As such, code conforming to C11 may not have
1505 been written expecting the possibility of the new values.
1506
1507 -fpermitted-flt-eval-methods specifies whether the compiler should
1508 allow only the values of "FLT_EVAL_METHOD" specified in C99/C11, or
1509 the extended set of values specified in ISO/IEC TS 18661-3.
1510
1511 style is either "c11" or "ts-18661-3" as appropriate.
1512
1513 The default when in a standards compliant mode (-std=c11 or
1514 similar) is -fpermitted-flt-eval-methods=c11. The default when in
1515 a GNU dialect (-std=gnu11 or similar) is
1516 -fpermitted-flt-eval-methods=ts-18661-3.
1517
1518 -aux-info filename
1519 Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all
1520 functions declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including
1521 those in header files. This option is silently ignored in any
1522 language other than C.
1523
1524 Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin
1525 of each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration
1526 was implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (I, N for new or O for
1527 old, respectively, in the first character after the line number and
1528 the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a definition
1529 (C or F, respectively, in the following character). In the case of
1530 function definitions, a K&R-style list of arguments followed by
1531 their declarations is also provided, inside comments, after the
1532 declaration.
1533
1534 -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1535 Accept variadic functions without named parameters.
1536
1537 Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very
1538 useful as it is not possible to read the arguments. This is only
1539 supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.
1540
1541 -fno-asm
1542 Do not recognize "asm", "inline" or "typeof" as a keyword, so that
1543 code can use these words as identifiers. You can use the keywords
1544 "__asm__", "__inline__" and "__typeof__" instead. -ansi implies
1545 -fno-asm.
1546
1547 In C++, this switch only affects the "typeof" keyword, since "asm"
1548 and "inline" are standard keywords. You may want to use the
1549 -fno-gnu-keywords flag instead, which has the same effect. In C99
1550 mode (-std=c99 or -std=gnu99), this switch only affects the "asm"
1551 and "typeof" keywords, since "inline" is a standard keyword in ISO
1552 C99.
1553
1554 -fno-builtin
1555 -fno-builtin-function
1556 Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1557 __builtin_ as prefix.
1558
1559 GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in
1560 functions more efficiently; for instance, calls to "alloca" may
1561 become single instructions which adjust the stack directly, and
1562 calls to "memcpy" may become inline copy loops. The resulting code
1563 is often both smaller and faster, but since the function calls no
1564 longer appear as such, you cannot set a breakpoint on those calls,
1565 nor can you change the behavior of the functions by linking with a
1566 different library. In addition, when a function is recognized as a
1567 built-in function, GCC may use information about that function to
1568 warn about problems with calls to that function, or to generate
1569 more efficient code, even if the resulting code still contains
1570 calls to that function. For example, warnings are given with
1571 -Wformat for bad calls to "printf" when "printf" is built in and
1572 "strlen" is known not to modify global memory.
1573
1574 With the -fno-builtin-function option only the built-in function
1575 function is disabled. function must not begin with __builtin_. If
1576 a function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC,
1577 this option is ignored. There is no corresponding
1578 -fbuiltin-function option; if you wish to enable built-in functions
1579 selectively when using -fno-builtin or -ffreestanding, you may
1580 define macros such as:
1581
1582 #define abs(n) __builtin_abs ((n))
1583 #define strcpy(d, s) __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1584
1585 -fgimple
1586 Enable parsing of function definitions marked with "__GIMPLE".
1587 This is an experimental feature that allows unit testing of GIMPLE
1588 passes.
1589
1590 -fhosted
1591 Assert that compilation targets a hosted environment. This implies
1592 -fbuiltin. A hosted environment is one in which the entire
1593 standard library is available, and in which "main" has a return
1594 type of "int". Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1595 This is equivalent to -fno-freestanding.
1596
1597 -ffreestanding
1598 Assert that compilation targets a freestanding environment. This
1599 implies -fno-builtin. A freestanding environment is one in which
1600 the standard library may not exist, and program startup may not
1601 necessarily be at "main". The most obvious example is an OS
1602 kernel. This is equivalent to -fno-hosted.
1603
1604 -fopenacc
1605 Enable handling of OpenACC directives "#pragma acc" in C/C++ and
1606 "!$acc" in Fortran. When -fopenacc is specified, the compiler
1607 generates accelerated code according to the OpenACC Application
1608 Programming Interface v2.0 <https://www.openacc.org>. This option
1609 implies -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets that have
1610 support for -pthread.
1611
1612 -fopenacc-dim=geom
1613 Specify default compute dimensions for parallel offload regions
1614 that do not explicitly specify. The geom value is a triple of
1615 ':'-separated sizes, in order 'gang', 'worker' and, 'vector'. A
1616 size can be omitted, to use a target-specific default value.
1617
1618 -fopenmp
1619 Enable handling of OpenMP directives "#pragma omp" in C/C++ and
1620 "!$omp" in Fortran. When -fopenmp is specified, the compiler
1621 generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application Program
1622 Interface v4.5 <https://www.openmp.org>. This option implies
1623 -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets that have support
1624 for -pthread. -fopenmp implies -fopenmp-simd.
1625
1626 -fopenmp-simd
1627 Enable handling of OpenMP's SIMD directives with "#pragma omp" in
1628 C/C++ and "!$omp" in Fortran. Other OpenMP directives are ignored.
1629
1630 -fgnu-tm
1631 When the option -fgnu-tm is specified, the compiler generates code
1632 for the Linux variant of Intel's current Transactional Memory ABI
1633 specification document (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009). This is an
1634 experimental feature whose interface may change in future versions
1635 of GCC, as the official specification changes. Please note that
1636 not all architectures are supported for this feature.
1637
1638 For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,
1639
1640 Note that the transactional memory feature is not supported with
1641 non-call exceptions (-fnon-call-exceptions).
1642
1643 -fms-extensions
1644 Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1645
1646 In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar
1647 to previous types declarations.
1648
1649 typedef int UOW;
1650 struct ABC {
1651 UOW UOW;
1652 };
1653
1654 Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1655 accepted with this option.
1656
1657 Note that this option is off for all targets but x86 targets using
1658 ms-abi.
1659
1660 -fplan9-extensions
1661 Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.
1662
1663 This enables -fms-extensions, permits passing pointers to
1664 structures with anonymous fields to functions that expect pointers
1665 to elements of the type of the field, and permits referring to
1666 anonymous fields declared using a typedef. This is only
1667 supported for C, not C++.
1668
1669 -fcond-mismatch
1670 Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second
1671 and third arguments. The value of such an expression is void.
1672 This option is not supported for C++.
1673
1674 -flax-vector-conversions
1675 Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers
1676 of elements and/or incompatible element types. This option should
1677 not be used for new code.
1678
1679 -funsigned-char
1680 Let the type "char" be unsigned, like "unsigned char".
1681
1682 Each kind of machine has a default for what "char" should be. It
1683 is either like "unsigned char" by default or like "signed char" by
1684 default.
1685
1686 Ideally, a portable program should always use "signed char" or
1687 "unsigned char" when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1688 But many programs have been written to use plain "char" and expect
1689 it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1690 machines they were written for. This option, and its inverse, let
1691 you make such a program work with the opposite default.
1692
1693 The type "char" is always a distinct type from each of "signed
1694 char" or "unsigned char", even though its behavior is always just
1695 like one of those two.
1696
1697 -fsigned-char
1698 Let the type "char" be signed, like "signed char".
1699
1700 Note that this is equivalent to -fno-unsigned-char, which is the
1701 negative form of -funsigned-char. Likewise, the option
1702 -fno-signed-char is equivalent to -funsigned-char.
1703
1704 -fsigned-bitfields
1705 -funsigned-bitfields
1706 -fno-signed-bitfields
1707 -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1708 These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned,
1709 when the declaration does not use either "signed" or "unsigned".
1710 By default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent:
1711 the basic integer types such as "int" are signed types.
1712
1713 -fsso-struct=endianness
1714 Set the default scalar storage order of structures and unions to
1715 the specified endianness. The accepted values are big-endian,
1716 little-endian and native for the native endianness of the target
1717 (the default). This option is not supported for C++.
1718
1719 Warning: the -fsso-struct switch causes GCC to generate code that
1720 is not binary compatible with code generated without it if the
1721 specified endianness is not the native endianness of the target.
1722
1723 Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1724 This section describes the command-line options that are only
1725 meaningful for C++ programs. You can also use most of the GNU compiler
1726 options regardless of what language your program is in. For example,
1727 you might compile a file firstClass.C like this:
1728
1729 g++ -g -fstrict-enums -O -c firstClass.C
1730
1731 In this example, only -fstrict-enums is an option meant only for C++
1732 programs; you can use the other options with any language supported by
1733 GCC.
1734
1735 Some options for compiling C programs, such as -std, are also relevant
1736 for C++ programs.
1737
1738 Here is a list of options that are only for compiling C++ programs:
1739
1740 -fabi-version=n
1741 Use version n of the C++ ABI. The default is version 0.
1742
1743 Version 0 refers to the version conforming most closely to the C++
1744 ABI specification. Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0
1745 will change in different versions of G++ as ABI bugs are fixed.
1746
1747 Version 1 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++
1748 3.2.
1749
1750 Version 2 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++
1751 3.4, and was the default through G++ 4.9.
1752
1753 Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a
1754 template argument.
1755
1756 Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard
1757 mangling for vector types.
1758
1759 Version 5, which first appeared in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling
1760 of attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of
1761 a plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of
1762 another parameter.
1763
1764 Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion
1765 behavior of C++11 scoped enums and the mangling of template
1766 argument packs, const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class
1767 scope function used as a template argument.
1768
1769 Version 7, which first appeared in G++ 4.8, that treats nullptr_t
1770 as a builtin type and corrects the mangling of lambdas in default
1771 argument scope.
1772
1773 Version 8, which first appeared in G++ 4.9, corrects the
1774 substitution behavior of function types with function-cv-
1775 qualifiers.
1776
1777 Version 9, which first appeared in G++ 5.2, corrects the alignment
1778 of "nullptr_t".
1779
1780 Version 10, which first appeared in G++ 6.1, adds mangling of
1781 attributes that affect type identity, such as ia32 calling
1782 convention attributes (e.g. stdcall).
1783
1784 Version 11, which first appeared in G++ 7, corrects the mangling of
1785 sizeof... expressions and operator names. For multiple entities
1786 with the same name within a function, that are declared in
1787 different scopes, the mangling now changes starting with the
1788 twelfth occurrence. It also implies -fnew-inheriting-ctors.
1789
1790 Version 12, which first appeared in G++ 8, corrects the calling
1791 conventions for empty classes on the x86_64 target and for classes
1792 with only deleted copy/move constructors. It accidentally changes
1793 the calling convention for classes with a deleted copy constructor
1794 and a trivial move constructor.
1795
1796 Version 13, which first appeared in G++ 8.2, fixes the accidental
1797 change in version 12.
1798
1799 See also -Wabi.
1800
1801 -fabi-compat-version=n
1802 On targets that support strong aliases, G++ works around mangling
1803 changes by creating an alias with the correct mangled name when
1804 defining a symbol with an incorrect mangled name. This switch
1805 specifies which ABI version to use for the alias.
1806
1807 With -fabi-version=0 (the default), this defaults to 11 (GCC 7
1808 compatibility). If another ABI version is explicitly selected,
1809 this defaults to 0. For compatibility with GCC versions 3.2
1810 through 4.9, use -fabi-compat-version=2.
1811
1812 If this option is not provided but -Wabi=n is, that version is used
1813 for compatibility aliases. If this option is provided along with
1814 -Wabi (without the version), the version from this option is used
1815 for the warning.
1816
1817 -fno-access-control
1818 Turn off all access checking. This switch is mainly useful for
1819 working around bugs in the access control code.
1820
1821 -faligned-new
1822 Enable support for C++17 "new" of types that require more alignment
1823 than "void* ::operator new(std::size_t)" provides. A numeric
1824 argument such as "-faligned-new=32" can be used to specify how much
1825 alignment (in bytes) is provided by that function, but few users
1826 will need to override the default of "alignof(std::max_align_t)".
1827
1828 This flag is enabled by default for -std=c++17.
1829
1830 -fchar8_t
1831 -fno-char8_t
1832 Enable support for "char8_t" as adopted for C++2a. This includes
1833 the addition of a new "char8_t" fundamental type, changes to the
1834 types of UTF-8 string and character literals, new signatures for
1835 user-defined literals, associated standard library updates, and new
1836 "__cpp_char8_t" and "__cpp_lib_char8_t" feature test macros.
1837
1838 This option enables functions to be overloaded for ordinary and
1839 UTF-8 strings:
1840
1841 int f(const char *); // #1
1842 int f(const char8_t *); // #2
1843 int v1 = f("text"); // Calls #1
1844 int v2 = f(u8"text"); // Calls #2
1845
1846 and introduces new signatures for user-defined literals:
1847
1848 int operator""_udl1(char8_t);
1849 int v3 = u8'x'_udl1;
1850 int operator""_udl2(const char8_t*, std::size_t);
1851 int v4 = u8"text"_udl2;
1852 template<typename T, T...> int operator""_udl3();
1853 int v5 = u8"text"_udl3;
1854
1855 The change to the types of UTF-8 string and character literals
1856 introduces incompatibilities with ISO C++11 and later standards.
1857 For example, the following code is well-formed under ISO C++11, but
1858 is ill-formed when -fchar8_t is specified.
1859
1860 char ca[] = u8"xx"; // error: char-array initialized from wide
1861 // string
1862 const char *cp = u8"xx";// error: invalid conversion from
1863 // `const char8_t*' to `const char*'
1864 int f(const char*);
1865 auto v = f(u8"xx"); // error: invalid conversion from
1866 // `const char8_t*' to `const char*'
1867 std::string s{u8"xx"}; // error: no matching function for call to
1868 // `std::basic_string<char>::basic_string()'
1869 using namespace std::literals;
1870 s = u8"xx"s; // error: conversion from
1871 // `basic_string<char8_t>' to non-scalar
1872 // type `basic_string<char>' requested
1873
1874 -fcheck-new
1875 Check that the pointer returned by "operator new" is non-null
1876 before attempting to modify the storage allocated. This check is
1877 normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
1878 "operator new" only returns 0 if it is declared "throw()", in which
1879 case the compiler always checks the return value even without this
1880 option. In all other cases, when "operator new" has a non-empty
1881 exception specification, memory exhaustion is signalled by throwing
1882 "std::bad_alloc". See also new (nothrow).
1883
1884 -fconcepts
1885 Enable support for the C++ Extensions for Concepts Technical
1886 Specification, ISO 19217 (2015), which allows code like
1887
1888 template <class T> concept bool Addable = requires (T t) { t + t; };
1889 template <Addable T> T add (T a, T b) { return a + b; }
1890
1891 -fconstexpr-depth=n
1892 Set the maximum nested evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr
1893 functions to n. A limit is needed to detect endless recursion
1894 during constant expression evaluation. The minimum specified by
1895 the standard is 512.
1896
1897 -fconstexpr-loop-limit=n
1898 Set the maximum number of iterations for a loop in C++14 constexpr
1899 functions to n. A limit is needed to detect infinite loops during
1900 constant expression evaluation. The default is 262144 (1<<18).
1901
1902 -fconstexpr-ops-limit=n
1903 Set the maximum number of operations during a single constexpr
1904 evaluation. Even when number of iterations of a single loop is
1905 limited with the above limit, if there are several nested loops and
1906 each of them has many iterations but still smaller than the above
1907 limit, or if in a body of some loop or even outside of a loop too
1908 many expressions need to be evaluated, the resulting constexpr
1909 evaluation might take too long. The default is 33554432 (1<<25).
1910
1911 -fdeduce-init-list
1912 Enable deduction of a template type parameter as
1913 "std::initializer_list" from a brace-enclosed initializer list,
1914 i.e.
1915
1916 template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
1917 {
1918 return realfn (t);
1919 }
1920
1921 void f()
1922 {
1923 forward({1,2}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
1924 }
1925
1926 This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the
1927 originally proposed semantics for the C++11 standard, but was not
1928 part of the final standard, so it is disabled by default. This
1929 option is deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of
1930 G++.
1931
1932 -fno-elide-constructors
1933 The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a
1934 temporary that is only used to initialize another object of the
1935 same type. Specifying this option disables that optimization, and
1936 forces G++ to call the copy constructor in all cases. This option
1937 also causes G++ to call trivial member functions which otherwise
1938 would be expanded inline.
1939
1940 In C++17, the compiler is required to omit these temporaries, but
1941 this option still affects trivial member functions.
1942
1943 -fno-enforce-eh-specs
1944 Don't generate code to check for violation of exception
1945 specifications at run time. This option violates the C++ standard,
1946 but may be useful for reducing code size in production builds, much
1947 like defining "NDEBUG". This does not give user code permission to
1948 throw exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the
1949 compiler still optimizes based on the specifications, so throwing
1950 an unexpected exception results in undefined behavior at run time.
1951
1952 -fextern-tls-init
1953 -fno-extern-tls-init
1954 The C++11 and OpenMP standards allow "thread_local" and
1955 "threadprivate" variables to have dynamic (runtime) initialization.
1956 To support this, any use of such a variable goes through a wrapper
1957 function that performs any necessary initialization. When the use
1958 and definition of the variable are in the same translation unit,
1959 this overhead can be optimized away, but when the use is in a
1960 different translation unit there is significant overhead even if
1961 the variable doesn't actually need dynamic initialization. If the
1962 programmer can be sure that no use of the variable in a non-
1963 defining TU needs to trigger dynamic initialization (either because
1964 the variable is statically initialized, or a use of the variable in
1965 the defining TU will be executed before any uses in another TU),
1966 they can avoid this overhead with the -fno-extern-tls-init option.
1967
1968 On targets that support symbol aliases, the default is
1969 -fextern-tls-init. On targets that do not support symbol aliases,
1970 the default is -fno-extern-tls-init.
1971
1972 -fno-gnu-keywords
1973 Do not recognize "typeof" as a keyword, so that code can use this
1974 word as an identifier. You can use the keyword "__typeof__"
1975 instead. This option is implied by the strict ISO C++ dialects:
1976 -ansi, -std=c++98, -std=c++11, etc.
1977
1978 -fno-implicit-templates
1979 Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated
1980 implicitly (i.e. by use); only emit code for explicit
1981 instantiations. If you use this option, you must take care to
1982 structure your code to include all the necessary explicit
1983 instantiations to avoid getting undefined symbols at link time.
1984
1985 -fno-implicit-inline-templates
1986 Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates,
1987 either. The default is to handle inlines differently so that
1988 compiles with and without optimization need the same set of
1989 explicit instantiations.
1990
1991 -fno-implement-inlines
1992 To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
1993 controlled by "#pragma implementation". This causes linker errors
1994 if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
1995
1996 -fms-extensions
1997 Disable Wpedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as
1998 implicit int and getting a pointer to member function via non-
1999 standard syntax.
2000
2001 -fnew-inheriting-ctors
2002 Enable the P0136 adjustment to the semantics of C++11 constructor
2003 inheritance. This is part of C++17 but also considered to be a
2004 Defect Report against C++11 and C++14. This flag is enabled by
2005 default unless -fabi-version=10 or lower is specified.
2006
2007 -fnew-ttp-matching
2008 Enable the P0522 resolution to Core issue 150, template template
2009 parameters and default arguments: this allows a template with
2010 default template arguments as an argument for a template template
2011 parameter with fewer template parameters. This flag is enabled by
2012 default for -std=c++17.
2013
2014 -fno-nonansi-builtins
2015 Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
2016 ANSI/ISO C. These include "ffs", "alloca", "_exit", "index",
2017 "bzero", "conjf", and other related functions.
2018
2019 -fnothrow-opt
2020 Treat a "throw()" exception specification as if it were a
2021 "noexcept" specification to reduce or eliminate the text size
2022 overhead relative to a function with no exception specification.
2023 If the function has local variables of types with non-trivial
2024 destructors, the exception specification actually makes the
2025 function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be
2026 optimized away. The semantic effect is that an exception thrown
2027 out of a function with such an exception specification results in a
2028 call to "terminate" rather than "unexpected".
2029
2030 -fno-operator-names
2031 Do not treat the operator name keywords "and", "bitand", "bitor",
2032 "compl", "not", "or" and "xor" as synonyms as keywords.
2033
2034 -fno-optional-diags
2035 Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need
2036 to issue. Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the
2037 one for a name having multiple meanings within a class.
2038
2039 -fpermissive
2040 Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
2041 warnings. Thus, using -fpermissive allows some nonconforming code
2042 to compile.
2043
2044 -fno-pretty-templates
2045 When an error message refers to a specialization of a function
2046 template, the compiler normally prints the signature of the
2047 template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or
2048 typenames in the signature (e.g. "void f(T) [with T = int]" rather
2049 than "void f(int)") so that it's clear which template is involved.
2050 When an error message refers to a specialization of a class
2051 template, the compiler omits any template arguments that match the
2052 default template arguments for that template. If either of these
2053 behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather
2054 than easier, you can use -fno-pretty-templates to disable them.
2055
2056 -frepo
2057 Enable automatic template instantiation at link time. This option
2058 also implies -fno-implicit-templates.
2059
2060 -fno-rtti
2061 Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
2062 functions for use by the C++ run-time type identification features
2063 ("dynamic_cast" and "typeid"). If you don't use those parts of the
2064 language, you can save some space by using this flag. Note that
2065 exception handling uses the same information, but G++ generates it
2066 as needed. The "dynamic_cast" operator can still be used for casts
2067 that do not require run-time type information, i.e. casts to "void
2068 *" or to unambiguous base classes.
2069
2070 Mixing code compiled with -frtti with that compiled with -fno-rtti
2071 may not work. For example, programs may fail to link if a class
2072 compiled with -fno-rtti is used as a base for a class compiled with
2073 -frtti.
2074
2075 -fsized-deallocation
2076 Enable the built-in global declarations
2077
2078 void operator delete (void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
2079 void operator delete[] (void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
2080
2081 as introduced in C++14. This is useful for user-defined
2082 replacement deallocation functions that, for example, use the size
2083 of the object to make deallocation faster. Enabled by default
2084 under -std=c++14 and above. The flag -Wsized-deallocation warns
2085 about places that might want to add a definition.
2086
2087 -fstrict-enums
2088 Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of
2089 enumerated type can only be one of the values of the enumeration
2090 (as defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
2091 represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all
2092 the enumerators). This assumption may not be valid if the program
2093 uses a cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated
2094 type.
2095
2096 -fstrong-eval-order
2097 Evaluate member access, array subscripting, and shift expressions
2098 in left-to-right order, and evaluate assignment in right-to-left
2099 order, as adopted for C++17. Enabled by default with -std=c++17.
2100 -fstrong-eval-order=some enables just the ordering of member access
2101 and shift expressions, and is the default without -std=c++17.
2102
2103 -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=n
2104 Set the maximum number of template instantiation notes for a single
2105 warning or error to n. The default value is 10.
2106
2107 -ftemplate-depth=n
2108 Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to n. A
2109 limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
2110 endless recursions during template class instantiation. ANSI/ISO
2111 C++ conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater
2112 than 17 (changed to 1024 in C++11). The default value is 900, as
2113 the compiler can run out of stack space before hitting 1024 in some
2114 situations.
2115
2116 -fno-threadsafe-statics
2117 Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
2118 ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics. You can use
2119 this option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need
2120 to be thread-safe.
2121
2122 -fuse-cxa-atexit
2123 Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with
2124 the "__cxa_atexit" function rather than the "atexit" function.
2125 This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of
2126 static destructors, but only works if your C library supports
2127 "__cxa_atexit".
2128
2129 -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2130 Don't use the "__cxa_get_exception_ptr" runtime routine. This
2131 causes "std::uncaught_exception" to be incorrect, but is necessary
2132 if the runtime routine is not available.
2133
2134 -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2135 This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
2136 pointers to inline functions or methods where the addresses of the
2137 two functions are taken in different shared objects.
2138
2139 The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline
2140 methods with "__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))" so that they
2141 do not appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT
2142 indirection when used within the DSO. Enabling this option can
2143 have a dramatic effect on load and link times of a DSO as it
2144 massively reduces the size of the dynamic export table when the
2145 library makes heavy use of templates.
2146
2147 The behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
2148 methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static
2149 variables local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce
2150 that the function is defined in only one shared object.
2151
2152 You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate
2153 the effect of the switch for that method. For example, if you do
2154 want to compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might
2155 mark it as having default visibility. Marking the enclosing class
2156 with explicit visibility has no effect.
2157
2158 Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this
2159 option as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library
2160 boundary.
2161
2162 -fvisibility-ms-compat
2163 This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++
2164 linkage model compatible with that of Microsoft Visual Studio.
2165
2166 The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:
2167
2168 1. It sets the default visibility to "hidden", like
2169 -fvisibility=hidden.
2170
2171 2. Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.
2172
2173 3. The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit
2174 visibility specifications that are defined in more than one
2175 shared object: those declarations are permitted if they are
2176 permitted when this option is not used.
2177
2178 In new code it is better to use -fvisibility=hidden and export
2179 those classes that are intended to be externally visible.
2180 Unfortunately it is possible for code to rely, perhaps
2181 accidentally, on the Visual Studio behavior.
2182
2183 Among the consequences of these changes are that static data
2184 members of the same type with the same name but defined in
2185 different shared objects are different, so changing one does not
2186 change the other; and that pointers to function members defined in
2187 different shared objects may not compare equal. When this flag is
2188 given, it is a violation of the ODR to define types with the same
2189 name differently.
2190
2191 -fno-weak
2192 Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the
2193 linker. By default, G++ uses weak symbols if they are available.
2194 This option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-
2195 users; it results in inferior code and has no benefits. This
2196 option may be removed in a future release of G++.
2197
2198 -nostdinc++
2199 Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific
2200 to C++, but do still search the other standard directories. (This
2201 option is used when building the C++ library.)
2202
2203 In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
2204 have meanings only for C++ programs:
2205
2206 -Wabi (C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2207 Warn when G++ it generates code that is probably not compatible
2208 with the vendor-neutral C++ ABI. Since G++ now defaults to
2209 updating the ABI with each major release, normally -Wabi will warn
2210 only if there is a check added later in a release series for an ABI
2211 issue discovered since the initial release. -Wabi will warn about
2212 more things if an older ABI version is selected (with
2213 -fabi-version=n).
2214
2215 -Wabi can also be used with an explicit version number to warn
2216 about compatibility with a particular -fabi-version level, e.g.
2217 -Wabi=2 to warn about changes relative to -fabi-version=2.
2218
2219 If an explicit version number is provided and -fabi-compat-version
2220 is not specified, the version number from this option is used for
2221 compatibility aliases. If no explicit version number is provided
2222 with this option, but -fabi-compat-version is specified, that
2223 version number is used for ABI warnings.
2224
2225 Although an effort has been made to warn about all such cases,
2226 there are probably some cases that are not warned about, even
2227 though G++ is generating incompatible code. There may also be
2228 cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is
2229 generated is compatible.
2230
2231 You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
2232 concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be
2233 binary compatible with code generated by other compilers.
2234
2235 Known incompatibilities in -fabi-version=2 (which was the default
2236 from GCC 3.4 to 4.9) include:
2237
2238 * A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type
2239 was mangled incorrectly:
2240
2241 extern int N;
2242 template <int &> struct S {};
2243 void n (S<N>) {2}
2244
2245 This was fixed in -fabi-version=3.
2246
2247 * SIMD vector types declared using "__attribute ((vector_size))"
2248 were mangled in a non-standard way that does not allow for
2249 overloading of functions taking vectors of different sizes.
2250
2251 The mangling was changed in -fabi-version=4.
2252
2253 * "__attribute ((const))" and "noreturn" were mangled as type
2254 qualifiers, and "decltype" of a plain declaration was folded
2255 away.
2256
2257 These mangling issues were fixed in -fabi-version=5.
2258
2259 * Scoped enumerators passed as arguments to a variadic function
2260 are promoted like unscoped enumerators, causing "va_arg" to
2261 complain. On most targets this does not actually affect the
2262 parameter passing ABI, as there is no way to pass an argument
2263 smaller than "int".
2264
2265 Also, the ABI changed the mangling of template argument packs,
2266 "const_cast", "static_cast", prefix increment/decrement, and a
2267 class scope function used as a template argument.
2268
2269 These issues were corrected in -fabi-version=6.
2270
2271 * Lambdas in default argument scope were mangled incorrectly, and
2272 the ABI changed the mangling of "nullptr_t".
2273
2274 These issues were corrected in -fabi-version=7.
2275
2276 * When mangling a function type with function-cv-qualifiers, the
2277 un-qualified function type was incorrectly treated as a
2278 substitution candidate.
2279
2280 This was fixed in -fabi-version=8, the default for GCC 5.1.
2281
2282 * "decltype(nullptr)" incorrectly had an alignment of 1, leading
2283 to unaligned accesses. Note that this did not affect the ABI
2284 of a function with a "nullptr_t" parameter, as parameters have
2285 a minimum alignment.
2286
2287 This was fixed in -fabi-version=9, the default for GCC 5.2.
2288
2289 * Target-specific attributes that affect the identity of a type,
2290 such as ia32 calling conventions on a function type (stdcall,
2291 regparm, etc.), did not affect the mangled name, leading to
2292 name collisions when function pointers were used as template
2293 arguments.
2294
2295 This was fixed in -fabi-version=10, the default for GCC 6.1.
2296
2297 It also warns about psABI-related changes. The known psABI changes
2298 at this point include:
2299
2300 * For SysV/x86-64, unions with "long double" members are passed
2301 in memory as specified in psABI. For example:
2302
2303 union U {
2304 long double ld;
2305 int i;
2306 };
2307
2308 "union U" is always passed in memory.
2309
2310 -Wabi-tag (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2311 Warn when a type with an ABI tag is used in a context that does not
2312 have that ABI tag. See C++ Attributes for more information about
2313 ABI tags.
2314
2315 -Wctor-dtor-privacy (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2316 Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
2317 destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends
2318 nor public static member functions. Also warn if there are no non-
2319 private methods, and there's at least one private member function
2320 that isn't a constructor or destructor.
2321
2322 -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2323 Warn when "delete" is used to destroy an instance of a class that
2324 has virtual functions and non-virtual destructor. It is unsafe to
2325 delete an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a base
2326 class if the base class does not have a virtual destructor. This
2327 warning is enabled by -Wall.
2328
2329 -Wdeprecated-copy (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2330 Warn that the implicit declaration of a copy constructor or copy
2331 assignment operator is deprecated if the class has a user-provided
2332 copy constructor or copy assignment operator, in C++11 and up.
2333 This warning is enabled by -Wextra. With -Wdeprecated-copy-dtor,
2334 also deprecate if the class has a user-provided destructor.
2335
2336 -Wno-init-list-lifetime (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2337 Do not warn about uses of "std::initializer_list" that are likely
2338 to result in dangling pointers. Since the underlying array for an
2339 "initializer_list" is handled like a normal C++ temporary object,
2340 it is easy to inadvertently keep a pointer to the array past the
2341 end of the array's lifetime. For example:
2342
2343 * If a function returns a temporary "initializer_list", or a
2344 local "initializer_list" variable, the array's lifetime ends at
2345 the end of the return statement, so the value returned has a
2346 dangling pointer.
2347
2348 * If a new-expression creates an "initializer_list", the array
2349 only lives until the end of the enclosing full-expression, so
2350 the "initializer_list" in the heap has a dangling pointer.
2351
2352 * When an "initializer_list" variable is assigned from a brace-
2353 enclosed initializer list, the temporary array created for the
2354 right side of the assignment only lives until the end of the
2355 full-expression, so at the next statement the
2356 "initializer_list" variable has a dangling pointer.
2357
2358 // li's initial underlying array lives as long as li
2359 std::initializer_list<int> li = { 1,2,3 };
2360 // assignment changes li to point to a temporary array
2361 li = { 4, 5 };
2362 // now the temporary is gone and li has a dangling pointer
2363 int i = li.begin()[0] // undefined behavior
2364
2365 * When a list constructor stores the "begin" pointer from the
2366 "initializer_list" argument, this doesn't extend the lifetime
2367 of the array, so if a class variable is constructed from a
2368 temporary "initializer_list", the pointer is left dangling by
2369 the end of the variable declaration statement.
2370
2371 -Wliteral-suffix (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2372 Warn when a string or character literal is followed by a ud-suffix
2373 which does not begin with an underscore. As a conforming
2374 extension, GCC treats such suffixes as separate preprocessing
2375 tokens in order to maintain backwards compatibility with code that
2376 uses formatting macros from "<inttypes.h>". For example:
2377
2378 #define __STDC_FORMAT_MACROS
2379 #include <inttypes.h>
2380 #include <stdio.h>
2381
2382 int main() {
2383 int64_t i64 = 123;
2384 printf("My int64: %" PRId64"\n", i64);
2385 }
2386
2387 In this case, "PRId64" is treated as a separate preprocessing
2388 token.
2389
2390 Additionally, warn when a user-defined literal operator is declared
2391 with a literal suffix identifier that doesn't begin with an
2392 underscore. Literal suffix identifiers that don't begin with an
2393 underscore are reserved for future standardization.
2394
2395 This warning is enabled by default.
2396
2397 -Wlto-type-mismatch
2398 During the link-time optimization warn about type mismatches in
2399 global declarations from different compilation units. Requires
2400 -flto to be enabled. Enabled by default.
2401
2402 -Wno-narrowing (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2403 For C++11 and later standards, narrowing conversions are diagnosed
2404 by default, as required by the standard. A narrowing conversion
2405 from a constant produces an error, and a narrowing conversion from
2406 a non-constant produces a warning, but -Wno-narrowing suppresses
2407 the diagnostic. Note that this does not affect the meaning of
2408 well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered ill-
2409 formed in SFINAE contexts.
2410
2411 With -Wnarrowing in C++98, warn when a narrowing conversion
2412 prohibited by C++11 occurs within { }, e.g.
2413
2414 int i = { 2.2 }; // error: narrowing from double to int
2415
2416 This flag is included in -Wall and -Wc++11-compat.
2417
2418 -Wnoexcept (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2419 Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a
2420 call to a function that does not have a non-throwing exception
2421 specification (i.e. "throw()" or "noexcept") but is known by the
2422 compiler to never throw an exception.
2423
2424 -Wnoexcept-type (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2425 Warn if the C++17 feature making "noexcept" part of a function type
2426 changes the mangled name of a symbol relative to C++14. Enabled by
2427 -Wabi and -Wc++17-compat.
2428
2429 As an example:
2430
2431 template <class T> void f(T t) { t(); };
2432 void g() noexcept;
2433 void h() { f(g); }
2434
2435 In C++14, "f" calls "f<void(*)()>", but in C++17 it calls
2436 "f<void(*)()noexcept>".
2437
2438 -Wclass-memaccess (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2439 Warn when the destination of a call to a raw memory function such
2440 as "memset" or "memcpy" is an object of class type, and when
2441 writing into such an object might bypass the class non-trivial or
2442 deleted constructor or copy assignment, violate const-correctness
2443 or encapsulation, or corrupt virtual table pointers. Modifying the
2444 representation of such objects may violate invariants maintained by
2445 member functions of the class. For example, the call to "memset"
2446 below is undefined because it modifies a non-trivial class object
2447 and is, therefore, diagnosed. The safe way to either initialize or
2448 clear the storage of objects of such types is by using the
2449 appropriate constructor or assignment operator, if one is
2450 available.
2451
2452 std::string str = "abc";
2453 memset (&str, 0, sizeof str);
2454
2455 The -Wclass-memaccess option is enabled by -Wall. Explicitly
2456 casting the pointer to the class object to "void *" or to a type
2457 that can be safely accessed by the raw memory function suppresses
2458 the warning.
2459
2460 -Wnon-virtual-dtor (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2461 Warn when a class has virtual functions and an accessible non-
2462 virtual destructor itself or in an accessible polymorphic base
2463 class, in which case it is possible but unsafe to delete an
2464 instance of a derived class through a pointer to the class itself
2465 or base class. This warning is automatically enabled if -Weffc++
2466 is specified.
2467
2468 -Wregister (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2469 Warn on uses of the "register" storage class specifier, except when
2470 it is part of the GNU Explicit Register Variables extension. The
2471 use of the "register" keyword as storage class specifier has been
2472 deprecated in C++11 and removed in C++17. Enabled by default with
2473 -std=c++17.
2474
2475 -Wreorder (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2476 Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does
2477 not match the order in which they must be executed. For instance:
2478
2479 struct A {
2480 int i;
2481 int j;
2482 A(): j (0), i (1) { }
2483 };
2484
2485 The compiler rearranges the member initializers for "i" and "j" to
2486 match the declaration order of the members, emitting a warning to
2487 that effect. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
2488
2489 -Wno-pessimizing-move (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2490 This warning warns when a call to "std::move" prevents copy
2491 elision. A typical scenario when copy elision can occur is when
2492 returning in a function with a class return type, when the
2493 expression being returned is the name of a non-volatile automatic
2494 object, and is not a function parameter, and has the same type as
2495 the function return type.
2496
2497 struct T {
2498 ...
2499 };
2500 T fn()
2501 {
2502 T t;
2503 ...
2504 return std::move (t);
2505 }
2506
2507 But in this example, the "std::move" call prevents copy elision.
2508
2509 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
2510
2511 -Wno-redundant-move (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2512 This warning warns about redundant calls to "std::move"; that is,
2513 when a move operation would have been performed even without the
2514 "std::move" call. This happens because the compiler is forced to
2515 treat the object as if it were an rvalue in certain situations such
2516 as returning a local variable, where copy elision isn't applicable.
2517 Consider:
2518
2519 struct T {
2520 ...
2521 };
2522 T fn(T t)
2523 {
2524 ...
2525 return std::move (t);
2526 }
2527
2528 Here, the "std::move" call is redundant. Because G++ implements
2529 Core Issue 1579, another example is:
2530
2531 struct T { // convertible to U
2532 ...
2533 };
2534 struct U {
2535 ...
2536 };
2537 U fn()
2538 {
2539 T t;
2540 ...
2541 return std::move (t);
2542 }
2543
2544 In this example, copy elision isn't applicable because the type of
2545 the expression being returned and the function return type differ,
2546 yet G++ treats the return value as if it were designated by an
2547 rvalue.
2548
2549 This warning is enabled by -Wextra.
2550
2551 -fext-numeric-literals (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2552 Accept imaginary, fixed-point, or machine-defined literal number
2553 suffixes as GNU extensions. When this option is turned off these
2554 suffixes are treated as C++11 user-defined literal numeric
2555 suffixes. This is on by default for all pre-C++11 dialects and all
2556 GNU dialects: -std=c++98, -std=gnu++98, -std=gnu++11, -std=gnu++14.
2557 This option is off by default for ISO C++11 onwards (-std=c++11,
2558 ...).
2559
2560 The following -W... options are not affected by -Wall.
2561
2562 -Weffc++ (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2563 Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott
2564 Meyers' Effective C++ series of books:
2565
2566 * Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for
2567 classes with dynamically-allocated memory.
2568
2569 * Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
2570
2571 * Have "operator=" return a reference to *this.
2572
2573 * Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
2574
2575 * Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
2576 decrement operators.
2577
2578 * Never overload "&&", "||", or ",".
2579
2580 This option also enables -Wnon-virtual-dtor, which is also one of
2581 the effective C++ recommendations. However, the check is extended
2582 to warn about the lack of virtual destructor in accessible non-
2583 polymorphic bases classes too.
2584
2585 When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
2586 headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use grep -v to filter
2587 out those warnings.
2588
2589 -Wstrict-null-sentinel (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2590 Warn about the use of an uncasted "NULL" as sentinel. When
2591 compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as "NULL" is
2592 defined to "__null". Although it is a null pointer constant rather
2593 than a null pointer, it is guaranteed to be of the same size as a
2594 pointer. But this use is not portable across different compilers.
2595
2596 -Wno-non-template-friend (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2597 Disable warnings when non-template friend functions are declared
2598 within a template. In very old versions of GCC that predate
2599 implementation of the ISO standard, declarations such as friend int
2600 foo(int), where the name of the friend is an unqualified-id, could
2601 be interpreted as a particular specialization of a template
2602 function; the warning exists to diagnose compatibility problems,
2603 and is enabled by default.
2604
2605 -Wold-style-cast (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2606 Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used
2607 within a C++ program. The new-style casts ("dynamic_cast",
2608 "static_cast", "reinterpret_cast", and "const_cast") are less
2609 vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
2610
2611 -Woverloaded-virtual (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2612 Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
2613 base class. For example, in:
2614
2615 struct A {
2616 virtual void f();
2617 };
2618
2619 struct B: public A {
2620 void f(int);
2621 };
2622
2623 the "A" class version of "f" is hidden in "B", and code like:
2624
2625 B* b;
2626 b->f();
2627
2628 fails to compile.
2629
2630 -Wno-pmf-conversions (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2631 Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member
2632 function to a plain pointer.
2633
2634 -Wsign-promo (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2635 Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
2636 enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned
2637 type of the same size. Previous versions of G++ tried to preserve
2638 unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
2639
2640 -Wtemplates (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2641 Warn when a primary template declaration is encountered. Some
2642 coding rules disallow templates, and this may be used to enforce
2643 that rule. The warning is inactive inside a system header file,
2644 such as the STL, so one can still use the STL. One may also
2645 instantiate or specialize templates.
2646
2647 -Wmultiple-inheritance (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2648 Warn when a class is defined with multiple direct base classes.
2649 Some coding rules disallow multiple inheritance, and this may be
2650 used to enforce that rule. The warning is inactive inside a system
2651 header file, such as the STL, so one can still use the STL. One
2652 may also define classes that indirectly use multiple inheritance.
2653
2654 -Wvirtual-inheritance
2655 Warn when a class is defined with a virtual direct base class.
2656 Some coding rules disallow multiple inheritance, and this may be
2657 used to enforce that rule. The warning is inactive inside a system
2658 header file, such as the STL, so one can still use the STL. One
2659 may also define classes that indirectly use virtual inheritance.
2660
2661 -Wnamespaces
2662 Warn when a namespace definition is opened. Some coding rules
2663 disallow namespaces, and this may be used to enforce that rule.
2664 The warning is inactive inside a system header file, such as the
2665 STL, so one can still use the STL. One may also use using
2666 directives and qualified names.
2667
2668 -Wno-terminate (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2669 Disable the warning about a throw-expression that will immediately
2670 result in a call to "terminate".
2671
2672 -Wno-class-conversion (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
2673 Disable the warning about the case when a conversion function
2674 converts an object to the same type, to a base class of that type,
2675 or to void; such a conversion function will never be called.
2676
2677 Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
2678 (NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
2679 languages themselves.
2680
2681 This section describes the command-line options that are only
2682 meaningful for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs. You can also
2683 use most of the language-independent GNU compiler options. For
2684 example, you might compile a file some_class.m like this:
2685
2686 gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
2687
2688 In this example, -fgnu-runtime is an option meant only for Objective-C
2689 and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
2690 language supported by GCC.
2691
2692 Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language,
2693 Objective-C compilations may also use options specific to the C front-
2694 end (e.g., -Wtraditional). Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may
2695 use C++-specific options (e.g., -Wabi).
2696
2697 Here is a list of options that are only for compiling Objective-C and
2698 Objective-C++ programs:
2699
2700 -fconstant-string-class=class-name
2701 Use class-name as the name of the class to instantiate for each
2702 literal string specified with the syntax "@"..."". The default
2703 class name is "NXConstantString" if the GNU runtime is being used,
2704 and "NSConstantString" if the NeXT runtime is being used (see
2705 below). The -fconstant-cfstrings option, if also present,
2706 overrides the -fconstant-string-class setting and cause "@"...""
2707 literals to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2708
2709 -fgnu-runtime
2710 Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2711 runtime. This is the default for most types of systems.
2712
2713 -fnext-runtime
2714 Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime. This is the
2715 default for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X. The
2716 macro "__NEXT_RUNTIME__" is predefined if (and only if) this option
2717 is used.
2718
2719 -fno-nil-receivers
2720 Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches ("[receiver
2721 message:arg]") in this translation unit ensure that the receiver is
2722 not "nil". This allows for more efficient entry points in the
2723 runtime to be used. This option is only available in conjunction
2724 with the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.
2725
2726 -fobjc-abi-version=n
2727 Use version n of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.
2728 This option is currently supported only for the NeXT runtime. In
2729 that case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI without
2730 support for properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.
2731 Version 1 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI with support for
2732 properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions. Version 2 is the
2733 modern (64-bit) ABI. If nothing is specified, the default is
2734 Version 0 on 32-bit target machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit target
2735 machines.
2736
2737 -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2738 For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables
2739 is a C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor. If so,
2740 synthesize a special "- (id) .cxx_construct" instance method which
2741 runs non-trivial default constructors on any such instance
2742 variables, in order, and then return "self". Similarly, check if
2743 any instance variable is a C++ object with a non-trivial
2744 destructor, and if so, synthesize a special "- (void)
2745 .cxx_destruct" method which runs all such default destructors, in
2746 reverse order.
2747
2748 The "- (id) .cxx_construct" and "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods
2749 thusly generated only operate on instance variables declared in the
2750 current Objective-C class, and not those inherited from
2751 superclasses. It is the responsibility of the Objective-C runtime
2752 to invoke all such methods in an object's inheritance hierarchy.
2753 The "- (id) .cxx_construct" methods are invoked by the runtime
2754 immediately after a new object instance is allocated; the "- (void)
2755 .cxx_destruct" methods are invoked immediately before the runtime
2756 deallocates an object instance.
2757
2758 As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and
2759 later has support for invoking the "- (id) .cxx_construct" and "-
2760 (void) .cxx_destruct" methods.
2761
2762 -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2763 Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher. On Darwin this is
2764 accomplished via the comm page.
2765
2766 -fobjc-exceptions
2767 Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in
2768 Objective-C, similar to what is offered by C++. This option is
2769 required to use the Objective-C keywords @try, @throw, @catch,
2770 @finally and @synchronized. This option is available with both the
2771 GNU runtime and the NeXT runtime (but not available in conjunction
2772 with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).
2773
2774 -fobjc-gc
2775 Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++
2776 programs. This option is only available with the NeXT runtime; the
2777 GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation that
2778 does not require special compiler flags.
2779
2780 -fobjc-nilcheck
2781 For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil
2782 receiver in method invocations before doing the actual method call.
2783 This is the default and can be disabled using -fno-objc-nilcheck.
2784 Class methods and super calls are never checked for nil in this way
2785 no matter what this flag is set to. Currently this flag does
2786 nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older version of the NeXT
2787 runtime ABI, is used.
2788
2789 -fobjc-std=objc1
2790 Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language
2791 recognized by GCC 4.0. This only affects the Objective-C additions
2792 to the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++
2793 standards, which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option
2794 flags. When this option is used with the Objective-C or
2795 Objective-C++ compiler, any Objective-C syntax that is not
2796 recognized by GCC 4.0 is rejected. This is useful if you need to
2797 make sure that your Objective-C code can be compiled with older
2798 versions of GCC.
2799
2800 -freplace-objc-classes
2801 Emit a special marker instructing ld(1) not to statically link in
2802 the resulting object file, and allow dyld(1) to load it in at run
2803 time instead. This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-
2804 Continue debugging mode, where the object file in question may be
2805 recompiled and dynamically reloaded in the course of program
2806 execution, without the need to restart the program itself.
2807 Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality is only available in
2808 conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3 and later.
2809
2810 -fzero-link
2811 When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily
2812 replaces calls to "objc_getClass("...")" (when the name of the
2813 class is known at compile time) with static class references that
2814 get initialized at load time, which improves run-time performance.
2815 Specifying the -fzero-link flag suppresses this behavior and causes
2816 calls to "objc_getClass("...")" to be retained. This is useful in
2817 Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows for individual class
2818 implementations to be modified during program execution. The GNU
2819 runtime currently always retains calls to "objc_get_class("...")"
2820 regardless of command-line options.
2821
2822 -fno-local-ivars
2823 By default instance variables in Objective-C can be accessed as if
2824 they were local variables from within the methods of the class
2825 they're declared in. This can lead to shadowing between instance
2826 variables and other variables declared either locally inside a
2827 class method or globally with the same name. Specifying the
2828 -fno-local-ivars flag disables this behavior thus avoiding variable
2829 shadowing issues.
2830
2831 -fivar-visibility=[public|protected|private|package]
2832 Set the default instance variable visibility to the specified
2833 option so that instance variables declared outside the scope of any
2834 access modifier directives default to the specified visibility.
2835
2836 -gen-decls
2837 Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file
2838 to a file named sourcename.decl.
2839
2840 -Wassign-intercept (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
2841 Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2842 garbage collector.
2843
2844 -Wno-protocol (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
2845 If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued
2846 for every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the
2847 class. The default behavior is to issue a warning for every method
2848 not explicitly implemented in the class, even if a method
2849 implementation is inherited from the superclass. If you use the
2850 -Wno-protocol option, then methods inherited from the superclass
2851 are considered to be implemented, and no warning is issued for
2852 them.
2853
2854 -Wselector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
2855 Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector
2856 are found during compilation. The check is performed on the list
2857 of methods in the final stage of compilation. Additionally, a
2858 check is performed for each selector appearing in a
2859 "@selector(...)" expression, and a corresponding method for that
2860 selector has been found during compilation. Because these checks
2861 scan the method table only at the end of compilation, these
2862 warnings are not produced if the final stage of compilation is not
2863 reached, for example because an error is found during compilation,
2864 or because the -fsyntax-only option is being used.
2865
2866 -Wstrict-selector-match (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
2867 Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return
2868 types are found for a given selector when attempting to send a
2869 message using this selector to a receiver of type "id" or "Class".
2870 When this flag is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler
2871 omits such warnings if any differences found are confined to types
2872 that share the same size and alignment.
2873
2874 -Wundeclared-selector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
2875 Warn if a "@selector(...)" expression referring to an undeclared
2876 selector is found. A selector is considered undeclared if no
2877 method with that name has been declared before the "@selector(...)"
2878 expression, either explicitly in an @interface or @protocol
2879 declaration, or implicitly in an @implementation section. This
2880 option always performs its checks as soon as a "@selector(...)"
2881 expression is found, while -Wselector only performs its checks in
2882 the final stage of compilation. This also enforces the coding
2883 style convention that methods and selectors must be declared before
2884 being used.
2885
2886 -print-objc-runtime-info
2887 Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed
2888 by value, if any.
2889
2890 Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
2891 Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
2892 the output device's aspect (e.g. its width, ...). You can use the
2893 options described below to control the formatting algorithm for
2894 diagnostic messages, e.g. how many characters per line, how often
2895 source location information should be reported. Note that some
2896 language front ends may not honor these options.
2897
2898 -fmessage-length=n
2899 Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about n
2900 characters. If n is zero, then no line-wrapping is done; each
2901 error message appears on a single line. This is the default for
2902 all front ends.
2903
2904 Note - this option also affects the display of the #error and
2905 #warning pre-processor directives, and the deprecated
2906 function/type/variable attribute. It does not however affect the
2907 pragma GCC warning and pragma GCC error pragmas.
2908
2909 -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
2910 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic
2911 messages reporter to emit source location information once; that
2912 is, in case the message is too long to fit on a single physical
2913 line and has to be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted
2914 (as prefix) again, over and over, in subsequent continuation lines.
2915 This is the default behavior.
2916
2917 -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
2918 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic
2919 messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
2920 prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
2921 a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
2922
2923 -fdiagnostics-color[=WHEN]
2924 -fno-diagnostics-color
2925 Use color in diagnostics. WHEN is never, always, or auto. The
2926 default depends on how the compiler has been configured, it can be
2927 any of the above WHEN options or also never if GCC_COLORS
2928 environment variable isn't present in the environment, and auto
2929 otherwise. auto means to use color only when the standard error is
2930 a terminal. The forms -fdiagnostics-color and
2931 -fno-diagnostics-color are aliases for -fdiagnostics-color=always
2932 and -fdiagnostics-color=never, respectively.
2933
2934 The colors are defined by the environment variable GCC_COLORS. Its
2935 value is a colon-separated list of capabilities and Select Graphic
2936 Rendition (SGR) substrings. SGR commands are interpreted by the
2937 terminal or terminal emulator. (See the section in the
2938 documentation of your text terminal for permitted values and their
2939 meanings as character attributes.) These substring values are
2940 integers in decimal representation and can be concatenated with
2941 semicolons. Common values to concatenate include 1 for bold, 4 for
2942 underline, 5 for blink, 7 for inverse, 39 for default foreground
2943 color, 30 to 37 for foreground colors, 90 to 97 for 16-color mode
2944 foreground colors, 38;5;0 to 38;5;255 for 88-color and 256-color
2945 modes foreground colors, 49 for default background color, 40 to 47
2946 for background colors, 100 to 107 for 16-color mode background
2947 colors, and 48;5;0 to 48;5;255 for 88-color and 256-color modes
2948 background colors.
2949
2950 The default GCC_COLORS is
2951
2952 error=01;31:warning=01;35:note=01;36:range1=32:range2=34:locus=01:\
2953 quote=01:fixit-insert=32:fixit-delete=31:\
2954 diff-filename=01:diff-hunk=32:diff-delete=31:diff-insert=32:\
2955 type-diff=01;32
2956
2957 where 01;31 is bold red, 01;35 is bold magenta, 01;36 is bold cyan,
2958 32 is green, 34 is blue, 01 is bold, and 31 is red. Setting
2959 GCC_COLORS to the empty string disables colors. Supported
2960 capabilities are as follows.
2961
2962 "error="
2963 SGR substring for error: markers.
2964
2965 "warning="
2966 SGR substring for warning: markers.
2967
2968 "note="
2969 SGR substring for note: markers.
2970
2971 "range1="
2972 SGR substring for first additional range.
2973
2974 "range2="
2975 SGR substring for second additional range.
2976
2977 "locus="
2978 SGR substring for location information, file:line or
2979 file:line:column etc.
2980
2981 "quote="
2982 SGR substring for information printed within quotes.
2983
2984 "fixit-insert="
2985 SGR substring for fix-it hints suggesting text to be inserted
2986 or replaced.
2987
2988 "fixit-delete="
2989 SGR substring for fix-it hints suggesting text to be deleted.
2990
2991 "diff-filename="
2992 SGR substring for filename headers within generated patches.
2993
2994 "diff-hunk="
2995 SGR substring for the starts of hunks within generated patches.
2996
2997 "diff-delete="
2998 SGR substring for deleted lines within generated patches.
2999
3000 "diff-insert="
3001 SGR substring for inserted lines within generated patches.
3002
3003 "type-diff="
3004 SGR substring for highlighting mismatching types within
3005 template arguments in the C++ frontend.
3006
3007 -fno-diagnostics-show-option
3008 By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the
3009 command-line option that directly controls the diagnostic (if such
3010 an option is known to the diagnostic machinery). Specifying the
3011 -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag suppresses that behavior.
3012
3013 -fno-diagnostics-show-caret
3014 By default, each diagnostic emitted includes the original source
3015 line and a caret ^ indicating the column. This option suppresses
3016 this information. The source line is truncated to n characters, if
3017 the -fmessage-length=n option is given. When the output is done to
3018 the terminal, the width is limited to the width given by the
3019 COLUMNS environment variable or, if not set, to the terminal width.
3020
3021 -fno-diagnostics-show-labels
3022 By default, when printing source code (via
3023 -fdiagnostics-show-caret), diagnostics can label ranges of source
3024 code with pertinent information, such as the types of expressions:
3025
3026 printf ("foo %s bar", long_i + long_j);
3027 ~^ ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3028 | |
3029 char * long int
3030
3031 This option suppresses the printing of these labels (in the example
3032 above, the vertical bars and the "char *" and "long int" text).
3033
3034 -fno-diagnostics-show-line-numbers
3035 By default, when printing source code (via
3036 -fdiagnostics-show-caret), a left margin is printed, showing line
3037 numbers. This option suppresses this left margin.
3038
3039 -fdiagnostics-minimum-margin-width=width
3040 This option controls the minimum width of the left margin printed
3041 by -fdiagnostics-show-line-numbers. It defaults to 6.
3042
3043 -fdiagnostics-parseable-fixits
3044 Emit fix-it hints in a machine-parseable format, suitable for
3045 consumption by IDEs. For each fix-it, a line will be printed after
3046 the relevant diagnostic, starting with the string "fix-it:". For
3047 example:
3048
3049 fix-it:"test.c":{45:3-45:21}:"gtk_widget_show_all"
3050
3051 The location is expressed as a half-open range, expressed as a
3052 count of bytes, starting at byte 1 for the initial column. In the
3053 above example, bytes 3 through 20 of line 45 of "test.c" are to be
3054 replaced with the given string:
3055
3056 00000000011111111112222222222
3057 12345678901234567890123456789
3058 gtk_widget_showall (dlg);
3059 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3060 gtk_widget_show_all
3061
3062 The filename and replacement string escape backslash as "\\", tab
3063 as "\t", newline as "\n", double quotes as "\"", non-printable
3064 characters as octal (e.g. vertical tab as "\013").
3065
3066 An empty replacement string indicates that the given range is to be
3067 removed. An empty range (e.g. "45:3-45:3") indicates that the
3068 string is to be inserted at the given position.
3069
3070 -fdiagnostics-generate-patch
3071 Print fix-it hints to stderr in unified diff format, after any
3072 diagnostics are printed. For example:
3073
3074 --- test.c
3075 +++ test.c
3076 @ -42,5 +42,5 @
3077
3078 void show_cb(GtkDialog *dlg)
3079 {
3080 - gtk_widget_showall(dlg);
3081 + gtk_widget_show_all(dlg);
3082 }
3083
3084 The diff may or may not be colorized, following the same rules as
3085 for diagnostics (see -fdiagnostics-color).
3086
3087 -fdiagnostics-show-template-tree
3088 In the C++ frontend, when printing diagnostics showing mismatching
3089 template types, such as:
3090
3091 could not convert 'std::map<int, std::vector<double> >()'
3092 from 'map<[...],vector<double>>' to 'map<[...],vector<float>>
3093
3094 the -fdiagnostics-show-template-tree flag enables printing a tree-
3095 like structure showing the common and differing parts of the types,
3096 such as:
3097
3098 map<
3099 [...],
3100 vector<
3101 [double != float]>>
3102
3103 The parts that differ are highlighted with color ("double" and
3104 "float" in this case).
3105
3106 -fno-elide-type
3107 By default when the C++ frontend prints diagnostics showing
3108 mismatching template types, common parts of the types are printed
3109 as "[...]" to simplify the error message. For example:
3110
3111 could not convert 'std::map<int, std::vector<double> >()'
3112 from 'map<[...],vector<double>>' to 'map<[...],vector<float>>
3113
3114 Specifying the -fno-elide-type flag suppresses that behavior. This
3115 flag also affects the output of the
3116 -fdiagnostics-show-template-tree flag.
3117
3118 -fno-show-column
3119 Do not print column numbers in diagnostics. This may be necessary
3120 if diagnostics are being scanned by a program that does not
3121 understand the column numbers, such as dejagnu.
3122
3123 -fdiagnostics-format=FORMAT
3124 Select a different format for printing diagnostics. FORMAT is text
3125 or json. The default is text.
3126
3127 The json format consists of a top-level JSON array containing JSON
3128 objects representing the diagnostics.
3129
3130 The JSON is emitted as one line, without formatting; the examples
3131 below have been formatted for clarity.
3132
3133 Diagnostics can have child diagnostics. For example, this error
3134 and note:
3135
3136 misleading-indentation.c:15:3: warning: this 'if' clause does not
3137 guard... [-Wmisleading-indentation]
3138 15 | if (flag)
3139 | ^~
3140 misleading-indentation.c:17:5: note: ...this statement, but the latter
3141 is misleadingly indented as if it were guarded by the 'if'
3142 17 | y = 2;
3143 | ^
3144
3145 might be printed in JSON form (after formatting) like this:
3146
3147 [
3148 {
3149 "kind": "warning",
3150 "locations": [
3151 {
3152 "caret": {
3153 "column": 3,
3154 "file": "misleading-indentation.c",
3155 "line": 15
3156 },
3157 "finish": {
3158 "column": 4,
3159 "file": "misleading-indentation.c",
3160 "line": 15
3161 }
3162 }
3163 ],
3164 "message": "this \u2018if\u2019 clause does not guard...",
3165 "option": "-Wmisleading-indentation",
3166 "children": [
3167 {
3168 "kind": "note",
3169 "locations": [
3170 {
3171 "caret": {
3172 "column": 5,
3173 "file": "misleading-indentation.c",
3174 "line": 17
3175 }
3176 }
3177 ],
3178 "message": "...this statement, but the latter is ..."
3179 }
3180 ]
3181 },
3182 ...
3183 ]
3184
3185 where the "note" is a child of the "warning".
3186
3187 A diagnostic has a "kind". If this is "warning", then there is an
3188 "option" key describing the command-line option controlling the
3189 warning.
3190
3191 A diagnostic can contain zero or more locations. Each location has
3192 up to three positions within it: a "caret" position and optional
3193 "start" and "finish" positions. A location can also have an
3194 optional "label" string. For example, this error:
3195
3196 bad-binary-ops.c:64:23: error: invalid operands to binary + (have 'S' {aka
3197 'struct s'} and 'T' {aka 'struct t'})
3198 64 | return callee_4a () + callee_4b ();
3199 | ~~~~~~~~~~~~ ^ ~~~~~~~~~~~~
3200 | | |
3201 | | T {aka struct t}
3202 | S {aka struct s}
3203
3204 has three locations. Its primary location is at the "+" token at
3205 column 23. It has two secondary locations, describing the left and
3206 right-hand sides of the expression, which have labels. It might be
3207 printed in JSON form as:
3208
3209 {
3210 "children": [],
3211 "kind": "error",
3212 "locations": [
3213 {
3214 "caret": {
3215 "column": 23, "file": "bad-binary-ops.c", "line": 64
3216 }
3217 },
3218 {
3219 "caret": {
3220 "column": 10, "file": "bad-binary-ops.c", "line": 64
3221 },
3222 "finish": {
3223 "column": 21, "file": "bad-binary-ops.c", "line": 64
3224 },
3225 "label": "S {aka struct s}"
3226 },
3227 {
3228 "caret": {
3229 "column": 25, "file": "bad-binary-ops.c", "line": 64
3230 },
3231 "finish": {
3232 "column": 36, "file": "bad-binary-ops.c", "line": 64
3233 },
3234 "label": "T {aka struct t}"
3235 }
3236 ],
3237 "message": "invalid operands to binary + ..."
3238 }
3239
3240 If a diagnostic contains fix-it hints, it has a "fixits" array,
3241 consisting of half-open intervals, similar to the output of
3242 -fdiagnostics-parseable-fixits. For example, this diagnostic with
3243 a replacement fix-it hint:
3244
3245 demo.c:8:15: error: 'struct s' has no member named 'colour'; did you
3246 mean 'color'?
3247 8 | return ptr->colour;
3248 | ^~~~~~
3249 | color
3250
3251 might be printed in JSON form as:
3252
3253 {
3254 "children": [],
3255 "fixits": [
3256 {
3257 "next": {
3258 "column": 21,
3259 "file": "demo.c",
3260 "line": 8
3261 },
3262 "start": {
3263 "column": 15,
3264 "file": "demo.c",
3265 "line": 8
3266 },
3267 "string": "color"
3268 }
3269 ],
3270 "kind": "error",
3271 "locations": [
3272 {
3273 "caret": {
3274 "column": 15,
3275 "file": "demo.c",
3276 "line": 8
3277 },
3278 "finish": {
3279 "column": 20,
3280 "file": "demo.c",
3281 "line": 8
3282 }
3283 }
3284 ],
3285 "message": "\u2018struct s\u2019 has no member named ..."
3286 }
3287
3288 where the fix-it hint suggests replacing the text from "start" up
3289 to but not including "next" with "string"'s value. Deletions are
3290 expressed via an empty value for "string", insertions by having
3291 "start" equal "next".
3292
3293 Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
3294 Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that are not
3295 inherently erroneous but that are risky or suggest there may have been
3296 an error.
3297
3298 The following language-independent options do not enable specific
3299 warnings but control the kinds of diagnostics produced by GCC.
3300
3301 -fsyntax-only
3302 Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond
3303 that.
3304
3305 -fmax-errors=n
3306 Limits the maximum number of error messages to n, at which point
3307 GCC bails out rather than attempting to continue processing the
3308 source code. If n is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the
3309 number of error messages produced. If -Wfatal-errors is also
3310 specified, then -Wfatal-errors takes precedence over this option.
3311
3312 -w Inhibit all warning messages.
3313
3314 -Werror
3315 Make all warnings into errors.
3316
3317 -Werror=
3318 Make the specified warning into an error. The specifier for a
3319 warning is appended; for example -Werror=switch turns the warnings
3320 controlled by -Wswitch into errors. This switch takes a negative
3321 form, to be used to negate -Werror for specific warnings; for
3322 example -Wno-error=switch makes -Wswitch warnings not be errors,
3323 even when -Werror is in effect.
3324
3325 The warning message for each controllable warning includes the
3326 option that controls the warning. That option can then be used
3327 with -Werror= and -Wno-error= as described above. (Printing of the
3328 option in the warning message can be disabled using the
3329 -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag.)
3330
3331 Note that specifying -Werror=foo automatically implies -Wfoo.
3332 However, -Wno-error=foo does not imply anything.
3333
3334 -Wfatal-errors
3335 This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first
3336 error occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing
3337 further error messages.
3338
3339 You can request many specific warnings with options beginning with -W,
3340 for example -Wimplicit to request warnings on implicit declarations.
3341 Each of these specific warning options also has a negative form
3342 beginning -Wno- to turn off warnings; for example, -Wno-implicit. This
3343 manual lists only one of the two forms, whichever is not the default.
3344 For further language-specific options also refer to C++ Dialect Options
3345 and Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options.
3346
3347 Some options, such as -Wall and -Wextra, turn on other options, such as
3348 -Wunused, which may turn on further options, such as -Wunused-value.
3349 The combined effect of positive and negative forms is that more
3350 specific options have priority over less specific ones, independently
3351 of their position in the command-line. For options of the same
3352 specificity, the last one takes effect. Options enabled or disabled via
3353 pragmas take effect as if they appeared at the end of the command-line.
3354
3355 When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g.,
3356 -Wunknown-warning), GCC emits a diagnostic stating that the option is
3357 not recognized. However, if the -Wno- form is used, the behavior is
3358 slightly different: no diagnostic is produced for -Wno-unknown-warning
3359 unless other diagnostics are being produced. This allows the use of
3360 new -Wno- options with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the
3361 compiler warns that an unrecognized option is present.
3362
3363 -Wpedantic
3364 -pedantic
3365 Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++; reject
3366 all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other programs
3367 that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++. For ISO C, follows the
3368 version of the ISO C standard specified by any -std option used.
3369
3370 Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or
3371 without this option (though a rare few require -ansi or a -std
3372 option specifying the required version of ISO C). However, without
3373 this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
3374 features are supported as well. With this option, they are
3375 rejected.
3376
3377 -Wpedantic does not cause warning messages for use of the alternate
3378 keywords whose names begin and end with __. Pedantic warnings are
3379 also disabled in the expression that follows "__extension__".
3380 However, only system header files should use these escape routes;
3381 application programs should avoid them.
3382
3383 Some users try to use -Wpedantic to check programs for strict ISO C
3384 conformance. They soon find that it does not do quite what they
3385 want: it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for
3386 which ISO C requires a diagnostic, and some others for which
3387 diagnostics have been added.
3388
3389 A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful
3390 in some instances, but would require considerable additional work
3391 and would be quite different from -Wpedantic. We don't have plans
3392 to support such a feature in the near future.
3393
3394 Where the standard specified with -std represents a GNU extended
3395 dialect of C, such as gnu90 or gnu99, there is a corresponding base
3396 standard, the version of ISO C on which the GNU extended dialect is
3397 based. Warnings from -Wpedantic are given where they are required
3398 by the base standard. (It does not make sense for such warnings to
3399 be given only for features not in the specified GNU C dialect,
3400 since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all features the
3401 compiler supports with the given option, and there would be nothing
3402 to warn about.)
3403
3404 -pedantic-errors
3405 Give an error whenever the base standard (see -Wpedantic) requires
3406 a diagnostic, in some cases where there is undefined behavior at
3407 compile-time and in some other cases that do not prevent
3408 compilation of programs that are valid according to the standard.
3409 This is not equivalent to -Werror=pedantic, since there are errors
3410 enabled by this option and not enabled by the latter and vice
3411 versa.
3412
3413 -Wall
3414 This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users
3415 consider questionable, and that are easy to avoid (or modify to
3416 prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros. This also
3417 enables some language-specific warnings described in C++ Dialect
3418 Options and Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options.
3419
3420 -Wall turns on the following warning flags:
3421
3422 -Waddress -Warray-bounds=1 (only with -O2) -Wbool-compare
3423 -Wbool-operation -Wc++11-compat -Wc++14-compat -Wcatch-value (C++
3424 and Objective-C++ only) -Wchar-subscripts -Wcomment
3425 -Wduplicate-decl-specifier (C and Objective-C only) -Wenum-compare
3426 (in C/ObjC; this is on by default in C++) -Wformat
3427 -Wint-in-bool-context -Wimplicit (C and Objective-C only)
3428 -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only)
3429 -Wimplicit-function-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
3430 -Winit-self (only for C++) -Wlogical-not-parentheses -Wmain (only
3431 for C/ObjC and unless -ffreestanding) -Wmaybe-uninitialized
3432 -Wmemset-elt-size -Wmemset-transposed-args -Wmisleading-indentation
3433 (only for C/C++) -Wmissing-attributes -Wmissing-braces (only for
3434 C/ObjC) -Wmultistatement-macros -Wnarrowing (only for C++)
3435 -Wnonnull -Wnonnull-compare -Wopenmp-simd -Wparentheses
3436 -Wpessimizing-move (only for C++) -Wpointer-sign -Wreorder
3437 -Wrestrict -Wreturn-type -Wsequence-point -Wsign-compare (only in
3438 C++) -Wsizeof-pointer-div -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess
3439 -Wstrict-aliasing -Wstrict-overflow=1 -Wswitch
3440 -Wtautological-compare -Wtrigraphs -Wuninitialized
3441 -Wunknown-pragmas -Wunused-function -Wunused-label -Wunused-value
3442 -Wunused-variable -Wvolatile-register-var
3443
3444 Note that some warning flags are not implied by -Wall. Some of
3445 them warn about constructions that users generally do not consider
3446 questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
3447 others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid
3448 in some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to
3449 suppress the warning. Some of them are enabled by -Wextra but many
3450 of them must be enabled individually.
3451
3452 -Wextra
3453 This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by
3454 -Wall. (This option used to be called -W. The older name is still
3455 supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)
3456
3457 -Wclobbered -Wcast-function-type -Wdeprecated-copy (C++ only)
3458 -Wempty-body -Wignored-qualifiers -Wimplicit-fallthrough=3
3459 -Wmissing-field-initializers -Wmissing-parameter-type (C only)
3460 -Wold-style-declaration (C only) -Woverride-init -Wsign-compare (C
3461 only) -Wredundant-move (only for C++) -Wtype-limits -Wuninitialized
3462 -Wshift-negative-value (in C++03 and in C99 and newer)
3463 -Wunused-parameter (only with -Wunused or -Wall)
3464 -Wunused-but-set-parameter (only with -Wunused or -Wall)
3465
3466 The option -Wextra also prints warning messages for the following
3467 cases:
3468
3469 * A pointer is compared against integer zero with "<", "<=", ">",
3470 or ">=".
3471
3472 * (C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a
3473 conditional expression.
3474
3475 * (C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.
3476
3477 * (C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared
3478 "register".
3479
3480 * (C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been
3481 declared "register".
3482
3483 * (C++ only) A base class is not initialized in the copy
3484 constructor of a derived class.
3485
3486 -Wchar-subscripts
3487 Warn if an array subscript has type "char". This is a common cause
3488 of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on
3489 some machines. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
3490
3491 -Wno-coverage-mismatch
3492 Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the -fprofile-use
3493 option. If a source file is changed between compiling with
3494 -fprofile-generate and with -fprofile-use, the files with the
3495 profile feedback can fail to match the source file and GCC cannot
3496 use the profile feedback information. By default, this warning is
3497 enabled and is treated as an error. -Wno-coverage-mismatch can be
3498 used to disable the warning or -Wno-error=coverage-mismatch can be
3499 used to disable the error. Disabling the error for this warning
3500 can result in poorly optimized code and is useful only in the case
3501 of very minor changes such as bug fixes to an existing code-base.
3502 Completely disabling the warning is not recommended.
3503
3504 -Wno-cpp
3505 (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)
3506
3507 Suppress warning messages emitted by "#warning" directives.
3508
3509 -Wdouble-promotion (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
3510 Give a warning when a value of type "float" is implicitly promoted
3511 to "double". CPUs with a 32-bit "single-precision" floating-point
3512 unit implement "float" in hardware, but emulate "double" in
3513 software. On such a machine, doing computations using "double"
3514 values is much more expensive because of the overhead required for
3515 software emulation.
3516
3517 It is easy to accidentally do computations with "double" because
3518 floating-point literals are implicitly of type "double". For
3519 example, in:
3520
3521 float area(float radius)
3522 {
3523 return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
3524 }
3525
3526 the compiler performs the entire computation with "double" because
3527 the floating-point literal is a "double".
3528
3529 -Wduplicate-decl-specifier (C and Objective-C only)
3530 Warn if a declaration has duplicate "const", "volatile", "restrict"
3531 or "_Atomic" specifier. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
3532
3533 -Wformat
3534 -Wformat=n
3535 Check calls to "printf" and "scanf", etc., to make sure that the
3536 arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
3537 specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string
3538 make sense. This includes standard functions, and others specified
3539 by format attributes, in the "printf", "scanf", "strftime" and
3540 "strfmon" (an X/Open extension, not in the C standard) families (or
3541 other target-specific families). Which functions are checked
3542 without format attributes having been specified depends on the
3543 standard version selected, and such checks of functions without the
3544 attribute specified are disabled by -ffreestanding or -fno-builtin.
3545
3546 The formats are checked against the format features supported by
3547 GNU libc version 2.2. These include all ISO C90 and C99 features,
3548 as well as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD
3549 and GNU extensions. Other library implementations may not support
3550 all these features; GCC does not support warning about features
3551 that go beyond a particular library's limitations. However, if
3552 -Wpedantic is used with -Wformat, warnings are given about format
3553 features not in the selected standard version (but not for
3554 "strfmon" formats, since those are not in any version of the C
3555 standard).
3556
3557 -Wformat=1
3558 -Wformat
3559 Option -Wformat is equivalent to -Wformat=1, and -Wno-format is
3560 equivalent to -Wformat=0. Since -Wformat also checks for null
3561 format arguments for several functions, -Wformat also implies
3562 -Wnonnull. Some aspects of this level of format checking can
3563 be disabled by the options: -Wno-format-contains-nul,
3564 -Wno-format-extra-args, and -Wno-format-zero-length. -Wformat
3565 is enabled by -Wall.
3566
3567 -Wno-format-contains-nul
3568 If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about format strings that
3569 contain NUL bytes.
3570
3571 -Wno-format-extra-args
3572 If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to
3573 a "printf" or "scanf" format function. The C standard
3574 specifies that such arguments are ignored.
3575
3576 Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
3577 specified with $ operand number specifications, normally
3578 warnings are still given, since the implementation could not
3579 know what type to pass to "va_arg" to skip the unused
3580 arguments. However, in the case of "scanf" formats, this
3581 option suppresses the warning if the unused arguments are all
3582 pointers, since the Single Unix Specification says that such
3583 unused arguments are allowed.
3584
3585 -Wformat-overflow
3586 -Wformat-overflow=level
3587 Warn about calls to formatted input/output functions such as
3588 "sprintf" and "vsprintf" that might overflow the destination
3589 buffer. When the exact number of bytes written by a format
3590 directive cannot be determined at compile-time it is estimated
3591 based on heuristics that depend on the level argument and on
3592 optimization. While enabling optimization will in most cases
3593 improve the accuracy of the warning, it may also result in
3594 false positives.
3595
3596 -Wformat-overflow
3597 -Wformat-overflow=1
3598 Level 1 of -Wformat-overflow enabled by -Wformat employs a
3599 conservative approach that warns only about calls that most
3600 likely overflow the buffer. At this level, numeric
3601 arguments to format directives with unknown values are
3602 assumed to have the value of one, and strings of unknown
3603 length to be empty. Numeric arguments that are known to be
3604 bounded to a subrange of their type, or string arguments
3605 whose output is bounded either by their directive's
3606 precision or by a finite set of string literals, are
3607 assumed to take on the value within the range that results
3608 in the most bytes on output. For example, the call to
3609 "sprintf" below is diagnosed because even with both a and b
3610 equal to zero, the terminating NUL character ('\0')
3611 appended by the function to the destination buffer will be
3612 written past its end. Increasing the size of the buffer by
3613 a single byte is sufficient to avoid the warning, though it
3614 may not be sufficient to avoid the overflow.
3615
3616 void f (int a, int b)
3617 {
3618 char buf [13];
3619 sprintf (buf, "a = %i, b = %i\n", a, b);
3620 }
3621
3622 -Wformat-overflow=2
3623 Level 2 warns also about calls that might overflow the
3624 destination buffer given an argument of sufficient length
3625 or magnitude. At level 2, unknown numeric arguments are
3626 assumed to have the minimum representable value for signed
3627 types with a precision greater than 1, and the maximum
3628 representable value otherwise. Unknown string arguments
3629 whose length cannot be assumed to be bounded either by the
3630 directive's precision, or by a finite set of string
3631 literals they may evaluate to, or the character array they
3632 may point to, are assumed to be 1 character long.
3633
3634 At level 2, the call in the example above is again
3635 diagnosed, but this time because with a equal to a 32-bit
3636 "INT_MIN" the first %i directive will write some of its
3637 digits beyond the end of the destination buffer. To make
3638 the call safe regardless of the values of the two
3639 variables, the size of the destination buffer must be
3640 increased to at least 34 bytes. GCC includes the minimum
3641 size of the buffer in an informational note following the
3642 warning.
3643
3644 An alternative to increasing the size of the destination
3645 buffer is to constrain the range of formatted values. The
3646 maximum length of string arguments can be bounded by
3647 specifying the precision in the format directive. When
3648 numeric arguments of format directives can be assumed to be
3649 bounded by less than the precision of their type, choosing
3650 an appropriate length modifier to the format specifier will
3651 reduce the required buffer size. For example, if a and b
3652 in the example above can be assumed to be within the
3653 precision of the "short int" type then using either the %hi
3654 format directive or casting the argument to "short" reduces
3655 the maximum required size of the buffer to 24 bytes.
3656
3657 void f (int a, int b)
3658 {
3659 char buf [23];
3660 sprintf (buf, "a = %hi, b = %i\n", a, (short)b);
3661 }
3662
3663 -Wno-format-zero-length
3664 If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about zero-length
3665 formats. The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are
3666 allowed.
3667
3668 -Wformat=2
3669 Enable -Wformat plus additional format checks. Currently
3670 equivalent to -Wformat -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security
3671 -Wformat-y2k.
3672
3673 -Wformat-nonliteral
3674 If -Wformat is specified, also warn if the format string is not
3675 a string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format
3676 function takes its format arguments as a "va_list".
3677
3678 -Wformat-security
3679 If -Wformat is specified, also warn about uses of format
3680 functions that represent possible security problems. At
3681 present, this warns about calls to "printf" and "scanf"
3682 functions where the format string is not a string literal and
3683 there are no format arguments, as in "printf (foo);". This may
3684 be a security hole if the format string came from untrusted
3685 input and contains %n. (This is currently a subset of what
3686 -Wformat-nonliteral warns about, but in future warnings may be
3687 added to -Wformat-security that are not included in
3688 -Wformat-nonliteral.)
3689
3690 -Wformat-signedness
3691 If -Wformat is specified, also warn if the format string
3692 requires an unsigned argument and the argument is signed and
3693 vice versa.
3694
3695 -Wformat-truncation
3696 -Wformat-truncation=level
3697 Warn about calls to formatted input/output functions such as
3698 "snprintf" and "vsnprintf" that might result in output
3699 truncation. When the exact number of bytes written by a format
3700 directive cannot be determined at compile-time it is estimated
3701 based on heuristics that depend on the level argument and on
3702 optimization. While enabling optimization will in most cases
3703 improve the accuracy of the warning, it may also result in
3704 false positives. Except as noted otherwise, the option uses
3705 the same logic -Wformat-overflow.
3706
3707 -Wformat-truncation
3708 -Wformat-truncation=1
3709 Level 1 of -Wformat-truncation enabled by -Wformat employs
3710 a conservative approach that warns only about calls to
3711 bounded functions whose return value is unused and that
3712 will most likely result in output truncation.
3713
3714 -Wformat-truncation=2
3715 Level 2 warns also about calls to bounded functions whose
3716 return value is used and that might result in truncation
3717 given an argument of sufficient length or magnitude.
3718
3719 -Wformat-y2k
3720 If -Wformat is specified, also warn about "strftime" formats
3721 that may yield only a two-digit year.
3722
3723 -Wnonnull
3724 Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as requiring
3725 a non-null value by the "nonnull" function attribute.
3726
3727 -Wnonnull is included in -Wall and -Wformat. It can be disabled
3728 with the -Wno-nonnull option.
3729
3730 -Wnonnull-compare
3731 Warn when comparing an argument marked with the "nonnull" function
3732 attribute against null inside the function.
3733
3734 -Wnonnull-compare is included in -Wall. It can be disabled with
3735 the -Wno-nonnull-compare option.
3736
3737 -Wnull-dereference
3738 Warn if the compiler detects paths that trigger erroneous or
3739 undefined behavior due to dereferencing a null pointer. This
3740 option is only active when -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is active,
3741 which is enabled by optimizations in most targets. The precision
3742 of the warnings depends on the optimization options used.
3743
3744 -Winit-self (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
3745 Warn about uninitialized variables that are initialized with
3746 themselves. Note this option can only be used with the
3747 -Wuninitialized option.
3748
3749 For example, GCC warns about "i" being uninitialized in the
3750 following snippet only when -Winit-self has been specified:
3751
3752 int f()
3753 {
3754 int i = i;
3755 return i;
3756 }
3757
3758 This warning is enabled by -Wall in C++.
3759
3760 -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only)
3761 Warn when a declaration does not specify a type. This warning is
3762 enabled by -Wall.
3763
3764 -Wimplicit-function-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
3765 Give a warning whenever a function is used before being declared.
3766 In C99 mode (-std=c99 or -std=gnu99), this warning is enabled by
3767 default and it is made into an error by -pedantic-errors. This
3768 warning is also enabled by -Wall.
3769
3770 -Wimplicit (C and Objective-C only)
3771 Same as -Wimplicit-int and -Wimplicit-function-declaration. This
3772 warning is enabled by -Wall.
3773
3774 -Wimplicit-fallthrough
3775 -Wimplicit-fallthrough is the same as -Wimplicit-fallthrough=3 and
3776 -Wno-implicit-fallthrough is the same as -Wimplicit-fallthrough=0.
3777
3778 -Wimplicit-fallthrough=n
3779 Warn when a switch case falls through. For example:
3780
3781 switch (cond)
3782 {
3783 case 1:
3784 a = 1;
3785 break;
3786 case 2:
3787 a = 2;
3788 case 3:
3789 a = 3;
3790 break;
3791 }
3792
3793 This warning does not warn when the last statement of a case cannot
3794 fall through, e.g. when there is a return statement or a call to
3795 function declared with the noreturn attribute.
3796 -Wimplicit-fallthrough= also takes into account control flow
3797 statements, such as ifs, and only warns when appropriate. E.g.
3798
3799 switch (cond)
3800 {
3801 case 1:
3802 if (i > 3) {
3803 bar (5);
3804 break;
3805 } else if (i < 1) {
3806 bar (0);
3807 } else
3808 return;
3809 default:
3810 ...
3811 }
3812
3813 Since there are occasions where a switch case fall through is
3814 desirable, GCC provides an attribute, "__attribute__
3815 ((fallthrough))", that is to be used along with a null statement to
3816 suppress this warning that would normally occur:
3817
3818 switch (cond)
3819 {
3820 case 1:
3821 bar (0);
3822 __attribute__ ((fallthrough));
3823 default:
3824 ...
3825 }
3826
3827 C++17 provides a standard way to suppress the
3828 -Wimplicit-fallthrough warning using "[[fallthrough]];" instead of
3829 the GNU attribute. In C++11 or C++14 users can use
3830 "[[gnu::fallthrough]];", which is a GNU extension. Instead of
3831 these attributes, it is also possible to add a fallthrough comment
3832 to silence the warning. The whole body of the C or C++ style
3833 comment should match the given regular expressions listed below.
3834 The option argument n specifies what kind of comments are accepted:
3835
3836 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=0 disables the warning altogether.>
3837 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=1 matches ".*" regular>
3838 expression, any comment is used as fallthrough comment.
3839
3840 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=2 case insensitively matches>
3841 ".*falls?[ \t-]*thr(ough|u).*" regular expression.
3842
3843 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=3 case sensitively matches one of the>
3844 following regular expressions:
3845
3846 *<"-fallthrough">
3847 *<"@fallthrough@">
3848 *<"lint -fallthrough[ \t]*">
3849 *<"[ \t.!]*(ELSE,? |INTENTIONAL(LY)? )?FALL(S |
3850 |-)?THR(OUGH|U)[ \t.!]*(-[^\n\r]*)?">
3851 *<"[ \t.!]*(Else,? |Intentional(ly)? )?Fall((s |
3852 |-)[Tt]|t)hr(ough|u)[ \t.!]*(-[^\n\r]*)?">
3853 *<"[ \t.!]*([Ee]lse,? |[Ii]ntentional(ly)? )?fall(s |
3854 |-)?thr(ough|u)[ \t.!]*(-[^\n\r]*)?">
3855 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=4 case sensitively matches one of the>
3856 following regular expressions:
3857
3858 *<"-fallthrough">
3859 *<"@fallthrough@">
3860 *<"lint -fallthrough[ \t]*">
3861 *<"[ \t]*FALLTHR(OUGH|U)[ \t]*">
3862 *<-Wimplicit-fallthrough=5 doesn't recognize any comments as>
3863 fallthrough comments, only attributes disable the warning.
3864
3865 The comment needs to be followed after optional whitespace and
3866 other comments by "case" or "default" keywords or by a user label
3867 that precedes some "case" or "default" label.
3868
3869 switch (cond)
3870 {
3871 case 1:
3872 bar (0);
3873 /* FALLTHRU */
3874 default:
3875 ...
3876 }
3877
3878 The -Wimplicit-fallthrough=3 warning is enabled by -Wextra.
3879
3880 -Wif-not-aligned (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
3881 Control if warning triggered by the "warn_if_not_aligned" attribute
3882 should be issued. This is enabled by default. Use
3883 -Wno-if-not-aligned to disable it.
3884
3885 -Wignored-qualifiers (C and C++ only)
3886 Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier such as
3887 "const". For ISO C such a type qualifier has no effect, since the
3888 value returned by a function is not an lvalue. For C++, the
3889 warning is only emitted for scalar types or "void". ISO C
3890 prohibits qualified "void" return types on function definitions, so
3891 such return types always receive a warning even without this
3892 option.
3893
3894 This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.
3895
3896 -Wignored-attributes (C and C++ only)
3897 Warn when an attribute is ignored. This is different from the
3898 -Wattributes option in that it warns whenever the compiler decides
3899 to drop an attribute, not that the attribute is either unknown,
3900 used in a wrong place, etc. This warning is enabled by default.
3901
3902 -Wmain
3903 Warn if the type of "main" is suspicious. "main" should be a
3904 function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
3905 arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types. This
3906 warning is enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either -Wall
3907 or -Wpedantic.
3908
3909 -Wmisleading-indentation (C and C++ only)
3910 Warn when the indentation of the code does not reflect the block
3911 structure. Specifically, a warning is issued for "if", "else",
3912 "while", and "for" clauses with a guarded statement that does not
3913 use braces, followed by an unguarded statement with the same
3914 indentation.
3915
3916 In the following example, the call to "bar" is misleadingly
3917 indented as if it were guarded by the "if" conditional.
3918
3919 if (some_condition ())
3920 foo ();
3921 bar (); /* Gotcha: this is not guarded by the "if". */
3922
3923 In the case of mixed tabs and spaces, the warning uses the
3924 -ftabstop= option to determine if the statements line up
3925 (defaulting to 8).
3926
3927 The warning is not issued for code involving multiline preprocessor
3928 logic such as the following example.
3929
3930 if (flagA)
3931 foo (0);
3932 #if SOME_CONDITION_THAT_DOES_NOT_HOLD
3933 if (flagB)
3934 #endif
3935 foo (1);
3936
3937 The warning is not issued after a "#line" directive, since this
3938 typically indicates autogenerated code, and no assumptions can be
3939 made about the layout of the file that the directive references.
3940
3941 This warning is enabled by -Wall in C and C++.
3942
3943 -Wmissing-attributes
3944 Warn when a declaration of a function is missing one or more
3945 attributes that a related function is declared with and whose
3946 absence may adversely affect the correctness or efficiency of
3947 generated code. For example, the warning is issued for
3948 declarations of aliases that use attributes to specify less
3949 restrictive requirements than those of their targets. This
3950 typically represents a potential optimization opportunity. By
3951 contrast, the -Wattribute-alias=2 option controls warnings issued
3952 when the alias is more restrictive than the target, which could
3953 lead to incorrect code generation. Attributes considered include
3954 "alloc_align", "alloc_size", "cold", "const", "hot", "leaf",
3955 "malloc", "nonnull", "noreturn", "nothrow", "pure",
3956 "returns_nonnull", and "returns_twice".
3957
3958 In C++, the warning is issued when an explicit specialization of a
3959 primary template declared with attribute "alloc_align",
3960 "alloc_size", "assume_aligned", "format", "format_arg", "malloc",
3961 or "nonnull" is declared without it. Attributes "deprecated",
3962 "error", and "warning" suppress the warning..
3963
3964 You can use the "copy" attribute to apply the same set of
3965 attributes to a declaration as that on another declaration without
3966 explicitly enumerating the attributes. This attribute can be
3967 applied to declarations of functions, variables, or types.
3968
3969 -Wmissing-attributes is enabled by -Wall.
3970
3971 For example, since the declaration of the primary function template
3972 below makes use of both attribute "malloc" and "alloc_size" the
3973 declaration of the explicit specialization of the template is
3974 diagnosed because it is missing one of the attributes.
3975
3976 template <class T>
3977 T* __attribute__ ((malloc, alloc_size (1)))
3978 allocate (size_t);
3979
3980 template <>
3981 void* __attribute__ ((malloc)) // missing alloc_size
3982 allocate<void> (size_t);
3983
3984 -Wmissing-braces
3985 Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.
3986 In the following example, the initializer for "a" is not fully
3987 bracketed, but that for "b" is fully bracketed. This warning is
3988 enabled by -Wall in C.
3989
3990 int a[2][2] = { 0, 1, 2, 3 };
3991 int b[2][2] = { { 0, 1 }, { 2, 3 } };
3992
3993 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
3994
3995 -Wmissing-include-dirs (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
3996 Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
3997
3998 -Wmissing-profile
3999 Warn if feedback profiles are missing when using the -fprofile-use
4000 option. This option diagnoses those cases where a new function or
4001 a new file is added to the user code between compiling with
4002 -fprofile-generate and with -fprofile-use, without regenerating the
4003 profiles. In these cases, the profile feedback data files do not
4004 contain any profile feedback information for the newly added
4005 function or file respectively. Also, in the case when profile
4006 count data (.gcda) files are removed, GCC cannot use any profile
4007 feedback information. In all these cases, warnings are issued to
4008 inform the user that a profile generation step is due.
4009 -Wno-missing-profile can be used to disable the warning. Ignoring
4010 the warning can result in poorly optimized code. Completely
4011 disabling the warning is not recommended and should be done only
4012 when non-existent profile data is justified.
4013
4014 -Wmultistatement-macros
4015 Warn about unsafe multiple statement macros that appear to be
4016 guarded by a clause such as "if", "else", "for", "switch", or
4017 "while", in which only the first statement is actually guarded
4018 after the macro is expanded.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 #define DOIT x++; y++
4023 if (c)
4024 DOIT;
4025
4026 will increment "y" unconditionally, not just when "c" holds. The
4027 can usually be fixed by wrapping the macro in a do-while loop:
4028
4029 #define DOIT do { x++; y++; } while (0)
4030 if (c)
4031 DOIT;
4032
4033 This warning is enabled by -Wall in C and C++.
4034
4035 -Wparentheses
4036 Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such as when
4037 there is an assignment in a context where a truth value is
4038 expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
4039 often get confused about.
4040
4041 Also warn if a comparison like "x<=y<=z" appears; this is
4042 equivalent to "(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z", which is a different
4043 interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
4044
4045 Also warn for dangerous uses of the GNU extension to "?:" with
4046 omitted middle operand. When the condition in the "?": operator is
4047 a boolean expression, the omitted value is always 1. Often
4048 programmers expect it to be a value computed inside the conditional
4049 expression instead.
4050
4051 For C++ this also warns for some cases of unnecessary parentheses
4052 in declarations, which can indicate an attempt at a function call
4053 instead of a declaration:
4054
4055 {
4056 // Declares a local variable called mymutex.
4057 std::unique_lock<std::mutex> (mymutex);
4058 // User meant std::unique_lock<std::mutex> lock (mymutex);
4059 }
4060
4061 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4062
4063 -Wsequence-point
4064 Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of
4065 violations of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
4066
4067 The C and C++ standards define the order in which expressions in a
4068 C/C++ program are evaluated in terms of sequence points, which
4069 represent a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the
4070 program: those executed before the sequence point, and those
4071 executed after it. These occur after the evaluation of a full
4072 expression (one which is not part of a larger expression), after
4073 the evaluation of the first operand of a "&&", "||", "? :" or ","
4074 (comma) operator, before a function is called (but after the
4075 evaluation of its arguments and the expression denoting the called
4076 function), and in certain other places. Other than as expressed by
4077 the sequence point rules, the order of evaluation of subexpressions
4078 of an expression is not specified. All these rules describe only a
4079 partial order rather than a total order, since, for example, if two
4080 functions are called within one expression with no sequence point
4081 between them, the order in which the functions are called is not
4082 specified. However, the standards committee have ruled that
4083 function calls do not overlap.
4084
4085 It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to
4086 the values of objects take effect. Programs whose behavior depends
4087 on this have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify
4088 that "Between the previous and next sequence point an object shall
4089 have its stored value modified at most once by the evaluation of an
4090 expression. Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to
4091 determine the value to be stored.". If a program breaks these
4092 rules, the results on any particular implementation are entirely
4093 unpredictable.
4094
4095 Examples of code with undefined behavior are "a = a++;", "a[n] =
4096 b[n++]" and "a[i++] = i;". Some more complicated cases are not
4097 diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false
4098 positive result, but in general it has been found fairly effective
4099 at detecting this sort of problem in programs.
4100
4101 The C++17 standard will define the order of evaluation of operands
4102 in more cases: in particular it requires that the right-hand side
4103 of an assignment be evaluated before the left-hand side, so the
4104 above examples are no longer undefined. But this warning will
4105 still warn about them, to help people avoid writing code that is
4106 undefined in C and earlier revisions of C++.
4107
4108 The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
4109 over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle
4110 cases. Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed
4111 formal definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
4112 <http://gcc.gnu.org/readings.html>.
4113
4114 This warning is enabled by -Wall for C and C++.
4115
4116 -Wno-return-local-addr
4117 Do not warn about returning a pointer (or in C++, a reference) to a
4118 variable that goes out of scope after the function returns.
4119
4120 -Wreturn-type
4121 Warn whenever a function is defined with a return type that
4122 defaults to "int". Also warn about any "return" statement with no
4123 return value in a function whose return type is not "void" (falling
4124 off the end of the function body is considered returning without a
4125 value).
4126
4127 For C only, warn about a "return" statement with an expression in a
4128 function whose return type is "void", unless the expression type is
4129 also "void". As a GNU extension, the latter case is accepted
4130 without a warning unless -Wpedantic is used. Attempting to use the
4131 return value of a non-"void" function other than "main" that flows
4132 off the end by reaching the closing curly brace that terminates the
4133 function is undefined.
4134
4135 Unlike in C, in C++, flowing off the end of a non-"void" function
4136 other than "main" results in undefined behavior even when the value
4137 of the function is not used.
4138
4139 This warning is enabled by default in C++ and by -Wall otherwise.
4140
4141 -Wshift-count-negative
4142 Warn if shift count is negative. This warning is enabled by
4143 default.
4144
4145 -Wshift-count-overflow
4146 Warn if shift count >= width of type. This warning is enabled by
4147 default.
4148
4149 -Wshift-negative-value
4150 Warn if left shifting a negative value. This warning is enabled by
4151 -Wextra in C99 and C++11 modes (and newer).
4152
4153 -Wshift-overflow
4154 -Wshift-overflow=n
4155 Warn about left shift overflows. This warning is enabled by
4156 default in C99 and C++11 modes (and newer).
4157
4158 -Wshift-overflow=1
4159 This is the warning level of -Wshift-overflow and is enabled by
4160 default in C99 and C++11 modes (and newer). This warning level
4161 does not warn about left-shifting 1 into the sign bit.
4162 (However, in C, such an overflow is still rejected in contexts
4163 where an integer constant expression is required.) No warning
4164 is emitted in C++2A mode (and newer), as signed left shifts
4165 always wrap.
4166
4167 -Wshift-overflow=2
4168 This warning level also warns about left-shifting 1 into the
4169 sign bit, unless C++14 mode (or newer) is active.
4170
4171 -Wswitch
4172 Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type
4173 and lacks a "case" for one or more of the named codes of that
4174 enumeration. (The presence of a "default" label prevents this
4175 warning.) "case" labels outside the enumeration range also provoke
4176 warnings when this option is used (even if there is a "default"
4177 label). This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4178
4179 -Wswitch-default
4180 Warn whenever a "switch" statement does not have a "default" case.
4181
4182 -Wswitch-enum
4183 Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type
4184 and lacks a "case" for one or more of the named codes of that
4185 enumeration. "case" labels outside the enumeration range also
4186 provoke warnings when this option is used. The only difference
4187 between -Wswitch and this option is that this option gives a
4188 warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a
4189 "default" label.
4190
4191 -Wswitch-bool
4192 Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of boolean type and
4193 the case values are outside the range of a boolean type. It is
4194 possible to suppress this warning by casting the controlling
4195 expression to a type other than "bool". For example:
4196
4197 switch ((int) (a == 4))
4198 {
4199 ...
4200 }
4201
4202 This warning is enabled by default for C and C++ programs.
4203
4204 -Wswitch-unreachable
4205 Warn whenever a "switch" statement contains statements between the
4206 controlling expression and the first case label, which will never
4207 be executed. For example:
4208
4209 switch (cond)
4210 {
4211 i = 15;
4212 ...
4213 case 5:
4214 ...
4215 }
4216
4217 -Wswitch-unreachable does not warn if the statement between the
4218 controlling expression and the first case label is just a
4219 declaration:
4220
4221 switch (cond)
4222 {
4223 int i;
4224 ...
4225 case 5:
4226 i = 5;
4227 ...
4228 }
4229
4230 This warning is enabled by default for C and C++ programs.
4231
4232 -Wsync-nand (C and C++ only)
4233 Warn when "__sync_fetch_and_nand" and "__sync_nand_and_fetch"
4234 built-in functions are used. These functions changed semantics in
4235 GCC 4.4.
4236
4237 -Wunused-but-set-parameter
4238 Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise
4239 unused (aside from its declaration).
4240
4241 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4242
4243 This warning is also enabled by -Wunused together with -Wextra.
4244
4245 -Wunused-but-set-variable
4246 Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused
4247 (aside from its declaration). This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4248
4249 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4250
4251 This warning is also enabled by -Wunused, which is enabled by
4252 -Wall.
4253
4254 -Wunused-function
4255 Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
4256 non-inline static function is unused. This warning is enabled by
4257 -Wall.
4258
4259 -Wunused-label
4260 Warn whenever a label is declared but not used. This warning is
4261 enabled by -Wall.
4262
4263 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4264
4265 -Wunused-local-typedefs (C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)
4266 Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.
4267 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4268
4269 -Wunused-parameter
4270 Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its
4271 declaration.
4272
4273 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4274
4275 -Wno-unused-result
4276 Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute
4277 "warn_unused_result" does not use its return value. The default is
4278 -Wunused-result.
4279
4280 -Wunused-variable
4281 Warn whenever a local or static variable is unused aside from its
4282 declaration. This option implies -Wunused-const-variable=1 for C,
4283 but not for C++. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4284
4285 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4286
4287 -Wunused-const-variable
4288 -Wunused-const-variable=n
4289 Warn whenever a constant static variable is unused aside from its
4290 declaration. -Wunused-const-variable=1 is enabled by
4291 -Wunused-variable for C, but not for C++. In C this declares
4292 variable storage, but in C++ this is not an error since const
4293 variables take the place of "#define"s.
4294
4295 To suppress this warning use the "unused" attribute.
4296
4297 -Wunused-const-variable=1
4298 This is the warning level that is enabled by -Wunused-variable
4299 for C. It warns only about unused static const variables
4300 defined in the main compilation unit, but not about static
4301 const variables declared in any header included.
4302
4303 -Wunused-const-variable=2
4304 This warning level also warns for unused constant static
4305 variables in headers (excluding system headers). This is the
4306 warning level of -Wunused-const-variable and must be explicitly
4307 requested since in C++ this isn't an error and in C it might be
4308 harder to clean up all headers included.
4309
4310 -Wunused-value
4311 Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not
4312 used. To suppress this warning cast the unused expression to
4313 "void". This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand side
4314 of a comma expression that contains no side effects. For example,
4315 an expression such as "x[i,j]" causes a warning, while
4316 "x[(void)i,j]" does not.
4317
4318 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4319
4320 -Wunused
4321 All the above -Wunused options combined.
4322
4323 In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you
4324 must either specify -Wextra -Wunused (note that -Wall implies
4325 -Wunused), or separately specify -Wunused-parameter.
4326
4327 -Wuninitialized
4328 Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being
4329 initialized or if a variable may be clobbered by a "setjmp" call.
4330 In C++, warn if a non-static reference or non-static "const" member
4331 appears in a class without constructors.
4332
4333 If you want to warn about code that uses the uninitialized value of
4334 the variable in its own initializer, use the -Winit-self option.
4335
4336 These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
4337 elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
4338 variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole. They do
4339 not occur for variables or elements declared "volatile". Because
4340 these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or
4341 elements for which there are warnings depends on the precise
4342 optimization options and version of GCC used.
4343
4344 Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used
4345 only to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
4346 computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the
4347 warnings are printed.
4348
4349 -Winvalid-memory-model
4350 Warn for invocations of __atomic Builtins, __sync Builtins, and the
4351 C11 atomic generic functions with a memory consistency argument
4352 that is either invalid for the operation or outside the range of
4353 values of the "memory_order" enumeration. For example, since the
4354 "__atomic_store" and "__atomic_store_n" built-ins are only defined
4355 for the relaxed, release, and sequentially consistent memory orders
4356 the following code is diagnosed:
4357
4358 void store (int *i)
4359 {
4360 __atomic_store_n (i, 0, memory_order_consume);
4361 }
4362
4363 -Winvalid-memory-model is enabled by default.
4364
4365 -Wmaybe-uninitialized
4366 For an automatic (i.e. local) variable, if there exists a path from
4367 the function entry to a use of the variable that is initialized,
4368 but there exist some other paths for which the variable is not
4369 initialized, the compiler emits a warning if it cannot prove the
4370 uninitialized paths are not executed at run time.
4371
4372 These warnings are only possible in optimizing compilation, because
4373 otherwise GCC does not keep track of the state of variables.
4374
4375 These warnings are made optional because GCC may not be able to
4376 determine when the code is correct in spite of appearing to have an
4377 error. Here is one example of how this can happen:
4378
4379 {
4380 int x;
4381 switch (y)
4382 {
4383 case 1: x = 1;
4384 break;
4385 case 2: x = 4;
4386 break;
4387 case 3: x = 5;
4388 }
4389 foo (x);
4390 }
4391
4392 If the value of "y" is always 1, 2 or 3, then "x" is always
4393 initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. To suppress the warning,
4394 you need to provide a default case with assert(0) or similar code.
4395
4396 This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might
4397 be changed by a call to "longjmp". The compiler sees only the
4398 calls to "setjmp". It cannot know where "longjmp" will be called;
4399 in fact, a signal handler could call it at any point in the code.
4400 As a result, you may get a warning even when there is in fact no
4401 problem because "longjmp" cannot in fact be called at the place
4402 that would cause a problem.
4403
4404 Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the
4405 functions you use that never return as "noreturn".
4406
4407 This warning is enabled by -Wall or -Wextra.
4408
4409 -Wunknown-pragmas
4410 Warn when a "#pragma" directive is encountered that is not
4411 understood by GCC. If this command-line option is used, warnings
4412 are even issued for unknown pragmas in system header files. This
4413 is not the case if the warnings are only enabled by the -Wall
4414 command-line option.
4415
4416 -Wno-pragmas
4417 Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
4418 invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas. See also
4419 -Wunknown-pragmas.
4420
4421 -Wno-prio-ctor-dtor
4422 Do not warn if a priority from 0 to 100 is used for constructor or
4423 destructor. The use of constructor and destructor attributes allow
4424 you to assign a priority to the constructor/destructor to control
4425 its order of execution before "main" is called or after it returns.
4426 The priority values must be greater than 100 as the compiler
4427 reserves priority values between 0--100 for the implementation.
4428
4429 -Wstrict-aliasing
4430 This option is only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active. It
4431 warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that
4432 the compiler is using for optimization. The warning does not catch
4433 all cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls. It
4434 is included in -Wall. It is equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=3
4435
4436 -Wstrict-aliasing=n
4437 This option is only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active. It
4438 warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that
4439 the compiler is using for optimization. Higher levels correspond
4440 to higher accuracy (fewer false positives). Higher levels also
4441 correspond to more effort, similar to the way -O works.
4442 -Wstrict-aliasing is equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=3.
4443
4444 Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate. Possibly useful
4445 when higher levels do not warn but -fstrict-aliasing still breaks
4446 the code, as it has very few false negatives. However, it has many
4447 false positives. Warns for all pointer conversions between
4448 possibly incompatible types, even if never dereferenced. Runs in
4449 the front end only.
4450
4451 Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise. May still have many
4452 false positives (not as many as level 1 though), and few false
4453 negatives (but possibly more than level 1). Unlike level 1, it
4454 only warns when an address is taken. Warns about incomplete types.
4455 Runs in the front end only.
4456
4457 Level 3 (default for -Wstrict-aliasing): Should have very few false
4458 positives and few false negatives. Slightly slower than levels 1
4459 or 2 when optimization is enabled. Takes care of the common
4460 pun+dereference pattern in the front end: "*(int*)&some_float". If
4461 optimization is enabled, it also runs in the back end, where it
4462 deals with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to
4463 information. Only warns when the converted pointer is
4464 dereferenced. Does not warn about incomplete types.
4465
4466 -Wstrict-overflow
4467 -Wstrict-overflow=n
4468 This option is only active when signed overflow is undefined. It
4469 warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
4470 assumption that signed overflow does not occur. Note that it does
4471 not warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only
4472 warns about cases where the compiler implements some optimization.
4473 Thus this warning depends on the optimization level.
4474
4475 An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
4476 perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such
4477 that overflow never does, in fact, occur. Therefore this warning
4478 can easily give a false positive: a warning about code that is not
4479 actually a problem. To help focus on important issues, several
4480 warning levels are defined. No warnings are issued for the use of
4481 undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a
4482 loop requires, in particular when determining whether a loop will
4483 be executed at all.
4484
4485 -Wstrict-overflow=1
4486 Warn about cases that are both questionable and easy to avoid.
4487 For example the compiler simplifies "x + 1 > x" to 1. This
4488 level of -Wstrict-overflow is enabled by -Wall; higher levels
4489 are not, and must be explicitly requested.
4490
4491 -Wstrict-overflow=2
4492 Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to
4493 a constant. For example: "abs (x) >= 0". This can only be
4494 simplified when signed integer overflow is undefined, because
4495 "abs (INT_MIN)" overflows to "INT_MIN", which is less than
4496 zero. -Wstrict-overflow (with no level) is the same as
4497 -Wstrict-overflow=2.
4498
4499 -Wstrict-overflow=3
4500 Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.
4501 For example: "x + 1 > 1" is simplified to "x > 0".
4502
4503 -Wstrict-overflow=4
4504 Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above
4505 cases. For example: "(x * 10) / 5" is simplified to "x * 2".
4506
4507 -Wstrict-overflow=5
4508 Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude
4509 of a constant involved in a comparison. For example: "x + 2 >
4510 y" is simplified to "x + 1 >= y". This is reported only at the
4511 highest warning level because this simplification applies to
4512 many comparisons, so this warning level gives a very large
4513 number of false positives.
4514
4515 -Wstringop-overflow
4516 -Wstringop-overflow=type
4517 Warn for calls to string manipulation functions such as "memcpy"
4518 and "strcpy" that are determined to overflow the destination
4519 buffer. The optional argument is one greater than the type of
4520 Object Size Checking to perform to determine the size of the
4521 destination. The argument is meaningful only for functions that
4522 operate on character arrays but not for raw memory functions like
4523 "memcpy" which always make use of Object Size type-0. The option
4524 also warns for calls that specify a size in excess of the largest
4525 possible object or at most "SIZE_MAX / 2" bytes. The option
4526 produces the best results with optimization enabled but can detect
4527 a small subset of simple buffer overflows even without optimization
4528 in calls to the GCC built-in functions like "__builtin_memcpy" that
4529 correspond to the standard functions. In any case, the option
4530 warns about just a subset of buffer overflows detected by the
4531 corresponding overflow checking built-ins. For example, the option
4532 will issue a warning for the "strcpy" call below because it copies
4533 at least 5 characters (the string "blue" including the terminating
4534 NUL) into the buffer of size 4.
4535
4536 enum Color { blue, purple, yellow };
4537 const char* f (enum Color clr)
4538 {
4539 static char buf [4];
4540 const char *str;
4541 switch (clr)
4542 {
4543 case blue: str = "blue"; break;
4544 case purple: str = "purple"; break;
4545 case yellow: str = "yellow"; break;
4546 }
4547
4548 return strcpy (buf, str); // warning here
4549 }
4550
4551 Option -Wstringop-overflow=2 is enabled by default.
4552
4553 -Wstringop-overflow
4554 -Wstringop-overflow=1
4555 The -Wstringop-overflow=1 option uses type-zero Object Size
4556 Checking to determine the sizes of destination objects. This
4557 is the default setting of the option. At this setting the
4558 option will not warn for writes past the end of subobjects of
4559 larger objects accessed by pointers unless the size of the
4560 largest surrounding object is known. When the destination may
4561 be one of several objects it is assumed to be the largest one
4562 of them. On Linux systems, when optimization is enabled at
4563 this setting the option warns for the same code as when the
4564 "_FORTIFY_SOURCE" macro is defined to a non-zero value.
4565
4566 -Wstringop-overflow=2
4567 The -Wstringop-overflow=2 option uses type-one Object Size
4568 Checking to determine the sizes of destination objects. At
4569 this setting the option will warn about overflows when writing
4570 to members of the largest complete objects whose exact size is
4571 known. It will, however, not warn for excessive writes to the
4572 same members of unknown objects referenced by pointers since
4573 they may point to arrays containing unknown numbers of
4574 elements.
4575
4576 -Wstringop-overflow=3
4577 The -Wstringop-overflow=3 option uses type-two Object Size
4578 Checking to determine the sizes of destination objects. At
4579 this setting the option warns about overflowing the smallest
4580 object or data member. This is the most restrictive setting of
4581 the option that may result in warnings for safe code.
4582
4583 -Wstringop-overflow=4
4584 The -Wstringop-overflow=4 option uses type-three Object Size
4585 Checking to determine the sizes of destination objects. At
4586 this setting the option will warn about overflowing any data
4587 members, and when the destination is one of several objects it
4588 uses the size of the largest of them to decide whether to issue
4589 a warning. Similarly to -Wstringop-overflow=3 this setting of
4590 the option may result in warnings for benign code.
4591
4592 -Wstringop-truncation
4593 Warn for calls to bounded string manipulation functions such as
4594 "strncat", "strncpy", and "stpncpy" that may either truncate the
4595 copied string or leave the destination unchanged.
4596
4597 In the following example, the call to "strncat" specifies a bound
4598 that is less than the length of the source string. As a result,
4599 the copy of the source will be truncated and so the call is
4600 diagnosed. To avoid the warning use "bufsize - strlen (buf) - 1)"
4601 as the bound.
4602
4603 void append (char *buf, size_t bufsize)
4604 {
4605 strncat (buf, ".txt", 3);
4606 }
4607
4608 As another example, the following call to "strncpy" results in
4609 copying to "d" just the characters preceding the terminating NUL,
4610 without appending the NUL to the end. Assuming the result of
4611 "strncpy" is necessarily a NUL-terminated string is a common
4612 mistake, and so the call is diagnosed. To avoid the warning when
4613 the result is not expected to be NUL-terminated, call "memcpy"
4614 instead.
4615
4616 void copy (char *d, const char *s)
4617 {
4618 strncpy (d, s, strlen (s));
4619 }
4620
4621 In the following example, the call to "strncpy" specifies the size
4622 of the destination buffer as the bound. If the length of the
4623 source string is equal to or greater than this size the result of
4624 the copy will not be NUL-terminated. Therefore, the call is also
4625 diagnosed. To avoid the warning, specify "sizeof buf - 1" as the
4626 bound and set the last element of the buffer to "NUL".
4627
4628 void copy (const char *s)
4629 {
4630 char buf[80];
4631 strncpy (buf, s, sizeof buf);
4632 ...
4633 }
4634
4635 In situations where a character array is intended to store a
4636 sequence of bytes with no terminating "NUL" such an array may be
4637 annotated with attribute "nonstring" to avoid this warning. Such
4638 arrays, however, are not suitable arguments to functions that
4639 expect "NUL"-terminated strings. To help detect accidental misuses
4640 of such arrays GCC issues warnings unless it can prove that the use
4641 is safe.
4642
4643 -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn|format|cold|malloc]
4644 Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The
4645 attributes currently supported are listed below.
4646
4647 -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
4648 -Wsuggest-attribute=const
4649 -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
4650 -Wmissing-noreturn
4651 -Wsuggest-attribute=malloc
4652 Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes
4653 "pure", "const" or "noreturn" or "malloc". The compiler only
4654 warns for functions visible in other compilation units or (in
4655 the case of "pure" and "const") if it cannot prove that the
4656 function returns normally. A function returns normally if it
4657 doesn't contain an infinite loop or return abnormally by
4658 throwing, calling "abort" or trapping. This analysis requires
4659 option -fipa-pure-const, which is enabled by default at -O and
4660 higher. Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the
4661 analysis.
4662
4663 -Wsuggest-attribute=format
4664 -Wmissing-format-attribute
4665 Warn about function pointers that might be candidates for
4666 "format" attributes. Note these are only possible candidates,
4667 not absolute ones. GCC guesses that function pointers with
4668 "format" attributes that are used in assignment,
4669 initialization, parameter passing or return statements should
4670 have a corresponding "format" attribute in the resulting type.
4671 I.e. the left-hand side of the assignment or initialization,
4672 the type of the parameter variable, or the return type of the
4673 containing function respectively should also have a "format"
4674 attribute to avoid the warning.
4675
4676 GCC also warns about function definitions that might be
4677 candidates for "format" attributes. Again, these are only
4678 possible candidates. GCC guesses that "format" attributes
4679 might be appropriate for any function that calls a function
4680 like "vprintf" or "vscanf", but this might not always be the
4681 case, and some functions for which "format" attributes are
4682 appropriate may not be detected.
4683
4684 -Wsuggest-attribute=cold
4685 Warn about functions that might be candidates for "cold"
4686 attribute. This is based on static detection and generally
4687 will only warn about functions which always leads to a call to
4688 another "cold" function such as wrappers of C++ "throw" or
4689 fatal error reporting functions leading to "abort".
4690
4691 -Wsuggest-final-types
4692 Warn about types with virtual methods where code quality would be
4693 improved if the type were declared with the C++11 "final"
4694 specifier, or, if possible, declared in an anonymous namespace.
4695 This allows GCC to more aggressively devirtualize the polymorphic
4696 calls. This warning is more effective with link time optimization,
4697 where the information about the class hierarchy graph is more
4698 complete.
4699
4700 -Wsuggest-final-methods
4701 Warn about virtual methods where code quality would be improved if
4702 the method were declared with the C++11 "final" specifier, or, if
4703 possible, its type were declared in an anonymous namespace or with
4704 the "final" specifier. This warning is more effective with link-
4705 time optimization, where the information about the class hierarchy
4706 graph is more complete. It is recommended to first consider
4707 suggestions of -Wsuggest-final-types and then rebuild with new
4708 annotations.
4709
4710 -Wsuggest-override
4711 Warn about overriding virtual functions that are not marked with
4712 the override keyword.
4713
4714 -Walloc-zero
4715 Warn about calls to allocation functions decorated with attribute
4716 "alloc_size" that specify zero bytes, including those to the built-
4717 in forms of the functions "aligned_alloc", "alloca", "calloc",
4718 "malloc", and "realloc". Because the behavior of these functions
4719 when called with a zero size differs among implementations (and in
4720 the case of "realloc" has been deprecated) relying on it may result
4721 in subtle portability bugs and should be avoided.
4722
4723 -Walloc-size-larger-than=byte-size
4724 Warn about calls to functions decorated with attribute "alloc_size"
4725 that attempt to allocate objects larger than the specified number
4726 of bytes, or where the result of the size computation in an integer
4727 type with infinite precision would exceed the value of PTRDIFF_MAX
4728 on the target. -Walloc-size-larger-than=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by
4729 default. Warnings controlled by the option can be disabled either
4730 by specifying byte-size of SIZE_MAX or more or by
4731 -Wno-alloc-size-larger-than.
4732
4733 -Wno-alloc-size-larger-than
4734 Disable -Walloc-size-larger-than= warnings. The option is
4735 equivalent to -Walloc-size-larger-than=SIZE_MAX or larger.
4736
4737 -Walloca
4738 This option warns on all uses of "alloca" in the source.
4739
4740 -Walloca-larger-than=byte-size
4741 This option warns on calls to "alloca" with an integer argument
4742 whose value is either zero, or that is not bounded by a controlling
4743 predicate that limits its value to at most byte-size. It also
4744 warns for calls to "alloca" where the bound value is unknown.
4745 Arguments of non-integer types are considered unbounded even if
4746 they appear to be constrained to the expected range.
4747
4748 For example, a bounded case of "alloca" could be:
4749
4750 void func (size_t n)
4751 {
4752 void *p;
4753 if (n <= 1000)
4754 p = alloca (n);
4755 else
4756 p = malloc (n);
4757 f (p);
4758 }
4759
4760 In the above example, passing "-Walloca-larger-than=1000" would not
4761 issue a warning because the call to "alloca" is known to be at most
4762 1000 bytes. However, if "-Walloca-larger-than=500" were passed,
4763 the compiler would emit a warning.
4764
4765 Unbounded uses, on the other hand, are uses of "alloca" with no
4766 controlling predicate constraining its integer argument. For
4767 example:
4768
4769 void func ()
4770 {
4771 void *p = alloca (n);
4772 f (p);
4773 }
4774
4775 If "-Walloca-larger-than=500" were passed, the above would trigger
4776 a warning, but this time because of the lack of bounds checking.
4777
4778 Note, that even seemingly correct code involving signed integers
4779 could cause a warning:
4780
4781 void func (signed int n)
4782 {
4783 if (n < 500)
4784 {
4785 p = alloca (n);
4786 f (p);
4787 }
4788 }
4789
4790 In the above example, n could be negative, causing a larger than
4791 expected argument to be implicitly cast into the "alloca" call.
4792
4793 This option also warns when "alloca" is used in a loop.
4794
4795 -Walloca-larger-than=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by default but is
4796 usually only effective when -ftree-vrp is active (default for -O2
4797 and above).
4798
4799 See also -Wvla-larger-than=byte-size.
4800
4801 -Wno-alloca-larger-than
4802 Disable -Walloca-larger-than= warnings. The option is equivalent
4803 to -Walloca-larger-than=SIZE_MAX or larger.
4804
4805 -Warray-bounds
4806 -Warray-bounds=n
4807 This option is only active when -ftree-vrp is active (default for
4808 -O2 and above). It warns about subscripts to arrays that are always
4809 out of bounds. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4810
4811 -Warray-bounds=1
4812 This is the warning level of -Warray-bounds and is enabled by
4813 -Wall; higher levels are not, and must be explicitly requested.
4814
4815 -Warray-bounds=2
4816 This warning level also warns about out of bounds access for
4817 arrays at the end of a struct and for arrays accessed through
4818 pointers. This warning level may give a larger number of false
4819 positives and is deactivated by default.
4820
4821 -Wattribute-alias=n
4822 -Wno-attribute-alias
4823 Warn about declarations using the "alias" and similar attributes
4824 whose target is incompatible with the type of the alias.
4825
4826 -Wattribute-alias=1
4827 The default warning level of the -Wattribute-alias option
4828 diagnoses incompatibilities between the type of the alias
4829 declaration and that of its target. Such incompatibilities are
4830 typically indicative of bugs.
4831
4832 -Wattribute-alias=2
4833 At this level -Wattribute-alias also diagnoses cases where the
4834 attributes of the alias declaration are more restrictive than
4835 the attributes applied to its target. These mismatches can
4836 potentially result in incorrect code generation. In other
4837 cases they may be benign and could be resolved simply by adding
4838 the missing attribute to the target. For comparison, see the
4839 -Wmissing-attributes option, which controls diagnostics when
4840 the alias declaration is less restrictive than the target,
4841 rather than more restrictive.
4842
4843 Attributes considered include "alloc_align", "alloc_size",
4844 "cold", "const", "hot", "leaf", "malloc", "nonnull",
4845 "noreturn", "nothrow", "pure", "returns_nonnull", and
4846 "returns_twice".
4847
4848 -Wattribute-alias is equivalent to -Wattribute-alias=1. This is
4849 the default. You can disable these warnings with either
4850 -Wno-attribute-alias or -Wattribute-alias=0.
4851
4852 -Wbool-compare
4853 Warn about boolean expression compared with an integer value
4854 different from "true"/"false". For instance, the following
4855 comparison is always false:
4856
4857 int n = 5;
4858 ...
4859 if ((n > 1) == 2) { ... }
4860
4861 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4862
4863 -Wbool-operation
4864 Warn about suspicious operations on expressions of a boolean type.
4865 For instance, bitwise negation of a boolean is very likely a bug in
4866 the program. For C, this warning also warns about incrementing or
4867 decrementing a boolean, which rarely makes sense. (In C++,
4868 decrementing a boolean is always invalid. Incrementing a boolean
4869 is invalid in C++17, and deprecated otherwise.)
4870
4871 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4872
4873 -Wduplicated-branches
4874 Warn when an if-else has identical branches. This warning detects
4875 cases like
4876
4877 if (p != NULL)
4878 return 0;
4879 else
4880 return 0;
4881
4882 It doesn't warn when both branches contain just a null statement.
4883 This warning also warn for conditional operators:
4884
4885 int i = x ? *p : *p;
4886
4887 -Wduplicated-cond
4888 Warn about duplicated conditions in an if-else-if chain. For
4889 instance, warn for the following code:
4890
4891 if (p->q != NULL) { ... }
4892 else if (p->q != NULL) { ... }
4893
4894 -Wframe-address
4895 Warn when the __builtin_frame_address or __builtin_return_address
4896 is called with an argument greater than 0. Such calls may return
4897 indeterminate values or crash the program. The warning is included
4898 in -Wall.
4899
4900 -Wno-discarded-qualifiers (C and Objective-C only)
4901 Do not warn if type qualifiers on pointers are being discarded.
4902 Typically, the compiler warns if a "const char *" variable is
4903 passed to a function that takes a "char *" parameter. This option
4904 can be used to suppress such a warning.
4905
4906 -Wno-discarded-array-qualifiers (C and Objective-C only)
4907 Do not warn if type qualifiers on arrays which are pointer targets
4908 are being discarded. Typically, the compiler warns if a "const int
4909 (*)[]" variable is passed to a function that takes a "int (*)[]"
4910 parameter. This option can be used to suppress such a warning.
4911
4912 -Wno-incompatible-pointer-types (C and Objective-C only)
4913 Do not warn when there is a conversion between pointers that have
4914 incompatible types. This warning is for cases not covered by
4915 -Wno-pointer-sign, which warns for pointer argument passing or
4916 assignment with different signedness.
4917
4918 -Wno-int-conversion (C and Objective-C only)
4919 Do not warn about incompatible integer to pointer and pointer to
4920 integer conversions. This warning is about implicit conversions;
4921 for explicit conversions the warnings -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast and
4922 -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast may be used.
4923
4924 -Wno-div-by-zero
4925 Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero. Floating-
4926 point division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a
4927 legitimate way of obtaining infinities and NaNs.
4928
4929 -Wsystem-headers
4930 Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
4931 Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the
4932 assumption that they usually do not indicate real problems and
4933 would only make the compiler output harder to read. Using this
4934 command-line option tells GCC to emit warnings from system headers
4935 as if they occurred in user code. However, note that using -Wall
4936 in conjunction with this option does not warn about unknown pragmas
4937 in system headers---for that, -Wunknown-pragmas must also be used.
4938
4939 -Wtautological-compare
4940 Warn if a self-comparison always evaluates to true or false. This
4941 warning detects various mistakes such as:
4942
4943 int i = 1;
4944 ...
4945 if (i > i) { ... }
4946
4947 This warning also warns about bitwise comparisons that always
4948 evaluate to true or false, for instance:
4949
4950 if ((a & 16) == 10) { ... }
4951
4952 will always be false.
4953
4954 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
4955
4956 -Wtrampolines
4957 Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.
4958 A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at
4959 run time on the stack when the address of a nested function is
4960 taken, and is used to call the nested function indirectly. For
4961 some targets, it is made up of data only and thus requires no
4962 special treatment. But, for most targets, it is made up of code
4963 and thus requires the stack to be made executable in order for the
4964 program to work properly.
4965
4966 -Wfloat-equal
4967 Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.
4968
4969 The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
4970 programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
4971 infinitely precise real numbers. If you are doing this, then you
4972 need to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the
4973 maximum or likely maximum error that the computation introduces,
4974 and allow for it when performing comparisons (and when producing
4975 output, but that's a different problem). In particular, instead of
4976 testing for equality, you should check to see whether the two
4977 values have ranges that overlap; and this is done with the
4978 relational operators, so equality comparisons are probably
4979 mistaken.
4980
4981 -Wtraditional (C and Objective-C only)
4982 Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in
4983 traditional and ISO C. Also warn about ISO C constructs that have
4984 no traditional C equivalent, and/or problematic constructs that
4985 should be avoided.
4986
4987 * Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the
4988 macro body. In traditional C macro replacement takes place
4989 within string literals, but in ISO C it does not.
4990
4991 * In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
4992 Traditional preprocessors only considered a line to be a
4993 directive if the # appeared in column 1 on the line. Therefore
4994 -Wtraditional warns about directives that traditional C
4995 understands but ignores because the # does not appear as the
4996 first character on the line. It also suggests you hide
4997 directives like "#pragma" not understood by traditional C by
4998 indenting them. Some traditional implementations do not
4999 recognize "#elif", so this option suggests avoiding it
5000 altogether.
5001
5002 * A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
5003
5004 * The unary plus operator.
5005
5006 * The U integer constant suffix, or the F or L floating-point
5007 constant suffixes. (Traditional C does support the L suffix on
5008 integer constants.) Note, these suffixes appear in macros
5009 defined in the system headers of most modern systems, e.g. the
5010 _MIN/_MAX macros in "<limits.h>". Use of these macros in user
5011 code might normally lead to spurious warnings, however GCC's
5012 integrated preprocessor has enough context to avoid warning in
5013 these cases.
5014
5015 * A function declared external in one block and then used after
5016 the end of the block.
5017
5018 * A "switch" statement has an operand of type "long".
5019
5020 * A non-"static" function declaration follows a "static" one.
5021 This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
5022
5023 * The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
5024 signedness from its traditional type. This warning is only
5025 issued if the base of the constant is ten. I.e. hexadecimal or
5026 octal values, which typically represent bit patterns, are not
5027 warned about.
5028
5029 * Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
5030
5031 * Initialization of automatic aggregates.
5032
5033 * Identifier conflicts with labels. Traditional C lacks a
5034 separate namespace for labels.
5035
5036 * Initialization of unions. If the initializer is zero, the
5037 warning is omitted. This is done under the assumption that the
5038 zero initializer in user code appears conditioned on e.g.
5039 "__STDC__" to avoid missing initializer warnings and relies on
5040 default initialization to zero in the traditional C case.
5041
5042 * Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values
5043 and vice versa. The absence of these prototypes when compiling
5044 with traditional C causes serious problems. This is a subset
5045 of the possible conversion warnings; for the full set use
5046 -Wtraditional-conversion.
5047
5048 * Use of ISO C style function definitions. This warning
5049 intentionally is not issued for prototype declarations or
5050 variadic functions because these ISO C features appear in your
5051 code when using libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros,
5052 "PARAMS" and "VPARAMS". This warning is also bypassed for
5053 nested functions because that feature is already a GCC
5054 extension and thus not relevant to traditional C compatibility.
5055
5056 -Wtraditional-conversion (C and Objective-C only)
5057 Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from
5058 what would happen to the same argument in the absence of a
5059 prototype. This includes conversions of fixed point to floating
5060 and vice versa, and conversions changing the width or signedness of
5061 a fixed-point argument except when the same as the default
5062 promotion.
5063
5064 -Wdeclaration-after-statement (C and Objective-C only)
5065 Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.
5066 This construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is
5067 by default allowed in GCC. It is not supported by ISO C90.
5068
5069 -Wshadow
5070 Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows another
5071 variable, parameter, type, class member (in C++), or instance
5072 variable (in Objective-C) or whenever a built-in function is
5073 shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler warns if a local variable
5074 shadows an explicit typedef, but not if it shadows a
5075 struct/class/enum. Same as -Wshadow=global.
5076
5077 -Wno-shadow-ivar (Objective-C only)
5078 Do not warn whenever a local variable shadows an instance variable
5079 in an Objective-C method.
5080
5081 -Wshadow=global
5082 The default for -Wshadow. Warns for any (global) shadowing.
5083
5084 -Wshadow=local
5085 Warn when a local variable shadows another local variable or
5086 parameter. This warning is enabled by -Wshadow=global.
5087
5088 -Wshadow=compatible-local
5089 Warn when a local variable shadows another local variable or
5090 parameter whose type is compatible with that of the shadowing
5091 variable. In C++, type compatibility here means the type of the
5092 shadowing variable can be converted to that of the shadowed
5093 variable. The creation of this flag (in addition to -Wshadow=local)
5094 is based on the idea that when a local variable shadows another one
5095 of incompatible type, it is most likely intentional, not a bug or
5096 typo, as shown in the following example:
5097
5098 for (SomeIterator i = SomeObj.begin(); i != SomeObj.end(); ++i)
5099 {
5100 for (int i = 0; i < N; ++i)
5101 {
5102 ...
5103 }
5104 ...
5105 }
5106
5107 Since the two variable "i" in the example above have incompatible
5108 types, enabling only -Wshadow=compatible-local will not emit a
5109 warning. Because their types are incompatible, if a programmer
5110 accidentally uses one in place of the other, type checking will
5111 catch that and emit an error or warning. So not warning (about
5112 shadowing) in this case will not lead to undetected bugs. Use of
5113 this flag instead of -Wshadow=local can possibly reduce the number
5114 of warnings triggered by intentional shadowing.
5115
5116 This warning is enabled by -Wshadow=local.
5117
5118 -Wlarger-than=byte-size
5119 Warn whenever an object is defined whose size exceeds byte-size.
5120 -Wlarger-than=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by default. Warnings
5121 controlled by the option can be disabled either by specifying byte-
5122 size of SIZE_MAX or more or by -Wno-larger-than.
5123
5124 -Wno-larger-than
5125 Disable -Wlarger-than= warnings. The option is equivalent to
5126 -Wlarger-than=SIZE_MAX or larger.
5127
5128 -Wframe-larger-than=byte-size
5129 Warn if the size of a function frame exceeds byte-size. The
5130 computation done to determine the stack frame size is approximate
5131 and not conservative. The actual requirements may be somewhat
5132 greater than byte-size even if you do not get a warning. In
5133 addition, any space allocated via "alloca", variable-length arrays,
5134 or related constructs is not included by the compiler when
5135 determining whether or not to issue a warning.
5136 -Wframe-larger-than=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by default. Warnings
5137 controlled by the option can be disabled either by specifying byte-
5138 size of SIZE_MAX or more or by -Wno-frame-larger-than.
5139
5140 -Wno-frame-larger-than
5141 Disable -Wframe-larger-than= warnings. The option is equivalent to
5142 -Wframe-larger-than=SIZE_MAX or larger.
5143
5144 -Wno-free-nonheap-object
5145 Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not
5146 allocated on the heap.
5147
5148 -Wstack-usage=byte-size
5149 Warn if the stack usage of a function might exceed byte-size. The
5150 computation done to determine the stack usage is conservative. Any
5151 space allocated via "alloca", variable-length arrays, or related
5152 constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or
5153 not to issue a warning.
5154
5155 The message is in keeping with the output of -fstack-usage.
5156
5157 * If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified
5158 amount, it's:
5159
5160 warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes
5161
5162 * If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:
5163
5164 warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes
5165
5166 * If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:
5167
5168 warning: stack usage might be unbounded
5169
5170 -Wstack-usage=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by default. Warnings
5171 controlled by the option can be disabled either by specifying byte-
5172 size of SIZE_MAX or more or by -Wno-stack-usage.
5173
5174 -Wno-stack-usage
5175 Disable -Wstack-usage= warnings. The option is equivalent to
5176 -Wstack-usage=SIZE_MAX or larger.
5177
5178 -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
5179 Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler cannot
5180 assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices. With
5181 -funsafe-loop-optimizations warn if the compiler makes such
5182 assumptions.
5183
5184 -Wno-pedantic-ms-format (MinGW targets only)
5185 When used in combination with -Wformat and -pedantic without GNU
5186 extensions, this option disables the warnings about non-ISO
5187 "printf" / "scanf" format width specifiers "I32", "I64", and "I"
5188 used on Windows targets, which depend on the MS runtime.
5189
5190 -Waligned-new
5191 Warn about a new-expression of a type that requires greater
5192 alignment than the "alignof(std::max_align_t)" but uses an
5193 allocation function without an explicit alignment parameter. This
5194 option is enabled by -Wall.
5195
5196 Normally this only warns about global allocation functions, but
5197 -Waligned-new=all also warns about class member allocation
5198 functions.
5199
5200 -Wplacement-new
5201 -Wplacement-new=n
5202 Warn about placement new expressions with undefined behavior, such
5203 as constructing an object in a buffer that is smaller than the type
5204 of the object. For example, the placement new expression below is
5205 diagnosed because it attempts to construct an array of 64 integers
5206 in a buffer only 64 bytes large.
5207
5208 char buf [64];
5209 new (buf) int[64];
5210
5211 This warning is enabled by default.
5212
5213 -Wplacement-new=1
5214 This is the default warning level of -Wplacement-new. At this
5215 level the warning is not issued for some strictly undefined
5216 constructs that GCC allows as extensions for compatibility with
5217 legacy code. For example, the following "new" expression is
5218 not diagnosed at this level even though it has undefined
5219 behavior according to the C++ standard because it writes past
5220 the end of the one-element array.
5221
5222 struct S { int n, a[1]; };
5223 S *s = (S *)malloc (sizeof *s + 31 * sizeof s->a[0]);
5224 new (s->a)int [32]();
5225
5226 -Wplacement-new=2
5227 At this level, in addition to diagnosing all the same
5228 constructs as at level 1, a diagnostic is also issued for
5229 placement new expressions that construct an object in the last
5230 member of structure whose type is an array of a single element
5231 and whose size is less than the size of the object being
5232 constructed. While the previous example would be diagnosed,
5233 the following construct makes use of the flexible member array
5234 extension to avoid the warning at level 2.
5235
5236 struct S { int n, a[]; };
5237 S *s = (S *)malloc (sizeof *s + 32 * sizeof s->a[0]);
5238 new (s->a)int [32]();
5239
5240 -Wpointer-arith
5241 Warn about anything that depends on the "size of" a function type
5242 or of "void". GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
5243 convenience in calculations with "void *" pointers and pointers to
5244 functions. In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves
5245 "NULL". This warning is also enabled by -Wpedantic.
5246
5247 -Wpointer-compare
5248 Warn if a pointer is compared with a zero character constant. This
5249 usually means that the pointer was meant to be dereferenced. For
5250 example:
5251
5252 const char *p = foo ();
5253 if (p == '\0')
5254 return 42;
5255
5256 Note that the code above is invalid in C++11.
5257
5258 This warning is enabled by default.
5259
5260 -Wtype-limits
5261 Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the
5262 limited range of the data type, but do not warn for constant
5263 expressions. For example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared
5264 against zero with "<" or ">=". This warning is also enabled by
5265 -Wextra.
5266
5267 -Wabsolute-value (C and Objective-C only)
5268 Warn for calls to standard functions that compute the absolute
5269 value of an argument when a more appropriate standard function is
5270 available. For example, calling "abs(3.14)" triggers the warning
5271 because the appropriate function to call to compute the absolute
5272 value of a double argument is "fabs". The option also triggers
5273 warnings when the argument in a call to such a function has an
5274 unsigned type. This warning can be suppressed with an explicit
5275 type cast and it is also enabled by -Wextra.
5276
5277 -Wcomment
5278 -Wcomments
5279 Warn whenever a comment-start sequence /* appears in a /* comment,
5280 or whenever a backslash-newline appears in a // comment. This
5281 warning is enabled by -Wall.
5282
5283 -Wtrigraphs
5284 Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning
5285 of the program. Trigraphs within comments are not warned about,
5286 except those that would form escaped newlines.
5287
5288 This option is implied by -Wall. If -Wall is not given, this
5289 option is still enabled unless trigraphs are enabled. To get
5290 trigraph conversion without warnings, but get the other -Wall
5291 warnings, use -trigraphs -Wall -Wno-trigraphs.
5292
5293 -Wundef
5294 Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an "#if" directive.
5295 Such identifiers are replaced with zero.
5296
5297 -Wexpansion-to-defined
5298 Warn whenever defined is encountered in the expansion of a macro
5299 (including the case where the macro is expanded by an #if
5300 directive). Such usage is not portable. This warning is also
5301 enabled by -Wpedantic and -Wextra.
5302
5303 -Wunused-macros
5304 Warn about macros defined in the main file that are unused. A
5305 macro is used if it is expanded or tested for existence at least
5306 once. The preprocessor also warns if the macro has not been used
5307 at the time it is redefined or undefined.
5308
5309 Built-in macros, macros defined on the command line, and macros
5310 defined in include files are not warned about.
5311
5312 Note: If a macro is actually used, but only used in skipped
5313 conditional blocks, then the preprocessor reports it as unused. To
5314 avoid the warning in such a case, you might improve the scope of
5315 the macro's definition by, for example, moving it into the first
5316 skipped block. Alternatively, you could provide a dummy use with
5317 something like:
5318
5319 #if defined the_macro_causing_the_warning
5320 #endif
5321
5322 -Wno-endif-labels
5323 Do not warn whenever an "#else" or an "#endif" are followed by
5324 text. This sometimes happens in older programs with code of the
5325 form
5326
5327 #if FOO
5328 ...
5329 #else FOO
5330 ...
5331 #endif FOO
5332
5333 The second and third "FOO" should be in comments. This warning is
5334 on by default.
5335
5336 -Wbad-function-cast (C and Objective-C only)
5337 Warn when a function call is cast to a non-matching type. For
5338 example, warn if a call to a function returning an integer type is
5339 cast to a pointer type.
5340
5341 -Wc90-c99-compat (C and Objective-C only)
5342 Warn about features not present in ISO C90, but present in ISO C99.
5343 For instance, warn about use of variable length arrays, "long long"
5344 type, "bool" type, compound literals, designated initializers, and
5345 so on. This option is independent of the standards mode. Warnings
5346 are disabled in the expression that follows "__extension__".
5347
5348 -Wc99-c11-compat (C and Objective-C only)
5349 Warn about features not present in ISO C99, but present in ISO C11.
5350 For instance, warn about use of anonymous structures and unions,
5351 "_Atomic" type qualifier, "_Thread_local" storage-class specifier,
5352 "_Alignas" specifier, "Alignof" operator, "_Generic" keyword, and
5353 so on. This option is independent of the standards mode. Warnings
5354 are disabled in the expression that follows "__extension__".
5355
5356 -Wc++-compat (C and Objective-C only)
5357 Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset
5358 of ISO C and ISO C++, e.g. request for implicit conversion from
5359 "void *" to a pointer to non-"void" type.
5360
5361 -Wc++11-compat (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5362 Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++
5363 1998 and ISO C++ 2011, e.g., identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are
5364 keywords in ISO C++ 2011. This warning turns on -Wnarrowing and is
5365 enabled by -Wall.
5366
5367 -Wc++14-compat (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5368 Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++
5369 2011 and ISO C++ 2014. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
5370
5371 -Wc++17-compat (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5372 Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++
5373 2014 and ISO C++ 2017. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
5374
5375 -Wcast-qual
5376 Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier
5377 from the target type. For example, warn if a "const char *" is
5378 cast to an ordinary "char *".
5379
5380 Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an
5381 unsafe way. For example, casting "char **" to "const char **" is
5382 unsafe, as in this example:
5383
5384 /* p is char ** value. */
5385 const char **q = (const char **) p;
5386 /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK. */
5387 *q = "string";
5388 /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory. */
5389 **p = 'b';
5390
5391 -Wcast-align
5392 Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of
5393 the target is increased. For example, warn if a "char *" is cast
5394 to an "int *" on machines where integers can only be accessed at
5395 two- or four-byte boundaries.
5396
5397 -Wcast-align=strict
5398 Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of
5399 the target is increased. For example, warn if a "char *" is cast
5400 to an "int *" regardless of the target machine.
5401
5402 -Wcast-function-type
5403 Warn when a function pointer is cast to an incompatible function
5404 pointer. In a cast involving function types with a variable
5405 argument list only the types of initial arguments that are provided
5406 are considered. Any parameter of pointer-type matches any other
5407 pointer-type. Any benign differences in integral types are
5408 ignored, like "int" vs. "long" on ILP32 targets. Likewise type
5409 qualifiers are ignored. The function type "void (*) (void)" is
5410 special and matches everything, which can be used to suppress this
5411 warning. In a cast involving pointer to member types this warning
5412 warns whenever the type cast is changing the pointer to member
5413 type. This warning is enabled by -Wextra.
5414
5415 -Wwrite-strings
5416 When compiling C, give string constants the type "const
5417 char[length]" so that copying the address of one into a non-"const"
5418 "char *" pointer produces a warning. These warnings help you find
5419 at compile time code that can try to write into a string constant,
5420 but only if you have been very careful about using "const" in
5421 declarations and prototypes. Otherwise, it is just a nuisance.
5422 This is why we did not make -Wall request these warnings.
5423
5424 When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from
5425 string literals to "char *". This warning is enabled by default
5426 for C++ programs.
5427
5428 -Wcatch-value
5429 -Wcatch-value=n (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5430 Warn about catch handlers that do not catch via reference. With
5431 -Wcatch-value=1 (or -Wcatch-value for short) warn about polymorphic
5432 class types that are caught by value. With -Wcatch-value=2 warn
5433 about all class types that are caught by value. With
5434 -Wcatch-value=3 warn about all types that are not caught by
5435 reference. -Wcatch-value is enabled by -Wall.
5436
5437 -Wclobbered
5438 Warn for variables that might be changed by "longjmp" or "vfork".
5439 This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.
5440
5441 -Wconditionally-supported (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5442 Warn for conditionally-supported (C++11 [intro.defs]) constructs.
5443
5444 -Wconversion
5445 Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This includes
5446 conversions between real and integer, like "abs (x)" when "x" is
5447 "double"; conversions between signed and unsigned, like "unsigned
5448 ui = -1"; and conversions to smaller types, like "sqrtf (M_PI)". Do
5449 not warn for explicit casts like "abs ((int) x)" and "ui =
5450 (unsigned) -1", or if the value is not changed by the conversion
5451 like in "abs (2.0)". Warnings about conversions between signed and
5452 unsigned integers can be disabled by using -Wno-sign-conversion.
5453
5454 For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-
5455 defined conversions; and conversions that never use a type
5456 conversion operator: conversions to "void", the same type, a base
5457 class or a reference to them. Warnings about conversions between
5458 signed and unsigned integers are disabled by default in C++ unless
5459 -Wsign-conversion is explicitly enabled.
5460
5461 -Wno-conversion-null (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5462 Do not warn for conversions between "NULL" and non-pointer types.
5463 -Wconversion-null is enabled by default.
5464
5465 -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5466 Warn when a literal 0 is used as null pointer constant. This can
5467 be useful to facilitate the conversion to "nullptr" in C++11.
5468
5469 -Wsubobject-linkage (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5470 Warn if a class type has a base or a field whose type uses the
5471 anonymous namespace or depends on a type with no linkage. If a
5472 type A depends on a type B with no or internal linkage, defining it
5473 in multiple translation units would be an ODR violation because the
5474 meaning of B is different in each translation unit. If A only
5475 appears in a single translation unit, the best way to silence the
5476 warning is to give it internal linkage by putting it in an
5477 anonymous namespace as well. The compiler doesn't give this
5478 warning for types defined in the main .C file, as those are
5479 unlikely to have multiple definitions. -Wsubobject-linkage is
5480 enabled by default.
5481
5482 -Wdangling-else
5483 Warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which "if"
5484 statement an "else" branch belongs. Here is an example of such a
5485 case:
5486
5487 {
5488 if (a)
5489 if (b)
5490 foo ();
5491 else
5492 bar ();
5493 }
5494
5495 In C/C++, every "else" branch belongs to the innermost possible
5496 "if" statement, which in this example is "if (b)". This is often
5497 not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above
5498 example by indentation the programmer chose. When there is the
5499 potential for this confusion, GCC issues a warning when this flag
5500 is specified. To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around
5501 the innermost "if" statement so there is no way the "else" can
5502 belong to the enclosing "if". The resulting code looks like this:
5503
5504 {
5505 if (a)
5506 {
5507 if (b)
5508 foo ();
5509 else
5510 bar ();
5511 }
5512 }
5513
5514 This warning is enabled by -Wparentheses.
5515
5516 -Wdate-time
5517 Warn when macros "__TIME__", "__DATE__" or "__TIMESTAMP__" are
5518 encountered as they might prevent bit-wise-identical reproducible
5519 compilations.
5520
5521 -Wdelete-incomplete (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5522 Warn when deleting a pointer to incomplete type, which may cause
5523 undefined behavior at runtime. This warning is enabled by default.
5524
5525 -Wuseless-cast (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5526 Warn when an expression is casted to its own type.
5527
5528 -Wempty-body
5529 Warn if an empty body occurs in an "if", "else" or "do while"
5530 statement. This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.
5531
5532 -Wenum-compare
5533 Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated
5534 types. In C++ enumerated type mismatches in conditional
5535 expressions are also diagnosed and the warning is enabled by
5536 default. In C this warning is enabled by -Wall.
5537
5538 -Wextra-semi (C++, Objective-C++ only)
5539 Warn about redundant semicolon after in-class function definition.
5540
5541 -Wjump-misses-init (C, Objective-C only)
5542 Warn if a "goto" statement or a "switch" statement jumps forward
5543 across the initialization of a variable, or jumps backward to a
5544 label after the variable has been initialized. This only warns
5545 about variables that are initialized when they are declared. This
5546 warning is only supported for C and Objective-C; in C++ this sort
5547 of branch is an error in any case.
5548
5549 -Wjump-misses-init is included in -Wc++-compat. It can be disabled
5550 with the -Wno-jump-misses-init option.
5551
5552 -Wsign-compare
5553 Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could
5554 produce an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to
5555 unsigned. In C++, this warning is also enabled by -Wall. In C, it
5556 is also enabled by -Wextra.
5557
5558 -Wsign-conversion
5559 Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an
5560 integer value, like assigning a signed integer expression to an
5561 unsigned integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning.
5562 In C, this option is enabled also by -Wconversion.
5563
5564 -Wfloat-conversion
5565 Warn for implicit conversions that reduce the precision of a real
5566 value. This includes conversions from real to integer, and from
5567 higher precision real to lower precision real values. This option
5568 is also enabled by -Wconversion.
5569
5570 -Wno-scalar-storage-order
5571 Do not warn on suspicious constructs involving reverse scalar
5572 storage order.
5573
5574 -Wsized-deallocation (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5575 Warn about a definition of an unsized deallocation function
5576
5577 void operator delete (void *) noexcept;
5578 void operator delete[] (void *) noexcept;
5579
5580 without a definition of the corresponding sized deallocation
5581 function
5582
5583 void operator delete (void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
5584 void operator delete[] (void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
5585
5586 or vice versa. Enabled by -Wextra along with -fsized-deallocation.
5587
5588 -Wsizeof-pointer-div
5589 Warn for suspicious divisions of two sizeof expressions that divide
5590 the pointer size by the element size, which is the usual way to
5591 compute the array size but won't work out correctly with pointers.
5592 This warning warns e.g. about "sizeof (ptr) / sizeof (ptr[0])" if
5593 "ptr" is not an array, but a pointer. This warning is enabled by
5594 -Wall.
5595
5596 -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess
5597 Warn for suspicious length parameters to certain string and memory
5598 built-in functions if the argument uses "sizeof". This warning
5599 triggers for example for "memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (ptr));" if "ptr"
5600 is not an array, but a pointer, and suggests a possible fix, or
5601 about "memcpy (&foo, ptr, sizeof (&foo));".
5602 -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess also warns about calls to bounded string
5603 copy functions like "strncat" or "strncpy" that specify as the
5604 bound a "sizeof" expression of the source array. For example, in
5605 the following function the call to "strncat" specifies the size of
5606 the source string as the bound. That is almost certainly a mistake
5607 and so the call is diagnosed.
5608
5609 void make_file (const char *name)
5610 {
5611 char path[PATH_MAX];
5612 strncpy (path, name, sizeof path - 1);
5613 strncat (path, ".text", sizeof ".text");
5614 ...
5615 }
5616
5617 The -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess option is enabled by -Wall.
5618
5619 -Wsizeof-array-argument
5620 Warn when the "sizeof" operator is applied to a parameter that is
5621 declared as an array in a function definition. This warning is
5622 enabled by default for C and C++ programs.
5623
5624 -Wmemset-elt-size
5625 Warn for suspicious calls to the "memset" built-in function, if the
5626 first argument references an array, and the third argument is a
5627 number equal to the number of elements, but not equal to the size
5628 of the array in memory. This indicates that the user has omitted a
5629 multiplication by the element size. This warning is enabled by
5630 -Wall.
5631
5632 -Wmemset-transposed-args
5633 Warn for suspicious calls to the "memset" built-in function where
5634 the second argument is not zero and the third argument is zero.
5635 For example, the call "memset (buf, sizeof buf, 0)" is diagnosed
5636 because "memset (buf, 0, sizeof buf)" was meant instead. The
5637 diagnostic is only emitted if the third argument is a literal zero.
5638 Otherwise, if it is an expression that is folded to zero, or a cast
5639 of zero to some type, it is far less likely that the arguments have
5640 been mistakenly transposed and no warning is emitted. This warning
5641 is enabled by -Wall.
5642
5643 -Waddress
5644 Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
5645 the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
5646 "void func(void); if (func)", and comparisons against the memory
5647 address of a string literal, such as "if (x == "abc")". Such uses
5648 typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
5649 always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
5650 indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
5651 call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
5652 behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that
5653 the programmer intended to use "strcmp". This warning is enabled
5654 by -Wall.
5655
5656 -Waddress-of-packed-member
5657 Warn when the address of packed member of struct or union is taken,
5658 which usually results in an unaligned pointer value. This is
5659 enabled by default.
5660
5661 -Wlogical-op
5662 Warn about suspicious uses of logical operators in expressions.
5663 This includes using logical operators in contexts where a bit-wise
5664 operator is likely to be expected. Also warns when the operands of
5665 a logical operator are the same:
5666
5667 extern int a;
5668 if (a < 0 && a < 0) { ... }
5669
5670 -Wlogical-not-parentheses
5671 Warn about logical not used on the left hand side operand of a
5672 comparison. This option does not warn if the right operand is
5673 considered to be a boolean expression. Its purpose is to detect
5674 suspicious code like the following:
5675
5676 int a;
5677 ...
5678 if (!a > 1) { ... }
5679
5680 It is possible to suppress the warning by wrapping the LHS into
5681 parentheses:
5682
5683 if ((!a) > 1) { ... }
5684
5685 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
5686
5687 -Waggregate-return
5688 Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined
5689 or called. (In languages where you can return an array, this also
5690 elicits a warning.)
5691
5692 -Wno-aggressive-loop-optimizations
5693 Warn if in a loop with constant number of iterations the compiler
5694 detects undefined behavior in some statement during one or more of
5695 the iterations.
5696
5697 -Wno-attributes
5698 Do not warn if an unexpected "__attribute__" is used, such as
5699 unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
5700 etc. This does not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
5701 attributes.
5702
5703 -Wno-builtin-declaration-mismatch
5704 Warn if a built-in function is declared with an incompatible
5705 signature or as a non-function, or when a built-in function
5706 declared with a type that does not include a prototype is called
5707 with arguments whose promoted types do not match those expected by
5708 the function. When -Wextra is specified, also warn when a built-in
5709 function that takes arguments is declared without a prototype. The
5710 -Wno-builtin-declaration-mismatch warning is enabled by default.
5711 To avoid the warning include the appropriate header to bring the
5712 prototypes of built-in functions into scope.
5713
5714 For example, the call to "memset" below is diagnosed by the warning
5715 because the function expects a value of type "size_t" as its
5716 argument but the type of 32 is "int". With -Wextra, the
5717 declaration of the function is diagnosed as well.
5718
5719 extern void* memset ();
5720 void f (void *d)
5721 {
5722 memset (d, '\0', 32);
5723 }
5724
5725 -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
5726 Do not warn if certain built-in macros are redefined. This
5727 suppresses warnings for redefinition of "__TIMESTAMP__",
5728 "__TIME__", "__DATE__", "__FILE__", and "__BASE_FILE__".
5729
5730 -Wstrict-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
5731 Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
5732 argument types. (An old-style function definition is permitted
5733 without a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the
5734 argument types.)
5735
5736 -Wold-style-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
5737 Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a
5738 declaration. For example, warn if storage-class specifiers like
5739 "static" are not the first things in a declaration. This warning
5740 is also enabled by -Wextra.
5741
5742 -Wold-style-definition (C and Objective-C only)
5743 Warn if an old-style function definition is used. A warning is
5744 given even if there is a previous prototype.
5745
5746 -Wmissing-parameter-type (C and Objective-C only)
5747 A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in
5748 K&R-style functions:
5749
5750 void foo(bar) { }
5751
5752 This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.
5753
5754 -Wmissing-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
5755 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
5756 declaration. This warning is issued even if the definition itself
5757 provides a prototype. Use this option to detect global functions
5758 that do not have a matching prototype declaration in a header file.
5759 This option is not valid for C++ because all function declarations
5760 provide prototypes and a non-matching declaration declares an
5761 overload rather than conflict with an earlier declaration. Use
5762 -Wmissing-declarations to detect missing declarations in C++.
5763
5764 -Wmissing-declarations
5765 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous
5766 declaration. Do so even if the definition itself provides a
5767 prototype. Use this option to detect global functions that are not
5768 declared in header files. In C, no warnings are issued for
5769 functions with previous non-prototype declarations; use
5770 -Wmissing-prototypes to detect missing prototypes. In C++, no
5771 warnings are issued for function templates, or for inline
5772 functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.
5773
5774 -Wmissing-field-initializers
5775 Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing. For
5776 example, the following code causes such a warning, because "x.h" is
5777 implicitly zero:
5778
5779 struct s { int f, g, h; };
5780 struct s x = { 3, 4 };
5781
5782 This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the
5783 following modification does not trigger a warning:
5784
5785 struct s { int f, g, h; };
5786 struct s x = { .f = 3, .g = 4 };
5787
5788 In C this option does not warn about the universal zero initializer
5789 { 0 }:
5790
5791 struct s { int f, g, h; };
5792 struct s x = { 0 };
5793
5794 Likewise, in C++ this option does not warn about the empty { }
5795 initializer, for example:
5796
5797 struct s { int f, g, h; };
5798 s x = { };
5799
5800 This warning is included in -Wextra. To get other -Wextra warnings
5801 without this one, use -Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers.
5802
5803 -Wno-multichar
5804 Do not warn if a multicharacter constant ('FOOF') is used. Usually
5805 they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
5806 implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable
5807 code.
5808
5809 -Wnormalized=[none|id|nfc|nfkc]
5810 In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
5811 different sequences of characters. However, sometimes when
5812 characters outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can
5813 have two different character sequences that look the same. To
5814 avoid confusion, the ISO 10646 standard sets out some normalization
5815 rules which when applied ensure that two sequences that look the
5816 same are turned into the same sequence. GCC can warn you if you
5817 are using identifiers that have not been normalized; this option
5818 controls that warning.
5819
5820 There are four levels of warning supported by GCC. The default is
5821 -Wnormalized=nfc, which warns about any identifier that is not in
5822 the ISO 10646 "C" normalized form, NFC. NFC is the recommended
5823 form for most uses. It is equivalent to -Wnormalized.
5824
5825 Unfortunately, there are some characters allowed in identifiers by
5826 ISO C and ISO C++ that, when turned into NFC, are not allowed in
5827 identifiers. That is, there's no way to use these symbols in
5828 portable ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC.
5829 -Wnormalized=id suppresses the warning for these characters. It is
5830 hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
5831 this, which is why this option is not the default.
5832
5833 You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
5834 -Wnormalized=none or -Wno-normalized. You should only do this if
5835 you are using some other normalization scheme (like "D"), because
5836 otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible
5837 to see.
5838
5839 Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look
5840 identical in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once
5841 formatting has been applied. For instance "\u207F", "SUPERSCRIPT
5842 LATIN SMALL LETTER N", displays just like a regular "n" that has
5843 been placed in a superscript. ISO 10646 defines the NFKC
5844 normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
5845 well, and GCC warns if your code is not in NFKC if you use
5846 -Wnormalized=nfkc. This warning is comparable to warning about
5847 every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
5848 confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
5849 useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment
5850 cannot be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
5851
5852 -Wno-attribute-warning
5853 Do not warn about usage of functions declared with "warning"
5854 attribute. By default, this warning is enabled.
5855 -Wno-attribute-warning can be used to disable the warning or
5856 -Wno-error=attribute-warning can be used to disable the error when
5857 compiled with -Werror flag.
5858
5859 -Wno-deprecated
5860 Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.
5861
5862 -Wno-deprecated-declarations
5863 Do not warn about uses of functions, variables, and types marked as
5864 deprecated by using the "deprecated" attribute.
5865
5866 -Wno-overflow
5867 Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
5868
5869 -Wno-odr
5870 Warn about One Definition Rule violations during link-time
5871 optimization. Requires -flto-odr-type-merging to be enabled.
5872 Enabled by default.
5873
5874 -Wopenmp-simd
5875 Warn if the vectorizer cost model overrides the OpenMP simd
5876 directive set by user. The -fsimd-cost-model=unlimited option can
5877 be used to relax the cost model.
5878
5879 -Woverride-init (C and Objective-C only)
5880 Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden
5881 when using designated initializers.
5882
5883 This warning is included in -Wextra. To get other -Wextra warnings
5884 without this one, use -Wextra -Wno-override-init.
5885
5886 -Woverride-init-side-effects (C and Objective-C only)
5887 Warn if an initialized field with side effects is overridden when
5888 using designated initializers. This warning is enabled by default.
5889
5890 -Wpacked
5891 Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
5892 attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
5893 Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit. For
5894 instance, in this code, the variable "f.x" in "struct bar" is
5895 misaligned even though "struct bar" does not itself have the packed
5896 attribute:
5897
5898 struct foo {
5899 int x;
5900 char a, b, c, d;
5901 } __attribute__((packed));
5902 struct bar {
5903 char z;
5904 struct foo f;
5905 };
5906
5907 -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
5908 The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the "packed" attribute on
5909 bit-fields of type "char". This has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but the
5910 change can lead to differences in the structure layout. GCC
5911 informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.
5912 For example there is no longer a 4-bit padding between field "a"
5913 and "b" in this structure:
5914
5915 struct foo
5916 {
5917 char a:4;
5918 char b:8;
5919 } __attribute__ ((packed));
5920
5921 This warning is enabled by default. Use
5922 -Wno-packed-bitfield-compat to disable this warning.
5923
5924 -Wpacked-not-aligned (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
5925 Warn if a structure field with explicitly specified alignment in a
5926 packed struct or union is misaligned. For example, a warning will
5927 be issued on "struct S", like, "warning: alignment 1 of 'struct S'
5928 is less than 8", in this code:
5929
5930 struct __attribute__ ((aligned (8))) S8 { char a[8]; };
5931 struct __attribute__ ((packed)) S {
5932 struct S8 s8;
5933 };
5934
5935 This warning is enabled by -Wall.
5936
5937 -Wpadded
5938 Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an
5939 element of the structure or to align the whole structure.
5940 Sometimes when this happens it is possible to rearrange the fields
5941 of the structure to reduce the padding and so make the structure
5942 smaller.
5943
5944 -Wredundant-decls
5945 Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even
5946 in cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
5947
5948 -Wno-restrict
5949 Warn when an object referenced by a "restrict"-qualified parameter
5950 (or, in C++, a "__restrict"-qualified parameter) is aliased by
5951 another argument, or when copies between such objects overlap. For
5952 example, the call to the "strcpy" function below attempts to
5953 truncate the string by replacing its initial characters with the
5954 last four. However, because the call writes the terminating NUL
5955 into "a[4]", the copies overlap and the call is diagnosed.
5956
5957 void foo (void)
5958 {
5959 char a[] = "abcd1234";
5960 strcpy (a, a + 4);
5961 ...
5962 }
5963
5964 The -Wrestrict option detects some instances of simple overlap even
5965 without optimization but works best at -O2 and above. It is
5966 included in -Wall.
5967
5968 -Wnested-externs (C and Objective-C only)
5969 Warn if an "extern" declaration is encountered within a function.
5970
5971 -Wno-inherited-variadic-ctor
5972 Suppress warnings about use of C++11 inheriting constructors when
5973 the base class inherited from has a C variadic constructor; the
5974 warning is on by default because the ellipsis is not inherited.
5975
5976 -Winline
5977 Warn if a function that is declared as inline cannot be inlined.
5978 Even with this option, the compiler does not warn about failures to
5979 inline functions declared in system headers.
5980
5981 The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or
5982 not to inline a function. For example, the compiler takes into
5983 account the size of the function being inlined and the amount of
5984 inlining that has already been done in the current function.
5985 Therefore, seemingly insignificant changes in the source program
5986 can cause the warnings produced by -Winline to appear or disappear.
5987
5988 -Wno-invalid-offsetof (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
5989 Suppress warnings from applying the "offsetof" macro to a non-POD
5990 type. According to the 2014 ISO C++ standard, applying "offsetof"
5991 to a non-standard-layout type is undefined. In existing C++
5992 implementations, however, "offsetof" typically gives meaningful
5993 results. This flag is for users who are aware that they are
5994 writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore
5995 the warning about it.
5996
5997 The restrictions on "offsetof" may be relaxed in a future version
5998 of the C++ standard.
5999
6000 -Wint-in-bool-context
6001 Warn for suspicious use of integer values where boolean values are
6002 expected, such as conditional expressions (?:) using non-boolean
6003 integer constants in boolean context, like "if (a <= b ? 2 : 3)".
6004 Or left shifting of signed integers in boolean context, like "for
6005 (a = 0; 1 << a; a++);". Likewise for all kinds of multiplications
6006 regardless of the data type. This warning is enabled by -Wall.
6007
6008 -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
6009 Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
6010 different size. In C++, casting to a pointer type of smaller size
6011 is an error. Wint-to-pointer-cast is enabled by default.
6012
6013 -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast (C and Objective-C only)
6014 Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
6015 different size.
6016
6017 -Winvalid-pch
6018 Warn if a precompiled header is found in the search path but cannot
6019 be used.
6020
6021 -Wlong-long
6022 Warn if "long long" type is used. This is enabled by either
6023 -Wpedantic or -Wtraditional in ISO C90 and C++98 modes. To inhibit
6024 the warning messages, use -Wno-long-long.
6025
6026 -Wvariadic-macros
6027 Warn if variadic macros are used in ISO C90 mode, or if the GNU
6028 alternate syntax is used in ISO C99 mode. This is enabled by
6029 either -Wpedantic or -Wtraditional. To inhibit the warning
6030 messages, use -Wno-variadic-macros.
6031
6032 -Wvarargs
6033 Warn upon questionable usage of the macros used to handle variable
6034 arguments like "va_start". This is default. To inhibit the
6035 warning messages, use -Wno-varargs.
6036
6037 -Wvector-operation-performance
6038 Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities
6039 of the architecture. Mainly useful for the performance tuning.
6040 Vector operation can be implemented "piecewise", which means that
6041 the scalar operation is performed on every vector element; "in
6042 parallel", which means that the vector operation is implemented
6043 using scalars of wider type, which normally is more performance
6044 efficient; and "as a single scalar", which means that vector fits
6045 into a scalar type.
6046
6047 -Wno-virtual-move-assign
6048 Suppress warnings about inheriting from a virtual base with a non-
6049 trivial C++11 move assignment operator. This is dangerous because
6050 if the virtual base is reachable along more than one path, it is
6051 moved multiple times, which can mean both objects end up in the
6052 moved-from state. If the move assignment operator is written to
6053 avoid moving from a moved-from object, this warning can be
6054 disabled.
6055
6056 -Wvla
6057 Warn if a variable-length array is used in the code. -Wno-vla
6058 prevents the -Wpedantic warning of the variable-length array.
6059
6060 -Wvla-larger-than=byte-size
6061 If this option is used, the compiler will warn for declarations of
6062 variable-length arrays whose size is either unbounded, or bounded
6063 by an argument that allows the array size to exceed byte-size
6064 bytes. This is similar to how -Walloca-larger-than=byte-size
6065 works, but with variable-length arrays.
6066
6067 Note that GCC may optimize small variable-length arrays of a known
6068 value into plain arrays, so this warning may not get triggered for
6069 such arrays.
6070
6071 -Wvla-larger-than=PTRDIFF_MAX is enabled by default but is
6072 typically only effective when -ftree-vrp is active (default for -O2
6073 and above).
6074
6075 See also -Walloca-larger-than=byte-size.
6076
6077 -Wno-vla-larger-than
6078 Disable -Wvla-larger-than= warnings. The option is equivalent to
6079 -Wvla-larger-than=SIZE_MAX or larger.
6080
6081 -Wvolatile-register-var
6082 Warn if a register variable is declared volatile. The volatile
6083 modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate
6084 reads and/or writes to register variables. This warning is enabled
6085 by -Wall.
6086
6087 -Wdisabled-optimization
6088 Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled. This warning
6089 does not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your
6090 code; it merely indicates that GCC's optimizers are unable to
6091 handle the code effectively. Often, the problem is that your code
6092 is too big or too complex; GCC refuses to optimize programs when
6093 the optimization itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of
6094 time.
6095
6096 -Wpointer-sign (C and Objective-C only)
6097 Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different
6098 signedness. This option is only supported for C and Objective-C.
6099 It is implied by -Wall and by -Wpedantic, which can be disabled
6100 with -Wno-pointer-sign.
6101
6102 -Wstack-protector
6103 This option is only active when -fstack-protector is active. It
6104 warns about functions that are not protected against stack
6105 smashing.
6106
6107 -Woverlength-strings
6108 Warn about string constants that are longer than the "minimum
6109 maximum" length specified in the C standard. Modern compilers
6110 generally allow string constants that are much longer than the
6111 standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
6112 using longer strings.
6113
6114 The limit applies after string constant concatenation, and does not
6115 count the trailing NUL. In C90, the limit was 509 characters; in
6116 C99, it was raised to 4095. C++98 does not specify a normative
6117 minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++.
6118
6119 This option is implied by -Wpedantic, and can be disabled with
6120 -Wno-overlength-strings.
6121
6122 -Wunsuffixed-float-constants (C and Objective-C only)
6123 Issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have a
6124 suffix. When used together with -Wsystem-headers it warns about
6125 such constants in system header files. This can be useful when
6126 preparing code to use with the "FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64" pragma from
6127 the decimal floating-point extension to C99.
6128
6129 -Wno-designated-init (C and Objective-C only)
6130 Suppress warnings when a positional initializer is used to
6131 initialize a structure that has been marked with the
6132 "designated_init" attribute.
6133
6134 -Whsa
6135 Issue a warning when HSAIL cannot be emitted for the compiled
6136 function or OpenMP construct.
6137
6138 Options for Debugging Your Program
6139 To tell GCC to emit extra information for use by a debugger, in almost
6140 all cases you need only to add -g to your other options.
6141
6142 GCC allows you to use -g with -O. The shortcuts taken by optimized
6143 code may occasionally be surprising: some variables you declared may
6144 not exist at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not
6145 expect it; some statements may not be executed because they compute
6146 constant results or their values are already at hand; some statements
6147 may execute in different places because they have been moved out of
6148 loops. Nevertheless it is possible to debug optimized output. This
6149 makes it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have
6150 bugs.
6151
6152 If you are not using some other optimization option, consider using -Og
6153 with -g. With no -O option at all, some compiler passes that collect
6154 information useful for debugging do not run at all, so that -Og may
6155 result in a better debugging experience.
6156
6157 -g Produce debugging information in the operating system's native
6158 format (stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF). GDB can work with this
6159 debugging information.
6160
6161 On most systems that use stabs format, -g enables use of extra
6162 debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
6163 makes debugging work better in GDB but probably makes other
6164 debuggers crash or refuse to read the program. If you want to
6165 control for certain whether to generate the extra information, use
6166 -gstabs+, -gstabs, -gxcoff+, -gxcoff, or -gvms (see below).
6167
6168 -ggdb
6169 Produce debugging information for use by GDB. This means to use
6170 the most expressive format available (DWARF, stabs, or the native
6171 format if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions
6172 if at all possible.
6173
6174 -gdwarf
6175 -gdwarf-version
6176 Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is
6177 supported). The value of version may be either 2, 3, 4 or 5; the
6178 default version for most targets is 4. DWARF Version 5 is only
6179 experimental.
6180
6181 Note that with DWARF Version 2, some ports require and always use
6182 some non-conflicting DWARF 3 extensions in the unwind tables.
6183
6184 Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and -fvar-tracking-assignments for
6185 maximum benefit.
6186
6187 GCC no longer supports DWARF Version 1, which is substantially
6188 different than Version 2 and later. For historical reasons, some
6189 other DWARF-related options such as -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm) retain a
6190 reference to DWARF Version 2 in their names, but apply to all
6191 currently-supported versions of DWARF.
6192
6193 -gstabs
6194 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is
6195 supported), without GDB extensions. This is the format used by DBX
6196 on most BSD systems. On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems
6197 this option produces stabs debugging output that is not understood
6198 by DBX. On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU
6199 assembler.
6200
6201 -gstabs+
6202 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is
6203 supported), using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU
6204 debugger (GDB). The use of these extensions is likely to make
6205 other debuggers crash or refuse to read the program.
6206
6207 -gxcoff
6208 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is
6209 supported). This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM
6210 RS/6000 systems.
6211
6212 -gxcoff+
6213 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is
6214 supported), using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU
6215 debugger (GDB). The use of these extensions is likely to make
6216 other debuggers crash or refuse to read the program, and may cause
6217 assemblers other than the GNU assembler (GAS) to fail with an
6218 error.
6219
6220 -gvms
6221 Produce debugging information in Alpha/VMS debug format (if that is
6222 supported). This is the format used by DEBUG on Alpha/VMS systems.
6223
6224 -glevel
6225 -ggdblevel
6226 -gstabslevel
6227 -gxcofflevel
6228 -gvmslevel
6229 Request debugging information and also use level to specify how
6230 much information. The default level is 2.
6231
6232 Level 0 produces no debug information at all. Thus, -g0 negates
6233 -g.
6234
6235 Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces
6236 in parts of the program that you don't plan to debug. This
6237 includes descriptions of functions and external variables, and line
6238 number tables, but no information about local variables.
6239
6240 Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro
6241 definitions present in the program. Some debuggers support macro
6242 expansion when you use -g3.
6243
6244 If you use multiple -g options, with or without level numbers, the
6245 last such option is the one that is effective.
6246
6247 -gdwarf does not accept a concatenated debug level, to avoid
6248 confusion with -gdwarf-level. Instead use an additional -glevel
6249 option to change the debug level for DWARF.
6250
6251 -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
6252 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is
6253 supported), for only symbols that are actually used.
6254
6255 -femit-class-debug-always
6256 Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only
6257 one object file, emit it in all object files using the class. This
6258 option should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle
6259 the way GCC normally emits debugging information for classes
6260 because using this option increases the size of debugging
6261 information by as much as a factor of two.
6262
6263 -fno-merge-debug-strings
6264 Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging
6265 information that are identical in different object files. Merging
6266 is not supported by all assemblers or linkers. Merging decreases
6267 the size of the debug information in the output file at the cost of
6268 increasing link processing time. Merging is enabled by default.
6269
6270 -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new
6271 When compiling files residing in directory old, record debugging
6272 information describing them as if the files resided in directory
6273 new instead. This can be used to replace a build-time path with an
6274 install-time path in the debug info. It can also be used to change
6275 an absolute path to a relative path by using . for new. This can
6276 give more reproducible builds, which are location independent, but
6277 may require an extra command to tell GDB where to find the source
6278 files. See also -ffile-prefix-map.
6279
6280 -fvar-tracking
6281 Run variable tracking pass. It computes where variables are stored
6282 at each position in code. Better debugging information is then
6283 generated (if the debugging information format supports this
6284 information).
6285
6286 It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (-Os, -O,
6287 -O2, ...), debugging information (-g) and the debug info format
6288 supports it.
6289
6290 -fvar-tracking-assignments
6291 Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and
6292 attempt to carry the annotations over throughout the compilation
6293 all the way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information
6294 while optimizing. Use of -gdwarf-4 is recommended along with it.
6295
6296 It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case
6297 annotations are created and maintained, but discarded at the end.
6298 By default, this flag is enabled together with -fvar-tracking,
6299 except when selective scheduling is enabled.
6300
6301 -gsplit-dwarf
6302 Separate as much DWARF debugging information as possible into a
6303 separate output file with the extension .dwo. This option allows
6304 the build system to avoid linking files with debug information. To
6305 be useful, this option requires a debugger capable of reading .dwo
6306 files.
6307
6308 -gdescribe-dies
6309 Add description attributes to some DWARF DIEs that have no name
6310 attribute, such as artificial variables, external references and
6311 call site parameter DIEs.
6312
6313 -gpubnames
6314 Generate DWARF ".debug_pubnames" and ".debug_pubtypes" sections.
6315
6316 -ggnu-pubnames
6317 Generate ".debug_pubnames" and ".debug_pubtypes" sections in a
6318 format suitable for conversion into a GDB index. This option is
6319 only useful with a linker that can produce GDB index version 7.
6320
6321 -fdebug-types-section
6322 When using DWARF Version 4 or higher, type DIEs can be put into
6323 their own ".debug_types" section instead of making them part of the
6324 ".debug_info" section. It is more efficient to put them in a
6325 separate comdat section since the linker can then remove
6326 duplicates. But not all DWARF consumers support ".debug_types"
6327 sections yet and on some objects ".debug_types" produces larger
6328 instead of smaller debugging information.
6329
6330 -grecord-gcc-switches
6331 -gno-record-gcc-switches
6332 This switch causes the command-line options used to invoke the
6333 compiler that may affect code generation to be appended to the
6334 DW_AT_producer attribute in DWARF debugging information. The
6335 options are concatenated with spaces separating them from each
6336 other and from the compiler version. It is enabled by default.
6337 See also -frecord-gcc-switches for another way of storing compiler
6338 options into the object file.
6339
6340 -gstrict-dwarf
6341 Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than
6342 selected with -gdwarf-version. On most targets using non-
6343 conflicting DWARF extensions from later standard versions is
6344 allowed.
6345
6346 -gno-strict-dwarf
6347 Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than
6348 selected with -gdwarf-version.
6349
6350 -gas-loc-support
6351 Inform the compiler that the assembler supports ".loc" directives.
6352 It may then use them for the assembler to generate DWARF2+ line
6353 number tables.
6354
6355 This is generally desirable, because assembler-generated line-
6356 number tables are a lot more compact than those the compiler can
6357 generate itself.
6358
6359 This option will be enabled by default if, at GCC configure time,
6360 the assembler was found to support such directives.
6361
6362 -gno-as-loc-support
6363 Force GCC to generate DWARF2+ line number tables internally, if
6364 DWARF2+ line number tables are to be generated.
6365
6366 gas-locview-support
6367 Inform the compiler that the assembler supports "view" assignment
6368 and reset assertion checking in ".loc" directives.
6369
6370 This option will be enabled by default if, at GCC configure time,
6371 the assembler was found to support them.
6372
6373 gno-as-locview-support
6374 Force GCC to assign view numbers internally, if
6375 -gvariable-location-views are explicitly requested.
6376
6377 -gcolumn-info
6378 -gno-column-info
6379 Emit location column information into DWARF debugging information,
6380 rather than just file and line. This option is enabled by default.
6381
6382 -gstatement-frontiers
6383 -gno-statement-frontiers
6384 This option causes GCC to create markers in the internal
6385 representation at the beginning of statements, and to keep them
6386 roughly in place throughout compilation, using them to guide the
6387 output of "is_stmt" markers in the line number table. This is
6388 enabled by default when compiling with optimization (-Os, -O, -O2,
6389 ...), and outputting DWARF 2 debug information at the normal level.
6390
6391 -gvariable-location-views
6392 -gvariable-location-views=incompat5
6393 -gno-variable-location-views
6394 Augment variable location lists with progressive view numbers
6395 implied from the line number table. This enables debug information
6396 consumers to inspect state at certain points of the program, even
6397 if no instructions associated with the corresponding source
6398 locations are present at that point. If the assembler lacks
6399 support for view numbers in line number tables, this will cause the
6400 compiler to emit the line number table, which generally makes them
6401 somewhat less compact. The augmented line number tables and
6402 location lists are fully backward-compatible, so they can be
6403 consumed by debug information consumers that are not aware of these
6404 augmentations, but they won't derive any benefit from them either.
6405
6406 This is enabled by default when outputting DWARF 2 debug
6407 information at the normal level, as long as there is assembler
6408 support, -fvar-tracking-assignments is enabled and -gstrict-dwarf
6409 is not. When assembler support is not available, this may still be
6410 enabled, but it will force GCC to output internal line number
6411 tables, and if -ginternal-reset-location-views is not enabled, that
6412 will most certainly lead to silently mismatching location views.
6413
6414 There is a proposed representation for view numbers that is not
6415 backward compatible with the location list format introduced in
6416 DWARF 5, that can be enabled with
6417 -gvariable-location-views=incompat5. This option may be removed in
6418 the future, is only provided as a reference implementation of the
6419 proposed representation. Debug information consumers are not
6420 expected to support this extended format, and they would be
6421 rendered unable to decode location lists using it.
6422
6423 -ginternal-reset-location-views
6424 -gnointernal-reset-location-views
6425 Attempt to determine location views that can be omitted from
6426 location view lists. This requires the compiler to have very
6427 accurate insn length estimates, which isn't always the case, and it
6428 may cause incorrect view lists to be generated silently when using
6429 an assembler that does not support location view lists. The GNU
6430 assembler will flag any such error as a "view number mismatch".
6431 This is only enabled on ports that define a reliable estimation
6432 function.
6433
6434 -ginline-points
6435 -gno-inline-points
6436 Generate extended debug information for inlined functions.
6437 Location view tracking markers are inserted at inlined entry
6438 points, so that address and view numbers can be computed and output
6439 in debug information. This can be enabled independently of
6440 location views, in which case the view numbers won't be output, but
6441 it can only be enabled along with statement frontiers, and it is
6442 only enabled by default if location views are enabled.
6443
6444 -gz[=type]
6445 Produce compressed debug sections in DWARF format, if that is
6446 supported. If type is not given, the default type depends on the
6447 capabilities of the assembler and linker used. type may be one of
6448 none (don't compress debug sections), zlib (use zlib compression in
6449 ELF gABI format), or zlib-gnu (use zlib compression in traditional
6450 GNU format). If the linker doesn't support writing compressed
6451 debug sections, the option is rejected. Otherwise, if the
6452 assembler does not support them, -gz is silently ignored when
6453 producing object files.
6454
6455 -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
6456 Emit debug information for struct-like types only when the base
6457 name of the compilation source file matches the base name of file
6458 in which the struct is defined.
6459
6460 This option substantially reduces the size of debugging
6461 information, but at significant potential loss in type information
6462 to the debugger. See -femit-struct-debug-reduced for a less
6463 aggressive option. See -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more
6464 detailed control.
6465
6466 This option works only with DWARF debug output.
6467
6468 -femit-struct-debug-reduced
6469 Emit debug information for struct-like types only when the base
6470 name of the compilation source file matches the base name of file
6471 in which the type is defined, unless the struct is a template or
6472 defined in a system header.
6473
6474 This option significantly reduces the size of debugging
6475 information, with some potential loss in type information to the
6476 debugger. See -femit-struct-debug-baseonly for a more aggressive
6477 option. See -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more detailed
6478 control.
6479
6480 This option works only with DWARF debug output.
6481
6482 -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-list]
6483 Specify the struct-like types for which the compiler generates
6484 debug information. The intent is to reduce duplicate struct debug
6485 information between different object files within the same program.
6486
6487 This option is a detailed version of -femit-struct-debug-reduced
6488 and -femit-struct-debug-baseonly, which serves for most needs.
6489
6490 A specification has the
6491 syntax[dir:|ind:][ord:|gen:](any|sys|base|none)
6492
6493 The optional first word limits the specification to structs that
6494 are used directly (dir:) or used indirectly (ind:). A struct type
6495 is used directly when it is the type of a variable, member.
6496 Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs. That is, when use
6497 of an incomplete struct is valid, the use is indirect. An example
6498 is struct one direct; struct two * indirect;.
6499
6500 The optional second word limits the specification to ordinary
6501 structs (ord:) or generic structs (gen:). Generic structs are a
6502 bit complicated to explain. For C++, these are non-explicit
6503 specializations of template classes, or non-template classes within
6504 the above. Other programming languages have generics, but
6505 -femit-struct-debug-detailed does not yet implement them.
6506
6507 The third word specifies the source files for those structs for
6508 which the compiler should emit debug information. The values none
6509 and any have the normal meaning. The value base means that the
6510 base of name of the file in which the type declaration appears must
6511 match the base of the name of the main compilation file. In
6512 practice, this means that when compiling foo.c, debug information
6513 is generated for types declared in that file and foo.h, but not
6514 other header files. The value sys means those types satisfying
6515 base or declared in system or compiler headers.
6516
6517 You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your
6518 application.
6519
6520 The default is -femit-struct-debug-detailed=all.
6521
6522 This option works only with DWARF debug output.
6523
6524 -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
6525 Emit DWARF unwind info as compiler generated ".eh_frame" section
6526 instead of using GAS ".cfi_*" directives.
6527
6528 -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types
6529 Normally, when producing DWARF output, GCC avoids producing debug
6530 symbol output for types that are nowhere used in the source file
6531 being compiled. Sometimes it is useful to have GCC emit debugging
6532 information for all types declared in a compilation unit,
6533 regardless of whether or not they are actually used in that
6534 compilation unit, for example if, in the debugger, you want to cast
6535 a value to a type that is not actually used in your program (but is
6536 declared). More often, however, this results in a significant
6537 amount of wasted space.
6538
6539 Options That Control Optimization
6540 These options control various sorts of optimizations.
6541
6542 Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
6543 cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected results.
6544 Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a breakpoint
6545 between statements, you can then assign a new value to any variable or
6546 change the program counter to any other statement in the function and
6547 get exactly the results you expect from the source code.
6548
6549 Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve the
6550 performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time and
6551 possibly the ability to debug the program.
6552
6553 The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of the
6554 program. Compiling multiple files at once to a single output file mode
6555 allows the compiler to use information gained from all of the files
6556 when compiling each of them.
6557
6558 Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag. Only
6559 optimizations that have a flag are listed in this section.
6560
6561 Most optimizations are completely disabled at -O0 or if an -O level is
6562 not set on the command line, even if individual optimization flags are
6563 specified. Similarly, -Og suppresses many optimization passes.
6564
6565 Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly
6566 different set of optimizations may be enabled at each -O level than
6567 those listed here. You can invoke GCC with -Q --help=optimizers to
6568 find out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.
6569
6570 -O
6571 -O1 Optimize. Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a
6572 lot more memory for a large function.
6573
6574 With -O, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution time,
6575 without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
6576 compilation time.
6577
6578 -O turns on the following optimization flags:
6579
6580 -fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-count-reg -fcombine-stack-adjustments
6581 -fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fdce -fdefer-pop -fdelayed-branch
6582 -fdse -fforward-propagate -fguess-branch-probability
6583 -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 -finline-functions-called-once
6584 -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const -fipa-reference
6585 -fipa-reference-addressable -fmerge-constants
6586 -fmove-loop-invariants -fomit-frame-pointer -freorder-blocks
6587 -fshrink-wrap -fshrink-wrap-separate -fsplit-wide-types
6588 -fssa-backprop -fssa-phiopt -ftree-bit-ccp -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch
6589 -ftree-coalesce-vars -ftree-copy-prop -ftree-dce
6590 -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse -ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre
6591 -ftree-phiprop -ftree-pta -ftree-scev-cprop -ftree-sink -ftree-slsr
6592 -ftree-sra -ftree-ter -funit-at-a-time
6593
6594 -O2 Optimize even more. GCC performs nearly all supported
6595 optimizations that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff. As
6596 compared to -O, this option increases both compilation time and the
6597 performance of the generated code.
6598
6599 -O2 turns on all optimization flags specified by -O. It also turns
6600 on the following optimization flags:
6601
6602 -falign-functions -falign-jumps -falign-labels -falign-loops
6603 -fcaller-saves -fcode-hoisting -fcrossjumping -fcse-follow-jumps
6604 -fcse-skip-blocks -fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize
6605 -fdevirtualize-speculatively -fexpensive-optimizations -fgcse
6606 -fgcse-lm -fhoist-adjacent-loads -finline-small-functions
6607 -findirect-inlining -fipa-bit-cp -fipa-cp -fipa-icf -fipa-ra
6608 -fipa-sra -fipa-vrp -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
6609 -flra-remat -foptimize-sibling-calls -foptimize-strlen
6610 -fpartial-inlining -fpeephole2 -freorder-blocks-algorithm=stc
6611 -freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions
6612 -frerun-cse-after-loop -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2
6613 -fsched-interblock -fsched-spec -fstore-merging -fstrict-aliasing
6614 -fthread-jumps -ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-pre
6615 -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge -ftree-vrp
6616
6617 Please note the warning under -fgcse about invoking -O2 on programs
6618 that use computed gotos.
6619
6620 -O3 Optimize yet more. -O3 turns on all optimizations specified by -O2
6621 and also turns on the following optimization flags:
6622
6623 -fgcse-after-reload -finline-functions -fipa-cp-clone
6624 -floop-interchange -floop-unroll-and-jam -fpeel-loops
6625 -fpredictive-commoning -fsplit-paths
6626 -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns -ftree-loop-distribution
6627 -ftree-loop-vectorize -ftree-partial-pre -ftree-slp-vectorize
6628 -funswitch-loops -fvect-cost-model -fversion-loops-for-strides
6629
6630 -O0 Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected
6631 results. This is the default.
6632
6633 -Os Optimize for size. -Os enables all -O2 optimizations except those
6634 that often increase code size:
6635
6636 -falign-functions -falign-jumps -falign-labels -falign-loops
6637 -fprefetch-loop-arrays -freorder-blocks-algorithm=stc
6638
6639 It also enables -finline-functions, causes the compiler to tune for
6640 code size rather than execution speed, and performs further
6641 optimizations designed to reduce code size.
6642
6643 -Ofast
6644 Disregard strict standards compliance. -Ofast enables all -O3
6645 optimizations. It also enables optimizations that are not valid
6646 for all standard-compliant programs. It turns on -ffast-math and
6647 the Fortran-specific -fstack-arrays, unless -fmax-stack-var-size is
6648 specified, and -fno-protect-parens.
6649
6650 -Og Optimize debugging experience. -Og should be the optimization
6651 level of choice for the standard edit-compile-debug cycle, offering
6652 a reasonable level of optimization while maintaining fast
6653 compilation and a good debugging experience. It is a better choice
6654 than -O0 for producing debuggable code because some compiler passes
6655 that collect debug information are disabled at -O0.
6656
6657 Like -O0, -Og completely disables a number of optimization passes
6658 so that individual options controlling them have no effect.
6659 Otherwise -Og enables all -O1 optimization flags except for those
6660 that may interfere with debugging:
6661
6662 -fbranch-count-reg -fdelayed-branch -fif-conversion
6663 -fif-conversion2 -finline-functions-called-once
6664 -fmove-loop-invariants -fssa-phiopt -ftree-bit-ccp -ftree-pta
6665 -ftree-sra
6666
6667 If you use multiple -O options, with or without level numbers, the last
6668 such option is the one that is effective.
6669
6670 Options of the form -fflag specify machine-independent flags. Most
6671 flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo
6672 is -fno-foo. In the table below, only one of the forms is listed---the
6673 one you typically use. You can figure out the other form by either
6674 removing no- or adding it.
6675
6676 The following options control specific optimizations. They are either
6677 activated by -O options or are related to ones that are. You can use
6678 the following flags in the rare cases when "fine-tuning" of
6679 optimizations to be performed is desired.
6680
6681 -fno-defer-pop
6682 For machines that must pop arguments after a function call, always
6683 pop the arguments as soon as each function returns. At levels -O1
6684 and higher, -fdefer-pop is the default; this allows the compiler to
6685 let arguments accumulate on the stack for several function calls
6686 and pop them all at once.
6687
6688 -fforward-propagate
6689 Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL. The pass tries to
6690 combine two instructions and checks if the result can be
6691 simplified. If loop unrolling is active, two passes are performed
6692 and the second is scheduled after loop unrolling.
6693
6694 This option is enabled by default at optimization levels -O, -O2,
6695 -O3, -Os.
6696
6697 -ffp-contract=style
6698 -ffp-contract=off disables floating-point expression contraction.
6699 -ffp-contract=fast enables floating-point expression contraction
6700 such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target has
6701 native support for them. -ffp-contract=on enables floating-point
6702 expression contraction if allowed by the language standard. This
6703 is currently not implemented and treated equal to
6704 -ffp-contract=off.
6705
6706 The default is -ffp-contract=fast.
6707
6708 -fomit-frame-pointer
6709 Omit the frame pointer in functions that don't need one. This
6710 avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore the frame
6711 pointer; on many targets it also makes an extra register available.
6712
6713 On some targets this flag has no effect because the standard
6714 calling sequence always uses a frame pointer, so it cannot be
6715 omitted.
6716
6717 Note that -fno-omit-frame-pointer doesn't guarantee the frame
6718 pointer is used in all functions. Several targets always omit the
6719 frame pointer in leaf functions.
6720
6721 Enabled by default at -O and higher.
6722
6723 -foptimize-sibling-calls
6724 Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
6725
6726 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6727
6728 -foptimize-strlen
6729 Optimize various standard C string functions (e.g. "strlen",
6730 "strchr" or "strcpy") and their "_FORTIFY_SOURCE" counterparts into
6731 faster alternatives.
6732
6733 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
6734
6735 -fno-inline
6736 Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with the
6737 "always_inline" attribute. This is the default when not
6738 optimizing.
6739
6740 Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them with
6741 the "noinline" attribute.
6742
6743 -finline-small-functions
6744 Integrate functions into their callers when their body is smaller
6745 than expected function call code (so overall size of program gets
6746 smaller). The compiler heuristically decides which functions are
6747 simple enough to be worth integrating in this way. This inlining
6748 applies to all functions, even those not declared inline.
6749
6750 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6751
6752 -findirect-inlining
6753 Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to be known at
6754 compile time thanks to previous inlining. This option has any
6755 effect only when inlining itself is turned on by the
6756 -finline-functions or -finline-small-functions options.
6757
6758 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6759
6760 -finline-functions
6761 Consider all functions for inlining, even if they are not declared
6762 inline. The compiler heuristically decides which functions are
6763 worth integrating in this way.
6764
6765 If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function
6766 is declared "static", then the function is normally not output as
6767 assembler code in its own right.
6768
6769 Enabled at levels -O3, -Os. Also enabled by -fprofile-use and
6770 -fauto-profile.
6771
6772 -finline-functions-called-once
6773 Consider all "static" functions called once for inlining into their
6774 caller even if they are not marked "inline". If a call to a given
6775 function is integrated, then the function is not output as
6776 assembler code in its own right.
6777
6778 Enabled at levels -O1, -O2, -O3 and -Os, but not -Og.
6779
6780 -fearly-inlining
6781 Inline functions marked by "always_inline" and functions whose body
6782 seems smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
6783 -fprofile-generate instrumentation and real inlining pass. Doing
6784 so makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining
6785 faster on programs having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
6786
6787 Enabled by default.
6788
6789 -fipa-sra
6790 Perform interprocedural scalar replacement of aggregates, removal
6791 of unused parameters and replacement of parameters passed by
6792 reference by parameters passed by value.
6793
6794 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3 and -Os.
6795
6796 -finline-limit=n
6797 By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.
6798 This flag allows coarse control of this limit. n is the size of
6799 functions that can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.
6800
6801 Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which
6802 may be specified individually by using --param name=value. The
6803 -finline-limit=n option sets some of these parameters as follows:
6804
6805 max-inline-insns-single
6806 is set to n/2.
6807
6808 max-inline-insns-auto
6809 is set to n/2.
6810
6811 See below for a documentation of the individual parameters
6812 controlling inlining and for the defaults of these parameters.
6813
6814 Note: there may be no value to -finline-limit that results in
6815 default behavior.
6816
6817 Note: pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
6818 abstract measurement of function's size. In no way does it
6819 represent a count of assembly instructions and as such its exact
6820 meaning might change from one release to an another.
6821
6822 -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6823 This is a more fine-grained version of -fkeep-inline-functions,
6824 which applies only to functions that are declared using the
6825 "dllexport" attribute or declspec.
6826
6827 -fkeep-inline-functions
6828 In C, emit "static" functions that are declared "inline" into the
6829 object file, even if the function has been inlined into all of its
6830 callers. This switch does not affect functions using the "extern
6831 inline" extension in GNU C90. In C++, emit any and all inline
6832 functions into the object file.
6833
6834 -fkeep-static-functions
6835 Emit "static" functions into the object file, even if the function
6836 is never used.
6837
6838 -fkeep-static-consts
6839 Emit variables declared "static const" when optimization isn't
6840 turned on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
6841
6842 GCC enables this option by default. If you want to force the
6843 compiler to check if a variable is referenced, regardless of
6844 whether or not optimization is turned on, use the
6845 -fno-keep-static-consts option.
6846
6847 -fmerge-constants
6848 Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and
6849 floating-point constants) across compilation units.
6850
6851 This option is the default for optimized compilation if the
6852 assembler and linker support it. Use -fno-merge-constants to
6853 inhibit this behavior.
6854
6855 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.
6856
6857 -fmerge-all-constants
6858 Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
6859
6860 This option implies -fmerge-constants. In addition to
6861 -fmerge-constants this considers e.g. even constant initialized
6862 arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-
6863 point types. Languages like C or C++ require each variable,
6864 including multiple instances of the same variable in recursive
6865 calls, to have distinct locations, so using this option results in
6866 non-conforming behavior.
6867
6868 -fmodulo-sched
6869 Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first
6870 scheduling pass. This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders
6871 their instructions by overlapping different iterations.
6872
6873 -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6874 Perform more aggressive SMS-based modulo scheduling with register
6875 moves allowed. By setting this flag certain anti-dependences edges
6876 are deleted, which triggers the generation of reg-moves based on
6877 the life-range analysis. This option is effective only with
6878 -fmodulo-sched enabled.
6879
6880 -fno-branch-count-reg
6881 Disable the optimization pass that scans for opportunities to use
6882 "decrement and branch" instructions on a count register instead of
6883 instruction sequences that decrement a register, compare it against
6884 zero, and then branch based upon the result. This option is only
6885 meaningful on architectures that support such instructions, which
6886 include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390. Note that the
6887 -fno-branch-count-reg option doesn't remove the decrement and
6888 branch instructions from the generated instruction stream
6889 introduced by other optimization passes.
6890
6891 The default is -fbranch-count-reg at -O1 and higher, except for
6892 -Og.
6893
6894 -fno-function-cse
6895 Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction
6896 that calls a constant function contain the function's address
6897 explicitly.
6898
6899 This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
6900 that alter the assembler output may be confused by the
6901 optimizations performed when this option is not used.
6902
6903 The default is -ffunction-cse
6904
6905 -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6906 If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables
6907 that are initialized to zero into BSS. This can save space in the
6908 resulting code.
6909
6910 This option turns off this behavior because some programs
6911 explicitly rely on variables going to the data section---e.g., so
6912 that the resulting executable can find the beginning of that
6913 section and/or make assumptions based on that.
6914
6915 The default is -fzero-initialized-in-bss.
6916
6917 -fthread-jumps
6918 Perform optimizations that check to see if a jump branches to a
6919 location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found.
6920 If so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of
6921 the second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on
6922 whether the condition is known to be true or false.
6923
6924 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6925
6926 -fsplit-wide-types
6927 When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as "long
6928 long" on a 32-bit system, split the registers apart and allocate
6929 them independently. This normally generates better code for those
6930 types, but may make debugging more difficult.
6931
6932 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.
6933
6934 -fcse-follow-jumps
6935 In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump
6936 instructions when the target of the jump is not reached by any
6937 other path. For example, when CSE encounters an "if" statement
6938 with an "else" clause, CSE follows the jump when the condition
6939 tested is false.
6940
6941 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6942
6943 -fcse-skip-blocks
6944 This is similar to -fcse-follow-jumps, but causes CSE to follow
6945 jumps that conditionally skip over blocks. When CSE encounters a
6946 simple "if" statement with no else clause, -fcse-skip-blocks causes
6947 CSE to follow the jump around the body of the "if".
6948
6949 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6950
6951 -frerun-cse-after-loop
6952 Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations
6953 are performed.
6954
6955 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6956
6957 -fgcse
6958 Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass. This pass
6959 also performs global constant and copy propagation.
6960
6961 Note: When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
6962 extension, you may get better run-time performance if you disable
6963 the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
6964 -fno-gcse to the command line.
6965
6966 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
6967
6968 -fgcse-lm
6969 When -fgcse-lm is enabled, global common subexpression elimination
6970 attempts to move loads that are only killed by stores into
6971 themselves. This allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to
6972 be changed to a load outside the loop, and a copy/store within the
6973 loop.
6974
6975 Enabled by default when -fgcse is enabled.
6976
6977 -fgcse-sm
6978 When -fgcse-sm is enabled, a store motion pass is run after global
6979 common subexpression elimination. This pass attempts to move
6980 stores out of loops. When used in conjunction with -fgcse-lm,
6981 loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load
6982 before the loop and a store after the loop.
6983
6984 Not enabled at any optimization level.
6985
6986 -fgcse-las
6987 When -fgcse-las is enabled, the global common subexpression
6988 elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores
6989 to the same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
6990
6991 Not enabled at any optimization level.
6992
6993 -fgcse-after-reload
6994 When -fgcse-after-reload is enabled, a redundant load elimination
6995 pass is performed after reload. The purpose of this pass is to
6996 clean up redundant spilling.
6997
6998 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
6999
7000 -faggressive-loop-optimizations
7001 This option tells the loop optimizer to use language constraints to
7002 derive bounds for the number of iterations of a loop. This assumes
7003 that loop code does not invoke undefined behavior by for example
7004 causing signed integer overflows or out-of-bound array accesses.
7005 The bounds for the number of iterations of a loop are used to guide
7006 loop unrolling and peeling and loop exit test optimizations. This
7007 option is enabled by default.
7008
7009 -funconstrained-commons
7010 This option tells the compiler that variables declared in common
7011 blocks (e.g. Fortran) may later be overridden with longer trailing
7012 arrays. This prevents certain optimizations that depend on knowing
7013 the array bounds.
7014
7015 -fcrossjumping
7016 Perform cross-jumping transformation. This transformation unifies
7017 equivalent code and saves code size. The resulting code may or may
7018 not perform better than without cross-jumping.
7019
7020 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7021
7022 -fauto-inc-dec
7023 Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.
7024 This pass is always skipped on architectures that do not have
7025 instructions to support this. Enabled by default at -O and higher
7026 on architectures that support this.
7027
7028 -fdce
7029 Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL. Enabled by default at
7030 -O and higher.
7031
7032 -fdse
7033 Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL. Enabled by default at
7034 -O and higher.
7035
7036 -fif-conversion
7037 Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less
7038 equivalents. This includes use of conditional moves, min, max, set
7039 flags and abs instructions, and some tricks doable by standard
7040 arithmetics. The use of conditional execution on chips where it is
7041 available is controlled by -fif-conversion2.
7042
7043 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os, but not with -Og.
7044
7045 -fif-conversion2
7046 Use conditional execution (where available) to transform
7047 conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.
7048
7049 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os, but not with -Og.
7050
7051 -fdeclone-ctor-dtor
7052 The C++ ABI requires multiple entry points for constructors and
7053 destructors: one for a base subobject, one for a complete object,
7054 and one for a virtual destructor that calls operator delete
7055 afterwards. For a hierarchy with virtual bases, the base and
7056 complete variants are clones, which means two copies of the
7057 function. With this option, the base and complete variants are
7058 changed to be thunks that call a common implementation.
7059
7060 Enabled by -Os.
7061
7062 -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
7063 Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers, and
7064 that no code or data element resides at address zero. This option
7065 enables simple constant folding optimizations at all optimization
7066 levels. In addition, other optimization passes in GCC use this
7067 flag to control global dataflow analyses that eliminate useless
7068 checks for null pointers; these assume that a memory access to
7069 address zero always results in a trap, so that if a pointer is
7070 checked after it has already been dereferenced, it cannot be null.
7071
7072 Note however that in some environments this assumption is not true.
7073 Use -fno-delete-null-pointer-checks to disable this optimization
7074 for programs that depend on that behavior.
7075
7076 This option is enabled by default on most targets. On Nios II ELF,
7077 it defaults to off. On AVR, CR16, and MSP430, this option is
7078 completely disabled.
7079
7080 Passes that use the dataflow information are enabled independently
7081 at different optimization levels.
7082
7083 -fdevirtualize
7084 Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.
7085 This is done both within a procedure and interprocedurally as part
7086 of indirect inlining (-findirect-inlining) and interprocedural
7087 constant propagation (-fipa-cp). Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7088
7089 -fdevirtualize-speculatively
7090 Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to speculative direct
7091 calls. Based on the analysis of the type inheritance graph,
7092 determine for a given call the set of likely targets. If the set is
7093 small, preferably of size 1, change the call into a conditional
7094 deciding between direct and indirect calls. The speculative calls
7095 enable more optimizations, such as inlining. When they seem
7096 useless after further optimization, they are converted back into
7097 original form.
7098
7099 -fdevirtualize-at-ltrans
7100 Stream extra information needed for aggressive devirtualization
7101 when running the link-time optimizer in local transformation mode.
7102 This option enables more devirtualization but significantly
7103 increases the size of streamed data. For this reason it is disabled
7104 by default.
7105
7106 -fexpensive-optimizations
7107 Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively
7108 expensive.
7109
7110 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7111
7112 -free
7113 Attempt to remove redundant extension instructions. This is
7114 especially helpful for the x86-64 architecture, which implicitly
7115 zero-extends in 64-bit registers after writing to their lower
7116 32-bit half.
7117
7118 Enabled for Alpha, AArch64 and x86 at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7119
7120 -fno-lifetime-dse
7121 In C++ the value of an object is only affected by changes within
7122 its lifetime: when the constructor begins, the object has an
7123 indeterminate value, and any changes during the lifetime of the
7124 object are dead when the object is destroyed. Normally dead store
7125 elimination will take advantage of this; if your code relies on the
7126 value of the object storage persisting beyond the lifetime of the
7127 object, you can use this flag to disable this optimization. To
7128 preserve stores before the constructor starts (e.g. because your
7129 operator new clears the object storage) but still treat the object
7130 as dead after the destructor you, can use -flifetime-dse=1. The
7131 default behavior can be explicitly selected with -flifetime-dse=2.
7132 -flifetime-dse=0 is equivalent to -fno-lifetime-dse.
7133
7134 -flive-range-shrinkage
7135 Attempt to decrease register pressure through register live range
7136 shrinkage. This is helpful for fast processors with small or
7137 moderate size register sets.
7138
7139 -fira-algorithm=algorithm
7140 Use the specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register
7141 allocator. The algorithm argument can be priority, which specifies
7142 Chow's priority coloring, or CB, which specifies Chaitin-Briggs
7143 coloring. Chaitin-Briggs coloring is not implemented for all
7144 architectures, but for those targets that do support it, it is the
7145 default because it generates better code.
7146
7147 -fira-region=region
7148 Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator. The
7149 region argument should be one of the following:
7150
7151 all Use all loops as register allocation regions. This can give
7152 the best results for machines with a small and/or irregular
7153 register set.
7154
7155 mixed
7156 Use all loops except for loops with small register pressure as
7157 the regions. This value usually gives the best results in most
7158 cases and for most architectures, and is enabled by default
7159 when compiling with optimization for speed (-O, -O2, ...).
7160
7161 one Use all functions as a single region. This typically results
7162 in the smallest code size, and is enabled by default for -Os or
7163 -O0.
7164
7165 -fira-hoist-pressure
7166 Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in the code hoisting pass for
7167 decisions to hoist expressions. This option usually results in
7168 smaller code, but it can slow the compiler down.
7169
7170 This option is enabled at level -Os for all targets.
7171
7172 -fira-loop-pressure
7173 Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to
7174 move loop invariants. This option usually results in generation of
7175 faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>=
7176 32 registers), but it can slow the compiler down.
7177
7178 This option is enabled at level -O3 for some targets.
7179
7180 -fno-ira-share-save-slots
7181 Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard
7182 registers living through a call. Each hard register gets a
7183 separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
7184 larger.
7185
7186 -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
7187 Disable sharing of stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.
7188 Each pseudo-register that does not get a hard register gets a
7189 separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
7190 larger.
7191
7192 -flra-remat
7193 Enable CFG-sensitive rematerialization in LRA. Instead of loading
7194 values of spilled pseudos, LRA tries to rematerialize (recalculate)
7195 values if it is profitable.
7196
7197 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7198
7199 -fdelayed-branch
7200 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder
7201 instructions to exploit instruction slots available after delayed
7202 branch instructions.
7203
7204 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os, but not at -Og.
7205
7206 -fschedule-insns
7207 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder
7208 instructions to eliminate execution stalls due to required data
7209 being unavailable. This helps machines that have slow floating
7210 point or memory load instructions by allowing other instructions to
7211 be issued until the result of the load or floating-point
7212 instruction is required.
7213
7214 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
7215
7216 -fschedule-insns2
7217 Similar to -fschedule-insns, but requests an additional pass of
7218 instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done.
7219 This is especially useful on machines with a relatively small
7220 number of registers and where memory load instructions take more
7221 than one cycle.
7222
7223 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7224
7225 -fno-sched-interblock
7226 Disable instruction scheduling across basic blocks, which is
7227 normally enabled when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.
7228 with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.
7229
7230 -fno-sched-spec
7231 Disable speculative motion of non-load instructions, which is
7232 normally enabled when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.
7233 with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.
7234
7235 -fsched-pressure
7236 Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before register
7237 allocation. This only makes sense when scheduling before register
7238 allocation is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or
7239 higher. Usage of this option can improve the generated code and
7240 decrease its size by preventing register pressure increase above
7241 the number of available hard registers and subsequent spills in
7242 register allocation.
7243
7244 -fsched-spec-load
7245 Allow speculative motion of some load instructions. This only
7246 makes sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e. with
7247 -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.
7248
7249 -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
7250 Allow speculative motion of more load instructions. This only
7251 makes sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e. with
7252 -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.
7253
7254 -fsched-stalled-insns
7255 -fsched-stalled-insns=n
7256 Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the
7257 queue of stalled insns into the ready list during the second
7258 scheduling pass. -fno-sched-stalled-insns means that no insns are
7259 moved prematurely, -fsched-stalled-insns=0 means there is no limit
7260 on how many queued insns can be moved prematurely.
7261 -fsched-stalled-insns without a value is equivalent to
7262 -fsched-stalled-insns=1.
7263
7264 -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
7265 -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=n
7266 Define how many insn groups (cycles) are examined for a dependency
7267 on a stalled insn that is a candidate for premature removal from
7268 the queue of stalled insns. This has an effect only during the
7269 second scheduling pass, and only if -fsched-stalled-insns is used.
7270 -fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep is equivalent to
7271 -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0. -fsched-stalled-insns-dep without a
7272 value is equivalent to -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1.
7273
7274 -fsched2-use-superblocks
7275 When scheduling after register allocation, use superblock
7276 scheduling. This allows motion across basic block boundaries,
7277 resulting in faster schedules. This option is experimental, as not
7278 all machine descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough
7279 to avoid unreliable results from the algorithm.
7280
7281 This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation,
7282 i.e. with -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.
7283
7284 -fsched-group-heuristic
7285 Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic favors
7286 the instruction that belongs to a schedule group. This is enabled
7287 by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns
7288 or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.
7289
7290 -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
7291 Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler. This
7292 heuristic favors instructions on the critical path. This is
7293 enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with
7294 -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.
7295
7296 -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
7297 Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.
7298 This heuristic favors speculative instructions with greater
7299 dependency weakness. This is enabled by default when scheduling is
7300 enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2
7301 or higher.
7302
7303 -fsched-rank-heuristic
7304 Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic favors
7305 the instruction belonging to a basic block with greater size or
7306 frequency. This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
7307 i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or
7308 higher.
7309
7310 -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
7311 Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler. This
7312 heuristic favors the instruction that is less dependent on the last
7313 instruction scheduled. This is enabled by default when scheduling
7314 is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at
7315 -O2 or higher.
7316
7317 -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
7318 Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler. This
7319 heuristic favors the instruction that has more instructions
7320 depending on it. This is enabled by default when scheduling is
7321 enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2
7322 or higher.
7323
7324 -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
7325 Modulo scheduling is performed before traditional scheduling. If a
7326 loop is modulo scheduled, later scheduling passes may change its
7327 schedule. Use this option to control that behavior.
7328
7329 -fselective-scheduling
7330 Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.
7331 Selective scheduling runs instead of the first scheduler pass.
7332
7333 -fselective-scheduling2
7334 Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.
7335 Selective scheduling runs instead of the second scheduler pass.
7336
7337 -fsel-sched-pipelining
7338 Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective
7339 scheduling. This option has no effect unless one of
7340 -fselective-scheduling or -fselective-scheduling2 is turned on.
7341
7342 -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
7343 When pipelining loops during selective scheduling, also pipeline
7344 outer loops. This option has no effect unless
7345 -fsel-sched-pipelining is turned on.
7346
7347 -fsemantic-interposition
7348 Some object formats, like ELF, allow interposing of symbols by the
7349 dynamic linker. This means that for symbols exported from the DSO,
7350 the compiler cannot perform interprocedural propagation, inlining
7351 and other optimizations in anticipation that the function or
7352 variable in question may change. While this feature is useful, for
7353 example, to rewrite memory allocation functions by a debugging
7354 implementation, it is expensive in the terms of code quality. With
7355 -fno-semantic-interposition the compiler assumes that if
7356 interposition happens for functions the overwriting function will
7357 have precisely the same semantics (and side effects). Similarly if
7358 interposition happens for variables, the constructor of the
7359 variable will be the same. The flag has no effect for functions
7360 explicitly declared inline (where it is never allowed for
7361 interposition to change semantics) and for symbols explicitly
7362 declared weak.
7363
7364 -fshrink-wrap
7365 Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need
7366 it, rather than at the top of the function. This flag is enabled
7367 by default at -O and higher.
7368
7369 -fshrink-wrap-separate
7370 Shrink-wrap separate parts of the prologue and epilogue separately,
7371 so that those parts are only executed when needed. This option is
7372 on by default, but has no effect unless -fshrink-wrap is also
7373 turned on and the target supports this.
7374
7375 -fcaller-saves
7376 Enable allocation of values to registers that are clobbered by
7377 function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore
7378 the registers around such calls. Such allocation is done only when
7379 it seems to result in better code.
7380
7381 This option is always enabled by default on certain machines,
7382 usually those which have no call-preserved registers to use
7383 instead.
7384
7385 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7386
7387 -fcombine-stack-adjustments
7388 Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory
7389 references and then tries to find ways to combine them.
7390
7391 Enabled by default at -O1 and higher.
7392
7393 -fipa-ra
7394 Use caller save registers for allocation if those registers are not
7395 used by any called function. In that case it is not necessary to
7396 save and restore them around calls. This is only possible if
7397 called functions are part of same compilation unit as current
7398 function and they are compiled before it.
7399
7400 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os, however the option is disabled if
7401 generated code will be instrumented for profiling (-p, or -pg) or
7402 if callee's register usage cannot be known exactly (this happens on
7403 targets that do not expose prologues and epilogues in RTL).
7404
7405 -fconserve-stack
7406 Attempt to minimize stack usage. The compiler attempts to use less
7407 stack space, even if that makes the program slower. This option
7408 implies setting the large-stack-frame parameter to 100 and the
7409 large-stack-frame-growth parameter to 400.
7410
7411 -ftree-reassoc
7412 Perform reassociation on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7413 -O and higher.
7414
7415 -fcode-hoisting
7416 Perform code hoisting. Code hoisting tries to move the evaluation
7417 of expressions executed on all paths to the function exit as early
7418 as possible. This is especially useful as a code size
7419 optimization, but it often helps for code speed as well. This flag
7420 is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.
7421
7422 -ftree-pre
7423 Perform partial redundancy elimination (PRE) on trees. This flag
7424 is enabled by default at -O2 and -O3.
7425
7426 -ftree-partial-pre
7427 Make partial redundancy elimination (PRE) more aggressive. This
7428 flag is enabled by default at -O3.
7429
7430 -ftree-forwprop
7431 Perform forward propagation on trees. This flag is enabled by
7432 default at -O and higher.
7433
7434 -ftree-fre
7435 Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees. The difference
7436 between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions that are
7437 computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation. This
7438 analysis is faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
7439 This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.
7440
7441 -ftree-phiprop
7442 Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees. This
7443 pass is enabled by default at -O and higher.
7444
7445 -fhoist-adjacent-loads
7446 Speculatively hoist loads from both branches of an if-then-else if
7447 the loads are from adjacent locations in the same structure and the
7448 target architecture has a conditional move instruction. This flag
7449 is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.
7450
7451 -ftree-copy-prop
7452 Perform copy propagation on trees. This pass eliminates
7453 unnecessary copy operations. This flag is enabled by default at -O
7454 and higher.
7455
7456 -fipa-pure-const
7457 Discover which functions are pure or constant. Enabled by default
7458 at -O and higher.
7459
7460 -fipa-reference
7461 Discover which static variables do not escape the compilation unit.
7462 Enabled by default at -O and higher.
7463
7464 -fipa-reference-addressable
7465 Discover read-only, write-only and non-addressable static
7466 variables. Enabled by default at -O and higher.
7467
7468 -fipa-stack-alignment
7469 Reduce stack alignment on call sites if possible. Enabled by
7470 default.
7471
7472 -fipa-pta
7473 Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural
7474 modification and reference analysis. This option can cause
7475 excessive memory and compile-time usage on large compilation units.
7476 It is not enabled by default at any optimization level.
7477
7478 -fipa-profile
7479 Perform interprocedural profile propagation. The functions called
7480 only from cold functions are marked as cold. Also functions
7481 executed once (such as "cold", "noreturn", static constructors or
7482 destructors) are identified. Cold functions and loop less parts of
7483 functions executed once are then optimized for size. Enabled by
7484 default at -O and higher.
7485
7486 -fipa-cp
7487 Perform interprocedural constant propagation. This optimization
7488 analyzes the program to determine when values passed to functions
7489 are constants and then optimizes accordingly. This optimization
7490 can substantially increase performance if the application has
7491 constants passed to functions. This flag is enabled by default at
7492 -O2, -Os and -O3. It is also enabled by -fprofile-use and
7493 -fauto-profile.
7494
7495 -fipa-cp-clone
7496 Perform function cloning to make interprocedural constant
7497 propagation stronger. When enabled, interprocedural constant
7498 propagation performs function cloning when externally visible
7499 function can be called with constant arguments. Because this
7500 optimization can create multiple copies of functions, it may
7501 significantly increase code size (see --param
7502 ipcp-unit-growth=value). This flag is enabled by default at -O3.
7503 It is also enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7504
7505 -fipa-bit-cp
7506 When enabled, perform interprocedural bitwise constant propagation.
7507 This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and by -fprofile-use and
7508 -fauto-profile. It requires that -fipa-cp is enabled.
7509
7510 -fipa-vrp
7511 When enabled, perform interprocedural propagation of value ranges.
7512 This flag is enabled by default at -O2. It requires that -fipa-cp
7513 is enabled.
7514
7515 -fipa-icf
7516 Perform Identical Code Folding for functions and read-only
7517 variables. The optimization reduces code size and may disturb
7518 unwind stacks by replacing a function by equivalent one with a
7519 different name. The optimization works more effectively with link-
7520 time optimization enabled.
7521
7522 Although the behavior is similar to the Gold Linker's ICF
7523 optimization, GCC ICF works on different levels and thus the
7524 optimizations are not same - there are equivalences that are found
7525 only by GCC and equivalences found only by Gold.
7526
7527 This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and -Os.
7528
7529 -flive-patching=level
7530 Control GCC's optimizations to produce output suitable for live-
7531 patching.
7532
7533 If the compiler's optimization uses a function's body or
7534 information extracted from its body to optimize/change another
7535 function, the latter is called an impacted function of the former.
7536 If a function is patched, its impacted functions should be patched
7537 too.
7538
7539 The impacted functions are determined by the compiler's
7540 interprocedural optimizations. For example, a caller is impacted
7541 when inlining a function into its caller, cloning a function and
7542 changing its caller to call this new clone, or extracting a
7543 function's pureness/constness information to optimize its direct or
7544 indirect callers, etc.
7545
7546 Usually, the more IPA optimizations enabled, the larger the number
7547 of impacted functions for each function. In order to control the
7548 number of impacted functions and more easily compute the list of
7549 impacted function, IPA optimizations can be partially enabled at
7550 two different levels.
7551
7552 The level argument should be one of the following:
7553
7554 inline-clone
7555 Only enable inlining and cloning optimizations, which includes
7556 inlining, cloning, interprocedural scalar replacement of
7557 aggregates and partial inlining. As a result, when patching a
7558 function, all its callers and its clones' callers are impacted,
7559 therefore need to be patched as well.
7560
7561 -flive-patching=inline-clone disables the following
7562 optimization flags: -fwhole-program -fipa-pta -fipa-reference
7563 -fipa-ra -fipa-icf -fipa-icf-functions -fipa-icf-variables
7564 -fipa-bit-cp -fipa-vrp -fipa-pure-const
7565 -fipa-reference-addressable -fipa-stack-alignment
7566
7567 inline-only-static
7568 Only enable inlining of static functions. As a result, when
7569 patching a static function, all its callers are impacted and so
7570 need to be patched as well.
7571
7572 In addition to all the flags that -flive-patching=inline-clone
7573 disables, -flive-patching=inline-only-static disables the
7574 following additional optimization flags: -fipa-cp-clone
7575 -fipa-sra -fpartial-inlining -fipa-cp
7576
7577 When -flive-patching is specified without any value, the default
7578 value is inline-clone.
7579
7580 This flag is disabled by default.
7581
7582 Note that -flive-patching is not supported with link-time
7583 optimization (-flto).
7584
7585 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
7586 Detect paths that trigger erroneous or undefined behavior due to
7587 dereferencing a null pointer. Isolate those paths from the main
7588 control flow and turn the statement with erroneous or undefined
7589 behavior into a trap. This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and
7590 higher and depends on -fdelete-null-pointer-checks also being
7591 enabled.
7592
7593 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute
7594 Detect paths that trigger erroneous or undefined behavior due to a
7595 null value being used in a way forbidden by a "returns_nonnull" or
7596 "nonnull" attribute. Isolate those paths from the main control
7597 flow and turn the statement with erroneous or undefined behavior
7598 into a trap. This is not currently enabled, but may be enabled by
7599 -O2 in the future.
7600
7601 -ftree-sink
7602 Perform forward store motion on trees. This flag is enabled by
7603 default at -O and higher.
7604
7605 -ftree-bit-ccp
7606 Perform sparse conditional bit constant propagation on trees and
7607 propagate pointer alignment information. This pass only operates
7608 on local scalar variables and is enabled by default at -O1 and
7609 higher, except for -Og. It requires that -ftree-ccp is enabled.
7610
7611 -ftree-ccp
7612 Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.
7613 This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by
7614 default at -O and higher.
7615
7616 -fssa-backprop
7617 Propagate information about uses of a value up the definition chain
7618 in order to simplify the definitions. For example, this pass
7619 strips sign operations if the sign of a value never matters. The
7620 flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.
7621
7622 -fssa-phiopt
7623 Perform pattern matching on SSA PHI nodes to optimize conditional
7624 code. This pass is enabled by default at -O1 and higher, except
7625 for -Og.
7626
7627 -ftree-switch-conversion
7628 Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to
7629 initializations from a scalar array. This flag is enabled by
7630 default at -O2 and higher.
7631
7632 -ftree-tail-merge
7633 Look for identical code sequences. When found, replace one with a
7634 jump to the other. This optimization is known as tail merging or
7635 cross jumping. This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.
7636 The compilation time in this pass can be limited using max-tail-
7637 merge-comparisons parameter and max-tail-merge-iterations
7638 parameter.
7639
7640 -ftree-dce
7641 Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees. This flag is enabled
7642 by default at -O and higher.
7643
7644 -ftree-builtin-call-dce
7645 Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to built-
7646 in functions that may set "errno" but are otherwise free of side
7647 effects. This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher if -Os
7648 is not also specified.
7649
7650 -ftree-dominator-opts
7651 Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
7652 propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and
7653 expression simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.
7654 This also performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This
7655 flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.
7656
7657 -ftree-dse
7658 Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees. A dead store is a
7659 store into a memory location that is later overwritten by another
7660 store without any intervening loads. In this case the earlier
7661 store can be deleted. This flag is enabled by default at -O and
7662 higher.
7663
7664 -ftree-ch
7665 Perform loop header copying on trees. This is beneficial since it
7666 increases effectiveness of code motion optimizations. It also
7667 saves one jump. This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.
7668 It is not enabled for -Os, since it usually increases code size.
7669
7670 -ftree-loop-optimize
7671 Perform loop optimizations on trees. This flag is enabled by
7672 default at -O and higher.
7673
7674 -ftree-loop-linear
7675 -floop-strip-mine
7676 -floop-block
7677 Perform loop nest optimizations. Same as -floop-nest-optimize. To
7678 use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured with
7679 --with-isl to enable the Graphite loop transformation
7680 infrastructure.
7681
7682 -fgraphite-identity
7683 Enable the identity transformation for graphite. For every SCoP we
7684 generate the polyhedral representation and transform it back to
7685 gimple. Using -fgraphite-identity we can check the costs or
7686 benefits of the GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation. Some
7687 minimal optimizations are also performed by the code generator isl,
7688 like index splitting and dead code elimination in loops.
7689
7690 -floop-nest-optimize
7691 Enable the isl based loop nest optimizer. This is a generic loop
7692 nest optimizer based on the Pluto optimization algorithms. It
7693 calculates a loop structure optimized for data-locality and
7694 parallelism. This option is experimental.
7695
7696 -floop-parallelize-all
7697 Use the Graphite data dependence analysis to identify loops that
7698 can be parallelized. Parallelize all the loops that can be
7699 analyzed to not contain loop carried dependences without checking
7700 that it is profitable to parallelize the loops.
7701
7702 -ftree-coalesce-vars
7703 While transforming the program out of the SSA representation,
7704 attempt to reduce copying by coalescing versions of different user-
7705 defined variables, instead of just compiler temporaries. This may
7706 severely limit the ability to debug an optimized program compiled
7707 with -fno-var-tracking-assignments. In the negated form, this flag
7708 prevents SSA coalescing of user variables. This option is enabled
7709 by default if optimization is enabled, and it does very little
7710 otherwise.
7711
7712 -ftree-loop-if-convert
7713 Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to
7714 branch-less equivalents. The intent is to remove control-flow from
7715 the innermost loops in order to improve the ability of the
7716 vectorization pass to handle these loops. This is enabled by
7717 default if vectorization is enabled.
7718
7719 -ftree-loop-distribution
7720 Perform loop distribution. This flag can improve cache performance
7721 on big loop bodies and allow further loop optimizations, like
7722 parallelization or vectorization, to take place. For example, the
7723 loop
7724
7725 DO I = 1, N
7726 A(I) = B(I) + C
7727 D(I) = E(I) * F
7728 ENDDO
7729
7730 is transformed to
7731
7732 DO I = 1, N
7733 A(I) = B(I) + C
7734 ENDDO
7735 DO I = 1, N
7736 D(I) = E(I) * F
7737 ENDDO
7738
7739 This flag is enabled by default at -O3. It is also enabled by
7740 -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7741
7742 -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
7743 Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated
7744 with calls to a library. This flag is enabled by default at -O3,
7745 and by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7746
7747 This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call
7748 to memset zero. For example, the loop
7749
7750 DO I = 1, N
7751 A(I) = 0
7752 B(I) = A(I) + I
7753 ENDDO
7754
7755 is transformed to
7756
7757 DO I = 1, N
7758 A(I) = 0
7759 ENDDO
7760 DO I = 1, N
7761 B(I) = A(I) + I
7762 ENDDO
7763
7764 and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset
7765 zero. This flag is enabled by default at -O3. It is also enabled
7766 by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7767
7768 -floop-interchange
7769 Perform loop interchange outside of graphite. This flag can
7770 improve cache performance on loop nest and allow further loop
7771 optimizations, like vectorization, to take place. For example, the
7772 loop
7773
7774 for (int i = 0; i < N; i++)
7775 for (int j = 0; j < N; j++)
7776 for (int k = 0; k < N; k++)
7777 c[i][j] = c[i][j] + a[i][k]*b[k][j];
7778
7779 is transformed to
7780
7781 for (int i = 0; i < N; i++)
7782 for (int k = 0; k < N; k++)
7783 for (int j = 0; j < N; j++)
7784 c[i][j] = c[i][j] + a[i][k]*b[k][j];
7785
7786 This flag is enabled by default at -O3. It is also enabled by
7787 -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7788
7789 -floop-unroll-and-jam
7790 Apply unroll and jam transformations on feasible loops. In a loop
7791 nest this unrolls the outer loop by some factor and fuses the
7792 resulting multiple inner loops. This flag is enabled by default at
7793 -O3. It is also enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7794
7795 -ftree-loop-im
7796 Perform loop invariant motion on trees. This pass moves only
7797 invariants that are hard to handle at RTL level (function calls,
7798 operations that expand to nontrivial sequences of insns). With
7799 -funswitch-loops it also moves operands of conditions that are
7800 invariant out of the loop, so that we can use just trivial
7801 invariantness analysis in loop unswitching. The pass also includes
7802 store motion.
7803
7804 -ftree-loop-ivcanon
7805 Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in loops for
7806 which determining number of iterations requires complicated
7807 analysis. Later optimizations then may determine the number
7808 easily. Useful especially in connection with unrolling.
7809
7810 -ftree-scev-cprop
7811 Perform final value replacement. If a variable is modified in a
7812 loop in such a way that its value when exiting the loop can be
7813 determined using only its initial value and the number of loop
7814 iterations, replace uses of the final value by such a computation,
7815 provided it is sufficiently cheap. This reduces data dependencies
7816 and may allow further simplifications. Enabled by default at -O
7817 and higher.
7818
7819 -fivopts
7820 Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction,
7821 induction variable merging and induction variable elimination) on
7822 trees.
7823
7824 -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
7825 Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n
7826 threads. This is only possible for loops whose iterations are
7827 independent and can be arbitrarily reordered. The optimization is
7828 only profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-
7829 intensive, rather than constrained e.g. by memory bandwidth. This
7830 option implies -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets that
7831 have support for -pthread.
7832
7833 -ftree-pta
7834 Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees. This flag is
7835 enabled by default at -O1 and higher, except for -Og.
7836
7837 -ftree-sra
7838 Perform scalar replacement of aggregates. This pass replaces
7839 structure references with scalars to prevent committing structures
7840 to memory too early. This flag is enabled by default at -O1 and
7841 higher, except for -Og.
7842
7843 -fstore-merging
7844 Perform merging of narrow stores to consecutive memory addresses.
7845 This pass merges contiguous stores of immediate values narrower
7846 than a word into fewer wider stores to reduce the number of
7847 instructions. This is enabled by default at -O2 and higher as well
7848 as -Os.
7849
7850 -ftree-ter
7851 Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal
7852 phase. Single use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use
7853 location with their defining expression. This results in non-
7854 GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders much more complex trees to
7855 work on resulting in better RTL generation. This is enabled by
7856 default at -O and higher.
7857
7858 -ftree-slsr
7859 Perform straight-line strength reduction on trees. This recognizes
7860 related expressions involving multiplications and replaces them by
7861 less expensive calculations when possible. This is enabled by
7862 default at -O and higher.
7863
7864 -ftree-vectorize
7865 Perform vectorization on trees. This flag enables
7866 -ftree-loop-vectorize and -ftree-slp-vectorize if not explicitly
7867 specified.
7868
7869 -ftree-loop-vectorize
7870 Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by
7871 default at -O3 and by -ftree-vectorize, -fprofile-use, and
7872 -fauto-profile.
7873
7874 -ftree-slp-vectorize
7875 Perform basic block vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by
7876 default at -O3 and by -ftree-vectorize, -fprofile-use, and
7877 -fauto-profile.
7878
7879 -fvect-cost-model=model
7880 Alter the cost model used for vectorization. The model argument
7881 should be one of unlimited, dynamic or cheap. With the unlimited
7882 model the vectorized code-path is assumed to be profitable while
7883 with the dynamic model a runtime check guards the vectorized code-
7884 path to enable it only for iteration counts that will likely
7885 execute faster than when executing the original scalar loop. The
7886 cheap model disables vectorization of loops where doing so would be
7887 cost prohibitive for example due to required runtime checks for
7888 data dependence or alignment but otherwise is equal to the dynamic
7889 model. The default cost model depends on other optimization flags
7890 and is either dynamic or cheap.
7891
7892 -fsimd-cost-model=model
7893 Alter the cost model used for vectorization of loops marked with
7894 the OpenMP simd directive. The model argument should be one of
7895 unlimited, dynamic, cheap. All values of model have the same
7896 meaning as described in -fvect-cost-model and by default a cost
7897 model defined with -fvect-cost-model is used.
7898
7899 -ftree-vrp
7900 Perform Value Range Propagation on trees. This is similar to the
7901 constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values
7902 are propagated. This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary
7903 range checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks. This
7904 is enabled by default at -O2 and higher. Null pointer check
7905 elimination is only done if -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is
7906 enabled.
7907
7908 -fsplit-paths
7909 Split paths leading to loop backedges. This can improve dead code
7910 elimination and common subexpression elimination. This is enabled
7911 by default at -O3 and above.
7912
7913 -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7914 Enables expression of values of induction variables in later
7915 iterations of the unrolled loop using the value in the first
7916 iteration. This breaks long dependency chains, thus improving
7917 efficiency of the scheduling passes.
7918
7919 A combination of -fweb and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
7920 same effect. However, that is not reliable in cases where the loop
7921 body is more complicated than a single basic block. It also does
7922 not work at all on some architectures due to restrictions in the
7923 CSE pass.
7924
7925 This optimization is enabled by default.
7926
7927 -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7928 With this option, the compiler creates multiple copies of some
7929 local variables when unrolling a loop, which can result in superior
7930 code.
7931
7932 -fpartial-inlining
7933 Inline parts of functions. This option has any effect only when
7934 inlining itself is turned on by the -finline-functions or
7935 -finline-small-functions options.
7936
7937 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
7938
7939 -fpredictive-commoning
7940 Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing
7941 computations (especially memory loads and stores) performed in
7942 previous iterations of loops.
7943
7944 This option is enabled at level -O3. It is also enabled by
7945 -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
7946
7947 -fprefetch-loop-arrays
7948 If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to
7949 prefetch memory to improve the performance of loops that access
7950 large arrays.
7951
7952 This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
7953 dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
7954
7955 Disabled at level -Os.
7956
7957 -fno-printf-return-value
7958 Do not substitute constants for known return value of formatted
7959 output functions such as "sprintf", "snprintf", "vsprintf", and
7960 "vsnprintf" (but not "printf" of "fprintf"). This transformation
7961 allows GCC to optimize or even eliminate branches based on the
7962 known return value of these functions called with arguments that
7963 are either constant, or whose values are known to be in a range
7964 that makes determining the exact return value possible. For
7965 example, when -fprintf-return-value is in effect, both the branch
7966 and the body of the "if" statement (but not the call to "snprint")
7967 can be optimized away when "i" is a 32-bit or smaller integer
7968 because the return value is guaranteed to be at most 8.
7969
7970 char buf[9];
7971 if (snprintf (buf, "%08x", i) >= sizeof buf)
7972 ...
7973
7974 The -fprintf-return-value option relies on other optimizations and
7975 yields best results with -O2 and above. It works in tandem with
7976 the -Wformat-overflow and -Wformat-truncation options. The
7977 -fprintf-return-value option is enabled by default.
7978
7979 -fno-peephole
7980 -fno-peephole2
7981 Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations. The
7982 difference between -fno-peephole and -fno-peephole2 is in how they
7983 are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
7984 other, a few use both.
7985
7986 -fpeephole is enabled by default. -fpeephole2 enabled at levels
7987 -O2, -O3, -Os.
7988
7989 -fno-guess-branch-probability
7990 Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
7991
7992 GCC uses heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are not
7993 provided by profiling feedback (-fprofile-arcs). These heuristics
7994 are based on the control flow graph. If some branch probabilities
7995 are specified by "__builtin_expect", then the heuristics are used
7996 to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow
7997 graph, taking the "__builtin_expect" info into account. The
7998 interactions between the heuristics and "__builtin_expect" can be
7999 complex, and in some cases, it may be useful to disable the
8000 heuristics so that the effects of "__builtin_expect" are easier to
8001 understand.
8002
8003 It is also possible to specify expected probability of the
8004 expression with "__builtin_expect_with_probability" built-in
8005 function.
8006
8007 The default is -fguess-branch-probability at levels -O, -O2, -O3,
8008 -Os.
8009
8010 -freorder-blocks
8011 Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce
8012 number of taken branches and improve code locality.
8013
8014 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.
8015
8016 -freorder-blocks-algorithm=algorithm
8017 Use the specified algorithm for basic block reordering. The
8018 algorithm argument can be simple, which does not increase code size
8019 (except sometimes due to secondary effects like alignment), or stc,
8020 the "software trace cache" algorithm, which tries to put all often
8021 executed code together, minimizing the number of branches executed
8022 by making extra copies of code.
8023
8024 The default is simple at levels -O, -Os, and stc at levels -O2,
8025 -O3.
8026
8027 -freorder-blocks-and-partition
8028 In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in
8029 order to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold
8030 basic blocks into separate sections of the assembly and .o files,
8031 to improve paging and cache locality performance.
8032
8033 This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
8034 exception handling or unwind tables (on targets using
8035 setjump/longjump or target specific scheme), for linkonce sections,
8036 for functions with a user-defined section attribute and on any
8037 architecture that does not support named sections. When
8038 -fsplit-stack is used this option is not enabled by default (to
8039 avoid linker errors), but may be enabled explicitly (if using a
8040 working linker).
8041
8042 Enabled for x86 at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
8043
8044 -freorder-functions
8045 Reorder functions in the object file in order to improve code
8046 locality. This is implemented by using special subsections
8047 ".text.hot" for most frequently executed functions and
8048 ".text.unlikely" for unlikely executed functions. Reordering is
8049 done by the linker so object file format must support named
8050 sections and linker must place them in a reasonable way.
8051
8052 This option isn't effective unless you either provide profile
8053 feedback (see -fprofile-arcs for details) or manually annotate
8054 functions with "hot" or "cold" attributes.
8055
8056 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
8057
8058 -fstrict-aliasing
8059 Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules
8060 applicable to the language being compiled. For C (and C++), this
8061 activates optimizations based on the type of expressions. In
8062 particular, an object of one type is assumed never to reside at the
8063 same address as an object of a different type, unless the types are
8064 almost the same. For example, an "unsigned int" can alias an
8065 "int", but not a "void*" or a "double". A character type may alias
8066 any other type.
8067
8068 Pay special attention to code like this:
8069
8070 union a_union {
8071 int i;
8072 double d;
8073 };
8074
8075 int f() {
8076 union a_union t;
8077 t.d = 3.0;
8078 return t.i;
8079 }
8080
8081 The practice of reading from a different union member than the one
8082 most recently written to (called "type-punning") is common. Even
8083 with -fstrict-aliasing, type-punning is allowed, provided the
8084 memory is accessed through the union type. So, the code above
8085 works as expected. However, this code might not:
8086
8087 int f() {
8088 union a_union t;
8089 int* ip;
8090 t.d = 3.0;
8091 ip = &t.i;
8092 return *ip;
8093 }
8094
8095 Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting
8096 pointer and dereferencing the result has undefined behavior, even
8097 if the cast uses a union type, e.g.:
8098
8099 int f() {
8100 double d = 3.0;
8101 return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
8102 }
8103
8104 The -fstrict-aliasing option is enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
8105
8106 -falign-functions
8107 -falign-functions=n
8108 -falign-functions=n:m
8109 -falign-functions=n:m:n2
8110 -falign-functions=n:m:n2:m2
8111 Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
8112 n, skipping up to m-1 bytes. This ensures that at least the first
8113 m bytes of the function can be fetched by the CPU without crossing
8114 an n-byte alignment boundary.
8115
8116 If m is not specified, it defaults to n.
8117
8118 Examples: -falign-functions=32 aligns functions to the next 32-byte
8119 boundary, -falign-functions=24 aligns to the next 32-byte boundary
8120 only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less,
8121 -falign-functions=32:7 aligns to the next 32-byte boundary only if
8122 this can be done by skipping 6 bytes or less.
8123
8124 The second pair of n2:m2 values allows you to specify a secondary
8125 alignment: -falign-functions=64:7:32:3 aligns to the next 64-byte
8126 boundary if this can be done by skipping 6 bytes or less, otherwise
8127 aligns to the next 32-byte boundary if this can be done by skipping
8128 2 bytes or less. If m2 is not specified, it defaults to n2.
8129
8130 Some assemblers only support this flag when n is a power of two; in
8131 that case, it is rounded up.
8132
8133 -fno-align-functions and -falign-functions=1 are equivalent and
8134 mean that functions are not aligned.
8135
8136 If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8137 The maximum allowed n option value is 65536.
8138
8139 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
8140
8141 -flimit-function-alignment
8142 If this option is enabled, the compiler tries to avoid
8143 unnecessarily overaligning functions. It attempts to instruct the
8144 assembler to align by the amount specified by -falign-functions,
8145 but not to skip more bytes than the size of the function.
8146
8147 -falign-labels
8148 -falign-labels=n
8149 -falign-labels=n:m
8150 -falign-labels=n:m:n2
8151 -falign-labels=n:m:n2:m2
8152 Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary.
8153
8154 Parameters of this option are analogous to the -falign-functions
8155 option. -fno-align-labels and -falign-labels=1 are equivalent and
8156 mean that labels are not aligned.
8157
8158 If -falign-loops or -falign-jumps are applicable and are greater
8159 than this value, then their values are used instead.
8160
8161 If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
8162 which is very likely to be 1, meaning no alignment. The maximum
8163 allowed n option value is 65536.
8164
8165 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
8166
8167 -falign-loops
8168 -falign-loops=n
8169 -falign-loops=n:m
8170 -falign-loops=n:m:n2
8171 -falign-loops=n:m:n2:m2
8172 Align loops to a power-of-two boundary. If the loops are executed
8173 many times, this makes up for any execution of the dummy padding
8174 instructions.
8175
8176 Parameters of this option are analogous to the -falign-functions
8177 option. -fno-align-loops and -falign-loops=1 are equivalent and
8178 mean that loops are not aligned. The maximum allowed n option
8179 value is 65536.
8180
8181 If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8182
8183 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
8184
8185 -falign-jumps
8186 -falign-jumps=n
8187 -falign-jumps=n:m
8188 -falign-jumps=n:m:n2
8189 -falign-jumps=n:m:n2:m2
8190 Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
8191 where the targets can only be reached by jumping. In this case, no
8192 dummy operations need be executed.
8193
8194 Parameters of this option are analogous to the -falign-functions
8195 option. -fno-align-jumps and -falign-jumps=1 are equivalent and
8196 mean that loops are not aligned.
8197
8198 If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8199 The maximum allowed n option value is 65536.
8200
8201 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.
8202
8203 -funit-at-a-time
8204 This option is left for compatibility reasons. -funit-at-a-time has
8205 no effect, while -fno-unit-at-a-time implies -fno-toplevel-reorder
8206 and -fno-section-anchors.
8207
8208 Enabled by default.
8209
8210 -fno-toplevel-reorder
8211 Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and "asm"
8212 statements. Output them in the same order that they appear in the
8213 input file. When this option is used, unreferenced static
8214 variables are not removed. This option is intended to support
8215 existing code that relies on a particular ordering. For new code,
8216 it is better to use attributes when possible.
8217
8218 -ftoplevel-reorder is the default at -O1 and higher, and also at
8219 -O0 if -fsection-anchors is explicitly requested. Additionally
8220 -fno-toplevel-reorder implies -fno-section-anchors.
8221
8222 -fweb
8223 Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes
8224 and assign each web individual pseudo register. This allows the
8225 register allocation pass to operate on pseudos directly, but also
8226 strengthens several other optimization passes, such as CSE, loop
8227 optimizer and trivial dead code remover. It can, however, make
8228 debugging impossible, since variables no longer stay in a "home
8229 register".
8230
8231 Enabled by default with -funroll-loops.
8232
8233 -fwhole-program
8234 Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole
8235 program being compiled. All public functions and variables with
8236 the exception of "main" and those merged by attribute
8237 "externally_visible" become static functions and in effect are
8238 optimized more aggressively by interprocedural optimizers.
8239
8240 This option should not be used in combination with -flto. Instead
8241 relying on a linker plugin should provide safer and more precise
8242 information.
8243
8244 -flto[=n]
8245 This option runs the standard link-time optimizer. When invoked
8246 with source code, it generates GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal
8247 representations) and writes it to special ELF sections in the
8248 object file. When the object files are linked together, all the
8249 function bodies are read from these ELF sections and instantiated
8250 as if they had been part of the same translation unit.
8251
8252 To use the link-time optimizer, -flto and optimization options
8253 should be specified at compile time and during the final link. It
8254 is recommended that you compile all the files participating in the
8255 same link with the same options and also specify those options at
8256 link time. For example:
8257
8258 gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
8259 gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
8260 gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o
8261
8262 The first two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation of
8263 GIMPLE into special ELF sections inside foo.o and bar.o. The final
8264 invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from foo.o and bar.o, merges
8265 the two files into a single internal image, and compiles the result
8266 as usual. Since both foo.o and bar.o are merged into a single
8267 image, this causes all the interprocedural analyses and
8268 optimizations in GCC to work across the two files as if they were a
8269 single one. This means, for example, that the inliner is able to
8270 inline functions in bar.o into functions in foo.o and vice-versa.
8271
8272 Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:
8273
8274 gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c
8275
8276 The above generates bytecode for foo.c and bar.c, merges them
8277 together into a single GIMPLE representation and optimizes them as
8278 usual to produce myprog.
8279
8280 The important thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time
8281 optimizations you need to use the GCC driver to perform the link
8282 step. GCC automatically performs link-time optimization if any of
8283 the objects involved were compiled with the -flto command-line
8284 option. You can always override the automatic decision to do link-
8285 time optimization by passing -fno-lto to the link command.
8286
8287 To make whole program optimization effective, it is necessary to
8288 make certain whole program assumptions. The compiler needs to know
8289 what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries and
8290 runtime outside of the link-time optimized unit. When supported by
8291 the linker, the linker plugin (see -fuse-linker-plugin) passes
8292 information to the compiler about used and externally visible
8293 symbols. When the linker plugin is not available, -fwhole-program
8294 should be used to allow the compiler to make these assumptions,
8295 which leads to more aggressive optimization decisions.
8296
8297 When a file is compiled with -flto without -fuse-linker-plugin, the
8298 generated object file is larger than a regular object file because
8299 it contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code (see
8300 -ffat-lto-objects. This means that object files with LTO
8301 information can be linked as normal object files; if -fno-lto is
8302 passed to the linker, no interprocedural optimizations are applied.
8303 Note that when -fno-fat-lto-objects is enabled the compile stage is
8304 faster but you cannot perform a regular, non-LTO link on them.
8305
8306 When producing the final binary, GCC only applies link-time
8307 optimizations to those files that contain bytecode. Therefore, you
8308 can mix and match object files and libraries with GIMPLE bytecodes
8309 and final object code. GCC automatically selects which files to
8310 optimize in LTO mode and which files to link without further
8311 processing.
8312
8313 Generally, options specified at link time override those specified
8314 at compile time, although in some cases GCC attempts to infer link-
8315 time options from the settings used to compile the input files.
8316
8317 If you do not specify an optimization level option -O at link time,
8318 then GCC uses the highest optimization level used when compiling
8319 the object files. Note that it is generally ineffective to specify
8320 an optimization level option only at link time and not at compile
8321 time, for two reasons. First, compiling without optimization
8322 suppresses compiler passes that gather information needed for
8323 effective optimization at link time. Second, some early
8324 optimization passes can be performed only at compile time and not
8325 at link time.
8326
8327 There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when
8328 generating bytecodes, as they need to be used during the final
8329 link. Currently, the following options and their settings are
8330 taken from the first object file that explicitly specifies them:
8331 -fPIC, -fpic, -fpie, -fcommon, -fexceptions, -fnon-call-exceptions,
8332 -fgnu-tm and all the -m target flags.
8333
8334 Certain ABI-changing flags are required to match in all compilation
8335 units, and trying to override this at link time with a conflicting
8336 value is ignored. This includes options such as
8337 -freg-struct-return and -fpcc-struct-return.
8338
8339 Other options such as -ffp-contract, -fno-strict-overflow, -fwrapv,
8340 -fno-trapv or -fno-strict-aliasing are passed through to the link
8341 stage and merged conservatively for conflicting translation units.
8342 Specifically -fno-strict-overflow, -fwrapv and -fno-trapv take
8343 precedence; and for example -ffp-contract=off takes precedence over
8344 -ffp-contract=fast. You can override them at link time.
8345
8346 If LTO encounters objects with C linkage declared with incompatible
8347 types in separate translation units to be linked together
8348 (undefined behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a non-fatal
8349 diagnostic may be issued. The behavior is still undefined at run
8350 time. Similar diagnostics may be raised for other languages.
8351
8352 Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply
8353 interprocedural optimizations on files written in different
8354 languages:
8355
8356 gcc -c -flto foo.c
8357 g++ -c -flto bar.cc
8358 gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
8359 g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran
8360
8361 Notice that the final link is done with g++ to get the C++ runtime
8362 libraries and -lgfortran is added to get the Fortran runtime
8363 libraries. In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you
8364 should use the same link command options as when mixing languages
8365 in a regular (non-LTO) compilation.
8366
8367 If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a library
8368 archive, say libfoo.a, it is possible to extract and use them in an
8369 LTO link if you are using a linker with plugin support. To create
8370 static libraries suitable for LTO, use gcc-ar and gcc-ranlib
8371 instead of ar and ranlib; to show the symbols of object files with
8372 GIMPLE bytecode, use gcc-nm. Those commands require that ar,
8373 ranlib and nm have been compiled with plugin support. At link
8374 time, use the flag -fuse-linker-plugin to ensure that the library
8375 participates in the LTO optimization process:
8376
8377 gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo
8378
8379 With the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed
8380 GIMPLE files from libfoo.a and passes them on to the running GCC to
8381 make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.
8382
8383 If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not
8384 enable the linker plugin, then the objects inside libfoo.a are
8385 extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate in the
8386 LTO optimization process. In order to make a static library
8387 suitable for both LTO optimization and usual linkage, compile its
8388 object files with -flto -ffat-lto-objects.
8389
8390 Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole
8391 program to operate. If the program does not require any symbols to
8392 be exported, it is possible to combine -flto and -fwhole-program to
8393 allow the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive
8394 assumptions which may lead to improved optimization opportunities.
8395 Use of -fwhole-program is not needed when linker plugin is active
8396 (see -fuse-linker-plugin).
8397
8398 The current implementation of LTO makes no attempt to generate
8399 bytecode that is portable between different types of hosts. The
8400 bytecode files are versioned and there is a strict version check,
8401 so bytecode files generated in one version of GCC do not work with
8402 an older or newer version of GCC.
8403
8404 Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of
8405 debugging information on systems other than those using a
8406 combination of ELF and DWARF.
8407
8408 If you specify the optional n, the optimization and code generation
8409 done at link time is executed in parallel using n parallel jobs by
8410 utilizing an installed make program. The environment variable MAKE
8411 may be used to override the program used. The default value for n
8412 is 1.
8413
8414 You can also specify -flto=jobserver to use GNU make's job server
8415 mode to determine the number of parallel jobs. This is useful when
8416 the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel. You
8417 must prepend a + to the command recipe in the parent Makefile for
8418 this to work. This option likely only works if MAKE is GNU make.
8419
8420 -flto-partition=alg
8421 Specify the partitioning algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.
8422 The value is either 1to1 to specify a partitioning mirroring the
8423 original source files or balanced to specify partitioning into
8424 equally sized chunks (whenever possible) or max to create new
8425 partition for every symbol where possible. Specifying none as an
8426 algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely. The
8427 default value is balanced. While 1to1 can be used as an workaround
8428 for various code ordering issues, the max partitioning is intended
8429 for internal testing only. The value one specifies that exactly
8430 one partition should be used while the value none bypasses
8431 partitioning and executes the link-time optimization step directly
8432 from the WPA phase.
8433
8434 -flto-odr-type-merging
8435 Enable streaming of mangled types names of C++ types and their
8436 unification at link time. This increases size of LTO object files,
8437 but enables diagnostics about One Definition Rule violations.
8438
8439 -flto-compression-level=n
8440 This option specifies the level of compression used for
8441 intermediate language written to LTO object files, and is only
8442 meaningful in conjunction with LTO mode (-flto). Valid values are
8443 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression). Values outside this
8444 range are clamped to either 0 or 9. If the option is not given, a
8445 default balanced compression setting is used.
8446
8447 -fuse-linker-plugin
8448 Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization.
8449 This option relies on plugin support in the linker, which is
8450 available in gold or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.
8451
8452 This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE
8453 bytecode out of library archives. This improves the quality of
8454 optimization by exposing more code to the link-time optimizer.
8455 This information specifies what symbols can be accessed externally
8456 (by non-LTO object or during dynamic linking). Resulting code
8457 quality improvements on binaries (and shared libraries that use
8458 hidden visibility) are similar to -fwhole-program. See -flto for a
8459 description of the effect of this flag and how to use it.
8460
8461 This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is
8462 enabled and GCC was configured for use with a linker supporting
8463 plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).
8464
8465 -ffat-lto-objects
8466 Fat LTO objects are object files that contain both the intermediate
8467 language and the object code. This makes them usable for both LTO
8468 linking and normal linking. This option is effective only when
8469 compiling with -flto and is ignored at link time.
8470
8471 -fno-fat-lto-objects improves compilation time over plain LTO, but
8472 requires the complete toolchain to be aware of LTO. It requires a
8473 linker with linker plugin support for basic functionality.
8474 Additionally, nm, ar and ranlib need to support linker plugins to
8475 allow a full-featured build environment (capable of building static
8476 libraries etc). GCC provides the gcc-ar, gcc-nm, gcc-ranlib
8477 wrappers to pass the right options to these tools. With non fat LTO
8478 makefiles need to be modified to use them.
8479
8480 Note that modern binutils provide plugin auto-load mechanism.
8481 Installing the linker plugin into $libdir/bfd-plugins has the same
8482 effect as usage of the command wrappers (gcc-ar, gcc-nm and gcc-
8483 ranlib).
8484
8485 The default is -fno-fat-lto-objects on targets with linker plugin
8486 support.
8487
8488 -fcompare-elim
8489 After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction
8490 splitting, identify arithmetic instructions that compute processor
8491 flags similar to a comparison operation based on that arithmetic.
8492 If possible, eliminate the explicit comparison operation.
8493
8494 This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly
8495 represent the comparison operation before register allocation is
8496 complete.
8497
8498 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.
8499
8500 -fcprop-registers
8501 After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction
8502 splitting, perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce
8503 scheduling dependencies and occasionally eliminate the copy.
8504
8505 Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.
8506
8507 -fprofile-correction
8508 Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded
8509 programs may be inconsistent due to missed counter updates. When
8510 this option is specified, GCC uses heuristics to correct or smooth
8511 out such inconsistencies. By default, GCC emits an error message
8512 when an inconsistent profile is detected.
8513
8514 This option is enabled by -fauto-profile.
8515
8516 -fprofile-use
8517 -fprofile-use=path
8518 Enable profile feedback-directed optimizations, and the following
8519 optimizations, many of which are generally profitable only with
8520 profile feedback available:
8521
8522 -fbranch-probabilities -fprofile-values -funroll-loops
8523 -fpeel-loops -ftracer -fvpt -finline-functions -fipa-cp
8524 -fipa-cp-clone -fipa-bit-cp -fpredictive-commoning -fsplit-loops
8525 -funswitch-loops -fgcse-after-reload -ftree-loop-vectorize
8526 -ftree-slp-vectorize -fvect-cost-model=dynamic
8527 -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns -fprofile-reorder-functions
8528
8529 Before you can use this option, you must first generate profiling
8530 information.
8531
8532 By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do
8533 not match the source code. This error can be turned into a warning
8534 by using -Wno-error=coverage-mismatch. Note this may result in
8535 poorly optimized code. Additionally, by default, GCC also emits a
8536 warning message if the feedback profiles do not exist (see
8537 -Wmissing-profile).
8538
8539 If path is specified, GCC looks at the path to find the profile
8540 feedback data files. See -fprofile-dir.
8541
8542 -fauto-profile
8543 -fauto-profile=path
8544 Enable sampling-based feedback-directed optimizations, and the
8545 following optimizations, many of which are generally profitable
8546 only with profile feedback available:
8547
8548 -fbranch-probabilities -fprofile-values -funroll-loops
8549 -fpeel-loops -ftracer -fvpt -finline-functions -fipa-cp
8550 -fipa-cp-clone -fipa-bit-cp -fpredictive-commoning -fsplit-loops
8551 -funswitch-loops -fgcse-after-reload -ftree-loop-vectorize
8552 -ftree-slp-vectorize -fvect-cost-model=dynamic
8553 -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns -fprofile-correction
8554
8555 path is the name of a file containing AutoFDO profile information.
8556 If omitted, it defaults to fbdata.afdo in the current directory.
8557
8558 Producing an AutoFDO profile data file requires running your
8559 program with the perf utility on a supported GNU/Linux target
8560 system. For more information, see <https://perf.wiki.kernel.org/>.
8561
8562 E.g.
8563
8564 perf record -e br_inst_retired:near_taken -b -o perf.data \
8565 -- your_program
8566
8567 Then use the create_gcov tool to convert the raw profile data to a
8568 format that can be used by GCC. You must also supply the
8569 unstripped binary for your program to this tool. See
8570 <https://github.com/google/autofdo>.
8571
8572 E.g.
8573
8574 create_gcov --binary=your_program.unstripped --profile=perf.data \
8575 --gcov=profile.afdo
8576
8577 The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-
8578 point arithmetic. These options trade off between speed and
8579 correctness. All must be specifically enabled.
8580
8581 -ffloat-store
8582 Do not store floating-point variables in registers, and inhibit
8583 other options that might change whether a floating-point value is
8584 taken from a register or memory.
8585
8586 This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such
8587 as the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
8588 precision than a "double" is supposed to have. Similarly for the
8589 x86 architecture. For most programs, the excess precision does
8590 only good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of
8591 IEEE floating point. Use -ffloat-store for such programs, after
8592 modifying them to store all pertinent intermediate computations
8593 into variables.
8594
8595 -fexcess-precision=style
8596 This option allows further control over excess precision on
8597 machines where floating-point operations occur in a format with
8598 more precision or range than the IEEE standard and interchange
8599 floating-point types. By default, -fexcess-precision=fast is in
8600 effect; this means that operations may be carried out in a wider
8601 precision than the types specified in the source if that would
8602 result in faster code, and it is unpredictable when rounding to the
8603 types specified in the source code takes place. When compiling C,
8604 if -fexcess-precision=standard is specified then excess precision
8605 follows the rules specified in ISO C99; in particular, both casts
8606 and assignments cause values to be rounded to their semantic types
8607 (whereas -ffloat-store only affects assignments). This option is
8608 enabled by default for C if a strict conformance option such as
8609 -std=c99 is used. -ffast-math enables -fexcess-precision=fast by
8610 default regardless of whether a strict conformance option is used.
8611
8612 -fexcess-precision=standard is not implemented for languages other
8613 than C. On the x86, it has no effect if -mfpmath=sse or
8614 -mfpmath=sse+387 is specified; in the former case, IEEE semantics
8615 apply without excess precision, and in the latter, rounding is
8616 unpredictable.
8617
8618 -ffast-math
8619 Sets the options -fno-math-errno, -funsafe-math-optimizations,
8620 -ffinite-math-only, -fno-rounding-math, -fno-signaling-nans,
8621 -fcx-limited-range and -fexcess-precision=fast.
8622
8623 This option causes the preprocessor macro "__FAST_MATH__" to be
8624 defined.
8625
8626 This option is not turned on by any -O option besides -Ofast since
8627 it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on an
8628 exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
8629 functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs that do
8630 not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8631
8632 -fno-math-errno
8633 Do not set "errno" after calling math functions that are executed
8634 with a single instruction, e.g., "sqrt". A program that relies on
8635 IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
8636 for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
8637
8638 This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result
8639 in incorrect output for programs that depend on an exact
8640 implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
8641 functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs that do
8642 not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8643
8644 The default is -fmath-errno.
8645
8646 On Darwin systems, the math library never sets "errno". There is
8647 therefore no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility
8648 that it might, and -fno-math-errno is the default.
8649
8650 -funsafe-math-optimizations
8651 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
8652 that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
8653 ANSI standards. When used at link time, it may include libraries
8654 or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
8655 similar optimizations.
8656
8657 This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result
8658 in incorrect output for programs that depend on an exact
8659 implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
8660 functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs that do
8661 not require the guarantees of these specifications. Enables
8662 -fno-signed-zeros, -fno-trapping-math, -fassociative-math and
8663 -freciprocal-math.
8664
8665 The default is -fno-unsafe-math-optimizations.
8666
8667 -fassociative-math
8668 Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point
8669 operations. This violates the ISO C and C++ language standard by
8670 possibly changing computation result. NOTE: re-ordering may change
8671 the sign of zero as well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create
8672 underflow or overflow (and thus cannot be used on code that relies
8673 on rounding behavior like "(x + 2**52) - 2**52". May also reorder
8674 floating-point comparisons and thus may not be used when ordered
8675 comparisons are required. This option requires that both
8676 -fno-signed-zeros and -fno-trapping-math be in effect. Moreover,
8677 it doesn't make much sense with -frounding-math. For Fortran the
8678 option is automatically enabled when both -fno-signed-zeros and
8679 -fno-trapping-math are in effect.
8680
8681 The default is -fno-associative-math.
8682
8683 -freciprocal-math
8684 Allow the reciprocal of a value to be used instead of dividing by
8685 the value if this enables optimizations. For example "x / y" can
8686 be replaced with "x * (1/y)", which is useful if "(1/y)" is subject
8687 to common subexpression elimination. Note that this loses
8688 precision and increases the number of flops operating on the value.
8689
8690 The default is -fno-reciprocal-math.
8691
8692 -ffinite-math-only
8693 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume that
8694 arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
8695
8696 This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result
8697 in incorrect output for programs that depend on an exact
8698 implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
8699 functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs that do
8700 not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8701
8702 The default is -fno-finite-math-only.
8703
8704 -fno-signed-zeros
8705 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that ignore the
8706 signedness of zero. IEEE arithmetic specifies the behavior of
8707 distinct +0.0 and -0.0 values, which then prohibits simplification
8708 of expressions such as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with
8709 -ffinite-math-only). This option implies that the sign of a zero
8710 result isn't significant.
8711
8712 The default is -fsigned-zeros.
8713
8714 -fno-trapping-math
8715 Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot
8716 generate user-visible traps. These traps include division by zero,
8717 overflow, underflow, inexact result and invalid operation. This
8718 option requires that -fno-signaling-nans be in effect. Setting
8719 this option may allow faster code if one relies on "non-stop" IEEE
8720 arithmetic, for example.
8721
8722 This option should never be turned on by any -O option since it can
8723 result in incorrect output for programs that depend on an exact
8724 implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
8725 functions.
8726
8727 The default is -ftrapping-math.
8728
8729 -frounding-math
8730 Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default
8731 floating-point rounding behavior. This is round-to-zero for all
8732 floating point to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all
8733 other arithmetic truncations. This option should be specified for
8734 programs that change the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may
8735 be executed with a non-default rounding mode. This option disables
8736 constant folding of floating-point expressions at compile time
8737 (which may be affected by rounding mode) and arithmetic
8738 transformations that are unsafe in the presence of sign-dependent
8739 rounding modes.
8740
8741 The default is -fno-rounding-math.
8742
8743 This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8744 disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
8745 Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
8746 using C99's "FENV_ACCESS" pragma. This command-line option will be
8747 used to specify the default state for "FENV_ACCESS".
8748
8749 -fsignaling-nans
8750 Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-
8751 visible traps during floating-point operations. Setting this
8752 option disables optimizations that may change the number of
8753 exceptions visible with signaling NaNs. This option implies
8754 -ftrapping-math.
8755
8756 This option causes the preprocessor macro "__SUPPORT_SNAN__" to be
8757 defined.
8758
8759 The default is -fno-signaling-nans.
8760
8761 This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8762 disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
8763
8764 -fno-fp-int-builtin-inexact
8765 Do not allow the built-in functions "ceil", "floor", "round" and
8766 "trunc", and their "float" and "long double" variants, to generate
8767 code that raises the "inexact" floating-point exception for
8768 noninteger arguments. ISO C99 and C11 allow these functions to
8769 raise the "inexact" exception, but ISO/IEC TS 18661-1:2014, the C
8770 bindings to IEEE 754-2008, does not allow these functions to do so.
8771
8772 The default is -ffp-int-builtin-inexact, allowing the exception to
8773 be raised. This option does nothing unless -ftrapping-math is in
8774 effect.
8775
8776 Even if -fno-fp-int-builtin-inexact is used, if the functions
8777 generate a call to a library function then the "inexact" exception
8778 may be raised if the library implementation does not follow TS
8779 18661.
8780
8781 -fsingle-precision-constant
8782 Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of
8783 implicitly converting them to double-precision constants.
8784
8785 -fcx-limited-range
8786 When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
8787 needed when performing complex division. Also, there is no
8788 checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or division
8789 is "NaN + I*NaN", with an attempt to rescue the situation in that
8790 case. The default is -fno-cx-limited-range, but is enabled by
8791 -ffast-math.
8792
8793 This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
8794 "CX_LIMITED_RANGE" pragma. Nevertheless, the option applies to all
8795 languages.
8796
8797 -fcx-fortran-rules
8798 Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules. Range
8799 reduction is done as part of complex division, but there is no
8800 checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or division
8801 is "NaN + I*NaN", with an attempt to rescue the situation in that
8802 case.
8803
8804 The default is -fno-cx-fortran-rules.
8805
8806 The following options control optimizations that may improve
8807 performance, but are not enabled by any -O options. This section
8808 includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
8809
8810 -fbranch-probabilities
8811 After running a program compiled with -fprofile-arcs, you can
8812 compile it a second time using -fbranch-probabilities, to improve
8813 optimizations based on the number of times each branch was taken.
8814 When a program compiled with -fprofile-arcs exits, it saves arc
8815 execution counts to a file called sourcename.gcda for each source
8816 file. The information in this data file is very dependent on the
8817 structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source
8818 code and the same optimization options for both compilations.
8819
8820 With -fbranch-probabilities, GCC puts a REG_BR_PROB note on each
8821 JUMP_INSN and CALL_INSN. These can be used to improve
8822 optimization. Currently, they are only used in one place: in
8823 reorg.c, instead of guessing which path a branch is most likely to
8824 take, the REG_BR_PROB values are used to exactly determine which
8825 path is taken more often.
8826
8827 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8828
8829 -fprofile-values
8830 If combined with -fprofile-arcs, it adds code so that some data
8831 about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
8832
8833 With -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered from
8834 profiling values of expressions for usage in optimizations.
8835
8836 Enabled by -fprofile-generate, -fprofile-use, and -fauto-profile.
8837
8838 -fprofile-reorder-functions
8839 Function reordering based on profile instrumentation collects first
8840 time of execution of a function and orders these functions in
8841 ascending order.
8842
8843 Enabled with -fprofile-use.
8844
8845 -fvpt
8846 If combined with -fprofile-arcs, this option instructs the compiler
8847 to add code to gather information about values of expressions.
8848
8849 With -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered and
8850 actually performs the optimizations based on them. Currently the
8851 optimizations include specialization of division operations using
8852 the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
8853
8854 Enabled with -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8855
8856 -frename-registers
8857 Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
8858 of registers left over after register allocation. This
8859 optimization most benefits processors with lots of registers.
8860 Depending on the debug information format adopted by the target,
8861 however, it can make debugging impossible, since variables no
8862 longer stay in a "home register".
8863
8864 Enabled by default with -funroll-loops.
8865
8866 -fschedule-fusion
8867 Performs a target dependent pass over the instruction stream to
8868 schedule instructions of same type together because target machine
8869 can execute them more efficiently if they are adjacent to each
8870 other in the instruction flow.
8871
8872 Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.
8873
8874 -ftracer
8875 Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size. This
8876 transformation simplifies the control flow of the function allowing
8877 other optimizations to do a better job.
8878
8879 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8880
8881 -funroll-loops
8882 Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at
8883 compile time or upon entry to the loop. -funroll-loops implies
8884 -frerun-cse-after-loop, -fweb and -frename-registers. It also
8885 turns on complete loop peeling (i.e. complete removal of loops with
8886 a small constant number of iterations). This option makes code
8887 larger, and may or may not make it run faster.
8888
8889 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8890
8891 -funroll-all-loops
8892 Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain
8893 when the loop is entered. This usually makes programs run more
8894 slowly. -funroll-all-loops implies the same options as
8895 -funroll-loops.
8896
8897 -fpeel-loops
8898 Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not
8899 roll much (from profile feedback or static analysis). It also
8900 turns on complete loop peeling (i.e. complete removal of loops with
8901 small constant number of iterations).
8902
8903 Enabled by -O3, -fprofile-use, and -fauto-profile.
8904
8905 -fmove-loop-invariants
8906 Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.
8907 Enabled at level -O1 and higher, except for -Og.
8908
8909 -fsplit-loops
8910 Split a loop into two if it contains a condition that's always true
8911 for one side of the iteration space and false for the other.
8912
8913 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8914
8915 -funswitch-loops
8916 Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with
8917 duplicates of the loop on both branches (modified according to
8918 result of the condition).
8919
8920 Enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8921
8922 -fversion-loops-for-strides
8923 If a loop iterates over an array with a variable stride, create
8924 another version of the loop that assumes the stride is always one.
8925 For example:
8926
8927 for (int i = 0; i < n; ++i)
8928 x[i * stride] = ...;
8929
8930 becomes:
8931
8932 if (stride == 1)
8933 for (int i = 0; i < n; ++i)
8934 x[i] = ...;
8935 else
8936 for (int i = 0; i < n; ++i)
8937 x[i * stride] = ...;
8938
8939 This is particularly useful for assumed-shape arrays in Fortran
8940 where (for example) it allows better vectorization assuming
8941 contiguous accesses. This flag is enabled by default at -O3. It
8942 is also enabled by -fprofile-use and -fauto-profile.
8943
8944 -ffunction-sections
8945 -fdata-sections
8946 Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
8947 file if the target supports arbitrary sections. The name of the
8948 function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
8949 in the output file.
8950
8951 Use these options on systems where the linker can perform
8952 optimizations to improve locality of reference in the instruction
8953 space. Most systems using the ELF object format have linkers with
8954 such optimizations. On AIX, the linker rearranges sections
8955 (CSECTs) based on the call graph. The performance impact varies.
8956
8957 Together with a linker garbage collection (linker --gc-sections
8958 option) these options may lead to smaller statically-linked
8959 executables (after stripping).
8960
8961 On ELF/DWARF systems these options do not degenerate the quality of
8962 the debug information. There could be issues with other object
8963 files/debug info formats.
8964
8965 Only use these options when there are significant benefits from
8966 doing so. When you specify these options, the assembler and linker
8967 create larger object and executable files and are also slower.
8968 These options affect code generation. They prevent optimizations
8969 by the compiler and assembler using relative locations inside a
8970 translation unit since the locations are unknown until link time.
8971 An example of such an optimization is relaxing calls to short call
8972 instructions.
8973
8974 -fbranch-target-load-optimize
8975 Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue /
8976 epilogue threading. The use of target registers can typically be
8977 exposed only during reload, thus hoisting loads out of loops and
8978 doing inter-block scheduling needs a separate optimization pass.
8979
8980 -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8981 Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue /
8982 epilogue threading.
8983
8984 -fbtr-bb-exclusive
8985 When performing branch target register load optimization, don't
8986 reuse branch target registers within any basic block.
8987
8988 -fstdarg-opt
8989 Optimize the prologue of variadic argument functions with respect
8990 to usage of those arguments.
8991
8992 -fsection-anchors
8993 Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
8994 shared "anchor" symbols to address nearby objects. This
8995 transformation can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT
8996 accesses on some targets.
8997
8998 For example, the implementation of the following function "foo":
8999
9000 static int a, b, c;
9001 int foo (void) { return a + b + c; }
9002
9003 usually calculates the addresses of all three variables, but if you
9004 compile it with -fsection-anchors, it accesses the variables from a
9005 common anchor point instead. The effect is similar to the
9006 following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
9007
9008 int foo (void)
9009 {
9010 register int *xr = &x;
9011 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
9012 }
9013
9014 Not all targets support this option.
9015
9016 --param name=value
9017 In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
9018 optimization that is done. For example, GCC does not inline
9019 functions that contain more than a certain number of instructions.
9020 You can control some of these constants on the command line using
9021 the --param option.
9022
9023 The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values,
9024 are tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to
9025 change without notice in future releases.
9026
9027 In order to get minimal, maximal and default value of a parameter,
9028 one can use --help=param -Q options.
9029
9030 In each case, the value is an integer. The allowable choices for
9031 name are:
9032
9033 predictable-branch-outcome
9034 When branch is predicted to be taken with probability lower
9035 than this threshold (in percent), then it is considered well
9036 predictable.
9037
9038 max-rtl-if-conversion-insns
9039 RTL if-conversion tries to remove conditional branches around a
9040 block and replace them with conditionally executed
9041 instructions. This parameter gives the maximum number of
9042 instructions in a block which should be considered for if-
9043 conversion. The compiler will also use other heuristics to
9044 decide whether if-conversion is likely to be profitable.
9045
9046 max-rtl-if-conversion-predictable-cost
9047 max-rtl-if-conversion-unpredictable-cost
9048 RTL if-conversion will try to remove conditional branches
9049 around a block and replace them with conditionally executed
9050 instructions. These parameters give the maximum permissible
9051 cost for the sequence that would be generated by if-conversion
9052 depending on whether the branch is statically determined to be
9053 predictable or not. The units for this parameter are the same
9054 as those for the GCC internal seq_cost metric. The compiler
9055 will try to provide a reasonable default for this parameter
9056 using the BRANCH_COST target macro.
9057
9058 max-crossjump-edges
9059 The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for cross-
9060 jumping. The algorithm used by -fcrossjumping is O(N^2) in the
9061 number of edges incoming to each block. Increasing values mean
9062 more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time
9063 increase with probably small improvement in executable size.
9064
9065 min-crossjump-insns
9066 The minimum number of instructions that must be matched at the
9067 end of two blocks before cross-jumping is performed on them.
9068 This value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the
9069 block being cross-jumped from are matched.
9070
9071 max-grow-copy-bb-insns
9072 The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic
9073 blocks instead of jumping. The expansion is relative to a jump
9074 instruction.
9075
9076 max-goto-duplication-insns
9077 The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that
9078 jumps to a computed goto. To avoid O(N^2) behavior in a number
9079 of passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation
9080 process, and unfactors them as late as possible. Only computed
9081 jumps at the end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-
9082 duplication-insns are unfactored.
9083
9084 max-delay-slot-insn-search
9085 The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for
9086 an instruction to fill a delay slot. If more than this
9087 arbitrary number of instructions are searched, the time savings
9088 from filling the delay slot are minimal, so stop searching.
9089 Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
9090 compilation time increase with probably small improvement in
9091 execution time.
9092
9093 max-delay-slot-live-search
9094 When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of
9095 instructions to consider when searching for a block with valid
9096 live register information. Increasing this arbitrarily chosen
9097 value means more aggressive optimization, increasing the
9098 compilation time. This parameter should be removed when the
9099 delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the control-flow
9100 graph.
9101
9102 max-gcse-memory
9103 The approximate maximum amount of memory that can be allocated
9104 in order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
9105 optimization. If more memory than specified is required, the
9106 optimization is not done.
9107
9108 max-gcse-insertion-ratio
9109 If the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger
9110 than this value for any expression, then RTL PRE inserts or
9111 removes the expression and thus leaves partially redundant
9112 computations in the instruction stream.
9113
9114 max-pending-list-length
9115 The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling allows
9116 before flushing the current state and starting over. Large
9117 functions with few branches or calls can create excessively
9118 large lists which needlessly consume memory and resources.
9119
9120 max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
9121 The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should
9122 make when modulo scheduling a loop. Larger values can
9123 exponentially increase compilation time.
9124
9125 max-inline-insns-single
9126 Several parameters control the tree inliner used in GCC. This
9127 number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in
9128 GCC's internal representation) in a single function that the
9129 tree inliner considers for inlining. This only affects
9130 functions declared inline and methods implemented in a class
9131 declaration (C++).
9132
9133 max-inline-insns-auto
9134 When you use -finline-functions (included in -O3), a lot of
9135 functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
9136 by the compiler are investigated. To those functions, a
9137 different (more restrictive) limit compared to functions
9138 declared inline can be applied.
9139
9140 max-inline-insns-small
9141 This is bound applied to calls which are considered relevant
9142 with -finline-small-functions.
9143
9144 max-inline-insns-size
9145 This is bound applied to calls which are optimized for size.
9146 Small growth may be desirable to anticipate optimization
9147 oppurtunities exposed by inlining.
9148
9149 uninlined-function-insns
9150 Number of instructions accounted by inliner for function
9151 overhead such as function prologue and epilogue.
9152
9153 uninlined-function-time
9154 Extra time accounted by inliner for function overhead such as
9155 time needed to execute function prologue and epilogue
9156
9157 uninlined-thunk-insns
9158 uninlined-thunk-time
9159 Same as --param uninlined-function-insns and --param uninlined-
9160 function-time but applied to function thunks
9161
9162 inline-min-speedup
9163 When estimated performance improvement of caller + callee
9164 runtime exceeds this threshold (in percent), the function can
9165 be inlined regardless of the limit on --param max-inline-insns-
9166 single and --param max-inline-insns-auto.
9167
9168 large-function-insns
9169 The limit specifying really large functions. For functions
9170 larger than this limit after inlining, inlining is constrained
9171 by --param large-function-growth. This parameter is useful
9172 primarily to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-
9173 linear algorithms used by the back end.
9174
9175 large-function-growth
9176 Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining
9177 in percents. For example, parameter value 100 limits large
9178 function growth to 2.0 times the original size.
9179
9180 large-unit-insns
9181 The limit specifying large translation unit. Growth caused by
9182 inlining of units larger than this limit is limited by --param
9183 inline-unit-growth. For small units this might be too tight.
9184 For example, consider a unit consisting of function A that is
9185 inline and B that just calls A three times. If B is small
9186 relative to A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such
9187 inlining is very sane. For very large units consisting of
9188 small inlineable functions, however, the overall unit growth
9189 limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.
9190 Thus for smaller units, the size is increased to --param large-
9191 unit-insns before applying --param inline-unit-growth.
9192
9193 inline-unit-growth
9194 Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused
9195 by inlining. For example, parameter value 20 limits unit
9196 growth to 1.2 times the original size. Cold functions (either
9197 marked cold via an attribute or by profile feedback) are not
9198 accounted into the unit size.
9199
9200 ipcp-unit-growth
9201 Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused
9202 by interprocedural constant propagation. For example,
9203 parameter value 10 limits unit growth to 1.1 times the original
9204 size.
9205
9206 large-stack-frame
9207 The limit specifying large stack frames. While inlining the
9208 algorithm is trying to not grow past this limit too much.
9209
9210 large-stack-frame-growth
9211 Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by
9212 inlining in percents. For example, parameter value 1000 limits
9213 large stack frame growth to 11 times the original size.
9214
9215 max-inline-insns-recursive
9216 max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
9217 Specifies the maximum number of instructions an out-of-line
9218 copy of a self-recursive inline function can grow into by
9219 performing recursive inlining.
9220
9221 --param max-inline-insns-recursive applies to functions
9222 declared inline. For functions not declared inline, recursive
9223 inlining happens only when -finline-functions (included in -O3)
9224 is enabled; --param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto applies
9225 instead.
9226
9227 max-inline-recursive-depth
9228 max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
9229 Specifies the maximum recursion depth used for recursive
9230 inlining.
9231
9232 --param max-inline-recursive-depth applies to functions
9233 declared inline. For functions not declared inline, recursive
9234 inlining happens only when -finline-functions (included in -O3)
9235 is enabled; --param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto applies
9236 instead.
9237
9238 min-inline-recursive-probability
9239 Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep
9240 recursion in average and can hurt for function having little
9241 recursion depth by increasing the prologue size or complexity
9242 of function body to other optimizers.
9243
9244 When profile feedback is available (see -fprofile-generate) the
9245 actual recursion depth can be guessed from the probability that
9246 function recurses via a given call expression. This parameter
9247 limits inlining only to call expressions whose probability
9248 exceeds the given threshold (in percents).
9249
9250 early-inlining-insns
9251 Specify growth that the early inliner can make. In effect it
9252 increases the amount of inlining for code having a large
9253 abstraction penalty.
9254
9255 max-early-inliner-iterations
9256 Limit of iterations of the early inliner. This basically
9257 bounds the number of nested indirect calls the early inliner
9258 can resolve. Deeper chains are still handled by late inlining.
9259
9260 comdat-sharing-probability
9261 Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat
9262 visibility are shared across multiple compilation units.
9263
9264 profile-func-internal-id
9265 A parameter to control whether to use function internal id in
9266 profile database lookup. If the value is 0, the compiler uses
9267 an id that is based on function assembler name and filename,
9268 which makes old profile data more tolerant to source changes
9269 such as function reordering etc.
9270
9271 min-vect-loop-bound
9272 The minimum number of iterations under which loops are not
9273 vectorized when -ftree-vectorize is used. The number of
9274 iterations after vectorization needs to be greater than the
9275 value specified by this option to allow vectorization.
9276
9277 gcse-cost-distance-ratio
9278 Scaling factor in calculation of maximum distance an expression
9279 can be moved by GCSE optimizations. This is currently
9280 supported only in the code hoisting pass. The bigger the
9281 ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting is with simple
9282 expressions, i.e., the expressions that have cost less than
9283 gcse-unrestricted-cost. Specifying 0 disables hoisting of
9284 simple expressions.
9285
9286 gcse-unrestricted-cost
9287 Cost, roughly measured as the cost of a single typical machine
9288 instruction, at which GCSE optimizations do not constrain the
9289 distance an expression can travel. This is currently supported
9290 only in the code hoisting pass. The lesser the cost, the more
9291 aggressive code hoisting is. Specifying 0 allows all
9292 expressions to travel unrestricted distances.
9293
9294 max-hoist-depth
9295 The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions to
9296 hoist. This is used to avoid quadratic behavior in hoisting
9297 algorithm. The value of 0 does not limit on the search, but
9298 may slow down compilation of huge functions.
9299
9300 max-tail-merge-comparisons
9301 The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with. This
9302 is used to avoid quadratic behavior in tree tail merging.
9303
9304 max-tail-merge-iterations
9305 The maximum amount of iterations of the pass over the function.
9306 This is used to limit compilation time in tree tail merging.
9307
9308 store-merging-allow-unaligned
9309 Allow the store merging pass to introduce unaligned stores if
9310 it is legal to do so.
9311
9312 max-stores-to-merge
9313 The maximum number of stores to attempt to merge into wider
9314 stores in the store merging pass.
9315
9316 max-unrolled-insns
9317 The maximum number of instructions that a loop may have to be
9318 unrolled. If a loop is unrolled, this parameter also
9319 determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
9320
9321 max-average-unrolled-insns
9322 The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of
9323 their execution that a loop may have to be unrolled. If a loop
9324 is unrolled, this parameter also determines how many times the
9325 loop code is unrolled.
9326
9327 max-unroll-times
9328 The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
9329
9330 max-peeled-insns
9331 The maximum number of instructions that a loop may have to be
9332 peeled. If a loop is peeled, this parameter also determines
9333 how many times the loop code is peeled.
9334
9335 max-peel-times
9336 The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
9337
9338 max-peel-branches
9339 The maximum number of branches on the hot path through the
9340 peeled sequence.
9341
9342 max-completely-peeled-insns
9343 The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
9344
9345 max-completely-peel-times
9346 The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for
9347 complete peeling.
9348
9349 max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
9350 The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.
9351
9352 max-unswitch-insns
9353 The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
9354
9355 max-unswitch-level
9356 The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
9357
9358 lim-expensive
9359 The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop
9360 invariant motion.
9361
9362 iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
9363 Bound on number of candidates for induction variables, below
9364 which all candidates are considered for each use in induction
9365 variable optimizations. If there are more candidates than
9366 this, only the most relevant ones are considered to avoid
9367 quadratic time complexity.
9368
9369 iv-max-considered-uses
9370 The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that
9371 contain more induction variable uses.
9372
9373 iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
9374 If the number of candidates in the set is smaller than this
9375 value, always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set when
9376 adding a new one.
9377
9378 avg-loop-niter
9379 Average number of iterations of a loop.
9380
9381 dse-max-object-size
9382 Maximum size (in bytes) of objects tracked bytewise by dead
9383 store elimination. Larger values may result in larger
9384 compilation times.
9385
9386 dse-max-alias-queries-per-store
9387 Maximum number of queries into the alias oracle per store.
9388 Larger values result in larger compilation times and may result
9389 in more removed dead stores.
9390
9391 scev-max-expr-size
9392 Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions
9393 analyzer. Large expressions slow the analyzer.
9394
9395 scev-max-expr-complexity
9396 Bound on the complexity of the expressions in the scalar
9397 evolutions analyzer. Complex expressions slow the analyzer.
9398
9399 max-tree-if-conversion-phi-args
9400 Maximum number of arguments in a PHI supported by TREE if
9401 conversion unless the loop is marked with simd pragma.
9402
9403 vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
9404 The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed
9405 when doing loop versioning for alignment in the vectorizer.
9406
9407 vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
9408 The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed
9409 when doing loop versioning for alias in the vectorizer.
9410
9411 vect-max-peeling-for-alignment
9412 The maximum number of loop peels to enhance access alignment
9413 for vectorizer. Value -1 means no limit.
9414
9415 max-iterations-to-track
9416 The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute-force
9417 algorithm for analysis of the number of iterations of the loop
9418 tries to evaluate.
9419
9420 hot-bb-count-ws-permille
9421 A basic block profile count is considered hot if it contributes
9422 to the given permillage (i.e. 0...1000) of the entire profiled
9423 execution.
9424
9425 hot-bb-frequency-fraction
9426 Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of
9427 basic block in function given basic block needs to have to be
9428 considered hot.
9429
9430 max-predicted-iterations
9431 The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.
9432 This is useful in cases where a function contains a single loop
9433 with known bound and another loop with unknown bound. The
9434 known number of iterations is predicted correctly, while the
9435 unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10. This means
9436 that the loop without bounds appears artificially cold relative
9437 to the other one.
9438
9439 builtin-expect-probability
9440 Control the probability of the expression having the specified
9441 value. This parameter takes a percentage (i.e. 0 ... 100) as
9442 input.
9443
9444 builtin-string-cmp-inline-length
9445 The maximum length of a constant string for a builtin string
9446 cmp call eligible for inlining.
9447
9448 align-threshold
9449 Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of a
9450 basic block in a function to align the basic block.
9451
9452 align-loop-iterations
9453 A loop expected to iterate at least the selected number of
9454 iterations is aligned.
9455
9456 tracer-dynamic-coverage
9457 tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
9458 This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given
9459 percentage of executed instructions is covered. This limits
9460 unnecessary code size expansion.
9461
9462 The tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback parameter is used only
9463 when profile feedback is available. The real profiles (as
9464 opposed to statically estimated ones) are much less balanced
9465 allowing the threshold to be larger value.
9466
9467 tracer-max-code-growth
9468 Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given
9469 percentage. This is a rather artificial limit, as most of the
9470 duplicates are eliminated later in cross jumping, so it may be
9471 set to much higher values than is the desired code growth.
9472
9473 tracer-min-branch-ratio
9474 Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge
9475 is less than this threshold (in percent).
9476
9477 tracer-min-branch-probability
9478 tracer-min-branch-probability-feedback
9479 Stop forward growth if the best edge has probability lower than
9480 this threshold.
9481
9482 Similarly to tracer-dynamic-coverage two parameters are
9483 provided. tracer-min-branch-probability-feedback is used for
9484 compilation with profile feedback and tracer-min-branch-
9485 probability compilation without. The value for compilation
9486 with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
9487 order to make tracer effective.
9488
9489 stack-clash-protection-guard-size
9490 Specify the size of the operating system provided stack guard
9491 as 2 raised to num bytes. Higher values may reduce the number
9492 of explicit probes, but a value larger than the operating
9493 system provided guard will leave code vulnerable to stack clash
9494 style attacks.
9495
9496 stack-clash-protection-probe-interval
9497 Stack clash protection involves probing stack space as it is
9498 allocated. This param controls the maximum distance between
9499 probes into the stack as 2 raised to num bytes. Higher values
9500 may reduce the number of explicit probes, but a value larger
9501 than the operating system provided guard will leave code
9502 vulnerable to stack clash style attacks.
9503
9504 max-cse-path-length
9505 The maximum number of basic blocks on path that CSE considers.
9506
9507 max-cse-insns
9508 The maximum number of instructions CSE processes before
9509 flushing.
9510
9511 ggc-min-expand
9512 GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory
9513 allocation. This parameter specifies the minimum percentage by
9514 which the garbage collector's heap should be allowed to expand
9515 between collections. Tuning this may improve compilation
9516 speed; it has no effect on code generation.
9517
9518 The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of
9519 100% when RAM >= 1GB. If "getrlimit" is available, the notion
9520 of "RAM" is the smallest of actual RAM and "RLIMIT_DATA" or
9521 "RLIMIT_AS". If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
9522 particular platform, the lower bound of 30% is used. Setting
9523 this parameter and ggc-min-heapsize to zero causes a full
9524 collection to occur at every opportunity. This is extremely
9525 slow, but can be useful for debugging.
9526
9527 ggc-min-heapsize
9528 Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins
9529 bothering to collect garbage. The first collection occurs
9530 after the heap expands by ggc-min-expand% beyond ggc-min-
9531 heapsize. Again, tuning this may improve compilation speed,
9532 and has no effect on code generation.
9533
9534 The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit
9535 that tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not
9536 exceeded, but with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and
9537 an upper bound of 131072 (128 megabytes). If GCC is not able
9538 to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower bound is
9539 used. Setting this parameter very large effectively disables
9540 garbage collection. Setting this parameter and ggc-min-expand
9541 to zero causes a full collection to occur at every opportunity.
9542
9543 max-reload-search-insns
9544 The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward
9545 for equivalent register. Increasing values mean more
9546 aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase
9547 with probably slightly better performance.
9548
9549 max-cselib-memory-locations
9550 The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into
9551 account. Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization,
9552 making the compilation time increase with probably slightly
9553 better performance.
9554
9555 max-sched-ready-insns
9556 The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the
9557 scheduler should consider at any given time during the first
9558 scheduling pass. Increasing values mean more thorough
9559 searches, making the compilation time increase with probably
9560 little benefit.
9561
9562 max-sched-region-blocks
9563 The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
9564 interblock scheduling.
9565
9566 max-pipeline-region-blocks
9567 The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
9568 pipelining in the selective scheduler.
9569
9570 max-sched-region-insns
9571 The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
9572 interblock scheduling.
9573
9574 max-pipeline-region-insns
9575 The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
9576 pipelining in the selective scheduler.
9577
9578 min-spec-prob
9579 The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source
9580 block for interblock speculative scheduling.
9581
9582 max-sched-extend-regions-iters
9583 The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
9584 A value of 0 disables region extensions.
9585
9586 max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
9587 The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for
9588 speculative motion.
9589
9590 sched-spec-prob-cutoff
9591 The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents),
9592 so that speculative insns are scheduled.
9593
9594 sched-state-edge-prob-cutoff
9595 The minimum probability an edge must have for the scheduler to
9596 save its state across it.
9597
9598 sched-mem-true-dep-cost
9599 Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load
9600 targeting same memory locations.
9601
9602 selsched-max-lookahead
9603 The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective
9604 scheduling. It is a depth of search for available
9605 instructions.
9606
9607 selsched-max-sched-times
9608 The maximum number of times that an instruction is scheduled
9609 during selective scheduling. This is the limit on the number
9610 of iterations through which the instruction may be pipelined.
9611
9612 selsched-insns-to-rename
9613 The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that
9614 are considered for renaming in the selective scheduler.
9615
9616 sms-min-sc
9617 The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler
9618 generates.
9619
9620 max-last-value-rtl
9621 The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be
9622 recorded in an expression in combiner for a pseudo register as
9623 last known value of that register.
9624
9625 max-combine-insns
9626 The maximum number of instructions the RTL combiner tries to
9627 combine.
9628
9629 integer-share-limit
9630 Small integer constants can use a shared data structure,
9631 reducing the compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed.
9632 This sets the maximum value of a shared integer constant.
9633
9634 ssp-buffer-size
9635 The minimum size of buffers (i.e. arrays) that receive stack
9636 smashing protection when -fstack-protection is used.
9637
9638 min-size-for-stack-sharing
9639 The minimum size of variables taking part in stack slot sharing
9640 when not optimizing.
9641
9642 max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
9643 Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to
9644 be duplicated when threading jumps.
9645
9646 max-fields-for-field-sensitive
9647 Maximum number of fields in a structure treated in a field
9648 sensitive manner during pointer analysis.
9649
9650 prefetch-latency
9651 Estimate on average number of instructions that are executed
9652 before prefetch finishes. The distance prefetched ahead is
9653 proportional to this constant. Increasing this number may also
9654 lead to less streams being prefetched (see simultaneous-
9655 prefetches).
9656
9657 simultaneous-prefetches
9658 Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.
9659
9660 l1-cache-line-size
9661 The size of cache line in L1 data cache, in bytes.
9662
9663 l1-cache-size
9664 The size of L1 data cache, in kilobytes.
9665
9666 l2-cache-size
9667 The size of L2 data cache, in kilobytes.
9668
9669 prefetch-dynamic-strides
9670 Whether the loop array prefetch pass should issue software
9671 prefetch hints for strides that are non-constant. In some
9672 cases this may be beneficial, though the fact the stride is
9673 non-constant may make it hard to predict when there is clear
9674 benefit to issuing these hints.
9675
9676 Set to 1 if the prefetch hints should be issued for non-
9677 constant strides. Set to 0 if prefetch hints should be issued
9678 only for strides that are known to be constant and below
9679 prefetch-minimum-stride.
9680
9681 prefetch-minimum-stride
9682 Minimum constant stride, in bytes, to start using prefetch
9683 hints for. If the stride is less than this threshold, prefetch
9684 hints will not be issued.
9685
9686 This setting is useful for processors that have hardware
9687 prefetchers, in which case there may be conflicts between the
9688 hardware prefetchers and the software prefetchers. If the
9689 hardware prefetchers have a maximum stride they can handle, it
9690 should be used here to improve the use of software prefetchers.
9691
9692 A value of -1 means we don't have a threshold and therefore
9693 prefetch hints can be issued for any constant stride.
9694
9695 This setting is only useful for strides that are known and
9696 constant.
9697
9698 loop-interchange-max-num-stmts
9699 The maximum number of stmts in a loop to be interchanged.
9700
9701 loop-interchange-stride-ratio
9702 The minimum ratio between stride of two loops for interchange
9703 to be profitable.
9704
9705 min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
9706 The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9707 number of prefetches to enable prefetching in a loop.
9708
9709 prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
9710 The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9711 number of memory references to enable prefetching in a loop.
9712
9713 use-canonical-types
9714 Whether the compiler should use the "canonical" type system.
9715 Should always be 1, which uses a more efficient internal
9716 mechanism for comparing types in C++ and Objective-C++.
9717 However, if bugs in the canonical type system are causing
9718 compilation failures, set this value to 0 to disable canonical
9719 types.
9720
9721 switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
9722 Switch initialization conversion refuses to create arrays that
9723 are bigger than switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio times the
9724 number of branches in the switch.
9725
9726 max-partial-antic-length
9727 Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the
9728 tree partial redundancy elimination optimization (-ftree-pre)
9729 when optimizing at -O3 and above. For some sorts of source
9730 code the enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization
9731 can run away, consuming all of the memory available on the host
9732 machine. This parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets
9733 that are computed, which prevents the runaway behavior.
9734 Setting a value of 0 for this parameter allows an unlimited set
9735 length.
9736
9737 rpo-vn-max-loop-depth
9738 Maximum loop depth that is value-numbered optimistically. When
9739 the limit hits the innermost rpo-vn-max-loop-depth loops and
9740 the outermost loop in the loop nest are value-numbered
9741 optimistically and the remaining ones not.
9742
9743 sccvn-max-alias-queries-per-access
9744 Maximum number of alias-oracle queries we perform when looking
9745 for redundancies for loads and stores. If this limit is hit
9746 the search is aborted and the load or store is not considered
9747 redundant. The number of queries is algorithmically limited to
9748 the number of stores on all paths from the load to the function
9749 entry.
9750
9751 ira-max-loops-num
9752 IRA uses regional register allocation by default. If a
9753 function contains more loops than the number given by this
9754 parameter, only at most the given number of the most
9755 frequently-executed loops form regions for regional register
9756 allocation.
9757
9758 ira-max-conflict-table-size
9759 Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the
9760 conflict table, the table can still require excessive amounts
9761 of memory for huge functions. If the conflict table for a
9762 function could be more than the size in MB given by this
9763 parameter, the register allocator instead uses a faster,
9764 simpler, and lower-quality algorithm that does not require
9765 building a pseudo-register conflict table.
9766
9767 ira-loop-reserved-regs
9768 IRA can be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in
9769 loops for decisions to move loop invariants (see -O3). The
9770 number of available registers reserved for some other purposes
9771 is given by this parameter. Default of the parameter is the
9772 best found from numerous experiments.
9773
9774 lra-inheritance-ebb-probability-cutoff
9775 LRA tries to reuse values reloaded in registers in subsequent
9776 insns. This optimization is called inheritance. EBB is used
9777 as a region to do this optimization. The parameter defines a
9778 minimal fall-through edge probability in percentage used to add
9779 BB to inheritance EBB in LRA. The default value was chosen
9780 from numerous runs of SPEC2000 on x86-64.
9781
9782 loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
9783 Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in
9784 compilation time and in amount of needed compile-time memory,
9785 with very large loops. Loops with more basic blocks than this
9786 parameter won't have loop invariant motion optimization
9787 performed on them.
9788
9789 loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
9790 Building data dependencies is expensive for very large loops.
9791 This parameter limits the number of data references in loops
9792 that are considered for data dependence analysis. These large
9793 loops are no handled by the optimizations using loop data
9794 dependencies.
9795
9796 max-vartrack-size
9797 Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during
9798 variable tracking dataflow analysis of any function. If this
9799 limit is exceeded with variable tracking at assignments
9800 enabled, analysis for that function is retried without it,
9801 after removing all debug insns from the function. If the limit
9802 is exceeded even without debug insns, var tracking analysis is
9803 completely disabled for the function. Setting the parameter to
9804 zero makes it unlimited.
9805
9806 max-vartrack-expr-depth
9807 Sets a maximum number of recursion levels when attempting to
9808 map variable names or debug temporaries to value expressions.
9809 This trades compilation time for more complete debug
9810 information. If this is set too low, value expressions that
9811 are available and could be represented in debug information may
9812 end up not being used; setting this higher may enable the
9813 compiler to find more complex debug expressions, but compile
9814 time and memory use may grow.
9815
9816 max-debug-marker-count
9817 Sets a threshold on the number of debug markers (e.g. begin
9818 stmt markers) to avoid complexity explosion at inlining or
9819 expanding to RTL. If a function has more such gimple stmts
9820 than the set limit, such stmts will be dropped from the inlined
9821 copy of a function, and from its RTL expansion.
9822
9823 min-nondebug-insn-uid
9824 Use uids starting at this parameter for nondebug insns. The
9825 range below the parameter is reserved exclusively for debug
9826 insns created by -fvar-tracking-assignments, but debug insns
9827 may get (non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range
9828 is exhausted.
9829
9830 ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
9831 IPA-SRA replaces a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new
9832 parameters only when their cumulative size is less or equal to
9833 ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor times the size of the original
9834 pointer parameter.
9835
9836 sra-max-scalarization-size-Ospeed
9837 sra-max-scalarization-size-Osize
9838 The two Scalar Reduction of Aggregates passes (SRA and IPA-SRA)
9839 aim to replace scalar parts of aggregates with uses of
9840 independent scalar variables. These parameters control the
9841 maximum size, in storage units, of aggregate which is
9842 considered for replacement when compiling for speed (sra-max-
9843 scalarization-size-Ospeed) or size (sra-max-scalarization-size-
9844 Osize) respectively.
9845
9846 tm-max-aggregate-size
9847 When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction,
9848 this parameter specifies the size in bytes after which
9849 variables are saved with the logging functions as opposed to
9850 save/restore code sequence pairs. This option only applies
9851 when using -fgnu-tm.
9852
9853 graphite-max-nb-scop-params
9854 To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms,
9855 the number of parameters in a Static Control Part (SCoP) is
9856 bounded. A value of zero can be used to lift the bound. A
9857 variable whose value is unknown at compilation time and defined
9858 outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.
9859
9860 loop-block-tile-size
9861 Loop blocking or strip mining transforms, enabled with
9862 -floop-block or -floop-strip-mine, strip mine each loop in the
9863 loop nest by a given number of iterations. The strip length
9864 can be changed using the loop-block-tile-size parameter.
9865
9866 ipa-cp-value-list-size
9867 IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed
9868 to a function's parameter in order to propagate them and
9869 perform devirtualization. ipa-cp-value-list-size is the
9870 maximum number of values and types it stores per one formal
9871 parameter of a function.
9872
9873 ipa-cp-eval-threshold
9874 IPA-CP calculates its own score of cloning profitability
9875 heuristics and performs those cloning opportunities with scores
9876 that exceed ipa-cp-eval-threshold.
9877
9878 ipa-cp-recursion-penalty
9879 Percentage penalty the recursive functions will receive when
9880 they are evaluated for cloning.
9881
9882 ipa-cp-single-call-penalty
9883 Percentage penalty functions containing a single call to
9884 another function will receive when they are evaluated for
9885 cloning.
9886
9887 ipa-max-agg-items
9888 IPA-CP is also capable to propagate a number of scalar values
9889 passed in an aggregate. ipa-max-agg-items controls the maximum
9890 number of such values per one parameter.
9891
9892 ipa-cp-loop-hint-bonus
9893 When IPA-CP determines that a cloning candidate would make the
9894 number of iterations of a loop known, it adds a bonus of ipa-
9895 cp-loop-hint-bonus to the profitability score of the candidate.
9896
9897 ipa-cp-array-index-hint-bonus
9898 When IPA-CP determines that a cloning candidate would make the
9899 index of an array access known, it adds a bonus of ipa-cp-
9900 array-index-hint-bonus to the profitability score of the
9901 candidate.
9902
9903 ipa-max-aa-steps
9904 During its analysis of function bodies, IPA-CP employs alias
9905 analysis in order to track values pointed to by function
9906 parameters. In order not spend too much time analyzing huge
9907 functions, it gives up and consider all memory clobbered after
9908 examining ipa-max-aa-steps statements modifying memory.
9909
9910 lto-partitions
9911 Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR
9912 compilation. The number of partitions should exceed the number
9913 of CPUs used for compilation.
9914
9915 lto-min-partition
9916 Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in estimated
9917 instructions). This prevents expenses of splitting very small
9918 programs into too many partitions.
9919
9920 lto-max-partition
9921 Size of max partition for WHOPR (in estimated instructions).
9922 to provide an upper bound for individual size of partition.
9923 Meant to be used only with balanced partitioning.
9924
9925 lto-max-streaming-parallelism
9926 Maximal number of parallel processes used for LTO streaming.
9927
9928 cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
9929 The maximum number of namespaces to consult for suggestions
9930 when C++ name lookup fails for an identifier.
9931
9932 sink-frequency-threshold
9933 The maximum relative execution frequency (in percents) of the
9934 target block relative to a statement's original block to allow
9935 statement sinking of a statement. Larger numbers result in
9936 more aggressive statement sinking. A small positive adjustment
9937 is applied for statements with memory operands as those are
9938 even more profitable so sink.
9939
9940 max-stores-to-sink
9941 The maximum number of conditional store pairs that can be sunk.
9942 Set to 0 if either vectorization (-ftree-vectorize) or if-
9943 conversion (-ftree-loop-if-convert) is disabled.
9944
9945 allow-store-data-races
9946 Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores. Set to
9947 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.
9948
9949 case-values-threshold
9950 The smallest number of different values for which it is best to
9951 use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches. If
9952 the value is 0, use the default for the machine.
9953
9954 tree-reassoc-width
9955 Set the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in
9956 reassociated tree. This parameter overrides target dependent
9957 heuristics used by default if has non zero value.
9958
9959 sched-pressure-algorithm
9960 Choose between the two available implementations of
9961 -fsched-pressure. Algorithm 1 is the original implementation
9962 and is the more likely to prevent instructions from being
9963 reordered. Algorithm 2 was designed to be a compromise between
9964 the relatively conservative approach taken by algorithm 1 and
9965 the rather aggressive approach taken by the default scheduler.
9966 It relies more heavily on having a regular register file and
9967 accurate register pressure classes. See haifa-sched.c in the
9968 GCC sources for more details.
9969
9970 The default choice depends on the target.
9971
9972 max-slsr-cand-scan
9973 Set the maximum number of existing candidates that are
9974 considered when seeking a basis for a new straight-line
9975 strength reduction candidate.
9976
9977 asan-globals
9978 Enable buffer overflow detection for global objects. This kind
9979 of protection is enabled by default if you are using
9980 -fsanitize=address option. To disable global objects
9981 protection use --param asan-globals=0.
9982
9983 asan-stack
9984 Enable buffer overflow detection for stack objects. This kind
9985 of protection is enabled by default when using
9986 -fsanitize=address. To disable stack protection use --param
9987 asan-stack=0 option.
9988
9989 asan-instrument-reads
9990 Enable buffer overflow detection for memory reads. This kind
9991 of protection is enabled by default when using
9992 -fsanitize=address. To disable memory reads protection use
9993 --param asan-instrument-reads=0.
9994
9995 asan-instrument-writes
9996 Enable buffer overflow detection for memory writes. This kind
9997 of protection is enabled by default when using
9998 -fsanitize=address. To disable memory writes protection use
9999 --param asan-instrument-writes=0 option.
10000
10001 asan-memintrin
10002 Enable detection for built-in functions. This kind of
10003 protection is enabled by default when using -fsanitize=address.
10004 To disable built-in functions protection use --param
10005 asan-memintrin=0.
10006
10007 asan-use-after-return
10008 Enable detection of use-after-return. This kind of protection
10009 is enabled by default when using the -fsanitize=address option.
10010 To disable it use --param asan-use-after-return=0.
10011
10012 Note: By default the check is disabled at run time. To enable
10013 it, add "detect_stack_use_after_return=1" to the environment
10014 variable ASAN_OPTIONS.
10015
10016 asan-instrumentation-with-call-threshold
10017 If number of memory accesses in function being instrumented is
10018 greater or equal to this number, use callbacks instead of
10019 inline checks. E.g. to disable inline code use --param
10020 asan-instrumentation-with-call-threshold=0.
10021
10022 use-after-scope-direct-emission-threshold
10023 If the size of a local variable in bytes is smaller or equal to
10024 this number, directly poison (or unpoison) shadow memory
10025 instead of using run-time callbacks.
10026
10027 max-fsm-thread-path-insns
10028 Maximum number of instructions to copy when duplicating blocks
10029 on a finite state automaton jump thread path.
10030
10031 max-fsm-thread-length
10032 Maximum number of basic blocks on a finite state automaton jump
10033 thread path.
10034
10035 max-fsm-thread-paths
10036 Maximum number of new jump thread paths to create for a finite
10037 state automaton.
10038
10039 parloops-chunk-size
10040 Chunk size of omp schedule for loops parallelized by parloops.
10041
10042 parloops-schedule
10043 Schedule type of omp schedule for loops parallelized by
10044 parloops (static, dynamic, guided, auto, runtime).
10045
10046 parloops-min-per-thread
10047 The minimum number of iterations per thread of an innermost
10048 parallelized loop for which the parallelized variant is
10049 preferred over the single threaded one. Note that for a
10050 parallelized loop nest the minimum number of iterations of the
10051 outermost loop per thread is two.
10052
10053 max-ssa-name-query-depth
10054 Maximum depth of recursion when querying properties of SSA
10055 names in things like fold routines. One level of recursion
10056 corresponds to following a use-def chain.
10057
10058 hsa-gen-debug-stores
10059 Enable emission of special debug stores within HSA kernels
10060 which are then read and reported by libgomp plugin. Generation
10061 of these stores is disabled by default, use --param
10062 hsa-gen-debug-stores=1 to enable it.
10063
10064 max-speculative-devirt-maydefs
10065 The maximum number of may-defs we analyze when looking for a
10066 must-def specifying the dynamic type of an object that invokes
10067 a virtual call we may be able to devirtualize speculatively.
10068
10069 max-vrp-switch-assertions
10070 The maximum number of assertions to add along the default edge
10071 of a switch statement during VRP.
10072
10073 unroll-jam-min-percent
10074 The minimum percentage of memory references that must be
10075 optimized away for the unroll-and-jam transformation to be
10076 considered profitable.
10077
10078 unroll-jam-max-unroll
10079 The maximum number of times the outer loop should be unrolled
10080 by the unroll-and-jam transformation.
10081
10082 max-rtl-if-conversion-unpredictable-cost
10083 Maximum permissible cost for the sequence that would be
10084 generated by the RTL if-conversion pass for a branch that is
10085 considered unpredictable.
10086
10087 max-variable-expansions-in-unroller
10088 If -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller is used, the maximum number
10089 of times that an individual variable will be expanded during
10090 loop unrolling.
10091
10092 tracer-min-branch-probability-feedback
10093 Stop forward growth if the probability of best edge is less
10094 than this threshold (in percent). Used when profile feedback is
10095 available.
10096
10097 partial-inlining-entry-probability
10098 Maximum probability of the entry BB of split region (in percent
10099 relative to entry BB of the function) to make partial inlining
10100 happen.
10101
10102 max-tracked-strlens
10103 Maximum number of strings for which strlen optimization pass
10104 will track string lengths.
10105
10106 gcse-after-reload-partial-fraction
10107 The threshold ratio for performing partial redundancy
10108 elimination after reload.
10109
10110 gcse-after-reload-critical-fraction
10111 The threshold ratio of critical edges execution count that
10112 permit performing redundancy elimination after reload.
10113
10114 max-loop-header-insns
10115 The maximum number of insns in loop header duplicated by the
10116 copy loop headers pass.
10117
10118 vect-epilogues-nomask
10119 Enable loop epilogue vectorization using smaller vector size.
10120
10121 slp-max-insns-in-bb
10122 Maximum number of instructions in basic block to be considered
10123 for SLP vectorization.
10124
10125 avoid-fma-max-bits
10126 Maximum number of bits for which we avoid creating FMAs.
10127
10128 sms-loop-average-count-threshold
10129 A threshold on the average loop count considered by the swing
10130 modulo scheduler.
10131
10132 sms-dfa-history
10133 The number of cycles the swing modulo scheduler considers when
10134 checking conflicts using DFA.
10135
10136 hot-bb-count-fraction
10137 Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic
10138 block in program given basic block needs to have to be
10139 considered hot (used in non-LTO mode)
10140
10141 max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
10142 The maximum number of instructions non-inline function can grow
10143 to via recursive inlining.
10144
10145 graphite-allow-codegen-errors
10146 Whether codegen errors should be ICEs when -fchecking.
10147
10148 sms-max-ii-factor
10149 A factor for tuning the upper bound that swing modulo scheduler
10150 uses for scheduling a loop.
10151
10152 lra-max-considered-reload-pseudos
10153 The max number of reload pseudos which are considered during
10154 spilling a non-reload pseudo.
10155
10156 max-pow-sqrt-depth
10157 Maximum depth of sqrt chains to use when synthesizing
10158 exponentiation by a real constant.
10159
10160 max-dse-active-local-stores
10161 Maximum number of active local stores in RTL dead store
10162 elimination.
10163
10164 asan-instrument-allocas
10165 Enable asan allocas/VLAs protection.
10166
10167 max-iterations-computation-cost
10168 Bound on the cost of an expression to compute the number of
10169 iterations.
10170
10171 max-isl-operations
10172 Maximum number of isl operations, 0 means unlimited.
10173
10174 graphite-max-arrays-per-scop
10175 Maximum number of arrays per scop.
10176
10177 max-vartrack-reverse-op-size
10178 Max. size of loc list for which reverse ops should be added.
10179
10180 unlikely-bb-count-fraction
10181 The minimum fraction of profile runs a given basic block
10182 execution count must be not to be considered unlikely.
10183
10184 tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
10185 The percentage of function, weighted by execution frequency,
10186 that must be covered by trace formation. Used when profile
10187 feedback is available.
10188
10189 max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
10190 The maximum depth of recursive inlining for non-inline
10191 functions.
10192
10193 fsm-scale-path-stmts
10194 Scale factor to apply to the number of statements in a
10195 threading path when comparing to the number of (scaled) blocks.
10196
10197 fsm-maximum-phi-arguments
10198 Maximum number of arguments a PHI may have before the FSM
10199 threader will not try to thread through its block.
10200
10201 uninit-control-dep-attempts
10202 Maximum number of nested calls to search for control
10203 dependencies during uninitialized variable analysis.
10204
10205 indir-call-topn-profile
10206 Track top N target addresses in indirect-call profile.
10207
10208 max-once-peeled-insns
10209 The maximum number of insns of a peeled loop that rolls only
10210 once.
10211
10212 sra-max-scalarization-size-Osize
10213 Maximum size, in storage units, of an aggregate which should be
10214 considered for scalarization when compiling for size.
10215
10216 fsm-scale-path-blocks
10217 Scale factor to apply to the number of blocks in a threading
10218 path when comparing to the number of (scaled) statements.
10219
10220 sched-autopref-queue-depth
10221 Hardware autoprefetcher scheduler model control flag. Number
10222 of lookahead cycles the model looks into; at ' ' only enable
10223 instruction sorting heuristic.
10224
10225 loop-versioning-max-inner-insns
10226 The maximum number of instructions that an inner loop can have
10227 before the loop versioning pass considers it too big to copy.
10228
10229 loop-versioning-max-outer-insns
10230 The maximum number of instructions that an outer loop can have
10231 before the loop versioning pass considers it too big to copy,
10232 discounting any instructions in inner loops that directly
10233 benefit from versioning.
10234
10235 ssa-name-def-chain-limit
10236 The maximum number of SSA_NAME assignments to follow in
10237 determining a property of a variable such as its value. This
10238 limits the number of iterations or recursive calls GCC performs
10239 when optimizing certain statements or when determining their
10240 validity prior to issuing diagnostics.
10241
10242 Program Instrumentation Options
10243 GCC supports a number of command-line options that control adding run-
10244 time instrumentation to the code it normally generates. For example,
10245 one purpose of instrumentation is collect profiling statistics for use
10246 in finding program hot spots, code coverage analysis, or profile-guided
10247 optimizations. Another class of program instrumentation is adding run-
10248 time checking to detect programming errors like invalid pointer
10249 dereferences or out-of-bounds array accesses, as well as deliberately
10250 hostile attacks such as stack smashing or C++ vtable hijacking. There
10251 is also a general hook which can be used to implement other forms of
10252 tracing or function-level instrumentation for debug or program analysis
10253 purposes.
10254
10255 -p
10256 -pg Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
10257 analysis program prof (for -p) or gprof (for -pg). You must use
10258 this option when compiling the source files you want data about,
10259 and you must also use it when linking.
10260
10261 You can use the function attribute "no_instrument_function" to
10262 suppress profiling of individual functions when compiling with
10263 these options.
10264
10265 -fprofile-arcs
10266 Add code so that program flow arcs are instrumented. During
10267 execution the program records how many times each branch and call
10268 is executed and how many times it is taken or returns. On targets
10269 that support constructors with priority support, profiling properly
10270 handles constructors, destructors and C++ constructors (and
10271 destructors) of classes which are used as a type of a global
10272 variable.
10273
10274 When the compiled program exits it saves this data to a file called
10275 auxname.gcda for each source file. The data may be used for
10276 profile-directed optimizations (-fbranch-probabilities), or for
10277 test coverage analysis (-ftest-coverage). Each object file's
10278 auxname is generated from the name of the output file, if
10279 explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise
10280 it is the basename of the source file. In both cases any suffix is
10281 removed (e.g. foo.gcda for input file dir/foo.c, or dir/foo.gcda
10282 for output file specified as -o dir/foo.o).
10283
10284 --coverage
10285 This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for
10286 coverage analysis. The option is a synonym for -fprofile-arcs
10287 -ftest-coverage (when compiling) and -lgcov (when linking). See
10288 the documentation for those options for more details.
10289
10290 * Compile the source files with -fprofile-arcs plus optimization
10291 and code generation options. For test coverage analysis, use
10292 the additional -ftest-coverage option. You do not need to
10293 profile every source file in a program.
10294
10295 * Compile the source files additionally with -fprofile-abs-path
10296 to create absolute path names in the .gcno files. This allows
10297 gcov to find the correct sources in projects where compilations
10298 occur with different working directories.
10299
10300 * Link your object files with -lgcov or -fprofile-arcs (the
10301 latter implies the former).
10302
10303 * Run the program on a representative workload to generate the
10304 arc profile information. This may be repeated any number of
10305 times. You can run concurrent instances of your program, and
10306 provided that the file system supports locking, the data files
10307 will be correctly updated. Unless a strict ISO C dialect
10308 option is in effect, "fork" calls are detected and correctly
10309 handled without double counting.
10310
10311 * For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files
10312 again with the same optimization and code generation options
10313 plus -fbranch-probabilities.
10314
10315 * For test coverage analysis, use gcov to produce human readable
10316 information from the .gcno and .gcda files. Refer to the gcov
10317 documentation for further information.
10318
10319 With -fprofile-arcs, for each function of your program GCC creates
10320 a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
10321 Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be
10322 instrumented: the compiler adds code to count the number of times
10323 that these arcs are executed. When an arc is the only exit or only
10324 entrance to a block, the instrumentation code can be added to the
10325 block; otherwise, a new basic block must be created to hold the
10326 instrumentation code.
10327
10328 -ftest-coverage
10329 Produce a notes file that the gcov code-coverage utility can use to
10330 show program coverage. Each source file's note file is called
10331 auxname.gcno. Refer to the -fprofile-arcs option above for a
10332 description of auxname and instructions on how to generate test
10333 coverage data. Coverage data matches the source files more closely
10334 if you do not optimize.
10335
10336 -fprofile-abs-path
10337 Automatically convert relative source file names to absolute path
10338 names in the .gcno files. This allows gcov to find the correct
10339 sources in projects where compilations occur with different working
10340 directories.
10341
10342 -fprofile-dir=path
10343 Set the directory to search for the profile data files in to path.
10344 This option affects only the profile data generated by
10345 -fprofile-generate, -ftest-coverage, -fprofile-arcs and used by
10346 -fprofile-use and -fbranch-probabilities and its related options.
10347 Both absolute and relative paths can be used. By default, GCC uses
10348 the current directory as path, thus the profile data file appears
10349 in the same directory as the object file. In order to prevent the
10350 file name clashing, if the object file name is not an absolute
10351 path, we mangle the absolute path of the sourcename.gcda file and
10352 use it as the file name of a .gcda file.
10353
10354 When an executable is run in a massive parallel environment, it is
10355 recommended to save profile to different folders. That can be done
10356 with variables in path that are exported during run-time:
10357
10358 %p process ID.
10359
10360 %q{VAR}
10361 value of environment variable VAR
10362
10363 -fprofile-generate
10364 -fprofile-generate=path
10365 Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to
10366 produce profile useful for later recompilation with profile
10367 feedback based optimization. You must use -fprofile-generate both
10368 when compiling and when linking your program.
10369
10370 The following options are enabled: -fprofile-arcs,
10371 -fprofile-values, -finline-functions, and -fipa-bit-cp.
10372
10373 If path is specified, GCC looks at the path to find the profile
10374 feedback data files. See -fprofile-dir.
10375
10376 To optimize the program based on the collected profile information,
10377 use -fprofile-use.
10378
10379 -fprofile-update=method
10380 Alter the update method for an application instrumented for profile
10381 feedback based optimization. The method argument should be one of
10382 single, atomic or prefer-atomic. The first one is useful for
10383 single-threaded applications, while the second one prevents profile
10384 corruption by emitting thread-safe code.
10385
10386 Warning: When an application does not properly join all threads (or
10387 creates an detached thread), a profile file can be still corrupted.
10388
10389 Using prefer-atomic would be transformed either to atomic, when
10390 supported by a target, or to single otherwise. The GCC driver
10391 automatically selects prefer-atomic when -pthread is present in the
10392 command line.
10393
10394 -fprofile-filter-files=regex
10395 Instrument only functions from files where names match any regular
10396 expression (separated by a semi-colon).
10397
10398 For example, -fprofile-filter-files=main.c;module.*.c will
10399 instrument only main.c and all C files starting with 'module'.
10400
10401 -fprofile-exclude-files=regex
10402 Instrument only functions from files where names do not match all
10403 the regular expressions (separated by a semi-colon).
10404
10405 For example, -fprofile-exclude-files=/usr/* will prevent
10406 instrumentation of all files that are located in /usr/ folder.
10407
10408 -fsanitize=address
10409 Enable AddressSanitizer, a fast memory error detector. Memory
10410 access instructions are instrumented to detect out-of-bounds and
10411 use-after-free bugs. The option enables
10412 -fsanitize-address-use-after-scope. See
10413 <https://github.com/google/sanitizers/wiki/AddressSanitizer> for
10414 more details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using the
10415 ASAN_OPTIONS environment variable. When set to "help=1", the
10416 available options are shown at startup of the instrumented program.
10417 See
10418 <https://github.com/google/sanitizers/wiki/AddressSanitizerFlags#run-time-flags>
10419 for a list of supported options. The option cannot be combined
10420 with -fsanitize=thread.
10421
10422 -fsanitize=kernel-address
10423 Enable AddressSanitizer for Linux kernel. See
10424 <https://github.com/google/kasan/wiki> for more details.
10425
10426 -fsanitize=pointer-compare
10427 Instrument comparison operation (<, <=, >, >=) with pointer
10428 operands. The option must be combined with either
10429 -fsanitize=kernel-address or -fsanitize=address The option cannot
10430 be combined with -fsanitize=thread. Note: By default the check is
10431 disabled at run time. To enable it, add
10432 "detect_invalid_pointer_pairs=2" to the environment variable
10433 ASAN_OPTIONS. Using "detect_invalid_pointer_pairs=1" detects
10434 invalid operation only when both pointers are non-null.
10435
10436 -fsanitize=pointer-subtract
10437 Instrument subtraction with pointer operands. The option must be
10438 combined with either -fsanitize=kernel-address or
10439 -fsanitize=address The option cannot be combined with
10440 -fsanitize=thread. Note: By default the check is disabled at run
10441 time. To enable it, add "detect_invalid_pointer_pairs=2" to the
10442 environment variable ASAN_OPTIONS. Using
10443 "detect_invalid_pointer_pairs=1" detects invalid operation only
10444 when both pointers are non-null.
10445
10446 -fsanitize=thread
10447 Enable ThreadSanitizer, a fast data race detector. Memory access
10448 instructions are instrumented to detect data race bugs. See
10449 <https://github.com/google/sanitizers/wiki#threadsanitizer> for
10450 more details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using the
10451 TSAN_OPTIONS environment variable; see
10452 <https://github.com/google/sanitizers/wiki/ThreadSanitizerFlags>
10453 for a list of supported options. The option cannot be combined
10454 with -fsanitize=address, -fsanitize=leak.
10455
10456 Note that sanitized atomic builtins cannot throw exceptions when
10457 operating on invalid memory addresses with non-call exceptions
10458 (-fnon-call-exceptions).
10459
10460 -fsanitize=leak
10461 Enable LeakSanitizer, a memory leak detector. This option only
10462 matters for linking of executables and the executable is linked
10463 against a library that overrides "malloc" and other allocator
10464 functions. See
10465 <https://github.com/google/sanitizers/wiki/AddressSanitizerLeakSanitizer>
10466 for more details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using
10467 the LSAN_OPTIONS environment variable. The option cannot be
10468 combined with -fsanitize=thread.
10469
10470 -fsanitize=undefined
10471 Enable UndefinedBehaviorSanitizer, a fast undefined behavior
10472 detector. Various computations are instrumented to detect
10473 undefined behavior at runtime. Current suboptions are:
10474
10475 -fsanitize=shift
10476 This option enables checking that the result of a shift
10477 operation is not undefined. Note that what exactly is
10478 considered undefined differs slightly between C and C++, as
10479 well as between ISO C90 and C99, etc. This option has two
10480 suboptions, -fsanitize=shift-base and
10481 -fsanitize=shift-exponent.
10482
10483 -fsanitize=shift-exponent
10484 This option enables checking that the second argument of a
10485 shift operation is not negative and is smaller than the
10486 precision of the promoted first argument.
10487
10488 -fsanitize=shift-base
10489 If the second argument of a shift operation is within range,
10490 check that the result of a shift operation is not undefined.
10491 Note that what exactly is considered undefined differs slightly
10492 between C and C++, as well as between ISO C90 and C99, etc.
10493
10494 -fsanitize=integer-divide-by-zero
10495 Detect integer division by zero as well as "INT_MIN / -1"
10496 division.
10497
10498 -fsanitize=unreachable
10499 With this option, the compiler turns the
10500 "__builtin_unreachable" call into a diagnostics message call
10501 instead. When reaching the "__builtin_unreachable" call, the
10502 behavior is undefined.
10503
10504 -fsanitize=vla-bound
10505 This option instructs the compiler to check that the size of a
10506 variable length array is positive.
10507
10508 -fsanitize=null
10509 This option enables pointer checking. Particularly, the
10510 application built with this option turned on will issue an
10511 error message when it tries to dereference a NULL pointer, or
10512 if a reference (possibly an rvalue reference) is bound to a
10513 NULL pointer, or if a method is invoked on an object pointed by
10514 a NULL pointer.
10515
10516 -fsanitize=return
10517 This option enables return statement checking. Programs built
10518 with this option turned on will issue an error message when the
10519 end of a non-void function is reached without actually
10520 returning a value. This option works in C++ only.
10521
10522 -fsanitize=signed-integer-overflow
10523 This option enables signed integer overflow checking. We check
10524 that the result of "+", "*", and both unary and binary "-" does
10525 not overflow in the signed arithmetics. Note, integer
10526 promotion rules must be taken into account. That is, the
10527 following is not an overflow:
10528
10529 signed char a = SCHAR_MAX;
10530 a++;
10531
10532 -fsanitize=bounds
10533 This option enables instrumentation of array bounds. Various
10534 out of bounds accesses are detected. Flexible array members,
10535 flexible array member-like arrays, and initializers of
10536 variables with static storage are not instrumented.
10537
10538 -fsanitize=bounds-strict
10539 This option enables strict instrumentation of array bounds.
10540 Most out of bounds accesses are detected, including flexible
10541 array members and flexible array member-like arrays.
10542 Initializers of variables with static storage are not
10543 instrumented.
10544
10545 -fsanitize=alignment
10546 This option enables checking of alignment of pointers when they
10547 are dereferenced, or when a reference is bound to
10548 insufficiently aligned target, or when a method or constructor
10549 is invoked on insufficiently aligned object.
10550
10551 -fsanitize=object-size
10552 This option enables instrumentation of memory references using
10553 the "__builtin_object_size" function. Various out of bounds
10554 pointer accesses are detected.
10555
10556 -fsanitize=float-divide-by-zero
10557 Detect floating-point division by zero. Unlike other similar
10558 options, -fsanitize=float-divide-by-zero is not enabled by
10559 -fsanitize=undefined, since floating-point division by zero can
10560 be a legitimate way of obtaining infinities and NaNs.
10561
10562 -fsanitize=float-cast-overflow
10563 This option enables floating-point type to integer conversion
10564 checking. We check that the result of the conversion does not
10565 overflow. Unlike other similar options,
10566 -fsanitize=float-cast-overflow is not enabled by
10567 -fsanitize=undefined. This option does not work well with
10568 "FE_INVALID" exceptions enabled.
10569
10570 -fsanitize=nonnull-attribute
10571 This option enables instrumentation of calls, checking whether
10572 null values are not passed to arguments marked as requiring a
10573 non-null value by the "nonnull" function attribute.
10574
10575 -fsanitize=returns-nonnull-attribute
10576 This option enables instrumentation of return statements in
10577 functions marked with "returns_nonnull" function attribute, to
10578 detect returning of null values from such functions.
10579
10580 -fsanitize=bool
10581 This option enables instrumentation of loads from bool. If a
10582 value other than 0/1 is loaded, a run-time error is issued.
10583
10584 -fsanitize=enum
10585 This option enables instrumentation of loads from an enum type.
10586 If a value outside the range of values for the enum type is
10587 loaded, a run-time error is issued.
10588
10589 -fsanitize=vptr
10590 This option enables instrumentation of C++ member function
10591 calls, member accesses and some conversions between pointers to
10592 base and derived classes, to verify the referenced object has
10593 the correct dynamic type.
10594
10595 -fsanitize=pointer-overflow
10596 This option enables instrumentation of pointer arithmetics. If
10597 the pointer arithmetics overflows, a run-time error is issued.
10598
10599 -fsanitize=builtin
10600 This option enables instrumentation of arguments to selected
10601 builtin functions. If an invalid value is passed to such
10602 arguments, a run-time error is issued. E.g. passing 0 as the
10603 argument to "__builtin_ctz" or "__builtin_clz" invokes
10604 undefined behavior and is diagnosed by this option.
10605
10606 While -ftrapv causes traps for signed overflows to be emitted,
10607 -fsanitize=undefined gives a diagnostic message. This currently
10608 works only for the C family of languages.
10609
10610 -fno-sanitize=all
10611 This option disables all previously enabled sanitizers.
10612 -fsanitize=all is not allowed, as some sanitizers cannot be used
10613 together.
10614
10615 -fasan-shadow-offset=number
10616 This option forces GCC to use custom shadow offset in
10617 AddressSanitizer checks. It is useful for experimenting with
10618 different shadow memory layouts in Kernel AddressSanitizer.
10619
10620 -fsanitize-sections=s1,s2,...
10621 Sanitize global variables in selected user-defined sections. si
10622 may contain wildcards.
10623
10624 -fsanitize-recover[=opts]
10625 -fsanitize-recover= controls error recovery mode for sanitizers
10626 mentioned in comma-separated list of opts. Enabling this option
10627 for a sanitizer component causes it to attempt to continue running
10628 the program as if no error happened. This means multiple runtime
10629 errors can be reported in a single program run, and the exit code
10630 of the program may indicate success even when errors have been
10631 reported. The -fno-sanitize-recover= option can be used to alter
10632 this behavior: only the first detected error is reported and
10633 program then exits with a non-zero exit code.
10634
10635 Currently this feature only works for -fsanitize=undefined (and its
10636 suboptions except for -fsanitize=unreachable and
10637 -fsanitize=return), -fsanitize=float-cast-overflow,
10638 -fsanitize=float-divide-by-zero, -fsanitize=bounds-strict,
10639 -fsanitize=kernel-address and -fsanitize=address. For these
10640 sanitizers error recovery is turned on by default, except
10641 -fsanitize=address, for which this feature is experimental.
10642 -fsanitize-recover=all and -fno-sanitize-recover=all is also
10643 accepted, the former enables recovery for all sanitizers that
10644 support it, the latter disables recovery for all sanitizers that
10645 support it.
10646
10647 Even if a recovery mode is turned on the compiler side, it needs to
10648 be also enabled on the runtime library side, otherwise the failures
10649 are still fatal. The runtime library defaults to "halt_on_error=0"
10650 for ThreadSanitizer and UndefinedBehaviorSanitizer, while default
10651 value for AddressSanitizer is "halt_on_error=1". This can be
10652 overridden through setting the "halt_on_error" flag in the
10653 corresponding environment variable.
10654
10655 Syntax without an explicit opts parameter is deprecated. It is
10656 equivalent to specifying an opts list of:
10657
10658 undefined,float-cast-overflow,float-divide-by-zero,bounds-strict
10659
10660 -fsanitize-address-use-after-scope
10661 Enable sanitization of local variables to detect use-after-scope
10662 bugs. The option sets -fstack-reuse to none.
10663
10664 -fsanitize-undefined-trap-on-error
10665 The -fsanitize-undefined-trap-on-error option instructs the
10666 compiler to report undefined behavior using "__builtin_trap" rather
10667 than a "libubsan" library routine. The advantage of this is that
10668 the "libubsan" library is not needed and is not linked in, so this
10669 is usable even in freestanding environments.
10670
10671 -fsanitize-coverage=trace-pc
10672 Enable coverage-guided fuzzing code instrumentation. Inserts a
10673 call to "__sanitizer_cov_trace_pc" into every basic block.
10674
10675 -fsanitize-coverage=trace-cmp
10676 Enable dataflow guided fuzzing code instrumentation. Inserts a
10677 call to "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmp1", "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmp2",
10678 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmp4" or "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmp8" for
10679 integral comparison with both operands variable or
10680 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_const_cmp1",
10681 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_const_cmp2",
10682 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_const_cmp4" or
10683 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_const_cmp8" for integral comparison with one
10684 operand constant, "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmpf" or
10685 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_cmpd" for float or double comparisons and
10686 "__sanitizer_cov_trace_switch" for switch statements.
10687
10688 -fcf-protection=[full|branch|return|none]
10689 Enable code instrumentation of control-flow transfers to increase
10690 program security by checking that target addresses of control-flow
10691 transfer instructions (such as indirect function call, function
10692 return, indirect jump) are valid. This prevents diverting the flow
10693 of control to an unexpected target. This is intended to protect
10694 against such threats as Return-oriented Programming (ROP), and
10695 similarly call/jmp-oriented programming (COP/JOP).
10696
10697 The value "branch" tells the compiler to implement checking of
10698 validity of control-flow transfer at the point of indirect branch
10699 instructions, i.e. call/jmp instructions. The value "return"
10700 implements checking of validity at the point of returning from a
10701 function. The value "full" is an alias for specifying both
10702 "branch" and "return". The value "none" turns off instrumentation.
10703
10704 The macro "__CET__" is defined when -fcf-protection is used. The
10705 first bit of "__CET__" is set to 1 for the value "branch" and the
10706 second bit of "__CET__" is set to 1 for the "return".
10707
10708 You can also use the "nocf_check" attribute to identify which
10709 functions and calls should be skipped from instrumentation.
10710
10711 Currently the x86 GNU/Linux target provides an implementation based
10712 on Intel Control-flow Enforcement Technology (CET).
10713
10714 -fstack-protector
10715 Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack
10716 smashing attacks. This is done by adding a guard variable to
10717 functions with vulnerable objects. This includes functions that
10718 call "alloca", and functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes. The
10719 guards are initialized when a function is entered and then checked
10720 when the function exits. If a guard check fails, an error message
10721 is printed and the program exits.
10722
10723 -fstack-protector-all
10724 Like -fstack-protector except that all functions are protected.
10725
10726 -fstack-protector-strong
10727 Like -fstack-protector but includes additional functions to be
10728 protected --- those that have local array definitions, or have
10729 references to local frame addresses.
10730
10731 -fstack-protector-explicit
10732 Like -fstack-protector but only protects those functions which have
10733 the "stack_protect" attribute.
10734
10735 -fstack-check
10736 Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of
10737 the stack. You should specify this flag if you are running in an
10738 environment with multiple threads, but you only rarely need to
10739 specify it in a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is
10740 automatically detected on nearly all systems if there is only one
10741 stack.
10742
10743 Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done;
10744 the operating system or the language runtime must do that. The
10745 switch causes generation of code to ensure that they see the stack
10746 being extended.
10747
10748 You can additionally specify a string parameter: no means no
10749 checking, generic means force the use of old-style checking,
10750 specific means use the best checking method and is equivalent to
10751 bare -fstack-check.
10752
10753 Old-style checking is a generic mechanism that requires no specific
10754 target support in the compiler but comes with the following
10755 drawbacks:
10756
10757 1. Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they are always
10758 allocated dynamically if their size exceeds a fixed threshold.
10759 Note this may change the semantics of some code.
10760
10761 2. Fixed limit on the size of the static frame of functions: when
10762 it is topped by a particular function, stack checking is not
10763 reliable and a warning is issued by the compiler.
10764
10765 3. Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy
10766 and the generic implementation, code performance is hampered.
10767
10768 Note that old-style stack checking is also the fallback method for
10769 specific if no target support has been added in the compiler.
10770
10771 -fstack-check= is designed for Ada's needs to detect infinite
10772 recursion and stack overflows. specific is an excellent choice
10773 when compiling Ada code. It is not generally sufficient to protect
10774 against stack-clash attacks. To protect against those you want
10775 -fstack-clash-protection.
10776
10777 -fstack-clash-protection
10778 Generate code to prevent stack clash style attacks. When this
10779 option is enabled, the compiler will only allocate one page of
10780 stack space at a time and each page is accessed immediately after
10781 allocation. Thus, it prevents allocations from jumping over any
10782 stack guard page provided by the operating system.
10783
10784 Most targets do not fully support stack clash protection. However,
10785 on those targets -fstack-clash-protection will protect dynamic
10786 stack allocations. -fstack-clash-protection may also provide
10787 limited protection for static stack allocations if the target
10788 supports -fstack-check=specific.
10789
10790 -fstack-limit-register=reg
10791 -fstack-limit-symbol=sym
10792 -fno-stack-limit
10793 Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a
10794 certain value, either the value of a register or the address of a
10795 symbol. If a larger stack is required, a signal is raised at run
10796 time. For most targets, the signal is raised before the stack
10797 overruns the boundary, so it is possible to catch the signal
10798 without taking special precautions.
10799
10800 For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address 0x80000000
10801 and grows downwards, you can use the flags
10802 -fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit and
10803 -Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000 to enforce a stack limit of
10804 128KB. Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
10805
10806 You can locally override stack limit checking by using the
10807 "no_stack_limit" function attribute.
10808
10809 -fsplit-stack
10810 Generate code to automatically split the stack before it overflows.
10811 The resulting program has a discontiguous stack which can only
10812 overflow if the program is unable to allocate any more memory.
10813 This is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no
10814 longer necessary to calculate a good stack size to use for each
10815 thread. This is currently only implemented for the x86 targets
10816 running GNU/Linux.
10817
10818 When code compiled with -fsplit-stack calls code compiled without
10819 -fsplit-stack, there may not be much stack space available for the
10820 latter code to run. If compiling all code, including library code,
10821 with -fsplit-stack is not an option, then the linker can fix up
10822 these calls so that the code compiled without -fsplit-stack always
10823 has a large stack. Support for this is implemented in the gold
10824 linker in GNU binutils release 2.21 and later.
10825
10826 -fvtable-verify=[std|preinit|none]
10827 This option is only available when compiling C++ code. It turns on
10828 (or off, if using -fvtable-verify=none) the security feature that
10829 verifies at run time, for every virtual call, that the vtable
10830 pointer through which the call is made is valid for the type of the
10831 object, and has not been corrupted or overwritten. If an invalid
10832 vtable pointer is detected at run time, an error is reported and
10833 execution of the program is immediately halted.
10834
10835 This option causes run-time data structures to be built at program
10836 startup, which are used for verifying the vtable pointers. The
10837 options std and preinit control the timing of when these data
10838 structures are built. In both cases the data structures are built
10839 before execution reaches "main". Using -fvtable-verify=std causes
10840 the data structures to be built after shared libraries have been
10841 loaded and initialized. -fvtable-verify=preinit causes them to be
10842 built before shared libraries have been loaded and initialized.
10843
10844 If this option appears multiple times in the command line with
10845 different values specified, none takes highest priority over both
10846 std and preinit; preinit takes priority over std.
10847
10848 -fvtv-debug
10849 When used in conjunction with -fvtable-verify=std or
10850 -fvtable-verify=preinit, causes debug versions of the runtime
10851 functions for the vtable verification feature to be called. This
10852 flag also causes the compiler to log information about which vtable
10853 pointers it finds for each class. This information is written to a
10854 file named vtv_set_ptr_data.log in the directory named by the
10855 environment variable VTV_LOGS_DIR if that is defined or the current
10856 working directory otherwise.
10857
10858 Note: This feature appends data to the log file. If you want a
10859 fresh log file, be sure to delete any existing one.
10860
10861 -fvtv-counts
10862 This is a debugging flag. When used in conjunction with
10863 -fvtable-verify=std or -fvtable-verify=preinit, this causes the
10864 compiler to keep track of the total number of virtual calls it
10865 encounters and the number of verifications it inserts. It also
10866 counts the number of calls to certain run-time library functions
10867 that it inserts and logs this information for each compilation
10868 unit. The compiler writes this information to a file named
10869 vtv_count_data.log in the directory named by the environment
10870 variable VTV_LOGS_DIR if that is defined or the current working
10871 directory otherwise. It also counts the size of the vtable pointer
10872 sets for each class, and writes this information to
10873 vtv_class_set_sizes.log in the same directory.
10874
10875 Note: This feature appends data to the log files. To get fresh
10876 log files, be sure to delete any existing ones.
10877
10878 -finstrument-functions
10879 Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.
10880 Just after function entry and just before function exit, the
10881 following profiling functions are called with the address of the
10882 current function and its call site. (On some platforms,
10883 "__builtin_return_address" does not work beyond the current
10884 function, so the call site information may not be available to the
10885 profiling functions otherwise.)
10886
10887 void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
10888 void *call_site);
10889 void __cyg_profile_func_exit (void *this_fn,
10890 void *call_site);
10891
10892 The first argument is the address of the start of the current
10893 function, which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
10894
10895 This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in
10896 other functions. The profiling calls indicate where, conceptually,
10897 the inline function is entered and exited. This means that
10898 addressable versions of such functions must be available. If all
10899 your uses of a function are expanded inline, this may mean an
10900 additional expansion of code size. If you use "extern inline" in
10901 your C code, an addressable version of such functions must be
10902 provided. (This is normally the case anyway, but if you get lucky
10903 and the optimizer always expands the functions inline, you might
10904 have gotten away without providing static copies.)
10905
10906 A function may be given the attribute "no_instrument_function", in
10907 which case this instrumentation is not done. This can be used, for
10908 example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
10909 interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling
10910 functions cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the
10911 profiling routines generate output or allocate memory).
10912
10913 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...
10914 Set the list of functions that are excluded from instrumentation
10915 (see the description of -finstrument-functions). If the file that
10916 contains a function definition matches with one of file, then that
10917 function is not instrumented. The match is done on substrings: if
10918 the file parameter is a substring of the file name, it is
10919 considered to be a match.
10920
10921 For example:
10922
10923 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys
10924
10925 excludes any inline function defined in files whose pathnames
10926 contain /bits/stl or include/sys.
10927
10928 If, for some reason, you want to include letter , in one of sym,
10929 write ,. For example,
10930 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=',,tmp' (note the single
10931 quote surrounding the option).
10932
10933 -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
10934 This is similar to -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list, but
10935 this option sets the list of function names to be excluded from
10936 instrumentation. The function name to be matched is its user-
10937 visible name, such as "vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)", not
10938 the internal mangled name (e.g., "_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE"). The
10939 match is done on substrings: if the sym parameter is a substring of
10940 the function name, it is considered to be a match. For C99 and C++
10941 extended identifiers, the function name must be given in UTF-8, not
10942 using universal character names.
10943
10944 -fpatchable-function-entry=N[,M]
10945 Generate N NOPs right at the beginning of each function, with the
10946 function entry point before the Mth NOP. If M is omitted, it
10947 defaults to 0 so the function entry points to the address just at
10948 the first NOP. The NOP instructions reserve extra space which can
10949 be used to patch in any desired instrumentation at run time,
10950 provided that the code segment is writable. The amount of space is
10951 controllable indirectly via the number of NOPs; the NOP instruction
10952 used corresponds to the instruction emitted by the internal GCC
10953 back-end interface "gen_nop". This behavior is target-specific and
10954 may also depend on the architecture variant and/or other
10955 compilation options.
10956
10957 For run-time identification, the starting addresses of these areas,
10958 which correspond to their respective function entries minus M, are
10959 additionally collected in the "__patchable_function_entries"
10960 section of the resulting binary.
10961
10962 Note that the value of "__attribute__ ((patchable_function_entry
10963 (N,M)))" takes precedence over command-line option
10964 -fpatchable-function-entry=N,M. This can be used to increase the
10965 area size or to remove it completely on a single function. If
10966 "N=0", no pad location is recorded.
10967
10968 The NOP instructions are inserted at---and maybe before, depending
10969 on M---the function entry address, even before the prologue.
10970
10971 Options Controlling the Preprocessor
10972 These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
10973 file before actual compilation.
10974
10975 If you use the -E option, nothing is done except preprocessing. Some
10976 of these options make sense only together with -E because they cause
10977 the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual compilation.
10978
10979 In addition to the options listed here, there are a number of options
10980 to control search paths for include files documented in Directory
10981 Options. Options to control preprocessor diagnostics are listed in
10982 Warning Options.
10983
10984 -D name
10985 Predefine name as a macro, with definition 1.
10986
10987 -D name=definition
10988 The contents of definition are tokenized and processed as if they
10989 appeared during translation phase three in a #define directive. In
10990 particular, the definition is truncated by embedded newline
10991 characters.
10992
10993 If you are invoking the preprocessor from a shell or shell-like
10994 program you may need to use the shell's quoting syntax to protect
10995 characters such as spaces that have a meaning in the shell syntax.
10996
10997 If you wish to define a function-like macro on the command line,
10998 write its argument list with surrounding parentheses before the
10999 equals sign (if any). Parentheses are meaningful to most shells,
11000 so you should quote the option. With sh and csh,
11001 -D'name(args...)=definition' works.
11002
11003 -D and -U options are processed in the order they are given on the
11004 command line. All -imacros file and -include file options are
11005 processed after all -D and -U options.
11006
11007 -U name
11008 Cancel any previous definition of name, either built in or provided
11009 with a -D option.
11010
11011 -include file
11012 Process file as if "#include "file"" appeared as the first line of
11013 the primary source file. However, the first directory searched for
11014 file is the preprocessor's working directory instead of the
11015 directory containing the main source file. If not found there, it
11016 is searched for in the remainder of the "#include "..."" search
11017 chain as normal.
11018
11019 If multiple -include options are given, the files are included in
11020 the order they appear on the command line.
11021
11022 -imacros file
11023 Exactly like -include, except that any output produced by scanning
11024 file is thrown away. Macros it defines remain defined. This
11025 allows you to acquire all the macros from a header without also
11026 processing its declarations.
11027
11028 All files specified by -imacros are processed before all files
11029 specified by -include.
11030
11031 -undef
11032 Do not predefine any system-specific or GCC-specific macros. The
11033 standard predefined macros remain defined.
11034
11035 -pthread
11036 Define additional macros required for using the POSIX threads
11037 library. You should use this option consistently for both
11038 compilation and linking. This option is supported on GNU/Linux
11039 targets, most other Unix derivatives, and also on x86 Cygwin and
11040 MinGW targets.
11041
11042 -M Instead of outputting the result of preprocessing, output a rule
11043 suitable for make describing the dependencies of the main source
11044 file. The preprocessor outputs one make rule containing the object
11045 file name for that source file, a colon, and the names of all the
11046 included files, including those coming from -include or -imacros
11047 command-line options.
11048
11049 Unless specified explicitly (with -MT or -MQ), the object file name
11050 consists of the name of the source file with any suffix replaced
11051 with object file suffix and with any leading directory parts
11052 removed. If there are many included files then the rule is split
11053 into several lines using \-newline. The rule has no commands.
11054
11055 This option does not suppress the preprocessor's debug output, such
11056 as -dM. To avoid mixing such debug output with the dependency
11057 rules you should explicitly specify the dependency output file with
11058 -MF, or use an environment variable like DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT.
11059 Debug output is still sent to the regular output stream as normal.
11060
11061 Passing -M to the driver implies -E, and suppresses warnings with
11062 an implicit -w.
11063
11064 -MM Like -M but do not mention header files that are found in system
11065 header directories, nor header files that are included, directly or
11066 indirectly, from such a header.
11067
11068 This implies that the choice of angle brackets or double quotes in
11069 an #include directive does not in itself determine whether that
11070 header appears in -MM dependency output.
11071
11072 -MF file
11073 When used with -M or -MM, specifies a file to write the
11074 dependencies to. If no -MF switch is given the preprocessor sends
11075 the rules to the same place it would send preprocessed output.
11076
11077 When used with the driver options -MD or -MMD, -MF overrides the
11078 default dependency output file.
11079
11080 If file is -, then the dependencies are written to stdout.
11081
11082 -MG In conjunction with an option such as -M requesting dependency
11083 generation, -MG assumes missing header files are generated files
11084 and adds them to the dependency list without raising an error. The
11085 dependency filename is taken directly from the "#include" directive
11086 without prepending any path. -MG also suppresses preprocessed
11087 output, as a missing header file renders this useless.
11088
11089 This feature is used in automatic updating of makefiles.
11090
11091 -MP This option instructs CPP to add a phony target for each dependency
11092 other than the main file, causing each to depend on nothing. These
11093 dummy rules work around errors make gives if you remove header
11094 files without updating the Makefile to match.
11095
11096 This is typical output:
11097
11098 test.o: test.c test.h
11099
11100 test.h:
11101
11102 -MT target
11103 Change the target of the rule emitted by dependency generation. By
11104 default CPP takes the name of the main input file, deletes any
11105 directory components and any file suffix such as .c, and appends
11106 the platform's usual object suffix. The result is the target.
11107
11108 An -MT option sets the target to be exactly the string you specify.
11109 If you want multiple targets, you can specify them as a single
11110 argument to -MT, or use multiple -MT options.
11111
11112 For example, -MT '$(objpfx)foo.o' might give
11113
11114 $(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c
11115
11116 -MQ target
11117 Same as -MT, but it quotes any characters which are special to
11118 Make. -MQ '$(objpfx)foo.o' gives
11119
11120 $$(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c
11121
11122 The default target is automatically quoted, as if it were given
11123 with -MQ.
11124
11125 -MD -MD is equivalent to -M -MF file, except that -E is not implied.
11126 The driver determines file based on whether an -o option is given.
11127 If it is, the driver uses its argument but with a suffix of .d,
11128 otherwise it takes the name of the input file, removes any
11129 directory components and suffix, and applies a .d suffix.
11130
11131 If -MD is used in conjunction with -E, any -o switch is understood
11132 to specify the dependency output file, but if used without -E, each
11133 -o is understood to specify a target object file.
11134
11135 Since -E is not implied, -MD can be used to generate a dependency
11136 output file as a side effect of the compilation process.
11137
11138 -MMD
11139 Like -MD except mention only user header files, not system header
11140 files.
11141
11142 -fpreprocessed
11143 Indicate to the preprocessor that the input file has already been
11144 preprocessed. This suppresses things like macro expansion,
11145 trigraph conversion, escaped newline splicing, and processing of
11146 most directives. The preprocessor still recognizes and removes
11147 comments, so that you can pass a file preprocessed with -C to the
11148 compiler without problems. In this mode the integrated
11149 preprocessor is little more than a tokenizer for the front ends.
11150
11151 -fpreprocessed is implicit if the input file has one of the
11152 extensions .i, .ii or .mi. These are the extensions that GCC uses
11153 for preprocessed files created by -save-temps.
11154
11155 -fdirectives-only
11156 When preprocessing, handle directives, but do not expand macros.
11157
11158 The option's behavior depends on the -E and -fpreprocessed options.
11159
11160 With -E, preprocessing is limited to the handling of directives
11161 such as "#define", "#ifdef", and "#error". Other preprocessor
11162 operations, such as macro expansion and trigraph conversion are not
11163 performed. In addition, the -dD option is implicitly enabled.
11164
11165 With -fpreprocessed, predefinition of command line and most builtin
11166 macros is disabled. Macros such as "__LINE__", which are
11167 contextually dependent, are handled normally. This enables
11168 compilation of files previously preprocessed with "-E
11169 -fdirectives-only".
11170
11171 With both -E and -fpreprocessed, the rules for -fpreprocessed take
11172 precedence. This enables full preprocessing of files previously
11173 preprocessed with "-E -fdirectives-only".
11174
11175 -fdollars-in-identifiers
11176 Accept $ in identifiers.
11177
11178 -fextended-identifiers
11179 Accept universal character names in identifiers. This option is
11180 enabled by default for C99 (and later C standard versions) and C++.
11181
11182 -fno-canonical-system-headers
11183 When preprocessing, do not shorten system header paths with
11184 canonicalization.
11185
11186 -ftabstop=width
11187 Set the distance between tab stops. This helps the preprocessor
11188 report correct column numbers in warnings or errors, even if tabs
11189 appear on the line. If the value is less than 1 or greater than
11190 100, the option is ignored. The default is 8.
11191
11192 -ftrack-macro-expansion[=level]
11193 Track locations of tokens across macro expansions. This allows the
11194 compiler to emit diagnostic about the current macro expansion stack
11195 when a compilation error occurs in a macro expansion. Using this
11196 option makes the preprocessor and the compiler consume more memory.
11197 The level parameter can be used to choose the level of precision of
11198 token location tracking thus decreasing the memory consumption if
11199 necessary. Value 0 of level de-activates this option. Value 1
11200 tracks tokens locations in a degraded mode for the sake of minimal
11201 memory overhead. In this mode all tokens resulting from the
11202 expansion of an argument of a function-like macro have the same
11203 location. Value 2 tracks tokens locations completely. This value is
11204 the most memory hungry. When this option is given no argument, the
11205 default parameter value is 2.
11206
11207 Note that "-ftrack-macro-expansion=2" is activated by default.
11208
11209 -fmacro-prefix-map=old=new
11210 When preprocessing files residing in directory old, expand the
11211 "__FILE__" and "__BASE_FILE__" macros as if the files resided in
11212 directory new instead. This can be used to change an absolute path
11213 to a relative path by using . for new which can result in more
11214 reproducible builds that are location independent. This option
11215 also affects "__builtin_FILE()" during compilation. See also
11216 -ffile-prefix-map.
11217
11218 -fexec-charset=charset
11219 Set the execution character set, used for string and character
11220 constants. The default is UTF-8. charset can be any encoding
11221 supported by the system's "iconv" library routine.
11222
11223 -fwide-exec-charset=charset
11224 Set the wide execution character set, used for wide string and
11225 character constants. The default is UTF-32 or UTF-16, whichever
11226 corresponds to the width of "wchar_t". As with -fexec-charset,
11227 charset can be any encoding supported by the system's "iconv"
11228 library routine; however, you will have problems with encodings
11229 that do not fit exactly in "wchar_t".
11230
11231 -finput-charset=charset
11232 Set the input character set, used for translation from the
11233 character set of the input file to the source character set used by
11234 GCC. If the locale does not specify, or GCC cannot get this
11235 information from the locale, the default is UTF-8. This can be
11236 overridden by either the locale or this command-line option.
11237 Currently the command-line option takes precedence if there's a
11238 conflict. charset can be any encoding supported by the system's
11239 "iconv" library routine.
11240
11241 -fpch-deps
11242 When using precompiled headers, this flag causes the dependency-
11243 output flags to also list the files from the precompiled header's
11244 dependencies. If not specified, only the precompiled header are
11245 listed and not the files that were used to create it, because those
11246 files are not consulted when a precompiled header is used.
11247
11248 -fpch-preprocess
11249 This option allows use of a precompiled header together with -E.
11250 It inserts a special "#pragma", "#pragma GCC pch_preprocess
11251 "filename"" in the output to mark the place where the precompiled
11252 header was found, and its filename. When -fpreprocessed is in use,
11253 GCC recognizes this "#pragma" and loads the PCH.
11254
11255 This option is off by default, because the resulting preprocessed
11256 output is only really suitable as input to GCC. It is switched on
11257 by -save-temps.
11258
11259 You should not write this "#pragma" in your own code, but it is
11260 safe to edit the filename if the PCH file is available in a
11261 different location. The filename may be absolute or it may be
11262 relative to GCC's current directory.
11263
11264 -fworking-directory
11265 Enable generation of linemarkers in the preprocessor output that
11266 let the compiler know the current working directory at the time of
11267 preprocessing. When this option is enabled, the preprocessor
11268 emits, after the initial linemarker, a second linemarker with the
11269 current working directory followed by two slashes. GCC uses this
11270 directory, when it's present in the preprocessed input, as the
11271 directory emitted as the current working directory in some
11272 debugging information formats. This option is implicitly enabled
11273 if debugging information is enabled, but this can be inhibited with
11274 the negated form -fno-working-directory. If the -P flag is present
11275 in the command line, this option has no effect, since no "#line"
11276 directives are emitted whatsoever.
11277
11278 -A predicate=answer
11279 Make an assertion with the predicate predicate and answer answer.
11280 This form is preferred to the older form -A predicate(answer),
11281 which is still supported, because it does not use shell special
11282 characters.
11283
11284 -A -predicate=answer
11285 Cancel an assertion with the predicate predicate and answer answer.
11286
11287 -C Do not discard comments. All comments are passed through to the
11288 output file, except for comments in processed directives, which are
11289 deleted along with the directive.
11290
11291 You should be prepared for side effects when using -C; it causes
11292 the preprocessor to treat comments as tokens in their own right.
11293 For example, comments appearing at the start of what would be a
11294 directive line have the effect of turning that line into an
11295 ordinary source line, since the first token on the line is no
11296 longer a #.
11297
11298 -CC Do not discard comments, including during macro expansion. This is
11299 like -C, except that comments contained within macros are also
11300 passed through to the output file where the macro is expanded.
11301
11302 In addition to the side effects of the -C option, the -CC option
11303 causes all C++-style comments inside a macro to be converted to
11304 C-style comments. This is to prevent later use of that macro from
11305 inadvertently commenting out the remainder of the source line.
11306
11307 The -CC option is generally used to support lint comments.
11308
11309 -P Inhibit generation of linemarkers in the output from the
11310 preprocessor. This might be useful when running the preprocessor
11311 on something that is not C code, and will be sent to a program
11312 which might be confused by the linemarkers.
11313
11314 -traditional
11315 -traditional-cpp
11316 Try to imitate the behavior of pre-standard C preprocessors, as
11317 opposed to ISO C preprocessors. See the GNU CPP manual for
11318 details.
11319
11320 Note that GCC does not otherwise attempt to emulate a pre-standard
11321 C compiler, and these options are only supported with the -E
11322 switch, or when invoking CPP explicitly.
11323
11324 -trigraphs
11325 Support ISO C trigraphs. These are three-character sequences, all
11326 starting with ??, that are defined by ISO C to stand for single
11327 characters. For example, ??/ stands for \, so '??/n' is a
11328 character constant for a newline.
11329
11330 The nine trigraphs and their replacements are
11331
11332 Trigraph: ??( ??) ??< ??> ??= ??/ ??' ??! ??-
11333 Replacement: [ ] { } # \ ^ | ~
11334
11335 By default, GCC ignores trigraphs, but in standard-conforming modes
11336 it converts them. See the -std and -ansi options.
11337
11338 -remap
11339 Enable special code to work around file systems which only permit
11340 very short file names, such as MS-DOS.
11341
11342 -H Print the name of each header file used, in addition to other
11343 normal activities. Each name is indented to show how deep in the
11344 #include stack it is. Precompiled header files are also printed,
11345 even if they are found to be invalid; an invalid precompiled header
11346 file is printed with ...x and a valid one with ...! .
11347
11348 -dletters
11349 Says to make debugging dumps during compilation as specified by
11350 letters. The flags documented here are those relevant to the
11351 preprocessor. Other letters are interpreted by the compiler
11352 proper, or reserved for future versions of GCC, and so are silently
11353 ignored. If you specify letters whose behavior conflicts, the
11354 result is undefined.
11355
11356 -dM Instead of the normal output, generate a list of #define
11357 directives for all the macros defined during the execution of
11358 the preprocessor, including predefined macros. This gives you
11359 a way of finding out what is predefined in your version of the
11360 preprocessor. Assuming you have no file foo.h, the command
11361
11362 touch foo.h; cpp -dM foo.h
11363
11364 shows all the predefined macros.
11365
11366 If you use -dM without the -E option, -dM is interpreted as a
11367 synonym for -fdump-rtl-mach.
11368
11369 -dD Like -dM except in two respects: it does not include the
11370 predefined macros, and it outputs both the #define directives
11371 and the result of preprocessing. Both kinds of output go to
11372 the standard output file.
11373
11374 -dN Like -dD, but emit only the macro names, not their expansions.
11375
11376 -dI Output #include directives in addition to the result of
11377 preprocessing.
11378
11379 -dU Like -dD except that only macros that are expanded, or whose
11380 definedness is tested in preprocessor directives, are output;
11381 the output is delayed until the use or test of the macro; and
11382 #undef directives are also output for macros tested but
11383 undefined at the time.
11384
11385 -fdebug-cpp
11386 This option is only useful for debugging GCC. When used from CPP
11387 or with -E, it dumps debugging information about location maps.
11388 Every token in the output is preceded by the dump of the map its
11389 location belongs to.
11390
11391 When used from GCC without -E, this option has no effect.
11392
11393 -Wp,option
11394 You can use -Wp,option to bypass the compiler driver and pass
11395 option directly through to the preprocessor. If option contains
11396 commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas. However,
11397 many options are modified, translated or interpreted by the
11398 compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and -Wp
11399 forcibly bypasses this phase. The preprocessor's direct interface
11400 is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible you
11401 should avoid using -Wp and let the driver handle the options
11402 instead.
11403
11404 -Xpreprocessor option
11405 Pass option as an option to the preprocessor. You can use this to
11406 supply system-specific preprocessor options that GCC does not
11407 recognize.
11408
11409 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
11410 -Xpreprocessor twice, once for the option and once for the
11411 argument.
11412
11413 -no-integrated-cpp
11414 Perform preprocessing as a separate pass before compilation. By
11415 default, GCC performs preprocessing as an integrated part of input
11416 tokenization and parsing. If this option is provided, the
11417 appropriate language front end (cc1, cc1plus, or cc1obj for C, C++,
11418 and Objective-C, respectively) is instead invoked twice, once for
11419 preprocessing only and once for actual compilation of the
11420 preprocessed input. This option may be useful in conjunction with
11421 the -B or -wrapper options to specify an alternate preprocessor or
11422 perform additional processing of the program source between normal
11423 preprocessing and compilation.
11424
11425 Passing Options to the Assembler
11426 You can pass options to the assembler.
11427
11428 -Wa,option
11429 Pass option as an option to the assembler. If option contains
11430 commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
11431
11432 -Xassembler option
11433 Pass option as an option to the assembler. You can use this to
11434 supply system-specific assembler options that GCC does not
11435 recognize.
11436
11437 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
11438 -Xassembler twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
11439
11440 Options for Linking
11441 These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
11442 an executable output file. They are meaningless if the compiler is not
11443 doing a link step.
11444
11445 object-file-name
11446 A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
11447 considered to name an object file or library. (Object files are
11448 distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
11449 contents.) If linking is done, these object files are used as
11450 input to the linker.
11451
11452 -c
11453 -S
11454 -E If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
11455 object file names should not be used as arguments.
11456
11457 -flinker-output=type
11458 This option controls the code generation of the link time
11459 optimizer. By default the linker output is determined by the
11460 linker plugin automatically. For debugging the compiler and in the
11461 case of incremental linking to non-lto object file is desired, it
11462 may be useful to control the type manually.
11463
11464 If type is exec the code generation is configured to produce static
11465 binary. In this case -fpic and -fpie are both disabled.
11466
11467 If type is dyn the code generation is configured to produce shared
11468 library. In this case -fpic or -fPIC is preserved, but not enabled
11469 automatically. This makes it possible to build shared libraries
11470 without position independent code on architectures this is
11471 possible, i.e. on x86.
11472
11473 If type is pie the code generation is configured to produce -fpie
11474 executable. This result in similar optimizations as exec except
11475 that -fpie is not disabled if specified at compilation time.
11476
11477 If type is rel the compiler assumes that incremental linking is
11478 done. The sections containing intermediate code for link-time
11479 optimization are merged, pre-optimized, and output to the resulting
11480 object file. In addition, if -ffat-lto-objects is specified the
11481 binary code is produced for future non-lto linking. The object file
11482 produced by incremental linking will be smaller than a static
11483 library produced from the same object files. At link-time the
11484 result of incremental linking will also load faster to compiler
11485 than a static library assuming that majority of objects in the
11486 library are used.
11487
11488 Finally nolto-rel configure compiler to for incremental linking
11489 where code generation is forced, final binary is produced and the
11490 intermediate code for later link-time optimization is stripped.
11491 When multiple object files are linked together the resulting code
11492 will be optimized better than with link time optimizations disabled
11493 (for example, the cross-module inlining will happen), most of
11494 benefits of whole program optimizations are however lost.
11495
11496 During the incremental link (by -r) the linker plugin will default
11497 to rel. With current interfaces to GNU Binutils it is however not
11498 possible to link incrementally LTO objects and non-LTO objects into
11499 a single mixed object file. In the case any of object files in
11500 incremental link cannot be used for link-time optimization the
11501 linker plugin will output warning and use nolto-rel. To maintain
11502 the whole program optimization it is recommended to link such
11503 objects into static library instead. Alternatively it is possible
11504 to use H.J. Lu's binutils with support for mixed objects.
11505
11506 -fuse-ld=bfd
11507 Use the bfd linker instead of the default linker.
11508
11509 -fuse-ld=gold
11510 Use the gold linker instead of the default linker.
11511
11512 -fuse-ld=lld
11513 Use the LLVM lld linker instead of the default linker.
11514
11515 -llibrary
11516 -l library
11517 Search the library named library when linking. (The second
11518 alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
11519 POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
11520
11521 The -l option is passed directly to the linker by GCC. Refer to
11522 your linker documentation for exact details. The general
11523 description below applies to the GNU linker.
11524
11525 The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library.
11526 The directories searched include several standard system
11527 directories plus any that you specify with -L.
11528
11529 Static libraries are archives of object files, and have file names
11530 like liblibrary.a. Some targets also support shared libraries,
11531 which typically have names like liblibrary.so. If both static and
11532 shared libraries are found, the linker gives preference to linking
11533 with the shared library unless the -static option is used.
11534
11535 It makes a difference where in the command you write this option;
11536 the linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the
11537 order they are specified. Thus, foo.o -lz bar.o searches library z
11538 after file foo.o but before bar.o. If bar.o refers to functions in
11539 z, those functions may not be loaded.
11540
11541 -lobjc
11542 You need this special case of the -l option in order to link an
11543 Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
11544
11545 -nostartfiles
11546 Do not use the standard system startup files when linking. The
11547 standard system libraries are used normally, unless -nostdlib,
11548 -nolibc, or -nodefaultlibs is used.
11549
11550 -nodefaultlibs
11551 Do not use the standard system libraries when linking. Only the
11552 libraries you specify are passed to the linker, and options
11553 specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as -static-libgcc
11554 or -shared-libgcc, are ignored. The standard startup files are
11555 used normally, unless -nostartfiles is used.
11556
11557 The compiler may generate calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and
11558 "memmove". These entries are usually resolved by entries in libc.
11559 These entry points should be supplied through some other mechanism
11560 when this option is specified.
11561
11562 -nolibc
11563 Do not use the C library or system libraries tightly coupled with
11564 it when linking. Still link with the startup files, libgcc or
11565 toolchain provided language support libraries such as libgnat,
11566 libgfortran or libstdc++ unless options preventing their inclusion
11567 are used as well. This typically removes -lc from the link command
11568 line, as well as system libraries that normally go with it and
11569 become meaningless when absence of a C library is assumed, for
11570 example -lpthread or -lm in some configurations. This is intended
11571 for bare-board targets when there is indeed no C library available.
11572
11573 -nostdlib
11574 Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when
11575 linking. No startup files and only the libraries you specify are
11576 passed to the linker, and options specifying linkage of the system
11577 libraries, such as -static-libgcc or -shared-libgcc, are ignored.
11578
11579 The compiler may generate calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and
11580 "memmove". These entries are usually resolved by entries in libc.
11581 These entry points should be supplied through some other mechanism
11582 when this option is specified.
11583
11584 One of the standard libraries bypassed by -nostdlib and
11585 -nodefaultlibs is libgcc.a, a library of internal subroutines which
11586 GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or
11587 special needs for some languages.
11588
11589 In most cases, you need libgcc.a even when you want to avoid other
11590 standard libraries. In other words, when you specify -nostdlib or
11591 -nodefaultlibs you should usually specify -lgcc as well. This
11592 ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
11593 library subroutines. (An example of such an internal subroutine is
11594 "__main", used to ensure C++ constructors are called.)
11595
11596 -e entry
11597 --entry=entry
11598 Specify that the program entry point is entry. The argument is
11599 interpreted by the linker; the GNU linker accepts either a symbol
11600 name or an address.
11601
11602 -pie
11603 Produce a dynamically linked position independent executable on
11604 targets that support it. For predictable results, you must also
11605 specify the same set of options used for compilation (-fpie, -fPIE,
11606 or model suboptions) when you specify this linker option.
11607
11608 -no-pie
11609 Don't produce a dynamically linked position independent executable.
11610
11611 -static-pie
11612 Produce a static position independent executable on targets that
11613 support it. A static position independent executable is similar to
11614 a static executable, but can be loaded at any address without a
11615 dynamic linker. For predictable results, you must also specify the
11616 same set of options used for compilation (-fpie, -fPIE, or model
11617 suboptions) when you specify this linker option.
11618
11619 -pthread
11620 Link with the POSIX threads library. This option is supported on
11621 GNU/Linux targets, most other Unix derivatives, and also on x86
11622 Cygwin and MinGW targets. On some targets this option also sets
11623 flags for the preprocessor, so it should be used consistently for
11624 both compilation and linking.
11625
11626 -r Produce a relocatable object as output. This is also known as
11627 partial linking.
11628
11629 -rdynamic
11630 Pass the flag -export-dynamic to the ELF linker, on targets that
11631 support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not only
11632 used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed for
11633 some uses of "dlopen" or to allow obtaining backtraces from within
11634 a program.
11635
11636 -s Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the
11637 executable.
11638
11639 -static
11640 On systems that support dynamic linking, this overrides -pie and
11641 prevents linking with the shared libraries. On other systems, this
11642 option has no effect.
11643
11644 -shared
11645 Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects
11646 to form an executable. Not all systems support this option. For
11647 predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
11648 used for compilation (-fpic, -fPIC, or model suboptions) when you
11649 specify this linker option.[1]
11650
11651 -shared-libgcc
11652 -static-libgcc
11653 On systems that provide libgcc as a shared library, these options
11654 force the use of either the shared or static version, respectively.
11655 If no shared version of libgcc was built when the compiler was
11656 configured, these options have no effect.
11657
11658 There are several situations in which an application should use the
11659 shared libgcc instead of the static version. The most common of
11660 these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
11661 across different shared libraries. In that case, each of the
11662 libraries as well as the application itself should use the shared
11663 libgcc.
11664
11665 Therefore, the G++ driver automatically adds -shared-libgcc
11666 whenever you build a shared library or a main executable, because
11667 C++ programs typically use exceptions, so this is the right thing
11668 to do.
11669
11670 If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you
11671 may find that they are not always linked with the shared libgcc.
11672 If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU
11673 linker or a GNU linker that does not support option --eh-frame-hdr,
11674 it links the shared version of libgcc into shared libraries by
11675 default. Otherwise, it takes advantage of the linker and optimizes
11676 away the linking with the shared version of libgcc, linking with
11677 the static version of libgcc by default. This allows exceptions to
11678 propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring
11679 relocation costs at library load time.
11680
11681 However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or
11682 catch exceptions, you must link it using the G++ driver, or using
11683 the option -shared-libgcc, such that it is linked with the shared
11684 libgcc.
11685
11686 -static-libasan
11687 When the -fsanitize=address option is used to link a program, the
11688 GCC driver automatically links against libasan. If libasan is
11689 available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
11690 then this links against the shared version of libasan. The
11691 -static-libasan option directs the GCC driver to link libasan
11692 statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.
11693
11694 -static-libtsan
11695 When the -fsanitize=thread option is used to link a program, the
11696 GCC driver automatically links against libtsan. If libtsan is
11697 available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
11698 then this links against the shared version of libtsan. The
11699 -static-libtsan option directs the GCC driver to link libtsan
11700 statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.
11701
11702 -static-liblsan
11703 When the -fsanitize=leak option is used to link a program, the GCC
11704 driver automatically links against liblsan. If liblsan is
11705 available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
11706 then this links against the shared version of liblsan. The
11707 -static-liblsan option directs the GCC driver to link liblsan
11708 statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.
11709
11710 -static-libubsan
11711 When the -fsanitize=undefined option is used to link a program, the
11712 GCC driver automatically links against libubsan. If libubsan is
11713 available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
11714 then this links against the shared version of libubsan. The
11715 -static-libubsan option directs the GCC driver to link libubsan
11716 statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.
11717
11718 -static-libstdc++
11719 When the g++ program is used to link a C++ program, it normally
11720 automatically links against libstdc++. If libstdc++ is available
11721 as a shared library, and the -static option is not used, then this
11722 links against the shared version of libstdc++. That is normally
11723 fine. However, it is sometimes useful to freeze the version of
11724 libstdc++ used by the program without going all the way to a fully
11725 static link. The -static-libstdc++ option directs the g++ driver
11726 to link libstdc++ statically, without necessarily linking other
11727 libraries statically.
11728
11729 -symbolic
11730 Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object.
11731 Warn about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link
11732 editor option -Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs). Only a few systems
11733 support this option.
11734
11735 -T script
11736 Use script as the linker script. This option is supported by most
11737 systems using the GNU linker. On some targets, such as bare-board
11738 targets without an operating system, the -T option may be required
11739 when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.
11740
11741 -Xlinker option
11742 Pass option as an option to the linker. You can use this to supply
11743 system-specific linker options that GCC does not recognize.
11744
11745 If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you
11746 must use -Xlinker twice, once for the option and once for the
11747 argument. For example, to pass -assert definitions, you must write
11748 -Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions. It does not work to write
11749 -Xlinker "-assert definitions", because this passes the entire
11750 string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
11751
11752 When using the GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass
11753 arguments to linker options using the option=value syntax than as
11754 separate arguments. For example, you can specify -Xlinker
11755 -Map=output.map rather than -Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map.
11756 Other linkers may not support this syntax for command-line options.
11757
11758 -Wl,option
11759 Pass option as an option to the linker. If option contains commas,
11760 it is split into multiple options at the commas. You can use this
11761 syntax to pass an argument to the option. For example,
11762 -Wl,-Map,output.map passes -Map output.map to the linker. When
11763 using the GNU linker, you can also get the same effect with
11764 -Wl,-Map=output.map.
11765
11766 -u symbol
11767 Pretend the symbol symbol is undefined, to force linking of library
11768 modules to define it. You can use -u multiple times with different
11769 symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
11770
11771 -z keyword
11772 -z is passed directly on to the linker along with the keyword
11773 keyword. See the section in the documentation of your linker for
11774 permitted values and their meanings.
11775
11776 Options for Directory Search
11777 These options specify directories to search for header files, for
11778 libraries and for parts of the compiler:
11779
11780 -I dir
11781 -iquote dir
11782 -isystem dir
11783 -idirafter dir
11784 Add the directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for
11785 header files during preprocessing. If dir begins with = or
11786 $SYSROOT, then the = or $SYSROOT is replaced by the sysroot prefix;
11787 see --sysroot and -isysroot.
11788
11789 Directories specified with -iquote apply only to the quote form of
11790 the directive, "#include "file"". Directories specified with -I,
11791 -isystem, or -idirafter apply to lookup for both the
11792 "#include "file"" and "#include <file>" directives.
11793
11794 You can specify any number or combination of these options on the
11795 command line to search for header files in several directories.
11796 The lookup order is as follows:
11797
11798 1. For the quote form of the include directive, the directory of
11799 the current file is searched first.
11800
11801 2. For the quote form of the include directive, the directories
11802 specified by -iquote options are searched in left-to-right
11803 order, as they appear on the command line.
11804
11805 3. Directories specified with -I options are scanned in left-to-
11806 right order.
11807
11808 4. Directories specified with -isystem options are scanned in
11809 left-to-right order.
11810
11811 5. Standard system directories are scanned.
11812
11813 6. Directories specified with -idirafter options are scanned in
11814 left-to-right order.
11815
11816 You can use -I to override a system header file, substituting your
11817 own version, since these directories are searched before the
11818 standard system header file directories. However, you should not
11819 use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
11820 system header files; use -isystem for that.
11821
11822 The -isystem and -idirafter options also mark the directory as a
11823 system directory, so that it gets the same special treatment that
11824 is applied to the standard system directories.
11825
11826 If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified
11827 with -isystem, is also specified with -I, the -I option is ignored.
11828 The directory is still searched but as a system directory at its
11829 normal position in the system include chain. This is to ensure
11830 that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and the ordering
11831 for the "#include_next" directive are not inadvertently changed.
11832 If you really need to change the search order for system
11833 directories, use the -nostdinc and/or -isystem options.
11834
11835 -I- Split the include path. This option has been deprecated. Please
11836 use -iquote instead for -I directories before the -I- and remove
11837 the -I- option.
11838
11839 Any directories specified with -I options before -I- are searched
11840 only for headers requested with "#include "file""; they are not
11841 searched for "#include <file>". If additional directories are
11842 specified with -I options after the -I-, those directories are
11843 searched for all #include directives.
11844
11845 In addition, -I- inhibits the use of the directory of the current
11846 file directory as the first search directory for "#include "file"".
11847 There is no way to override this effect of -I-.
11848
11849 -iprefix prefix
11850 Specify prefix as the prefix for subsequent -iwithprefix options.
11851 If the prefix represents a directory, you should include the final
11852 /.
11853
11854 -iwithprefix dir
11855 -iwithprefixbefore dir
11856 Append dir to the prefix specified previously with -iprefix, and
11857 add the resulting directory to the include search path.
11858 -iwithprefixbefore puts it in the same place -I would; -iwithprefix
11859 puts it where -idirafter would.
11860
11861 -isysroot dir
11862 This option is like the --sysroot option, but applies only to
11863 header files (except for Darwin targets, where it applies to both
11864 header files and libraries). See the --sysroot option for more
11865 information.
11866
11867 -imultilib dir
11868 Use dir as a subdirectory of the directory containing target-
11869 specific C++ headers.
11870
11871 -nostdinc
11872 Do not search the standard system directories for header files.
11873 Only the directories explicitly specified with -I, -iquote,
11874 -isystem, and/or -idirafter options (and the directory of the
11875 current file, if appropriate) are searched.
11876
11877 -nostdinc++
11878 Do not search for header files in the C++-specific standard
11879 directories, but do still search the other standard directories.
11880 (This option is used when building the C++ library.)
11881
11882 -iplugindir=dir
11883 Set the directory to search for plugins that are passed by
11884 -fplugin=name instead of -fplugin=path/name.so. This option is not
11885 meant to be used by the user, but only passed by the driver.
11886
11887 -Ldir
11888 Add directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for -l.
11889
11890 -Bprefix
11891 This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
11892 include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
11893
11894 The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
11895 cpp, cc1, as and ld. It tries prefix as a prefix for each program
11896 it tries to run, both with and without machine/version/ for the
11897 corresponding target machine and compiler version.
11898
11899 For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
11900 -B prefix, if any. If that name is not found, or if -B is not
11901 specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes, /usr/lib/gcc/
11902 and /usr/local/lib/gcc/. If neither of those results in a file
11903 name that is found, the unmodified program name is searched for
11904 using the directories specified in your PATH environment variable.
11905
11906 The compiler checks to see if the path provided by -B refers to a
11907 directory, and if necessary it adds a directory separator character
11908 at the end of the path.
11909
11910 -B prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply to
11911 libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
11912 options into -L options for the linker. They also apply to include
11913 files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
11914 options into -isystem options for the preprocessor. In this case,
11915 the compiler appends include to the prefix.
11916
11917 The runtime support file libgcc.a can also be searched for using
11918 the -B prefix, if needed. If it is not found there, the two
11919 standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all. The file is
11920 left out of the link if it is not found by those means.
11921
11922 Another way to specify a prefix much like the -B prefix is to use
11923 the environment variable GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.
11924
11925 As a special kludge, if the path provided by -B is [dir/]stageN/,
11926 where N is a number in the range 0 to 9, then it is replaced by
11927 [dir/]include. This is to help with boot-strapping the compiler.
11928
11929 -no-canonical-prefixes
11930 Do not expand any symbolic links, resolve references to /../ or
11931 /./, or make the path absolute when generating a relative prefix.
11932
11933 --sysroot=dir
11934 Use dir as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
11935 For example, if the compiler normally searches for headers in
11936 /usr/include and libraries in /usr/lib, it instead searches
11937 dir/usr/include and dir/usr/lib.
11938
11939 If you use both this option and the -isysroot option, then the
11940 --sysroot option applies to libraries, but the -isysroot option
11941 applies to header files.
11942
11943 The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary
11944 support for this option. If your linker does not support this
11945 option, the header file aspect of --sysroot still works, but the
11946 library aspect does not.
11947
11948 --no-sysroot-suffix
11949 For some targets, a suffix is added to the root directory specified
11950 with --sysroot, depending on the other options used, so that
11951 headers may for example be found in dir/suffix/usr/include instead
11952 of dir/usr/include. This option disables the addition of such a
11953 suffix.
11954
11955 Options for Code Generation Conventions
11956 These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
11957 used in code generation.
11958
11959 Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
11960 of -ffoo is -fno-foo. In the table below, only one of the forms is
11961 listed---the one that is not the default. You can figure out the other
11962 form by either removing no- or adding it.
11963
11964 -fstack-reuse=reuse-level
11965 This option controls stack space reuse for user declared local/auto
11966 variables and compiler generated temporaries. reuse_level can be
11967 all, named_vars, or none. all enables stack reuse for all local
11968 variables and temporaries, named_vars enables the reuse only for
11969 user defined local variables with names, and none disables stack
11970 reuse completely. The default value is all. The option is needed
11971 when the program extends the lifetime of a scoped local variable or
11972 a compiler generated temporary beyond the end point defined by the
11973 language. When a lifetime of a variable ends, and if the variable
11974 lives in memory, the optimizing compiler has the freedom to reuse
11975 its stack space with other temporaries or scoped local variables
11976 whose live range does not overlap with it. Legacy code extending
11977 local lifetime is likely to break with the stack reuse
11978 optimization.
11979
11980 For example,
11981
11982 int *p;
11983 {
11984 int local1;
11985
11986 p = &local1;
11987 local1 = 10;
11988 ....
11989 }
11990 {
11991 int local2;
11992 local2 = 20;
11993 ...
11994 }
11995
11996 if (*p == 10) // out of scope use of local1
11997 {
11998
11999 }
12000
12001 Another example:
12002
12003 struct A
12004 {
12005 A(int k) : i(k), j(k) { }
12006 int i;
12007 int j;
12008 };
12009
12010 A *ap;
12011
12012 void foo(const A& ar)
12013 {
12014 ap = &ar;
12015 }
12016
12017 void bar()
12018 {
12019 foo(A(10)); // temp object's lifetime ends when foo returns
12020
12021 {
12022 A a(20);
12023 ....
12024 }
12025 ap->i+= 10; // ap references out of scope temp whose space
12026 // is reused with a. What is the value of ap->i?
12027 }
12028
12029 The lifetime of a compiler generated temporary is well defined by
12030 the C++ standard. When a lifetime of a temporary ends, and if the
12031 temporary lives in memory, the optimizing compiler has the freedom
12032 to reuse its stack space with other temporaries or scoped local
12033 variables whose live range does not overlap with it. However some
12034 of the legacy code relies on the behavior of older compilers in
12035 which temporaries' stack space is not reused, the aggressive stack
12036 reuse can lead to runtime errors. This option is used to control
12037 the temporary stack reuse optimization.
12038
12039 -ftrapv
12040 This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition,
12041 subtraction, multiplication operations. The options -ftrapv and
12042 -fwrapv override each other, so using -ftrapv -fwrapv on the
12043 command-line results in -fwrapv being effective. Note that only
12044 active options override, so using -ftrapv -fwrapv -fno-wrapv on the
12045 command-line results in -ftrapv being effective.
12046
12047 -fwrapv
12048 This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
12049 overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
12050 using twos-complement representation. This flag enables some
12051 optimizations and disables others. The options -ftrapv and -fwrapv
12052 override each other, so using -ftrapv -fwrapv on the command-line
12053 results in -fwrapv being effective. Note that only active options
12054 override, so using -ftrapv -fwrapv -fno-wrapv on the command-line
12055 results in -ftrapv being effective.
12056
12057 -fwrapv-pointer
12058 This option instructs the compiler to assume that pointer
12059 arithmetic overflow on addition and subtraction wraps around using
12060 twos-complement representation. This flag disables some
12061 optimizations which assume pointer overflow is invalid.
12062
12063 -fstrict-overflow
12064 This option implies -fno-wrapv -fno-wrapv-pointer and when negated
12065 implies -fwrapv -fwrapv-pointer.
12066
12067 -fexceptions
12068 Enable exception handling. Generates extra code needed to
12069 propagate exceptions. For some targets, this implies GCC generates
12070 frame unwind information for all functions, which can produce
12071 significant data size overhead, although it does not affect
12072 execution. If you do not specify this option, GCC enables it by
12073 default for languages like C++ that normally require exception
12074 handling, and disables it for languages like C that do not normally
12075 require it. However, you may need to enable this option when
12076 compiling C code that needs to interoperate properly with exception
12077 handlers written in C++. You may also wish to disable this option
12078 if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't use exception
12079 handling.
12080
12081 -fnon-call-exceptions
12082 Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw
12083 exceptions. Note that this requires platform-specific runtime
12084 support that does not exist everywhere. Moreover, it only allows
12085 trapping instructions to throw exceptions, i.e. memory references
12086 or floating-point instructions. It does not allow exceptions to be
12087 thrown from arbitrary signal handlers such as "SIGALRM".
12088
12089 -fdelete-dead-exceptions
12090 Consider that instructions that may throw exceptions but don't
12091 otherwise contribute to the execution of the program can be
12092 optimized away. This option is enabled by default for the Ada
12093 front end, as permitted by the Ada language specification.
12094 Optimization passes that cause dead exceptions to be removed are
12095 enabled independently at different optimization levels.
12096
12097 -funwind-tables
12098 Similar to -fexceptions, except that it just generates any needed
12099 static data, but does not affect the generated code in any other
12100 way. You normally do not need to enable this option; instead, a
12101 language processor that needs this handling enables it on your
12102 behalf.
12103
12104 -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
12105 Generate unwind table in DWARF format, if supported by target
12106 machine. The table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it
12107 can be used for stack unwinding from asynchronous events (such as
12108 debugger or garbage collector).
12109
12110 -fno-gnu-unique
12111 On systems with recent GNU assembler and C library, the C++
12112 compiler uses the "STB_GNU_UNIQUE" binding to make sure that
12113 definitions of template static data members and static local
12114 variables in inline functions are unique even in the presence of
12115 "RTLD_LOCAL"; this is necessary to avoid problems with a library
12116 used by two different "RTLD_LOCAL" plugins depending on a
12117 definition in one of them and therefore disagreeing with the other
12118 one about the binding of the symbol. But this causes "dlclose" to
12119 be ignored for affected DSOs; if your program relies on
12120 reinitialization of a DSO via "dlclose" and "dlopen", you can use
12121 -fno-gnu-unique.
12122
12123 -fpcc-struct-return
12124 Return "short" "struct" and "union" values in memory like longer
12125 ones, rather than in registers. This convention is less efficient,
12126 but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between GCC-
12127 compiled files and files compiled with other compilers,
12128 particularly the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
12129
12130 The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
12131 on the target configuration macros.
12132
12133 Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment
12134 match that of some integer type.
12135
12136 Warning: code compiled with the -fpcc-struct-return switch is not
12137 binary compatible with code compiled with the -freg-struct-return
12138 switch. Use it to conform to a non-default application binary
12139 interface.
12140
12141 -freg-struct-return
12142 Return "struct" and "union" values in registers when possible.
12143 This is more efficient for small structures than
12144 -fpcc-struct-return.
12145
12146 If you specify neither -fpcc-struct-return nor -freg-struct-return,
12147 GCC defaults to whichever convention is standard for the target.
12148 If there is no standard convention, GCC defaults to
12149 -fpcc-struct-return, except on targets where GCC is the principal
12150 compiler. In those cases, we can choose the standard, and we chose
12151 the more efficient register return alternative.
12152
12153 Warning: code compiled with the -freg-struct-return switch is not
12154 binary compatible with code compiled with the -fpcc-struct-return
12155 switch. Use it to conform to a non-default application binary
12156 interface.
12157
12158 -fshort-enums
12159 Allocate to an "enum" type only as many bytes as it needs for the
12160 declared range of possible values. Specifically, the "enum" type
12161 is equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.
12162
12163 Warning: the -fshort-enums switch causes GCC to generate code that
12164 is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
12165 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
12166
12167 -fshort-wchar
12168 Override the underlying type for "wchar_t" to be "short unsigned
12169 int" instead of the default for the target. This option is useful
12170 for building programs to run under WINE.
12171
12172 Warning: the -fshort-wchar switch causes GCC to generate code that
12173 is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
12174 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
12175
12176 -fno-common
12177 In C code, this option controls the placement of global variables
12178 defined without an initializer, known as tentative definitions in
12179 the C standard. Tentative definitions are distinct from
12180 declarations of a variable with the "extern" keyword, which do not
12181 allocate storage.
12182
12183 Unix C compilers have traditionally allocated storage for
12184 uninitialized global variables in a common block. This allows the
12185 linker to resolve all tentative definitions of the same variable in
12186 different compilation units to the same object, or to a non-
12187 tentative definition. This is the behavior specified by -fcommon,
12188 and is the default for GCC on most targets. On the other hand,
12189 this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on some targets may
12190 carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.
12191
12192 The -fno-common option specifies that the compiler should instead
12193 place uninitialized global variables in the BSS section of the
12194 object file. This inhibits the merging of tentative definitions by
12195 the linker so you get a multiple-definition error if the same
12196 variable is defined in more than one compilation unit. Compiling
12197 with -fno-common is useful on targets for which it provides better
12198 performance, or if you wish to verify that the program will work on
12199 other systems that always treat uninitialized variable definitions
12200 this way.
12201
12202 -fno-ident
12203 Ignore the "#ident" directive.
12204
12205 -finhibit-size-directive
12206 Don't output a ".size" assembler directive, or anything else that
12207 would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
12208 two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory. This
12209 option is used when compiling crtstuff.c; you should not need to
12210 use it for anything else.
12211
12212 -fverbose-asm
12213 Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
12214 make it more readable. This option is generally only of use to
12215 those who actually need to read the generated assembly code
12216 (perhaps while debugging the compiler itself).
12217
12218 -fno-verbose-asm, the default, causes the extra information to be
12219 omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler files.
12220
12221 The added comments include:
12222
12223 * information on the compiler version and command-line options,
12224
12225 * the source code lines associated with the assembly
12226 instructions, in the form FILENAME:LINENUMBER:CONTENT OF LINE,
12227
12228 * hints on which high-level expressions correspond to the various
12229 assembly instruction operands.
12230
12231 For example, given this C source file:
12232
12233 int test (int n)
12234 {
12235 int i;
12236 int total = 0;
12237
12238 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
12239 total += i * i;
12240
12241 return total;
12242 }
12243
12244 compiling to (x86_64) assembly via -S and emitting the result
12245 direct to stdout via -o -
12246
12247 gcc -S test.c -fverbose-asm -Os -o -
12248
12249 gives output similar to this:
12250
12251 .file "test.c"
12252 # GNU C11 (GCC) version 7.0.0 20160809 (experimental) (x86_64-pc-linux-gnu)
12253 [...snip...]
12254 # options passed:
12255 [...snip...]
12256
12257 .text
12258 .globl test
12259 .type test, @function
12260 test:
12261 .LFB0:
12262 .cfi_startproc
12263 # test.c:4: int total = 0;
12264 xorl %eax, %eax # <retval>
12265 # test.c:6: for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
12266 xorl %edx, %edx # i
12267 .L2:
12268 # test.c:6: for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
12269 cmpl %edi, %edx # n, i
12270 jge .L5 #,
12271 # test.c:7: total += i * i;
12272 movl %edx, %ecx # i, tmp92
12273 imull %edx, %ecx # i, tmp92
12274 # test.c:6: for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
12275 incl %edx # i
12276 # test.c:7: total += i * i;
12277 addl %ecx, %eax # tmp92, <retval>
12278 jmp .L2 #
12279 .L5:
12280 # test.c:10: }
12281 ret
12282 .cfi_endproc
12283 .LFE0:
12284 .size test, .-test
12285 .ident "GCC: (GNU) 7.0.0 20160809 (experimental)"
12286 .section .note.GNU-stack,"",@progbits
12287
12288 The comments are intended for humans rather than machines and hence
12289 the precise format of the comments is subject to change.
12290
12291 -frecord-gcc-switches
12292 This switch causes the command line used to invoke the compiler to
12293 be recorded into the object file that is being created. This
12294 switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format of
12295 the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it
12296 usually takes the form of a section containing ASCII text. This
12297 switch is related to the -fverbose-asm switch, but that switch only
12298 records information in the assembler output file as comments, so it
12299 never reaches the object file. See also -grecord-gcc-switches for
12300 another way of storing compiler options into the object file.
12301
12302 -fpic
12303 Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a
12304 shared library, if supported for the target machine. Such code
12305 accesses all constant addresses through a global offset table
12306 (GOT). The dynamic loader resolves the GOT entries when the
12307 program starts (the dynamic loader is not part of GCC; it is part
12308 of the operating system). If the GOT size for the linked
12309 executable exceeds a machine-specific maximum size, you get an
12310 error message from the linker indicating that -fpic does not work;
12311 in that case, recompile with -fPIC instead. (These maximums are 8k
12312 on the SPARC, 28k on AArch64 and 32k on the m68k and RS/6000. The
12313 x86 has no such limit.)
12314
12315 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore
12316 works only on certain machines. For the x86, GCC supports PIC for
12317 System V but not for the Sun 386i. Code generated for the IBM
12318 RS/6000 is always position-independent.
12319
12320 When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are
12321 defined to 1.
12322
12323 -fPIC
12324 If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent
12325 code, suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the
12326 size of the global offset table. This option makes a difference on
12327 AArch64, m68k, PowerPC and SPARC.
12328
12329 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore
12330 works only on certain machines.
12331
12332 When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are
12333 defined to 2.
12334
12335 -fpie
12336 -fPIE
12337 These options are similar to -fpic and -fPIC, but the generated
12338 position-independent code can be only linked into executables.
12339 Usually these options are used to compile code that will be linked
12340 using the -pie GCC option.
12341
12342 -fpie and -fPIE both define the macros "__pie__" and "__PIE__".
12343 The macros have the value 1 for -fpie and 2 for -fPIE.
12344
12345 -fno-plt
12346 Do not use the PLT for external function calls in position-
12347 independent code. Instead, load the callee address at call sites
12348 from the GOT and branch to it. This leads to more efficient code
12349 by eliminating PLT stubs and exposing GOT loads to optimizations.
12350 On architectures such as 32-bit x86 where PLT stubs expect the GOT
12351 pointer in a specific register, this gives more register allocation
12352 freedom to the compiler. Lazy binding requires use of the PLT;
12353 with -fno-plt all external symbols are resolved at load time.
12354
12355 Alternatively, the function attribute "noplt" can be used to avoid
12356 calls through the PLT for specific external functions.
12357
12358 In position-dependent code, a few targets also convert calls to
12359 functions that are marked to not use the PLT to use the GOT
12360 instead.
12361
12362 -fno-jump-tables
12363 Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
12364 more efficient than other code generation strategies. This option
12365 is of use in conjunction with -fpic or -fPIC for building code that
12366 forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot reference the address of
12367 a jump table. On some targets, jump tables do not require a GOT
12368 and this option is not needed.
12369
12370 -ffixed-reg
12371 Treat the register named reg as a fixed register; generated code
12372 should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
12373 pointer or in some other fixed role).
12374
12375 reg must be the name of a register. The register names accepted
12376 are machine-specific and are defined in the "REGISTER_NAMES" macro
12377 in the machine description macro file.
12378
12379 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
12380 three-way choice.
12381
12382 -fcall-used-reg
12383 Treat the register named reg as an allocable register that is
12384 clobbered by function calls. It may be allocated for temporaries
12385 or variables that do not live across a call. Functions compiled
12386 this way do not save and restore the register reg.
12387
12388 It is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack
12389 pointer. Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed
12390 pervasive roles in the machine's execution model produces
12391 disastrous results.
12392
12393 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
12394 three-way choice.
12395
12396 -fcall-saved-reg
12397 Treat the register named reg as an allocable register saved by
12398 functions. It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables
12399 that live across a call. Functions compiled this way save and
12400 restore the register reg if they use it.
12401
12402 It is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack
12403 pointer. Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed
12404 pervasive roles in the machine's execution model produces
12405 disastrous results.
12406
12407 A different sort of disaster results from the use of this flag for
12408 a register in which function values may be returned.
12409
12410 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
12411 three-way choice.
12412
12413 -fpack-struct[=n]
12414 Without a value specified, pack all structure members together
12415 without holes. When a value is specified (which must be a small
12416 power of two), pack structure members according to this value,
12417 representing the maximum alignment (that is, objects with default
12418 alignment requirements larger than this are output potentially
12419 unaligned at the next fitting location.
12420
12421 Warning: the -fpack-struct switch causes GCC to generate code that
12422 is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
12423 Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal. Use it to conform to a
12424 non-default application binary interface.
12425
12426 -fleading-underscore
12427 This option and its counterpart, -fno-leading-underscore, forcibly
12428 change the way C symbols are represented in the object file. One
12429 use is to help link with legacy assembly code.
12430
12431 Warning: the -fleading-underscore switch causes GCC to generate
12432 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
12433 switch. Use it to conform to a non-default application binary
12434 interface. Not all targets provide complete support for this
12435 switch.
12436
12437 -ftls-model=model
12438 Alter the thread-local storage model to be used. The model
12439 argument should be one of global-dynamic, local-dynamic, initial-
12440 exec or local-exec. Note that the choice is subject to
12441 optimization: the compiler may use a more efficient model for
12442 symbols not visible outside of the translation unit, or if -fpic is
12443 not given on the command line.
12444
12445 The default without -fpic is initial-exec; with -fpic the default
12446 is global-dynamic.
12447
12448 -ftrampolines
12449 For targets that normally need trampolines for nested functions,
12450 always generate them instead of using descriptors. Otherwise, for
12451 targets that do not need them, like for example HP-PA or IA-64, do
12452 nothing.
12453
12454 A trampoline is a small piece of code that is created at run time
12455 on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and is
12456 used to call the nested function indirectly. Therefore, it
12457 requires the stack to be made executable in order for the program
12458 to work properly.
12459
12460 -fno-trampolines is enabled by default on a language by language
12461 basis to let the compiler avoid generating them, if it computes
12462 that this is safe, and replace them with descriptors. Descriptors
12463 are made up of data only, but the generated code must be prepared
12464 to deal with them. As of this writing, -fno-trampolines is enabled
12465 by default only for Ada.
12466
12467 Moreover, code compiled with -ftrampolines and code compiled with
12468 -fno-trampolines are not binary compatible if nested functions are
12469 present. This option must therefore be used on a program-wide
12470 basis and be manipulated with extreme care.
12471
12472 -fvisibility=[default|internal|hidden|protected]
12473 Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified
12474 option---all symbols are marked with this unless overridden within
12475 the code. Using this feature can very substantially improve
12476 linking and load times of shared object libraries, produce more
12477 optimized code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol
12478 clashes. It is strongly recommended that you use this in any
12479 shared objects you distribute.
12480
12481 Despite the nomenclature, default always means public; i.e.,
12482 available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
12483 protected and internal are pretty useless in real-world usage so
12484 the only other commonly used option is hidden. The default if
12485 -fvisibility isn't specified is default, i.e., make every symbol
12486 public.
12487
12488 A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF symbols
12489 have the correct visibility is given by "How To Write Shared
12490 Libraries" by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
12491 <https://www.akkadia.org/drepper/>)---however a superior solution
12492 made possible by this option to marking things hidden when the
12493 default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
12494 public. This is the norm with DLLs on Windows and with
12495 -fvisibility=hidden and "__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))"
12496 instead of "__declspec(dllexport)" you get almost identical
12497 semantics with identical syntax. This is a great boon to those
12498 working with cross-platform projects.
12499
12500 For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
12501 "#pragma GCC visibility" of use. This works by you enclosing the
12502 declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
12503 "#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)" and "#pragma GCC visibility
12504 pop". Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed as part
12505 of the API interface contract and thus all new code should always
12506 specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations
12507 only for use within the local DSO should always be marked
12508 explicitly as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection
12509 overheads---making this abundantly clear also aids readability and
12510 self-documentation of the code. Note that due to ISO C++
12511 specification requirements, "operator new" and "operator delete"
12512 must always be of default visibility.
12513
12514 Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular
12515 system headers and headers from any other library you use, may not
12516 be expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.
12517 You may need to explicitly say "#pragma GCC visibility
12518 push(default)" before including any such headers.
12519
12520 "extern" declarations are not affected by -fvisibility, so a lot of
12521 code can be recompiled with -fvisibility=hidden with no
12522 modifications. However, this means that calls to "extern"
12523 functions with no explicit visibility use the PLT, so it is more
12524 effective to use "__attribute ((visibility))" and/or "#pragma GCC
12525 visibility" to tell the compiler which "extern" declarations should
12526 be treated as hidden.
12527
12528 Note that -fvisibility does affect C++ vague linkage entities. This
12529 means that, for instance, an exception class that is be thrown
12530 between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default visibility so
12531 that the type_info nodes are unified between the DSOs.
12532
12533 An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
12534 is at <http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/Visibility>.
12535
12536 -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
12537 This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or
12538 other structure fields, although the compiler usually honors those
12539 types anyway) should use a single access of the width of the
12540 field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible. For
12541 example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral registers might
12542 require all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag you
12543 can declare all peripheral bit-fields as "unsigned short" (assuming
12544 short is 16 bits on these targets) to force GCC to use 16-bit
12545 accesses instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.
12546
12547 If this option is disabled, the compiler uses the most efficient
12548 instruction. In the previous example, that might be a 32-bit load
12549 instruction, even though that accesses bytes that do not contain
12550 any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated
12551 to the one being updated.
12552
12553 In some cases, such as when the "packed" attribute is applied to a
12554 structure field, it may not be possible to access the field with a
12555 single read or write that is correctly aligned for the target
12556 machine. In this case GCC falls back to generating multiple
12557 accesses rather than code that will fault or truncate the result at
12558 run time.
12559
12560 Note: Due to restrictions of the C/C++11 memory model, write
12561 accesses are not allowed to touch non bit-field members. It is
12562 therefore recommended to define all bits of the field's type as
12563 bit-field members.
12564
12565 The default value of this option is determined by the application
12566 binary interface for the target processor.
12567
12568 -fsync-libcalls
12569 This option controls whether any out-of-line instance of the
12570 "__sync" family of functions may be used to implement the C++11
12571 "__atomic" family of functions.
12572
12573 The default value of this option is enabled, thus the only useful
12574 form of the option is -fno-sync-libcalls. This option is used in
12575 the implementation of the libatomic runtime library.
12576
12577 GCC Developer Options
12578 This section describes command-line options that are primarily of
12579 interest to GCC developers, including options to support compiler
12580 testing and investigation of compiler bugs and compile-time performance
12581 problems. This includes options that produce debug dumps at various
12582 points in the compilation; that print statistics such as memory use and
12583 execution time; and that print information about GCC's configuration,
12584 such as where it searches for libraries. You should rarely need to use
12585 any of these options for ordinary compilation and linking tasks.
12586
12587 Many developer options that cause GCC to dump output to a file take an
12588 optional =filename suffix. You can specify stdout or - to dump to
12589 standard output, and stderr for standard error.
12590
12591 If =filename is omitted, a default dump file name is constructed by
12592 concatenating the base dump file name, a pass number, phase letter, and
12593 pass name. The base dump file name is the name of output file produced
12594 by the compiler if explicitly specified and not an executable;
12595 otherwise it is the source file name. The pass number is determined by
12596 the order passes are registered with the compiler's pass manager. This
12597 is generally the same as the order of execution, but passes registered
12598 by plugins, target-specific passes, or passes that are otherwise
12599 registered late are numbered higher than the pass named final, even if
12600 they are executed earlier. The phase letter is one of i (inter-
12601 procedural analysis), l (language-specific), r (RTL), or t (tree). The
12602 files are created in the directory of the output file.
12603
12604 -dletters
12605 -fdump-rtl-pass
12606 -fdump-rtl-pass=filename
12607 Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified
12608 by letters. This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
12609 compiler.
12610
12611 Some -dletters switches have different meaning when -E is used for
12612 preprocessing.
12613
12614 Debug dumps can be enabled with a -fdump-rtl switch or some -d
12615 option letters. Here are the possible letters for use in pass and
12616 letters, and their meanings:
12617
12618 -fdump-rtl-alignments
12619 Dump after branch alignments have been computed.
12620
12621 -fdump-rtl-asmcons
12622 Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out
12623 constraints.
12624
12625 -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
12626 Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery. This pass is only run on
12627 architectures that have auto inc or auto dec instructions.
12628
12629 -fdump-rtl-barriers
12630 Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.
12631
12632 -fdump-rtl-bbpart
12633 Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.
12634
12635 -fdump-rtl-bbro
12636 Dump after block reordering.
12637
12638 -fdump-rtl-btl1
12639 -fdump-rtl-btl2
12640 -fdump-rtl-btl1 and -fdump-rtl-btl2 enable dumping after the
12641 two branch target load optimization passes.
12642
12643 -fdump-rtl-bypass
12644 Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.
12645
12646 -fdump-rtl-combine
12647 Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.
12648
12649 -fdump-rtl-compgotos
12650 Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.
12651
12652 -fdump-rtl-ce1
12653 -fdump-rtl-ce2
12654 -fdump-rtl-ce3
12655 -fdump-rtl-ce1, -fdump-rtl-ce2, and -fdump-rtl-ce3 enable
12656 dumping after the three if conversion passes.
12657
12658 -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
12659 Dump after hard register copy propagation.
12660
12661 -fdump-rtl-csa
12662 Dump after combining stack adjustments.
12663
12664 -fdump-rtl-cse1
12665 -fdump-rtl-cse2
12666 -fdump-rtl-cse1 and -fdump-rtl-cse2 enable dumping after the
12667 two common subexpression elimination passes.
12668
12669 -fdump-rtl-dce
12670 Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.
12671
12672 -fdump-rtl-dbr
12673 Dump after delayed branch scheduling.
12674
12675 -fdump-rtl-dce1
12676 -fdump-rtl-dce2
12677 -fdump-rtl-dce1 and -fdump-rtl-dce2 enable dumping after the
12678 two dead store elimination passes.
12679
12680 -fdump-rtl-eh
12681 Dump after finalization of EH handling code.
12682
12683 -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
12684 Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.
12685
12686 -fdump-rtl-expand
12687 Dump after RTL generation.
12688
12689 -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
12690 -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
12691 -fdump-rtl-fwprop1 and -fdump-rtl-fwprop2 enable dumping after
12692 the two forward propagation passes.
12693
12694 -fdump-rtl-gcse1
12695 -fdump-rtl-gcse2
12696 -fdump-rtl-gcse1 and -fdump-rtl-gcse2 enable dumping after
12697 global common subexpression elimination.
12698
12699 -fdump-rtl-init-regs
12700 Dump after the initialization of the registers.
12701
12702 -fdump-rtl-initvals
12703 Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.
12704
12705 -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
12706 Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.
12707
12708 -fdump-rtl-ira
12709 Dump after iterated register allocation.
12710
12711 -fdump-rtl-jump
12712 Dump after the second jump optimization.
12713
12714 -fdump-rtl-loop2
12715 -fdump-rtl-loop2 enables dumping after the rtl loop
12716 optimization passes.
12717
12718 -fdump-rtl-mach
12719 Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization
12720 pass, if that pass exists.
12721
12722 -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
12723 Dump after removing redundant mode switches.
12724
12725 -fdump-rtl-rnreg
12726 Dump after register renumbering.
12727
12728 -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
12729 Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.
12730
12731 -fdump-rtl-peephole2
12732 Dump after the peephole pass.
12733
12734 -fdump-rtl-postreload
12735 Dump after post-reload optimizations.
12736
12737 -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
12738 Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.
12739
12740 -fdump-rtl-sched1
12741 -fdump-rtl-sched2
12742 -fdump-rtl-sched1 and -fdump-rtl-sched2 enable dumping after
12743 the basic block scheduling passes.
12744
12745 -fdump-rtl-ree
12746 Dump after sign/zero extension elimination.
12747
12748 -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
12749 Dump after common sequence discovery.
12750
12751 -fdump-rtl-shorten
12752 Dump after shortening branches.
12753
12754 -fdump-rtl-sibling
12755 Dump after sibling call optimizations.
12756
12757 -fdump-rtl-split1
12758 -fdump-rtl-split2
12759 -fdump-rtl-split3
12760 -fdump-rtl-split4
12761 -fdump-rtl-split5
12762 These options enable dumping after five rounds of instruction
12763 splitting.
12764
12765 -fdump-rtl-sms
12766 Dump after modulo scheduling. This pass is only run on some
12767 architectures.
12768
12769 -fdump-rtl-stack
12770 Dump after conversion from GCC's "flat register file" registers
12771 to the x87's stack-like registers. This pass is only run on
12772 x86 variants.
12773
12774 -fdump-rtl-subreg1
12775 -fdump-rtl-subreg2
12776 -fdump-rtl-subreg1 and -fdump-rtl-subreg2 enable dumping after
12777 the two subreg expansion passes.
12778
12779 -fdump-rtl-unshare
12780 Dump after all rtl has been unshared.
12781
12782 -fdump-rtl-vartrack
12783 Dump after variable tracking.
12784
12785 -fdump-rtl-vregs
12786 Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.
12787
12788 -fdump-rtl-web
12789 Dump after live range splitting.
12790
12791 -fdump-rtl-regclass
12792 -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
12793 -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
12794 -fdump-rtl-dfinit
12795 -fdump-rtl-dfinish
12796 These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.
12797
12798 -da
12799 -fdump-rtl-all
12800 Produce all the dumps listed above.
12801
12802 -dA Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging
12803 information.
12804
12805 -dD Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in
12806 addition to normal output.
12807
12808 -dH Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
12809
12810 -dp Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
12811 pattern and alternative is used. The length and cost of each
12812 instruction are also printed.
12813
12814 -dP Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each
12815 instruction. Also turns on -dp annotation.
12816
12817 -dx Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.
12818 Usually used with -fdump-rtl-expand.
12819
12820 -fdump-debug
12821 Dump debugging information generated during the debug generation
12822 phase.
12823
12824 -fdump-earlydebug
12825 Dump debugging information generated during the early debug
12826 generation phase.
12827
12828 -fdump-noaddr
12829 When doing debugging dumps, suppress address output. This makes it
12830 more feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler
12831 invocations with different compiler binaries and/or different text
12832 / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
12833
12834 -freport-bug
12835 Collect and dump debug information into a temporary file if an
12836 internal compiler error (ICE) occurs.
12837
12838 -fdump-unnumbered
12839 When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and
12840 address output. This makes it more feasible to use diff on
12841 debugging dumps for compiler invocations with different options, in
12842 particular with and without -g.
12843
12844 -fdump-unnumbered-links
12845 When doing debugging dumps (see -d option above), suppress
12846 instruction numbers for the links to the previous and next
12847 instructions in a sequence.
12848
12849 -fdump-ipa-switch
12850 -fdump-ipa-switch-options
12851 Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
12852 language tree to a file. The file name is generated by appending a
12853 switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
12854 created in the same directory as the output file. The following
12855 dumps are possible:
12856
12857 all Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.
12858
12859 cgraph
12860 Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused
12861 function removal, and inlining decisions.
12862
12863 inline
12864 Dump after function inlining.
12865
12866 Additionally, the options -optimized, -missed, -note, and -all can
12867 be provided, with the same meaning as for -fopt-info, defaulting to
12868 -optimized.
12869
12870 For example, -fdump-ipa-inline-optimized-missed will emit
12871 information on callsites that were inlined, along with callsites
12872 that were not inlined.
12873
12874 By default, the dump will contain messages about successful
12875 optimizations (equivalent to -optimized) together with low-level
12876 details about the analysis.
12877
12878 -fdump-lang-all
12879 -fdump-lang-switch
12880 -fdump-lang-switch-options
12881 -fdump-lang-switch-options=filename
12882 Control the dumping of language-specific information. The options
12883 and filename portions behave as described in the -fdump-tree
12884 option. The following switch values are accepted:
12885
12886 all Enable all language-specific dumps.
12887
12888 class
12889 Dump class hierarchy information. Virtual table information is
12890 emitted unless 'slim' is specified. This option is applicable
12891 to C++ only.
12892
12893 raw Dump the raw internal tree data. This option is applicable to
12894 C++ only.
12895
12896 -fdump-passes
12897 Print on stderr the list of optimization passes that are turned on
12898 and off by the current command-line options.
12899
12900 -fdump-statistics-option
12901 Enable and control dumping of pass statistics in a separate file.
12902 The file name is generated by appending a suffix ending in
12903 .statistics to the source file name, and the file is created in the
12904 same directory as the output file. If the -option form is used,
12905 -stats causes counters to be summed over the whole compilation unit
12906 while -details dumps every event as the passes generate them. The
12907 default with no option is to sum counters for each function
12908 compiled.
12909
12910 -fdump-tree-all
12911 -fdump-tree-switch
12912 -fdump-tree-switch-options
12913 -fdump-tree-switch-options=filename
12914 Control the dumping at various stages of processing the
12915 intermediate language tree to a file. If the -options form is
12916 used, options is a list of - separated options which control the
12917 details of the dump. Not all options are applicable to all dumps;
12918 those that are not meaningful are ignored. The following options
12919 are available
12920
12921 address
12922 Print the address of each node. Usually this is not meaningful
12923 as it changes according to the environment and source file.
12924 Its primary use is for tying up a dump file with a debug
12925 environment.
12926
12927 asmname
12928 If "DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME" has been set for a given decl, use
12929 that in the dump instead of "DECL_NAME". Its primary use is
12930 ease of use working backward from mangled names in the assembly
12931 file.
12932
12933 slim
12934 When dumping front-end intermediate representations, inhibit
12935 dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
12936 because that scope has been reached. Only dump such items when
12937 they are directly reachable by some other path.
12938
12939 When dumping pretty-printed trees, this option inhibits dumping
12940 the bodies of control structures.
12941
12942 When dumping RTL, print the RTL in slim (condensed) form
12943 instead of the default LISP-like representation.
12944
12945 raw Print a raw representation of the tree. By default, trees are
12946 pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
12947
12948 details
12949 Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).
12950 Also include information from the optimization passes.
12951
12952 stats
12953 Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored
12954 by every dump option).
12955
12956 blocks
12957 Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
12958
12959 graph
12960 For each of the other indicated dump files (-fdump-rtl-pass),
12961 dump a representation of the control flow graph suitable for
12962 viewing with GraphViz to file.passid.pass.dot. Each function
12963 in the file is pretty-printed as a subgraph, so that GraphViz
12964 can render them all in a single plot.
12965
12966 This option currently only works for RTL dumps, and the RTL is
12967 always dumped in slim form.
12968
12969 vops
12970 Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
12971
12972 lineno
12973 Enable showing line numbers for statements.
12974
12975 uid Enable showing the unique ID ("DECL_UID") for each variable.
12976
12977 verbose
12978 Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.
12979
12980 eh Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.
12981
12982 scev
12983 Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.
12984
12985 optimized
12986 Enable showing optimization information (only available in
12987 certain passes).
12988
12989 missed
12990 Enable showing missed optimization information (only available
12991 in certain passes).
12992
12993 note
12994 Enable other detailed optimization information (only available
12995 in certain passes).
12996
12997 all Turn on all options, except raw, slim, verbose and lineno.
12998
12999 optall
13000 Turn on all optimization options, i.e., optimized, missed, and
13001 note.
13002
13003 To determine what tree dumps are available or find the dump for a
13004 pass of interest follow the steps below.
13005
13006 1. Invoke GCC with -fdump-passes and in the stderr output look for
13007 a code that corresponds to the pass you are interested in. For
13008 example, the codes "tree-evrp", "tree-vrp1", and "tree-vrp2"
13009 correspond to the three Value Range Propagation passes. The
13010 number at the end distinguishes distinct invocations of the
13011 same pass.
13012
13013 2. To enable the creation of the dump file, append the pass code
13014 to the -fdump- option prefix and invoke GCC with it. For
13015 example, to enable the dump from the Early Value Range
13016 Propagation pass, invoke GCC with the -fdump-tree-evrp option.
13017 Optionally, you may specify the name of the dump file. If you
13018 don't specify one, GCC creates as described below.
13019
13020 3. Find the pass dump in a file whose name is composed of three
13021 components separated by a period: the name of the source file
13022 GCC was invoked to compile, a numeric suffix indicating the
13023 pass number followed by the letter t for tree passes (and the
13024 letter r for RTL passes), and finally the pass code. For
13025 example, the Early VRP pass dump might be in a file named
13026 myfile.c.038t.evrp in the current working directory. Note that
13027 the numeric codes are not stable and may change from one
13028 version of GCC to another.
13029
13030 -fopt-info
13031 -fopt-info-options
13032 -fopt-info-options=filename
13033 Controls optimization dumps from various optimization passes. If
13034 the -options form is used, options is a list of - separated option
13035 keywords to select the dump details and optimizations.
13036
13037 The options can be divided into three groups:
13038
13039 1. options describing what kinds of messages should be emitted,
13040
13041 2. options describing the verbosity of the dump, and
13042
13043 3. options describing which optimizations should be included.
13044
13045 The options from each group can be freely mixed as they are non-
13046 overlapping. However, in case of any conflicts, the later options
13047 override the earlier options on the command line.
13048
13049 The following options control which kinds of messages should be
13050 emitted:
13051
13052 optimized
13053 Print information when an optimization is successfully applied.
13054 It is up to a pass to decide which information is relevant. For
13055 example, the vectorizer passes print the source location of
13056 loops which are successfully vectorized.
13057
13058 missed
13059 Print information about missed optimizations. Individual passes
13060 control which information to include in the output.
13061
13062 note
13063 Print verbose information about optimizations, such as certain
13064 transformations, more detailed messages about decisions etc.
13065
13066 all Print detailed optimization information. This includes
13067 optimized, missed, and note.
13068
13069 The following option controls the dump verbosity:
13070
13071 internals
13072 By default, only "high-level" messages are emitted. This option
13073 enables additional, more detailed, messages, which are likely
13074 to only be of interest to GCC developers.
13075
13076 One or more of the following option keywords can be used to
13077 describe a group of optimizations:
13078
13079 ipa Enable dumps from all interprocedural optimizations.
13080
13081 loop
13082 Enable dumps from all loop optimizations.
13083
13084 inline
13085 Enable dumps from all inlining optimizations.
13086
13087 omp Enable dumps from all OMP (Offloading and Multi Processing)
13088 optimizations.
13089
13090 vec Enable dumps from all vectorization optimizations.
13091
13092 optall
13093 Enable dumps from all optimizations. This is a superset of the
13094 optimization groups listed above.
13095
13096 If options is omitted, it defaults to optimized-optall, which means
13097 to dump messages about successful optimizations from all the
13098 passes, omitting messages that are treated as "internals".
13099
13100 If the filename is provided, then the dumps from all the applicable
13101 optimizations are concatenated into the filename. Otherwise the
13102 dump is output onto stderr. Though multiple -fopt-info options are
13103 accepted, only one of them can include a filename. If other
13104 filenames are provided then all but the first such option are
13105 ignored.
13106
13107 Note that the output filename is overwritten in case of multiple
13108 translation units. If a combined output from multiple translation
13109 units is desired, stderr should be used instead.
13110
13111 In the following example, the optimization info is output to
13112 stderr:
13113
13114 gcc -O3 -fopt-info
13115
13116 This example:
13117
13118 gcc -O3 -fopt-info-missed=missed.all
13119
13120 outputs missed optimization report from all the passes into
13121 missed.all, and this one:
13122
13123 gcc -O2 -ftree-vectorize -fopt-info-vec-missed
13124
13125 prints information about missed optimization opportunities from
13126 vectorization passes on stderr. Note that -fopt-info-vec-missed is
13127 equivalent to -fopt-info-missed-vec. The order of the optimization
13128 group names and message types listed after -fopt-info does not
13129 matter.
13130
13131 As another example,
13132
13133 gcc -O3 -fopt-info-inline-optimized-missed=inline.txt
13134
13135 outputs information about missed optimizations as well as optimized
13136 locations from all the inlining passes into inline.txt.
13137
13138 Finally, consider:
13139
13140 gcc -fopt-info-vec-missed=vec.miss -fopt-info-loop-optimized=loop.opt
13141
13142 Here the two output filenames vec.miss and loop.opt are in conflict
13143 since only one output file is allowed. In this case, only the first
13144 option takes effect and the subsequent options are ignored. Thus
13145 only vec.miss is produced which contains dumps from the vectorizer
13146 about missed opportunities.
13147
13148 -fsave-optimization-record
13149 Write a SRCFILE.opt-record.json.gz file detailing what
13150 optimizations were performed, for those optimizations that support
13151 -fopt-info.
13152
13153 This option is experimental and the format of the data within the
13154 compressed JSON file is subject to change.
13155
13156 It is roughly equivalent to a machine-readable version of
13157 -fopt-info-all, as a collection of messages with source file, line
13158 number and column number, with the following additional data for
13159 each message:
13160
13161 * the execution count of the code being optimized, along with
13162 metadata about whether this was from actual profile data, or
13163 just an estimate, allowing consumers to prioritize messages by
13164 code hotness,
13165
13166 * the function name of the code being optimized, where
13167 applicable,
13168
13169 * the "inlining chain" for the code being optimized, so that when
13170 a function is inlined into several different places (which
13171 might themselves be inlined), the reader can distinguish
13172 between the copies,
13173
13174 * objects identifying those parts of the message that refer to
13175 expressions, statements or symbol-table nodes, which of these
13176 categories they are, and, when available, their source code
13177 location,
13178
13179 * the GCC pass that emitted the message, and
13180
13181 * the location in GCC's own code from which the message was
13182 emitted
13183
13184 Additionally, some messages are logically nested within other
13185 messages, reflecting implementation details of the optimization
13186 passes.
13187
13188 -fsched-verbose=n
13189 On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls
13190 the amount of debugging output the scheduler prints to the dump
13191 files.
13192
13193 For n greater than zero, -fsched-verbose outputs the same
13194 information as -fdump-rtl-sched1 and -fdump-rtl-sched2. For n
13195 greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities,
13196 detailed ready list information and unit/insn info. For n greater
13197 than two, it includes RTL at abort point, control-flow and regions
13198 info. And for n over four, -fsched-verbose also includes
13199 dependence info.
13200
13201 -fenable-kind-pass
13202 -fdisable-kind-pass=range-list
13203 This is a set of options that are used to explicitly disable/enable
13204 optimization passes. These options are intended for use for
13205 debugging GCC. Compiler users should use regular options for
13206 enabling/disabling passes instead.
13207
13208 -fdisable-ipa-pass
13209 Disable IPA pass pass. pass is the pass name. If the same pass
13210 is statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass
13211 name should be appended with a sequential number starting from
13212 1.
13213
13214 -fdisable-rtl-pass
13215 -fdisable-rtl-pass=range-list
13216 Disable RTL pass pass. pass is the pass name. If the same
13217 pass is statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the
13218 pass name should be appended with a sequential number starting
13219 from 1. range-list is a comma-separated list of function
13220 ranges or assembler names. Each range is a number pair
13221 separated by a colon. The range is inclusive in both ends. If
13222 the range is trivial, the number pair can be simplified as a
13223 single number. If the function's call graph node's uid falls
13224 within one of the specified ranges, the pass is disabled for
13225 that function. The uid is shown in the function header of a
13226 dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using option
13227 -fdump-passes.
13228
13229 -fdisable-tree-pass
13230 -fdisable-tree-pass=range-list
13231 Disable tree pass pass. See -fdisable-rtl for the description
13232 of option arguments.
13233
13234 -fenable-ipa-pass
13235 Enable IPA pass pass. pass is the pass name. If the same pass
13236 is statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass
13237 name should be appended with a sequential number starting from
13238 1.
13239
13240 -fenable-rtl-pass
13241 -fenable-rtl-pass=range-list
13242 Enable RTL pass pass. See -fdisable-rtl for option argument
13243 description and examples.
13244
13245 -fenable-tree-pass
13246 -fenable-tree-pass=range-list
13247 Enable tree pass pass. See -fdisable-rtl for the description
13248 of option arguments.
13249
13250 Here are some examples showing uses of these options.
13251
13252 # disable ccp1 for all functions
13253 -fdisable-tree-ccp1
13254 # disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
13255 -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
13256 # disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
13257 # [300,400], and [400,1000]
13258 # disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
13259 -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
13260 # disable early inlining
13261 -fdisable-tree-einline
13262 # disable ipa inlining
13263 -fdisable-ipa-inline
13264 # enable tree full unroll
13265 -fenable-tree-unroll
13266
13267 -fchecking
13268 -fchecking=n
13269 Enable internal consistency checking. The default depends on the
13270 compiler configuration. -fchecking=2 enables further internal
13271 consistency checking that might affect code generation.
13272
13273 -frandom-seed=string
13274 This option provides a seed that GCC uses in place of random
13275 numbers in generating certain symbol names that have to be
13276 different in every compiled file. It is also used to place unique
13277 stamps in coverage data files and the object files that produce
13278 them. You can use the -frandom-seed option to produce reproducibly
13279 identical object files.
13280
13281 The string can either be a number (decimal, octal or hex) or an
13282 arbitrary string (in which case it's converted to a number by
13283 computing CRC32).
13284
13285 The string should be different for every file you compile.
13286
13287 -save-temps
13288 -save-temps=cwd
13289 Store the usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently; place
13290 them in the current directory and name them based on the source
13291 file. Thus, compiling foo.c with -c -save-temps produces files
13292 foo.i and foo.s, as well as foo.o. This creates a preprocessed
13293 foo.i output file even though the compiler now normally uses an
13294 integrated preprocessor.
13295
13296 When used in combination with the -x command-line option,
13297 -save-temps is sensible enough to avoid over writing an input
13298 source file with the same extension as an intermediate file. The
13299 corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
13300 source file before using -save-temps.
13301
13302 If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source
13303 files that share a common base name in different subdirectories or
13304 the same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it
13305 is likely that the different parallel compilers will interfere with
13306 each other, and overwrite the temporary files. For instance:
13307
13308 gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
13309 gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&
13310
13311 may result in foo.i and foo.o being written to simultaneously by
13312 both compilers.
13313
13314 -save-temps=obj
13315 Store the usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently. If the
13316 -o option is used, the temporary files are based on the object
13317 file. If the -o option is not used, the -save-temps=obj switch
13318 behaves like -save-temps.
13319
13320 For example:
13321
13322 gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
13323 gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
13324 gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar
13325
13326 creates foo.i, foo.s, dir/xbar.i, dir/xbar.s, dir2/yfoobar.i,
13327 dir2/yfoobar.s, and dir2/yfoobar.o.
13328
13329 -time[=file]
13330 Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
13331 sequence. For C source files, this is the compiler proper and
13332 assembler (plus the linker if linking is done).
13333
13334 Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like
13335 this:
13336
13337 # cc1 0.12 0.01
13338 # as 0.00 0.01
13339
13340 The first number on each line is the "user time", that is time
13341 spent executing the program itself. The second number is "system
13342 time", time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of
13343 the program. Both numbers are in seconds.
13344
13345 With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to
13346 the named file, and it looks like this:
13347
13348 0.12 0.01 cc1 <options>
13349 0.00 0.01 as <options>
13350
13351 The "user time" and the "system time" are moved before the program
13352 name, and the options passed to the program are displayed, so that
13353 one can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which
13354 options.
13355
13356 -fdump-final-insns[=file]
13357 Dump the final internal representation (RTL) to file. If the
13358 optional argument is omitted (or if file is "."), the name of the
13359 dump file is determined by appending ".gkd" to the compilation
13360 output file name.
13361
13362 -fcompare-debug[=opts]
13363 If no error occurs during compilation, run the compiler a second
13364 time, adding opts and -fcompare-debug-second to the arguments
13365 passed to the second compilation. Dump the final internal
13366 representation in both compilations, and print an error if they
13367 differ.
13368
13369 If the equal sign is omitted, the default -gtoggle is used.
13370
13371 The environment variable GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG, if defined, non-empty
13372 and nonzero, implicitly enables -fcompare-debug. If
13373 GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG is defined to a string starting with a dash, then
13374 it is used for opts, otherwise the default -gtoggle is used.
13375
13376 -fcompare-debug=, with the equal sign but without opts, is
13377 equivalent to -fno-compare-debug, which disables the dumping of the
13378 final representation and the second compilation, preventing even
13379 GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG from taking effect.
13380
13381 To verify full coverage during -fcompare-debug testing, set
13382 GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG to say -fcompare-debug-not-overridden, which GCC
13383 rejects as an invalid option in any actual compilation (rather than
13384 preprocessing, assembly or linking). To get just a warning,
13385 setting GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG to -w%n-fcompare-debug not overridden
13386 will do.
13387
13388 -fcompare-debug-second
13389 This option is implicitly passed to the compiler for the second
13390 compilation requested by -fcompare-debug, along with options to
13391 silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause the
13392 compiler to produce output to files or to standard output as a side
13393 effect. Dump files and preserved temporary files are renamed so as
13394 to contain the ".gk" additional extension during the second
13395 compilation, to avoid overwriting those generated by the first.
13396
13397 When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the
13398 first compilation to be skipped, which makes it useful for little
13399 other than debugging the compiler proper.
13400
13401 -gtoggle
13402 Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option
13403 generates it, or turn it on at level 2 otherwise. The position of
13404 this argument in the command line does not matter; it takes effect
13405 after all other options are processed, and it does so only once, no
13406 matter how many times it is given. This is mainly intended to be
13407 used with -fcompare-debug.
13408
13409 -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
13410 Toggle -fvar-tracking-assignments, in the same way that -gtoggle
13411 toggles -g.
13412
13413 -Q Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled,
13414 and print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
13415
13416 -ftime-report
13417 Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by
13418 each pass when it finishes.
13419
13420 -ftime-report-details
13421 Record the time consumed by infrastructure parts separately for
13422 each pass.
13423
13424 -fira-verbose=n
13425 Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register
13426 allocator. The default value is 5. If the value n is greater or
13427 equal to 10, the dump output is sent to stderr using the same
13428 format as n minus 10.
13429
13430 -flto-report
13431 Prints a report with internal details on the workings of the link-
13432 time optimizer. The contents of this report vary from version to
13433 version. It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when
13434 processing object files in LTO mode (via -flto).
13435
13436 Disabled by default.
13437
13438 -flto-report-wpa
13439 Like -flto-report, but only print for the WPA phase of Link Time
13440 Optimization.
13441
13442 -fmem-report
13443 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
13444 allocation when it finishes.
13445
13446 -fmem-report-wpa
13447 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
13448 allocation for the WPA phase only.
13449
13450 -fpre-ipa-mem-report
13451 -fpost-ipa-mem-report
13452 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
13453 allocation before or after interprocedural optimization.
13454
13455 -fprofile-report
13456 Makes the compiler print some statistics about consistency of the
13457 (estimated) profile and effect of individual passes.
13458
13459 -fstack-usage
13460 Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program,
13461 on a per-function basis. The filename for the dump is made by
13462 appending .su to the auxname. auxname is generated from the name
13463 of the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an
13464 executable, otherwise it is the basename of the source file. An
13465 entry is made up of three fields:
13466
13467 * The name of the function.
13468
13469 * A number of bytes.
13470
13471 * One or more qualifiers: "static", "dynamic", "bounded".
13472
13473 The qualifier "static" means that the function manipulates the
13474 stack statically: a fixed number of bytes are allocated for the
13475 frame on function entry and released on function exit; no stack
13476 adjustments are otherwise made in the function. The second field
13477 is this fixed number of bytes.
13478
13479 The qualifier "dynamic" means that the function manipulates the
13480 stack dynamically: in addition to the static allocation described
13481 above, stack adjustments are made in the body of the function, for
13482 example to push/pop arguments around function calls. If the
13483 qualifier "bounded" is also present, the amount of these
13484 adjustments is bounded at compile time and the second field is an
13485 upper bound of the total amount of stack used by the function. If
13486 it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is not bounded
13487 at compile time and the second field only represents the bounded
13488 part.
13489
13490 -fstats
13491 Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the
13492 compilation. This option is supported only by the C++ front end,
13493 and the information is generally only useful to the G++ development
13494 team.
13495
13496 -fdbg-cnt-list
13497 Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.
13498
13499 -fdbg-cnt=counter-value-list
13500 Set the internal debug counter lower and upper bound. counter-
13501 value-list is a comma-separated list of
13502 name:lower_bound:upper_bound tuples which sets the lower and the
13503 upper bound of each debug counter name. The lower_bound is
13504 optional and is zero initialized if not set. All debug counters
13505 have the initial upper bound of "UINT_MAX"; thus "dbg_cnt" returns
13506 true always unless the upper bound is set by this option. For
13507 example, with -fdbg-cnt=dce:2:4,tail_call:10, "dbg_cnt(dce)"
13508 returns true only for third and fourth invocation. For
13509 "dbg_cnt(tail_call)" true is returned for first 10 invocations.
13510
13511 -print-file-name=library
13512 Print the full absolute name of the library file library that would
13513 be used when linking---and don't do anything else. With this
13514 option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
13515 file name.
13516
13517 -print-multi-directory
13518 Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by
13519 any other switches present in the command line. This directory is
13520 supposed to exist in GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.
13521
13522 -print-multi-lib
13523 Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler
13524 switches that enable them. The directory name is separated from
13525 the switches by ;, and each switch starts with an @ instead of the
13526 -, without spaces between multiple switches. This is supposed to
13527 ease shell processing.
13528
13529 -print-multi-os-directory
13530 Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multilib, relative
13531 to some lib subdirectory. If OS libraries are present in the lib
13532 subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is usually just ., if
13533 OS libraries are present in libsuffix sibling directories this
13534 prints e.g. ../lib64, ../lib or ../lib32, or if OS libraries are
13535 present in lib/subdir subdirectories it prints e.g. amd64, sparcv9
13536 or ev6.
13537
13538 -print-multiarch
13539 Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch, relative
13540 to some lib subdirectory.
13541
13542 -print-prog-name=program
13543 Like -print-file-name, but searches for a program such as cpp.
13544
13545 -print-libgcc-file-name
13546 Same as -print-file-name=libgcc.a.
13547
13548 This is useful when you use -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs but you do
13549 want to link with libgcc.a. You can do:
13550
13551 gcc -nostdlib <files>... `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
13552
13553 -print-search-dirs
13554 Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list
13555 of program and library directories gcc searches---and don't do
13556 anything else.
13557
13558 This is useful when gcc prints the error message installation
13559 problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory. To resolve
13560 this you either need to put cpp0 and the other compiler components
13561 where gcc expects to find them, or you can set the environment
13562 variable GCC_EXEC_PREFIX to the directory where you installed them.
13563 Don't forget the trailing /.
13564
13565 -print-sysroot
13566 Print the target sysroot directory that is used during compilation.
13567 This is the target sysroot specified either at configure time or
13568 using the --sysroot option, possibly with an extra suffix that
13569 depends on compilation options. If no target sysroot is specified,
13570 the option prints nothing.
13571
13572 -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
13573 Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for
13574 headers, or give an error if the compiler is not configured with
13575 such a suffix---and don't do anything else.
13576
13577 -dumpmachine
13578 Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
13579 i686-pc-linux-gnu)---and don't do anything else.
13580
13581 -dumpversion
13582 Print the compiler version (for example, 3.0, 6.3.0 or 7)---and
13583 don't do anything else. This is the compiler version used in
13584 filesystem paths and specs. Depending on how the compiler has been
13585 configured it can be just a single number (major version), two
13586 numbers separated by a dot (major and minor version) or three
13587 numbers separated by dots (major, minor and patchlevel version).
13588
13589 -dumpfullversion
13590 Print the full compiler version---and don't do anything else. The
13591 output is always three numbers separated by dots, major, minor and
13592 patchlevel version.
13593
13594 -dumpspecs
13595 Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.
13596 (This is used when GCC itself is being built.)
13597
13598 Machine-Dependent Options
13599 Each target machine supported by GCC can have its own options---for
13600 example, to allow you to compile for a particular processor variant or
13601 ABI, or to control optimizations specific to that machine. By
13602 convention, the names of machine-specific options start with -m.
13603
13604 Some configurations of the compiler also support additional target-
13605 specific options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the
13606 same platform.
13607
13608 AArch64 Options
13609
13610 These options are defined for AArch64 implementations:
13611
13612 -mabi=name
13613 Generate code for the specified data model. Permissible values are
13614 ilp32 for SysV-like data model where int, long int and pointers are
13615 32 bits, and lp64 for SysV-like data model where int is 32 bits,
13616 but long int and pointers are 64 bits.
13617
13618 The default depends on the specific target configuration. Note
13619 that the LP64 and ILP32 ABIs are not link-compatible; you must
13620 compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
13621 compatible set of libraries.
13622
13623 -mbig-endian
13624 Generate big-endian code. This is the default when GCC is
13625 configured for an aarch64_be-*-* target.
13626
13627 -mgeneral-regs-only
13628 Generate code which uses only the general-purpose registers. This
13629 will prevent the compiler from using floating-point and Advanced
13630 SIMD registers but will not impose any restrictions on the
13631 assembler.
13632
13633 -mlittle-endian
13634 Generate little-endian code. This is the default when GCC is
13635 configured for an aarch64-*-* but not an aarch64_be-*-* target.
13636
13637 -mcmodel=tiny
13638 Generate code for the tiny code model. The program and its
13639 statically defined symbols must be within 1MB of each other.
13640 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
13641
13642 -mcmodel=small
13643 Generate code for the small code model. The program and its
13644 statically defined symbols must be within 4GB of each other.
13645 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked. This is the
13646 default code model.
13647
13648 -mcmodel=large
13649 Generate code for the large code model. This makes no assumptions
13650 about addresses and sizes of sections. Programs can be statically
13651 linked only.
13652
13653 -mstrict-align
13654 -mno-strict-align
13655 Avoid or allow generating memory accesses that may not be aligned
13656 on a natural object boundary as described in the architecture
13657 specification.
13658
13659 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13660 -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
13661 Omit or keep the frame pointer in leaf functions. The former
13662 behavior is the default.
13663
13664 -mstack-protector-guard=guard
13665 -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
13666 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
13667 Generate stack protection code using canary at guard. Supported
13668 locations are global for a global canary or sysreg for a canary in
13669 an appropriate system register.
13670
13671 With the latter choice the options -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
13672 and -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset furthermore specify which
13673 system register to use as base register for reading the canary, and
13674 from what offset from that base register. There is no default
13675 register or offset as this is entirely for use within the Linux
13676 kernel.
13677
13678 -mstack-protector-guard=guard
13679 -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
13680 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
13681 Generate stack protection code using canary at guard. Supported
13682 locations are global for a global canary or sysreg for a canary in
13683 an appropriate system register.
13684
13685 With the latter choice the options -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
13686 and -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset furthermore specify which
13687 system register to use as base register for reading the canary, and
13688 from what offset from that base register. There is no default
13689 register or offset as this is entirely for use within the Linux
13690 kernel.
13691
13692 -mtls-dialect=desc
13693 Use TLS descriptors as the thread-local storage mechanism for
13694 dynamic accesses of TLS variables. This is the default.
13695
13696 -mtls-dialect=traditional
13697 Use traditional TLS as the thread-local storage mechanism for
13698 dynamic accesses of TLS variables.
13699
13700 -mtls-size=size
13701 Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets. Valid values are 12,
13702 24, 32, 48. This option requires binutils 2.26 or newer.
13703
13704 -mfix-cortex-a53-835769
13705 -mno-fix-cortex-a53-835769
13706 Enable or disable the workaround for the ARM Cortex-A53 erratum
13707 number 835769. This involves inserting a NOP instruction between
13708 memory instructions and 64-bit integer multiply-accumulate
13709 instructions.
13710
13711 -mfix-cortex-a53-843419
13712 -mno-fix-cortex-a53-843419
13713 Enable or disable the workaround for the ARM Cortex-A53 erratum
13714 number 843419. This erratum workaround is made at link time and
13715 this will only pass the corresponding flag to the linker.
13716
13717 -mlow-precision-recip-sqrt
13718 -mno-low-precision-recip-sqrt
13719 Enable or disable the reciprocal square root approximation. This
13720 option only has an effect if -ffast-math or
13721 -funsafe-math-optimizations is used as well. Enabling this reduces
13722 precision of reciprocal square root results to about 16 bits for
13723 single precision and to 32 bits for double precision.
13724
13725 -mlow-precision-sqrt
13726 -mno-low-precision-sqrt
13727 Enable or disable the square root approximation. This option only
13728 has an effect if -ffast-math or -funsafe-math-optimizations is used
13729 as well. Enabling this reduces precision of square root results to
13730 about 16 bits for single precision and to 32 bits for double
13731 precision. If enabled, it implies -mlow-precision-recip-sqrt.
13732
13733 -mlow-precision-div
13734 -mno-low-precision-div
13735 Enable or disable the division approximation. This option only has
13736 an effect if -ffast-math or -funsafe-math-optimizations is used as
13737 well. Enabling this reduces precision of division results to about
13738 16 bits for single precision and to 32 bits for double precision.
13739
13740 -mtrack-speculation
13741 -mno-track-speculation
13742 Enable or disable generation of additional code to track
13743 speculative execution through conditional branches. The tracking
13744 state can then be used by the compiler when expanding calls to
13745 "__builtin_speculation_safe_copy" to permit a more efficient code
13746 sequence to be generated.
13747
13748 -march=name
13749 Specify the name of the target architecture and, optionally, one or
13750 more feature modifiers. This option has the form
13751 -march=arch{+[no]feature}*.
13752
13753 The permissible values for arch are armv8-a, armv8.1-a, armv8.2-a,
13754 armv8.3-a, armv8.4-a, armv8.5-a or native.
13755
13756 The value armv8.5-a implies armv8.4-a and enables compiler support
13757 for the ARMv8.5-A architecture extensions.
13758
13759 The value armv8.4-a implies armv8.3-a and enables compiler support
13760 for the ARMv8.4-A architecture extensions.
13761
13762 The value armv8.3-a implies armv8.2-a and enables compiler support
13763 for the ARMv8.3-A architecture extensions.
13764
13765 The value armv8.2-a implies armv8.1-a and enables compiler support
13766 for the ARMv8.2-A architecture extensions.
13767
13768 The value armv8.1-a implies armv8-a and enables compiler support
13769 for the ARMv8.1-A architecture extension. In particular, it
13770 enables the +crc, +lse, and +rdma features.
13771
13772 The value native is available on native AArch64 GNU/Linux and
13773 causes the compiler to pick the architecture of the host system.
13774 This option has no effect if the compiler is unable to recognize
13775 the architecture of the host system,
13776
13777 The permissible values for feature are listed in the sub-section on
13778 aarch64-feature-modifiers,,-march and -mcpu Feature Modifiers.
13779 Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most
13780 feature is used.
13781
13782 GCC uses name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit
13783 when generating assembly code. If -march is specified without
13784 either of -mtune or -mcpu also being specified, the code is tuned
13785 to perform well across a range of target processors implementing
13786 the target architecture.
13787
13788 -mtune=name
13789 Specify the name of the target processor for which GCC should tune
13790 the performance of the code. Permissible values for this option
13791 are: generic, cortex-a35, cortex-a53, cortex-a55, cortex-a57,
13792 cortex-a72, cortex-a73, cortex-a75, cortex-a76, ares, exynos-m1,
13793 emag, falkor, neoverse-e1,neoverse-n1,qdf24xx, saphira, phecda,
13794 xgene1, vulcan, octeontx, octeontx81, octeontx83, thunderx,
13795 thunderxt88, thunderxt88p1, thunderxt81, tsv110, thunderxt83,
13796 thunderx2t99, cortex-a57.cortex-a53, cortex-a72.cortex-a53,
13797 cortex-a73.cortex-a35, cortex-a73.cortex-a53,
13798 cortex-a75.cortex-a55, cortex-a76.cortex-a55 native.
13799
13800 The values cortex-a57.cortex-a53, cortex-a72.cortex-a53,
13801 cortex-a73.cortex-a35, cortex-a73.cortex-a53,
13802 cortex-a75.cortex-a55, cortex-a76.cortex-a55 specify that GCC
13803 should tune for a big.LITTLE system.
13804
13805 Additionally on native AArch64 GNU/Linux systems the value native
13806 tunes performance to the host system. This option has no effect if
13807 the compiler is unable to recognize the processor of the host
13808 system.
13809
13810 Where none of -mtune=, -mcpu= or -march= are specified, the code is
13811 tuned to perform well across a range of target processors.
13812
13813 This option cannot be suffixed by feature modifiers.
13814
13815 -mcpu=name
13816 Specify the name of the target processor, optionally suffixed by
13817 one or more feature modifiers. This option has the form
13818 -mcpu=cpu{+[no]feature}*, where the permissible values for cpu are
13819 the same as those available for -mtune. The permissible values for
13820 feature are documented in the sub-section on
13821 aarch64-feature-modifiers,,-march and -mcpu Feature Modifiers.
13822 Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most
13823 feature is used.
13824
13825 GCC uses name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit
13826 when generating assembly code (as if by -march) and to determine
13827 the target processor for which to tune for performance (as if by
13828 -mtune). Where this option is used in conjunction with -march or
13829 -mtune, those options take precedence over the appropriate part of
13830 this option.
13831
13832 -moverride=string
13833 Override tuning decisions made by the back-end in response to a
13834 -mtune= switch. The syntax, semantics, and accepted values for
13835 string in this option are not guaranteed to be consistent across
13836 releases.
13837
13838 This option is only intended to be useful when developing GCC.
13839
13840 -mverbose-cost-dump
13841 Enable verbose cost model dumping in the debug dump files. This
13842 option is provided for use in debugging the compiler.
13843
13844 -mpc-relative-literal-loads
13845 -mno-pc-relative-literal-loads
13846 Enable or disable PC-relative literal loads. With this option
13847 literal pools are accessed using a single instruction and emitted
13848 after each function. This limits the maximum size of functions to
13849 1MB. This is enabled by default for -mcmodel=tiny.
13850
13851 -msign-return-address=scope
13852 Select the function scope on which return address signing will be
13853 applied. Permissible values are none, which disables return
13854 address signing, non-leaf, which enables pointer signing for
13855 functions which are not leaf functions, and all, which enables
13856 pointer signing for all functions. The default value is none. This
13857 option has been deprecated by -mbranch-protection.
13858
13859 -mbranch-protection=none|standard|pac-ret[+leaf]|bti
13860 Select the branch protection features to use. none is the default
13861 and turns off all types of branch protection. standard turns on
13862 all types of branch protection features. If a feature has
13863 additional tuning options, then standard sets it to its standard
13864 level. pac-ret[+leaf] turns on return address signing to its
13865 standard level: signing functions that save the return address to
13866 memory (non-leaf functions will practically always do this) using
13867 the a-key. The optional argument leaf can be used to extend the
13868 signing to include leaf functions. bti turns on branch target
13869 identification mechanism.
13870
13871 -msve-vector-bits=bits
13872 Specify the number of bits in an SVE vector register. This option
13873 only has an effect when SVE is enabled.
13874
13875 GCC supports two forms of SVE code generation: "vector-length
13876 agnostic" output that works with any size of vector register and
13877 "vector-length specific" output that allows GCC to make assumptions
13878 about the vector length when it is useful for optimization reasons.
13879 The possible values of bits are: scalable, 128, 256, 512, 1024 and
13880 2048. Specifying scalable selects vector-length agnostic output.
13881 At present -msve-vector-bits=128 also generates vector-length
13882 agnostic output. All other values generate vector-length specific
13883 code. The behavior of these values may change in future releases
13884 and no value except scalable should be relied on for producing code
13885 that is portable across different hardware SVE vector lengths.
13886
13887 The default is -msve-vector-bits=scalable, which produces vector-
13888 length agnostic code.
13889
13890 -march and -mcpu Feature Modifiers
13891
13892 Feature modifiers used with -march and -mcpu can be any of the
13893 following and their inverses nofeature:
13894
13895 crc Enable CRC extension. This is on by default for -march=armv8.1-a.
13896
13897 crypto
13898 Enable Crypto extension. This also enables Advanced SIMD and
13899 floating-point instructions.
13900
13901 fp Enable floating-point instructions. This is on by default for all
13902 possible values for options -march and -mcpu.
13903
13904 simd
13905 Enable Advanced SIMD instructions. This also enables floating-
13906 point instructions. This is on by default for all possible values
13907 for options -march and -mcpu.
13908
13909 sve Enable Scalable Vector Extension instructions. This also enables
13910 Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
13911
13912 lse Enable Large System Extension instructions. This is on by default
13913 for -march=armv8.1-a.
13914
13915 rdma
13916 Enable Round Double Multiply Accumulate instructions. This is on
13917 by default for -march=armv8.1-a.
13918
13919 fp16
13920 Enable FP16 extension. This also enables floating-point
13921 instructions.
13922
13923 fp16fml
13924 Enable FP16 fmla extension. This also enables FP16 extensions and
13925 floating-point instructions. This option is enabled by default for
13926 -march=armv8.4-a. Use of this option with architectures prior to
13927 Armv8.2-A is not supported.
13928
13929 rcpc
13930 Enable the RcPc extension. This does not change code generation
13931 from GCC, but is passed on to the assembler, enabling inline asm
13932 statements to use instructions from the RcPc extension.
13933
13934 dotprod
13935 Enable the Dot Product extension. This also enables Advanced SIMD
13936 instructions.
13937
13938 aes Enable the Armv8-a aes and pmull crypto extension. This also
13939 enables Advanced SIMD instructions.
13940
13941 sha2
13942 Enable the Armv8-a sha2 crypto extension. This also enables
13943 Advanced SIMD instructions.
13944
13945 sha3
13946 Enable the sha512 and sha3 crypto extension. This also enables
13947 Advanced SIMD instructions. Use of this option with architectures
13948 prior to Armv8.2-A is not supported.
13949
13950 sm4 Enable the sm3 and sm4 crypto extension. This also enables
13951 Advanced SIMD instructions. Use of this option with architectures
13952 prior to Armv8.2-A is not supported.
13953
13954 profile
13955 Enable the Statistical Profiling extension. This option is only to
13956 enable the extension at the assembler level and does not affect
13957 code generation.
13958
13959 rng Enable the Armv8.5-a Random Number instructions. This option is
13960 only to enable the extension at the assembler level and does not
13961 affect code generation.
13962
13963 memtag
13964 Enable the Armv8.5-a Memory Tagging Extensions. This option is
13965 only to enable the extension at the assembler level and does not
13966 affect code generation.
13967
13968 sb Enable the Armv8-a Speculation Barrier instruction. This option is
13969 only to enable the extension at the assembler level and does not
13970 affect code generation. This option is enabled by default for
13971 -march=armv8.5-a.
13972
13973 ssbs
13974 Enable the Armv8-a Speculative Store Bypass Safe instruction. This
13975 option is only to enable the extension at the assembler level and
13976 does not affect code generation. This option is enabled by default
13977 for -march=armv8.5-a.
13978
13979 predres
13980 Enable the Armv8-a Execution and Data Prediction Restriction
13981 instructions. This option is only to enable the extension at the
13982 assembler level and does not affect code generation. This option
13983 is enabled by default for -march=armv8.5-a.
13984
13985 Feature crypto implies aes, sha2, and simd, which implies fp.
13986 Conversely, nofp implies nosimd, which implies nocrypto, noaes and
13987 nosha2.
13988
13989 Adapteva Epiphany Options
13990
13991 These -m options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:
13992
13993 -mhalf-reg-file
13994 Don't allocate any register in the range "r32"..."r63". That
13995 allows code to run on hardware variants that lack these registers.
13996
13997 -mprefer-short-insn-regs
13998 Preferentially allocate registers that allow short instruction
13999 generation. This can result in increased instruction count, so
14000 this may either reduce or increase overall code size.
14001
14002 -mbranch-cost=num
14003 Set the cost of branches to roughly num "simple" instructions.
14004 This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
14005 consistent results across releases.
14006
14007 -mcmove
14008 Enable the generation of conditional moves.
14009
14010 -mnops=num
14011 Emit num NOPs before every other generated instruction.
14012
14013 -mno-soft-cmpsf
14014 For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an "fsub"
14015 instruction and test the flags. This is faster than a software
14016 comparison, but can get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs,
14017 or when two different small numbers are compared such that their
14018 difference is calculated as zero. The default is -msoft-cmpsf,
14019 which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant, software comparisons.
14020
14021 -mstack-offset=num
14022 Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.
14023 E.g., a value of 8 means that the eight bytes in the range
14024 "sp+0...sp+7" can be used by leaf functions without stack
14025 allocation. Values other than 8 or 16 are untested and unlikely to
14026 work. Note also that this option changes the ABI; compiling a
14027 program with a different stack offset than the libraries have been
14028 compiled with generally does not work. This option can be useful
14029 if you want to evaluate if a different stack offset would give you
14030 better code, but to actually use a different stack offset to build
14031 working programs, it is recommended to configure the toolchain with
14032 the appropriate --with-stack-offset=num option.
14033
14034 -mno-round-nearest
14035 Make the scheduler assume that the rounding mode has been set to
14036 truncating. The default is -mround-nearest.
14037
14038 -mlong-calls
14039 If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might
14040 be beyond the offset range of the "b" / "bl" instructions, and
14041 therefore load the function address into a register before
14042 performing a (otherwise direct) call. This is the default.
14043
14044 -mshort-calls
14045 If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls
14046 are in the range of the "b" / "bl" instructions, so use these
14047 instructions for direct calls. The default is -mlong-calls.
14048
14049 -msmall16
14050 Assume addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values. This
14051 does not apply to function addresses for which -mlong-calls
14052 semantics are in effect.
14053
14054 -mfp-mode=mode
14055 Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit. This
14056 determines the floating-point mode that is provided and expected at
14057 function call and return time. Making this mode match the mode you
14058 predominantly need at function start can make your programs smaller
14059 and faster by avoiding unnecessary mode switches.
14060
14061 mode can be set to one the following values:
14062
14063 caller
14064 Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored
14065 when the function returns, and when it calls other functions.
14066 This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other
14067 compilation units you might want to incorporate into different
14068 programs with different prevailing FPU modes, and the
14069 convenience of being able to use a single object file outweighs
14070 the size and speed overhead for any extra mode switching that
14071 might be needed, compared with what would be needed with a more
14072 specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.
14073
14074 truncate
14075 This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
14076 truncating (i.e. round towards zero) rounding mode. That
14077 includes conversion from floating point to integer.
14078
14079 round-nearest
14080 This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
14081 round-to-nearest-or-even rounding mode.
14082
14083 int This is the mode used to perform integer calculations in the
14084 FPU, e.g. integer multiply, or integer multiply-and-
14085 accumulate.
14086
14087 The default is -mfp-mode=caller
14088
14089 -mno-split-lohi
14090 -mno-postinc
14091 -mno-postmodify
14092 Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of
14093 32-bit loads, generation of post-increment addresses, and
14094 generation of post-modify addresses. The defaults are msplit-lohi,
14095 -mpost-inc, and -mpost-modify.
14096
14097 -mnovect-double
14098 Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode. The default is
14099 -mvect-double, which uses DImode as preferred SIMD mode.
14100
14101 -max-vect-align=num
14102 The maximum alignment for SIMD vector mode types. num may be 4 or
14103 8. The default is 8. Note that this is an ABI change, even though
14104 many library function interfaces are unaffected if they don't use
14105 SIMD vector modes in places that affect size and/or alignment of
14106 relevant types.
14107
14108 -msplit-vecmove-early
14109 Split vector moves into single word moves before reload. In theory
14110 this can give better register allocation, but so far the reverse
14111 seems to be generally the case.
14112
14113 -m1reg-reg
14114 Specify a register to hold the constant -1, which makes loading
14115 small negative constants and certain bitmasks faster. Allowable
14116 values for reg are r43 and r63, which specify use of that register
14117 as a fixed register, and none, which means that no register is used
14118 for this purpose. The default is -m1reg-none.
14119
14120 AMD GCN Options
14121
14122 These options are defined specifically for the AMD GCN port.
14123
14124 -march=gpu
14125 -mtune=gpu
14126 Set architecture type or tuning for gpu. Supported values for gpu
14127 are
14128
14129 fiji
14130 Compile for GCN3 Fiji devices (gfx803).
14131
14132 gfx900
14133 Compile for GCN5 Vega 10 devices (gfx900).
14134
14135 -mstack-size=bytes
14136 Specify how many bytes of stack space will be requested for each
14137 GPU thread (wave-front). Beware that there may be many threads and
14138 limited memory available. The size of the stack allocation may
14139 also have an impact on run-time performance. The default is 32KB
14140 when using OpenACC or OpenMP, and 1MB otherwise.
14141
14142 ARC Options
14143
14144 The following options control the architecture variant for which code
14145 is being compiled:
14146
14147 -mbarrel-shifter
14148 Generate instructions supported by barrel shifter. This is the
14149 default unless -mcpu=ARC601 or -mcpu=ARCEM is in effect.
14150
14151 -mjli-always
14152 Force to call a function using jli_s instruction. This option is
14153 valid only for ARCv2 architecture.
14154
14155 -mcpu=cpu
14156 Set architecture type, register usage, and instruction scheduling
14157 parameters for cpu. There are also shortcut alias options
14158 available for backward compatibility and convenience. Supported
14159 values for cpu are
14160
14161 arc600
14162 Compile for ARC600. Aliases: -mA6, -mARC600.
14163
14164 arc601
14165 Compile for ARC601. Alias: -mARC601.
14166
14167 arc700
14168 Compile for ARC700. Aliases: -mA7, -mARC700. This is the
14169 default when configured with --with-cpu=arc700.
14170
14171 arcem
14172 Compile for ARC EM.
14173
14174 archs
14175 Compile for ARC HS.
14176
14177 em Compile for ARC EM CPU with no hardware extensions.
14178
14179 em4 Compile for ARC EM4 CPU.
14180
14181 em4_dmips
14182 Compile for ARC EM4 DMIPS CPU.
14183
14184 em4_fpus
14185 Compile for ARC EM4 DMIPS CPU with the single-precision
14186 floating-point extension.
14187
14188 em4_fpuda
14189 Compile for ARC EM4 DMIPS CPU with single-precision floating-
14190 point and double assist instructions.
14191
14192 hs Compile for ARC HS CPU with no hardware extensions except the
14193 atomic instructions.
14194
14195 hs34
14196 Compile for ARC HS34 CPU.
14197
14198 hs38
14199 Compile for ARC HS38 CPU.
14200
14201 hs38_linux
14202 Compile for ARC HS38 CPU with all hardware extensions on.
14203
14204 arc600_norm
14205 Compile for ARC 600 CPU with "norm" instructions enabled.
14206
14207 arc600_mul32x16
14208 Compile for ARC 600 CPU with "norm" and 32x16-bit multiply
14209 instructions enabled.
14210
14211 arc600_mul64
14212 Compile for ARC 600 CPU with "norm" and "mul64"-family
14213 instructions enabled.
14214
14215 arc601_norm
14216 Compile for ARC 601 CPU with "norm" instructions enabled.
14217
14218 arc601_mul32x16
14219 Compile for ARC 601 CPU with "norm" and 32x16-bit multiply
14220 instructions enabled.
14221
14222 arc601_mul64
14223 Compile for ARC 601 CPU with "norm" and "mul64"-family
14224 instructions enabled.
14225
14226 nps400
14227 Compile for ARC 700 on NPS400 chip.
14228
14229 em_mini
14230 Compile for ARC EM minimalist configuration featuring reduced
14231 register set.
14232
14233 -mdpfp
14234 -mdpfp-compact
14235 Generate double-precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact
14236 implementation.
14237
14238 -mdpfp-fast
14239 Generate double-precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast
14240 implementation.
14241
14242 -mno-dpfp-lrsr
14243 Disable "lr" and "sr" instructions from using FPX extension aux
14244 registers.
14245
14246 -mea
14247 Generate extended arithmetic instructions. Currently only "divaw",
14248 "adds", "subs", and "sat16" are supported. This is always enabled
14249 for -mcpu=ARC700.
14250
14251 -mno-mpy
14252 Do not generate "mpy"-family instructions for ARC700. This option
14253 is deprecated.
14254
14255 -mmul32x16
14256 Generate 32x16-bit multiply and multiply-accumulate instructions.
14257
14258 -mmul64
14259 Generate "mul64" and "mulu64" instructions. Only valid for
14260 -mcpu=ARC600.
14261
14262 -mnorm
14263 Generate "norm" instructions. This is the default if -mcpu=ARC700
14264 is in effect.
14265
14266 -mspfp
14267 -mspfp-compact
14268 Generate single-precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact
14269 implementation.
14270
14271 -mspfp-fast
14272 Generate single-precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast
14273 implementation.
14274
14275 -msimd
14276 Enable generation of ARC SIMD instructions via target-specific
14277 builtins. Only valid for -mcpu=ARC700.
14278
14279 -msoft-float
14280 This option ignored; it is provided for compatibility purposes
14281 only. Software floating-point code is emitted by default, and this
14282 default can overridden by FPX options; -mspfp, -mspfp-compact, or
14283 -mspfp-fast for single precision, and -mdpfp, -mdpfp-compact, or
14284 -mdpfp-fast for double precision.
14285
14286 -mswap
14287 Generate "swap" instructions.
14288
14289 -matomic
14290 This enables use of the locked load/store conditional extension to
14291 implement atomic memory built-in functions. Not available for ARC
14292 6xx or ARC EM cores.
14293
14294 -mdiv-rem
14295 Enable "div" and "rem" instructions for ARCv2 cores.
14296
14297 -mcode-density
14298 Enable code density instructions for ARC EM. This option is on by
14299 default for ARC HS.
14300
14301 -mll64
14302 Enable double load/store operations for ARC HS cores.
14303
14304 -mtp-regno=regno
14305 Specify thread pointer register number.
14306
14307 -mmpy-option=multo
14308 Compile ARCv2 code with a multiplier design option. You can
14309 specify the option using either a string or numeric value for
14310 multo. wlh1 is the default value. The recognized values are:
14311
14312 0
14313 none
14314 No multiplier available.
14315
14316 1
14317 w 16x16 multiplier, fully pipelined. The following instructions
14318 are enabled: "mpyw" and "mpyuw".
14319
14320 2
14321 wlh1
14322 32x32 multiplier, fully pipelined (1 stage). The following
14323 instructions are additionally enabled: "mpy", "mpyu", "mpym",
14324 "mpymu", and "mpy_s".
14325
14326 3
14327 wlh2
14328 32x32 multiplier, fully pipelined (2 stages). The following
14329 instructions are additionally enabled: "mpy", "mpyu", "mpym",
14330 "mpymu", and "mpy_s".
14331
14332 4
14333 wlh3
14334 Two 16x16 multipliers, blocking, sequential. The following
14335 instructions are additionally enabled: "mpy", "mpyu", "mpym",
14336 "mpymu", and "mpy_s".
14337
14338 5
14339 wlh4
14340 One 16x16 multiplier, blocking, sequential. The following
14341 instructions are additionally enabled: "mpy", "mpyu", "mpym",
14342 "mpymu", and "mpy_s".
14343
14344 6
14345 wlh5
14346 One 32x4 multiplier, blocking, sequential. The following
14347 instructions are additionally enabled: "mpy", "mpyu", "mpym",
14348 "mpymu", and "mpy_s".
14349
14350 7
14351 plus_dmpy
14352 ARC HS SIMD support.
14353
14354 8
14355 plus_macd
14356 ARC HS SIMD support.
14357
14358 9
14359 plus_qmacw
14360 ARC HS SIMD support.
14361
14362 This option is only available for ARCv2 cores.
14363
14364 -mfpu=fpu
14365 Enables support for specific floating-point hardware extensions for
14366 ARCv2 cores. Supported values for fpu are:
14367
14368 fpus
14369 Enables support for single-precision floating-point hardware
14370 extensions.
14371
14372 fpud
14373 Enables support for double-precision floating-point hardware
14374 extensions. The single-precision floating-point extension is
14375 also enabled. Not available for ARC EM.
14376
14377 fpuda
14378 Enables support for double-precision floating-point hardware
14379 extensions using double-precision assist instructions. The
14380 single-precision floating-point extension is also enabled.
14381 This option is only available for ARC EM.
14382
14383 fpuda_div
14384 Enables support for double-precision floating-point hardware
14385 extensions using double-precision assist instructions. The
14386 single-precision floating-point, square-root, and divide
14387 extensions are also enabled. This option is only available for
14388 ARC EM.
14389
14390 fpuda_fma
14391 Enables support for double-precision floating-point hardware
14392 extensions using double-precision assist instructions. The
14393 single-precision floating-point and fused multiply and add
14394 hardware extensions are also enabled. This option is only
14395 available for ARC EM.
14396
14397 fpuda_all
14398 Enables support for double-precision floating-point hardware
14399 extensions using double-precision assist instructions. All
14400 single-precision floating-point hardware extensions are also
14401 enabled. This option is only available for ARC EM.
14402
14403 fpus_div
14404 Enables support for single-precision floating-point, square-
14405 root and divide hardware extensions.
14406
14407 fpud_div
14408 Enables support for double-precision floating-point, square-
14409 root and divide hardware extensions. This option includes
14410 option fpus_div. Not available for ARC EM.
14411
14412 fpus_fma
14413 Enables support for single-precision floating-point and fused
14414 multiply and add hardware extensions.
14415
14416 fpud_fma
14417 Enables support for double-precision floating-point and fused
14418 multiply and add hardware extensions. This option includes
14419 option fpus_fma. Not available for ARC EM.
14420
14421 fpus_all
14422 Enables support for all single-precision floating-point
14423 hardware extensions.
14424
14425 fpud_all
14426 Enables support for all single- and double-precision floating-
14427 point hardware extensions. Not available for ARC EM.
14428
14429 -mirq-ctrl-saved=register-range, blink, lp_count
14430 Specifies general-purposes registers that the processor
14431 automatically saves/restores on interrupt entry and exit.
14432 register-range is specified as two registers separated by a dash.
14433 The register range always starts with "r0", the upper limit is "fp"
14434 register. blink and lp_count are optional. This option is only
14435 valid for ARC EM and ARC HS cores.
14436
14437 -mrgf-banked-regs=number
14438 Specifies the number of registers replicated in second register
14439 bank on entry to fast interrupt. Fast interrupts are interrupts
14440 with the highest priority level P0. These interrupts save only PC
14441 and STATUS32 registers to avoid memory transactions during
14442 interrupt entry and exit sequences. Use this option when you are
14443 using fast interrupts in an ARC V2 family processor. Permitted
14444 values are 4, 8, 16, and 32.
14445
14446 -mlpc-width=width
14447 Specify the width of the "lp_count" register. Valid values for
14448 width are 8, 16, 20, 24, 28 and 32 bits. The default width is
14449 fixed to 32 bits. If the width is less than 32, the compiler does
14450 not attempt to transform loops in your program to use the zero-
14451 delay loop mechanism unless it is known that the "lp_count"
14452 register can hold the required loop-counter value. Depending on
14453 the width specified, the compiler and run-time library might
14454 continue to use the loop mechanism for various needs. This option
14455 defines macro "__ARC_LPC_WIDTH__" with the value of width.
14456
14457 -mrf16
14458 This option instructs the compiler to generate code for a 16-entry
14459 register file. This option defines the "__ARC_RF16__" preprocessor
14460 macro.
14461
14462 -mbranch-index
14463 Enable use of "bi" or "bih" instructions to implement jump tables.
14464
14465 The following options are passed through to the assembler, and also
14466 define preprocessor macro symbols.
14467
14468 -mdsp-packa
14469 Passed down to the assembler to enable the DSP Pack A extensions.
14470 Also sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xdsp_packa". This option is
14471 deprecated.
14472
14473 -mdvbf
14474 Passed down to the assembler to enable the dual Viterbi butterfly
14475 extension. Also sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xdvbf". This
14476 option is deprecated.
14477
14478 -mlock
14479 Passed down to the assembler to enable the locked load/store
14480 conditional extension. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14481 "__Xlock".
14482
14483 -mmac-d16
14484 Passed down to the assembler. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14485 "__Xxmac_d16". This option is deprecated.
14486
14487 -mmac-24
14488 Passed down to the assembler. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14489 "__Xxmac_24". This option is deprecated.
14490
14491 -mrtsc
14492 Passed down to the assembler to enable the 64-bit time-stamp
14493 counter extension instruction. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14494 "__Xrtsc". This option is deprecated.
14495
14496 -mswape
14497 Passed down to the assembler to enable the swap byte ordering
14498 extension instruction. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14499 "__Xswape".
14500
14501 -mtelephony
14502 Passed down to the assembler to enable dual- and single-operand
14503 instructions for telephony. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
14504 "__Xtelephony". This option is deprecated.
14505
14506 -mxy
14507 Passed down to the assembler to enable the XY memory extension.
14508 Also sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xxy".
14509
14510 The following options control how the assembly code is annotated:
14511
14512 -misize
14513 Annotate assembler instructions with estimated addresses.
14514
14515 -mannotate-align
14516 Explain what alignment considerations lead to the decision to make
14517 an instruction short or long.
14518
14519 The following options are passed through to the linker:
14520
14521 -marclinux
14522 Passed through to the linker, to specify use of the "arclinux"
14523 emulation. This option is enabled by default in tool chains built
14524 for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets when
14525 profiling is not requested.
14526
14527 -marclinux_prof
14528 Passed through to the linker, to specify use of the "arclinux_prof"
14529 emulation. This option is enabled by default in tool chains built
14530 for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets when
14531 profiling is requested.
14532
14533 The following options control the semantics of generated code:
14534
14535 -mlong-calls
14536 Generate calls as register indirect calls, thus providing access to
14537 the full 32-bit address range.
14538
14539 -mmedium-calls
14540 Don't use less than 25-bit addressing range for calls, which is the
14541 offset available for an unconditional branch-and-link instruction.
14542 Conditional execution of function calls is suppressed, to allow use
14543 of the 25-bit range, rather than the 21-bit range with conditional
14544 branch-and-link. This is the default for tool chains built for
14545 "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets.
14546
14547 -G num
14548 Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
14549 if that data is no bigger than num bytes. The default value of num
14550 is 4 for any ARC configuration, or 8 when we have double load/store
14551 operations.
14552
14553 -mno-sdata
14554 Do not generate sdata references. This is the default for tool
14555 chains built for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc"
14556 targets.
14557
14558 -mvolatile-cache
14559 Use ordinarily cached memory accesses for volatile references.
14560 This is the default.
14561
14562 -mno-volatile-cache
14563 Enable cache bypass for volatile references.
14564
14565 The following options fine tune code generation:
14566
14567 -malign-call
14568 Do alignment optimizations for call instructions.
14569
14570 -mauto-modify-reg
14571 Enable the use of pre/post modify with register displacement.
14572
14573 -mbbit-peephole
14574 Enable bbit peephole2.
14575
14576 -mno-brcc
14577 This option disables a target-specific pass in arc_reorg to
14578 generate compare-and-branch ("brcc") instructions. It has no
14579 effect on generation of these instructions driven by the combiner
14580 pass.
14581
14582 -mcase-vector-pcrel
14583 Use PC-relative switch case tables to enable case table shortening.
14584 This is the default for -Os.
14585
14586 -mcompact-casesi
14587 Enable compact "casesi" pattern. This is the default for -Os, and
14588 only available for ARCv1 cores. This option is deprecated.
14589
14590 -mno-cond-exec
14591 Disable the ARCompact-specific pass to generate conditional
14592 execution instructions.
14593
14594 Due to delay slot scheduling and interactions between operand
14595 numbers, literal sizes, instruction lengths, and the support for
14596 conditional execution, the target-independent pass to generate
14597 conditional execution is often lacking, so the ARC port has kept a
14598 special pass around that tries to find more conditional execution
14599 generation opportunities after register allocation, branch
14600 shortening, and delay slot scheduling have been done. This pass
14601 generally, but not always, improves performance and code size, at
14602 the cost of extra compilation time, which is why there is an option
14603 to switch it off. If you have a problem with call instructions
14604 exceeding their allowable offset range because they are
14605 conditionalized, you should consider using -mmedium-calls instead.
14606
14607 -mearly-cbranchsi
14608 Enable pre-reload use of the "cbranchsi" pattern.
14609
14610 -mexpand-adddi
14611 Expand "adddi3" and "subdi3" at RTL generation time into "add.f",
14612 "adc" etc. This option is deprecated.
14613
14614 -mindexed-loads
14615 Enable the use of indexed loads. This can be problematic because
14616 some optimizers then assume that indexed stores exist, which is not
14617 the case.
14618
14619 -mlra
14620 Enable Local Register Allocation. This is still experimental for
14621 ARC, so by default the compiler uses standard reload (i.e.
14622 -mno-lra).
14623
14624 -mlra-priority-none
14625 Don't indicate any priority for target registers.
14626
14627 -mlra-priority-compact
14628 Indicate target register priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.
14629
14630 -mlra-priority-noncompact
14631 Reduce target register priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.
14632
14633 -mmillicode
14634 When optimizing for size (using -Os), prologues and epilogues that
14635 have to save or restore a large number of registers are often
14636 shortened by using call to a special function in libgcc; this is
14637 referred to as a millicode call. As these calls can pose
14638 performance issues, and/or cause linking issues when linking in a
14639 nonstandard way, this option is provided to turn on or off
14640 millicode call generation.
14641
14642 -mcode-density-frame
14643 This option enable the compiler to emit "enter" and "leave"
14644 instructions. These instructions are only valid for CPUs with
14645 code-density feature.
14646
14647 -mmixed-code
14648 Tweak register allocation to help 16-bit instruction generation.
14649 This generally has the effect of decreasing the average instruction
14650 size while increasing the instruction count.
14651
14652 -mq-class
14653 Enable q instruction alternatives. This is the default for -Os.
14654
14655 -mRcq
14656 Enable Rcq constraint handling. Most short code generation depends
14657 on this. This is the default.
14658
14659 -mRcw
14660 Enable Rcw constraint handling. Most ccfsm condexec mostly depends
14661 on this. This is the default.
14662
14663 -msize-level=level
14664 Fine-tune size optimization with regards to instruction lengths and
14665 alignment. The recognized values for level are:
14666
14667 0 No size optimization. This level is deprecated and treated
14668 like 1.
14669
14670 1 Short instructions are used opportunistically.
14671
14672 2 In addition, alignment of loops and of code after barriers are
14673 dropped.
14674
14675 3 In addition, optional data alignment is dropped, and the option
14676 Os is enabled.
14677
14678 This defaults to 3 when -Os is in effect. Otherwise, the behavior
14679 when this is not set is equivalent to level 1.
14680
14681 -mtune=cpu
14682 Set instruction scheduling parameters for cpu, overriding any
14683 implied by -mcpu=.
14684
14685 Supported values for cpu are
14686
14687 ARC600
14688 Tune for ARC600 CPU.
14689
14690 ARC601
14691 Tune for ARC601 CPU.
14692
14693 ARC700
14694 Tune for ARC700 CPU with standard multiplier block.
14695
14696 ARC700-xmac
14697 Tune for ARC700 CPU with XMAC block.
14698
14699 ARC725D
14700 Tune for ARC725D CPU.
14701
14702 ARC750D
14703 Tune for ARC750D CPU.
14704
14705 -mmultcost=num
14706 Cost to assume for a multiply instruction, with 4 being equal to a
14707 normal instruction.
14708
14709 -munalign-prob-threshold=probability
14710 Set probability threshold for unaligning branches. When tuning for
14711 ARC700 and optimizing for speed, branches without filled delay slot
14712 are preferably emitted unaligned and long, unless profiling
14713 indicates that the probability for the branch to be taken is below
14714 probability. The default is (REG_BR_PROB_BASE/2), i.e. 5000.
14715
14716 The following options are maintained for backward compatibility, but
14717 are now deprecated and will be removed in a future release:
14718
14719 -margonaut
14720 Obsolete FPX.
14721
14722 -mbig-endian
14723 -EB Compile code for big-endian targets. Use of these options is now
14724 deprecated. Big-endian code is supported by configuring GCC to
14725 build "arceb-elf32" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets, for which big
14726 endian is the default.
14727
14728 -mlittle-endian
14729 -EL Compile code for little-endian targets. Use of these options is
14730 now deprecated. Little-endian code is supported by configuring GCC
14731 to build "arc-elf32" and "arc-linux-uclibc" targets, for which
14732 little endian is the default.
14733
14734 -mbarrel_shifter
14735 Replaced by -mbarrel-shifter.
14736
14737 -mdpfp_compact
14738 Replaced by -mdpfp-compact.
14739
14740 -mdpfp_fast
14741 Replaced by -mdpfp-fast.
14742
14743 -mdsp_packa
14744 Replaced by -mdsp-packa.
14745
14746 -mEA
14747 Replaced by -mea.
14748
14749 -mmac_24
14750 Replaced by -mmac-24.
14751
14752 -mmac_d16
14753 Replaced by -mmac-d16.
14754
14755 -mspfp_compact
14756 Replaced by -mspfp-compact.
14757
14758 -mspfp_fast
14759 Replaced by -mspfp-fast.
14760
14761 -mtune=cpu
14762 Values arc600, arc601, arc700 and arc700-xmac for cpu are replaced
14763 by ARC600, ARC601, ARC700 and ARC700-xmac respectively.
14764
14765 -multcost=num
14766 Replaced by -mmultcost.
14767
14768 ARM Options
14769
14770 These -m options are defined for the ARM port:
14771
14772 -mabi=name
14773 Generate code for the specified ABI. Permissible values are: apcs-
14774 gnu, atpcs, aapcs, aapcs-linux and iwmmxt.
14775
14776 -mapcs-frame
14777 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure
14778 Call Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly
14779 necessary for correct execution of the code. Specifying
14780 -fomit-frame-pointer with this option causes the stack frames not
14781 to be generated for leaf functions. The default is
14782 -mno-apcs-frame. This option is deprecated.
14783
14784 -mapcs
14785 This is a synonym for -mapcs-frame and is deprecated.
14786
14787 -mthumb-interwork
14788 Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
14789 instruction sets. Without this option, on pre-v5 architectures,
14790 the two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside one
14791 program. The default is -mno-thumb-interwork, since slightly
14792 larger code is generated when -mthumb-interwork is specified. In
14793 AAPCS configurations this option is meaningless.
14794
14795 -mno-sched-prolog
14796 Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or
14797 the merging of those instruction with the instructions in the
14798 function's body. This means that all functions start with a
14799 recognizable set of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a
14800 small set of different function prologues), and this information
14801 can be used to locate the start of functions inside an executable
14802 piece of code. The default is -msched-prolog.
14803
14804 -mfloat-abi=name
14805 Specifies which floating-point ABI to use. Permissible values are:
14806 soft, softfp and hard.
14807
14808 Specifying soft causes GCC to generate output containing library
14809 calls for floating-point operations. softfp allows the generation
14810 of code using hardware floating-point instructions, but still uses
14811 the soft-float calling conventions. hard allows generation of
14812 floating-point instructions and uses FPU-specific calling
14813 conventions.
14814
14815 The default depends on the specific target configuration. Note
14816 that the hard-float and soft-float ABIs are not link-compatible;
14817 you must compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link
14818 with a compatible set of libraries.
14819
14820 -mgeneral-regs-only
14821 Generate code which uses only the general-purpose registers. This
14822 will prevent the compiler from using floating-point and Advanced
14823 SIMD registers but will not impose any restrictions on the
14824 assembler.
14825
14826 -mlittle-endian
14827 Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode. This
14828 is the default for all standard configurations.
14829
14830 -mbig-endian
14831 Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the
14832 default is to compile code for a little-endian processor.
14833
14834 -mbe8
14835 -mbe32
14836 When linking a big-endian image select between BE8 and BE32
14837 formats. The option has no effect for little-endian images and is
14838 ignored. The default is dependent on the selected target
14839 architecture. For ARMv6 and later architectures the default is
14840 BE8, for older architectures the default is BE32. BE32 format has
14841 been deprecated by ARM.
14842
14843 -march=name[+extension...]
14844 This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture. GCC uses
14845 this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when
14846 generating assembly code. This option can be used in conjunction
14847 with or instead of the -mcpu= option.
14848
14849 Permissible names are: armv4t, armv5t, armv5te, armv6, armv6j,
14850 armv6k, armv6kz, armv6t2, armv6z, armv6zk, armv7, armv7-a, armv7ve,
14851 armv8-a, armv8.1-a, armv8.2-a, armv8.3-a, armv8.4-a, armv8.5-a,
14852 armv7-r, armv8-r, armv6-m, armv6s-m, armv7-m, armv7e-m,
14853 armv8-m.base, armv8-m.main, iwmmxt and iwmmxt2.
14854
14855 Additionally, the following architectures, which lack support for
14856 the Thumb execution state, are recognized but support is
14857 deprecated: armv4.
14858
14859 Many of the architectures support extensions. These can be added
14860 by appending +extension to the architecture name. Extension
14861 options are processed in order and capabilities accumulate. An
14862 extension will also enable any necessary base extensions upon which
14863 it depends. For example, the +crypto extension will always enable
14864 the +simd extension. The exception to the additive construction is
14865 for extensions that are prefixed with +no...: these extensions
14866 disable the specified option and any other extensions that may
14867 depend on the presence of that extension.
14868
14869 For example, -march=armv7-a+simd+nofp+vfpv4 is equivalent to
14870 writing -march=armv7-a+vfpv4 since the +simd option is entirely
14871 disabled by the +nofp option that follows it.
14872
14873 Most extension names are generically named, but have an effect that
14874 is dependent upon the architecture to which it is applied. For
14875 example, the +simd option can be applied to both armv7-a and
14876 armv8-a architectures, but will enable the original ARMv7-A
14877 Advanced SIMD (Neon) extensions for armv7-a and the ARMv8-A variant
14878 for armv8-a.
14879
14880 The table below lists the supported extensions for each
14881 architecture. Architectures not mentioned do not support any
14882 extensions.
14883
14884 armv5te
14885 armv6
14886 armv6j
14887 armv6k
14888 armv6kz
14889 armv6t2
14890 armv6z
14891 armv6zk
14892 +fp The VFPv2 floating-point instructions. The extension
14893 +vfpv2 can be used as an alias for this extension.
14894
14895 +nofp
14896 Disable the floating-point instructions.
14897
14898 armv7
14899 The common subset of the ARMv7-A, ARMv7-R and ARMv7-M
14900 architectures.
14901
14902 +fp The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14903 precision registers. The extension +vfpv3-d16 can be used
14904 as an alias for this extension. Note that floating-point
14905 is not supported by the base ARMv7-M architecture, but is
14906 compatible with both the ARMv7-A and ARMv7-R architectures.
14907
14908 +nofp
14909 Disable the floating-point instructions.
14910
14911 armv7-a
14912 +mp The multiprocessing extension.
14913
14914 +sec
14915 The security extension.
14916
14917 +fp The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14918 precision registers. The extension +vfpv3-d16 can be used
14919 as an alias for this extension.
14920
14921 +simd
14922 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v1 and the VFPv3 floating-point
14923 instructions. The extensions +neon and +neon-vfpv3 can be
14924 used as aliases for this extension.
14925
14926 +vfpv3
14927 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
14928 precision registers.
14929
14930 +vfpv3-d16-fp16
14931 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14932 precision registers and the half-precision floating-point
14933 conversion operations.
14934
14935 +vfpv3-fp16
14936 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
14937 precision registers and the half-precision floating-point
14938 conversion operations.
14939
14940 +vfpv4-d16
14941 The VFPv4 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14942 precision registers.
14943
14944 +vfpv4
14945 The VFPv4 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
14946 precision registers.
14947
14948 +neon-fp16
14949 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v1 and the VFPv3 floating-point
14950 instructions, with the half-precision floating-point
14951 conversion operations.
14952
14953 +neon-vfpv4
14954 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v2 and the VFPv4 floating-point
14955 instructions.
14956
14957 +nosimd
14958 Disable the Advanced SIMD instructions (does not disable
14959 floating point).
14960
14961 +nofp
14962 Disable the floating-point and Advanced SIMD instructions.
14963
14964 armv7ve
14965 The extended version of the ARMv7-A architecture with support
14966 for virtualization.
14967
14968 +fp The VFPv4 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14969 precision registers. The extension +vfpv4-d16 can be used
14970 as an alias for this extension.
14971
14972 +simd
14973 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v2 and the VFPv4 floating-point
14974 instructions. The extension +neon-vfpv4 can be used as an
14975 alias for this extension.
14976
14977 +vfpv3-d16
14978 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14979 precision registers.
14980
14981 +vfpv3
14982 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
14983 precision registers.
14984
14985 +vfpv3-d16-fp16
14986 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14987 precision registers and the half-precision floating-point
14988 conversion operations.
14989
14990 +vfpv3-fp16
14991 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
14992 precision registers and the half-precision floating-point
14993 conversion operations.
14994
14995 +vfpv4-d16
14996 The VFPv4 floating-point instructions, with 16 double-
14997 precision registers.
14998
14999 +vfpv4
15000 The VFPv4 floating-point instructions, with 32 double-
15001 precision registers.
15002
15003 +neon
15004 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v1 and the VFPv3 floating-point
15005 instructions. The extension +neon-vfpv3 can be used as an
15006 alias for this extension.
15007
15008 +neon-fp16
15009 The Advanced SIMD (Neon) v1 and the VFPv3 floating-point
15010 instructions, with the half-precision floating-point
15011 conversion operations.
15012
15013 +nosimd
15014 Disable the Advanced SIMD instructions (does not disable
15015 floating point).
15016
15017 +nofp
15018 Disable the floating-point and Advanced SIMD instructions.
15019
15020 armv8-a
15021 +crc
15022 The Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) instructions.
15023
15024 +simd
15025 The ARMv8-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
15026
15027 +crypto
15028 The cryptographic instructions.
15029
15030 +nocrypto
15031 Disable the cryptographic instructions.
15032
15033 +nofp
15034 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15035 instructions.
15036
15037 +sb Speculation Barrier Instruction.
15038
15039 +predres
15040 Execution and Data Prediction Restriction Instructions.
15041
15042 armv8.1-a
15043 +simd
15044 The ARMv8.1-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point
15045 instructions.
15046
15047 +crypto
15048 The cryptographic instructions. This also enables the
15049 Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
15050
15051 +nocrypto
15052 Disable the cryptographic instructions.
15053
15054 +nofp
15055 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15056 instructions.
15057
15058 +sb Speculation Barrier Instruction.
15059
15060 +predres
15061 Execution and Data Prediction Restriction Instructions.
15062
15063 armv8.2-a
15064 armv8.3-a
15065 +fp16
15066 The half-precision floating-point data processing
15067 instructions. This also enables the Advanced SIMD and
15068 floating-point instructions.
15069
15070 +fp16fml
15071 The half-precision floating-point fmla extension. This
15072 also enables the half-precision floating-point extension
15073 and Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
15074
15075 +simd
15076 The ARMv8.1-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point
15077 instructions.
15078
15079 +crypto
15080 The cryptographic instructions. This also enables the
15081 Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
15082
15083 +dotprod
15084 Enable the Dot Product extension. This also enables
15085 Advanced SIMD instructions.
15086
15087 +nocrypto
15088 Disable the cryptographic extension.
15089
15090 +nofp
15091 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15092 instructions.
15093
15094 +sb Speculation Barrier Instruction.
15095
15096 +predres
15097 Execution and Data Prediction Restriction Instructions.
15098
15099 armv8.4-a
15100 +fp16
15101 The half-precision floating-point data processing
15102 instructions. This also enables the Advanced SIMD and
15103 floating-point instructions as well as the Dot Product
15104 extension and the half-precision floating-point fmla
15105 extension.
15106
15107 +simd
15108 The ARMv8.3-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions
15109 as well as the Dot Product extension.
15110
15111 +crypto
15112 The cryptographic instructions. This also enables the
15113 Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions as well as
15114 the Dot Product extension.
15115
15116 +nocrypto
15117 Disable the cryptographic extension.
15118
15119 +nofp
15120 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15121 instructions.
15122
15123 +sb Speculation Barrier Instruction.
15124
15125 +predres
15126 Execution and Data Prediction Restriction Instructions.
15127
15128 armv8.5-a
15129 +fp16
15130 The half-precision floating-point data processing
15131 instructions. This also enables the Advanced SIMD and
15132 floating-point instructions as well as the Dot Product
15133 extension and the half-precision floating-point fmla
15134 extension.
15135
15136 +simd
15137 The ARMv8.3-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions
15138 as well as the Dot Product extension.
15139
15140 +crypto
15141 The cryptographic instructions. This also enables the
15142 Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions as well as
15143 the Dot Product extension.
15144
15145 +nocrypto
15146 Disable the cryptographic extension.
15147
15148 +nofp
15149 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15150 instructions.
15151
15152 armv7-r
15153 +fp.sp
15154 The single-precision VFPv3 floating-point instructions.
15155 The extension +vfpv3xd can be used as an alias for this
15156 extension.
15157
15158 +fp The VFPv3 floating-point instructions with 16 double-
15159 precision registers. The extension +vfpv3-d16 can be used
15160 as an alias for this extension.
15161
15162 +vfpv3xd-d16-fp16
15163 The single-precision VFPv3 floating-point instructions with
15164 16 double-precision registers and the half-precision
15165 floating-point conversion operations.
15166
15167 +vfpv3-d16-fp16
15168 The VFPv3 floating-point instructions with 16 double-
15169 precision registers and the half-precision floating-point
15170 conversion operations.
15171
15172 +nofp
15173 Disable the floating-point extension.
15174
15175 +idiv
15176 The ARM-state integer division instructions.
15177
15178 +noidiv
15179 Disable the ARM-state integer division extension.
15180
15181 armv7e-m
15182 +fp The single-precision VFPv4 floating-point instructions.
15183
15184 +fpv5
15185 The single-precision FPv5 floating-point instructions.
15186
15187 +fp.dp
15188 The single- and double-precision FPv5 floating-point
15189 instructions.
15190
15191 +nofp
15192 Disable the floating-point extensions.
15193
15194 armv8-m.main
15195 +dsp
15196 The DSP instructions.
15197
15198 +nodsp
15199 Disable the DSP extension.
15200
15201 +fp The single-precision floating-point instructions.
15202
15203 +fp.dp
15204 The single- and double-precision floating-point
15205 instructions.
15206
15207 +nofp
15208 Disable the floating-point extension.
15209
15210 armv8-r
15211 +crc
15212 The Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) instructions.
15213
15214 +fp.sp
15215 The single-precision FPv5 floating-point instructions.
15216
15217 +simd
15218 The ARMv8-A Advanced SIMD and floating-point instructions.
15219
15220 +crypto
15221 The cryptographic instructions.
15222
15223 +nocrypto
15224 Disable the cryptographic instructions.
15225
15226 +nofp
15227 Disable the floating-point, Advanced SIMD and cryptographic
15228 instructions.
15229
15230 -march=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture
15231 of the build computer. At present, this feature is only supported
15232 on GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the
15233 auto-detect is unsuccessful the option has no effect.
15234
15235 -mtune=name
15236 This option specifies the name of the target ARM processor for
15237 which GCC should tune the performance of the code. For some ARM
15238 implementations better performance can be obtained by using this
15239 option. Permissible names are: arm7tdmi, arm7tdmi-s, arm710t,
15240 arm720t, arm740t, strongarm, strongarm110, strongarm1100,
15241 0strongarm1110, arm8, arm810, arm9, arm9e, arm920, arm920t,
15242 arm922t, arm946e-s, arm966e-s, arm968e-s, arm926ej-s, arm940t,
15243 arm9tdmi, arm10tdmi, arm1020t, arm1026ej-s, arm10e, arm1020e,
15244 arm1022e, arm1136j-s, arm1136jf-s, mpcore, mpcorenovfp,
15245 arm1156t2-s, arm1156t2f-s, arm1176jz-s, arm1176jzf-s,
15246 generic-armv7-a, cortex-a5, cortex-a7, cortex-a8, cortex-a9,
15247 cortex-a12, cortex-a15, cortex-a17, cortex-a32, cortex-a35,
15248 cortex-a53, cortex-a55, cortex-a57, cortex-a72, cortex-a73,
15249 cortex-a75, cortex-a76, ares, cortex-r4, cortex-r4f, cortex-r5,
15250 cortex-r7, cortex-r8, cortex-r52, cortex-m0, cortex-m0plus,
15251 cortex-m1, cortex-m3, cortex-m4, cortex-m7, cortex-m23, cortex-m33,
15252 cortex-m1.small-multiply, cortex-m0.small-multiply,
15253 cortex-m0plus.small-multiply, exynos-m1, marvell-pj4, neoverse-n1,
15254 xscale, iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312, fa526, fa626, fa606te, fa626te,
15255 fmp626, fa726te, xgene1.
15256
15257 Additionally, this option can specify that GCC should tune the
15258 performance of the code for a big.LITTLE system. Permissible names
15259 are: cortex-a15.cortex-a7, cortex-a17.cortex-a7,
15260 cortex-a57.cortex-a53, cortex-a72.cortex-a53,
15261 cortex-a72.cortex-a35, cortex-a73.cortex-a53,
15262 cortex-a75.cortex-a55, cortex-a76.cortex-a55.
15263
15264 -mtune=generic-arch specifies that GCC should tune the performance
15265 for a blend of processors within architecture arch. The aim is to
15266 generate code that run well on the current most popular processors,
15267 balancing between optimizations that benefit some CPUs in the
15268 range, and avoiding performance pitfalls of other CPUs. The
15269 effects of this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU
15270 models come and go.
15271
15272 -mtune permits the same extension options as -mcpu, but the
15273 extension options do not affect the tuning of the generated code.
15274
15275 -mtune=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU of the
15276 build computer. At present, this feature is only supported on
15277 GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the auto-
15278 detect is unsuccessful the option has no effect.
15279
15280 -mcpu=name[+extension...]
15281 This specifies the name of the target ARM processor. GCC uses this
15282 name to derive the name of the target ARM architecture (as if
15283 specified by -march) and the ARM processor type for which to tune
15284 for performance (as if specified by -mtune). Where this option is
15285 used in conjunction with -march or -mtune, those options take
15286 precedence over the appropriate part of this option.
15287
15288 Many of the supported CPUs implement optional architectural
15289 extensions. Where this is so the architectural extensions are
15290 normally enabled by default. If implementations that lack the
15291 extension exist, then the extension syntax can be used to disable
15292 those extensions that have been omitted. For floating-point and
15293 Advanced SIMD (Neon) instructions, the settings of the options
15294 -mfloat-abi and -mfpu must also be considered: floating-point and
15295 Advanced SIMD instructions will only be used if -mfloat-abi is not
15296 set to soft; and any setting of -mfpu other than auto will override
15297 the available floating-point and SIMD extension instructions.
15298
15299 For example, cortex-a9 can be found in three major configurations:
15300 integer only, with just a floating-point unit or with floating-
15301 point and Advanced SIMD. The default is to enable all the
15302 instructions, but the extensions +nosimd and +nofp can be used to
15303 disable just the SIMD or both the SIMD and floating-point
15304 instructions respectively.
15305
15306 Permissible names for this option are the same as those for -mtune.
15307
15308 The following extension options are common to the listed CPUs:
15309
15310 +nodsp
15311 Disable the DSP instructions on cortex-m33.
15312
15313 +nofp
15314 Disables the floating-point instructions on arm9e, arm946e-s,
15315 arm966e-s, arm968e-s, arm10e, arm1020e, arm1022e, arm926ej-s,
15316 arm1026ej-s, cortex-r5, cortex-r7, cortex-r8, cortex-m4,
15317 cortex-m7 and cortex-m33. Disables the floating-point and SIMD
15318 instructions on generic-armv7-a, cortex-a5, cortex-a7,
15319 cortex-a8, cortex-a9, cortex-a12, cortex-a15, cortex-a17,
15320 cortex-a15.cortex-a7, cortex-a17.cortex-a7, cortex-a32,
15321 cortex-a35, cortex-a53 and cortex-a55.
15322
15323 +nofp.dp
15324 Disables the double-precision component of the floating-point
15325 instructions on cortex-r5, cortex-r7, cortex-r8, cortex-r52 and
15326 cortex-m7.
15327
15328 +nosimd
15329 Disables the SIMD (but not floating-point) instructions on
15330 generic-armv7-a, cortex-a5, cortex-a7 and cortex-a9.
15331
15332 +crypto
15333 Enables the cryptographic instructions on cortex-a32,
15334 cortex-a35, cortex-a53, cortex-a55, cortex-a57, cortex-a72,
15335 cortex-a73, cortex-a75, exynos-m1, xgene1,
15336 cortex-a57.cortex-a53, cortex-a72.cortex-a53,
15337 cortex-a73.cortex-a35, cortex-a73.cortex-a53 and
15338 cortex-a75.cortex-a55.
15339
15340 Additionally the generic-armv7-a pseudo target defaults to VFPv3
15341 with 16 double-precision registers. It supports the following
15342 extension options: mp, sec, vfpv3-d16, vfpv3, vfpv3-d16-fp16,
15343 vfpv3-fp16, vfpv4-d16, vfpv4, neon, neon-vfpv3, neon-fp16,
15344 neon-vfpv4. The meanings are the same as for the extensions to
15345 -march=armv7-a.
15346
15347 -mcpu=generic-arch is also permissible, and is equivalent to
15348 -march=arch -mtune=generic-arch. See -mtune for more information.
15349
15350 -mcpu=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU of the
15351 build computer. At present, this feature is only supported on
15352 GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the auto-
15353 detect is unsuccessful the option has no effect.
15354
15355 -mfpu=name
15356 This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware emulation)
15357 is available on the target. Permissible names are: auto, vfpv2,
15358 vfpv3, vfpv3-fp16, vfpv3-d16, vfpv3-d16-fp16, vfpv3xd,
15359 vfpv3xd-fp16, neon-vfpv3, neon-fp16, vfpv4, vfpv4-d16, fpv4-sp-d16,
15360 neon-vfpv4, fpv5-d16, fpv5-sp-d16, fp-armv8, neon-fp-armv8 and
15361 crypto-neon-fp-armv8. Note that neon is an alias for neon-vfpv3
15362 and vfp is an alias for vfpv2.
15363
15364 The setting auto is the default and is special. It causes the
15365 compiler to select the floating-point and Advanced SIMD
15366 instructions based on the settings of -mcpu and -march.
15367
15368 If the selected floating-point hardware includes the NEON extension
15369 (e.g. -mfpu=neon), note that floating-point operations are not
15370 generated by GCC's auto-vectorization pass unless
15371 -funsafe-math-optimizations is also specified. This is because
15372 NEON hardware does not fully implement the IEEE 754 standard for
15373 floating-point arithmetic (in particular denormal values are
15374 treated as zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a
15375 loss of precision.
15376
15377 You can also set the fpu name at function level by using the
15378 "target("fpu=")" function attributes or pragmas.
15379
15380 -mfp16-format=name
15381 Specify the format of the "__fp16" half-precision floating-point
15382 type. Permissible names are none, ieee, and alternative; the
15383 default is none, in which case the "__fp16" type is not defined.
15384
15385 -mstructure-size-boundary=n
15386 The sizes of all structures and unions are rounded up to a multiple
15387 of the number of bits set by this option. Permissible values are
15388 8, 32 and 64. The default value varies for different toolchains.
15389 For the COFF targeted toolchain the default value is 8. A value of
15390 64 is only allowed if the underlying ABI supports it.
15391
15392 Specifying a larger number can produce faster, more efficient code,
15393 but can also increase the size of the program. Different values
15394 are potentially incompatible. Code compiled with one value cannot
15395 necessarily expect to work with code or libraries compiled with
15396 another value, if they exchange information using structures or
15397 unions.
15398
15399 This option is deprecated.
15400
15401 -mabort-on-noreturn
15402 Generate a call to the function "abort" at the end of a "noreturn"
15403 function. It is executed if the function tries to return.
15404
15405 -mlong-calls
15406 -mno-long-calls
15407 Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
15408 address of the function into a register and then performing a
15409 subroutine call on this register. This switch is needed if the
15410 target function lies outside of the 64-megabyte addressing range of
15411 the offset-based version of subroutine call instruction.
15412
15413 Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls are turned
15414 into long calls. The heuristic is that static functions, functions
15415 that have the "short_call" attribute, functions that are inside the
15416 scope of a "#pragma no_long_calls" directive, and functions whose
15417 definitions have already been compiled within the current
15418 compilation unit are not turned into long calls. The exceptions to
15419 this rule are that weak function definitions, functions with the
15420 "long_call" attribute or the "section" attribute, and functions
15421 that are within the scope of a "#pragma long_calls" directive are
15422 always turned into long calls.
15423
15424 This feature is not enabled by default. Specifying -mno-long-calls
15425 restores the default behavior, as does placing the function calls
15426 within the scope of a "#pragma long_calls_off" directive. Note
15427 these switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to
15428 handle function calls via function pointers.
15429
15430 -msingle-pic-base
15431 Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather
15432 than loading it in the prologue for each function. The runtime
15433 system is responsible for initializing this register with an
15434 appropriate value before execution begins.
15435
15436 -mpic-register=reg
15437 Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing. For standard
15438 PIC base case, the default is any suitable register determined by
15439 compiler. For single PIC base case, the default is R9 if target is
15440 EABI based or stack-checking is enabled, otherwise the default is
15441 R10.
15442
15443 -mpic-data-is-text-relative
15444 Assume that the displacement between the text and data segments is
15445 fixed at static link time. This permits using PC-relative
15446 addressing operations to access data known to be in the data
15447 segment. For non-VxWorks RTP targets, this option is enabled by
15448 default. When disabled on such targets, it will enable
15449 -msingle-pic-base by default.
15450
15451 -mpoke-function-name
15452 Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
15453 preceding the function prologue. The generated code is similar to
15454 this:
15455
15456 t0
15457 .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
15458 .align
15459 t1
15460 .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
15461 arm_poke_function_name
15462 mov ip, sp
15463 stmfd sp!, {fp, ip, lr, pc}
15464 sub fp, ip, #4
15465
15466 When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
15467 "pc" stored at "fp + 0". If the trace function then looks at
15468 location "pc - 12" and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
15469 there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this
15470 location and has length "((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)".
15471
15472 -mthumb
15473 -marm
15474 Select between generating code that executes in ARM and Thumb
15475 states. The default for most configurations is to generate code
15476 that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
15477 configuring GCC with the --with-mode=state configure option.
15478
15479 You can also override the ARM and Thumb mode for each function by
15480 using the "target("thumb")" and "target("arm")" function attributes
15481 or pragmas.
15482
15483 -mflip-thumb
15484 Switch ARM/Thumb modes on alternating functions. This option is
15485 provided for regression testing of mixed Thumb/ARM code generation,
15486 and is not intended for ordinary use in compiling code.
15487
15488 -mtpcs-frame
15489 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure
15490 Call Standard for all non-leaf functions. (A leaf function is one
15491 that does not call any other functions.) The default is
15492 -mno-tpcs-frame.
15493
15494 -mtpcs-leaf-frame
15495 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure
15496 Call Standard for all leaf functions. (A leaf function is one that
15497 does not call any other functions.) The default is
15498 -mno-apcs-leaf-frame.
15499
15500 -mcallee-super-interworking
15501 Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled
15502 an ARM instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before
15503 executing the rest of the function. This allows these functions to
15504 be called from non-interworking code. This option is not valid in
15505 AAPCS configurations because interworking is enabled by default.
15506
15507 -mcaller-super-interworking
15508 Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
15509 execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
15510 compiled for interworking or not. There is a small overhead in the
15511 cost of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.
15512 This option is not valid in AAPCS configurations because
15513 interworking is enabled by default.
15514
15515 -mtp=name
15516 Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer. The
15517 valid models are soft, which generates calls to "__aeabi_read_tp",
15518 cp15, which fetches the thread pointer from "cp15" directly
15519 (supported in the arm6k architecture), and auto, which uses the
15520 best available method for the selected processor. The default
15521 setting is auto.
15522
15523 -mtls-dialect=dialect
15524 Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage. Two
15525 dialects are supported---gnu and gnu2. The gnu dialect selects the
15526 original GNU scheme for supporting local and global dynamic TLS
15527 models. The gnu2 dialect selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which
15528 provides better performance for shared libraries. The GNU
15529 descriptor scheme is compatible with the original scheme, but does
15530 require new assembler, linker and library support. Initial and
15531 local exec TLS models are unaffected by this option and always use
15532 the original scheme.
15533
15534 -mword-relocations
15535 Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values (i.e.
15536 R_ARM_ABS32). This is enabled by default on targets (uClinux,
15537 SymbianOS) where the runtime loader imposes this restriction, and
15538 when -fpic or -fPIC is specified. This option conflicts with
15539 -mslow-flash-data.
15540
15541 -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
15542 Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when "ldrd"
15543 instructions with overlapping destination and base registers are
15544 used. This option avoids generating these instructions. This
15545 option is enabled by default when -mcpu=cortex-m3 is specified.
15546
15547 -munaligned-access
15548 -mno-unaligned-access
15549 Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values
15550 from addresses that are not 16- or 32- bit aligned. By default
15551 unaligned access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6, all ARMv6-M and for
15552 ARMv8-M Baseline architectures, and enabled for all other
15553 architectures. If unaligned access is not enabled then words in
15554 packed data structures are accessed a byte at a time.
15555
15556 The ARM attribute "Tag_CPU_unaligned_access" is set in the
15557 generated object file to either true or false, depending upon the
15558 setting of this option. If unaligned access is enabled then the
15559 preprocessor symbol "__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED" is also defined.
15560
15561 -mneon-for-64bits
15562 Enables using Neon to handle scalar 64-bits operations. This is
15563 disabled by default since the cost of moving data from core
15564 registers to Neon is high.
15565
15566 -mslow-flash-data
15567 Assume loading data from flash is slower than fetching instruction.
15568 Therefore literal load is minimized for better performance. This
15569 option is only supported when compiling for ARMv7 M-profile and off
15570 by default. It conflicts with -mword-relocations.
15571
15572 -masm-syntax-unified
15573 Assume inline assembler is using unified asm syntax. The default
15574 is currently off which implies divided syntax. This option has no
15575 impact on Thumb2. However, this may change in future releases of
15576 GCC. Divided syntax should be considered deprecated.
15577
15578 -mrestrict-it
15579 Restricts generation of IT blocks to conform to the rules of
15580 ARMv8-A. IT blocks can only contain a single 16-bit instruction
15581 from a select set of instructions. This option is on by default for
15582 ARMv8-A Thumb mode.
15583
15584 -mprint-tune-info
15585 Print CPU tuning information as comment in assembler file. This is
15586 an option used only for regression testing of the compiler and not
15587 intended for ordinary use in compiling code. This option is
15588 disabled by default.
15589
15590 -mverbose-cost-dump
15591 Enable verbose cost model dumping in the debug dump files. This
15592 option is provided for use in debugging the compiler.
15593
15594 -mpure-code
15595 Do not allow constant data to be placed in code sections.
15596 Additionally, when compiling for ELF object format give all text
15597 sections the ELF processor-specific section attribute
15598 "SHF_ARM_PURECODE". This option is only available when generating
15599 non-pic code for M-profile targets with the MOVT instruction.
15600
15601 -mcmse
15602 Generate secure code as per the "ARMv8-M Security Extensions:
15603 Requirements on Development Tools Engineering Specification", which
15604 can be found on
15605 <http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.ecm0359818/ECM0359818_armv8m_security_extensions_reqs_on_dev_tools_1_0.pdf>.
15606
15607 AVR Options
15608
15609 These options are defined for AVR implementations:
15610
15611 -mmcu=mcu
15612 Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.
15613
15614 The default for this option is@tie{}avr2.
15615
15616 GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:
15617
15618 "avr2"
15619 "Classic" devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
15620 mcu@tie{}= "attiny22", "attiny26", "at90c8534", "at90s2313",
15621 "at90s2323", "at90s2333", "at90s2343", "at90s4414",
15622 "at90s4433", "at90s4434", "at90s8515", "at90s8535".
15623
15624 "avr25"
15625 "Classic" devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory and
15626 with the "MOVW" instruction. mcu@tie{}= "ata5272", "ata6616c",
15627 "attiny13", "attiny13a", "attiny2313", "attiny2313a",
15628 "attiny24", "attiny24a", "attiny25", "attiny261", "attiny261a",
15629 "attiny43u", "attiny4313", "attiny44", "attiny44a",
15630 "attiny441", "attiny45", "attiny461", "attiny461a", "attiny48",
15631 "attiny828", "attiny84", "attiny84a", "attiny841", "attiny85",
15632 "attiny861", "attiny861a", "attiny87", "attiny88", "at86rf401".
15633
15634 "avr3"
15635 "Classic" devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of
15636 program memory. mcu@tie{}= "at43usb355", "at76c711".
15637
15638 "avr31"
15639 "Classic" devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
15640 mcu@tie{}= "atmega103", "at43usb320".
15641
15642 "avr35"
15643 "Classic" devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program
15644 memory and with the "MOVW" instruction. mcu@tie{}= "ata5505",
15645 "ata6617c", "ata664251", "atmega16u2", "atmega32u2",
15646 "atmega8u2", "attiny1634", "attiny167", "at90usb162",
15647 "at90usb82".
15648
15649 "avr4"
15650 "Enhanced" devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
15651 mcu@tie{}= "ata6285", "ata6286", "ata6289", "ata6612c",
15652 "atmega48", "atmega48a", "atmega48p", "atmega48pa",
15653 "atmega48pb", "atmega8", "atmega8a", "atmega8hva",
15654 "atmega8515", "atmega8535", "atmega88", "atmega88a",
15655 "atmega88p", "atmega88pa", "atmega88pb", "at90pwm1",
15656 "at90pwm2", "at90pwm2b", "at90pwm3", "at90pwm3b", "at90pwm81".
15657
15658 "avr5"
15659 "Enhanced" devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of
15660 program memory. mcu@tie{}= "ata5702m322", "ata5782",
15661 "ata5790", "ata5790n", "ata5791", "ata5795", "ata5831",
15662 "ata6613c", "ata6614q", "ata8210", "ata8510", "atmega16",
15663 "atmega16a", "atmega16hva", "atmega16hva2", "atmega16hvb",
15664 "atmega16hvbrevb", "atmega16m1", "atmega16u4", "atmega161",
15665 "atmega162", "atmega163", "atmega164a", "atmega164p",
15666 "atmega164pa", "atmega165", "atmega165a", "atmega165p",
15667 "atmega165pa", "atmega168", "atmega168a", "atmega168p",
15668 "atmega168pa", "atmega168pb", "atmega169", "atmega169a",
15669 "atmega169p", "atmega169pa", "atmega32", "atmega32a",
15670 "atmega32c1", "atmega32hvb", "atmega32hvbrevb", "atmega32m1",
15671 "atmega32u4", "atmega32u6", "atmega323", "atmega324a",
15672 "atmega324p", "atmega324pa", "atmega325", "atmega325a",
15673 "atmega325p", "atmega325pa", "atmega3250", "atmega3250a",
15674 "atmega3250p", "atmega3250pa", "atmega328", "atmega328p",
15675 "atmega328pb", "atmega329", "atmega329a", "atmega329p",
15676 "atmega329pa", "atmega3290", "atmega3290a", "atmega3290p",
15677 "atmega3290pa", "atmega406", "atmega64", "atmega64a",
15678 "atmega64c1", "atmega64hve", "atmega64hve2", "atmega64m1",
15679 "atmega64rfr2", "atmega640", "atmega644", "atmega644a",
15680 "atmega644p", "atmega644pa", "atmega644rfr2", "atmega645",
15681 "atmega645a", "atmega645p", "atmega6450", "atmega6450a",
15682 "atmega6450p", "atmega649", "atmega649a", "atmega649p",
15683 "atmega6490", "atmega6490a", "atmega6490p", "at90can32",
15684 "at90can64", "at90pwm161", "at90pwm216", "at90pwm316",
15685 "at90scr100", "at90usb646", "at90usb647", "at94k", "m3000".
15686
15687 "avr51"
15688 "Enhanced" devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
15689 mcu@tie{}= "atmega128", "atmega128a", "atmega128rfa1",
15690 "atmega128rfr2", "atmega1280", "atmega1281", "atmega1284",
15691 "atmega1284p", "atmega1284rfr2", "at90can128", "at90usb1286",
15692 "at90usb1287".
15693
15694 "avr6"
15695 "Enhanced" devices with 3-byte PC, i.e. with more than
15696 128@tie{}KiB of program memory. mcu@tie{}= "atmega256rfr2",
15697 "atmega2560", "atmega2561", "atmega2564rfr2".
15698
15699 "avrxmega2"
15700 "XMEGA" devices with more than 8@tie{}KiB and up to 64@tie{}KiB
15701 of program memory. mcu@tie{}= "atxmega16a4", "atxmega16a4u",
15702 "atxmega16c4", "atxmega16d4", "atxmega16e5", "atxmega32a4",
15703 "atxmega32a4u", "atxmega32c3", "atxmega32c4", "atxmega32d3",
15704 "atxmega32d4", "atxmega32e5", "atxmega8e5".
15705
15706 "avrxmega3"
15707 "XMEGA" devices with up to 64@tie{}KiB of combined program
15708 memory and RAM, and with program memory visible in the RAM
15709 address space. mcu@tie{}= "attiny1614", "attiny1616",
15710 "attiny1617", "attiny212", "attiny214", "attiny3214",
15711 "attiny3216", "attiny3217", "attiny412", "attiny414",
15712 "attiny416", "attiny417", "attiny814", "attiny816",
15713 "attiny817".
15714
15715 "avrxmega4"
15716 "XMEGA" devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to
15717 128@tie{}KiB of program memory. mcu@tie{}= "atxmega64a3",
15718 "atxmega64a3u", "atxmega64a4u", "atxmega64b1", "atxmega64b3",
15719 "atxmega64c3", "atxmega64d3", "atxmega64d4".
15720
15721 "avrxmega5"
15722 "XMEGA" devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to
15723 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and more than 64@tie{}KiB of
15724 RAM. mcu@tie{}= "atxmega64a1", "atxmega64a1u".
15725
15726 "avrxmega6"
15727 "XMEGA" devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
15728 mcu@tie{}= "atxmega128a3", "atxmega128a3u", "atxmega128b1",
15729 "atxmega128b3", "atxmega128c3", "atxmega128d3", "atxmega128d4",
15730 "atxmega192a3", "atxmega192a3u", "atxmega192c3",
15731 "atxmega192d3", "atxmega256a3", "atxmega256a3b",
15732 "atxmega256a3bu", "atxmega256a3u", "atxmega256c3",
15733 "atxmega256d3", "atxmega384c3", "atxmega384d3".
15734
15735 "avrxmega7"
15736 "XMEGA" devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory
15737 and more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM. mcu@tie{}= "atxmega128a1",
15738 "atxmega128a1u", "atxmega128a4u".
15739
15740 "avrtiny"
15741 "TINY" Tiny core devices with 512@tie{}B up to 4@tie{}KiB of
15742 program memory. mcu@tie{}= "attiny10", "attiny20", "attiny4",
15743 "attiny40", "attiny5", "attiny9".
15744
15745 "avr1"
15746 This ISA is implemented by the minimal AVR core and supported
15747 for assembler only. mcu@tie{}= "attiny11", "attiny12",
15748 "attiny15", "attiny28", "at90s1200".
15749
15750 -mabsdata
15751 Assume that all data in static storage can be accessed by LDS / STS
15752 instructions. This option has only an effect on reduced Tiny
15753 devices like ATtiny40. See also the "absdata" AVR Variable
15754 Attributes,variable attribute.
15755
15756 -maccumulate-args
15757 Accumulate outgoing function arguments and acquire/release the
15758 needed stack space for outgoing function arguments once in function
15759 prologue/epilogue. Without this option, outgoing arguments are
15760 pushed before calling a function and popped afterwards.
15761
15762 Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on
15763 AVR so that accumulating the stack space might lead to smaller
15764 executables because arguments need not be removed from the stack
15765 after such a function call.
15766
15767 This option can lead to reduced code size for functions that
15768 perform several calls to functions that get their arguments on the
15769 stack like calls to printf-like functions.
15770
15771 -mbranch-cost=cost
15772 Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to cost.
15773 Reasonable values for cost are small, non-negative integers. The
15774 default branch cost is 0.
15775
15776 -mcall-prologues
15777 Functions prologues/epilogues are expanded as calls to appropriate
15778 subroutines. Code size is smaller.
15779
15780 -mgas-isr-prologues
15781 Interrupt service routines (ISRs) may use the "__gcc_isr" pseudo
15782 instruction supported by GNU Binutils. If this option is on, the
15783 feature can still be disabled for individual ISRs by means of the
15784 AVR Function Attributes,,"no_gccisr" function attribute. This
15785 feature is activated per default if optimization is on (but not
15786 with -Og, @pxref{Optimize Options}), and if GNU Binutils support
15787 PR21683 ("https://sourceware.org/PR21683").
15788
15789 -mint8
15790 Assume "int" to be 8-bit integer. This affects the sizes of all
15791 types: a "char" is 1 byte, an "int" is 1 byte, a "long" is 2 bytes,
15792 and "long long" is 4 bytes. Please note that this option does not
15793 conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code size.
15794
15795 -mmain-is-OS_task
15796 Do not save registers in "main". The effect is the same like
15797 attaching attribute AVR Function Attributes,,"OS_task" to "main".
15798 It is activated per default if optimization is on.
15799
15800 -mn-flash=num
15801 Assume that the flash memory has a size of num times 64@tie{}KiB.
15802
15803 -mno-interrupts
15804 Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts. Code
15805 size is smaller.
15806
15807 -mrelax
15808 Try to replace "CALL" resp. "JMP" instruction by the shorter
15809 "RCALL" resp. "RJMP" instruction if applicable. Setting -mrelax
15810 just adds the --mlink-relax option to the assembler's command line
15811 and the --relax option to the linker's command line.
15812
15813 Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are
15814 not known before code is located. Therefore, the assembler code
15815 generated by the compiler is the same, but the instructions in the
15816 executable may differ from instructions in the assembler code.
15817
15818 Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the
15819 section on "EIND" and linker stubs below.
15820
15821 -mrmw
15822 Assume that the device supports the Read-Modify-Write instructions
15823 "XCH", "LAC", "LAS" and "LAT".
15824
15825 -mshort-calls
15826 Assume that "RJMP" and "RCALL" can target the whole program memory.
15827
15828 This option is used internally for multilib selection. It is not
15829 an optimization option, and you don't need to set it by hand.
15830
15831 -msp8
15832 Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register, i.e. assume
15833 the high byte of the stack pointer is zero. In general, you don't
15834 need to set this option by hand.
15835
15836 This option is used internally by the compiler to select and build
15837 multilibs for architectures "avr2" and "avr25". These
15838 architectures mix devices with and without "SPH". For any setting
15839 other than -mmcu=avr2 or -mmcu=avr25 the compiler driver adds or
15840 removes this option from the compiler proper's command line,
15841 because the compiler then knows if the device or architecture has
15842 an 8-bit stack pointer and thus no "SPH" register or not.
15843
15844 -mstrict-X
15845 Use address register "X" in a way proposed by the hardware. This
15846 means that "X" is only used in indirect, post-increment or pre-
15847 decrement addressing.
15848
15849 Without this option, the "X" register may be used in the same way
15850 as "Y" or "Z" which then is emulated by additional instructions.
15851 For example, loading a value with "X+const" addressing with a small
15852 non-negative "const < 64" to a register Rn is performed as
15853
15854 adiw r26, const ; X += const
15855 ld <Rn>, X ; <Rn> = *X
15856 sbiw r26, const ; X -= const
15857
15858 -mtiny-stack
15859 Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.
15860
15861 -mfract-convert-truncate
15862 Allow to use truncation instead of rounding towards zero for
15863 fractional fixed-point types.
15864
15865 -nodevicelib
15866 Don't link against AVR-LibC's device specific library "lib<mcu>.a".
15867
15868 -Waddr-space-convert
15869 Warn about conversions between address spaces in the case where the
15870 resulting address space is not contained in the incoming address
15871 space.
15872
15873 -Wmisspelled-isr
15874 Warn if the ISR is misspelled, i.e. without __vector prefix.
15875 Enabled by default.
15876
15877 "EIND" and Devices with More Than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash
15878
15879 Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide. The address of a
15880 function or label is represented as word address so that indirect jumps
15881 and calls can target any code address in the range of 64@tie{}Ki words.
15882
15883 In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than
15884 128@tie{}Ki bytes of program memory space, there is a special function
15885 register called "EIND" that serves as most significant part of the
15886 target address when "EICALL" or "EIJMP" instructions are used.
15887
15888 Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by the
15889 compiler and are subject to some limitations:
15890
15891 * The compiler never sets "EIND".
15892
15893 * The compiler uses "EIND" implicitly in "EICALL"/"EIJMP"
15894 instructions or might read "EIND" directly in order to emulate an
15895 indirect call/jump by means of a "RET" instruction.
15896
15897 * The compiler assumes that "EIND" never changes during the startup
15898 code or during the application. In particular, "EIND" is not
15899 saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine
15900 prologue/epilogue.
15901
15902 * For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker
15903 generates stubs. Stubs are jump pads sometimes also called
15904 trampolines. Thus, the indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.
15905 The stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.
15906
15907 * Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker generates
15908 the stubs correctly in all situations. See the compiler option
15909 -mrelax and the linker option --relax. There are corner cases
15910 where the linker is supposed to generate stubs but aborts without
15911 relaxation and without a helpful error message.
15912
15913 * The default linker script is arranged for code with "EIND = 0". If
15914 code is supposed to work for a setup with "EIND != 0", a custom
15915 linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
15916 name start with ".trampolines" into the segment where "EIND" points
15917 to.
15918
15919 * The startup code from libgcc never sets "EIND". Notice that
15920 startup code is a blend of code from libgcc and AVR-LibC. For the
15921 impact of AVR-LibC on "EIND", see the AVR-LibC user manual
15922 ("http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual/").
15923
15924 * It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up "EIND"
15925 early, for example by means of initialization code located in
15926 section ".init3". Such code runs prior to general startup code that
15927 initializes RAM and calls constructors, but after the bit of
15928 startup code from AVR-LibC that sets "EIND" to the segment where
15929 the vector table is located.
15930
15931 #include <avr/io.h>
15932
15933 static void
15934 __attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
15935 init3_set_eind (void)
15936 {
15937 __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
15938 "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
15939 }
15940
15941 The "__trampolines_start" symbol is defined in the linker script.
15942
15943 * Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if the following
15944 two conditions are met:
15945
15946 -<The address of a label is taken by means of the "gs" modifier>
15947 (short for generate stubs) like so:
15948
15949 LDI r24, lo8(gs(<func>))
15950 LDI r25, hi8(gs(<func>))
15951
15952 -<The final location of that label is in a code segment>
15953 outside the segment where the stubs are located.
15954
15955 * The compiler emits such "gs" modifiers for code labels in the
15956 following situations:
15957
15958 -<Taking address of a function or code label.>
15959 -<Computed goto.>
15960 -<If prologue-save function is used, see -mcall-prologues>
15961 command-line option.
15962
15963 -<Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch>
15964 tables you can specify the -fno-jump-tables command-line
15965 option.
15966
15967 -<C and C++ constructors/destructors called during
15968 startup/shutdown.>
15969 -<If the tools hit a "gs()" modifier explained above.>
15970 * Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is not supported:
15971
15972 int main (void)
15973 {
15974 /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
15975 return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
15976 }
15977
15978 Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e. the function has to be
15979 called through a symbol ("func_4" in the example):
15980
15981 int main (void)
15982 {
15983 extern int func_4 (void);
15984
15985 /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
15986 return func_4();
15987 }
15988
15989 and the application be linked with -Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4.
15990 Alternatively, "func_4" can be defined in the linker script.
15991
15992 Handling of the "RAMPD", "RAMPX", "RAMPY" and "RAMPZ" Special Function
15993 Registers
15994
15995 Some AVR devices support memories larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range
15996 that can be accessed with 16-bit pointers. To access memory locations
15997 outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the content of a "RAMP" register is
15998 used as high part of the address: The "X", "Y", "Z" address register is
15999 concatenated with the "RAMPX", "RAMPY", "RAMPZ" special function
16000 register, respectively, to get a wide address. Similarly, "RAMPD" is
16001 used together with direct addressing.
16002
16003 * The startup code initializes the "RAMP" special function registers
16004 with zero.
16005
16006 * If a AVR Named Address Spaces,named address space other than
16007 generic or "__flash" is used, then "RAMPZ" is set as needed before
16008 the operation.
16009
16010 * If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB and the compiler
16011 needs to change "RAMPZ" to accomplish an operation, "RAMPZ" is
16012 reset to zero after the operation.
16013
16014 * If the device comes with a specific "RAMP" register, the ISR
16015 prologue/epilogue saves/restores that SFR and initializes it with
16016 zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.
16017
16018 * RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB is not supported by GCC for AVR
16019 targets. If you use inline assembler to read from locations
16020 outside the 16-bit address range and change one of the "RAMP"
16021 registers, you must reset it to zero after the access.
16022
16023 AVR Built-in Macros
16024
16025 GCC defines several built-in macros so that the user code can test for
16026 the presence or absence of features. Almost any of the following
16027 built-in macros are deduced from device capabilities and thus triggered
16028 by the -mmcu= command-line option.
16029
16030 For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see AVR Named Address Spaces
16031 and AVR Built-in Functions.
16032
16033 "__AVR_ARCH__"
16034 Build-in macro that resolves to a decimal number that identifies
16035 the architecture and depends on the -mmcu=mcu option. Possible
16036 values are:
16037
16038 2, 25, 3, 31, 35, 4, 5, 51, 6
16039
16040 for mcu="avr2", "avr25", "avr3", "avr31", "avr35", "avr4", "avr5",
16041 "avr51", "avr6",
16042
16043 respectively and
16044
16045 100, 102, 103, 104, 105, 106, 107
16046
16047 for mcu="avrtiny", "avrxmega2", "avrxmega3", "avrxmega4",
16048 "avrxmega5", "avrxmega6", "avrxmega7", respectively. If mcu
16049 specifies a device, this built-in macro is set accordingly. For
16050 example, with -mmcu=atmega8 the macro is defined to 4.
16051
16052 "__AVR_Device__"
16053 Setting -mmcu=device defines this built-in macro which reflects the
16054 device's name. For example, -mmcu=atmega8 defines the built-in
16055 macro "__AVR_ATmega8__", -mmcu=attiny261a defines
16056 "__AVR_ATtiny261A__", etc.
16057
16058 The built-in macros' names follow the scheme "__AVR_Device__" where
16059 Device is the device name as from the AVR user manual. The
16060 difference between Device in the built-in macro and device in
16061 -mmcu=device is that the latter is always lowercase.
16062
16063 If device is not a device but only a core architecture like avr51,
16064 this macro is not defined.
16065
16066 "__AVR_DEVICE_NAME__"
16067 Setting -mmcu=device defines this built-in macro to the device's
16068 name. For example, with -mmcu=atmega8 the macro is defined to
16069 "atmega8".
16070
16071 If device is not a device but only a core architecture like avr51,
16072 this macro is not defined.
16073
16074 "__AVR_XMEGA__"
16075 The device / architecture belongs to the XMEGA family of devices.
16076
16077 "__AVR_HAVE_ELPM__"
16078 The device has the "ELPM" instruction.
16079
16080 "__AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__"
16081 The device has the "ELPM Rn,Z" and "ELPM Rn,Z+" instructions.
16082
16083 "__AVR_HAVE_MOVW__"
16084 The device has the "MOVW" instruction to perform 16-bit register-
16085 register moves.
16086
16087 "__AVR_HAVE_LPMX__"
16088 The device has the "LPM Rn,Z" and "LPM Rn,Z+" instructions.
16089
16090 "__AVR_HAVE_MUL__"
16091 The device has a hardware multiplier.
16092
16093 "__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__"
16094 The device has the "JMP" and "CALL" instructions. This is the case
16095 for devices with more than 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
16096
16097 "__AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__"
16098 "__AVR_3_BYTE_PC__"
16099 The device has the "EIJMP" and "EICALL" instructions. This is the
16100 case for devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
16101 This also means that the program counter (PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.
16102
16103 "__AVR_2_BYTE_PC__"
16104 The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for
16105 devices with up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
16106
16107 "__AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__"
16108 "__AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__"
16109 The stack pointer (SP) register is treated as 8-bit respectively
16110 16-bit register by the compiler. The definition of these macros is
16111 affected by -mtiny-stack.
16112
16113 "__AVR_HAVE_SPH__"
16114 "__AVR_SP8__"
16115 The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special
16116 function register or has an 8-bit stack pointer, respectively. The
16117 definition of these macros is affected by -mmcu= and in the cases
16118 of -mmcu=avr2 and -mmcu=avr25 also by -msp8.
16119
16120 "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__"
16121 "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__"
16122 "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__"
16123 "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__"
16124 The device has the "RAMPD", "RAMPX", "RAMPY", "RAMPZ" special
16125 function register, respectively.
16126
16127 "__NO_INTERRUPTS__"
16128 This macro reflects the -mno-interrupts command-line option.
16129
16130 "__AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__"
16131 "__AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__"
16132 Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip 32-bit
16133 instructions because of a hardware erratum. Skip instructions are
16134 "SBRS", "SBRC", "SBIS", "SBIC" and "CPSE". The second macro is
16135 only defined if "__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__" is also set.
16136
16137 "__AVR_ISA_RMW__"
16138 The device has Read-Modify-Write instructions (XCH, LAC, LAS and
16139 LAT).
16140
16141 "__AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=offset"
16142 Instructions that can address I/O special function registers
16143 directly like "IN", "OUT", "SBI", etc. may use a different address
16144 as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like "LD" or "STS".
16145 This offset depends on the device architecture and has to be
16146 subtracted from the RAM address in order to get the respective
16147 I/O@tie{}address.
16148
16149 "__AVR_SHORT_CALLS__"
16150 The -mshort-calls command line option is set.
16151
16152 "__AVR_PM_BASE_ADDRESS__=addr"
16153 Some devices support reading from flash memory by means of "LD*"
16154 instructions. The flash memory is seen in the data address space
16155 at an offset of "__AVR_PM_BASE_ADDRESS__". If this macro is not
16156 defined, this feature is not available. If defined, the address
16157 space is linear and there is no need to put ".rodata" into RAM.
16158 This is handled by the default linker description file, and is
16159 currently available for "avrtiny" and "avrxmega3". Even more
16160 convenient, there is no need to use address spaces like "__flash"
16161 or features like attribute "progmem" and "pgm_read_*".
16162
16163 "__WITH_AVRLIBC__"
16164 The compiler is configured to be used together with AVR-Libc. See
16165 the --with-avrlibc configure option.
16166
16167 Blackfin Options
16168
16169 -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision]
16170 Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor. Currently,
16171 cpu can be one of bf512, bf514, bf516, bf518, bf522, bf523, bf524,
16172 bf525, bf526, bf527, bf531, bf532, bf533, bf534, bf536, bf537,
16173 bf538, bf539, bf542, bf544, bf547, bf548, bf549, bf542m, bf544m,
16174 bf547m, bf548m, bf549m, bf561, bf592.
16175
16176 The optional sirevision specifies the silicon revision of the
16177 target Blackfin processor. Any workarounds available for the
16178 targeted silicon revision are enabled. If sirevision is none, no
16179 workarounds are enabled. If sirevision is any, all workarounds for
16180 the targeted processor are enabled. The "__SILICON_REVISION__"
16181 macro is defined to two hexadecimal digits representing the major
16182 and minor numbers in the silicon revision. If sirevision is none,
16183 the "__SILICON_REVISION__" is not defined. If sirevision is any,
16184 the "__SILICON_REVISION__" is defined to be 0xffff. If this
16185 optional sirevision is not used, GCC assumes the latest known
16186 silicon revision of the targeted Blackfin processor.
16187
16188 GCC defines a preprocessor macro for the specified cpu. For the
16189 bfin-elf toolchain, this option causes the hardware BSP provided by
16190 libgloss to be linked in if -msim is not given.
16191
16192 Without this option, bf532 is used as the processor by default.
16193
16194 Note that support for bf561 is incomplete. For bf561, only the
16195 preprocessor macro is defined.
16196
16197 -msim
16198 Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator. This
16199 causes the simulator BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in.
16200 This option has effect only for bfin-elf toolchain. Certain other
16201 options, such as -mid-shared-library and -mfdpic, imply -msim.
16202
16203 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
16204 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.
16205 This avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame
16206 pointers and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.
16207
16208 -mspecld-anomaly
16209 When enabled, the compiler ensures that the generated code does not
16210 contain speculative loads after jump instructions. If this option
16211 is used, "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS" is defined.
16212
16213 -mno-specld-anomaly
16214 Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from
16215 occurring.
16216
16217 -mcsync-anomaly
16218 When enabled, the compiler ensures that the generated code does not
16219 contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional
16220 branches. If this option is used, "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS"
16221 is defined.
16222
16223 -mno-csync-anomaly
16224 Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions
16225 from occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
16226
16227 -mlow64k
16228 When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the
16229 knowledge that the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
16230
16231 -mno-low64k
16232 Assume that the program is arbitrarily large. This is the default.
16233
16234 -mstack-check-l1
16235 Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad
16236 memory by the uClinux kernel.
16237
16238 -mid-shared-library
16239 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID
16240 method. This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in
16241 an environment without virtual memory management. This option
16242 implies -fPIC. With a bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.
16243
16244 -mno-id-shared-library
16245 Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are
16246 being used. This is the default.
16247
16248 -mleaf-id-shared-library
16249 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID
16250 method, but assumes that this library or executable won't link
16251 against any other ID shared libraries. That allows the compiler to
16252 use faster code for jumps and calls.
16253
16254 -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
16255 Do not assume that the code being compiled won't link against any
16256 ID shared libraries. Slower code is generated for jump and call
16257 insns.
16258
16259 -mshared-library-id=n
16260 Specifies the identification number of the ID-based shared library
16261 being compiled. Specifying a value of 0 generates more compact
16262 code; specifying other values forces the allocation of that number
16263 to the current library but is no more space- or time-efficient than
16264 omitting this option.
16265
16266 -msep-data
16267 Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a
16268 different area of memory from the text segment. This allows for
16269 execute in place in an environment without virtual memory
16270 management by eliminating relocations against the text section.
16271
16272 -mno-sep-data
16273 Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text
16274 segment. This is the default.
16275
16276 -mlong-calls
16277 -mno-long-calls
16278 Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
16279 address of the function into a register and then performing a
16280 subroutine call on this register. This switch is needed if the
16281 target function lies outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the
16282 offset-based version of subroutine call instruction.
16283
16284 This feature is not enabled by default. Specifying -mno-long-calls
16285 restores the default behavior. Note these switches have no effect
16286 on how the compiler generates code to handle function calls via
16287 function pointers.
16288
16289 -mfast-fp
16290 Link with the fast floating-point library. This library relaxes
16291 some of the IEEE floating-point standard's rules for checking
16292 inputs against Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.
16293
16294 -minline-plt
16295 Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that
16296 are not known to bind locally. It has no effect without -mfdpic.
16297
16298 -mmulticore
16299 Build a standalone application for multicore Blackfin processors.
16300 This option causes proper start files and link scripts supporting
16301 multicore to be used, and defines the macro "__BFIN_MULTICORE". It
16302 can only be used with -mcpu=bf561[-sirevision].
16303
16304 This option can be used with -mcorea or -mcoreb, which selects the
16305 one-application-per-core programming model. Without -mcorea or
16306 -mcoreb, the single-application/dual-core programming model is
16307 used. In this model, the main function of Core B should be named as
16308 "coreb_main".
16309
16310 If this option is not used, the single-core application programming
16311 model is used.
16312
16313 -mcorea
16314 Build a standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using the
16315 one-application-per-core programming model. Proper start files and
16316 link scripts are used to support Core A, and the macro
16317 "__BFIN_COREA" is defined. This option can only be used in
16318 conjunction with -mmulticore.
16319
16320 -mcoreb
16321 Build a standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using the
16322 one-application-per-core programming model. Proper start files and
16323 link scripts are used to support Core B, and the macro
16324 "__BFIN_COREB" is defined. When this option is used, "coreb_main"
16325 should be used instead of "main". This option can only be used in
16326 conjunction with -mmulticore.
16327
16328 -msdram
16329 Build a standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and
16330 link scripts are used to put the application into SDRAM, and the
16331 macro "__BFIN_SDRAM" is defined. The loader should initialize
16332 SDRAM before loading the application.
16333
16334 -micplb
16335 Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time. This has an effect on
16336 certain anomaly workarounds. For Linux targets, the default is to
16337 assume ICPLBs are enabled; for standalone applications the default
16338 is off.
16339
16340 C6X Options
16341
16342 -march=name
16343 This specifies the name of the target architecture. GCC uses this
16344 name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when
16345 generating assembly code. Permissible names are: c62x, c64x,
16346 c64x+, c67x, c67x+, c674x.
16347
16348 -mbig-endian
16349 Generate code for a big-endian target.
16350
16351 -mlittle-endian
16352 Generate code for a little-endian target. This is the default.
16353
16354 -msim
16355 Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
16356
16357 -msdata=default
16358 Put small global and static data in the ".neardata" section, which
16359 is pointed to by register "B14". Put small uninitialized global
16360 and static data in the ".bss" section, which is adjacent to the
16361 ".neardata" section. Put small read-only data into the ".rodata"
16362 section. The corresponding sections used for large pieces of data
16363 are ".fardata", ".far" and ".const".
16364
16365 -msdata=all
16366 Put all data, not just small objects, into the sections reserved
16367 for small data, and use addressing relative to the "B14" register
16368 to access them.
16369
16370 -msdata=none
16371 Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use
16372 absolute addresses to access all data. Put all initialized global
16373 and static data in the ".fardata" section, and all uninitialized
16374 data in the ".far" section. Put all constant data into the
16375 ".const" section.
16376
16377 CRIS Options
16378
16379 These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
16380
16381 -march=architecture-type
16382 -mcpu=architecture-type
16383 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
16384 architecture-type are v3, v8 and v10 for respectively ETRAX 4,
16385 ETRAX 100, and ETRAX 100 LX. Default is v0 except for cris-axis-
16386 linux-gnu, where the default is v10.
16387
16388 -mtune=architecture-type
16389 Tune to architecture-type everything applicable about the generated
16390 code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
16391 The choices for architecture-type are the same as for
16392 -march=architecture-type.
16393
16394 -mmax-stack-frame=n
16395 Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds n bytes.
16396
16397 -metrax4
16398 -metrax100
16399 The options -metrax4 and -metrax100 are synonyms for -march=v3 and
16400 -march=v8 respectively.
16401
16402 -mmul-bug-workaround
16403 -mno-mul-bug-workaround
16404 Work around a bug in the "muls" and "mulu" instructions for CPU
16405 models where it applies. This option is active by default.
16406
16407 -mpdebug
16408 Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the
16409 assembly code. This option also has the effect of turning off the
16410 #NO_APP formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning
16411 of the assembly file.
16412
16413 -mcc-init
16414 Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always
16415 emit compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
16416
16417 -mno-side-effects
16418 Do not emit instructions with side effects in addressing modes
16419 other than post-increment.
16420
16421 -mstack-align
16422 -mno-stack-align
16423 -mdata-align
16424 -mno-data-align
16425 -mconst-align
16426 -mno-const-align
16427 These options (no- options) arrange (eliminate arrangements) for
16428 the stack frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for
16429 the maximum single data access size for the chosen CPU model. The
16430 default is to arrange for 32-bit alignment. ABI details such as
16431 structure layout are not affected by these options.
16432
16433 -m32-bit
16434 -m16-bit
16435 -m8-bit
16436 Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these
16437 options arrange for stack frame, writable data and constants to all
16438 be 32-bit, 16-bit or 8-bit aligned. The default is 32-bit
16439 alignment.
16440
16441 -mno-prologue-epilogue
16442 -mprologue-epilogue
16443 With -mno-prologue-epilogue, the normal function prologue and
16444 epilogue which set up the stack frame are omitted and no return
16445 instructions or return sequences are generated in the code. Use
16446 this option only together with visual inspection of the compiled
16447 code: no warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers
16448 must be saved, or storage for local variables needs to be
16449 allocated.
16450
16451 -mno-gotplt
16452 -mgotplt
16453 With -fpic and -fPIC, don't generate (do generate) instruction
16454 sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part of
16455 the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to
16456 the PLT. The default is -mgotplt.
16457
16458 -melf
16459 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
16460 cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
16461
16462 -mlinux
16463 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu
16464 target.
16465
16466 -sim
16467 This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf, arranges to link
16468 with input-output functions from a simulator library. Code,
16469 initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated
16470 consecutively.
16471
16472 -sim2
16473 Like -sim, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
16474 0x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
16475
16476 CR16 Options
16477
16478 These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.
16479
16480 -mmac
16481 Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by
16482 default.
16483
16484 -mcr16cplus
16485 -mcr16c
16486 Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture
16487 is default.
16488
16489 -msim
16490 Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator.
16491 Applicable to ELF compiler only.
16492
16493 -mint32
16494 Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.
16495
16496 -mbit-ops
16497 Generates "sbit"/"cbit" instructions for bit manipulations.
16498
16499 -mdata-model=model
16500 Choose a data model. The choices for model are near, far or medium.
16501 medium is default. However, far is not valid with -mcr16c, as the
16502 CR16C architecture does not support the far data model.
16503
16504 C-SKY Options
16505
16506 GCC supports these options when compiling for C-SKY V2 processors.
16507
16508 -march=arch
16509 Specify the C-SKY target architecture. Valid values for arch are:
16510 ck801, ck802, ck803, ck807, and ck810. The default is ck810.
16511
16512 -mcpu=cpu
16513 Specify the C-SKY target processor. Valid values for cpu are:
16514 ck801, ck801t, ck802, ck802t, ck802j, ck803, ck803h, ck803t,
16515 ck803ht, ck803f, ck803fh, ck803e, ck803eh, ck803et, ck803eht,
16516 ck803ef, ck803efh, ck803ft, ck803eft, ck803efht, ck803r1, ck803hr1,
16517 ck803tr1, ck803htr1, ck803fr1, ck803fhr1, ck803er1, ck803ehr1,
16518 ck803etr1, ck803ehtr1, ck803efr1, ck803efhr1, ck803ftr1,
16519 ck803eftr1, ck803efhtr1, ck803s, ck803st, ck803se, ck803sf,
16520 ck803sef, ck803seft, ck807e, ck807ef, ck807, ck807f, ck810e,
16521 ck810et, ck810ef, ck810eft, ck810, ck810v, ck810f, ck810t, ck810fv,
16522 ck810tv, ck810ft, and ck810ftv.
16523
16524 -mbig-endian
16525 -EB
16526 -mlittle-endian
16527 -EL Select big- or little-endian code. The default is little-endian.
16528
16529 -mhard-float
16530 -msoft-float
16531 Select hardware or software floating-point implementations. The
16532 default is soft float.
16533
16534 -mdouble-float
16535 -mno-double-float
16536 When -mhard-float is in effect, enable generation of double-
16537 precision float instructions. This is the default except when
16538 compiling for CK803.
16539
16540 -mfdivdu
16541 -mno-fdivdu
16542 When -mhard-float is in effect, enable generation of "frecipd",
16543 "fsqrtd", and "fdivd" instructions. This is the default except
16544 when compiling for CK803.
16545
16546 -mfpu=fpu
16547 Select the floating-point processor. This option can only be used
16548 with -mhard-float. Values for fpu are fpv2_sf (equivalent to
16549 -mno-double-float -mno-fdivdu), fpv2 (-mdouble-float -mno-divdu),
16550 and fpv2_divd (-mdouble-float -mdivdu).
16551
16552 -melrw
16553 -mno-elrw
16554 Enable the extended "lrw" instruction. This option defaults to on
16555 for CK801 and off otherwise.
16556
16557 -mistack
16558 -mno-istack
16559 Enable interrupt stack instructions; the default is off.
16560
16561 The -mistack option is required to handle the "interrupt" and "isr"
16562 function attributes.
16563
16564 -mmp
16565 Enable multiprocessor instructions; the default is off.
16566
16567 -mcp
16568 Enable coprocessor instructions; the default is off.
16569
16570 -mcache
16571 Enable coprocessor instructions; the default is off.
16572
16573 -msecurity
16574 Enable C-SKY security instructions; the default is off.
16575
16576 -mtrust
16577 Enable C-SKY trust instructions; the default is off.
16578
16579 -mdsp
16580 -medsp
16581 -mvdsp
16582 Enable C-SKY DSP, Enhanced DSP, or Vector DSP instructions,
16583 respectively. All of these options default to off.
16584
16585 -mdiv
16586 -mno-div
16587 Generate divide instructions. Default is off.
16588
16589 -msmart
16590 -mno-smart
16591 Generate code for Smart Mode, using only registers numbered 0-7 to
16592 allow use of 16-bit instructions. This option is ignored for CK801
16593 where this is the required behavior, and it defaults to on for
16594 CK802. For other targets, the default is off.
16595
16596 -mhigh-registers
16597 -mno-high-registers
16598 Generate code using the high registers numbered 16-31. This option
16599 is not supported on CK801, CK802, or CK803, and is enabled by
16600 default for other processors.
16601
16602 -manchor
16603 -mno-anchor
16604 Generate code using global anchor symbol addresses.
16605
16606 -mpushpop
16607 -mno-pushpop
16608 Generate code using "push" and "pop" instructions. This option
16609 defaults to on.
16610
16611 -mmultiple-stld
16612 -mstm
16613 -mno-multiple-stld
16614 -mno-stm
16615 Generate code using "stm" and "ldm" instructions. This option
16616 isn't supported on CK801 but is enabled by default on other
16617 processors.
16618
16619 -mconstpool
16620 -mno-constpool
16621 Create constant pools in the compiler instead of deferring it to
16622 the assembler. This option is the default and required for correct
16623 code generation on CK801 and CK802, and is optional on other
16624 processors.
16625
16626 -mstack-size
16627 -mno-stack-size
16628 Emit ".stack_size" directives for each function in the assembly
16629 output. This option defaults to off.
16630
16631 -mccrt
16632 -mno-ccrt
16633 Generate code for the C-SKY compiler runtime instead of libgcc.
16634 This option defaults to off.
16635
16636 -mbranch-cost=n
16637 Set the branch costs to roughly "n" instructions. The default is
16638 1.
16639
16640 -msched-prolog
16641 -mno-sched-prolog
16642 Permit scheduling of function prologue and epilogue sequences.
16643 Using this option can result in code that is not compliant with the
16644 C-SKY V2 ABI prologue requirements and that cannot be debugged or
16645 backtraced. It is disabled by default.
16646
16647 Darwin Options
16648
16649 These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin
16650 operating system.
16651
16652 FSF GCC on Darwin does not create "fat" object files; it creates an
16653 object file for the single architecture that GCC was built to target.
16654 Apple's GCC on Darwin does create "fat" files if multiple -arch options
16655 are used; it does so by running the compiler or linker multiple times
16656 and joining the results together with lipo.
16657
16658 The subtype of the file created (like ppc7400 or ppc970 or i686) is
16659 determined by the flags that specify the ISA that GCC is targeting,
16660 like -mcpu or -march. The -force_cpusubtype_ALL option can be used to
16661 override this.
16662
16663 The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
16664 mismatch. The assembler, as, only permits instructions to be used that
16665 are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating, so you cannot
16666 put 64-bit instructions in a ppc750 object file. The linker for shared
16667 libraries, /usr/bin/libtool, fails and prints an error if asked to
16668 create a shared library with a less restrictive subtype than its input
16669 files (for instance, trying to put a ppc970 object file in a ppc7400
16670 library). The linker for executables, ld, quietly gives the executable
16671 the most restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
16672
16673 -Fdir
16674 Add the framework directory dir to the head of the list of
16675 directories to be searched for header files. These directories are
16676 interleaved with those specified by -I options and are scanned in a
16677 left-to-right order.
16678
16679 A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it. A
16680 framework is a directory with a Headers and/or PrivateHeaders
16681 directory contained directly in it that ends in .framework. The
16682 name of a framework is the name of this directory excluding the
16683 .framework. Headers associated with the framework are found in one
16684 of those two directories, with Headers being searched first. A
16685 subframework is a framework directory that is in a framework's
16686 Frameworks directory. Includes of subframework headers can only
16687 appear in a header of a framework that contains the subframework,
16688 or in a sibling subframework header. Two subframeworks are
16689 siblings if they occur in the same framework. A subframework
16690 should not have the same name as a framework; a warning is issued
16691 if this is violated. Currently a subframework cannot have
16692 subframeworks; in the future, the mechanism may be extended to
16693 support this. The standard frameworks can be found in
16694 /System/Library/Frameworks and /Library/Frameworks. An example
16695 include looks like "#include <Framework/header.h>", where Framework
16696 denotes the name of the framework and header.h is found in the
16697 PrivateHeaders or Headers directory.
16698
16699 -iframeworkdir
16700 Like -F except the directory is a treated as a system directory.
16701 The main difference between this -iframework and -F is that with
16702 -iframework the compiler does not warn about constructs contained
16703 within header files found via dir. This option is valid only for
16704 the C family of languages.
16705
16706 -gused
16707 Emit debugging information for symbols that are used. For stabs
16708 debugging format, this enables -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols.
16709 This is by default ON.
16710
16711 -gfull
16712 Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
16713
16714 -mmacosx-version-min=version
16715 The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on is
16716 version. Typical values of version include 10.1, 10.2, and 10.3.9.
16717
16718 If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default,
16719 then the default for this option is the system version on which the
16720 compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices that
16721 are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.
16722
16723 -mkernel
16724 Enable kernel development mode. The -mkernel option sets -static,
16725 -fno-common, -fno-use-cxa-atexit, -fno-exceptions,
16726 -fno-non-call-exceptions, -fapple-kext, -fno-weak and -fno-rtti
16727 where applicable. This mode also sets -mno-altivec, -msoft-float,
16728 -fno-builtin and -mlong-branch for PowerPC targets.
16729
16730 -mone-byte-bool
16731 Override the defaults for "bool" so that "sizeof(bool)==1". By
16732 default "sizeof(bool)" is 4 when compiling for Darwin/PowerPC and 1
16733 when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this option has no effect on x86.
16734
16735 Warning: The -mone-byte-bool switch causes GCC to generate code
16736 that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
16737 switch. Using this switch may require recompiling all other
16738 modules in a program, including system libraries. Use this switch
16739 to conform to a non-default data model.
16740
16741 -mfix-and-continue
16742 -ffix-and-continue
16743 -findirect-data
16744 Generate code suitable for fast turnaround development, such as to
16745 allow GDB to dynamically load .o files into already-running
16746 programs. -findirect-data and -ffix-and-continue are provided for
16747 backwards compatibility.
16748
16749 -all_load
16750 Loads all members of static archive libraries. See man ld(1) for
16751 more information.
16752
16753 -arch_errors_fatal
16754 Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong
16755 architecture to be fatal.
16756
16757 -bind_at_load
16758 Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker
16759 will bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or
16760 launched.
16761
16762 -bundle
16763 Produce a Mach-o bundle format file. See man ld(1) for more
16764 information.
16765
16766 -bundle_loader executable
16767 This option specifies the executable that will load the build
16768 output file being linked. See man ld(1) for more information.
16769
16770 -dynamiclib
16771 When passed this option, GCC produces a dynamic library instead of
16772 an executable when linking, using the Darwin libtool command.
16773
16774 -force_cpusubtype_ALL
16775 This causes GCC's output file to have the ALL subtype, instead of
16776 one controlled by the -mcpu or -march option.
16777
16778 -allowable_client client_name
16779 -client_name
16780 -compatibility_version
16781 -current_version
16782 -dead_strip
16783 -dependency-file
16784 -dylib_file
16785 -dylinker_install_name
16786 -dynamic
16787 -exported_symbols_list
16788 -filelist
16789 -flat_namespace
16790 -force_flat_namespace
16791 -headerpad_max_install_names
16792 -image_base
16793 -init
16794 -install_name
16795 -keep_private_externs
16796 -multi_module
16797 -multiply_defined
16798 -multiply_defined_unused
16799 -noall_load
16800 -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
16801 -nofixprebinding
16802 -nomultidefs
16803 -noprebind
16804 -noseglinkedit
16805 -pagezero_size
16806 -prebind
16807 -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
16808 -private_bundle
16809 -read_only_relocs
16810 -sectalign
16811 -sectobjectsymbols
16812 -whyload
16813 -seg1addr
16814 -sectcreate
16815 -sectobjectsymbols
16816 -sectorder
16817 -segaddr
16818 -segs_read_only_addr
16819 -segs_read_write_addr
16820 -seg_addr_table
16821 -seg_addr_table_filename
16822 -seglinkedit
16823 -segprot
16824 -segs_read_only_addr
16825 -segs_read_write_addr
16826 -single_module
16827 -static
16828 -sub_library
16829 -sub_umbrella
16830 -twolevel_namespace
16831 -umbrella
16832 -undefined
16833 -unexported_symbols_list
16834 -weak_reference_mismatches
16835 -whatsloaded
16836 These options are passed to the Darwin linker. The Darwin linker
16837 man page describes them in detail.
16838
16839 DEC Alpha Options
16840
16841 These -m options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
16842
16843 -mno-soft-float
16844 -msoft-float
16845 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
16846 floating-point operations. When -msoft-float is specified,
16847 functions in libgcc.a are used to perform floating-point
16848 operations. Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
16849 floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call
16850 such emulations routines, these routines issue floating-point
16851 operations. If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-
16852 point operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as
16853 not to call them.
16854
16855 Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations
16856 are required to have floating-point registers.
16857
16858 -mfp-reg
16859 -mno-fp-regs
16860 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register
16861 set. -mno-fp-regs implies -msoft-float. If the floating-point
16862 register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed in
16863 integer registers as if they were integers and floating-point
16864 results are passed in $0 instead of $f0. This is a non-standard
16865 calling sequence, so any function with a floating-point argument or
16866 return value called by code compiled with -mno-fp-regs must also be
16867 compiled with that option.
16868
16869 A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not
16870 use, and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point
16871 registers.
16872
16873 -mieee
16874 The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized
16875 for maximum performance. It is mostly compliant with the IEEE
16876 floating-point standard. However, for full compliance, software
16877 assistance is required. This option generates code fully IEEE-
16878 compliant code except that the inexact-flag is not maintained (see
16879 below). If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro
16880 "_IEEE_FP" is defined during compilation. The resulting code is
16881 less efficient but is able to correctly support denormalized
16882 numbers and exceptional IEEE values such as not-a-number and
16883 plus/minus infinity. Other Alpha compilers call this option
16884 -ieee_with_no_inexact.
16885
16886 -mieee-with-inexact
16887 This is like -mieee except the generated code also maintains the
16888 IEEE inexact-flag. Turning on this option causes the generated
16889 code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math. In addition to
16890 "_IEEE_FP", "_IEEE_FP_EXACT" is defined as a preprocessor macro.
16891 On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
16892 significantly slower than the code generated by default. Since
16893 there is very little code that depends on the inexact-flag, you
16894 should normally not specify this option. Other Alpha compilers
16895 call this option -ieee_with_inexact.
16896
16897 -mfp-trap-mode=trap-mode
16898 This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
16899 Other Alpha compilers call this option -fptm trap-mode. The trap
16900 mode can be set to one of four values:
16901
16902 n This is the default (normal) setting. The only traps that are
16903 enabled are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g.,
16904 division by zero trap).
16905
16906 u In addition to the traps enabled by n, underflow traps are
16907 enabled as well.
16908
16909 su Like u, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
16910 completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
16911
16912 sui Like su, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
16913
16914 -mfp-rounding-mode=rounding-mode
16915 Selects the IEEE rounding mode. Other Alpha compilers call this
16916 option -fprm rounding-mode. The rounding-mode can be one of:
16917
16918 n Normal IEEE rounding mode. Floating-point numbers are rounded
16919 towards the nearest machine number or towards the even machine
16920 number in case of a tie.
16921
16922 m Round towards minus infinity.
16923
16924 c Chopped rounding mode. Floating-point numbers are rounded
16925 towards zero.
16926
16927 d Dynamic rounding mode. A field in the floating-point control
16928 register (fpcr, see Alpha architecture reference manual)
16929 controls the rounding mode in effect. The C library
16930 initializes this register for rounding towards plus infinity.
16931 Thus, unless your program modifies the fpcr, d corresponds to
16932 round towards plus infinity.
16933
16934 -mtrap-precision=trap-precision
16935 In the Alpha architecture, floating-point traps are imprecise.
16936 This means without software assistance it is impossible to recover
16937 from a floating trap and program execution normally needs to be
16938 terminated. GCC can generate code that can assist operating system
16939 trap handlers in determining the exact location that caused a
16940 floating-point trap. Depending on the requirements of an
16941 application, different levels of precisions can be selected:
16942
16943 p Program precision. This option is the default and means a trap
16944 handler can only identify which program caused a floating-point
16945 exception.
16946
16947 f Function precision. The trap handler can determine the
16948 function that caused a floating-point exception.
16949
16950 i Instruction precision. The trap handler can determine the
16951 exact instruction that caused a floating-point exception.
16952
16953 Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
16954 -scope_safe and -resumption_safe.
16955
16956 -mieee-conformant
16957 This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant. You must
16958 not use this option unless you also specify -mtrap-precision=i and
16959 either -mfp-trap-mode=su or -mfp-trap-mode=sui. Its only effect is
16960 to emit the line .eflag 48 in the function prologue of the
16961 generated assembly file.
16962
16963 -mbuild-constants
16964 Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to see if it
16965 can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
16966 instructions. If it cannot, it outputs the constant as a literal
16967 and generates code to load it from the data segment at run time.
16968
16969 Use this option to require GCC to construct all integer constants
16970 using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is
16971 six).
16972
16973 You typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
16974 loader. Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
16975 before it can find the variables and constants in its own data
16976 segment.
16977
16978 -mbwx
16979 -mno-bwx
16980 -mcix
16981 -mno-cix
16982 -mfix
16983 -mno-fix
16984 -mmax
16985 -mno-max
16986 Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
16987 CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets. The default is to use the
16988 instruction sets supported by the CPU type specified via -mcpu=
16989 option or that of the CPU on which GCC was built if none is
16990 specified.
16991
16992 -mfloat-vax
16993 -mfloat-ieee
16994 Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point
16995 arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
16996
16997 -mexplicit-relocs
16998 -mno-explicit-relocs
16999 Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol
17000 relocations except via assembler macros. Use of these macros does
17001 not allow optimal instruction scheduling. GNU binutils as of
17002 version 2.12 supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to
17003 explicitly mark which relocations should apply to which
17004 instructions. This option is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC
17005 detects the capabilities of the assembler when it is built and sets
17006 the default accordingly.
17007
17008 -msmall-data
17009 -mlarge-data
17010 When -mexplicit-relocs is in effect, static data is accessed via
17011 gp-relative relocations. When -msmall-data is used, objects 8
17012 bytes long or smaller are placed in a small data area (the ".sdata"
17013 and ".sbss" sections) and are accessed via 16-bit relocations off
17014 of the $gp register. This limits the size of the small data area
17015 to 64KB, but allows the variables to be directly accessed via a
17016 single instruction.
17017
17018 The default is -mlarge-data. With this option the data area is
17019 limited to just below 2GB. Programs that require more than 2GB of
17020 data must use "malloc" or "mmap" to allocate the data in the heap
17021 instead of in the program's data segment.
17022
17023 When generating code for shared libraries, -fpic implies
17024 -msmall-data and -fPIC implies -mlarge-data.
17025
17026 -msmall-text
17027 -mlarge-text
17028 When -msmall-text is used, the compiler assumes that the code of
17029 the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is thus
17030 reachable with a branch instruction. When -msmall-data is used,
17031 the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the same $gp
17032 value, and thus reduce the number of instructions required for a
17033 function call from 4 to 1.
17034
17035 The default is -mlarge-text.
17036
17037 -mcpu=cpu_type
17038 Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
17039 machine type cpu_type. You can specify either the EV style name or
17040 the corresponding chip number. GCC supports scheduling parameters
17041 for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and chooses the
17042 default values for the instruction set from the processor you
17043 specify. If you do not specify a processor type, GCC defaults to
17044 the processor on which the compiler was built.
17045
17046 Supported values for cpu_type are
17047
17048 ev4
17049 ev45
17050 21064
17051 Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
17052
17053 ev5
17054 21164
17055 Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
17056
17057 ev56
17058 21164a
17059 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
17060
17061 pca56
17062 21164pc
17063 21164PC
17064 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
17065
17066 ev6
17067 21264
17068 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX
17069 extensions.
17070
17071 ev67
17072 21264a
17073 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX
17074 extensions.
17075
17076 Native toolchains also support the value native, which selects the
17077 best architecture option for the host processor. -mcpu=native has
17078 no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.
17079
17080 -mtune=cpu_type
17081 Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
17082 cpu_type. The instruction set is not changed.
17083
17084 Native toolchains also support the value native, which selects the
17085 best architecture option for the host processor. -mtune=native has
17086 no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.
17087
17088 -mmemory-latency=time
17089 Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
17090 references as seen by the application. This number is highly
17091 dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application and
17092 the size of the external cache on the machine.
17093
17094 Valid options for time are
17095
17096 number
17097 A decimal number representing clock cycles.
17098
17099 L1
17100 L2
17101 L3
17102 main
17103 The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles
17104 for "typical" EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
17105 (also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main
17106 memory. Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
17107
17108 FR30 Options
17109
17110 These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.
17111
17112 -msmall-model
17113 Use the small address space model. This can produce smaller code,
17114 but it does assume that all symbolic values and addresses fit into
17115 a 20-bit range.
17116
17117 -mno-lsim
17118 Assume that runtime support has been provided and so there is no
17119 need to include the simulator library (libsim.a) on the linker
17120 command line.
17121
17122 FT32 Options
17123
17124 These options are defined specifically for the FT32 port.
17125
17126 -msim
17127 Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator. This
17128 causes an alternate runtime startup and library to be linked. You
17129 must not use this option when generating programs that will run on
17130 real hardware; you must provide your own runtime library for
17131 whatever I/O functions are needed.
17132
17133 -mlra
17134 Enable Local Register Allocation. This is still experimental for
17135 FT32, so by default the compiler uses standard reload.
17136
17137 -mnodiv
17138 Do not use div and mod instructions.
17139
17140 -mft32b
17141 Enable use of the extended instructions of the FT32B processor.
17142
17143 -mcompress
17144 Compress all code using the Ft32B code compression scheme.
17145
17146 -mnopm
17147 Do not generate code that reads program memory.
17148
17149 FRV Options
17150
17151 -mgpr-32
17152 Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.
17153
17154 -mgpr-64
17155 Use all 64 general-purpose registers.
17156
17157 -mfpr-32
17158 Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.
17159
17160 -mfpr-64
17161 Use all 64 floating-point registers.
17162
17163 -mhard-float
17164 Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.
17165
17166 -msoft-float
17167 Use library routines for floating-point operations.
17168
17169 -malloc-cc
17170 Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
17171
17172 -mfixed-cc
17173 Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
17174 use "icc0" and "fcc0".
17175
17176 -mdword
17177 Change ABI to use double word insns.
17178
17179 -mno-dword
17180 Do not use double word instructions.
17181
17182 -mdouble
17183 Use floating-point double instructions.
17184
17185 -mno-double
17186 Do not use floating-point double instructions.
17187
17188 -mmedia
17189 Use media instructions.
17190
17191 -mno-media
17192 Do not use media instructions.
17193
17194 -mmuladd
17195 Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
17196
17197 -mno-muladd
17198 Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
17199
17200 -mfdpic
17201 Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent
17202 pointers to functions. Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
17203 implies -fPIE. With -fpic or -fpie, it assumes GOT entries and
17204 small data are within a 12-bit range from the GOT base address;
17205 with -fPIC or -fPIE, GOT offsets are computed with 32 bits. With a
17206 bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.
17207
17208 -minline-plt
17209 Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that
17210 are not known to bind locally. It has no effect without -mfdpic.
17211 It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
17212 shared libraries (i.e., -fPIC or -fpic), or when an optimization
17213 option such as -O3 or above is present in the command line.
17214
17215 -mTLS
17216 Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
17217
17218 -mtls
17219 Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local
17220 code.
17221
17222 -mgprel-ro
17223 Enable the use of "GPREL" relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
17224 that is known to be in read-only sections. It's enabled by
17225 default, except for -fpic or -fpie: even though it may help make
17226 the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
17227 With -fPIC or -fPIE, it trades 3 instructions for 4, one of which
17228 may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need for a GOT
17229 entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a win.
17230 If it is not, -mno-gprel-ro can be used to disable it.
17231
17232 -multilib-library-pic
17233 Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries. It's implied by
17234 -mlibrary-pic, as well as by -fPIC and -fpic without -mfdpic. You
17235 should never have to use it explicitly.
17236
17237 -mlinked-fp
17238 Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer
17239 whenever a stack frame is allocated. This option is enabled by
17240 default and can be disabled with -mno-linked-fp.
17241
17242 -mlong-calls
17243 Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
17244 compilation unit. This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
17245 within the 32-bit address space.
17246
17247 -malign-labels
17248 Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting NOPs into
17249 the previous packet. This option only has an effect when VLIW
17250 packing is enabled. It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds
17251 NOPs to existing ones.
17252
17253 -mlibrary-pic
17254 Generate position-independent EABI code.
17255
17256 -macc-4
17257 Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
17258
17259 -macc-8
17260 Use all eight media accumulator registers.
17261
17262 -mpack
17263 Pack VLIW instructions.
17264
17265 -mno-pack
17266 Do not pack VLIW instructions.
17267
17268 -mno-eflags
17269 Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
17270
17271 -mcond-move
17272 Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
17273
17274 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17275 removed in a future version.
17276
17277 -mno-cond-move
17278 Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
17279
17280 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17281 removed in a future version.
17282
17283 -mscc
17284 Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
17285
17286 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17287 removed in a future version.
17288
17289 -mno-scc
17290 Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
17291
17292 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17293 removed in a future version.
17294
17295 -mcond-exec
17296 Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
17297
17298 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17299 removed in a future version.
17300
17301 -mno-cond-exec
17302 Disable the use of conditional execution.
17303
17304 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17305 removed in a future version.
17306
17307 -mvliw-branch
17308 Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
17309
17310 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17311 removed in a future version.
17312
17313 -mno-vliw-branch
17314 Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
17315
17316 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17317 removed in a future version.
17318
17319 -mmulti-cond-exec
17320 Enable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution
17321 (default).
17322
17323 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17324 removed in a future version.
17325
17326 -mno-multi-cond-exec
17327 Disable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution.
17328
17329 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17330 removed in a future version.
17331
17332 -mnested-cond-exec
17333 Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
17334
17335 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17336 removed in a future version.
17337
17338 -mno-nested-cond-exec
17339 Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
17340
17341 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be
17342 removed in a future version.
17343
17344 -moptimize-membar
17345 This switch removes redundant "membar" instructions from the
17346 compiler-generated code. It is enabled by default.
17347
17348 -mno-optimize-membar
17349 This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant "membar"
17350 instructions from the generated code.
17351
17352 -mtomcat-stats
17353 Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
17354
17355 -mcpu=cpu
17356 Select the processor type for which to generate code. Possible
17357 values are frv, fr550, tomcat, fr500, fr450, fr405, fr400, fr300
17358 and simple.
17359
17360 GNU/Linux Options
17361
17362 These -m options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
17363
17364 -mglibc
17365 Use the GNU C library. This is the default except on
17366 *-*-linux-*uclibc*, *-*-linux-*musl* and *-*-linux-*android*
17367 targets.
17368
17369 -muclibc
17370 Use uClibc C library. This is the default on *-*-linux-*uclibc*
17371 targets.
17372
17373 -mmusl
17374 Use the musl C library. This is the default on *-*-linux-*musl*
17375 targets.
17376
17377 -mbionic
17378 Use Bionic C library. This is the default on *-*-linux-*android*
17379 targets.
17380
17381 -mandroid
17382 Compile code compatible with Android platform. This is the default
17383 on *-*-linux-*android* targets.
17384
17385 When compiling, this option enables -mbionic, -fPIC,
17386 -fno-exceptions and -fno-rtti by default. When linking, this
17387 option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the
17388 linker. Finally, this option causes the preprocessor macro
17389 "__ANDROID__" to be defined.
17390
17391 -tno-android-cc
17392 Disable compilation effects of -mandroid, i.e., do not enable
17393 -mbionic, -fPIC, -fno-exceptions and -fno-rtti by default.
17394
17395 -tno-android-ld
17396 Disable linking effects of -mandroid, i.e., pass standard Linux
17397 linking options to the linker.
17398
17399 H8/300 Options
17400
17401 These -m options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
17402
17403 -mrelax
17404 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses
17405 the linker option -relax.
17406
17407 -mh Generate code for the H8/300H.
17408
17409 -ms Generate code for the H8S.
17410
17411 -mn Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode. This
17412 switch must be used either with -mh or -ms.
17413
17414 -ms2600
17415 Generate code for the H8S/2600. This switch must be used with -ms.
17416
17417 -mexr
17418 Extended registers are stored on stack before execution of function
17419 with monitor attribute. Default option is -mexr. This option is
17420 valid only for H8S targets.
17421
17422 -mno-exr
17423 Extended registers are not stored on stack before execution of
17424 function with monitor attribute. Default option is -mno-exr. This
17425 option is valid only for H8S targets.
17426
17427 -mint32
17428 Make "int" data 32 bits by default.
17429
17430 -malign-300
17431 On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the
17432 H8/300. The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and
17433 floats on 4-byte boundaries. -malign-300 causes them to be aligned
17434 on 2-byte boundaries. This option has no effect on the H8/300.
17435
17436 HPPA Options
17437
17438 These -m options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
17439
17440 -march=architecture-type
17441 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
17442 architecture-type are 1.0 for PA 1.0, 1.1 for PA 1.1, and 2.0 for
17443 PA 2.0 processors. Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models on an HP-UX
17444 system to determine the proper architecture option for your
17445 machine. Code compiled for lower numbered architectures runs on
17446 higher numbered architectures, but not the other way around.
17447
17448 -mpa-risc-1-0
17449 -mpa-risc-1-1
17450 -mpa-risc-2-0
17451 Synonyms for -march=1.0, -march=1.1, and -march=2.0 respectively.
17452
17453 -mcaller-copies
17454 The caller copies function arguments passed by hidden reference.
17455 This option should be used with care as it is not compatible with
17456 the default 32-bit runtime. However, only aggregates larger than
17457 eight bytes are passed by hidden reference and the option provides
17458 better compatibility with OpenMP.
17459
17460 -mjump-in-delay
17461 This option is ignored and provided for compatibility purposes
17462 only.
17463
17464 -mdisable-fpregs
17465 Prevent floating-point registers from being used in any manner.
17466 This is necessary for compiling kernels that perform lazy context
17467 switching of floating-point registers. If you use this option and
17468 attempt to perform floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.
17469
17470 -mdisable-indexing
17471 Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes. This
17472 avoids some rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated
17473 code under MACH.
17474
17475 -mno-space-regs
17476 Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers. This
17477 allows GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index
17478 address modes.
17479
17480 Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
17481
17482 -mfast-indirect-calls
17483 Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.
17484 This allows GCC to emit code that performs faster indirect calls.
17485
17486 This option does not work in the presence of shared libraries or
17487 nested functions.
17488
17489 -mfixed-range=register-range
17490 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
17491 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use.
17492 This is useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is
17493 specified as two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register
17494 ranges can be specified separated by a comma.
17495
17496 -mlong-load-store
17497 Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes
17498 required by the HP-UX 10 linker. This is equivalent to the +k
17499 option to the HP compilers.
17500
17501 -mportable-runtime
17502 Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF
17503 systems.
17504
17505 -mgas
17506 Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
17507
17508 -mschedule=cpu-type
17509 Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
17510 cpu-type. The choices for cpu-type are 700 7100, 7100LC, 7200,
17511 7300 and 8000. Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models on an HP-UX system
17512 to determine the proper scheduling option for your machine. The
17513 default scheduling is 8000.
17514
17515 -mlinker-opt
17516 Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker. Note this makes
17517 symbolic debugging impossible. It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX
17518 8 and HP-UX 9 linkers in which they give bogus error messages when
17519 linking some programs.
17520
17521 -msoft-float
17522 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
17523 Warning: the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
17524 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler
17525 are used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.
17526 You must make your own arrangements to provide suitable library
17527 functions for cross-compilation.
17528
17529 -msoft-float changes the calling convention in the output file;
17530 therefore, it is only useful if you compile all of a program with
17531 this option. In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the
17532 library that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to
17533 work.
17534
17535 -msio
17536 Generate the predefine, "_SIO", for server IO. The default is
17537 -mwsio. This generates the predefines, "__hp9000s700",
17538 "__hp9000s700__" and "_WSIO", for workstation IO. These options
17539 are available under HP-UX and HI-UX.
17540
17541 -mgnu-ld
17542 Use options specific to GNU ld. This passes -shared to ld when
17543 building a shared library. It is the default when GCC is
17544 configured, explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker. This
17545 option does not affect which ld is called; it only changes what
17546 parameters are passed to that ld. The ld that is called is
17547 determined by the --with-ld configure option, GCC's program search
17548 path, and finally by the user's PATH. The linker used by GCC can
17549 be printed using which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`. This option is
17550 only available on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e. configured with
17551 hppa*64*-*-hpux*.
17552
17553 -mhp-ld
17554 Use options specific to HP ld. This passes -b to ld when building
17555 a shared library and passes +Accept TypeMismatch to ld on all
17556 links. It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
17557 implicitly, with the HP linker. This option does not affect which
17558 ld is called; it only changes what parameters are passed to that
17559 ld. The ld that is called is determined by the --with-ld configure
17560 option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's PATH.
17561 The linker used by GCC can be printed using which `gcc
17562 -print-prog-name=ld`. This option is only available on the 64-bit
17563 HP-UX GCC, i.e. configured with hppa*64*-*-hpux*.
17564
17565 -mlong-calls
17566 Generate code that uses long call sequences. This ensures that a
17567 call is always able to reach linker generated stubs. The default
17568 is to generate long calls only when the distance from the call site
17569 to the beginning of the function or translation unit, as the case
17570 may be, exceeds a predefined limit set by the branch type being
17571 used. The limits for normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes,
17572 respectively for the PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures. Sibcalls are
17573 always limited at 240,000 bytes.
17574
17575 Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using
17576 the -ffunction-sections option, or when using the -mgas and
17577 -mno-portable-runtime options together under HP-UX with the SOM
17578 linker.
17579
17580 It is normally not desirable to use this option as it degrades
17581 performance. However, it may be useful in large applications,
17582 particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
17583
17584 The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
17585 assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated. The
17586 impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
17587 symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
17588 However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
17589 and it is quite long.
17590
17591 -munix=unix-std
17592 Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the
17593 specified UNIX standard. The choices for unix-std are 93, 95 and
17594 98. 93 is supported on all HP-UX versions. 95 is available on HP-
17595 UX 10.10 and later. 98 is available on HP-UX 11.11 and later. The
17596 default values are 93 for HP-UX 10.00, 95 for HP-UX 10.10 though to
17597 11.00, and 98 for HP-UX 11.11 and later.
17598
17599 -munix=93 provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
17600 -munix=95 provides additional predefines for "XOPEN_UNIX" and
17601 "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED", and the startfile unix95.o. -munix=98
17602 provides additional predefines for "_XOPEN_UNIX",
17603 "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED", "_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE" and
17604 "_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500", and the startfile unix98.o.
17605
17606 It is important to note that this option changes the interfaces for
17607 various library routines. It also affects the operational behavior
17608 of the C library. Thus, extreme care is needed in using this
17609 option.
17610
17611 Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
17612 standard must test, set and restore the variable
17613 "__xpg4_extended_mask" as appropriate. Most GNU software doesn't
17614 provide this capability.
17615
17616 -nolibdld
17617 Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when
17618 the -static option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
17619
17620 -static
17621 The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
17622 libdld.sl. There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl. Thus,
17623 when the -static option is specified, special link options are
17624 needed to resolve this dependency.
17625
17626 On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
17627 link with libdld.sl when the -static option is specified. This
17628 causes the resulting binary to be dynamic. On the 64-bit port, the
17629 linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case. The
17630 -nolibdld option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from adding
17631 these link options.
17632
17633 -threads
17634 Add support for multithreading with the dce thread library under
17635 HP-UX. This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
17636 linker.
17637
17638 IA-64 Options
17639
17640 These are the -m options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
17641
17642 -mbig-endian
17643 Generate code for a big-endian target. This is the default for HP-
17644 UX.
17645
17646 -mlittle-endian
17647 Generate code for a little-endian target. This is the default for
17648 AIX5 and GNU/Linux.
17649
17650 -mgnu-as
17651 -mno-gnu-as
17652 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler. This is the
17653 default.
17654
17655 -mgnu-ld
17656 -mno-gnu-ld
17657 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker. This is the default.
17658
17659 -mno-pic
17660 Generate code that does not use a global pointer register. The
17661 result is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64
17662 ABI.
17663
17664 -mvolatile-asm-stop
17665 -mno-volatile-asm-stop
17666 Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after
17667 volatile asm statements.
17668
17669 -mregister-names
17670 -mno-register-names
17671 Generate (or don't) in, loc, and out register names for the stacked
17672 registers. This may make assembler output more readable.
17673
17674 -mno-sdata
17675 -msdata
17676 Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.
17677 This may be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
17678
17679 -mconstant-gp
17680 Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.
17681 This is useful when compiling kernel code.
17682
17683 -mauto-pic
17684 Generate code that is self-relocatable. This implies
17685 -mconstant-gp. This is useful when compiling firmware code.
17686
17687 -minline-float-divide-min-latency
17688 Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values using the
17689 minimum latency algorithm.
17690
17691 -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
17692 Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values using the
17693 maximum throughput algorithm.
17694
17695 -mno-inline-float-divide
17696 Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.
17697
17698 -minline-int-divide-min-latency
17699 Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the
17700 minimum latency algorithm.
17701
17702 -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
17703 Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the
17704 maximum throughput algorithm.
17705
17706 -mno-inline-int-divide
17707 Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.
17708
17709 -minline-sqrt-min-latency
17710 Generate code for inline square roots using the minimum latency
17711 algorithm.
17712
17713 -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
17714 Generate code for inline square roots using the maximum throughput
17715 algorithm.
17716
17717 -mno-inline-sqrt
17718 Do not generate inline code for "sqrt".
17719
17720 -mfused-madd
17721 -mno-fused-madd
17722 Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add or
17723 multiply/subtract instructions. The default is to use these
17724 instructions.
17725
17726 -mno-dwarf2-asm
17727 -mdwarf2-asm
17728 Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF line number
17729 debugging info. This may be useful when not using the GNU
17730 assembler.
17731
17732 -mearly-stop-bits
17733 -mno-early-stop-bits
17734 Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
17735 instruction that triggered the stop bit. This can improve
17736 instruction scheduling, but does not always do so.
17737
17738 -mfixed-range=register-range
17739 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
17740 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use.
17741 This is useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is
17742 specified as two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register
17743 ranges can be specified separated by a comma.
17744
17745 -mtls-size=tls-size
17746 Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets. Valid values are 14,
17747 22, and 64.
17748
17749 -mtune=cpu-type
17750 Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values
17751 are itanium, itanium1, merced, itanium2, and mckinley.
17752
17753 -milp32
17754 -mlp64
17755 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment. The 32-bit
17756 environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits. The 64-bit
17757 environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
17758 These are HP-UX specific flags.
17759
17760 -mno-sched-br-data-spec
17761 -msched-br-data-spec
17762 (Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload. This
17763 results in generation of "ld.a" instructions and the corresponding
17764 check instructions ("ld.c" / "chk.a"). The default setting is
17765 disabled.
17766
17767 -msched-ar-data-spec
17768 -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
17769 (En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload. This
17770 results in generation of "ld.a" instructions and the corresponding
17771 check instructions ("ld.c" / "chk.a"). The default setting is
17772 enabled.
17773
17774 -mno-sched-control-spec
17775 -msched-control-spec
17776 (Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling. This feature is
17777 available only during region scheduling (i.e. before reload). This
17778 results in generation of the "ld.s" instructions and the
17779 corresponding check instructions "chk.s". The default setting is
17780 disabled.
17781
17782 -msched-br-in-data-spec
17783 -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
17784 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are
17785 dependent on the data speculative loads before reload. This is
17786 effective only with -msched-br-data-spec enabled. The default
17787 setting is enabled.
17788
17789 -msched-ar-in-data-spec
17790 -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
17791 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are
17792 dependent on the data speculative loads after reload. This is
17793 effective only with -msched-ar-data-spec enabled. The default
17794 setting is enabled.
17795
17796 -msched-in-control-spec
17797 -mno-sched-in-control-spec
17798 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are
17799 dependent on the control speculative loads. This is effective only
17800 with -msched-control-spec enabled. The default setting is enabled.
17801
17802 -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
17803 -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
17804 If enabled, data-speculative instructions are chosen for schedule
17805 only if there are no other choices at the moment. This makes the
17806 use of the data speculation much more conservative. The default
17807 setting is disabled.
17808
17809 -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
17810 -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
17811 If enabled, control-speculative instructions are chosen for
17812 schedule only if there are no other choices at the moment. This
17813 makes the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
17814 The default setting is disabled.
17815
17816 -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
17817 -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
17818 If enabled, speculative dependencies are considered during
17819 computation of the instructions priorities. This makes the use of
17820 the speculation a bit more conservative. The default setting is
17821 disabled.
17822
17823 -msched-spec-ldc
17824 Use a simple data speculation check. This option is on by default.
17825
17826 -msched-control-spec-ldc
17827 Use a simple check for control speculation. This option is on by
17828 default.
17829
17830 -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
17831 Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling. This option is
17832 on by default.
17833
17834 -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
17835 Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause
17836 a conflict when placed into the same instruction group. This
17837 option is disabled by default.
17838
17839 -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
17840 Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.
17841 This flag is disabled by default.
17842
17843 -msched-max-memory-insns=max-insns
17844 Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving
17845 lower priority to subsequent memory insns attempting to schedule in
17846 the same instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank
17847 conflicts. The default value is 1.
17848
17849 -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
17850 Makes the limit specified by msched-max-memory-insns a hard limit,
17851 disallowing more than that number in an instruction group.
17852 Otherwise, the limit is "soft", meaning that non-memory operations
17853 are preferred when the limit is reached, but memory operations may
17854 still be scheduled.
17855
17856 LM32 Options
17857
17858 These -m options are defined for the LatticeMico32 architecture:
17859
17860 -mbarrel-shift-enabled
17861 Enable barrel-shift instructions.
17862
17863 -mdivide-enabled
17864 Enable divide and modulus instructions.
17865
17866 -mmultiply-enabled
17867 Enable multiply instructions.
17868
17869 -msign-extend-enabled
17870 Enable sign extend instructions.
17871
17872 -muser-enabled
17873 Enable user-defined instructions.
17874
17875 M32C Options
17876
17877 -mcpu=name
17878 Select the CPU for which code is generated. name may be one of r8c
17879 for the R8C/Tiny series, m16c for the M16C (up to /60) series,
17880 m32cm for the M16C/80 series, or m32c for the M32C/80 series.
17881
17882 -msim
17883 Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator. This
17884 causes an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports,
17885 for example, file I/O. You must not use this option when
17886 generating programs that will run on real hardware; you must
17887 provide your own runtime library for whatever I/O functions are
17888 needed.
17889
17890 -memregs=number
17891 Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC uses
17892 during code generation. These pseudo-registers are used like real
17893 registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
17894 code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
17895 memory instead of registers. Note that all modules in a program
17896 must be compiled with the same value for this option. Because of
17897 that, you must not use this option with GCC's default runtime
17898 libraries.
17899
17900 M32R/D Options
17901
17902 These -m options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
17903
17904 -m32r2
17905 Generate code for the M32R/2.
17906
17907 -m32rx
17908 Generate code for the M32R/X.
17909
17910 -m32r
17911 Generate code for the M32R. This is the default.
17912
17913 -mmodel=small
17914 Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their
17915 addresses can be loaded with the "ld24" instruction), and assume
17916 all subroutines are reachable with the "bl" instruction. This is
17917 the default.
17918
17919 The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
17920 "model" attribute.
17921
17922 -mmodel=medium
17923 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the
17924 compiler generates "seth/add3" instructions to load their
17925 addresses), and assume all subroutines are reachable with the "bl"
17926 instruction.
17927
17928 -mmodel=large
17929 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the
17930 compiler generates "seth/add3" instructions to load their
17931 addresses), and assume subroutines may not be reachable with the
17932 "bl" instruction (the compiler generates the much slower
17933 "seth/add3/jl" instruction sequence).
17934
17935 -msdata=none
17936 Disable use of the small data area. Variables are put into one of
17937 ".data", ".bss", or ".rodata" (unless the "section" attribute has
17938 been specified). This is the default.
17939
17940 The small data area consists of sections ".sdata" and ".sbss".
17941 Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
17942 "section" attribute using one of these sections.
17943
17944 -msdata=sdata
17945 Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
17946 generate special code to reference them.
17947
17948 -msdata=use
17949 Put small global and static data in the small data area, and
17950 generate special instructions to reference them.
17951
17952 -G num
17953 Put global and static objects less than or equal to num bytes into
17954 the small data or BSS sections instead of the normal data or BSS
17955 sections. The default value of num is 8. The -msdata option must
17956 be set to one of sdata or use for this option to have any effect.
17957
17958 All modules should be compiled with the same -G num value.
17959 Compiling with different values of num may or may not work; if it
17960 doesn't the linker gives an error message---incorrect code is not
17961 generated.
17962
17963 -mdebug
17964 Makes the M32R-specific code in the compiler display some
17965 statistics that might help in debugging programs.
17966
17967 -malign-loops
17968 Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
17969
17970 -mno-align-loops
17971 Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops. This is the default.
17972
17973 -missue-rate=number
17974 Issue number instructions per cycle. number can only be 1 or 2.
17975
17976 -mbranch-cost=number
17977 number can only be 1 or 2. If it is 1 then branches are preferred
17978 over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite applies.
17979
17980 -mflush-trap=number
17981 Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache. The default
17982 is 12. Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
17983
17984 -mno-flush-trap
17985 Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
17986
17987 -mflush-func=name
17988 Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to
17989 flush the cache. The default is _flush_cache, but a function call
17990 is only used if a trap is not available.
17991
17992 -mno-flush-func
17993 Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
17994
17995 M680x0 Options
17996
17997 These are the -m options defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.
17998 The default settings depend on which architecture was selected when the
17999 compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices are
18000 given below.
18001
18002 -march=arch
18003 Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set
18004 architecture. Permissible values of arch for M680x0 architectures
18005 are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and cpu32. ColdFire
18006 architectures are selected according to Freescale's ISA
18007 classification and the permissible values are: isaa, isaaplus, isab
18008 and isac.
18009
18010 GCC defines a macro "__mcfarch__" whenever it is generating code
18011 for a ColdFire target. The arch in this macro is one of the -march
18012 arguments given above.
18013
18014 When used together, -march and -mtune select code that runs on a
18015 family of similar processors but that is optimized for a particular
18016 microarchitecture.
18017
18018 -mcpu=cpu
18019 Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor. The
18020 M680x0 cpus are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060, 68302,
18021 68332 and cpu32. The ColdFire cpus are given by the table below,
18022 which also classifies the CPUs into families:
18023
18024 Family : -mcpu arguments
18025 51 : 51 51ac 51ag 51cn 51em 51je 51jf 51jg 51jm 51mm 51qe 51qm
18026 5206 : 5202 5204 5206
18027 5206e : 5206e
18028 5208 : 5207 5208
18029 5211a : 5210a 5211a
18030 5213 : 5211 5212 5213
18031 5216 : 5214 5216
18032 52235 : 52230 52231 52232 52233 52234 52235
18033 5225 : 5224 5225
18034 52259 : 52252 52254 52255 52256 52258 52259
18035 5235 : 5232 5233 5234 5235 523x
18036 5249 : 5249
18037 5250 : 5250
18038 5271 : 5270 5271
18039 5272 : 5272
18040 5275 : 5274 5275
18041 5282 : 5280 5281 5282 528x
18042 53017 : 53011 53012 53013 53014 53015 53016 53017
18043 5307 : 5307
18044 5329 : 5327 5328 5329 532x
18045 5373 : 5372 5373 537x
18046 5407 : 5407
18047 5475 : 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 547x 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484
18048 5485
18049
18050 -mcpu=cpu overrides -march=arch if arch is compatible with cpu.
18051 Other combinations of -mcpu and -march are rejected.
18052
18053 GCC defines the macro "__mcf_cpu_cpu" when ColdFire target cpu is
18054 selected. It also defines "__mcf_family_family", where the value
18055 of family is given by the table above.
18056
18057 -mtune=tune
18058 Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture within the
18059 constraints set by -march and -mcpu. The M680x0 microarchitectures
18060 are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and cpu32. The
18061 ColdFire microarchitectures are: cfv1, cfv2, cfv3, cfv4 and cfv4e.
18062
18063 You can also use -mtune=68020-40 for code that needs to run
18064 relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040 targets. -mtune=68020-60
18065 is similar but includes 68060 targets as well. These two options
18066 select the same tuning decisions as -m68020-40 and -m68020-60
18067 respectively.
18068
18069 GCC defines the macros "__mcarch" and "__mcarch__" when tuning for
18070 680x0 architecture arch. It also defines "mcarch" unless either
18071 -ansi or a non-GNU -std option is used. If GCC is tuning for a
18072 range of architectures, as selected by -mtune=68020-40 or
18073 -mtune=68020-60, it defines the macros for every architecture in
18074 the range.
18075
18076 GCC also defines the macro "__muarch__" when tuning for ColdFire
18077 microarchitecture uarch, where uarch is one of the arguments given
18078 above.
18079
18080 -m68000
18081 -mc68000
18082 Generate output for a 68000. This is the default when the compiler
18083 is configured for 68000-based systems. It is equivalent to
18084 -march=68000.
18085
18086 Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
18087 including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
18088
18089 -m68010
18090 Generate output for a 68010. This is the default when the compiler
18091 is configured for 68010-based systems. It is equivalent to
18092 -march=68010.
18093
18094 -m68020
18095 -mc68020
18096 Generate output for a 68020. This is the default when the compiler
18097 is configured for 68020-based systems. It is equivalent to
18098 -march=68020.
18099
18100 -m68030
18101 Generate output for a 68030. This is the default when the compiler
18102 is configured for 68030-based systems. It is equivalent to
18103 -march=68030.
18104
18105 -m68040
18106 Generate output for a 68040. This is the default when the compiler
18107 is configured for 68040-based systems. It is equivalent to
18108 -march=68040.
18109
18110 This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have
18111 to be emulated by software on the 68040. Use this option if your
18112 68040 does not have code to emulate those instructions.
18113
18114 -m68060
18115 Generate output for a 68060. This is the default when the compiler
18116 is configured for 68060-based systems. It is equivalent to
18117 -march=68060.
18118
18119 This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions
18120 that have to be emulated by software on the 68060. Use this option
18121 if your 68060 does not have code to emulate those instructions.
18122
18123 -mcpu32
18124 Generate output for a CPU32. This is the default when the compiler
18125 is configured for CPU32-based systems. It is equivalent to
18126 -march=cpu32.
18127
18128 Use this option for microcontrollers with a CPU32 or CPU32+ core,
18129 including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334, 68336, 68340,
18130 68341, 68349 and 68360.
18131
18132 -m5200
18133 Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU. This is the default when
18134 the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems. It is
18135 equivalent to -mcpu=5206, and is now deprecated in favor of that
18136 option.
18137
18138 Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including the
18139 MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5206.
18140
18141 -m5206e
18142 Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU. The option is now
18143 deprecated in favor of the equivalent -mcpu=5206e.
18144
18145 -m528x
18146 Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family. The
18147 option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent -mcpu=528x.
18148
18149 -m5307
18150 Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU. The option is now
18151 deprecated in favor of the equivalent -mcpu=5307.
18152
18153 -m5407
18154 Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU. The option is now
18155 deprecated in favor of the equivalent -mcpu=5407.
18156
18157 -mcfv4e
18158 Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU (e.g. 547x/548x).
18159 This includes use of hardware floating-point instructions. The
18160 option is equivalent to -mcpu=547x, and is now deprecated in favor
18161 of that option.
18162
18163 -m68020-40
18164 Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new
18165 instructions. This results in code that can run relatively
18166 efficiently on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The
18167 generated code does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on
18168 the 68040.
18169
18170 The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-40.
18171
18172 -m68020-60
18173 Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new
18174 instructions. This results in code that can run relatively
18175 efficiently on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The
18176 generated code does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on
18177 the 68060.
18178
18179 The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-60.
18180
18181 -mhard-float
18182 -m68881
18183 Generate floating-point instructions. This is the default for
18184 68020 and above, and for ColdFire devices that have an FPU. It
18185 defines the macro "__HAVE_68881__" on M680x0 targets and
18186 "__mcffpu__" on ColdFire targets.
18187
18188 -msoft-float
18189 Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls
18190 instead. This is the default for 68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.
18191 It is also the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.
18192
18193 -mdiv
18194 -mno-div
18195 Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder
18196 instructions. If -march is used without -mcpu, the default is "on"
18197 for ColdFire architectures and "off" for M680x0 architectures.
18198 Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU (either the
18199 default CPU, or the one specified by -mcpu). For example, the
18200 default is "off" for -mcpu=5206 and "on" for -mcpu=5206e.
18201
18202 GCC defines the macro "__mcfhwdiv__" when this option is enabled.
18203
18204 -mshort
18205 Consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide, like "short int".
18206 Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
18207 16-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to
18208 32-bit.
18209
18210 -mno-short
18211 Do not consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide. This is the
18212 default.
18213
18214 -mnobitfield
18215 -mno-bitfield
18216 Do not use the bit-field instructions. The -m68000, -mcpu32 and
18217 -m5200 options imply -mnobitfield.
18218
18219 -mbitfield
18220 Do use the bit-field instructions. The -m68020 option implies
18221 -mbitfield. This is the default if you use a configuration
18222 designed for a 68020.
18223
18224 -mrtd
18225 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
18226 that take a fixed number of arguments return with the "rtd"
18227 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This
18228 saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
18229 the arguments there.
18230
18231 This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally used
18232 on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
18233 compiled with the Unix compiler.
18234
18235 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
18236 take variable numbers of arguments (including "printf"); otherwise
18237 incorrect code is generated for calls to those functions.
18238
18239 In addition, seriously incorrect code results if you call a
18240 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
18241 harmlessly ignored.)
18242
18243 The "rtd" instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
18244 68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
18245
18246 The default is -mno-rtd.
18247
18248 -malign-int
18249 -mno-align-int
18250 Control whether GCC aligns "int", "long", "long long", "float",
18251 "double", and "long double" variables on a 32-bit boundary
18252 (-malign-int) or a 16-bit boundary (-mno-align-int). Aligning
18253 variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
18254 faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more
18255 memory.
18256
18257 Warning: if you use the -malign-int switch, GCC aligns structures
18258 containing the above types differently than most published
18259 application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
18260
18261 -mpcrel
18262 Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead
18263 of using a global offset table. At present, this option implies
18264 -fpic, allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.
18265 -fPIC is not presently supported with -mpcrel, though this could be
18266 supported for 68020 and higher processors.
18267
18268 -mno-strict-align
18269 -mstrict-align
18270 Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references are handled by
18271 the system.
18272
18273 -msep-data
18274 Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a
18275 different area of memory from the text segment. This allows for
18276 execute-in-place in an environment without virtual memory
18277 management. This option implies -fPIC.
18278
18279 -mno-sep-data
18280 Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text
18281 segment. This is the default.
18282
18283 -mid-shared-library
18284 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID
18285 method. This allows for execute-in-place and shared libraries in
18286 an environment without virtual memory management. This option
18287 implies -fPIC.
18288
18289 -mno-id-shared-library
18290 Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are
18291 being used. This is the default.
18292
18293 -mshared-library-id=n
18294 Specifies the identification number of the ID-based shared library
18295 being compiled. Specifying a value of 0 generates more compact
18296 code; specifying other values forces the allocation of that number
18297 to the current library, but is no more space- or time-efficient
18298 than omitting this option.
18299
18300 -mxgot
18301 -mno-xgot
18302 When generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate
18303 code that works if the GOT has more than 8192 entries. This code
18304 is larger and slower than code generated without this option. On
18305 M680x0 processors, this option is not needed; -fPIC suffices.
18306
18307 GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT.
18308 While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT is
18309 smaller than about 64k. Anything larger causes the linker to
18310 report an error such as:
18311
18312 relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar
18313
18314 If this happens, you should recompile your code with -mxgot. It
18315 should then work with very large GOTs. However, code generated
18316 with -mxgot is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to
18317 fetch the value of a global symbol.
18318
18319 Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker,
18320 can create multiple GOTs and sort GOT entries. If you have such a
18321 linker, you should only need to use -mxgot when compiling a single
18322 object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries. Very few do.
18323
18324 These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position-
18325 independent code.
18326
18327 -mlong-jump-table-offsets
18328 Use 32-bit offsets in "switch" tables. The default is to use
18329 16-bit offsets.
18330
18331 MCore Options
18332
18333 These are the -m options defined for the Motorola M*Core processors.
18334
18335 -mhardlit
18336 -mno-hardlit
18337 Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
18338 instructions or less.
18339
18340 -mdiv
18341 -mno-div
18342 Use the divide instruction. (Enabled by default).
18343
18344 -mrelax-immediate
18345 -mno-relax-immediate
18346 Allow arbitrary-sized immediates in bit operations.
18347
18348 -mwide-bitfields
18349 -mno-wide-bitfields
18350 Always treat bit-fields as "int"-sized.
18351
18352 -m4byte-functions
18353 -mno-4byte-functions
18354 Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.
18355
18356 -mcallgraph-data
18357 -mno-callgraph-data
18358 Emit callgraph information.
18359
18360 -mslow-bytes
18361 -mno-slow-bytes
18362 Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
18363
18364 -mlittle-endian
18365 -mbig-endian
18366 Generate code for a little-endian target.
18367
18368 -m210
18369 -m340
18370 Generate code for the 210 processor.
18371
18372 -mno-lsim
18373 Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the
18374 simulator library (libsim.a) from the linker command line.
18375
18376 -mstack-increment=size
18377 Set the maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.
18378 Large values can increase the speed of programs that contain
18379 functions that need a large amount of stack space, but they can
18380 also trigger a segmentation fault if the stack is extended too
18381 much. The default value is 0x1000.
18382
18383 MeP Options
18384
18385 -mabsdiff
18386 Enables the "abs" instruction, which is the absolute difference
18387 between two registers.
18388
18389 -mall-opts
18390 Enables all the optional instructions---average, multiply, divide,
18391 bit operations, leading zero, absolute difference, min/max, clip,
18392 and saturation.
18393
18394 -maverage
18395 Enables the "ave" instruction, which computes the average of two
18396 registers.
18397
18398 -mbased=n
18399 Variables of size n bytes or smaller are placed in the ".based"
18400 section by default. Based variables use the $tp register as a base
18401 register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the ".based" section.
18402
18403 -mbitops
18404 Enables the bit operation instructions---bit test ("btstm"), set
18405 ("bsetm"), clear ("bclrm"), invert ("bnotm"), and test-and-set
18406 ("tas").
18407
18408 -mc=name
18409 Selects which section constant data is placed in. name may be
18410 tiny, near, or far.
18411
18412 -mclip
18413 Enables the "clip" instruction. Note that -mclip is not useful
18414 unless you also provide -mminmax.
18415
18416 -mconfig=name
18417 Selects one of the built-in core configurations. Each MeP chip has
18418 one or more modules in it; each module has a core CPU and a variety
18419 of coprocessors, optional instructions, and peripherals. The
18420 "MeP-Integrator" tool, not part of GCC, provides these
18421 configurations through this option; using this option is the same
18422 as using all the corresponding command-line options. The default
18423 configuration is default.
18424
18425 -mcop
18426 Enables the coprocessor instructions. By default, this is a 32-bit
18427 coprocessor. Note that the coprocessor is normally enabled via the
18428 -mconfig= option.
18429
18430 -mcop32
18431 Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.
18432
18433 -mcop64
18434 Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.
18435
18436 -mivc2
18437 Enables IVC2 scheduling. IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.
18438
18439 -mdc
18440 Causes constant variables to be placed in the ".near" section.
18441
18442 -mdiv
18443 Enables the "div" and "divu" instructions.
18444
18445 -meb
18446 Generate big-endian code.
18447
18448 -mel
18449 Generate little-endian code.
18450
18451 -mio-volatile
18452 Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the "io" attribute
18453 is to be considered volatile.
18454
18455 -ml Causes variables to be assigned to the ".far" section by default.
18456
18457 -mleadz
18458 Enables the "leadz" (leading zero) instruction.
18459
18460 -mm Causes variables to be assigned to the ".near" section by default.
18461
18462 -mminmax
18463 Enables the "min" and "max" instructions.
18464
18465 -mmult
18466 Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.
18467
18468 -mno-opts
18469 Disables all the optional instructions enabled by -mall-opts.
18470
18471 -mrepeat
18472 Enables the "repeat" and "erepeat" instructions, used for low-
18473 overhead looping.
18474
18475 -ms Causes all variables to default to the ".tiny" section. Note that
18476 there is a 65536-byte limit to this section. Accesses to these
18477 variables use the %gp base register.
18478
18479 -msatur
18480 Enables the saturation instructions. Note that the compiler does
18481 not currently generate these itself, but this option is included
18482 for compatibility with other tools, like "as".
18483
18484 -msdram
18485 Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based
18486 runtime.
18487
18488 -msim
18489 Link the simulator run-time libraries.
18490
18491 -msimnovec
18492 Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support
18493 for reset and exception vectors and tables.
18494
18495 -mtf
18496 Causes all functions to default to the ".far" section. Without
18497 this option, functions default to the ".near" section.
18498
18499 -mtiny=n
18500 Variables that are n bytes or smaller are allocated to the ".tiny"
18501 section. These variables use the $gp base register. The default
18502 for this option is 4, but note that there's a 65536-byte limit to
18503 the ".tiny" section.
18504
18505 MicroBlaze Options
18506
18507 -msoft-float
18508 Use software emulation for floating point (default).
18509
18510 -mhard-float
18511 Use hardware floating-point instructions.
18512
18513 -mmemcpy
18514 Do not optimize block moves, use "memcpy".
18515
18516 -mno-clearbss
18517 This option is deprecated. Use -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
18518 instead.
18519
18520 -mcpu=cpu-type
18521 Use features of, and schedule code for, the given CPU. Supported
18522 values are in the format vX.YY.Z, where X is a major version, YY is
18523 the minor version, and Z is compatibility code. Example values are
18524 v3.00.a, v4.00.b, v5.00.a, v5.00.b, v6.00.a.
18525
18526 -mxl-soft-mul
18527 Use software multiply emulation (default).
18528
18529 -mxl-soft-div
18530 Use software emulation for divides (default).
18531
18532 -mxl-barrel-shift
18533 Use the hardware barrel shifter.
18534
18535 -mxl-pattern-compare
18536 Use pattern compare instructions.
18537
18538 -msmall-divides
18539 Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.
18540
18541 -mxl-stack-check
18542 This option is deprecated. Use -fstack-check instead.
18543
18544 -mxl-gp-opt
18545 Use GP-relative ".sdata"/".sbss" sections.
18546
18547 -mxl-multiply-high
18548 Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.
18549
18550 -mxl-float-convert
18551 Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.
18552
18553 -mxl-float-sqrt
18554 Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.
18555
18556 -mbig-endian
18557 Generate code for a big-endian target.
18558
18559 -mlittle-endian
18560 Generate code for a little-endian target.
18561
18562 -mxl-reorder
18563 Use reorder instructions (swap and byte reversed load/store).
18564
18565 -mxl-mode-app-model
18566 Select application model app-model. Valid models are
18567
18568 executable
18569 normal executable (default), uses startup code crt0.o.
18570
18571 -mpic-data-is-text-relative
18572 Assume that the displacement between the text and data segments
18573 is fixed at static link time. This allows data to be
18574 referenced by offset from start of text address instead of GOT
18575 since PC-relative addressing is not supported.
18576
18577 xmdstub
18578 for use with Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based
18579 software intrusive debug agent called xmdstub. This uses
18580 startup file crt1.o and sets the start address of the program
18581 to 0x800.
18582
18583 bootstrap
18584 for applications that are loaded using a bootloader. This
18585 model uses startup file crt2.o which does not contain a
18586 processor reset vector handler. This is suitable for
18587 transferring control on a processor reset to the bootloader
18588 rather than the application.
18589
18590 novectors
18591 for applications that do not require any of the MicroBlaze
18592 vectors. This option may be useful for applications running
18593 within a monitoring application. This model uses crt3.o as a
18594 startup file.
18595
18596 Option -xl-mode-app-model is a deprecated alias for -mxl-mode-app-
18597 model.
18598
18599 MIPS Options
18600
18601 -EB Generate big-endian code.
18602
18603 -EL Generate little-endian code. This is the default for mips*el-*-*
18604 configurations.
18605
18606 -march=arch
18607 Generate code that runs on arch, which can be the name of a generic
18608 MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor. The ISA names
18609 are: mips1, mips2, mips3, mips4, mips32, mips32r2, mips32r3,
18610 mips32r5, mips32r6, mips64, mips64r2, mips64r3, mips64r5 and
18611 mips64r6. The processor names are: 4kc, 4km, 4kp, 4ksc, 4kec,
18612 4kem, 4kep, 4ksd, 5kc, 5kf, 20kc, 24kc, 24kf2_1, 24kf1_1, 24kec,
18613 24kef2_1, 24kef1_1, 34kc, 34kf2_1, 34kf1_1, 34kn, 74kc, 74kf2_1,
18614 74kf1_1, 74kf3_2, 1004kc, 1004kf2_1, 1004kf1_1, i6400, i6500,
18615 interaptiv, loongson2e, loongson2f, loongson3a, gs464, gs464e,
18616 gs264e, m4k, m14k, m14kc, m14ke, m14kec, m5100, m5101, octeon,
18617 octeon+, octeon2, octeon3, orion, p5600, p6600, r2000, r3000,
18618 r3900, r4000, r4400, r4600, r4650, r4700, r5900, r6000, r8000,
18619 rm7000, rm9000, r10000, r12000, r14000, r16000, sb1, sr71000,
18620 vr4100, vr4111, vr4120, vr4130, vr4300, vr5000, vr5400, vr5500, xlr
18621 and xlp. The special value from-abi selects the most compatible
18622 architecture for the selected ABI (that is, mips1 for 32-bit ABIs
18623 and mips3 for 64-bit ABIs).
18624
18625 The native Linux/GNU toolchain also supports the value native,
18626 which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
18627 -march=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the
18628 processor.
18629
18630 In processor names, a final 000 can be abbreviated as k (for
18631 example, -march=r2k). Prefixes are optional, and vr may be written
18632 r.
18633
18634 Names of the form nf2_1 refer to processors with FPUs clocked at
18635 half the rate of the core, names of the form nf1_1 refer to
18636 processors with FPUs clocked at the same rate as the core, and
18637 names of the form nf3_2 refer to processors with FPUs clocked a
18638 ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core. For compatibility reasons,
18639 nf is accepted as a synonym for nf2_1 while nx and bfx are accepted
18640 as synonyms for nf1_1.
18641
18642 GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option. The
18643 first is "_MIPS_ARCH", which gives the name of target architecture,
18644 as a string. The second has the form "_MIPS_ARCH_foo", where foo
18645 is the capitalized value of "_MIPS_ARCH". For example,
18646 -march=r2000 sets "_MIPS_ARCH" to "r2000" and defines the macro
18647 "_MIPS_ARCH_R2000".
18648
18649 Note that the "_MIPS_ARCH" macro uses the processor names given
18650 above. In other words, it has the full prefix and does not
18651 abbreviate 000 as k. In the case of from-abi, the macro names the
18652 resolved architecture (either "mips1" or "mips3"). It names the
18653 default architecture when no -march option is given.
18654
18655 -mtune=arch
18656 Optimize for arch. Among other things, this option controls the
18657 way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of
18658 arithmetic operations. The list of arch values is the same as for
18659 -march.
18660
18661 When this option is not used, GCC optimizes for the processor
18662 specified by -march. By using -march and -mtune together, it is
18663 possible to generate code that runs on a family of processors, but
18664 optimize the code for one particular member of that family.
18665
18666 -mtune defines the macros "_MIPS_TUNE" and "_MIPS_TUNE_foo", which
18667 work in the same way as the -march ones described above.
18668
18669 -mips1
18670 Equivalent to -march=mips1.
18671
18672 -mips2
18673 Equivalent to -march=mips2.
18674
18675 -mips3
18676 Equivalent to -march=mips3.
18677
18678 -mips4
18679 Equivalent to -march=mips4.
18680
18681 -mips32
18682 Equivalent to -march=mips32.
18683
18684 -mips32r3
18685 Equivalent to -march=mips32r3.
18686
18687 -mips32r5
18688 Equivalent to -march=mips32r5.
18689
18690 -mips32r6
18691 Equivalent to -march=mips32r6.
18692
18693 -mips64
18694 Equivalent to -march=mips64.
18695
18696 -mips64r2
18697 Equivalent to -march=mips64r2.
18698
18699 -mips64r3
18700 Equivalent to -march=mips64r3.
18701
18702 -mips64r5
18703 Equivalent to -march=mips64r5.
18704
18705 -mips64r6
18706 Equivalent to -march=mips64r6.
18707
18708 -mips16
18709 -mno-mips16
18710 Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code. If GCC is targeting a
18711 MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it makes use of the MIPS16e ASE.
18712
18713 MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a per-function
18714 basis by means of "mips16" and "nomips16" attributes.
18715
18716 -mflip-mips16
18717 Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions. This option is
18718 provided for regression testing of mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code
18719 generation, and is not intended for ordinary use in compiling user
18720 code.
18721
18722 -minterlink-compressed
18723 -mno-interlink-compressed
18724 Require (do not require) that code using the standard
18725 (uncompressed) MIPS ISA be link-compatible with MIPS16 and
18726 microMIPS code, and vice versa.
18727
18728 For example, code using the standard ISA encoding cannot jump
18729 directly to MIPS16 or microMIPS code; it must either use a call or
18730 an indirect jump. -minterlink-compressed therefore disables direct
18731 jumps unless GCC knows that the target of the jump is not
18732 compressed.
18733
18734 -minterlink-mips16
18735 -mno-interlink-mips16
18736 Aliases of -minterlink-compressed and -mno-interlink-compressed.
18737 These options predate the microMIPS ASE and are retained for
18738 backwards compatibility.
18739
18740 -mabi=32
18741 -mabi=o64
18742 -mabi=n32
18743 -mabi=64
18744 -mabi=eabi
18745 Generate code for the given ABI.
18746
18747 Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant. GCC normally
18748 generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but
18749 you can use -mgp32 to get 32-bit code instead.
18750
18751 For information about the O64 ABI, see
18752 <http://gcc.gnu.org/projects/mipso64-abi.html>.
18753
18754 GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point
18755 registers are 64 rather than 32 bits wide. You can select this
18756 combination with -mabi=32 -mfp64. This ABI relies on the "mthc1"
18757 and "mfhc1" instructions and is therefore only supported for
18758 MIPS32R2, MIPS32R3 and MIPS32R5 processors.
18759
18760 The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the
18761 same, but each scalar value is passed in a single 64-bit register
18762 rather than a pair of 32-bit registers. For example, scalar
18763 floating-point values are returned in $f0 only, not a $f0/$f1 pair.
18764 The set of call-saved registers also remains the same in that the
18765 even-numbered double-precision registers are saved.
18766
18767 Two additional variants of the o32 ABI are supported to enable a
18768 transition from 32-bit to 64-bit registers. These are FPXX
18769 (-mfpxx) and FP64A (-mfp64 -mno-odd-spreg). The FPXX extension
18770 mandates that all code must execute correctly when run using 32-bit
18771 or 64-bit registers. The code can be interlinked with either FP32
18772 or FP64, but not both. The FP64A extension is similar to the FP64
18773 extension but forbids the use of odd-numbered single-precision
18774 registers. This can be used in conjunction with the "FRE" mode of
18775 FPUs in MIPS32R5 processors and allows both FP32 and FP64A code to
18776 interlink and run in the same process without changing FPU modes.
18777
18778 -mabicalls
18779 -mno-abicalls
18780 Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
18781 dynamic objects. -mabicalls is the default for SVR4-based systems.
18782
18783 -mshared
18784 -mno-shared
18785 Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
18786 and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries. This
18787 option only affects -mabicalls.
18788
18789 All -mabicalls code has traditionally been position-independent,
18790 regardless of options like -fPIC and -fpic. However, as an
18791 extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
18792 accesses for locally-binding symbols. It can also use shorter GP
18793 initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-
18794 defined functions. This mode is selected by -mno-shared.
18795
18796 -mno-shared depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
18797 objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker. However, the
18798 option does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only
18799 affects the ABI of relocatable objects. Using -mno-shared
18800 generally makes executables both smaller and quicker.
18801
18802 -mshared is the default.
18803
18804 -mplt
18805 -mno-plt
18806 Assume (do not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers support
18807 PLTs and copy relocations. This option only affects -mno-shared
18808 -mabicalls. For the n64 ABI, this option has no effect without
18809 -msym32.
18810
18811 You can make -mplt the default by configuring GCC with
18812 --with-mips-plt. The default is -mno-plt otherwise.
18813
18814 -mxgot
18815 -mno-xgot
18816 Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
18817 offset table.
18818
18819 GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT.
18820 While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT is
18821 smaller than about 64k. Anything larger causes the linker to
18822 report an error such as:
18823
18824 relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
18825
18826 If this happens, you should recompile your code with -mxgot. This
18827 works with very large GOTs, although the code is also less
18828 efficient, since it takes three instructions to fetch the value of
18829 a global symbol.
18830
18831 Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs. If you have such
18832 a linker, you should only need to use -mxgot when a single object
18833 file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries. Very few do.
18834
18835 These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
18836 independent code.
18837
18838 -mgp32
18839 Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
18840
18841 -mgp64
18842 Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
18843
18844 -mfp32
18845 Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
18846
18847 -mfp64
18848 Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
18849
18850 -mfpxx
18851 Do not assume the width of floating-point registers.
18852
18853 -mhard-float
18854 Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
18855
18856 -msoft-float
18857 Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions. Implement
18858 floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
18859
18860 -mno-float
18861 Equivalent to -msoft-float, but additionally asserts that the
18862 program being compiled does not perform any floating-point
18863 operations. This option is presently supported only by some bare-
18864 metal MIPS configurations, where it may select a special set of
18865 libraries that lack all floating-point support (including, for
18866 example, the floating-point "printf" formats). If code compiled
18867 with -mno-float accidentally contains floating-point operations, it
18868 is likely to suffer a link-time or run-time failure.
18869
18870 -msingle-float
18871 Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-
18872 precision operations.
18873
18874 -mdouble-float
18875 Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-
18876 precision operations. This is the default.
18877
18878 -modd-spreg
18879 -mno-odd-spreg
18880 Enable the use of odd-numbered single-precision floating-point
18881 registers for the o32 ABI. This is the default for processors that
18882 are known to support these registers. When using the o32 FPXX ABI,
18883 -mno-odd-spreg is set by default.
18884
18885 -mabs=2008
18886 -mabs=legacy
18887 These options control the treatment of the special not-a-number
18888 (NaN) IEEE 754 floating-point data with the "abs.fmt" and "neg.fmt"
18889 machine instructions.
18890
18891 By default or when -mabs=legacy is used the legacy treatment is
18892 selected. In this case these instructions are considered
18893 arithmetic and avoided where correct operation is required and the
18894 input operand might be a NaN. A longer sequence of instructions
18895 that manipulate the sign bit of floating-point datum manually is
18896 used instead unless the -ffinite-math-only option has also been
18897 specified.
18898
18899 The -mabs=2008 option selects the IEEE 754-2008 treatment. In this
18900 case these instructions are considered non-arithmetic and therefore
18901 operating correctly in all cases, including in particular where the
18902 input operand is a NaN. These instructions are therefore always
18903 used for the respective operations.
18904
18905 -mnan=2008
18906 -mnan=legacy
18907 These options control the encoding of the special not-a-number
18908 (NaN) IEEE 754 floating-point data.
18909
18910 The -mnan=legacy option selects the legacy encoding. In this case
18911 quiet NaNs (qNaNs) are denoted by the first bit of their trailing
18912 significand field being 0, whereas signaling NaNs (sNaNs) are
18913 denoted by the first bit of their trailing significand field being
18914 1.
18915
18916 The -mnan=2008 option selects the IEEE 754-2008 encoding. In this
18917 case qNaNs are denoted by the first bit of their trailing
18918 significand field being 1, whereas sNaNs are denoted by the first
18919 bit of their trailing significand field being 0.
18920
18921 The default is -mnan=legacy unless GCC has been configured with
18922 --with-nan=2008.
18923
18924 -mllsc
18925 -mno-llsc
18926 Use (do not use) ll, sc, and sync instructions to implement atomic
18927 memory built-in functions. When neither option is specified, GCC
18928 uses the instructions if the target architecture supports them.
18929
18930 -mllsc is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the
18931 instructions and -mno-llsc can be useful when compiling for
18932 nonstandard ISAs. You can make either option the default by
18933 configuring GCC with --with-llsc and --without-llsc respectively.
18934 --with-llsc is the default for some configurations; see the
18935 installation documentation for details.
18936
18937 -mdsp
18938 -mno-dsp
18939 Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
18940 This option defines the preprocessor macro "__mips_dsp". It also
18941 defines "__mips_dsp_rev" to 1.
18942
18943 -mdspr2
18944 -mno-dspr2
18945 Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
18946 This option defines the preprocessor macros "__mips_dsp" and
18947 "__mips_dspr2". It also defines "__mips_dsp_rev" to 2.
18948
18949 -msmartmips
18950 -mno-smartmips
18951 Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.
18952
18953 -mpaired-single
18954 -mno-paired-single
18955 Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
18956 This option requires hardware floating-point support to be
18957 enabled.
18958
18959 -mdmx
18960 -mno-mdmx
18961 Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions. This
18962 option can only be used when generating 64-bit code and requires
18963 hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
18964
18965 -mips3d
18966 -mno-mips3d
18967 Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE. The option -mips3d implies
18968 -mpaired-single.
18969
18970 -mmicromips
18971 -mno-micromips
18972 Generate (do not generate) microMIPS code.
18973
18974 MicroMIPS code generation can also be controlled on a per-function
18975 basis by means of "micromips" and "nomicromips" attributes.
18976
18977 -mmt
18978 -mno-mt
18979 Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.
18980
18981 -mmcu
18982 -mno-mcu
18983 Use (do not use) the MIPS MCU ASE instructions.
18984
18985 -meva
18986 -mno-eva
18987 Use (do not use) the MIPS Enhanced Virtual Addressing instructions.
18988
18989 -mvirt
18990 -mno-virt
18991 Use (do not use) the MIPS Virtualization (VZ) instructions.
18992
18993 -mxpa
18994 -mno-xpa
18995 Use (do not use) the MIPS eXtended Physical Address (XPA)
18996 instructions.
18997
18998 -mcrc
18999 -mno-crc
19000 Use (do not use) the MIPS Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC)
19001 instructions.
19002
19003 -mginv
19004 -mno-ginv
19005 Use (do not use) the MIPS Global INValidate (GINV) instructions.
19006
19007 -mloongson-mmi
19008 -mno-loongson-mmi
19009 Use (do not use) the MIPS Loongson MultiMedia extensions
19010 Instructions (MMI).
19011
19012 -mloongson-ext
19013 -mno-loongson-ext
19014 Use (do not use) the MIPS Loongson EXTensions (EXT) instructions.
19015
19016 -mloongson-ext2
19017 -mno-loongson-ext2
19018 Use (do not use) the MIPS Loongson EXTensions r2 (EXT2)
19019 instructions.
19020
19021 -mlong64
19022 Force "long" types to be 64 bits wide. See -mlong32 for an
19023 explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
19024 determined.
19025
19026 -mlong32
19027 Force "long", "int", and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
19028
19029 The default size of "int"s, "long"s and pointers depends on the
19030 ABI. All the supported ABIs use 32-bit "int"s. The n64 ABI uses
19031 64-bit "long"s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use 32-bit
19032 "long"s. Pointers are the same size as "long"s, or the same size
19033 as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
19034
19035 -msym32
19036 -mno-sym32
19037 Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values,
19038 regardless of the selected ABI. This option is useful in
19039 combination with -mabi=64 and -mno-abicalls because it allows GCC
19040 to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
19041
19042 -G num
19043 Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
19044 if that data is no bigger than num bytes. GCC can then generate
19045 more efficient accesses to the data; see -mgpopt for details.
19046
19047 The default -G option depends on the configuration.
19048
19049 -mlocal-sdata
19050 -mno-local-sdata
19051 Extend (do not extend) the -G behavior to local data too, such as
19052 to static variables in C. -mlocal-sdata is the default for all
19053 configurations.
19054
19055 If the linker complains that an application is using too much small
19056 data, you might want to try rebuilding the less performance-
19057 critical parts with -mno-local-sdata. You might also want to build
19058 large libraries with -mno-local-sdata, so that the libraries leave
19059 more room for the main program.
19060
19061 -mextern-sdata
19062 -mno-extern-sdata
19063 Assume (do not assume) that externally-defined data is in a small
19064 data section if the size of that data is within the -G limit.
19065 -mextern-sdata is the default for all configurations.
19066
19067 If you compile a module Mod with -mextern-sdata -G num -mgpopt, and
19068 Mod references a variable Var that is no bigger than num bytes, you
19069 must make sure that Var is placed in a small data section. If Var
19070 is defined by another module, you must either compile that module
19071 with a high-enough -G setting or attach a "section" attribute to
19072 Var's definition. If Var is common, you must link the application
19073 with a high-enough -G setting.
19074
19075 The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile and
19076 link every module with the same -G option. However, you may wish
19077 to build a library that supports several different small data
19078 limits. You can do this by compiling the library with the highest
19079 supported -G setting and additionally using -mno-extern-sdata to
19080 stop the library from making assumptions about externally-defined
19081 data.
19082
19083 -mgpopt
19084 -mno-gpopt
19085 Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to
19086 be in a small data section; see -G, -mlocal-sdata and
19087 -mextern-sdata. -mgpopt is the default for all configurations.
19088
19089 -mno-gpopt is useful for cases where the $gp register might not
19090 hold the value of "_gp". For example, if the code is part of a
19091 library that might be used in a boot monitor, programs that call
19092 boot monitor routines pass an unknown value in $gp. (In such
19093 situations, the boot monitor itself is usually compiled with -G0.)
19094
19095 -mno-gpopt implies -mno-local-sdata and -mno-extern-sdata.
19096
19097 -membedded-data
19098 -mno-embedded-data
19099 Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible,
19100 then next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data.
19101 This gives slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the
19102 amount of RAM required when executing, and thus may be preferred
19103 for some embedded systems.
19104
19105 -muninit-const-in-rodata
19106 -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
19107 Put uninitialized "const" variables in the read-only data section.
19108 This option is only meaningful in conjunction with -membedded-data.
19109
19110 -mcode-readable=setting
19111 Specify whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable
19112 sections. There are three possible settings:
19113
19114 -mcode-readable=yes
19115 Instructions may freely access executable sections. This is
19116 the default setting.
19117
19118 -mcode-readable=pcrel
19119 MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable
19120 sections, but other instructions must not do so. This option
19121 is useful on 4KSc and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have
19122 the Read Inhibit bit set. It is also useful on processors that
19123 can be configured to have a dual instruction/data SRAM
19124 interface and that, like the M4K, automatically redirect PC-
19125 relative loads to the instruction RAM.
19126
19127 -mcode-readable=no
19128 Instructions must not access executable sections. This option
19129 can be useful on targets that are configured to have a dual
19130 instruction/data SRAM interface but that (unlike the M4K) do
19131 not automatically redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction
19132 RAM.
19133
19134 -msplit-addresses
19135 -mno-split-addresses
19136 Enable (disable) use of the "%hi()" and "%lo()" assembler
19137 relocation operators. This option has been superseded by
19138 -mexplicit-relocs but is retained for backwards compatibility.
19139
19140 -mexplicit-relocs
19141 -mno-explicit-relocs
19142 Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with
19143 symbolic addresses. The alternative, selected by
19144 -mno-explicit-relocs, is to use assembler macros instead.
19145
19146 -mexplicit-relocs is the default if GCC was configured to use an
19147 assembler that supports relocation operators.
19148
19149 -mcheck-zero-division
19150 -mno-check-zero-division
19151 Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.
19152
19153 The default is -mcheck-zero-division.
19154
19155 -mdivide-traps
19156 -mdivide-breaks
19157 MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
19158 conditional trap or a break instruction. Using traps results in
19159 smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later. Also,
19160 some versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap
19161 from generating the proper signal ("SIGFPE"). Use -mdivide-traps
19162 to allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
19163 -mdivide-breaks to force the use of breaks.
19164
19165 The default is usually -mdivide-traps, but this can be overridden
19166 at configure time using --with-divide=breaks. Divide-by-zero
19167 checks can be completely disabled using -mno-check-zero-division.
19168
19169 -mload-store-pairs
19170 -mno-load-store-pairs
19171 Enable (disable) an optimization that pairs consecutive load or
19172 store instructions to enable load/store bonding. This option is
19173 enabled by default but only takes effect when the selected
19174 architecture is known to support bonding.
19175
19176 -mmemcpy
19177 -mno-memcpy
19178 Force (do not force) the use of "memcpy" for non-trivial block
19179 moves. The default is -mno-memcpy, which allows GCC to inline most
19180 constant-sized copies.
19181
19182 -mlong-calls
19183 -mno-long-calls
19184 Disable (do not disable) use of the "jal" instruction. Calling
19185 functions using "jal" is more efficient but requires the caller and
19186 callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
19187
19188 This option has no effect on abicalls code. The default is
19189 -mno-long-calls.
19190
19191 -mmad
19192 -mno-mad
19193 Enable (disable) use of the "mad", "madu" and "mul" instructions,
19194 as provided by the R4650 ISA.
19195
19196 -mimadd
19197 -mno-imadd
19198 Enable (disable) use of the "madd" and "msub" integer instructions.
19199 The default is -mimadd on architectures that support "madd" and
19200 "msub" except for the 74k architecture where it was found to
19201 generate slower code.
19202
19203 -mfused-madd
19204 -mno-fused-madd
19205 Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate
19206 instructions, when they are available. The default is
19207 -mfused-madd.
19208
19209 On the R8000 CPU when multiply-accumulate instructions are used,
19210 the intermediate product is calculated to infinite precision and is
19211 not subject to the FCSR Flush to Zero bit. This may be undesirable
19212 in some circumstances. On other processors the result is
19213 numerically identical to the equivalent computation using separate
19214 multiply, add, subtract and negate instructions.
19215
19216 -nocpp
19217 Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
19218 assembler files (with a .s suffix) when assembling them.
19219
19220 -mfix-24k
19221 -mno-fix-24k
19222 Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.
19223 The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by
19224 GCC.
19225
19226 -mfix-r4000
19227 -mno-fix-r4000
19228 Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
19229
19230 - A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result
19231 if executed immediately after starting an integer division.
19232
19233 - A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result
19234 if executed while an integer multiplication is in progress.
19235
19236 - An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in
19237 a delay slot of a taken branch or a jump.
19238
19239 -mfix-r4400
19240 -mno-fix-r4400
19241 Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
19242
19243 - A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result
19244 if executed immediately after starting an integer division.
19245
19246 -mfix-r10000
19247 -mno-fix-r10000
19248 Work around certain R10000 errata:
19249
19250 - "ll"/"sc" sequences may not behave atomically on revisions
19251 prior to 3.0. They may deadlock on revisions 2.6 and earlier.
19252
19253 This option can only be used if the target architecture supports
19254 branch-likely instructions. -mfix-r10000 is the default when
19255 -march=r10000 is used; -mno-fix-r10000 is the default otherwise.
19256
19257 -mfix-r5900
19258 -mno-fix-r5900
19259 Do not attempt to schedule the preceding instruction into the delay
19260 slot of a branch instruction placed at the end of a short loop of
19261 six instructions or fewer and always schedule a "nop" instruction
19262 there instead. The short loop bug under certain conditions causes
19263 loops to execute only once or twice, due to a hardware bug in the
19264 R5900 chip. The workaround is implemented by the assembler rather
19265 than by GCC.
19266
19267 -mfix-rm7000
19268 -mno-fix-rm7000
19269 Work around the RM7000 "dmult"/"dmultu" errata. The workarounds
19270 are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC.
19271
19272 -mfix-vr4120
19273 -mno-fix-vr4120
19274 Work around certain VR4120 errata:
19275
19276 - "dmultu" does not always produce the correct result.
19277
19278 - "div" and "ddiv" do not always produce the correct result if
19279 one of the operands is negative.
19280
19281 The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions
19282 in libgcc.a. At present, these functions are only provided by the
19283 "mips64vr*-elf" configurations.
19284
19285 Other VR4120 errata require a NOP to be inserted between certain
19286 pairs of instructions. These errata are handled by the assembler,
19287 not by GCC itself.
19288
19289 -mfix-vr4130
19290 Work around the VR4130 "mflo"/"mfhi" errata. The workarounds are
19291 implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC, although GCC
19292 avoids using "mflo" and "mfhi" if the VR4130 "macc", "macchi",
19293 "dmacc" and "dmacchi" instructions are available instead.
19294
19295 -mfix-sb1
19296 -mno-fix-sb1
19297 Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata. (This flag currently
19298 works around the SB-1 revision 2 "F1" and "F2" floating-point
19299 errata.)
19300
19301 -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting
19302 Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the side
19303 effects of speculation on R10K processors.
19304
19305 In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the
19306 outcome of a conditional branch and speculatively executes
19307 instructions from the "taken" branch. It later aborts these
19308 instructions if the predicted outcome is wrong. However, on the
19309 R10K, even aborted instructions can have side effects.
19310
19311 This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the
19312 system, kernel loads. As an example, a speculatively-executed
19313 store may load the target memory into cache and mark the cache line
19314 as dirty, even if the store itself is later aborted. If a DMA
19315 operation writes to the same area of memory before the "dirty" line
19316 is flushed, the cached data overwrites the DMA-ed data. See the
19317 R10K processor manual for a full description, including other
19318 potential problems.
19319
19320 One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before every
19321 memory access that might be speculatively executed and that might
19322 have side effects even if aborted. -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting
19323 controls GCC's implementation of this workaround. It assumes that
19324 aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions does not have
19325 side effects:
19326
19327 1. the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;
19328
19329 2. the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;
19330
19331 3. the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant
19332 address.
19333
19334 It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative
19335 accesses to these regions are indeed safe.
19336
19337 If the input program contains a function declaration such as:
19338
19339 void foo (void);
19340
19341 then the implementation of "foo" must allow "j foo" and "jal foo"
19342 to be executed speculatively. GCC honors this restriction for
19343 functions it compiles itself. It expects non-GCC functions (such
19344 as hand-written assembly code) to do the same.
19345
19346 The option has three forms:
19347
19348 -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
19349 Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be
19350 speculatively executed and that might have side effects even if
19351 aborted.
19352
19353 -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
19354 Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be
19355 speculatively executed and that might have side effects even if
19356 aborted.
19357
19358 -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
19359 Disable the insertion of cache barriers. This is the default
19360 setting.
19361
19362 -mflush-func=func
19363 -mno-flush-func
19364 Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to
19365 not call any such function. If called, the function must take the
19366 same arguments as the common "_flush_func", that is, the address of
19367 the memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of
19368 the memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches). The
19369 default depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly
19370 is either "_flush_func" or "__cpu_flush".
19371
19372 mbranch-cost=num
19373 Set the cost of branches to roughly num "simple" instructions.
19374 This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
19375 consistent results across releases. A zero cost redundantly
19376 selects the default, which is based on the -mtune setting.
19377
19378 -mbranch-likely
19379 -mno-branch-likely
19380 Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of
19381 the default for the selected architecture. By default, Branch
19382 Likely instructions may be generated if they are supported by the
19383 selected architecture. An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64
19384 architectures and processors that implement those architectures;
19385 for those, Branch Likely instructions are not be generated by
19386 default because the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures specifically
19387 deprecate their use.
19388
19389 -mcompact-branches=never
19390 -mcompact-branches=optimal
19391 -mcompact-branches=always
19392 These options control which form of branches will be generated.
19393 The default is -mcompact-branches=optimal.
19394
19395 The -mcompact-branches=never option ensures that compact branch
19396 instructions will never be generated.
19397
19398 The -mcompact-branches=always option ensures that a compact branch
19399 instruction will be generated if available. If a compact branch
19400 instruction is not available, a delay slot form of the branch will
19401 be used instead.
19402
19403 This option is supported from MIPS Release 6 onwards.
19404
19405 The -mcompact-branches=optimal option will cause a delay slot
19406 branch to be used if one is available in the current ISA and the
19407 delay slot is successfully filled. If the delay slot is not
19408 filled, a compact branch will be chosen if one is available.
19409
19410 -mfp-exceptions
19411 -mno-fp-exceptions
19412 Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled. This affects how FP
19413 instructions are scheduled for some processors. The default is
19414 that FP exceptions are enabled.
19415
19416 For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we
19417 are emitting 64-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes.
19418 Otherwise, we can only use one FP pipe.
19419
19420 -mvr4130-align
19421 -mno-vr4130-align
19422 The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
19423 instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned. When
19424 this option is enabled, GCC aligns pairs of instructions that it
19425 thinks should execute in parallel.
19426
19427 This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130. It
19428 normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
19429 It is enabled by default at optimization level -O3.
19430
19431 -msynci
19432 -mno-synci
19433 Enable (disable) generation of "synci" instructions on
19434 architectures that support it. The "synci" instructions (if
19435 enabled) are generated when "__builtin___clear_cache" is compiled.
19436
19437 This option defaults to -mno-synci, but the default can be
19438 overridden by configuring GCC with --with-synci.
19439
19440 When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally
19441 safe to use "synci". However, on many multi-core (SMP) systems, it
19442 does not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may
19443 lead to undefined behavior.
19444
19445 -mrelax-pic-calls
19446 -mno-relax-pic-calls
19447 Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register $25
19448 into direct calls. This is only possible if the linker can resolve
19449 the destination at link time and if the destination is within range
19450 for a direct call.
19451
19452 -mrelax-pic-calls is the default if GCC was configured to use an
19453 assembler and a linker that support the ".reloc" assembly directive
19454 and -mexplicit-relocs is in effect. With -mno-explicit-relocs,
19455 this optimization can be performed by the assembler and the linker
19456 alone without help from the compiler.
19457
19458 -mmcount-ra-address
19459 -mno-mcount-ra-address
19460 Emit (do not emit) code that allows "_mcount" to modify the calling
19461 function's return address. When enabled, this option extends the
19462 usual "_mcount" interface with a new ra-address parameter, which
19463 has type "intptr_t *" and is passed in register $12. "_mcount" can
19464 then modify the return address by doing both of the following:
19465
19466 * Returning the new address in register $31.
19467
19468 * Storing the new address in "*ra-address", if ra-address is
19469 nonnull.
19470
19471 The default is -mno-mcount-ra-address.
19472
19473 -mframe-header-opt
19474 -mno-frame-header-opt
19475 Enable (disable) frame header optimization in the o32 ABI. When
19476 using the o32 ABI, calling functions will allocate 16 bytes on the
19477 stack for the called function to write out register arguments.
19478 When enabled, this optimization will suppress the allocation of the
19479 frame header if it can be determined that it is unused.
19480
19481 This optimization is off by default at all optimization levels.
19482
19483 -mlxc1-sxc1
19484 -mno-lxc1-sxc1
19485 When applicable, enable (disable) the generation of "lwxc1",
19486 "swxc1", "ldxc1", "sdxc1" instructions. Enabled by default.
19487
19488 -mmadd4
19489 -mno-madd4
19490 When applicable, enable (disable) the generation of 4-operand
19491 "madd.s", "madd.d" and related instructions. Enabled by default.
19492
19493 MMIX Options
19494
19495 These options are defined for the MMIX:
19496
19497 -mlibfuncs
19498 -mno-libfuncs
19499 Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled,
19500 passing all values in registers, no matter the size.
19501
19502 -mepsilon
19503 -mno-epsilon
19504 Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with
19505 respect to the "rE" epsilon register.
19506
19507 -mabi=mmixware
19508 -mabi=gnu
19509 Generate code that passes function parameters and return values
19510 that (in the called function) are seen as registers $0 and up, as
19511 opposed to the GNU ABI which uses global registers $231 and up.
19512
19513 -mzero-extend
19514 -mno-zero-extend
19515 When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use
19516 (do not use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather
19517 than sign-extending ones.
19518
19519 -mknuthdiv
19520 -mno-knuthdiv
19521 Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same
19522 sign as the divisor. With the default, -mno-knuthdiv, the sign of
19523 the remainder follows the sign of the dividend. Both methods are
19524 arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
19525
19526 -mtoplevel-symbols
19527 -mno-toplevel-symbols
19528 Prepend (do not prepend) a : to all global symbols, so the assembly
19529 code can be used with the "PREFIX" assembly directive.
19530
19531 -melf
19532 Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
19533 mmo format used by the mmix simulator.
19534
19535 -mbranch-predict
19536 -mno-branch-predict
19537 Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static
19538 branch prediction indicates a probable branch.
19539
19540 -mbase-addresses
19541 -mno-base-addresses
19542 Generate (do not generate) code that uses base addresses. Using a
19543 base address automatically generates a request (handled by the
19544 assembler and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global
19545 register. The register is used for one or more base address
19546 requests within the range 0 to 255 from the value held in the
19547 register. The generally leads to short and fast code, but the
19548 number of different data items that can be addressed is limited.
19549 This means that a program that uses lots of static data may require
19550 -mno-base-addresses.
19551
19552 -msingle-exit
19553 -mno-single-exit
19554 Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in
19555 each function.
19556
19557 MN10300 Options
19558
19559 These -m options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
19560
19561 -mmult-bug
19562 Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
19563 MN10300 processors. This is the default.
19564
19565 -mno-mult-bug
19566 Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for
19567 the MN10300 processors.
19568
19569 -mam33
19570 Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
19571
19572 -mno-am33
19573 Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
19574 This is the default.
19575
19576 -mam33-2
19577 Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.
19578
19579 -mam34
19580 Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.
19581
19582 -mtune=cpu-type
19583 Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when
19584 scheduling instructions. This does not change the targeted
19585 processor type. The CPU type must be one of mn10300, am33, am33-2
19586 or am34.
19587
19588 -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
19589 When generating a function that returns a pointer, return the
19590 pointer in both "a0" and "d0". Otherwise, the pointer is returned
19591 only in "a0", and attempts to call such functions without a
19592 prototype result in errors. Note that this option is on by
19593 default; use -mno-return-pointer-on-d0 to disable it.
19594
19595 -mno-crt0
19596 Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
19597
19598 -mrelax
19599 Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation
19600 optimization pass to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory
19601 addresses. This option only has an effect when used on the command
19602 line for the final link step.
19603
19604 This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
19605
19606 -mliw
19607 Allow the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word instructions
19608 if the target is the AM33 or later. This is the default. This
19609 option defines the preprocessor macro "__LIW__".
19610
19611 -mno-liw
19612 Do not allow the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word
19613 instructions. This option defines the preprocessor macro
19614 "__NO_LIW__".
19615
19616 -msetlb
19617 Allow the compiler to generate the SETLB and Lcc instructions if
19618 the target is the AM33 or later. This is the default. This option
19619 defines the preprocessor macro "__SETLB__".
19620
19621 -mno-setlb
19622 Do not allow the compiler to generate SETLB or Lcc instructions.
19623 This option defines the preprocessor macro "__NO_SETLB__".
19624
19625 Moxie Options
19626
19627 -meb
19628 Generate big-endian code. This is the default for moxie-*-*
19629 configurations.
19630
19631 -mel
19632 Generate little-endian code.
19633
19634 -mmul.x
19635 Generate mul.x and umul.x instructions. This is the default for
19636 moxiebox-*-* configurations.
19637
19638 -mno-crt0
19639 Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
19640
19641 MSP430 Options
19642
19643 These options are defined for the MSP430:
19644
19645 -masm-hex
19646 Force assembly output to always use hex constants. Normally such
19647 constants are signed decimals, but this option is available for
19648 testsuite and/or aesthetic purposes.
19649
19650 -mmcu=
19651 Select the MCU to target. This is used to create a C preprocessor
19652 symbol based upon the MCU name, converted to upper case and pre-
19653 and post-fixed with __. This in turn is used by the msp430.h
19654 header file to select an MCU-specific supplementary header file.
19655
19656 The option also sets the ISA to use. If the MCU name is one that
19657 is known to only support the 430 ISA then that is selected,
19658 otherwise the 430X ISA is selected. A generic MCU name of msp430
19659 can also be used to select the 430 ISA. Similarly the generic
19660 msp430x MCU name selects the 430X ISA.
19661
19662 In addition an MCU-specific linker script is added to the linker
19663 command line. The script's name is the name of the MCU with .ld
19664 appended. Thus specifying -mmcu=xxx on the gcc command line
19665 defines the C preprocessor symbol "__XXX__" and cause the linker to
19666 search for a script called xxx.ld.
19667
19668 This option is also passed on to the assembler.
19669
19670 -mwarn-mcu
19671 -mno-warn-mcu
19672 This option enables or disables warnings about conflicts between
19673 the MCU name specified by the -mmcu option and the ISA set by the
19674 -mcpu option and/or the hardware multiply support set by the
19675 -mhwmult option. It also toggles warnings about unrecognized MCU
19676 names. This option is on by default.
19677
19678 -mcpu=
19679 Specifies the ISA to use. Accepted values are msp430, msp430x and
19680 msp430xv2. This option is deprecated. The -mmcu= option should be
19681 used to select the ISA.
19682
19683 -msim
19684 Link to the simulator runtime libraries and linker script.
19685 Overrides any scripts that would be selected by the -mmcu= option.
19686
19687 -mlarge
19688 Use large-model addressing (20-bit pointers, 32-bit "size_t").
19689
19690 -msmall
19691 Use small-model addressing (16-bit pointers, 16-bit "size_t").
19692
19693 -mrelax
19694 This option is passed to the assembler and linker, and allows the
19695 linker to perform certain optimizations that cannot be done until
19696 the final link.
19697
19698 mhwmult=
19699 Describes the type of hardware multiply supported by the target.
19700 Accepted values are none for no hardware multiply, 16bit for the
19701 original 16-bit-only multiply supported by early MCUs. 32bit for
19702 the 16/32-bit multiply supported by later MCUs and f5series for the
19703 16/32-bit multiply supported by F5-series MCUs. A value of auto
19704 can also be given. This tells GCC to deduce the hardware multiply
19705 support based upon the MCU name provided by the -mmcu option. If
19706 no -mmcu option is specified or if the MCU name is not recognized
19707 then no hardware multiply support is assumed. "auto" is the
19708 default setting.
19709
19710 Hardware multiplies are normally performed by calling a library
19711 routine. This saves space in the generated code. When compiling
19712 at -O3 or higher however the hardware multiplier is invoked inline.
19713 This makes for bigger, but faster code.
19714
19715 The hardware multiply routines disable interrupts whilst running
19716 and restore the previous interrupt state when they finish. This
19717 makes them safe to use inside interrupt handlers as well as in
19718 normal code.
19719
19720 -minrt
19721 Enable the use of a minimum runtime environment - no static
19722 initializers or constructors. This is intended for memory-
19723 constrained devices. The compiler includes special symbols in some
19724 objects that tell the linker and runtime which code fragments are
19725 required.
19726
19727 -mcode-region=
19728 -mdata-region=
19729 These options tell the compiler where to place functions and data
19730 that do not have one of the "lower", "upper", "either" or "section"
19731 attributes. Possible values are "lower", "upper", "either" or
19732 "any". The first three behave like the corresponding attribute.
19733 The fourth possible value - "any" - is the default. It leaves
19734 placement entirely up to the linker script and how it assigns the
19735 standard sections (".text", ".data", etc) to the memory regions.
19736
19737 -msilicon-errata=
19738 This option passes on a request to assembler to enable the fixes
19739 for the named silicon errata.
19740
19741 -msilicon-errata-warn=
19742 This option passes on a request to the assembler to enable warning
19743 messages when a silicon errata might need to be applied.
19744
19745 NDS32 Options
19746
19747 These options are defined for NDS32 implementations:
19748
19749 -mbig-endian
19750 Generate code in big-endian mode.
19751
19752 -mlittle-endian
19753 Generate code in little-endian mode.
19754
19755 -mreduced-regs
19756 Use reduced-set registers for register allocation.
19757
19758 -mfull-regs
19759 Use full-set registers for register allocation.
19760
19761 -mcmov
19762 Generate conditional move instructions.
19763
19764 -mno-cmov
19765 Do not generate conditional move instructions.
19766
19767 -mext-perf
19768 Generate performance extension instructions.
19769
19770 -mno-ext-perf
19771 Do not generate performance extension instructions.
19772
19773 -mext-perf2
19774 Generate performance extension 2 instructions.
19775
19776 -mno-ext-perf2
19777 Do not generate performance extension 2 instructions.
19778
19779 -mext-string
19780 Generate string extension instructions.
19781
19782 -mno-ext-string
19783 Do not generate string extension instructions.
19784
19785 -mv3push
19786 Generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.
19787
19788 -mno-v3push
19789 Do not generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.
19790
19791 -m16-bit
19792 Generate 16-bit instructions.
19793
19794 -mno-16-bit
19795 Do not generate 16-bit instructions.
19796
19797 -misr-vector-size=num
19798 Specify the size of each interrupt vector, which must be 4 or 16.
19799
19800 -mcache-block-size=num
19801 Specify the size of each cache block, which must be a power of 2
19802 between 4 and 512.
19803
19804 -march=arch
19805 Specify the name of the target architecture.
19806
19807 -mcmodel=code-model
19808 Set the code model to one of
19809
19810 small
19811 All the data and read-only data segments must be within 512KB
19812 addressing space. The text segment must be within 16MB
19813 addressing space.
19814
19815 medium
19816 The data segment must be within 512KB while the read-only data
19817 segment can be within 4GB addressing space. The text segment
19818 should be still within 16MB addressing space.
19819
19820 large
19821 All the text and data segments can be within 4GB addressing
19822 space.
19823
19824 -mctor-dtor
19825 Enable constructor/destructor feature.
19826
19827 -mrelax
19828 Guide linker to relax instructions.
19829
19830 Nios II Options
19831
19832 These are the options defined for the Altera Nios II processor.
19833
19834 -G num
19835 Put global and static objects less than or equal to num bytes into
19836 the small data or BSS sections instead of the normal data or BSS
19837 sections. The default value of num is 8.
19838
19839 -mgpopt=option
19840 -mgpopt
19841 -mno-gpopt
19842 Generate (do not generate) GP-relative accesses. The following
19843 option names are recognized:
19844
19845 none
19846 Do not generate GP-relative accesses.
19847
19848 local
19849 Generate GP-relative accesses for small data objects that are
19850 not external, weak, or uninitialized common symbols. Also use
19851 GP-relative addressing for objects that have been explicitly
19852 placed in a small data section via a "section" attribute.
19853
19854 global
19855 As for local, but also generate GP-relative accesses for small
19856 data objects that are external, weak, or common. If you use
19857 this option, you must ensure that all parts of your program
19858 (including libraries) are compiled with the same -G setting.
19859
19860 data
19861 Generate GP-relative accesses for all data objects in the
19862 program. If you use this option, the entire data and BSS
19863 segments of your program must fit in 64K of memory and you must
19864 use an appropriate linker script to allocate them within the
19865 addressable range of the global pointer.
19866
19867 all Generate GP-relative addresses for function pointers as well as
19868 data pointers. If you use this option, the entire text, data,
19869 and BSS segments of your program must fit in 64K of memory and
19870 you must use an appropriate linker script to allocate them
19871 within the addressable range of the global pointer.
19872
19873 -mgpopt is equivalent to -mgpopt=local, and -mno-gpopt is
19874 equivalent to -mgpopt=none.
19875
19876 The default is -mgpopt except when -fpic or -fPIC is specified to
19877 generate position-independent code. Note that the Nios II ABI does
19878 not permit GP-relative accesses from shared libraries.
19879
19880 You may need to specify -mno-gpopt explicitly when building
19881 programs that include large amounts of small data, including large
19882 GOT data sections. In this case, the 16-bit offset for GP-relative
19883 addressing may not be large enough to allow access to the entire
19884 small data section.
19885
19886 -mgprel-sec=regexp
19887 This option specifies additional section names that can be accessed
19888 via GP-relative addressing. It is most useful in conjunction with
19889 "section" attributes on variable declarations and a custom linker
19890 script. The regexp is a POSIX Extended Regular Expression.
19891
19892 This option does not affect the behavior of the -G option, and the
19893 specified sections are in addition to the standard ".sdata" and
19894 ".sbss" small-data sections that are recognized by -mgpopt.
19895
19896 -mr0rel-sec=regexp
19897 This option specifies names of sections that can be accessed via a
19898 16-bit offset from "r0"; that is, in the low 32K or high 32K of the
19899 32-bit address space. It is most useful in conjunction with
19900 "section" attributes on variable declarations and a custom linker
19901 script. The regexp is a POSIX Extended Regular Expression.
19902
19903 In contrast to the use of GP-relative addressing for small data,
19904 zero-based addressing is never generated by default and there are
19905 no conventional section names used in standard linker scripts for
19906 sections in the low or high areas of memory.
19907
19908 -mel
19909 -meb
19910 Generate little-endian (default) or big-endian (experimental) code,
19911 respectively.
19912
19913 -march=arch
19914 This specifies the name of the target Nios II architecture. GCC
19915 uses this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit
19916 when generating assembly code. Permissible names are: r1, r2.
19917
19918 The preprocessor macro "__nios2_arch__" is available to programs,
19919 with value 1 or 2, indicating the targeted ISA level.
19920
19921 -mbypass-cache
19922 -mno-bypass-cache
19923 Force all load and store instructions to always bypass cache by
19924 using I/O variants of the instructions. The default is not to
19925 bypass the cache.
19926
19927 -mno-cache-volatile
19928 -mcache-volatile
19929 Volatile memory access bypass the cache using the I/O variants of
19930 the load and store instructions. The default is not to bypass the
19931 cache.
19932
19933 -mno-fast-sw-div
19934 -mfast-sw-div
19935 Do not use table-based fast divide for small numbers. The default
19936 is to use the fast divide at -O3 and above.
19937
19938 -mno-hw-mul
19939 -mhw-mul
19940 -mno-hw-mulx
19941 -mhw-mulx
19942 -mno-hw-div
19943 -mhw-div
19944 Enable or disable emitting "mul", "mulx" and "div" family of
19945 instructions by the compiler. The default is to emit "mul" and not
19946 emit "div" and "mulx".
19947
19948 -mbmx
19949 -mno-bmx
19950 -mcdx
19951 -mno-cdx
19952 Enable or disable generation of Nios II R2 BMX (bit manipulation)
19953 and CDX (code density) instructions. Enabling these instructions
19954 also requires -march=r2. Since these instructions are optional
19955 extensions to the R2 architecture, the default is not to emit them.
19956
19957 -mcustom-insn=N
19958 -mno-custom-insn
19959 Each -mcustom-insn=N option enables use of a custom instruction
19960 with encoding N when generating code that uses insn. For example,
19961 -mcustom-fadds=253 generates custom instruction 253 for single-
19962 precision floating-point add operations instead of the default
19963 behavior of using a library call.
19964
19965 The following values of insn are supported. Except as otherwise
19966 noted, floating-point operations are expected to be implemented
19967 with normal IEEE 754 semantics and correspond directly to the C
19968 operators or the equivalent GCC built-in functions.
19969
19970 Single-precision floating point:
19971
19972 fadds, fsubs, fdivs, fmuls
19973 Binary arithmetic operations.
19974
19975 fnegs
19976 Unary negation.
19977
19978 fabss
19979 Unary absolute value.
19980
19981 fcmpeqs, fcmpges, fcmpgts, fcmples, fcmplts, fcmpnes
19982 Comparison operations.
19983
19984 fmins, fmaxs
19985 Floating-point minimum and maximum. These instructions are
19986 only generated if -ffinite-math-only is specified.
19987
19988 fsqrts
19989 Unary square root operation.
19990
19991 fcoss, fsins, ftans, fatans, fexps, flogs
19992 Floating-point trigonometric and exponential functions. These
19993 instructions are only generated if -funsafe-math-optimizations
19994 is also specified.
19995
19996 Double-precision floating point:
19997
19998 faddd, fsubd, fdivd, fmuld
19999 Binary arithmetic operations.
20000
20001 fnegd
20002 Unary negation.
20003
20004 fabsd
20005 Unary absolute value.
20006
20007 fcmpeqd, fcmpged, fcmpgtd, fcmpled, fcmpltd, fcmpned
20008 Comparison operations.
20009
20010 fmind, fmaxd
20011 Double-precision minimum and maximum. These instructions are
20012 only generated if -ffinite-math-only is specified.
20013
20014 fsqrtd
20015 Unary square root operation.
20016
20017 fcosd, fsind, ftand, fatand, fexpd, flogd
20018 Double-precision trigonometric and exponential functions.
20019 These instructions are only generated if
20020 -funsafe-math-optimizations is also specified.
20021
20022 Conversions:
20023
20024 fextsd
20025 Conversion from single precision to double precision.
20026
20027 ftruncds
20028 Conversion from double precision to single precision.
20029
20030 fixsi, fixsu, fixdi, fixdu
20031 Conversion from floating point to signed or unsigned integer
20032 types, with truncation towards zero.
20033
20034 round
20035 Conversion from single-precision floating point to signed
20036 integer, rounding to the nearest integer and ties away from
20037 zero. This corresponds to the "__builtin_lroundf" function
20038 when -fno-math-errno is used.
20039
20040 floatis, floatus, floatid, floatud
20041 Conversion from signed or unsigned integer types to floating-
20042 point types.
20043
20044 In addition, all of the following transfer instructions for
20045 internal registers X and Y must be provided to use any of the
20046 double-precision floating-point instructions. Custom instructions
20047 taking two double-precision source operands expect the first
20048 operand in the 64-bit register X. The other operand (or only
20049 operand of a unary operation) is given to the custom arithmetic
20050 instruction with the least significant half in source register src1
20051 and the most significant half in src2. A custom instruction that
20052 returns a double-precision result returns the most significant 32
20053 bits in the destination register and the other half in 32-bit
20054 register Y. GCC automatically generates the necessary code
20055 sequences to write register X and/or read register Y when double-
20056 precision floating-point instructions are used.
20057
20058 fwrx
20059 Write src1 into the least significant half of X and src2 into
20060 the most significant half of X.
20061
20062 fwry
20063 Write src1 into Y.
20064
20065 frdxhi, frdxlo
20066 Read the most or least (respectively) significant half of X and
20067 store it in dest.
20068
20069 frdy
20070 Read the value of Y and store it into dest.
20071
20072 Note that you can gain more local control over generation of Nios
20073 II custom instructions by using the "target("custom-insn=N")" and
20074 "target("no-custom-insn")" function attributes or pragmas.
20075
20076 -mcustom-fpu-cfg=name
20077 This option enables a predefined, named set of custom instruction
20078 encodings (see -mcustom-insn above). Currently, the following sets
20079 are defined:
20080
20081 -mcustom-fpu-cfg=60-1 is equivalent to: -mcustom-fmuls=252
20082 -mcustom-fadds=253 -mcustom-fsubs=254 -fsingle-precision-constant
20083
20084 -mcustom-fpu-cfg=60-2 is equivalent to: -mcustom-fmuls=252
20085 -mcustom-fadds=253 -mcustom-fsubs=254 -mcustom-fdivs=255
20086 -fsingle-precision-constant
20087
20088 -mcustom-fpu-cfg=72-3 is equivalent to: -mcustom-floatus=243
20089 -mcustom-fixsi=244 -mcustom-floatis=245 -mcustom-fcmpgts=246
20090 -mcustom-fcmples=249 -mcustom-fcmpeqs=250 -mcustom-fcmpnes=251
20091 -mcustom-fmuls=252 -mcustom-fadds=253 -mcustom-fsubs=254
20092 -mcustom-fdivs=255 -fsingle-precision-constant
20093
20094 Custom instruction assignments given by individual -mcustom-insn=
20095 options override those given by -mcustom-fpu-cfg=, regardless of
20096 the order of the options on the command line.
20097
20098 Note that you can gain more local control over selection of a FPU
20099 configuration by using the "target("custom-fpu-cfg=name")" function
20100 attribute or pragma.
20101
20102 These additional -m options are available for the Altera Nios II ELF
20103 (bare-metal) target:
20104
20105 -mhal
20106 Link with HAL BSP. This suppresses linking with the GCC-provided C
20107 runtime startup and termination code, and is typically used in
20108 conjunction with -msys-crt0= to specify the location of the
20109 alternate startup code provided by the HAL BSP.
20110
20111 -msmallc
20112 Link with a limited version of the C library, -lsmallc, rather than
20113 Newlib.
20114
20115 -msys-crt0=startfile
20116 startfile is the file name of the startfile (crt0) to use when
20117 linking. This option is only useful in conjunction with -mhal.
20118
20119 -msys-lib=systemlib
20120 systemlib is the library name of the library that provides low-
20121 level system calls required by the C library, e.g. "read" and
20122 "write". This option is typically used to link with a library
20123 provided by a HAL BSP.
20124
20125 Nvidia PTX Options
20126
20127 These options are defined for Nvidia PTX:
20128
20129 -m32
20130 -m64
20131 Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit ABI.
20132
20133 -misa=ISA-string
20134 Generate code for given the specified PTX ISA (e.g. sm_35). ISA
20135 strings must be lower-case. Valid ISA strings include sm_30 and
20136 sm_35. The default ISA is sm_30.
20137
20138 -mmainkernel
20139 Link in code for a __main kernel. This is for stand-alone instead
20140 of offloading execution.
20141
20142 -moptimize
20143 Apply partitioned execution optimizations. This is the default
20144 when any level of optimization is selected.
20145
20146 -msoft-stack
20147 Generate code that does not use ".local" memory directly for stack
20148 storage. Instead, a per-warp stack pointer is maintained
20149 explicitly. This enables variable-length stack allocation (with
20150 variable-length arrays or "alloca"), and when global memory is used
20151 for underlying storage, makes it possible to access automatic
20152 variables from other threads, or with atomic instructions. This
20153 code generation variant is used for OpenMP offloading, but the
20154 option is exposed on its own for the purpose of testing the
20155 compiler; to generate code suitable for linking into programs using
20156 OpenMP offloading, use option -mgomp.
20157
20158 -muniform-simt
20159 Switch to code generation variant that allows to execute all
20160 threads in each warp, while maintaining memory state and side
20161 effects as if only one thread in each warp was active outside of
20162 OpenMP SIMD regions. All atomic operations and calls to runtime
20163 (malloc, free, vprintf) are conditionally executed (iff current
20164 lane index equals the master lane index), and the register being
20165 assigned is copied via a shuffle instruction from the master lane.
20166 Outside of SIMD regions lane 0 is the master; inside, each thread
20167 sees itself as the master. Shared memory array "int __nvptx_uni[]"
20168 stores all-zeros or all-ones bitmasks for each warp, indicating
20169 current mode (0 outside of SIMD regions). Each thread can bitwise-
20170 and the bitmask at position "tid.y" with current lane index to
20171 compute the master lane index.
20172
20173 -mgomp
20174 Generate code for use in OpenMP offloading: enables -msoft-stack
20175 and -muniform-simt options, and selects corresponding multilib
20176 variant.
20177
20178 OpenRISC Options
20179
20180 These options are defined for OpenRISC:
20181
20182 -mboard=name
20183 Configure a board specific runtime. This will be passed to the
20184 linker for newlib board library linking. The default is "or1ksim".
20185
20186 -mnewlib
20187 For compatibility, it's always newlib for elf now.
20188
20189 -mhard-div
20190 Generate code for hardware which supports divide instructions.
20191 This is the default.
20192
20193 -mhard-mul
20194 Generate code for hardware which supports multiply instructions.
20195 This is the default.
20196
20197 -mcmov
20198 Generate code for hardware which supports the conditional move
20199 ("l.cmov") instruction.
20200
20201 -mror
20202 Generate code for hardware which supports rotate right
20203 instructions.
20204
20205 -msext
20206 Generate code for hardware which supports sign-extension
20207 instructions.
20208
20209 -msfimm
20210 Generate code for hardware which supports set flag immediate
20211 ("l.sf*i") instructions.
20212
20213 -mshftimm
20214 Generate code for hardware which supports shift immediate related
20215 instructions (i.e. "l.srai", "l.srli", "l.slli", "1.rori"). Note,
20216 to enable generation of the "l.rori" instruction the -mror flag
20217 must also be specified.
20218
20219 -msoft-div
20220 Generate code for hardware which requires divide instruction
20221 emulation.
20222
20223 -msoft-mul
20224 Generate code for hardware which requires multiply instruction
20225 emulation.
20226
20227 PDP-11 Options
20228
20229 These options are defined for the PDP-11:
20230
20231 -mfpu
20232 Use hardware FPP floating point. This is the default. (FIS
20233 floating point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.) Implies -m45.
20234
20235 -msoft-float
20236 Do not use hardware floating point.
20237
20238 -mac0
20239 Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler
20240 syntax).
20241
20242 -mno-ac0
20243 Return floating-point results in memory. This is the default.
20244
20245 -m40
20246 Generate code for a PDP-11/40. Implies -msoft-float -mno-split.
20247
20248 -m45
20249 Generate code for a PDP-11/45. This is the default.
20250
20251 -m10
20252 Generate code for a PDP-11/10. Implies -msoft-float -mno-split.
20253
20254 -mint16
20255 -mno-int32
20256 Use 16-bit "int". This is the default.
20257
20258 -mint32
20259 -mno-int16
20260 Use 32-bit "int".
20261
20262 -msplit
20263 Target has split instruction and data space. Implies -m45.
20264
20265 -munix-asm
20266 Use Unix assembler syntax.
20267
20268 -mdec-asm
20269 Use DEC assembler syntax.
20270
20271 -mgnu-asm
20272 Use GNU assembler syntax. This is the default.
20273
20274 -mlra
20275 Use the new LRA register allocator. By default, the old "reload"
20276 allocator is used.
20277
20278 picoChip Options
20279
20280 These -m options are defined for picoChip implementations:
20281
20282 -mae=ae_type
20283 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
20284 parameters for array element type ae_type. Supported values for
20285 ae_type are ANY, MUL, and MAC.
20286
20287 -mae=ANY selects a completely generic AE type. Code generated with
20288 this option runs on any of the other AE types. The code is not as
20289 efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific AE type, and
20290 some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) do not work properly
20291 on all types of AE.
20292
20293 -mae=MUL selects a MUL AE type. This is the most useful AE type
20294 for compiled code, and is the default.
20295
20296 -mae=MAC selects a DSP-style MAC AE. Code compiled with this
20297 option may suffer from poor performance of byte (char)
20298 manipulation, since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support
20299 for byte load/stores.
20300
20301 -msymbol-as-address
20302 Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in
20303 a load/store instruction, without first loading it into a register.
20304 Typically, the use of this option generates larger programs, which
20305 run faster than when the option isn't used. However, the results
20306 vary from program to program, so it is left as a user option,
20307 rather than being permanently enabled.
20308
20309 -mno-inefficient-warnings
20310 Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code. These
20311 warnings can be generated, for example, when compiling code that
20312 performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type. The MAC
20313 AE has no hardware support for byte-level memory operations, so all
20314 byte load/stores must be synthesized from word load/store
20315 operations. This is inefficient and a warning is generated to
20316 indicate that you should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations,
20317 or to target an AE type that has the necessary hardware support.
20318 This option disables these warnings.
20319
20320 PowerPC Options
20321
20322 These are listed under
20323
20324 RISC-V Options
20325
20326 These command-line options are defined for RISC-V targets:
20327
20328 -mbranch-cost=n
20329 Set the cost of branches to roughly n instructions.
20330
20331 -mplt
20332 -mno-plt
20333 When generating PIC code, do or don't allow the use of PLTs.
20334 Ignored for non-PIC. The default is -mplt.
20335
20336 -mabi=ABI-string
20337 Specify integer and floating-point calling convention. ABI-string
20338 contains two parts: the size of integer types and the registers
20339 used for floating-point types. For example -march=rv64ifd
20340 -mabi=lp64d means that long and pointers are 64-bit (implicitly
20341 defining int to be 32-bit), and that floating-point values up to 64
20342 bits wide are passed in F registers. Contrast this with
20343 -march=rv64ifd -mabi=lp64f, which still allows the compiler to
20344 generate code that uses the F and D extensions but only allows
20345 floating-point values up to 32 bits long to be passed in registers;
20346 or -march=rv64ifd -mabi=lp64, in which no floating-point arguments
20347 will be passed in registers.
20348
20349 The default for this argument is system dependent, users who want a
20350 specific calling convention should specify one explicitly. The
20351 valid calling conventions are: ilp32, ilp32f, ilp32d, lp64, lp64f,
20352 and lp64d. Some calling conventions are impossible to implement on
20353 some ISAs: for example, -march=rv32if -mabi=ilp32d is invalid
20354 because the ABI requires 64-bit values be passed in F registers,
20355 but F registers are only 32 bits wide. There is also the ilp32e
20356 ABI that can only be used with the rv32e architecture. This ABI is
20357 not well specified at present, and is subject to change.
20358
20359 -mfdiv
20360 -mno-fdiv
20361 Do or don't use hardware floating-point divide and square root
20362 instructions. This requires the F or D extensions for floating-
20363 point registers. The default is to use them if the specified
20364 architecture has these instructions.
20365
20366 -mdiv
20367 -mno-div
20368 Do or don't use hardware instructions for integer division. This
20369 requires the M extension. The default is to use them if the
20370 specified architecture has these instructions.
20371
20372 -march=ISA-string
20373 Generate code for given RISC-V ISA (e.g. rv64im). ISA strings must
20374 be lower-case. Examples include rv64i, rv32g, rv32e, and rv32imaf.
20375
20376 -mtune=processor-string
20377 Optimize the output for the given processor, specified by
20378 microarchitecture name. Permissible values for this option are:
20379 rocket, sifive-3-series, sifive-5-series, sifive-7-series, and
20380 size.
20381
20382 When -mtune= is not specified, the default is rocket.
20383
20384 The size choice is not intended for use by end-users. This is used
20385 when -Os is specified. It overrides the instruction cost info
20386 provided by -mtune=, but does not override the pipeline info. This
20387 helps reduce code size while still giving good performance.
20388
20389 -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
20390 Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to num
20391 byte boundary. If -mpreferred-stack-boundary is not specified, the
20392 default is 4 (16 bytes or 128-bits).
20393
20394 Warning: If you use this switch, then you must build all modules
20395 with the same value, including any libraries. This includes the
20396 system libraries and startup modules.
20397
20398 -msmall-data-limit=n
20399 Put global and static data smaller than n bytes into a special
20400 section (on some targets).
20401
20402 -msave-restore
20403 -mno-save-restore
20404 Do or don't use smaller but slower prologue and epilogue code that
20405 uses library function calls. The default is to use fast inline
20406 prologues and epilogues.
20407
20408 -mstrict-align
20409 -mno-strict-align
20410 Do not or do generate unaligned memory accesses. The default is
20411 set depending on whether the processor we are optimizing for
20412 supports fast unaligned access or not.
20413
20414 -mcmodel=medlow
20415 Generate code for the medium-low code model. The program and its
20416 statically defined symbols must lie within a single 2 GiB address
20417 range and must lie between absolute addresses -2 GiB and +2 GiB.
20418 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked. This is the
20419 default code model.
20420
20421 -mcmodel=medany
20422 Generate code for the medium-any code model. The program and its
20423 statically defined symbols must be within any single 2 GiB address
20424 range. Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
20425
20426 -mexplicit-relocs
20427 -mno-exlicit-relocs
20428 Use or do not use assembler relocation operators when dealing with
20429 symbolic addresses. The alternative is to use assembler macros
20430 instead, which may limit optimization.
20431
20432 -mrelax
20433 -mno-relax
20434 Take advantage of linker relaxations to reduce the number of
20435 instructions required to materialize symbol addresses. The default
20436 is to take advantage of linker relaxations.
20437
20438 -memit-attribute
20439 -mno-emit-attribute
20440 Emit (do not emit) RISC-V attribute to record extra information
20441 into ELF objects. This feature requires at least binutils 2.32.
20442
20443 RL78 Options
20444
20445 -msim
20446 Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a
20447 simulator.
20448
20449 -mmul=none
20450 -mmul=g10
20451 -mmul=g13
20452 -mmul=g14
20453 -mmul=rl78
20454 Specifies the type of hardware multiplication and division support
20455 to be used. The simplest is "none", which uses software for both
20456 multiplication and division. This is the default. The "g13" value
20457 is for the hardware multiply/divide peripheral found on the
20458 RL78/G13 (S2 core) targets. The "g14" value selects the use of the
20459 multiplication and division instructions supported by the RL78/G14
20460 (S3 core) parts. The value "rl78" is an alias for "g14" and the
20461 value "mg10" is an alias for "none".
20462
20463 In addition a C preprocessor macro is defined, based upon the
20464 setting of this option. Possible values are: "__RL78_MUL_NONE__",
20465 "__RL78_MUL_G13__" or "__RL78_MUL_G14__".
20466
20467 -mcpu=g10
20468 -mcpu=g13
20469 -mcpu=g14
20470 -mcpu=rl78
20471 Specifies the RL78 core to target. The default is the G14 core,
20472 also known as an S3 core or just RL78. The G13 or S2 core does not
20473 have multiply or divide instructions, instead it uses a hardware
20474 peripheral for these operations. The G10 or S1 core does not have
20475 register banks, so it uses a different calling convention.
20476
20477 If this option is set it also selects the type of hardware multiply
20478 support to use, unless this is overridden by an explicit -mmul=none
20479 option on the command line. Thus specifying -mcpu=g13 enables the
20480 use of the G13 hardware multiply peripheral and specifying
20481 -mcpu=g10 disables the use of hardware multiplications altogether.
20482
20483 Note, although the RL78/G14 core is the default target, specifying
20484 -mcpu=g14 or -mcpu=rl78 on the command line does change the
20485 behavior of the toolchain since it also enables G14 hardware
20486 multiply support. If these options are not specified on the
20487 command line then software multiplication routines will be used
20488 even though the code targets the RL78 core. This is for backwards
20489 compatibility with older toolchains which did not have hardware
20490 multiply and divide support.
20491
20492 In addition a C preprocessor macro is defined, based upon the
20493 setting of this option. Possible values are: "__RL78_G10__",
20494 "__RL78_G13__" or "__RL78_G14__".
20495
20496 -mg10
20497 -mg13
20498 -mg14
20499 -mrl78
20500 These are aliases for the corresponding -mcpu= option. They are
20501 provided for backwards compatibility.
20502
20503 -mallregs
20504 Allow the compiler to use all of the available registers. By
20505 default registers "r24..r31" are reserved for use in interrupt
20506 handlers. With this option enabled these registers can be used in
20507 ordinary functions as well.
20508
20509 -m64bit-doubles
20510 -m32bit-doubles
20511 Make the "double" data type be 64 bits (-m64bit-doubles) or 32 bits
20512 (-m32bit-doubles) in size. The default is -m32bit-doubles.
20513
20514 -msave-mduc-in-interrupts
20515 -mno-save-mduc-in-interrupts
20516 Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the MDUC
20517 registers. This is only necessary if normal code might use the
20518 MDUC registers, for example because it performs multiplication and
20519 division operations. The default is to ignore the MDUC registers
20520 as this makes the interrupt handlers faster. The target option
20521 -mg13 needs to be passed for this to work as this feature is only
20522 available on the G13 target (S2 core). The MDUC registers will
20523 only be saved if the interrupt handler performs a multiplication or
20524 division operation or it calls another function.
20525
20526 IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
20527
20528 These -m options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
20529
20530 -mpowerpc-gpopt
20531 -mno-powerpc-gpopt
20532 -mpowerpc-gfxopt
20533 -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
20534 -mpowerpc64
20535 -mno-powerpc64
20536 -mmfcrf
20537 -mno-mfcrf
20538 -mpopcntb
20539 -mno-popcntb
20540 -mpopcntd
20541 -mno-popcntd
20542 -mfprnd
20543 -mno-fprnd
20544 -mcmpb
20545 -mno-cmpb
20546 -mmfpgpr
20547 -mno-mfpgpr
20548 -mhard-dfp
20549 -mno-hard-dfp
20550 You use these options to specify which instructions are available
20551 on the processor you are using. The default value of these options
20552 is determined when configuring GCC. Specifying the -mcpu=cpu_type
20553 overrides the specification of these options. We recommend you use
20554 the -mcpu=cpu_type option rather than the options listed above.
20555
20556 Specifying -mpowerpc-gpopt allows GCC to use the optional PowerPC
20557 architecture instructions in the General Purpose group, including
20558 floating-point square root. Specifying -mpowerpc-gfxopt allows GCC
20559 to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
20560 Graphics group, including floating-point select.
20561
20562 The -mmfcrf option allows GCC to generate the move from condition
20563 register field instruction implemented on the POWER4 processor and
20564 other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01 architecture. The
20565 -mpopcntb option allows GCC to generate the popcount and double-
20566 precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
20567 POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC
20568 V2.02 architecture. The -mpopcntd option allows GCC to generate
20569 the popcount instruction implemented on the POWER7 processor and
20570 other processors that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture. The
20571 -mfprnd option allows GCC to generate the FP round to integer
20572 instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
20573 processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture. The -mcmpb
20574 option allows GCC to generate the compare bytes instruction
20575 implemented on the POWER6 processor and other processors that
20576 support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture. The -mmfpgpr option allows
20577 GCC to generate the FP move to/from general-purpose register
20578 instructions implemented on the POWER6X processor and other
20579 processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05 architecture.
20580 The -mhard-dfp option allows GCC to generate the decimal floating-
20581 point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.
20582
20583 The -mpowerpc64 option allows GCC to generate the additional 64-bit
20584 instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture and
20585 to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities. GCC defaults to
20586 -mno-powerpc64.
20587
20588 -mcpu=cpu_type
20589 Set architecture type, register usage, and instruction scheduling
20590 parameters for machine type cpu_type. Supported values for
20591 cpu_type are 401, 403, 405, 405fp, 440, 440fp, 464, 464fp, 476,
20592 476fp, 505, 601, 602, 603, 603e, 604, 604e, 620, 630, 740, 7400,
20593 7450, 750, 801, 821, 823, 860, 970, 8540, a2, e300c2, e300c3,
20594 e500mc, e500mc64, e5500, e6500, ec603e, G3, G4, G5, titan, power3,
20595 power4, power5, power5+, power6, power6x, power7, power8, power9,
20596 powerpc, powerpc64, powerpc64le, rs64, and native.
20597
20598 -mcpu=powerpc, -mcpu=powerpc64, and -mcpu=powerpc64le specify pure
20599 32-bit PowerPC (either endian), 64-bit big endian PowerPC and
20600 64-bit little endian PowerPC architecture machine types, with an
20601 appropriate, generic processor model assumed for scheduling
20602 purposes.
20603
20604 Specifying native as cpu type detects and selects the architecture
20605 option that corresponds to the host processor of the system
20606 performing the compilation. -mcpu=native has no effect if GCC does
20607 not recognize the processor.
20608
20609 The other options specify a specific processor. Code generated
20610 under those options runs best on that processor, and may not run at
20611 all on others.
20612
20613 The -mcpu options automatically enable or disable the following
20614 options:
20615
20616 -maltivec -mfprnd -mhard-float -mmfcrf -mmultiple -mpopcntb
20617 -mpopcntd -mpowerpc64 -mpowerpc-gpopt -mpowerpc-gfxopt -mmulhw
20618 -mdlmzb -mmfpgpr -mvsx -mcrypto -mhtm -mpower8-fusion
20619 -mpower8-vector -mquad-memory -mquad-memory-atomic -mfloat128
20620 -mfloat128-hardware
20621
20622 The particular options set for any particular CPU varies between
20623 compiler versions, depending on what setting seems to produce
20624 optimal code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the
20625 actual hardware's capabilities. If you wish to set an individual
20626 option to a particular value, you may specify it after the -mcpu
20627 option, like -mcpu=970 -mno-altivec.
20628
20629 On AIX, the -maltivec and -mpowerpc64 options are not enabled or
20630 disabled by the -mcpu option at present because AIX does not have
20631 full support for these options. You may still enable or disable
20632 them individually if you're sure it'll work in your environment.
20633
20634 -mtune=cpu_type
20635 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
20636 cpu_type, but do not set the architecture type or register usage,
20637 as -mcpu=cpu_type does. The same values for cpu_type are used for
20638 -mtune as for -mcpu. If both are specified, the code generated
20639 uses the architecture and registers set by -mcpu, but the
20640 scheduling parameters set by -mtune.
20641
20642 -mcmodel=small
20643 Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to
20644 64k.
20645
20646 -mcmodel=medium
20647 Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other
20648 static data may be up to a total of 4G in size. This is the
20649 default for 64-bit Linux.
20650
20651 -mcmodel=large
20652 Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to
20653 4G in size. Other data and code is only limited by the 64-bit
20654 address space.
20655
20656 -maltivec
20657 -mno-altivec
20658 Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and
20659 also enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct
20660 access to the AltiVec instruction set. You may also need to set
20661 -mabi=altivec to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
20662 enhancements.
20663
20664 When -maltivec is used, the element order for AltiVec intrinsics
20665 such as "vec_splat", "vec_extract", and "vec_insert" match array
20666 element order corresponding to the endianness of the target. That
20667 is, element zero identifies the leftmost element in a vector
20668 register when targeting a big-endian platform, and identifies the
20669 rightmost element in a vector register when targeting a little-
20670 endian platform.
20671
20672 -mvrsave
20673 -mno-vrsave
20674 Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
20675
20676 -msecure-plt
20677 Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and
20678 shared libraries with non-executable ".plt" and ".got" sections.
20679 This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
20680
20681 -mbss-plt
20682 Generate code that uses a BSS ".plt" section that ld.so fills in,
20683 and requires ".plt" and ".got" sections that are both writable and
20684 executable. This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
20685
20686 -misel
20687 -mno-isel
20688 This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL
20689 instructions.
20690
20691 -mvsx
20692 -mno-vsx
20693 Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX)
20694 instructions, and also enable the use of built-in functions that
20695 allow more direct access to the VSX instruction set.
20696
20697 -mcrypto
20698 -mno-crypto
20699 Enable the use (disable) of the built-in functions that allow
20700 direct access to the cryptographic instructions that were added in
20701 version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.
20702
20703 -mhtm
20704 -mno-htm
20705 Enable (disable) the use of the built-in functions that allow
20706 direct access to the Hardware Transactional Memory (HTM)
20707 instructions that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.
20708
20709 -mpower8-fusion
20710 -mno-power8-fusion
20711 Generate code that keeps (does not keeps) some integer operations
20712 adjacent so that the instructions can be fused together on power8
20713 and later processors.
20714
20715 -mpower8-vector
20716 -mno-power8-vector
20717 Generate code that uses (does not use) the vector and scalar
20718 instructions that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.
20719 Also enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct
20720 access to the vector instructions.
20721
20722 -mquad-memory
20723 -mno-quad-memory
20724 Generate code that uses (does not use) the non-atomic quad word
20725 memory instructions. The -mquad-memory option requires use of
20726 64-bit mode.
20727
20728 -mquad-memory-atomic
20729 -mno-quad-memory-atomic
20730 Generate code that uses (does not use) the atomic quad word memory
20731 instructions. The -mquad-memory-atomic option requires use of
20732 64-bit mode.
20733
20734 -mfloat128
20735 -mno-float128
20736 Enable/disable the __float128 keyword for IEEE 128-bit floating
20737 point and use either software emulation for IEEE 128-bit floating
20738 point or hardware instructions.
20739
20740 The VSX instruction set (-mvsx, -mcpu=power7, -mcpu=power8), or
20741 -mcpu=power9 must be enabled to use the IEEE 128-bit floating point
20742 support. The IEEE 128-bit floating point support only works on
20743 PowerPC Linux systems.
20744
20745 The default for -mfloat128 is enabled on PowerPC Linux systems
20746 using the VSX instruction set, and disabled on other systems.
20747
20748 If you use the ISA 3.0 instruction set (-mpower9-vector or
20749 -mcpu=power9) on a 64-bit system, the IEEE 128-bit floating point
20750 support will also enable the generation of ISA 3.0 IEEE 128-bit
20751 floating point instructions. Otherwise, if you do not specify to
20752 generate ISA 3.0 instructions or you are targeting a 32-bit big
20753 endian system, IEEE 128-bit floating point will be done with
20754 software emulation.
20755
20756 -mfloat128-hardware
20757 -mno-float128-hardware
20758 Enable/disable using ISA 3.0 hardware instructions to support the
20759 __float128 data type.
20760
20761 The default for -mfloat128-hardware is enabled on PowerPC Linux
20762 systems using the ISA 3.0 instruction set, and disabled on other
20763 systems.
20764
20765 -m32
20766 -m64
20767 Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
20768 targets (including GNU/Linux). The 32-bit environment sets int,
20769 long and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any
20770 PowerPC variant. The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and
20771 long and pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as
20772 for -mpowerpc64.
20773
20774 -mfull-toc
20775 -mno-fp-in-toc
20776 -mno-sum-in-toc
20777 -mminimal-toc
20778 Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created
20779 for every executable file. The -mfull-toc option is selected by
20780 default. In that case, GCC allocates at least one TOC entry for
20781 each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program. GCC
20782 also places floating-point constants in the TOC. However, only
20783 16,384 entries are available in the TOC.
20784
20785 If you receive a linker error message that saying you have
20786 overflowed the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of
20787 TOC space used with the -mno-fp-in-toc and -mno-sum-in-toc options.
20788 -mno-fp-in-toc prevents GCC from putting floating-point constants
20789 in the TOC and -mno-sum-in-toc forces GCC to generate code to
20790 calculate the sum of an address and a constant at run time instead
20791 of putting that sum into the TOC. You may specify one or both of
20792 these options. Each causes GCC to produce very slightly slower and
20793 larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
20794
20795 If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both
20796 of these options, specify -mminimal-toc instead. This option
20797 causes GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file. When you
20798 specify this option, GCC produces code that is slower and larger
20799 but which uses extremely little TOC space. You may wish to use
20800 this option only on files that contain less frequently-executed
20801 code.
20802
20803 -maix64
20804 -maix32
20805 Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers,
20806 64-bit "long" type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
20807 Specifying -maix64 implies -mpowerpc64, while -maix32 disables the
20808 64-bit ABI and implies -mno-powerpc64. GCC defaults to -maix32.
20809
20810 -mxl-compat
20811 -mno-xl-compat
20812 Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler
20813 semantics when using AIX-compatible ABI. Pass floating-point
20814 arguments to prototyped functions beyond the register save area
20815 (RSA) on the stack in addition to argument FPRs. Do not assume
20816 that most significant double in 128-bit long double value is
20817 properly rounded when comparing values and converting to double.
20818 Use XL symbol names for long double support routines.
20819
20820 The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially
20821 documented to handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function
20822 that takes the address of its arguments with fewer arguments than
20823 declared. IBM XL compilers access floating-point arguments that do
20824 not fit in the RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled
20825 without optimization. Because always storing floating-point
20826 arguments on the stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this
20827 option is not enabled by default and only is necessary when calling
20828 subroutines compiled by IBM XL compilers without optimization.
20829
20830 -mpe
20831 Support IBM RS/6000 SP Parallel Environment (PE). Link an
20832 application written to use message passing with special startup
20833 code to enable the application to run. The system must have PE
20834 installed in the standard location (/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/), or the
20835 specs file must be overridden with the -specs= option to specify
20836 the appropriate directory location. The Parallel Environment does
20837 not support threads, so the -mpe option and the -pthread option are
20838 incompatible.
20839
20840 -malign-natural
20841 -malign-power
20842 On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
20843 -malign-natural overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
20844 types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based
20845 boundary. The option -malign-power instructs GCC to follow the
20846 ABI-specified alignment rules. GCC defaults to the standard
20847 alignment defined in the ABI.
20848
20849 On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and
20850 -malign-power is not supported.
20851
20852 -msoft-float
20853 -mhard-float
20854 Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register
20855 set. Software floating-point emulation is provided if you use the
20856 -msoft-float option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
20857
20858 -mmultiple
20859 -mno-multiple
20860 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
20861 instructions and the store multiple word instructions. These
20862 instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
20863 generated on PowerPC systems. Do not use -mmultiple on little-
20864 endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when
20865 the processor is in little-endian mode. The exceptions are PPC740
20866 and PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.
20867
20868 -mupdate
20869 -mno-update
20870 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store
20871 instructions that update the base register to the address of the
20872 calculated memory location. These instructions are generated by
20873 default. If you use -mno-update, there is a small window between
20874 the time that the stack pointer is updated and the address of the
20875 previous frame is stored, which means code that walks the stack
20876 frame across interrupts or signals may get corrupted data.
20877
20878 -mavoid-indexed-addresses
20879 -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
20880 Generate code that tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed
20881 load or store instructions. These instructions can incur a
20882 performance penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations,
20883 such as when stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M
20884 boundary. This option is enabled by default when targeting Power6
20885 and disabled otherwise.
20886
20887 -mfused-madd
20888 -mno-fused-madd
20889 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply
20890 and accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by
20891 default if hardware floating point is used. The machine-dependent
20892 -mfused-madd option is now mapped to the machine-independent
20893 -ffp-contract=fast option, and -mno-fused-madd is mapped to
20894 -ffp-contract=off.
20895
20896 -mmulhw
20897 -mno-mulhw
20898 Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
20899 multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476
20900 processors. These instructions are generated by default when
20901 targeting those processors.
20902
20903 -mdlmzb
20904 -mno-dlmzb
20905 Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search dlmzb
20906 instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors. This
20907 instruction is generated by default when targeting those
20908 processors.
20909
20910 -mno-bit-align
20911 -mbit-align
20912 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force
20913 structures and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the
20914 base type of the bit-field.
20915
20916 For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
20917 "unsigned" bit-fields of length 1 is aligned to a 4-byte boundary
20918 and has a size of 4 bytes. By using -mno-bit-align, the structure
20919 is aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in size.
20920
20921 -mno-strict-align
20922 -mstrict-align
20923 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
20924 unaligned memory references are handled by the system.
20925
20926 -mrelocatable
20927 -mno-relocatable
20928 Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to
20929 be relocated to a different address at run time. A simple embedded
20930 PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of
20931 ".got2" and 4-byte locations listed in the ".fixup" section, a
20932 table of 32-bit addresses generated by this option. For this to
20933 work, all objects linked together must be compiled with
20934 -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. -mrelocatable code aligns the
20935 stack to an 8-byte boundary.
20936
20937 -mrelocatable-lib
20938 -mno-relocatable-lib
20939 Like -mrelocatable, -mrelocatable-lib generates a ".fixup" section
20940 to allow static executables to be relocated at run time, but
20941 -mrelocatable-lib does not use the smaller stack alignment of
20942 -mrelocatable. Objects compiled with -mrelocatable-lib may be
20943 linked with objects compiled with any combination of the
20944 -mrelocatable options.
20945
20946 -mno-toc
20947 -mtoc
20948 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
20949 register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the
20950 addresses used in the program.
20951
20952 -mlittle
20953 -mlittle-endian
20954 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
20955 processor in little-endian mode. The -mlittle-endian option is the
20956 same as -mlittle.
20957
20958 -mbig
20959 -mbig-endian
20960 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
20961 processor in big-endian mode. The -mbig-endian option is the same
20962 as -mbig.
20963
20964 -mdynamic-no-pic
20965 On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
20966 relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable. The
20967 resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
20968 libraries.
20969
20970 -msingle-pic-base
20971 Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather
20972 than loading it in the prologue for each function. The runtime
20973 system is responsible for initializing this register with an
20974 appropriate value before execution begins.
20975
20976 -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority
20977 This option controls the priority that is assigned to dispatch-slot
20978 restricted instructions during the second scheduling pass. The
20979 argument priority takes the value 0, 1, or 2 to assign no, highest,
20980 or second-highest (respectively) priority to dispatch-slot
20981 restricted instructions.
20982
20983 -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type
20984 This option controls which dependences are considered costly by the
20985 target during instruction scheduling. The argument dependence_type
20986 takes one of the following values:
20987
20988 no No dependence is costly.
20989
20990 all All dependences are costly.
20991
20992 true_store_to_load
20993 A true dependence from store to load is costly.
20994
20995 store_to_load
20996 Any dependence from store to load is costly.
20997
20998 number
20999 Any dependence for which the latency is greater than or equal
21000 to number is costly.
21001
21002 -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
21003 This option controls which NOP insertion scheme is used during the
21004 second scheduling pass. The argument scheme takes one of the
21005 following values:
21006
21007 no Don't insert NOPs.
21008
21009 pad Pad with NOPs any dispatch group that has vacant issue slots,
21010 according to the scheduler's grouping.
21011
21012 regroup_exact
21013 Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into separate
21014 groups. Insert exactly as many NOPs as needed to force an insn
21015 to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
21016
21017 number
21018 Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into separate
21019 groups. Insert number NOPs to force an insn to a new group.
21020
21021 -mcall-sysv
21022 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using
21023 calling conventions that adhere to the March 1995 draft of the
21024 System V Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor
21025 supplement. This is the default unless you configured GCC using
21026 powerpc-*-eabiaix.
21027
21028 -mcall-sysv-eabi
21029 -mcall-eabi
21030 Specify both -mcall-sysv and -meabi options.
21031
21032 -mcall-sysv-noeabi
21033 Specify both -mcall-sysv and -mno-eabi options.
21034
21035 -mcall-aixdesc
21036 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX
21037 operating system.
21038
21039 -mcall-linux
21040 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
21041 Linux-based GNU system.
21042
21043 -mcall-freebsd
21044 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
21045 FreeBSD operating system.
21046
21047 -mcall-netbsd
21048 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
21049 NetBSD operating system.
21050
21051 -mcall-openbsd
21052 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
21053 OpenBSD operating system.
21054
21055 -mtraceback=traceback_type
21056 Select the type of traceback table. Valid values for traceback_type
21057 are full, part, and no.
21058
21059 -maix-struct-return
21060 Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI).
21061
21062 -msvr4-struct-return
21063 Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified
21064 by the SVR4 ABI).
21065
21066 -mabi=abi-type
21067 Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such
21068 extension. Valid values are altivec, no-altivec, ibmlongdouble,
21069 ieeelongdouble, elfv1, elfv2.
21070
21071 -mabi=ibmlongdouble
21072 Change the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.
21073 This is not likely to work if your system defaults to using IEEE
21074 extended-precision long double. If you change the long double type
21075 from IEEE extended-precision, the compiler will issue a warning
21076 unless you use the -Wno-psabi option. Requires -mlong-double-128
21077 to be enabled.
21078
21079 -mabi=ieeelongdouble
21080 Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.
21081 This is not likely to work if your system defaults to using IBM
21082 extended-precision long double. If you change the long double type
21083 from IBM extended-precision, the compiler will issue a warning
21084 unless you use the -Wno-psabi option. Requires -mlong-double-128
21085 to be enabled.
21086
21087 -mabi=elfv1
21088 Change the current ABI to use the ELFv1 ABI. This is the default
21089 ABI for big-endian PowerPC 64-bit Linux. Overriding the default
21090 ABI requires special system support and is likely to fail in
21091 spectacular ways.
21092
21093 -mabi=elfv2
21094 Change the current ABI to use the ELFv2 ABI. This is the default
21095 ABI for little-endian PowerPC 64-bit Linux. Overriding the default
21096 ABI requires special system support and is likely to fail in
21097 spectacular ways.
21098
21099 -mgnu-attribute
21100 -mno-gnu-attribute
21101 Emit .gnu_attribute assembly directives to set tag/value pairs in a
21102 .gnu.attributes section that specify ABI variations in function
21103 parameters or return values.
21104
21105 -mprototype
21106 -mno-prototype
21107 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
21108 variable argument functions are properly prototyped. Otherwise,
21109 the compiler must insert an instruction before every non-prototyped
21110 call to set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register ("CR") to
21111 indicate whether floating-point values are passed in the floating-
21112 point registers in case the function takes variable arguments.
21113 With -mprototype, only calls to prototyped variable argument
21114 functions set or clear the bit.
21115
21116 -msim
21117 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is
21118 called sim-crt0.o and that the standard C libraries are libsim.a
21119 and libc.a. This is the default for powerpc-*-eabisim
21120 configurations.
21121
21122 -mmvme
21123 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is
21124 called crt0.o and the standard C libraries are libmvme.a and
21125 libc.a.
21126
21127 -mads
21128 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is
21129 called crt0.o and the standard C libraries are libads.a and libc.a.
21130
21131 -myellowknife
21132 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is
21133 called crt0.o and the standard C libraries are libyk.a and libc.a.
21134
21135 -mvxworks
21136 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
21137 compiling for a VxWorks system.
21138
21139 -memb
21140 On embedded PowerPC systems, set the "PPC_EMB" bit in the ELF flags
21141 header to indicate that eabi extended relocations are used.
21142
21143 -meabi
21144 -mno-eabi
21145 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to
21146 the Embedded Applications Binary Interface (EABI), which is a set
21147 of modifications to the System V.4 specifications. Selecting
21148 -meabi means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a
21149 function "__eabi" is called from "main" to set up the EABI
21150 environment, and the -msdata option can use both "r2" and "r13" to
21151 point to two separate small data areas. Selecting -mno-eabi means
21152 that the stack is aligned to a 16-byte boundary, no EABI
21153 initialization function is called from "main", and the -msdata
21154 option only uses "r13" to point to a single small data area. The
21155 -meabi option is on by default if you configured GCC using one of
21156 the powerpc*-*-eabi* options.
21157
21158 -msdata=eabi
21159 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
21160 "const" global and static data in the ".sdata2" section, which is
21161 pointed to by register "r2". Put small initialized non-"const"
21162 global and static data in the ".sdata" section, which is pointed to
21163 by register "r13". Put small uninitialized global and static data
21164 in the ".sbss" section, which is adjacent to the ".sdata" section.
21165 The -msdata=eabi option is incompatible with the -mrelocatable
21166 option. The -msdata=eabi option also sets the -memb option.
21167
21168 -msdata=sysv
21169 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and
21170 static data in the ".sdata" section, which is pointed to by
21171 register "r13". Put small uninitialized global and static data in
21172 the ".sbss" section, which is adjacent to the ".sdata" section.
21173 The -msdata=sysv option is incompatible with the -mrelocatable
21174 option.
21175
21176 -msdata=default
21177 -msdata
21178 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if -meabi is used,
21179 compile code the same as -msdata=eabi, otherwise compile code the
21180 same as -msdata=sysv.
21181
21182 -msdata=data
21183 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global data
21184 in the ".sdata" section. Put small uninitialized global data in
21185 the ".sbss" section. Do not use register "r13" to address small
21186 data however. This is the default behavior unless other -msdata
21187 options are used.
21188
21189 -msdata=none
21190 -mno-sdata
21191 On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static
21192 data in the ".data" section, and all uninitialized data in the
21193 ".bss" section.
21194
21195 -mreadonly-in-sdata
21196 Put read-only objects in the ".sdata" section as well. This is the
21197 default.
21198
21199 -mblock-move-inline-limit=num
21200 Inline all block moves (such as calls to "memcpy" or structure
21201 copies) less than or equal to num bytes. The minimum value for num
21202 is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit targets. The
21203 default value is target-specific.
21204
21205 -mblock-compare-inline-limit=num
21206 Generate non-looping inline code for all block compares (such as
21207 calls to "memcmp" or structure compares) less than or equal to num
21208 bytes. If num is 0, all inline expansion (non-loop and loop) of
21209 block compare is disabled. The default value is target-specific.
21210
21211 -mblock-compare-inline-loop-limit=num
21212 Generate an inline expansion using loop code for all block compares
21213 that are less than or equal to num bytes, but greater than the
21214 limit for non-loop inline block compare expansion. If the block
21215 length is not constant, at most num bytes will be compared before
21216 "memcmp" is called to compare the remainder of the block. The
21217 default value is target-specific.
21218
21219 -mstring-compare-inline-limit=num
21220 Compare at most num string bytes with inline code. If the
21221 difference or end of string is not found at the end of the inline
21222 compare a call to "strcmp" or "strncmp" will take care of the rest
21223 of the comparison. The default is 64 bytes.
21224
21225 -G num
21226 On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than
21227 or equal to num bytes into the small data or BSS sections instead
21228 of the normal data or BSS section. By default, num is 8. The -G
21229 num switch is also passed to the linker. All modules should be
21230 compiled with the same -G num value.
21231
21232 -mregnames
21233 -mno-regnames
21234 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit
21235 register names in the assembly language output using symbolic
21236 forms.
21237
21238 -mlongcall
21239 -mno-longcall
21240 By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer and
21241 more expensive calling sequence is required. This is required for
21242 calls farther than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current
21243 location. A short call is generated if the compiler knows the call
21244 cannot be that far away. This setting can be overridden by the
21245 "shortcall" function attribute, or by "#pragma longcall(0)".
21246
21247 Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and
21248 generating glue code on the fly. On these systems, long calls are
21249 unnecessary and generate slower code. As of this writing, the AIX
21250 linker can do this, as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64. It is
21251 planned to add this feature to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC
21252 systems as well.
21253
21254 On PowerPC64 ELFv2 and 32-bit PowerPC systems with newer GNU
21255 linkers, GCC can generate long calls using an inline PLT call
21256 sequence (see -mpltseq). PowerPC with -mbss-plt and PowerPC64
21257 ELFv1 (big-endian) do not support inline PLT calls.
21258
21259 On Darwin/PPC systems, "#pragma longcall" generates "jbsr callee,
21260 L42", plus a branch island (glue code). The two target addresses
21261 represent the callee and the branch island. The Darwin/PPC linker
21262 prefers the first address and generates a "bl callee" if the PPC
21263 "bl" instruction reaches the callee directly; otherwise, the linker
21264 generates "bl L42" to call the branch island. The branch island is
21265 appended to the body of the calling function; it computes the full
21266 32-bit address of the callee and jumps to it.
21267
21268 On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit
21269 to the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides
21270 whether to use or discard it.
21271
21272 In the future, GCC may ignore all longcall specifications when the
21273 linker is known to generate glue.
21274
21275 -mpltseq
21276 -mno-pltseq
21277 Implement (do not implement) -fno-plt and long calls using an
21278 inline PLT call sequence that supports lazy linking and long calls
21279 to functions in dlopen'd shared libraries. Inline PLT calls are
21280 only supported on PowerPC64 ELFv2 and 32-bit PowerPC systems with
21281 newer GNU linkers, and are enabled by default if the support is
21282 detected when configuring GCC, and, in the case of 32-bit PowerPC,
21283 if GCC is configured with --enable-secureplt. -mpltseq code and
21284 -mbss-plt 32-bit PowerPC relocatable objects may not be linked
21285 together.
21286
21287 -mtls-markers
21288 -mno-tls-markers
21289 Mark (do not mark) calls to "__tls_get_addr" with a relocation
21290 specifying the function argument. The relocation allows the linker
21291 to reliably associate function call with argument setup
21292 instructions for TLS optimization, which in turn allows GCC to
21293 better schedule the sequence.
21294
21295 -mrecip
21296 -mno-recip
21297 This option enables use of the reciprocal estimate and reciprocal
21298 square root estimate instructions with additional Newton-Raphson
21299 steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or square
21300 root and divide for floating-point arguments. You should use the
21301 -ffast-math option when using -mrecip (or at least
21302 -funsafe-math-optimizations, -ffinite-math-only, -freciprocal-math
21303 and -fno-trapping-math). Note that while the throughput of the
21304 sequence is generally higher than the throughput of the non-
21305 reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
21306 decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals
21307 0.99999994) for reciprocal square roots.
21308
21309 -mrecip=opt
21310 This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions may be
21311 used. opt is a comma-separated list of options, which may be
21312 preceded by a "!" to invert the option:
21313
21314 all Enable all estimate instructions.
21315
21316 default
21317 Enable the default instructions, equivalent to -mrecip.
21318
21319 none
21320 Disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to -mno-recip.
21321
21322 div Enable the reciprocal approximation instructions for both
21323 single and double precision.
21324
21325 divf
21326 Enable the single-precision reciprocal approximation
21327 instructions.
21328
21329 divd
21330 Enable the double-precision reciprocal approximation
21331 instructions.
21332
21333 rsqrt
21334 Enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions
21335 for both single and double precision.
21336
21337 rsqrtf
21338 Enable the single-precision reciprocal square root
21339 approximation instructions.
21340
21341 rsqrtd
21342 Enable the double-precision reciprocal square root
21343 approximation instructions.
21344
21345 So, for example, -mrecip=all,!rsqrtd enables all of the reciprocal
21346 estimate instructions, except for the "FRSQRTE", "XSRSQRTEDP", and
21347 "XVRSQRTEDP" instructions which handle the double-precision
21348 reciprocal square root calculations.
21349
21350 -mrecip-precision
21351 -mno-recip-precision
21352 Assume (do not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions
21353 provide higher-precision estimates than is mandated by the PowerPC
21354 ABI. Selecting -mcpu=power6, -mcpu=power7 or -mcpu=power8
21355 automatically selects -mrecip-precision. The double-precision
21356 square root estimate instructions are not generated by default on
21357 low-precision machines, since they do not provide an estimate that
21358 converges after three steps.
21359
21360 -mveclibabi=type
21361 Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
21362 external library. The only type supported at present is mass,
21363 which specifies to use IBM's Mathematical Acceleration Subsystem
21364 (MASS) libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external
21365 libraries. GCC currently emits calls to "acosd2", "acosf4",
21366 "acoshd2", "acoshf4", "asind2", "asinf4", "asinhd2", "asinhf4",
21367 "atan2d2", "atan2f4", "atand2", "atanf4", "atanhd2", "atanhf4",
21368 "cbrtd2", "cbrtf4", "cosd2", "cosf4", "coshd2", "coshf4", "erfcd2",
21369 "erfcf4", "erfd2", "erff4", "exp2d2", "exp2f4", "expd2", "expf4",
21370 "expm1d2", "expm1f4", "hypotd2", "hypotf4", "lgammad2", "lgammaf4",
21371 "log10d2", "log10f4", "log1pd2", "log1pf4", "log2d2", "log2f4",
21372 "logd2", "logf4", "powd2", "powf4", "sind2", "sinf4", "sinhd2",
21373 "sinhf4", "sqrtd2", "sqrtf4", "tand2", "tanf4", "tanhd2", and
21374 "tanhf4" when generating code for power7. Both -ftree-vectorize
21375 and -funsafe-math-optimizations must also be enabled. The MASS
21376 libraries must be specified at link time.
21377
21378 -mfriz
21379 -mno-friz
21380 Generate (do not generate) the "friz" instruction when the
21381 -funsafe-math-optimizations option is used to optimize rounding of
21382 floating-point values to 64-bit integer and back to floating point.
21383 The "friz" instruction does not return the same value if the
21384 floating-point number is too large to fit in an integer.
21385
21386 -mpointers-to-nested-functions
21387 -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
21388 Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain
21389 register ("r11") when calling through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit
21390 Linux systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word
21391 descriptor giving the function address, TOC value to be loaded in
21392 register "r2", and static chain value to be loaded in register
21393 "r11". The -mpointers-to-nested-functions is on by default. You
21394 cannot call through pointers to nested functions or pointers to
21395 functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
21396 you use -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions.
21397
21398 -msave-toc-indirect
21399 -mno-save-toc-indirect
21400 Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the
21401 reserved stack location in the function prologue if the function
21402 calls through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems. If the
21403 TOC value is not saved in the prologue, it is saved just before the
21404 call through the pointer. The -mno-save-toc-indirect option is the
21405 default.
21406
21407 -mcompat-align-parm
21408 -mno-compat-align-parm
21409 Generate (do not generate) code to pass structure parameters with a
21410 maximum alignment of 64 bits, for compatibility with older versions
21411 of GCC.
21412
21413 Older versions of GCC (prior to 4.9.0) incorrectly did not align a
21414 structure parameter on a 128-bit boundary when that structure
21415 contained a member requiring 128-bit alignment. This is corrected
21416 in more recent versions of GCC. This option may be used to
21417 generate code that is compatible with functions compiled with older
21418 versions of GCC.
21419
21420 The -mno-compat-align-parm option is the default.
21421
21422 -mstack-protector-guard=guard
21423 -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
21424 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
21425 -mstack-protector-guard-symbol=symbol
21426 Generate stack protection code using canary at guard. Supported
21427 locations are global for global canary or tls for per-thread canary
21428 in the TLS block (the default with GNU libc version 2.4 or later).
21429
21430 With the latter choice the options -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
21431 and -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset furthermore specify which
21432 register to use as base register for reading the canary, and from
21433 what offset from that base register. The default for those is as
21434 specified in the relevant ABI.
21435 -mstack-protector-guard-symbol=symbol overrides the offset with a
21436 symbol reference to a canary in the TLS block.
21437
21438 RX Options
21439
21440 These command-line options are defined for RX targets:
21441
21442 -m64bit-doubles
21443 -m32bit-doubles
21444 Make the "double" data type be 64 bits (-m64bit-doubles) or 32 bits
21445 (-m32bit-doubles) in size. The default is -m32bit-doubles. Note
21446 RX floating-point hardware only works on 32-bit values, which is
21447 why the default is -m32bit-doubles.
21448
21449 -fpu
21450 -nofpu
21451 Enables (-fpu) or disables (-nofpu) the use of RX floating-point
21452 hardware. The default is enabled for the RX600 series and disabled
21453 for the RX200 series.
21454
21455 Floating-point instructions are only generated for 32-bit floating-
21456 point values, however, so the FPU hardware is not used for doubles
21457 if the -m64bit-doubles option is used.
21458
21459 Note If the -fpu option is enabled then -funsafe-math-optimizations
21460 is also enabled automatically. This is because the RX FPU
21461 instructions are themselves unsafe.
21462
21463 -mcpu=name
21464 Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted. Currently three types
21465 are supported, the generic RX600 and RX200 series hardware and the
21466 specific RX610 CPU. The default is RX600.
21467
21468 The only difference between RX600 and RX610 is that the RX610 does
21469 not support the "MVTIPL" instruction.
21470
21471 The RX200 series does not have a hardware floating-point unit and
21472 so -nofpu is enabled by default when this type is selected.
21473
21474 -mbig-endian-data
21475 -mlittle-endian-data
21476 Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format. The default is
21477 -mlittle-endian-data, i.e. to store data in the little-endian
21478 format.
21479
21480 -msmall-data-limit=N
21481 Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables
21482 which can be placed into the small data area. Using the small data
21483 area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
21484 limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does
21485 not overflow. Also when the small data area is used one of the
21486 RX's registers (usually "r13") is reserved for use pointing to this
21487 area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler. This
21488 could result in slower and/or larger code if variables are pushed
21489 onto the stack instead of being held in this register.
21490
21491 Note, common variables (variables that have not been initialized)
21492 and constants are not placed into the small data area as they are
21493 assigned to other sections in the output executable.
21494
21495 The default value is zero, which disables this feature. Note, this
21496 feature is not enabled by default with higher optimization levels
21497 (-O2 etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of
21498 reserving a register. It is up to the programmer to experiment and
21499 discover whether this feature is of benefit to their program. See
21500 the description of the -mpid option for a description of how the
21501 actual register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.
21502
21503 -msim
21504 -mno-sim
21505 Use the simulator runtime. The default is to use the libgloss
21506 board-specific runtime.
21507
21508 -mas100-syntax
21509 -mno-as100-syntax
21510 When generating assembler output use a syntax that is compatible
21511 with Renesas's AS100 assembler. This syntax can also be handled by
21512 the GAS assembler, but it has some restrictions so it is not
21513 generated by default.
21514
21515 -mmax-constant-size=N
21516 Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a constant that can be
21517 used as an operand in a RX instruction. Although the RX
21518 instruction set does allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to
21519 be used in instructions, a longer value equates to a longer
21520 instruction. Thus in some circumstances it can be beneficial to
21521 restrict the size of constants that are used in instructions.
21522 Constants that are too big are instead placed into a constant pool
21523 and referenced via register indirection.
21524
21525 The value N can be between 0 and 4. A value of 0 (the default) or
21526 4 means that constants of any size are allowed.
21527
21528 -mrelax
21529 Enable linker relaxation. Linker relaxation is a process whereby
21530 the linker attempts to reduce the size of a program by finding
21531 shorter versions of various instructions. Disabled by default.
21532
21533 -mint-register=N
21534 Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt
21535 handler functions. The value N can be between 0 and 4. A value of
21536 1 means that register "r13" is reserved for the exclusive use of
21537 fast interrupt handlers. A value of 2 reserves "r13" and "r12". A
21538 value of 3 reserves "r13", "r12" and "r11", and a value of 4
21539 reserves "r13" through "r10". A value of 0, the default, does not
21540 reserve any registers.
21541
21542 -msave-acc-in-interrupts
21543 Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the
21544 accumulator register. This is only necessary if normal code might
21545 use the accumulator register, for example because it performs
21546 64-bit multiplications. The default is to ignore the accumulator
21547 as this makes the interrupt handlers faster.
21548
21549 -mpid
21550 -mno-pid
21551 Enables the generation of position independent data. When enabled
21552 any access to constant data is done via an offset from a base
21553 address held in a register. This allows the location of constant
21554 data to be determined at run time without requiring the executable
21555 to be relocated, which is a benefit to embedded applications with
21556 tight memory constraints. Data that can be modified is not
21557 affected by this option.
21558
21559 Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually "r13", for
21560 the constant data base address. This can result in slower and/or
21561 larger code, especially in complicated functions.
21562
21563 The actual register chosen to hold the constant data base address
21564 depends upon whether the -msmall-data-limit and/or the
21565 -mint-register command-line options are enabled. Starting with
21566 register "r13" and proceeding downwards, registers are allocated
21567 first to satisfy the requirements of -mint-register, then -mpid and
21568 finally -msmall-data-limit. Thus it is possible for the small data
21569 area register to be "r8" if both -mint-register=4 and -mpid are
21570 specified on the command line.
21571
21572 By default this feature is not enabled. The default can be
21573 restored via the -mno-pid command-line option.
21574
21575 -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
21576 -mwarn-multiple-fast-interrupts
21577 Prevents GCC from issuing a warning message if it finds more than
21578 one fast interrupt handler when it is compiling a file. The
21579 default is to issue a warning for each extra fast interrupt handler
21580 found, as the RX only supports one such interrupt.
21581
21582 -mallow-string-insns
21583 -mno-allow-string-insns
21584 Enables or disables the use of the string manipulation instructions
21585 "SMOVF", "SCMPU", "SMOVB", "SMOVU", "SUNTIL" "SWHILE" and also the
21586 "RMPA" instruction. These instructions may prefetch data, which is
21587 not safe to do if accessing an I/O register. (See section 12.2.7
21588 of the RX62N Group User's Manual for more information).
21589
21590 The default is to allow these instructions, but it is not possible
21591 for GCC to reliably detect all circumstances where a string
21592 instruction might be used to access an I/O register, so their use
21593 cannot be disabled automatically. Instead it is reliant upon the
21594 programmer to use the -mno-allow-string-insns option if their
21595 program accesses I/O space.
21596
21597 When the instructions are enabled GCC defines the C preprocessor
21598 symbol "__RX_ALLOW_STRING_INSNS__", otherwise it defines the symbol
21599 "__RX_DISALLOW_STRING_INSNS__".
21600
21601 -mjsr
21602 -mno-jsr
21603 Use only (or not only) "JSR" instructions to access functions.
21604 This option can be used when code size exceeds the range of "BSR"
21605 instructions. Note that -mno-jsr does not mean to not use "JSR"
21606 but instead means that any type of branch may be used.
21607
21608 Note: The generic GCC command-line option -ffixed-reg has special
21609 significance to the RX port when used with the "interrupt" function
21610 attribute. This attribute indicates a function intended to process
21611 fast interrupts. GCC ensures that it only uses the registers "r10",
21612 "r11", "r12" and/or "r13" and only provided that the normal use of the
21613 corresponding registers have been restricted via the -ffixed-reg or
21614 -mint-register command-line options.
21615
21616 S/390 and zSeries Options
21617
21618 These are the -m options defined for the S/390 and zSeries
21619 architecture.
21620
21621 -mhard-float
21622 -msoft-float
21623 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and
21624 registers for floating-point operations. When -msoft-float is
21625 specified, functions in libgcc.a are used to perform floating-point
21626 operations. When -mhard-float is specified, the compiler generates
21627 IEEE floating-point instructions. This is the default.
21628
21629 -mhard-dfp
21630 -mno-hard-dfp
21631 Use (do not use) the hardware decimal-floating-point instructions
21632 for decimal-floating-point operations. When -mno-hard-dfp is
21633 specified, functions in libgcc.a are used to perform decimal-
21634 floating-point operations. When -mhard-dfp is specified, the
21635 compiler generates decimal-floating-point hardware instructions.
21636 This is the default for -march=z9-ec or higher.
21637
21638 -mlong-double-64
21639 -mlong-double-128
21640 These switches control the size of "long double" type. A size of 64
21641 bits makes the "long double" type equivalent to the "double" type.
21642 This is the default.
21643
21644 -mbackchain
21645 -mno-backchain
21646 Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain
21647 pointer into the callee's stack frame. A backchain may be needed
21648 to allow debugging using tools that do not understand DWARF call
21649 frame information. When -mno-packed-stack is in effect, the
21650 backchain pointer is stored at the bottom of the stack frame; when
21651 -mpacked-stack is in effect, the backchain is placed into the
21652 topmost word of the 96/160 byte register save area.
21653
21654 In general, code compiled with -mbackchain is call-compatible with
21655 code compiled with -mmo-backchain; however, use of the backchain
21656 for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is
21657 built with -mbackchain. Note that the combination of -mbackchain,
21658 -mpacked-stack and -mhard-float is not supported. In order to
21659 build a linux kernel use -msoft-float.
21660
21661 The default is to not maintain the backchain.
21662
21663 -mpacked-stack
21664 -mno-packed-stack
21665 Use (do not use) the packed stack layout. When -mno-packed-stack
21666 is specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte
21667 register save area only for their default purpose; unused fields
21668 still take up stack space. When -mpacked-stack is specified,
21669 register save slots are densely packed at the top of the register
21670 save area; unused space is reused for other purposes, allowing for
21671 more efficient use of the available stack space. However, when
21672 -mbackchain is also in effect, the topmost word of the save area is
21673 always used to store the backchain, and the return address register
21674 is always saved two words below the backchain.
21675
21676 As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated
21677 with -mpacked-stack is call-compatible with code generated with
21678 -mno-packed-stack. Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
21679 S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain
21680 at run time, not just for debugging purposes. Such code is not
21681 call-compatible with code compiled with -mpacked-stack. Also, note
21682 that the combination of -mbackchain, -mpacked-stack and
21683 -mhard-float is not supported. In order to build a linux kernel
21684 use -msoft-float.
21685
21686 The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
21687
21688 -msmall-exec
21689 -mno-small-exec
21690 Generate (or do not generate) code using the "bras" instruction to
21691 do subroutine calls. This only works reliably if the total
21692 executable size does not exceed 64k. The default is to use the
21693 "basr" instruction instead, which does not have this limitation.
21694
21695 -m64
21696 -m31
21697 When -m31 is specified, generate code compliant to the GNU/Linux
21698 for S/390 ABI. When -m64 is specified, generate code compliant to
21699 the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI. This allows GCC in particular to
21700 generate 64-bit instructions. For the s390 targets, the default is
21701 -m31, while the s390x targets default to -m64.
21702
21703 -mzarch
21704 -mesa
21705 When -mzarch is specified, generate code using the instructions
21706 available on z/Architecture. When -mesa is specified, generate
21707 code using the instructions available on ESA/390. Note that -mesa
21708 is not possible with -m64. When generating code compliant to the
21709 GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI, the default is -mesa. When generating
21710 code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is
21711 -mzarch.
21712
21713 -mhtm
21714 -mno-htm
21715 The -mhtm option enables a set of builtins making use of
21716 instructions available with the transactional execution facility
21717 introduced with the IBM zEnterprise EC12 machine generation S/390
21718 System z Built-in Functions. -mhtm is enabled by default when
21719 using -march=zEC12.
21720
21721 -mvx
21722 -mno-vx
21723 When -mvx is specified, generate code using the instructions
21724 available with the vector extension facility introduced with the
21725 IBM z13 machine generation. This option changes the ABI for some
21726 vector type values with regard to alignment and calling
21727 conventions. In case vector type values are being used in an ABI-
21728 relevant context a GAS .gnu_attribute command will be added to mark
21729 the resulting binary with the ABI used. -mvx is enabled by default
21730 when using -march=z13.
21731
21732 -mzvector
21733 -mno-zvector
21734 The -mzvector option enables vector language extensions and
21735 builtins using instructions available with the vector extension
21736 facility introduced with the IBM z13 machine generation. This
21737 option adds support for vector to be used as a keyword to define
21738 vector type variables and arguments. vector is only available when
21739 GNU extensions are enabled. It will not be expanded when
21740 requesting strict standard compliance e.g. with -std=c99. In
21741 addition to the GCC low-level builtins -mzvector enables a set of
21742 builtins added for compatibility with AltiVec-style implementations
21743 like Power and Cell. In order to make use of these builtins the
21744 header file vecintrin.h needs to be included. -mzvector is
21745 disabled by default.
21746
21747 -mmvcle
21748 -mno-mvcle
21749 Generate (or do not generate) code using the "mvcle" instruction to
21750 perform block moves. When -mno-mvcle is specified, use a "mvc"
21751 loop instead. This is the default unless optimizing for size.
21752
21753 -mdebug
21754 -mno-debug
21755 Print (or do not print) additional debug information when
21756 compiling. The default is to not print debug information.
21757
21758 -march=cpu-type
21759 Generate code that runs on cpu-type, which is the name of a system
21760 representing a certain processor type. Possible values for cpu-
21761 type are z900/arch5, z990/arch6, z9-109, z9-ec/arch7, z10/arch8,
21762 z196/arch9, zEC12, z13/arch11, z14/arch12, and native.
21763
21764 The default is -march=z900.
21765
21766 Specifying native as cpu type can be used to select the best
21767 architecture option for the host processor. -march=native has no
21768 effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.
21769
21770 -mtune=cpu-type
21771 Tune to cpu-type everything applicable about the generated code,
21772 except for the ABI and the set of available instructions. The list
21773 of cpu-type values is the same as for -march. The default is the
21774 value used for -march.
21775
21776 -mtpf-trace
21777 -mno-tpf-trace
21778 Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches
21779 to trace routines in the operating system. This option is off by
21780 default, even when compiling for the TPF OS.
21781
21782 -mfused-madd
21783 -mno-fused-madd
21784 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply
21785 and accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by
21786 default if hardware floating point is used.
21787
21788 -mwarn-framesize=framesize
21789 Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame
21790 size. Because this is a compile-time check it doesn't need to be a
21791 real problem when the program runs. It is intended to identify
21792 functions that most probably cause a stack overflow. It is useful
21793 to be used in an environment with limited stack size e.g. the linux
21794 kernel.
21795
21796 -mwarn-dynamicstack
21797 Emit a warning if the function calls "alloca" or uses dynamically-
21798 sized arrays. This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack
21799 size.
21800
21801 -mstack-guard=stack-guard
21802 -mstack-size=stack-size
21803 If these options are provided the S/390 back end emits additional
21804 instructions in the function prologue that trigger a trap if the
21805 stack size is stack-guard bytes above the stack-size (remember that
21806 the stack on S/390 grows downward). If the stack-guard option is
21807 omitted the smallest power of 2 larger than the frame size of the
21808 compiled function is chosen. These options are intended to be used
21809 to help debugging stack overflow problems. The additionally
21810 emitted code causes only little overhead and hence can also be used
21811 in production-like systems without greater performance degradation.
21812 The given values have to be exact powers of 2 and stack-size has to
21813 be greater than stack-guard without exceeding 64k. In order to be
21814 efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
21815 at an address aligned to the value given by stack-size. The stack-
21816 guard option can only be used in conjunction with stack-size.
21817
21818 -mhotpatch=pre-halfwords,post-halfwords
21819 If the hotpatch option is enabled, a "hot-patching" function
21820 prologue is generated for all functions in the compilation unit.
21821 The funtion label is prepended with the given number of two-byte
21822 NOP instructions (pre-halfwords, maximum 1000000). After the
21823 label, 2 * post-halfwords bytes are appended, using the largest NOP
21824 like instructions the architecture allows (maximum 1000000).
21825
21826 If both arguments are zero, hotpatching is disabled.
21827
21828 This option can be overridden for individual functions with the
21829 "hotpatch" attribute.
21830
21831 Score Options
21832
21833 These options are defined for Score implementations:
21834
21835 -meb
21836 Compile code for big-endian mode. This is the default.
21837
21838 -mel
21839 Compile code for little-endian mode.
21840
21841 -mnhwloop
21842 Disable generation of "bcnz" instructions.
21843
21844 -muls
21845 Enable generation of unaligned load and store instructions.
21846
21847 -mmac
21848 Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by
21849 default.
21850
21851 -mscore5
21852 Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
21853
21854 -mscore5u
21855 Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
21856
21857 -mscore7
21858 Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
21859
21860 -mscore7d
21861 Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
21862
21863 SH Options
21864
21865 These -m options are defined for the SH implementations:
21866
21867 -m1 Generate code for the SH1.
21868
21869 -m2 Generate code for the SH2.
21870
21871 -m2e
21872 Generate code for the SH2e.
21873
21874 -m2a-nofpu
21875 Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a
21876 way that the floating-point unit is not used.
21877
21878 -m2a-single-only
21879 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-
21880 precision floating-point operations are used.
21881
21882 -m2a-single
21883 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is
21884 in single-precision mode by default.
21885
21886 -m2a
21887 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is
21888 in double-precision mode by default.
21889
21890 -m3 Generate code for the SH3.
21891
21892 -m3e
21893 Generate code for the SH3e.
21894
21895 -m4-nofpu
21896 Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
21897
21898 -m4-single-only
21899 Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
21900 supports single-precision arithmetic.
21901
21902 -m4-single
21903 Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
21904 single-precision mode by default.
21905
21906 -m4 Generate code for the SH4.
21907
21908 -m4-100
21909 Generate code for SH4-100.
21910
21911 -m4-100-nofpu
21912 Generate code for SH4-100 in such a way that the floating-point
21913 unit is not used.
21914
21915 -m4-100-single
21916 Generate code for SH4-100 assuming the floating-point unit is in
21917 single-precision mode by default.
21918
21919 -m4-100-single-only
21920 Generate code for SH4-100 in such a way that no double-precision
21921 floating-point operations are used.
21922
21923 -m4-200
21924 Generate code for SH4-200.
21925
21926 -m4-200-nofpu
21927 Generate code for SH4-200 without in such a way that the floating-
21928 point unit is not used.
21929
21930 -m4-200-single
21931 Generate code for SH4-200 assuming the floating-point unit is in
21932 single-precision mode by default.
21933
21934 -m4-200-single-only
21935 Generate code for SH4-200 in such a way that no double-precision
21936 floating-point operations are used.
21937
21938 -m4-300
21939 Generate code for SH4-300.
21940
21941 -m4-300-nofpu
21942 Generate code for SH4-300 without in such a way that the floating-
21943 point unit is not used.
21944
21945 -m4-300-single
21946 Generate code for SH4-300 in such a way that no double-precision
21947 floating-point operations are used.
21948
21949 -m4-300-single-only
21950 Generate code for SH4-300 in such a way that no double-precision
21951 floating-point operations are used.
21952
21953 -m4-340
21954 Generate code for SH4-340 (no MMU, no FPU).
21955
21956 -m4-500
21957 Generate code for SH4-500 (no FPU). Passes -isa=sh4-nofpu to the
21958 assembler.
21959
21960 -m4a-nofpu
21961 Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that
21962 the floating-point unit is not used.
21963
21964 -m4a-single-only
21965 Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
21966 floating-point operations are used.
21967
21968 -m4a-single
21969 Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
21970 single-precision mode by default.
21971
21972 -m4a
21973 Generate code for the SH4a.
21974
21975 -m4al
21976 Same as -m4a-nofpu, except that it implicitly passes -dsp to the
21977 assembler. GCC doesn't generate any DSP instructions at the
21978 moment.
21979
21980 -mb Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.
21981
21982 -ml Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.
21983
21984 -mdalign
21985 Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries. Note that this changes the
21986 calling conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C
21987 library do not work unless you recompile it first with -mdalign.
21988
21989 -mrelax
21990 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses
21991 the linker option -relax.
21992
21993 -mbigtable
21994 Use 32-bit offsets in "switch" tables. The default is to use
21995 16-bit offsets.
21996
21997 -mbitops
21998 Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.
21999
22000 -mfmovd
22001 Enable the use of the instruction "fmovd". Check -mdalign for
22002 alignment constraints.
22003
22004 -mrenesas
22005 Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
22006
22007 -mno-renesas
22008 Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the
22009 Renesas conventions were available. This option is the default for
22010 all targets of the SH toolchain.
22011
22012 -mnomacsave
22013 Mark the "MAC" register as call-clobbered, even if -mrenesas is
22014 given.
22015
22016 -mieee
22017 -mno-ieee
22018 Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which
22019 affects the handling of cases where the result of a comparison is
22020 unordered. By default -mieee is implicitly enabled. If
22021 -ffinite-math-only is enabled -mno-ieee is implicitly set, which
22022 results in faster floating-point greater-equal and less-equal
22023 comparisons. The implicit settings can be overridden by specifying
22024 either -mieee or -mno-ieee.
22025
22026 -minline-ic_invalidate
22027 Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting
22028 up nested function trampolines. This option has no effect if
22029 -musermode is in effect and the selected code generation option
22030 (e.g. -m4) does not allow the use of the "icbi" instruction. If
22031 the selected code generation option does not allow the use of the
22032 "icbi" instruction, and -musermode is not in effect, the inlined
22033 code manipulates the instruction cache address array directly with
22034 an associative write. This not only requires privileged mode at
22035 run time, but it also fails if the cache line had been mapped via
22036 the TLB and has become unmapped.
22037
22038 -misize
22039 Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
22040
22041 -mpadstruct
22042 This option is deprecated. It pads structures to multiple of 4
22043 bytes, which is incompatible with the SH ABI.
22044
22045 -matomic-model=model
22046 Sets the model of atomic operations and additional parameters as a
22047 comma separated list. For details on the atomic built-in functions
22048 see __atomic Builtins. The following models and parameters are
22049 supported:
22050
22051 none
22052 Disable compiler generated atomic sequences and emit library
22053 calls for atomic operations. This is the default if the target
22054 is not "sh*-*-linux*".
22055
22056 soft-gusa
22057 Generate GNU/Linux compatible gUSA software atomic sequences
22058 for the atomic built-in functions. The generated atomic
22059 sequences require additional support from the
22060 interrupt/exception handling code of the system and are only
22061 suitable for SH3* and SH4* single-core systems. This option is
22062 enabled by default when the target is "sh*-*-linux*" and SH3*
22063 or SH4*. When the target is SH4A, this option also partially
22064 utilizes the hardware atomic instructions "movli.l" and
22065 "movco.l" to create more efficient code, unless strict is
22066 specified.
22067
22068 soft-tcb
22069 Generate software atomic sequences that use a variable in the
22070 thread control block. This is a variation of the gUSA
22071 sequences which can also be used on SH1* and SH2* targets. The
22072 generated atomic sequences require additional support from the
22073 interrupt/exception handling code of the system and are only
22074 suitable for single-core systems. When using this model, the
22075 gbr-offset= parameter has to be specified as well.
22076
22077 soft-imask
22078 Generate software atomic sequences that temporarily disable
22079 interrupts by setting "SR.IMASK = 1111". This model works only
22080 when the program runs in privileged mode and is only suitable
22081 for single-core systems. Additional support from the
22082 interrupt/exception handling code of the system is not
22083 required. This model is enabled by default when the target is
22084 "sh*-*-linux*" and SH1* or SH2*.
22085
22086 hard-llcs
22087 Generate hardware atomic sequences using the "movli.l" and
22088 "movco.l" instructions only. This is only available on SH4A
22089 and is suitable for multi-core systems. Since the hardware
22090 instructions support only 32 bit atomic variables access to 8
22091 or 16 bit variables is emulated with 32 bit accesses. Code
22092 compiled with this option is also compatible with other
22093 software atomic model interrupt/exception handling systems if
22094 executed on an SH4A system. Additional support from the
22095 interrupt/exception handling code of the system is not required
22096 for this model.
22097
22098 gbr-offset=
22099 This parameter specifies the offset in bytes of the variable in
22100 the thread control block structure that should be used by the
22101 generated atomic sequences when the soft-tcb model has been
22102 selected. For other models this parameter is ignored. The
22103 specified value must be an integer multiple of four and in the
22104 range 0-1020.
22105
22106 strict
22107 This parameter prevents mixed usage of multiple atomic models,
22108 even if they are compatible, and makes the compiler generate
22109 atomic sequences of the specified model only.
22110
22111 -mtas
22112 Generate the "tas.b" opcode for "__atomic_test_and_set". Notice
22113 that depending on the particular hardware and software
22114 configuration this can degrade overall performance due to the
22115 operand cache line flushes that are implied by the "tas.b"
22116 instruction. On multi-core SH4A processors the "tas.b" instruction
22117 must be used with caution since it can result in data corruption
22118 for certain cache configurations.
22119
22120 -mprefergot
22121 When generating position-independent code, emit function calls
22122 using the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage
22123 Table.
22124
22125 -musermode
22126 -mno-usermode
22127 Don't allow (allow) the compiler generating privileged mode code.
22128 Specifying -musermode also implies -mno-inline-ic_invalidate if the
22129 inlined code would not work in user mode. -musermode is the
22130 default when the target is "sh*-*-linux*". If the target is SH1*
22131 or SH2* -musermode has no effect, since there is no user mode.
22132
22133 -multcost=number
22134 Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
22135
22136 -mdiv=strategy
22137 Set the division strategy to be used for integer division
22138 operations. strategy can be one of:
22139
22140 call-div1
22141 Calls a library function that uses the single-step division
22142 instruction "div1" to perform the operation. Division by zero
22143 calculates an unspecified result and does not trap. This is
22144 the default except for SH4, SH2A and SHcompact.
22145
22146 call-fp
22147 Calls a library function that performs the operation in double
22148 precision floating point. Division by zero causes a floating-
22149 point exception. This is the default for SHcompact with FPU.
22150 Specifying this for targets that do not have a double precision
22151 FPU defaults to "call-div1".
22152
22153 call-table
22154 Calls a library function that uses a lookup table for small
22155 divisors and the "div1" instruction with case distinction for
22156 larger divisors. Division by zero calculates an unspecified
22157 result and does not trap. This is the default for SH4.
22158 Specifying this for targets that do not have dynamic shift
22159 instructions defaults to "call-div1".
22160
22161 When a division strategy has not been specified the default
22162 strategy is selected based on the current target. For SH2A the
22163 default strategy is to use the "divs" and "divu" instructions
22164 instead of library function calls.
22165
22166 -maccumulate-outgoing-args
22167 Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue
22168 rather than around each call. Generally beneficial for performance
22169 and size. Also needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack
22170 frame around conditional code.
22171
22172 -mdivsi3_libfunc=name
22173 Set the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed
22174 division to name. This only affects the name used in the call
22175 division strategies, and the compiler still expects the same sets
22176 of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option were not
22177 present.
22178
22179 -mfixed-range=register-range
22180 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
22181 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use.
22182 This is useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is
22183 specified as two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register
22184 ranges can be specified separated by a comma.
22185
22186 -mbranch-cost=num
22187 Assume num to be the cost for a branch instruction. Higher numbers
22188 make the compiler try to generate more branch-free code if
22189 possible. If not specified the value is selected depending on the
22190 processor type that is being compiled for.
22191
22192 -mzdcbranch
22193 -mno-zdcbranch
22194 Assume (do not assume) that zero displacement conditional branch
22195 instructions "bt" and "bf" are fast. If -mzdcbranch is specified,
22196 the compiler prefers zero displacement branch code sequences. This
22197 is enabled by default when generating code for SH4 and SH4A. It
22198 can be explicitly disabled by specifying -mno-zdcbranch.
22199
22200 -mcbranch-force-delay-slot
22201 Force the usage of delay slots for conditional branches, which
22202 stuffs the delay slot with a "nop" if a suitable instruction cannot
22203 be found. By default this option is disabled. It can be enabled
22204 to work around hardware bugs as found in the original SH7055.
22205
22206 -mfused-madd
22207 -mno-fused-madd
22208 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply
22209 and accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by
22210 default if hardware floating point is used. The machine-dependent
22211 -mfused-madd option is now mapped to the machine-independent
22212 -ffp-contract=fast option, and -mno-fused-madd is mapped to
22213 -ffp-contract=off.
22214
22215 -mfsca
22216 -mno-fsca
22217 Allow or disallow the compiler to emit the "fsca" instruction for
22218 sine and cosine approximations. The option -mfsca must be used in
22219 combination with -funsafe-math-optimizations. It is enabled by
22220 default when generating code for SH4A. Using -mno-fsca disables
22221 sine and cosine approximations even if -funsafe-math-optimizations
22222 is in effect.
22223
22224 -mfsrra
22225 -mno-fsrra
22226 Allow or disallow the compiler to emit the "fsrra" instruction for
22227 reciprocal square root approximations. The option -mfsrra must be
22228 used in combination with -funsafe-math-optimizations and
22229 -ffinite-math-only. It is enabled by default when generating code
22230 for SH4A. Using -mno-fsrra disables reciprocal square root
22231 approximations even if -funsafe-math-optimizations and
22232 -ffinite-math-only are in effect.
22233
22234 -mpretend-cmove
22235 Prefer zero-displacement conditional branches for conditional move
22236 instruction patterns. This can result in faster code on the SH4
22237 processor.
22238
22239 -mfdpic
22240 Generate code using the FDPIC ABI.
22241
22242 Solaris 2 Options
22243
22244 These -m options are supported on Solaris 2:
22245
22246 -mclear-hwcap
22247 -mclear-hwcap tells the compiler to remove the hardware
22248 capabilities generated by the Solaris assembler. This is only
22249 necessary when object files use ISA extensions not supported by the
22250 current machine, but check at runtime whether or not to use them.
22251
22252 -mimpure-text
22253 -mimpure-text, used in addition to -shared, tells the compiler to
22254 not pass -z text to the linker when linking a shared object. Using
22255 this option, you can link position-dependent code into a shared
22256 object.
22257
22258 -mimpure-text suppresses the "relocations remain against
22259 allocatable but non-writable sections" linker error message.
22260 However, the necessary relocations trigger copy-on-write, and the
22261 shared object is not actually shared across processes. Instead of
22262 using -mimpure-text, you should compile all source code with -fpic
22263 or -fPIC.
22264
22265 These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:
22266
22267 -pthreads
22268 This is a synonym for -pthread.
22269
22270 SPARC Options
22271
22272 These -m options are supported on the SPARC:
22273
22274 -mno-app-regs
22275 -mapp-regs
22276 Specify -mapp-regs to generate output using the global registers 2
22277 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications.
22278 Like the global register 1, each global register 2 through 4 is
22279 then treated as an allocable register that is clobbered by function
22280 calls. This is the default.
22281
22282 To be fully SVR4 ABI-compliant at the cost of some performance
22283 loss, specify -mno-app-regs. You should compile libraries and
22284 system software with this option.
22285
22286 -mflat
22287 -mno-flat
22288 With -mflat, the compiler does not generate save/restore
22289 instructions and uses a "flat" or single register window model.
22290 This model is compatible with the regular register window model.
22291 The local registers and the input registers (0--5) are still
22292 treated as "call-saved" registers and are saved on the stack as
22293 needed.
22294
22295 With -mno-flat (the default), the compiler generates save/restore
22296 instructions (except for leaf functions). This is the normal
22297 operating mode.
22298
22299 -mfpu
22300 -mhard-float
22301 Generate output containing floating-point instructions. This is
22302 the default.
22303
22304 -mno-fpu
22305 -msoft-float
22306 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
22307 Warning: the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
22308 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler
22309 are used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.
22310 You must make your own arrangements to provide suitable library
22311 functions for cross-compilation. The embedded targets sparc-*-aout
22312 and sparclite-*-* do provide software floating-point support.
22313
22314 -msoft-float changes the calling convention in the output file;
22315 therefore, it is only useful if you compile all of a program with
22316 this option. In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the
22317 library that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to
22318 work.
22319
22320 -mhard-quad-float
22321 Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point
22322 instructions.
22323
22324 -msoft-quad-float
22325 Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long
22326 double) floating-point instructions. The functions called are
22327 those specified in the SPARC ABI. This is the default.
22328
22329 As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have
22330 hardware support for the quad-word floating-point instructions.
22331 They all invoke a trap handler for one of these instructions, and
22332 then the trap handler emulates the effect of the instruction.
22333 Because of the trap handler overhead, this is much slower than
22334 calling the ABI library routines. Thus the -msoft-quad-float
22335 option is the default.
22336
22337 -mno-unaligned-doubles
22338 -munaligned-doubles
22339 Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment. This is the default.
22340
22341 With -munaligned-doubles, GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte
22342 alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they
22343 have an absolute address. Otherwise, it assumes they have 4-byte
22344 alignment. Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility
22345 problems with code generated by other compilers. It is not the
22346 default because it results in a performance loss, especially for
22347 floating-point code.
22348
22349 -muser-mode
22350 -mno-user-mode
22351 Do not generate code that can only run in supervisor mode. This is
22352 relevant only for the "casa" instruction emitted for the LEON3
22353 processor. This is the default.
22354
22355 -mfaster-structs
22356 -mno-faster-structs
22357 With -mfaster-structs, the compiler assumes that structures should
22358 have 8-byte alignment. This enables the use of pairs of "ldd" and
22359 "std" instructions for copies in structure assignment, in place of
22360 twice as many "ld" and "st" pairs. However, the use of this
22361 changed alignment directly violates the SPARC ABI. Thus, it's
22362 intended only for use on targets where the developer acknowledges
22363 that their resulting code is not directly in line with the rules of
22364 the ABI.
22365
22366 -mstd-struct-return
22367 -mno-std-struct-return
22368 With -mstd-struct-return, the compiler generates checking code in
22369 functions returning structures or unions to detect size mismatches
22370 between the two sides of function calls, as per the 32-bit ABI.
22371
22372 The default is -mno-std-struct-return. This option has no effect
22373 in 64-bit mode.
22374
22375 -mlra
22376 -mno-lra
22377 Enable Local Register Allocation. This is the default for SPARC
22378 since GCC 7 so -mno-lra needs to be passed to get old Reload.
22379
22380 -mcpu=cpu_type
22381 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
22382 parameters for machine type cpu_type. Supported values for
22383 cpu_type are v7, cypress, v8, supersparc, hypersparc, leon, leon3,
22384 leon3v7, sparclite, f930, f934, sparclite86x, sparclet, tsc701, v9,
22385 ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4,
22386 niagara7 and m8.
22387
22388 Native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains also support the value
22389 native, which selects the best architecture option for the host
22390 processor. -mcpu=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize
22391 the processor.
22392
22393 Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that
22394 select an architecture and not an implementation. These are v7,
22395 v8, sparclite, sparclet, v9.
22396
22397 Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
22398 implementations.
22399
22400 v7 cypress, leon3v7
22401
22402 v8 supersparc, hypersparc, leon, leon3
22403
22404 sparclite
22405 f930, f934, sparclite86x
22406
22407 sparclet
22408 tsc701
22409
22410 v9 ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4,
22411 niagara7, m8
22412
22413 By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for
22414 the V7 variant of the SPARC architecture. With -mcpu=cypress, the
22415 compiler additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as
22416 used in the SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series. This is also
22417 appropriate for the older SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
22418
22419 With -mcpu=v8, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
22420 architecture. The only difference from V7 code is that the
22421 compiler emits the integer multiply and integer divide instructions
22422 which exist in SPARC-V8 but not in SPARC-V7. With
22423 -mcpu=supersparc, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
22424 SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and 2000
22425 series.
22426
22427 With -mcpu=sparclite, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant
22428 of the SPARC architecture. This adds the integer multiply, integer
22429 divide step and scan ("ffs") instructions which exist in SPARClite
22430 but not in SPARC-V7. With -mcpu=f930, the compiler additionally
22431 optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original
22432 SPARClite, with no FPU. With -mcpu=f934, the compiler additionally
22433 optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86934 chip, which is the more recent
22434 SPARClite with FPU.
22435
22436 With -mcpu=sparclet, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
22437 the SPARC architecture. This adds the integer multiply,
22438 multiply/accumulate, integer divide step and scan ("ffs")
22439 instructions which exist in SPARClet but not in SPARC-V7. With
22440 -mcpu=tsc701, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the TEMIC
22441 SPARClet chip.
22442
22443 With -mcpu=v9, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
22444 architecture. This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move
22445 instructions, 3 additional floating-point condition code registers
22446 and conditional move instructions. With -mcpu=ultrasparc, the
22447 compiler additionally optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi
22448 chips. With -mcpu=ultrasparc3, the compiler additionally optimizes
22449 it for the Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips. With
22450 -mcpu=niagara, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
22451 UltraSPARC T1 chips. With -mcpu=niagara2, the compiler
22452 additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With
22453 -mcpu=niagara3, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
22454 UltraSPARC T3 chips. With -mcpu=niagara4, the compiler
22455 additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips. With
22456 -mcpu=niagara7, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Oracle
22457 SPARC M7 chips. With -mcpu=m8, the compiler additionally optimizes
22458 it for Oracle M8 chips.
22459
22460 -mtune=cpu_type
22461 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
22462 cpu_type, but do not set the instruction set or register set that
22463 the option -mcpu=cpu_type does.
22464
22465 The same values for -mcpu=cpu_type can be used for -mtune=cpu_type,
22466 but the only useful values are those that select a particular CPU
22467 implementation. Those are cypress, supersparc, hypersparc, leon,
22468 leon3, leon3v7, f930, f934, sparclite86x, tsc701, ultrasparc,
22469 ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4, niagara7 and
22470 m8. With native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, native can also
22471 be used.
22472
22473 -mv8plus
22474 -mno-v8plus
22475 With -mv8plus, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI. The
22476 difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
22477 considered 64 bits wide. This is enabled by default on Solaris in
22478 32-bit mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
22479
22480 -mvis
22481 -mno-vis
22482 With -mvis, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22483 UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The default is
22484 -mno-vis.
22485
22486 -mvis2
22487 -mno-vis2
22488 With -mvis2, GCC generates code that takes advantage of version 2.0
22489 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The default
22490 is -mvis2 when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions,
22491 such as UltraSPARC-III and later. Setting -mvis2 also sets -mvis.
22492
22493 -mvis3
22494 -mno-vis3
22495 With -mvis3, GCC generates code that takes advantage of version 3.0
22496 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The default
22497 is -mvis3 when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions,
22498 such as niagara-3 and later. Setting -mvis3 also sets -mvis2 and
22499 -mvis.
22500
22501 -mvis4
22502 -mno-vis4
22503 With -mvis4, GCC generates code that takes advantage of version 4.0
22504 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The default
22505 is -mvis4 when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions,
22506 such as niagara-7 and later. Setting -mvis4 also sets -mvis3,
22507 -mvis2 and -mvis.
22508
22509 -mvis4b
22510 -mno-vis4b
22511 With -mvis4b, GCC generates code that takes advantage of version
22512 4.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions, plus the
22513 additional VIS instructions introduced in the Oracle SPARC
22514 Architecture 2017. The default is -mvis4b when targeting a cpu
22515 that supports such instructions, such as m8 and later. Setting
22516 -mvis4b also sets -mvis4, -mvis3, -mvis2 and -mvis.
22517
22518 -mcbcond
22519 -mno-cbcond
22520 With -mcbcond, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22521 UltraSPARC Compare-and-Branch-on-Condition instructions. The
22522 default is -mcbcond when targeting a CPU that supports such
22523 instructions, such as Niagara-4 and later.
22524
22525 -mfmaf
22526 -mno-fmaf
22527 With -mfmaf, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22528 UltraSPARC Fused Multiply-Add Floating-point instructions. The
22529 default is -mfmaf when targeting a CPU that supports such
22530 instructions, such as Niagara-3 and later.
22531
22532 -mfsmuld
22533 -mno-fsmuld
22534 With -mfsmuld, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22535 Floating-point Multiply Single to Double (FsMULd) instruction. The
22536 default is -mfsmuld when targeting a CPU supporting the
22537 architecture versions V8 or V9 with FPU except -mcpu=leon.
22538
22539 -mpopc
22540 -mno-popc
22541 With -mpopc, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22542 UltraSPARC Population Count instruction. The default is -mpopc
22543 when targeting a CPU that supports such an instruction, such as
22544 Niagara-2 and later.
22545
22546 -msubxc
22547 -mno-subxc
22548 With -msubxc, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the
22549 UltraSPARC Subtract-Extended-with-Carry instruction. The default
22550 is -msubxc when targeting a CPU that supports such an instruction,
22551 such as Niagara-7 and later.
22552
22553 -mfix-at697f
22554 Enable the documented workaround for the single erratum of the
22555 Atmel AT697F processor (which corresponds to erratum #13 of the
22556 AT697E processor).
22557
22558 -mfix-ut699
22559 Enable the documented workarounds for the floating-point errata and
22560 the data cache nullify errata of the UT699 processor.
22561
22562 -mfix-ut700
22563 Enable the documented workaround for the back-to-back store errata
22564 of the UT699E/UT700 processor.
22565
22566 -mfix-gr712rc
22567 Enable the documented workaround for the back-to-back store errata
22568 of the GR712RC processor.
22569
22570 These -m options are supported in addition to the above on SPARC-V9
22571 processors in 64-bit environments:
22572
22573 -m32
22574 -m64
22575 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment. The 32-bit
22576 environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits. The 64-bit
22577 environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
22578
22579 -mcmodel=which
22580 Set the code model to one of
22581
22582 medlow
22583 The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs must be
22584 linked in the low 32 bits of memory. Programs can be
22585 statically or dynamically linked.
22586
22587 medmid
22588 The Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs must
22589 be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data
22590 segments must be less than 2GB in size and the data segment
22591 must be located within 2GB of the text segment.
22592
22593 medany
22594 The Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs may
22595 be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must
22596 be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located
22597 within 2GB of the text segment.
22598
22599 embmedany
22600 The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems: 64-bit
22601 addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
22602 size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link
22603 time). The global register %g4 points to the base of the data
22604 segment. Programs are statically linked and PIC is not
22605 supported.
22606
22607 -mmemory-model=mem-model
22608 Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of
22609
22610 default
22611 The default memory model for the processor and operating
22612 system.
22613
22614 rmo Relaxed Memory Order
22615
22616 pso Partial Store Order
22617
22618 tso Total Store Order
22619
22620 sc Sequential Consistency
22621
22622 These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the
22623 SPARC-V9 architecture manual, as set in the processor's "PSTATE.MM"
22624 field.
22625
22626 -mstack-bias
22627 -mno-stack-bias
22628 With -mstack-bias, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and frame
22629 pointer if present, are offset by -2047 which must be added back
22630 when making stack frame references. This is the default in 64-bit
22631 mode. Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
22632
22633 SPU Options
22634
22635 These -m options are supported on the SPU:
22636
22637 -mwarn-reloc
22638 -merror-reloc
22639 The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations. By
22640 default, GCC gives an error when it generates code that requires a
22641 dynamic relocation. -mno-error-reloc disables the error,
22642 -mwarn-reloc generates a warning instead.
22643
22644 -msafe-dma
22645 -munsafe-dma
22646 Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be
22647 reordered with respect to loads and stores of the memory that is
22648 being accessed. With -munsafe-dma you must use the "volatile"
22649 keyword to protect memory accesses, but that can lead to
22650 inefficient code in places where the memory is known to not change.
22651 Rather than mark the memory as volatile, you can use -msafe-dma to
22652 tell the compiler to treat the DMA instructions as potentially
22653 affecting all memory.
22654
22655 -mbranch-hints
22656 By default, GCC generates a branch hint instruction to avoid
22657 pipeline stalls for always-taken or probably-taken branches. A
22658 hint is not generated closer than 8 instructions away from its
22659 branch. There is little reason to disable them, except for
22660 debugging purposes, or to make an object a little bit smaller.
22661
22662 -msmall-mem
22663 -mlarge-mem
22664 By default, GCC generates code assuming that addresses are never
22665 larger than 18 bits. With -mlarge-mem code is generated that
22666 assumes a full 32-bit address.
22667
22668 -mstdmain
22669 By default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-
22670 style main function interface (which has an unconventional
22671 parameter list). With -mstdmain, GCC links your program against
22672 startup code that assumes a C99-style interface to "main",
22673 including a local copy of "argv" strings.
22674
22675 -mfixed-range=register-range
22676 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
22677 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use.
22678 This is useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is
22679 specified as two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register
22680 ranges can be specified separated by a comma.
22681
22682 -mea32
22683 -mea64
22684 Compile code assuming that pointers to the PPU address space
22685 accessed via the "__ea" named address space qualifier are either 32
22686 or 64 bits wide. The default is 32 bits. As this is an ABI-
22687 changing option, all object code in an executable must be compiled
22688 with the same setting.
22689
22690 -maddress-space-conversion
22691 -mno-address-space-conversion
22692 Allow/disallow treating the "__ea" address space as superset of the
22693 generic address space. This enables explicit type casts between
22694 "__ea" and generic pointer as well as implicit conversions of
22695 generic pointers to "__ea" pointers. The default is to allow
22696 address space pointer conversions.
22697
22698 -mcache-size=cache-size
22699 This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links
22700 to an executable and selects a software-managed cache for accessing
22701 variables in the "__ea" address space with a particular cache size.
22702 Possible options for cache-size are 8, 16, 32, 64 and 128. The
22703 default cache size is 64KB.
22704
22705 -matomic-updates
22706 -mno-atomic-updates
22707 This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links
22708 to an executable and selects whether atomic updates to the
22709 software-managed cache of PPU-side variables are used. If you use
22710 atomic updates, changes to a PPU variable from SPU code using the
22711 "__ea" named address space qualifier do not interfere with changes
22712 to other PPU variables residing in the same cache line from PPU
22713 code. If you do not use atomic updates, such interference may
22714 occur; however, writing back cache lines is more efficient. The
22715 default behavior is to use atomic updates.
22716
22717 -mdual-nops
22718 -mdual-nops=n
22719 By default, GCC inserts NOPs to increase dual issue when it expects
22720 it to increase performance. n can be a value from 0 to 10. A
22721 smaller n inserts fewer NOPs. 10 is the default, 0 is the same as
22722 -mno-dual-nops. Disabled with -Os.
22723
22724 -mhint-max-nops=n
22725 Maximum number of NOPs to insert for a branch hint. A branch hint
22726 must be at least 8 instructions away from the branch it is
22727 affecting. GCC inserts up to n NOPs to enforce this, otherwise it
22728 does not generate the branch hint.
22729
22730 -mhint-max-distance=n
22731 The encoding of the branch hint instruction limits the hint to be
22732 within 256 instructions of the branch it is affecting. By default,
22733 GCC makes sure it is within 125.
22734
22735 -msafe-hints
22736 Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall
22737 indefinitely. By default, GCC inserts the "hbrp" instruction to
22738 make sure this stall won't happen.
22739
22740 Options for System V
22741
22742 These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
22743 compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
22744
22745 -G Create a shared object. It is recommended that -symbolic or
22746 -shared be used instead.
22747
22748 -Qy Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
22749 ".ident" assembler directive in the output.
22750
22751 -Qn Refrain from adding ".ident" directives to the output file (this is
22752 the default).
22753
22754 -YP,dirs
22755 Search the directories dirs, and no others, for libraries specified
22756 with -l.
22757
22758 -Ym,dir
22759 Look in the directory dir to find the M4 preprocessor. The
22760 assembler uses this option.
22761
22762 TILE-Gx Options
22763
22764 These -m options are supported on the TILE-Gx:
22765
22766 -mcmodel=small
22767 Generate code for the small model. The distance for direct calls
22768 is limited to 500M in either direction. PC-relative addresses are
22769 32 bits. Absolute addresses support the full address range.
22770
22771 -mcmodel=large
22772 Generate code for the large model. There is no limitation on call
22773 distance, pc-relative addresses, or absolute addresses.
22774
22775 -mcpu=name
22776 Selects the type of CPU to be targeted. Currently the only
22777 supported type is tilegx.
22778
22779 -m32
22780 -m64
22781 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment. The 32-bit
22782 environment sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits. The 64-bit
22783 environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
22784
22785 -mbig-endian
22786 -mlittle-endian
22787 Generate code in big/little endian mode, respectively.
22788
22789 TILEPro Options
22790
22791 These -m options are supported on the TILEPro:
22792
22793 -mcpu=name
22794 Selects the type of CPU to be targeted. Currently the only
22795 supported type is tilepro.
22796
22797 -m32
22798 Generate code for a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and
22799 pointer to 32 bits. This is the only supported behavior so the
22800 flag is essentially ignored.
22801
22802 V850 Options
22803
22804 These -m options are defined for V850 implementations:
22805
22806 -mlong-calls
22807 -mno-long-calls
22808 Treat all calls as being far away (near). If calls are assumed to
22809 be far away, the compiler always loads the function's address into
22810 a register, and calls indirect through the pointer.
22811
22812 -mno-ep
22813 -mep
22814 Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
22815 pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the "ep" register, and
22816 use the shorter "sld" and "sst" instructions. The -mep option is
22817 on by default if you optimize.
22818
22819 -mno-prolog-function
22820 -mprolog-function
22821 Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore
22822 registers at the prologue and epilogue of a function. The external
22823 functions are slower, but use less code space if more than one
22824 function saves the same number of registers. The -mprolog-function
22825 option is on by default if you optimize.
22826
22827 -mspace
22828 Try to make the code as small as possible. At present, this just
22829 turns on the -mep and -mprolog-function options.
22830
22831 -mtda=n
22832 Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into
22833 the tiny data area that register "ep" points to. The tiny data
22834 area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte
22835 references).
22836
22837 -msda=n
22838 Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into
22839 the small data area that register "gp" points to. The small data
22840 area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
22841
22842 -mzda=n
22843 Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into
22844 the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
22845
22846 -mv850
22847 Specify that the target processor is the V850.
22848
22849 -mv850e3v5
22850 Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5. The
22851 preprocessor constant "__v850e3v5__" is defined if this option is
22852 used.
22853
22854 -mv850e2v4
22855 Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5. This is an
22856 alias for the -mv850e3v5 option.
22857
22858 -mv850e2v3
22859 Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3. The
22860 preprocessor constant "__v850e2v3__" is defined if this option is
22861 used.
22862
22863 -mv850e2
22864 Specify that the target processor is the V850E2. The preprocessor
22865 constant "__v850e2__" is defined if this option is used.
22866
22867 -mv850e1
22868 Specify that the target processor is the V850E1. The preprocessor
22869 constants "__v850e1__" and "__v850e__" are defined if this option
22870 is used.
22871
22872 -mv850es
22873 Specify that the target processor is the V850ES. This is an alias
22874 for the -mv850e1 option.
22875
22876 -mv850e
22877 Specify that the target processor is the V850E. The preprocessor
22878 constant "__v850e__" is defined if this option is used.
22879
22880 If neither -mv850 nor -mv850e nor -mv850e1 nor -mv850e2 nor
22881 -mv850e2v3 nor -mv850e3v5 are defined then a default target
22882 processor is chosen and the relevant __v850*__ preprocessor
22883 constant is defined.
22884
22885 The preprocessor constants "__v850" and "__v851__" are always
22886 defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
22887
22888 -mdisable-callt
22889 -mno-disable-callt
22890 This option suppresses generation of the "CALLT" instruction for
22891 the v850e, v850e1, v850e2, v850e2v3 and v850e3v5 flavors of the
22892 v850 architecture.
22893
22894 This option is enabled by default when the RH850 ABI is in use (see
22895 -mrh850-abi), and disabled by default when the GCC ABI is in use.
22896 If "CALLT" instructions are being generated then the C preprocessor
22897 symbol "__V850_CALLT__" is defined.
22898
22899 -mrelax
22900 -mno-relax
22901 Pass on (or do not pass on) the -mrelax command-line option to the
22902 assembler.
22903
22904 -mlong-jumps
22905 -mno-long-jumps
22906 Disable (or re-enable) the generation of PC-relative jump
22907 instructions.
22908
22909 -msoft-float
22910 -mhard-float
22911 Disable (or re-enable) the generation of hardware floating point
22912 instructions. This option is only significant when the target
22913 architecture is V850E2V3 or higher. If hardware floating point
22914 instructions are being generated then the C preprocessor symbol
22915 "__FPU_OK__" is defined, otherwise the symbol "__NO_FPU__" is
22916 defined.
22917
22918 -mloop
22919 Enables the use of the e3v5 LOOP instruction. The use of this
22920 instruction is not enabled by default when the e3v5 architecture is
22921 selected because its use is still experimental.
22922
22923 -mrh850-abi
22924 -mghs
22925 Enables support for the RH850 version of the V850 ABI. This is the
22926 default. With this version of the ABI the following rules apply:
22927
22928 * Integer sized structures and unions are returned via a memory
22929 pointer rather than a register.
22930
22931 * Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are
22932 passed by value.
22933
22934 * Functions are aligned to 16-bit boundaries.
22935
22936 * The -m8byte-align command-line option is supported.
22937
22938 * The -mdisable-callt command-line option is enabled by default.
22939 The -mno-disable-callt command-line option is not supported.
22940
22941 When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol
22942 "__V850_RH850_ABI__" is defined.
22943
22944 -mgcc-abi
22945 Enables support for the old GCC version of the V850 ABI. With this
22946 version of the ABI the following rules apply:
22947
22948 * Integer sized structures and unions are returned in register
22949 "r10".
22950
22951 * Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are
22952 passed by reference.
22953
22954 * Functions are aligned to 32-bit boundaries, unless optimizing
22955 for size.
22956
22957 * The -m8byte-align command-line option is not supported.
22958
22959 * The -mdisable-callt command-line option is supported but not
22960 enabled by default.
22961
22962 When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol
22963 "__V850_GCC_ABI__" is defined.
22964
22965 -m8byte-align
22966 -mno-8byte-align
22967 Enables support for "double" and "long long" types to be aligned on
22968 8-byte boundaries. The default is to restrict the alignment of all
22969 objects to at most 4-bytes. When -m8byte-align is in effect the C
22970 preprocessor symbol "__V850_8BYTE_ALIGN__" is defined.
22971
22972 -mbig-switch
22973 Generate code suitable for big switch tables. Use this option only
22974 if the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within
22975 a switch table.
22976
22977 -mapp-regs
22978 This option causes r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
22979 the compiler. This setting is the default.
22980
22981 -mno-app-regs
22982 This option causes r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
22983
22984 VAX Options
22985
22986 These -m options are defined for the VAX:
22987
22988 -munix
22989 Do not output certain jump instructions ("aobleq" and so on) that
22990 the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long ranges.
22991
22992 -mgnu
22993 Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that the GNU
22994 assembler is being used.
22995
22996 -mg Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of
22997 D-format.
22998
22999 Visium Options
23000
23001 -mdebug
23002 A program which performs file I/O and is destined to run on an MCM
23003 target should be linked with this option. It causes the libraries
23004 libc.a and libdebug.a to be linked. The program should be run on
23005 the target under the control of the GDB remote debugging stub.
23006
23007 -msim
23008 A program which performs file I/O and is destined to run on the
23009 simulator should be linked with option. This causes libraries
23010 libc.a and libsim.a to be linked.
23011
23012 -mfpu
23013 -mhard-float
23014 Generate code containing floating-point instructions. This is the
23015 default.
23016
23017 -mno-fpu
23018 -msoft-float
23019 Generate code containing library calls for floating-point.
23020
23021 -msoft-float changes the calling convention in the output file;
23022 therefore, it is only useful if you compile all of a program with
23023 this option. In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the
23024 library that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to
23025 work.
23026
23027 -mcpu=cpu_type
23028 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
23029 parameters for machine type cpu_type. Supported values for
23030 cpu_type are mcm, gr5 and gr6.
23031
23032 mcm is a synonym of gr5 present for backward compatibility.
23033
23034 By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for
23035 the GR5 variant of the Visium architecture.
23036
23037 With -mcpu=gr6, GCC generates code for the GR6 variant of the
23038 Visium architecture. The only difference from GR5 code is that the
23039 compiler will generate block move instructions.
23040
23041 -mtune=cpu_type
23042 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
23043 cpu_type, but do not set the instruction set or register set that
23044 the option -mcpu=cpu_type would.
23045
23046 -msv-mode
23047 Generate code for the supervisor mode, where there are no
23048 restrictions on the access to general registers. This is the
23049 default.
23050
23051 -muser-mode
23052 Generate code for the user mode, where the access to some general
23053 registers is forbidden: on the GR5, registers r24 to r31 cannot be
23054 accessed in this mode; on the GR6, only registers r29 to r31 are
23055 affected.
23056
23057 VMS Options
23058
23059 These -m options are defined for the VMS implementations:
23060
23061 -mvms-return-codes
23062 Return VMS condition codes from "main". The default is to return
23063 POSIX-style condition (e.g. error) codes.
23064
23065 -mdebug-main=prefix
23066 Flag the first routine whose name starts with prefix as the main
23067 routine for the debugger.
23068
23069 -mmalloc64
23070 Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
23071
23072 -mpointer-size=size
23073 Set the default size of pointers. Possible options for size are 32
23074 or short for 32 bit pointers, 64 or long for 64 bit pointers, and
23075 no for supporting only 32 bit pointers. The later option disables
23076 "pragma pointer_size".
23077
23078 VxWorks Options
23079
23080 The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.
23081 Options specific to the target hardware are listed with the other
23082 options for that target.
23083
23084 -mrtp
23085 GCC can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time
23086 processes (RTPs). This option switches from the former to the
23087 latter. It also defines the preprocessor macro "__RTP__".
23088
23089 -non-static
23090 Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static
23091 libraries. The options -static and -shared can also be used for
23092 RTPs; -static is the default.
23093
23094 -Bstatic
23095 -Bdynamic
23096 These options are passed down to the linker. They are defined for
23097 compatibility with Diab.
23098
23099 -Xbind-lazy
23100 Enable lazy binding of function calls. This option is equivalent
23101 to -Wl,-z,now and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
23102
23103 -Xbind-now
23104 Disable lazy binding of function calls. This option is the default
23105 and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
23106
23107 x86 Options
23108
23109 These -m options are defined for the x86 family of computers.
23110
23111 -march=cpu-type
23112 Generate instructions for the machine type cpu-type. In contrast
23113 to -mtune=cpu-type, which merely tunes the generated code for the
23114 specified cpu-type, -march=cpu-type allows GCC to generate code
23115 that may not run at all on processors other than the one indicated.
23116 Specifying -march=cpu-type implies -mtune=cpu-type.
23117
23118 The choices for cpu-type are:
23119
23120 native
23121 This selects the CPU to generate code for at compilation time
23122 by determining the processor type of the compiling machine.
23123 Using -march=native enables all instruction subsets supported
23124 by the local machine (hence the result might not run on
23125 different machines). Using -mtune=native produces code
23126 optimized for the local machine under the constraints of the
23127 selected instruction set.
23128
23129 x86-64
23130 A generic CPU with 64-bit extensions.
23131
23132 i386
23133 Original Intel i386 CPU.
23134
23135 i486
23136 Intel i486 CPU. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23137
23138 i586
23139 pentium
23140 Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
23141
23142 lakemont
23143 Intel Lakemont MCU, based on Intel Pentium CPU.
23144
23145 pentium-mmx
23146 Intel Pentium MMX CPU, based on Pentium core with MMX
23147 instruction set support.
23148
23149 pentiumpro
23150 Intel Pentium Pro CPU.
23151
23152 i686
23153 When used with -march, the Pentium Pro instruction set is used,
23154 so the code runs on all i686 family chips. When used with
23155 -mtune, it has the same meaning as generic.
23156
23157 pentium2
23158 Intel Pentium II CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX
23159 instruction set support.
23160
23161 pentium3
23162 pentium3m
23163 Intel Pentium III CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX and
23164 SSE instruction set support.
23165
23166 pentium-m
23167 Intel Pentium M; low-power version of Intel Pentium III CPU
23168 with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support. Used by
23169 Centrino notebooks.
23170
23171 pentium4
23172 pentium4m
23173 Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set
23174 support.
23175
23176 prescott
23177 Improved version of Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and
23178 SSE3 instruction set support.
23179
23180 nocona
23181 Improved version of Intel Pentium 4 CPU with 64-bit extensions,
23182 MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
23183
23184 core2
23185 Intel Core 2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3
23186 and SSSE3 instruction set support.
23187
23188 nehalem
23189 Intel Nehalem CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3,
23190 SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2 and POPCNT instruction set support.
23191
23192 westmere
23193 Intel Westmere CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2,
23194 SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES and PCLMUL instruction
23195 set support.
23196
23197 sandybridge
23198 Intel Sandy Bridge CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2,
23199 SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AES and PCLMUL
23200 instruction set support.
23201
23202 ivybridge
23203 Intel Ivy Bridge CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2,
23204 SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AES, PCLMUL,
23205 FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction set support.
23206
23207 haswell
23208 Intel Haswell CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23209 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23210 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2 and F16C instruction
23211 set support.
23212
23213 broadwell
23214 Intel Broadwell CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23215 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23216 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX and
23217 PREFETCHW instruction set support.
23218
23219 skylake
23220 Intel Skylake CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23221 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23222 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX,
23223 PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC and XSAVES instruction set
23224 support.
23225
23226 bonnell
23227 Intel Bonnell CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23228 SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3 instruction set support.
23229
23230 silvermont
23231 Intel Silvermont CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23232 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL and
23233 RDRND instruction set support.
23234
23235 goldmont
23236 Intel Goldmont CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23237 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL, RDRND,
23238 XSAVE, XSAVEOPT and FSGSBASE instruction set support.
23239
23240 goldmont-plus
23241 Intel Goldmont Plus CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23242 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL,
23243 RDRND, XSAVE, XSAVEOPT, FSGSBASE, PTWRITE, RDPID, SGX and UMIP
23244 instruction set support.
23245
23246 tremont
23247 Intel Tremont CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23248 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL, RDRND,
23249 XSAVE, XSAVEOPT, FSGSBASE, PTWRITE, RDPID, SGX, UMIP, GFNI-SSE,
23250 CLWB and ENCLV instruction set support.
23251
23252 knl Intel Knight's Landing CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23253 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23254 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX,
23255 PREFETCHW, AVX512F, AVX512PF, AVX512ER and AVX512CD instruction
23256 set support.
23257
23258 knm Intel Knights Mill CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23259 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23260 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX,
23261 PREFETCHW, AVX512F, AVX512PF, AVX512ER, AVX512CD, AVX5124VNNIW,
23262 AVX5124FMAPS and AVX512VPOPCNTDQ instruction set support.
23263
23264 skylake-avx512
23265 Intel Skylake Server CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23266 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, PKU, AVX, AVX2,
23267 AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED,
23268 ADCX, PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, AVX512F, CLWB,
23269 AVX512VL, AVX512BW, AVX512DQ and AVX512CD instruction set
23270 support.
23271
23272 cannonlake
23273 Intel Cannonlake Server CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23274 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, PKU, AVX, AVX2,
23275 AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED,
23276 ADCX, PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, AVX512F, AVX512VL,
23277 AVX512BW, AVX512DQ, AVX512CD, AVX512VBMI, AVX512IFMA, SHA and
23278 UMIP instruction set support.
23279
23280 icelake-client
23281 Intel Icelake Client CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23282 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, PKU, AVX, AVX2,
23283 AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED,
23284 ADCX, PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, AVX512F, AVX512VL,
23285 AVX512BW, AVX512DQ, AVX512CD, AVX512VBMI, AVX512IFMA, SHA,
23286 CLWB, UMIP, RDPID, GFNI, AVX512VBMI2, AVX512VPOPCNTDQ,
23287 AVX512BITALG, AVX512VNNI, VPCLMULQDQ, VAES instruction set
23288 support.
23289
23290 icelake-server
23291 Intel Icelake Server CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX,
23292 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, PKU, AVX, AVX2,
23293 AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED,
23294 ADCX, PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, AVX512F, AVX512VL,
23295 AVX512BW, AVX512DQ, AVX512CD, AVX512VBMI, AVX512IFMA, SHA,
23296 CLWB, UMIP, RDPID, GFNI, AVX512VBMI2, AVX512VPOPCNTDQ,
23297 AVX512BITALG, AVX512VNNI, VPCLMULQDQ, VAES, PCONFIG and
23298 WBNOINVD instruction set support.
23299
23300 cascadelake
23301 Intel Cascadelake CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE,
23302 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, PKU, AVX, AVX2, AES,
23303 PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX,
23304 PREFETCHW, CLFLUSHOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, AVX512F, CLWB, AVX512VL,
23305 AVX512BW, AVX512DQ, AVX512CD and AVX512VNNI instruction set
23306 support.
23307
23308 k6 AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
23309
23310 k6-2
23311 k6-3
23312 Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction
23313 set support.
23314
23315 athlon
23316 athlon-tbird
23317 AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow! and SSE
23318 prefetch instructions support.
23319
23320 athlon-4
23321 athlon-xp
23322 athlon-mp
23323 Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow! and
23324 full SSE instruction set support.
23325
23326 k8
23327 opteron
23328 athlon64
23329 athlon-fx
23330 Processors based on the AMD K8 core with x86-64 instruction set
23331 support, including the AMD Opteron, Athlon 64, and Athlon 64 FX
23332 processors. (This supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3DNow!, enhanced
23333 3DNow! and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
23334
23335 k8-sse3
23336 opteron-sse3
23337 athlon64-sse3
23338 Improved versions of AMD K8 cores with SSE3 instruction set
23339 support.
23340
23341 amdfam10
23342 barcelona
23343 CPUs based on AMD Family 10h cores with x86-64 instruction set
23344 support. (This supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!,
23345 enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
23346
23347 bdver1
23348 CPUs based on AMD Family 15h cores with x86-64 instruction set
23349 support. (This supersets FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL,
23350 CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM
23351 and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
23352
23353 bdver2
23354 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set
23355 support. (This supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, AVX, XOP,
23356 LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3,
23357 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
23358
23359 bdver3
23360 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set
23361 support. (This supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, FSGSBASE,
23362 AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A,
23363 SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set
23364 extensions.
23365
23366 bdver4
23367 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set
23368 support. (This supersets BMI, BMI2, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4,
23369 FSGSBASE, AVX, AVX2, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MOVBE, MMX,
23370 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit
23371 instruction set extensions.
23372
23373 znver1
23374 AMD Family 17h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set
23375 support. (This supersets BMI, BMI2, F16C, FMA, FSGSBASE, AVX,
23376 AVX2, ADCX, RDSEED, MWAITX, SHA, CLZERO, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16,
23377 MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM,
23378 XSAVEC, XSAVES, CLFLUSHOPT, POPCNT, and 64-bit instruction set
23379 extensions.
23380
23381 znver2
23382 AMD Family 17h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set
23383 support. (This supersets BMI, BMI2, ,CLWB, F16C, FMA, FSGSBASE,
23384 AVX, AVX2, ADCX, RDSEED, MWAITX, SHA, CLZERO, AES, PCL_MUL,
23385 CX16, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1,
23386 SSE4.2, ABM, XSAVEC, XSAVES, CLFLUSHOPT, POPCNT, and 64-bit
23387 instruction set extensions.)
23388
23389 btver1
23390 CPUs based on AMD Family 14h cores with x86-64 instruction set
23391 support. (This supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A,
23392 CX16, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
23393
23394 btver2
23395 CPUs based on AMD Family 16h cores with x86-64 instruction set
23396 support. This includes MOVBE, F16C, BMI, AVX, PCL_MUL, AES,
23397 SSE4.2, SSE4.1, CX16, ABM, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE3, SSE2, SSE, MMX
23398 and 64-bit instruction set extensions.
23399
23400 winchip-c6
23401 IDT WinChip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional
23402 MMX instruction set support.
23403
23404 winchip2
23405 IDT WinChip 2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional
23406 MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.
23407
23408 c3 VIA C3 CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support. (No
23409 scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23410
23411 c3-2
23412 VIA C3-2 (Nehemiah/C5XL) CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set
23413 support. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23414
23415 c7 VIA C7 (Esther) CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
23416 set support. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23417
23418 samuel-2
23419 VIA Eden Samuel 2 CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set
23420 support. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23421
23422 nehemiah
23423 VIA Eden Nehemiah CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.
23424 (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23425
23426 esther
23427 VIA Eden Esther CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
23428 set support. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23429
23430 eden-x2
23431 VIA Eden X2 CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3
23432 instruction set support. (No scheduling is implemented for
23433 this chip.)
23434
23435 eden-x4
23436 VIA Eden X4 CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
23437 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX and AVX2 instruction set support. (No
23438 scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
23439
23440 nano
23441 Generic VIA Nano CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and
23442 SSSE3 instruction set support. (No scheduling is implemented
23443 for this chip.)
23444
23445 nano-1000
23446 VIA Nano 1xxx CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
23447 instruction set support. (No scheduling is implemented for
23448 this chip.)
23449
23450 nano-2000
23451 VIA Nano 2xxx CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
23452 instruction set support. (No scheduling is implemented for
23453 this chip.)
23454
23455 nano-3000
23456 VIA Nano 3xxx CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3 and
23457 SSE4.1 instruction set support. (No scheduling is implemented
23458 for this chip.)
23459
23460 nano-x2
23461 VIA Nano Dual Core CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3
23462 and SSE4.1 instruction set support. (No scheduling is
23463 implemented for this chip.)
23464
23465 nano-x4
23466 VIA Nano Quad Core CPU with x86-64, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3
23467 and SSE4.1 instruction set support. (No scheduling is
23468 implemented for this chip.)
23469
23470 geode
23471 AMD Geode embedded processor with MMX and 3DNow! instruction
23472 set support.
23473
23474 -mtune=cpu-type
23475 Tune to cpu-type everything applicable about the generated code,
23476 except for the ABI and the set of available instructions. While
23477 picking a specific cpu-type schedules things appropriately for that
23478 particular chip, the compiler does not generate any code that
23479 cannot run on the default machine type unless you use a -march=cpu-
23480 type option. For example, if GCC is configured for
23481 i686-pc-linux-gnu then -mtune=pentium4 generates code that is tuned
23482 for Pentium 4 but still runs on i686 machines.
23483
23484 The choices for cpu-type are the same as for -march. In addition,
23485 -mtune supports 2 extra choices for cpu-type:
23486
23487 generic
23488 Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/AMD64/EM64T
23489 processors. If you know the CPU on which your code will run,
23490 then you should use the corresponding -mtune or -march option
23491 instead of -mtune=generic. But, if you do not know exactly
23492 what CPU users of your application will have, then you should
23493 use this option.
23494
23495 As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior
23496 of this option will change. Therefore, if you upgrade to a
23497 newer version of GCC, code generation controlled by this option
23498 will change to reflect the processors that are most common at
23499 the time that version of GCC is released.
23500
23501 There is no -march=generic option because -march indicates the
23502 instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no generic
23503 instruction set applicable to all processors. In contrast,
23504 -mtune indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
23505 processors) for which the code is optimized.
23506
23507 intel
23508 Produce code optimized for the most current Intel processors,
23509 which are Haswell and Silvermont for this version of GCC. If
23510 you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should
23511 use the corresponding -mtune or -march option instead of
23512 -mtune=intel. But, if you want your application performs
23513 better on both Haswell and Silvermont, then you should use this
23514 option.
23515
23516 As new Intel processors are deployed in the marketplace, the
23517 behavior of this option will change. Therefore, if you upgrade
23518 to a newer version of GCC, code generation controlled by this
23519 option will change to reflect the most current Intel processors
23520 at the time that version of GCC is released.
23521
23522 There is no -march=intel option because -march indicates the
23523 instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no common
23524 instruction set applicable to all processors. In contrast,
23525 -mtune indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
23526 processors) for which the code is optimized.
23527
23528 -mcpu=cpu-type
23529 A deprecated synonym for -mtune.
23530
23531 -mfpmath=unit
23532 Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit unit. The
23533 choices for unit are:
23534
23535 387 Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the
23536 majority of chips and emulated otherwise. Code compiled with
23537 this option runs almost everywhere. The temporary results are
23538 computed in 80-bit precision instead of the precision specified
23539 by the type, resulting in slightly different results compared
23540 to most of other chips. See -ffloat-store for more detailed
23541 description.
23542
23543 This is the default choice for non-Darwin x86-32 targets.
23544
23545 sse Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE
23546 instruction set. This instruction set is supported by Pentium
23547 III and newer chips, and in the AMD line by Athlon-4, Athlon XP
23548 and Athlon MP chips. The earlier version of the SSE
23549 instruction set supports only single-precision arithmetic, thus
23550 the double and extended-precision arithmetic are still done
23551 using 387. A later version, present only in Pentium 4 and AMD
23552 x86-64 chips, supports double-precision arithmetic too.
23553
23554 For the x86-32 compiler, you must use -march=cpu-type, -msse or
23555 -msse2 switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
23556 effective. For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are
23557 enabled by default.
23558
23559 The resulting code should be considerably faster in the
23560 majority of cases and avoid the numerical instability problems
23561 of 387 code, but may break some existing code that expects
23562 temporaries to be 80 bits.
23563
23564 This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler, Darwin
23565 x86-32 targets, and the default choice for x86-32 targets with
23566 the SSE2 instruction set when -ffast-math is enabled.
23567
23568 sse,387
23569 sse+387
23570 both
23571 Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once. This
23572 effectively doubles the amount of available registers, and on
23573 chips with separate execution units for 387 and SSE the
23574 execution resources too. Use this option with care, as it is
23575 still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not
23576 model separate functional units well, resulting in unstable
23577 performance.
23578
23579 -masm=dialect
23580 Output assembly instructions using selected dialect. Also affects
23581 which dialect is used for basic "asm" and extended "asm". Supported
23582 choices (in dialect order) are att or intel. The default is att.
23583 Darwin does not support intel.
23584
23585 -mieee-fp
23586 -mno-ieee-fp
23587 Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point
23588 comparisons. These correctly handle the case where the result of a
23589 comparison is unordered.
23590
23591 -m80387
23592 -mhard-float
23593 Generate output containing 80387 instructions for floating point.
23594
23595 -mno-80387
23596 -msoft-float
23597 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
23598
23599 Warning: the requisite libraries are not part of GCC. Normally the
23600 facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but this
23601 cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make your
23602 own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for cross-
23603 compilation.
23604
23605 On machines where a function returns floating-point results in the
23606 80387 register stack, some floating-point opcodes may be emitted
23607 even if -msoft-float is used.
23608
23609 -mno-fp-ret-in-387
23610 Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
23611
23612 The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
23613 "float" and "double" in an FPU register, even if there is no FPU.
23614 The idea is that the operating system should emulate an FPU.
23615
23616 The option -mno-fp-ret-in-387 causes such values to be returned in
23617 ordinary CPU registers instead.
23618
23619 -mno-fancy-math-387
23620 Some 387 emulators do not support the "sin", "cos" and "sqrt"
23621 instructions for the 387. Specify this option to avoid generating
23622 those instructions. This option is overridden when -march
23623 indicates that the target CPU always has an FPU and so the
23624 instruction does not need emulation. These instructions are not
23625 generated unless you also use the -funsafe-math-optimizations
23626 switch.
23627
23628 -malign-double
23629 -mno-align-double
23630 Control whether GCC aligns "double", "long double", and "long long"
23631 variables on a two-word boundary or a one-word boundary. Aligning
23632 "double" variables on a two-word boundary produces code that runs
23633 somewhat faster on a Pentium at the expense of more memory.
23634
23635 On x86-64, -malign-double is enabled by default.
23636
23637 Warning: if you use the -malign-double switch, structures
23638 containing the above types are aligned differently than the
23639 published application binary interface specifications for the
23640 x86-32 and are not binary compatible with structures in code
23641 compiled without that switch.
23642
23643 -m96bit-long-double
23644 -m128bit-long-double
23645 These switches control the size of "long double" type. The x86-32
23646 application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits, so
23647 -m96bit-long-double is the default in 32-bit mode.
23648
23649 Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer "long double" to be
23650 aligned to an 8- or 16-byte boundary. In arrays or structures
23651 conforming to the ABI, this is not possible. So specifying
23652 -m128bit-long-double aligns "long double" to a 16-byte boundary by
23653 padding the "long double" with an additional 32-bit zero.
23654
23655 In the x86-64 compiler, -m128bit-long-double is the default choice
23656 as its ABI specifies that "long double" is aligned on 16-byte
23657 boundary.
23658
23659 Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision
23660 over the x87 standard of 80 bits for a "long double".
23661
23662 Warning: if you override the default value for your target ABI,
23663 this changes the size of structures and arrays containing "long
23664 double" variables, as well as modifying the function calling
23665 convention for functions taking "long double". Hence they are not
23666 binary-compatible with code compiled without that switch.
23667
23668 -mlong-double-64
23669 -mlong-double-80
23670 -mlong-double-128
23671 These switches control the size of "long double" type. A size of 64
23672 bits makes the "long double" type equivalent to the "double" type.
23673 This is the default for 32-bit Bionic C library. A size of 128
23674 bits makes the "long double" type equivalent to the "__float128"
23675 type. This is the default for 64-bit Bionic C library.
23676
23677 Warning: if you override the default value for your target ABI,
23678 this changes the size of structures and arrays containing "long
23679 double" variables, as well as modifying the function calling
23680 convention for functions taking "long double". Hence they are not
23681 binary-compatible with code compiled without that switch.
23682
23683 -malign-data=type
23684 Control how GCC aligns variables. Supported values for type are
23685 compat uses increased alignment value compatible uses GCC 4.8 and
23686 earlier, abi uses alignment value as specified by the psABI, and
23687 cacheline uses increased alignment value to match the cache line
23688 size. compat is the default.
23689
23690 -mlarge-data-threshold=threshold
23691 When -mcmodel=medium is specified, data objects larger than
23692 threshold are placed in the large data section. This value must be
23693 the same across all objects linked into the binary, and defaults to
23694 65535.
23695
23696 -mrtd
23697 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
23698 that take a fixed number of arguments return with the "ret num"
23699 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This
23700 saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
23701 the arguments there.
23702
23703 You can specify that an individual function is called with this
23704 calling sequence with the function attribute "stdcall". You can
23705 also override the -mrtd option by using the function attribute
23706 "cdecl".
23707
23708 Warning: this calling convention is incompatible with the one
23709 normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
23710 libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
23711
23712 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
23713 take variable numbers of arguments (including "printf"); otherwise
23714 incorrect code is generated for calls to those functions.
23715
23716 In addition, seriously incorrect code results if you call a
23717 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
23718 harmlessly ignored.)
23719
23720 -mregparm=num
23721 Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments. By
23722 default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
23723 registers can be used. You can control this behavior for a
23724 specific function by using the function attribute "regparm".
23725
23726 Warning: if you use this switch, and num is nonzero, then you must
23727 build all modules with the same value, including any libraries.
23728 This includes the system libraries and startup modules.
23729
23730 -msseregparm
23731 Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
23732 and return values. You can control this behavior for a specific
23733 function by using the function attribute "sseregparm".
23734
23735 Warning: if you use this switch then you must build all modules
23736 with the same value, including any libraries. This includes the
23737 system libraries and startup modules.
23738
23739 -mvect8-ret-in-mem
23740 Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers. This is
23741 the default on Solaris@tie{}8 and 9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of
23742 the Sun Studio compilers until version 12. Later compiler versions
23743 (starting with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used by
23744 other x86 targets, which is the default on Solaris@tie{}10 and
23745 later. Only use this option if you need to remain compatible with
23746 existing code produced by those previous compiler versions or older
23747 versions of GCC.
23748
23749 -mpc32
23750 -mpc64
23751 -mpc80
23752 Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits. When
23753 -mpc32 is specified, the significands of results of floating-point
23754 operations are rounded to 24 bits (single precision); -mpc64 rounds
23755 the significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits
23756 (double precision) and -mpc80 rounds the significands of results of
23757 floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision),
23758 which is the default. When this option is used, floating-point
23759 operations in higher precisions are not available to the programmer
23760 without setting the FPU control word explicitly.
23761
23762 Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the
23763 default 80 bits can speed some programs by 2% or more. Note that
23764 some mathematical libraries assume that extended-precision (80-bit)
23765 floating-point operations are enabled by default; routines in such
23766 libraries could suffer significant loss of accuracy, typically
23767 through so-called "catastrophic cancellation", when this option is
23768 used to set the precision to less than extended precision.
23769
23770 -mstackrealign
23771 Realign the stack at entry. On the x86, the -mstackrealign option
23772 generates an alternate prologue and epilogue that realigns the run-
23773 time stack if necessary. This supports mixing legacy codes that
23774 keep 4-byte stack alignment with modern codes that keep 16-byte
23775 stack alignment for SSE compatibility. See also the attribute
23776 "force_align_arg_pointer", applicable to individual functions.
23777
23778 -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
23779 Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to num
23780 byte boundary. If -mpreferred-stack-boundary is not specified, the
23781 default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
23782
23783 Warning: When generating code for the x86-64 architecture with SSE
23784 extensions disabled, -mpreferred-stack-boundary=3 can be used to
23785 keep the stack boundary aligned to 8 byte boundary. Since x86-64
23786 ABI require 16 byte stack alignment, this is ABI incompatible and
23787 intended to be used in controlled environment where stack space is
23788 important limitation. This option leads to wrong code when
23789 functions compiled with 16 byte stack alignment (such as functions
23790 from a standard library) are called with misaligned stack. In this
23791 case, SSE instructions may lead to misaligned memory access traps.
23792 In addition, variable arguments are handled incorrectly for 16 byte
23793 aligned objects (including x87 long double and __int128), leading
23794 to wrong results. You must build all modules with
23795 -mpreferred-stack-boundary=3, including any libraries. This
23796 includes the system libraries and startup modules.
23797
23798 -mincoming-stack-boundary=num
23799 Assume the incoming stack is aligned to a 2 raised to num byte
23800 boundary. If -mincoming-stack-boundary is not specified, the one
23801 specified by -mpreferred-stack-boundary is used.
23802
23803 On Pentium and Pentium Pro, "double" and "long double" values
23804 should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary (see -malign-double) or
23805 suffer significant run time performance penalties. On Pentium III,
23806 the Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type "__m128" may not work
23807 properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.
23808
23809 To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack
23810 boundary must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on
23811 the stack. Further, every function must be generated such that it
23812 keeps the stack aligned. Thus calling a function compiled with a
23813 higher preferred stack boundary from a function compiled with a
23814 lower preferred stack boundary most likely misaligns the stack. It
23815 is recommended that libraries that use callbacks always use the
23816 default setting.
23817
23818 This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
23819 increases code size. Code that is sensitive to stack space usage,
23820 such as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to
23821 reduce the preferred alignment to -mpreferred-stack-boundary=2.
23822
23823 -mmmx
23824 -msse
23825 -msse2
23826 -msse3
23827 -mssse3
23828 -msse4
23829 -msse4a
23830 -msse4.1
23831 -msse4.2
23832 -mavx
23833 -mavx2
23834 -mavx512f
23835 -mavx512pf
23836 -mavx512er
23837 -mavx512cd
23838 -mavx512vl
23839 -mavx512bw
23840 -mavx512dq
23841 -mavx512ifma
23842 -mavx512vbmi
23843 -msha
23844 -maes
23845 -mpclmul
23846 -mclflushopt
23847 -mclwb
23848 -mfsgsbase
23849 -mptwrite
23850 -mrdrnd
23851 -mf16c
23852 -mfma
23853 -mpconfig
23854 -mwbnoinvd
23855 -mfma4
23856 -mprfchw
23857 -mrdpid
23858 -mprefetchwt1
23859 -mrdseed
23860 -msgx
23861 -mxop
23862 -mlwp
23863 -m3dnow
23864 -m3dnowa
23865 -mpopcnt
23866 -mabm
23867 -madx
23868 -mbmi
23869 -mbmi2
23870 -mlzcnt
23871 -mfxsr
23872 -mxsave
23873 -mxsaveopt
23874 -mxsavec
23875 -mxsaves
23876 -mrtm
23877 -mhle
23878 -mtbm
23879 -mmwaitx
23880 -mclzero
23881 -mpku
23882 -mavx512vbmi2
23883 -mgfni
23884 -mvaes
23885 -mwaitpkg
23886 -mvpclmulqdq
23887 -mavx512bitalg
23888 -mmovdiri
23889 -mmovdir64b
23890 -mavx512vpopcntdq
23891 -mavx5124fmaps
23892 -mavx512vnni
23893 -mavx5124vnniw
23894 -mcldemote
23895 These switches enable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE,
23896 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4, SSE4A, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AVX2, AVX512F,
23897 AVX512PF, AVX512ER, AVX512CD, AVX512VL, AVX512BW, AVX512DQ,
23898 AVX512IFMA, AVX512VBMI, SHA, AES, PCLMUL, CLFLUSHOPT, CLWB,
23899 FSGSBASE, PTWRITE, RDRND, F16C, FMA, PCONFIG, WBNOINVD, FMA4,
23900 PREFETCHW, RDPID, PREFETCHWT1, RDSEED, SGX, XOP, LWP, 3DNow!,
23901 enhanced 3DNow!, POPCNT, ABM, ADX, BMI, BMI2, LZCNT, FXSR, XSAVE,
23902 XSAVEOPT, XSAVEC, XSAVES, RTM, HLE, TBM, MWAITX, CLZERO, PKU,
23903 AVX512VBMI2, GFNI, VAES, WAITPKG, VPCLMULQDQ, AVX512BITALG,
23904 MOVDIRI, MOVDIR64B, AVX512VPOPCNTDQ, AVX5124FMAPS, AVX512VNNI,
23905 AVX5124VNNIW, or CLDEMOTE extended instruction sets. Each has a
23906 corresponding -mno- option to disable use of these instructions.
23907
23908 These extensions are also available as built-in functions: see x86
23909 Built-in Functions, for details of the functions enabled and
23910 disabled by these switches.
23911
23912 To generate SSE/SSE2 instructions automatically from floating-point
23913 code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see -mfpmath=sse.
23914
23915 GCC depresses SSEx instructions when -mavx is used. Instead, it
23916 generates new AVX instructions or AVX equivalence for all SSEx
23917 instructions when needed.
23918
23919 These options enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
23920 generated code, even without -mfpmath=sse. Applications that
23921 perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
23922 supported architecture, using the appropriate flags. In
23923 particular, the file containing the CPU detection code should be
23924 compiled without these options.
23925
23926 -mdump-tune-features
23927 This option instructs GCC to dump the names of the x86 performance
23928 tuning features and default settings. The names can be used in
23929 -mtune-ctrl=feature-list.
23930
23931 -mtune-ctrl=feature-list
23932 This option is used to do fine grain control of x86 code generation
23933 features. feature-list is a comma separated list of feature names.
23934 See also -mdump-tune-features. When specified, the feature is
23935 turned on if it is not preceded with ^, otherwise, it is turned
23936 off. -mtune-ctrl=feature-list is intended to be used by GCC
23937 developers. Using it may lead to code paths not covered by testing
23938 and can potentially result in compiler ICEs or runtime errors.
23939
23940 -mno-default
23941 This option instructs GCC to turn off all tunable features. See
23942 also -mtune-ctrl=feature-list and -mdump-tune-features.
23943
23944 -mcld
23945 This option instructs GCC to emit a "cld" instruction in the
23946 prologue of functions that use string instructions. String
23947 instructions depend on the DF flag to select between autoincrement
23948 or autodecrement mode. While the ABI specifies the DF flag to be
23949 cleared on function entry, some operating systems violate this
23950 specification by not clearing the DF flag in their exception
23951 dispatchers. The exception handler can be invoked with the DF flag
23952 set, which leads to wrong direction mode when string instructions
23953 are used. This option can be enabled by default on 32-bit x86
23954 targets by configuring GCC with the --enable-cld configure option.
23955 Generation of "cld" instructions can be suppressed with the
23956 -mno-cld compiler option in this case.
23957
23958 -mvzeroupper
23959 This option instructs GCC to emit a "vzeroupper" instruction before
23960 a transfer of control flow out of the function to minimize the AVX
23961 to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary "zeroupper"
23962 intrinsics.
23963
23964 -mprefer-avx128
23965 This option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead
23966 of 256-bit AVX instructions in the auto-vectorizer.
23967
23968 -mprefer-vector-width=opt
23969 This option instructs GCC to use opt-bit vector width in
23970 instructions instead of default on the selected platform.
23971
23972 none
23973 No extra limitations applied to GCC other than defined by the
23974 selected platform.
23975
23976 128 Prefer 128-bit vector width for instructions.
23977
23978 256 Prefer 256-bit vector width for instructions.
23979
23980 512 Prefer 512-bit vector width for instructions.
23981
23982 -mcx16
23983 This option enables GCC to generate "CMPXCHG16B" instructions in
23984 64-bit code to implement compare-and-exchange operations on 16-byte
23985 aligned 128-bit objects. This is useful for atomic updates of data
23986 structures exceeding one machine word in size. The compiler uses
23987 this instruction to implement __sync Builtins. However, for
23988 __atomic Builtins operating on 128-bit integers, a library call is
23989 always used.
23990
23991 -msahf
23992 This option enables generation of "SAHF" instructions in 64-bit
23993 code. Early Intel Pentium 4 CPUs with Intel 64 support, prior to
23994 the introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December 2005, lacked the
23995 "LAHF" and "SAHF" instructions which are supported by AMD64. These
23996 are load and store instructions, respectively, for certain status
23997 flags. In 64-bit mode, the "SAHF" instruction is used to optimize
23998 "fmod", "drem", and "remainder" built-in functions; see Other
23999 Builtins for details.
24000
24001 -mmovbe
24002 This option enables use of the "movbe" instruction to implement
24003 "__builtin_bswap32" and "__builtin_bswap64".
24004
24005 -mshstk
24006 The -mshstk option enables shadow stack built-in functions from x86
24007 Control-flow Enforcement Technology (CET).
24008
24009 -mcrc32
24010 This option enables built-in functions "__builtin_ia32_crc32qi",
24011 "__builtin_ia32_crc32hi", "__builtin_ia32_crc32si" and
24012 "__builtin_ia32_crc32di" to generate the "crc32" machine
24013 instruction.
24014
24015 -mrecip
24016 This option enables use of "RCPSS" and "RSQRTSS" instructions (and
24017 their vectorized variants "RCPPS" and "RSQRTPS") with an additional
24018 Newton-Raphson step to increase precision instead of "DIVSS" and
24019 "SQRTSS" (and their vectorized variants) for single-precision
24020 floating-point arguments. These instructions are generated only
24021 when -funsafe-math-optimizations is enabled together with
24022 -ffinite-math-only and -fno-trapping-math. Note that while the
24023 throughput of the sequence is higher than the throughput of the
24024 non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
24025 decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals
24026 0.99999994).
24027
24028 Note that GCC implements "1.0f/sqrtf(x)" in terms of "RSQRTSS" (or
24029 "RSQRTPS") already with -ffast-math (or the above option
24030 combination), and doesn't need -mrecip.
24031
24032 Also note that GCC emits the above sequence with additional Newton-
24033 Raphson step for vectorized single-float division and vectorized
24034 "sqrtf(x)" already with -ffast-math (or the above option
24035 combination), and doesn't need -mrecip.
24036
24037 -mrecip=opt
24038 This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions may be
24039 used. opt is a comma-separated list of options, which may be
24040 preceded by a ! to invert the option:
24041
24042 all Enable all estimate instructions.
24043
24044 default
24045 Enable the default instructions, equivalent to -mrecip.
24046
24047 none
24048 Disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to -mno-recip.
24049
24050 div Enable the approximation for scalar division.
24051
24052 vec-div
24053 Enable the approximation for vectorized division.
24054
24055 sqrt
24056 Enable the approximation for scalar square root.
24057
24058 vec-sqrt
24059 Enable the approximation for vectorized square root.
24060
24061 So, for example, -mrecip=all,!sqrt enables all of the reciprocal
24062 approximations, except for square root.
24063
24064 -mveclibabi=type
24065 Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
24066 external library. Supported values for type are svml for the Intel
24067 short vector math library and acml for the AMD math core library.
24068 To use this option, both -ftree-vectorize and
24069 -funsafe-math-optimizations have to be enabled, and an SVML or ACML
24070 ABI-compatible library must be specified at link time.
24071
24072 GCC currently emits calls to "vmldExp2", "vmldLn2", "vmldLog102",
24073 "vmldPow2", "vmldTanh2", "vmldTan2", "vmldAtan2", "vmldAtanh2",
24074 "vmldCbrt2", "vmldSinh2", "vmldSin2", "vmldAsinh2", "vmldAsin2",
24075 "vmldCosh2", "vmldCos2", "vmldAcosh2", "vmldAcos2", "vmlsExp4",
24076 "vmlsLn4", "vmlsLog104", "vmlsPow4", "vmlsTanh4", "vmlsTan4",
24077 "vmlsAtan4", "vmlsAtanh4", "vmlsCbrt4", "vmlsSinh4", "vmlsSin4",
24078 "vmlsAsinh4", "vmlsAsin4", "vmlsCosh4", "vmlsCos4", "vmlsAcosh4"
24079 and "vmlsAcos4" for corresponding function type when
24080 -mveclibabi=svml is used, and "__vrd2_sin", "__vrd2_cos",
24081 "__vrd2_exp", "__vrd2_log", "__vrd2_log2", "__vrd2_log10",
24082 "__vrs4_sinf", "__vrs4_cosf", "__vrs4_expf", "__vrs4_logf",
24083 "__vrs4_log2f", "__vrs4_log10f" and "__vrs4_powf" for the
24084 corresponding function type when -mveclibabi=acml is used.
24085
24086 -mabi=name
24087 Generate code for the specified calling convention. Permissible
24088 values are sysv for the ABI used on GNU/Linux and other systems,
24089 and ms for the Microsoft ABI. The default is to use the Microsoft
24090 ABI when targeting Microsoft Windows and the SysV ABI on all other
24091 systems. You can control this behavior for specific functions by
24092 using the function attributes "ms_abi" and "sysv_abi".
24093
24094 -mforce-indirect-call
24095 Force all calls to functions to be indirect. This is useful when
24096 using Intel Processor Trace where it generates more precise timing
24097 information for function calls.
24098
24099 -mmanual-endbr
24100 Insert ENDBR instruction at function entry only via the "cf_check"
24101 function attribute. This is useful when used with the option
24102 -fcf-protection=branch to control ENDBR insertion at the function
24103 entry.
24104
24105 -mcall-ms2sysv-xlogues
24106 Due to differences in 64-bit ABIs, any Microsoft ABI function that
24107 calls a System V ABI function must consider RSI, RDI and XMM6-15 as
24108 clobbered. By default, the code for saving and restoring these
24109 registers is emitted inline, resulting in fairly lengthy prologues
24110 and epilogues. Using -mcall-ms2sysv-xlogues emits prologues and
24111 epilogues that use stubs in the static portion of libgcc to perform
24112 these saves and restores, thus reducing function size at the cost
24113 of a few extra instructions.
24114
24115 -mtls-dialect=type
24116 Generate code to access thread-local storage using the gnu or gnu2
24117 conventions. gnu is the conservative default; gnu2 is more
24118 efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time requirements that
24119 cannot be satisfied on all systems.
24120
24121 -mpush-args
24122 -mno-push-args
24123 Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters. This method is
24124 shorter and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations
24125 and is enabled by default. In some cases disabling it may improve
24126 performance because of improved scheduling and reduced
24127 dependencies.
24128
24129 -maccumulate-outgoing-args
24130 If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing
24131 arguments is computed in the function prologue. This is faster on
24132 most modern CPUs because of reduced dependencies, improved
24133 scheduling and reduced stack usage when the preferred stack
24134 boundary is not equal to 2. The drawback is a notable increase in
24135 code size. This switch implies -mno-push-args.
24136
24137 -mthreads
24138 Support thread-safe exception handling on MinGW. Programs that
24139 rely on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all
24140 code with the -mthreads option. When compiling, -mthreads defines
24141 -D_MT; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
24142 -lmingwthrd which cleans up per-thread exception-handling data.
24143
24144 -mms-bitfields
24145 -mno-ms-bitfields
24146 Enable/disable bit-field layout compatible with the native
24147 Microsoft Windows compiler.
24148
24149 If "packed" is used on a structure, or if bit-fields are used, it
24150 may be that the Microsoft ABI lays out the structure differently
24151 than the way GCC normally does. Particularly when moving packed
24152 data between functions compiled with GCC and the native Microsoft
24153 compiler (either via function call or as data in a file), it may be
24154 necessary to access either format.
24155
24156 This option is enabled by default for Microsoft Windows targets.
24157 This behavior can also be controlled locally by use of variable or
24158 type attributes. For more information, see x86 Variable Attributes
24159 and x86 Type Attributes.
24160
24161 The Microsoft structure layout algorithm is fairly simple with the
24162 exception of the bit-field packing. The padding and alignment of
24163 members of structures and whether a bit-field can straddle a
24164 storage-unit boundary are determine by these rules:
24165
24166 1. Structure members are stored sequentially in the order in which
24167 they are
24168 declared: the first member has the lowest memory address and
24169 the last member the highest.
24170
24171 2. Every data object has an alignment requirement. The alignment
24172 requirement
24173 for all data except structures, unions, and arrays is either
24174 the size of the object or the current packing size (specified
24175 with either the "aligned" attribute or the "pack" pragma),
24176 whichever is less. For structures, unions, and arrays, the
24177 alignment requirement is the largest alignment requirement of
24178 its members. Every object is allocated an offset so that:
24179
24180 offset % alignment_requirement == 0
24181
24182 3. Adjacent bit-fields are packed into the same 1-, 2-, or 4-byte
24183 allocation
24184 unit if the integral types are the same size and if the next
24185 bit-field fits into the current allocation unit without
24186 crossing the boundary imposed by the common alignment
24187 requirements of the bit-fields.
24188
24189 MSVC interprets zero-length bit-fields in the following ways:
24190
24191 1. If a zero-length bit-field is inserted between two bit-fields
24192 that
24193 are normally coalesced, the bit-fields are not coalesced.
24194
24195 For example:
24196
24197 struct
24198 {
24199 unsigned long bf_1 : 12;
24200 unsigned long : 0;
24201 unsigned long bf_2 : 12;
24202 } t1;
24203
24204 The size of "t1" is 8 bytes with the zero-length bit-field. If
24205 the zero-length bit-field were removed, "t1"'s size would be 4
24206 bytes.
24207
24208 2. If a zero-length bit-field is inserted after a bit-field, "foo",
24209 and the
24210 alignment of the zero-length bit-field is greater than the
24211 member that follows it, "bar", "bar" is aligned as the type of
24212 the zero-length bit-field.
24213
24214 For example:
24215
24216 struct
24217 {
24218 char foo : 4;
24219 short : 0;
24220 char bar;
24221 } t2;
24222
24223 struct
24224 {
24225 char foo : 4;
24226 short : 0;
24227 double bar;
24228 } t3;
24229
24230 For "t2", "bar" is placed at offset 2, rather than offset 1.
24231 Accordingly, the size of "t2" is 4. For "t3", the zero-length
24232 bit-field does not affect the alignment of "bar" or, as a
24233 result, the size of the structure.
24234
24235 Taking this into account, it is important to note the
24236 following:
24237
24238 1. If a zero-length bit-field follows a normal bit-field, the
24239 type of the
24240 zero-length bit-field may affect the alignment of the
24241 structure as whole. For example, "t2" has a size of 4
24242 bytes, since the zero-length bit-field follows a normal
24243 bit-field, and is of type short.
24244
24245 2. Even if a zero-length bit-field is not followed by a normal
24246 bit-field, it may
24247 still affect the alignment of the structure:
24248
24249 struct
24250 {
24251 char foo : 6;
24252 long : 0;
24253 } t4;
24254
24255 Here, "t4" takes up 4 bytes.
24256
24257 3. Zero-length bit-fields following non-bit-field members are
24258 ignored:
24259 struct
24260 {
24261 char foo;
24262 long : 0;
24263 char bar;
24264 } t5;
24265
24266 Here, "t5" takes up 2 bytes.
24267
24268 -mno-align-stringops
24269 Do not align the destination of inlined string operations. This
24270 switch reduces code size and improves performance in case the
24271 destination is already aligned, but GCC doesn't know about it.
24272
24273 -minline-all-stringops
24274 By default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination
24275 is known to be aligned to least a 4-byte boundary. This enables
24276 more inlining and increases code size, but may improve performance
24277 of code that depends on fast "memcpy", "strlen", and "memset" for
24278 short lengths.
24279
24280 -minline-stringops-dynamically
24281 For string operations of unknown size, use run-time checks with
24282 inline code for small blocks and a library call for large blocks.
24283
24284 -mstringop-strategy=alg
24285 Override the internal decision heuristic for the particular
24286 algorithm to use for inlining string operations. The allowed
24287 values for alg are:
24288
24289 rep_byte
24290 rep_4byte
24291 rep_8byte
24292 Expand using i386 "rep" prefix of the specified size.
24293
24294 byte_loop
24295 loop
24296 unrolled_loop
24297 Expand into an inline loop.
24298
24299 libcall
24300 Always use a library call.
24301
24302 -mmemcpy-strategy=strategy
24303 Override the internal decision heuristic to decide if
24304 "__builtin_memcpy" should be inlined and what inline algorithm to
24305 use when the expected size of the copy operation is known. strategy
24306 is a comma-separated list of alg:max_size:dest_align triplets. alg
24307 is specified in -mstringop-strategy, max_size specifies the max
24308 byte size with which inline algorithm alg is allowed. For the last
24309 triplet, the max_size must be "-1". The max_size of the triplets in
24310 the list must be specified in increasing order. The minimal byte
24311 size for alg is 0 for the first triplet and "max_size + 1" of the
24312 preceding range.
24313
24314 -mmemset-strategy=strategy
24315 The option is similar to -mmemcpy-strategy= except that it is to
24316 control "__builtin_memset" expansion.
24317
24318 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
24319 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.
24320 This avoids the instructions to save, set up, and restore frame
24321 pointers and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.
24322 The option -fomit-leaf-frame-pointer removes the frame pointer for
24323 leaf functions, which might make debugging harder.
24324
24325 -mtls-direct-seg-refs
24326 -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
24327 Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from
24328 the TLS segment register (%gs for 32-bit, %fs for 64-bit), or
24329 whether the thread base pointer must be added. Whether or not this
24330 is valid depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
24331 segment to cover the entire TLS area.
24332
24333 For systems that use the GNU C Library, the default is on.
24334
24335 -msse2avx
24336 -mno-sse2avx
24337 Specify that the assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX
24338 prefix. The option -mavx turns this on by default.
24339
24340 -mfentry
24341 -mno-fentry
24342 If profiling is active (-pg), put the profiling counter call before
24343 the prologue. Note: On x86 architectures the attribute
24344 "ms_hook_prologue" isn't possible at the moment for -mfentry and
24345 -pg.
24346
24347 -mrecord-mcount
24348 -mno-record-mcount
24349 If profiling is active (-pg), generate a __mcount_loc section that
24350 contains pointers to each profiling call. This is useful for
24351 automatically patching and out calls.
24352
24353 -mnop-mcount
24354 -mno-nop-mcount
24355 If profiling is active (-pg), generate the calls to the profiling
24356 functions as NOPs. This is useful when they should be patched in
24357 later dynamically. This is likely only useful together with
24358 -mrecord-mcount.
24359
24360 -minstrument-return=type
24361 Instrument function exit in -pg -mfentry instrumented functions
24362 with call to specified function. This only instruments true returns
24363 ending with ret, but not sibling calls ending with jump. Valid
24364 types are none to not instrument, call to generate a call to
24365 __return__, or nop5 to generate a 5 byte nop.
24366
24367 -mrecord-return
24368 -mno-record-return
24369 Generate a __return_loc section pointing to all return
24370 instrumentation code.
24371
24372 -mfentry-name=name
24373 Set name of __fentry__ symbol called at function entry for -pg
24374 -mfentry functions.
24375
24376 -mfentry-section=name
24377 Set name of section to record -mrecord-mcount calls (default
24378 __mcount_loc).
24379
24380 -mskip-rax-setup
24381 -mno-skip-rax-setup
24382 When generating code for the x86-64 architecture with SSE
24383 extensions disabled, -mskip-rax-setup can be used to skip setting
24384 up RAX register when there are no variable arguments passed in
24385 vector registers.
24386
24387 Warning: Since RAX register is used to avoid unnecessarily saving
24388 vector registers on stack when passing variable arguments, the
24389 impacts of this option are callees may waste some stack space,
24390 misbehave or jump to a random location. GCC 4.4 or newer don't
24391 have those issues, regardless the RAX register value.
24392
24393 -m8bit-idiv
24394 -mno-8bit-idiv
24395 On some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide
24396 is much faster than 32-bit/64-bit integer divide. This option
24397 generates a run-time check. If both dividend and divisor are
24398 within range of 0 to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used
24399 instead of 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.
24400
24401 -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
24402 -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
24403 Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.
24404
24405 -mstack-protector-guard=guard
24406 -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
24407 -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset
24408 Generate stack protection code using canary at guard. Supported
24409 locations are global for global canary or tls for per-thread canary
24410 in the TLS block (the default). This option has effect only when
24411 -fstack-protector or -fstack-protector-all is specified.
24412
24413 With the latter choice the options -mstack-protector-guard-reg=reg
24414 and -mstack-protector-guard-offset=offset furthermore specify which
24415 segment register (%fs or %gs) to use as base register for reading
24416 the canary, and from what offset from that base register. The
24417 default for those is as specified in the relevant ABI.
24418
24419 -mgeneral-regs-only
24420 Generate code that uses only the general-purpose registers. This
24421 prevents the compiler from using floating-point, vector, mask and
24422 bound registers.
24423
24424 -mindirect-branch=choice
24425 Convert indirect call and jump with choice. The default is keep,
24426 which keeps indirect call and jump unmodified. thunk converts
24427 indirect call and jump to call and return thunk. thunk-inline
24428 converts indirect call and jump to inlined call and return thunk.
24429 thunk-extern converts indirect call and jump to external call and
24430 return thunk provided in a separate object file. You can control
24431 this behavior for a specific function by using the function
24432 attribute "indirect_branch".
24433
24434 Note that -mcmodel=large is incompatible with
24435 -mindirect-branch=thunk and -mindirect-branch=thunk-extern since
24436 the thunk function may not be reachable in the large code model.
24437
24438 Note that -mindirect-branch=thunk-extern is incompatible with
24439 -fcf-protection=branch since the external thunk cannot be modified
24440 to disable control-flow check.
24441
24442 -mfunction-return=choice
24443 Convert function return with choice. The default is keep, which
24444 keeps function return unmodified. thunk converts function return
24445 to call and return thunk. thunk-inline converts function return to
24446 inlined call and return thunk. thunk-extern converts function
24447 return to external call and return thunk provided in a separate
24448 object file. You can control this behavior for a specific function
24449 by using the function attribute "function_return".
24450
24451 Note that -mcmodel=large is incompatible with
24452 -mfunction-return=thunk and -mfunction-return=thunk-extern since
24453 the thunk function may not be reachable in the large code model.
24454
24455 -mindirect-branch-register
24456 Force indirect call and jump via register.
24457
24458 These -m switches are supported in addition to the above on x86-64
24459 processors in 64-bit environments.
24460
24461 -m32
24462 -m64
24463 -mx32
24464 -m16
24465 -miamcu
24466 Generate code for a 16-bit, 32-bit or 64-bit environment. The -m32
24467 option sets "int", "long", and pointer types to 32 bits, and
24468 generates code that runs on any i386 system.
24469
24470 The -m64 option sets "int" to 32 bits and "long" and pointer types
24471 to 64 bits, and generates code for the x86-64 architecture. For
24472 Darwin only the -m64 option also turns off the -fno-pic and
24473 -mdynamic-no-pic options.
24474
24475 The -mx32 option sets "int", "long", and pointer types to 32 bits,
24476 and generates code for the x86-64 architecture.
24477
24478 The -m16 option is the same as -m32, except for that it outputs the
24479 ".code16gcc" assembly directive at the beginning of the assembly
24480 output so that the binary can run in 16-bit mode.
24481
24482 The -miamcu option generates code which conforms to Intel MCU
24483 psABI. It requires the -m32 option to be turned on.
24484
24485 -mno-red-zone
24486 Do not use a so-called "red zone" for x86-64 code. The red zone is
24487 mandated by the x86-64 ABI; it is a 128-byte area beyond the
24488 location of the stack pointer that is not modified by signal or
24489 interrupt handlers and therefore can be used for temporary data
24490 without adjusting the stack pointer. The flag -mno-red-zone
24491 disables this red zone.
24492
24493 -mcmodel=small
24494 Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols
24495 must be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space. Pointers
24496 are 64 bits. Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
24497 This is the default code model.
24498
24499 -mcmodel=kernel
24500 Generate code for the kernel code model. The kernel runs in the
24501 negative 2 GB of the address space. This model has to be used for
24502 Linux kernel code.
24503
24504 -mcmodel=medium
24505 Generate code for the medium model: the program is linked in the
24506 lower 2 GB of the address space. Small symbols are also placed
24507 there. Symbols with sizes larger than -mlarge-data-threshold are
24508 put into large data or BSS sections and can be located above 2GB.
24509 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
24510
24511 -mcmodel=large
24512 Generate code for the large model. This model makes no assumptions
24513 about addresses and sizes of sections.
24514
24515 -maddress-mode=long
24516 Generate code for long address mode. This is only supported for
24517 64-bit and x32 environments. It is the default address mode for
24518 64-bit environments.
24519
24520 -maddress-mode=short
24521 Generate code for short address mode. This is only supported for
24522 32-bit and x32 environments. It is the default address mode for
24523 32-bit and x32 environments.
24524
24525 x86 Windows Options
24526
24527 These additional options are available for Microsoft Windows targets:
24528
24529 -mconsole
24530 This option specifies that a console application is to be
24531 generated, by instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem
24532 type required for console applications. This option is available
24533 for Cygwin and MinGW targets and is enabled by default on those
24534 targets.
24535
24536 -mdll
24537 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
24538 specifies that a DLL---a dynamic link library---is to be generated,
24539 enabling the selection of the required runtime startup object and
24540 entry point.
24541
24542 -mnop-fun-dllimport
24543 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
24544 specifies that the "dllimport" attribute should be ignored.
24545
24546 -mthread
24547 This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that
24548 MinGW-specific thread support is to be used.
24549
24550 -municode
24551 This option is available for MinGW-w64 targets. It causes the
24552 "UNICODE" preprocessor macro to be predefined, and chooses Unicode-
24553 capable runtime startup code.
24554
24555 -mwin32
24556 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
24557 specifies that the typical Microsoft Windows predefined macros are
24558 to be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice
24559 of runtime library/startup code.
24560
24561 -mwindows
24562 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
24563 specifies that a GUI application is to be generated by instructing
24564 the linker to set the PE header subsystem type appropriately.
24565
24566 -fno-set-stack-executable
24567 This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that the
24568 executable flag for the stack used by nested functions isn't set.
24569 This is necessary for binaries running in kernel mode of Microsoft
24570 Windows, as there the User32 API, which is used to set executable
24571 privileges, isn't available.
24572
24573 -fwritable-relocated-rdata
24574 This option is available for MinGW and Cygwin targets. It
24575 specifies that relocated-data in read-only section is put into the
24576 ".data" section. This is a necessary for older runtimes not
24577 supporting modification of ".rdata" sections for pseudo-relocation.
24578
24579 -mpe-aligned-commons
24580 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
24581 specifies that the GNU extension to the PE file format that permits
24582 the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be used when
24583 generating code. It is enabled by default if GCC detects that the
24584 target assembler found during configuration supports the feature.
24585
24586 See also under x86 Options for standard options.
24587
24588 Xstormy16 Options
24589
24590 These options are defined for Xstormy16:
24591
24592 -msim
24593 Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
24594
24595 Xtensa Options
24596
24597 These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
24598
24599 -mconst16
24600 -mno-const16
24601 Enable or disable use of "CONST16" instructions for loading
24602 constant values. The "CONST16" instruction is currently not a
24603 standard option from Tensilica. When enabled, "CONST16"
24604 instructions are always used in place of the standard "L32R"
24605 instructions. The use of "CONST16" is enabled by default only if
24606 the "L32R" instruction is not available.
24607
24608 -mfused-madd
24609 -mno-fused-madd
24610 Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
24611 instructions in the floating-point option. This has no effect if
24612 the floating-point option is not also enabled. Disabling fused
24613 multiply/add and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler
24614 to use separate instructions for the multiply and add/subtract
24615 operations. This may be desirable in some cases where strict IEEE
24616 754-compliant results are required: the fused multiply add/subtract
24617 instructions do not round the intermediate result, thereby
24618 producing results with more bits of precision than specified by the
24619 IEEE standard. Disabling fused multiply add/subtract instructions
24620 also ensures that the program output is not sensitive to the
24621 compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract operations.
24622
24623 -mserialize-volatile
24624 -mno-serialize-volatile
24625 When this option is enabled, GCC inserts "MEMW" instructions before
24626 "volatile" memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
24627 The default is -mserialize-volatile. Use -mno-serialize-volatile
24628 to omit the "MEMW" instructions.
24629
24630 -mforce-no-pic
24631 For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must
24632 be position-independent code (PIC), this option disables PIC for
24633 compiling kernel code.
24634
24635 -mtext-section-literals
24636 -mno-text-section-literals
24637 These options control the treatment of literal pools. The default
24638 is -mno-text-section-literals, which places literals in a separate
24639 section in the output file. This allows the literal pool to be
24640 placed in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine
24641 literal pools from separate object files to remove redundant
24642 literals and improve code size. With -mtext-section-literals, the
24643 literals are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them
24644 as close as possible to their references. This may be necessary
24645 for large assembly files. Literals for each function are placed
24646 right before that function.
24647
24648 -mauto-litpools
24649 -mno-auto-litpools
24650 These options control the treatment of literal pools. The default
24651 is -mno-auto-litpools, which places literals in a separate section
24652 in the output file unless -mtext-section-literals is used. With
24653 -mauto-litpools the literals are interspersed in the text section
24654 by the assembler. Compiler does not produce explicit ".literal"
24655 directives and loads literals into registers with "MOVI"
24656 instructions instead of "L32R" to let the assembler do relaxation
24657 and place literals as necessary. This option allows assembler to
24658 create several literal pools per function and assemble very big
24659 functions, which may not be possible with -mtext-section-literals.
24660
24661 -mtarget-align
24662 -mno-target-align
24663 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
24664 automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
24665 expense of some code density. The assembler attempts to widen
24666 density instructions to align branch targets and the instructions
24667 following call instructions. If there are not enough preceding
24668 safe density instructions to align a target, no widening is
24669 performed. The default is -mtarget-align. These options do not
24670 affect the treatment of auto-aligned instructions like "LOOP",
24671 which the assembler always aligns, either by widening density
24672 instructions or by inserting NOP instructions.
24673
24674 -mlongcalls
24675 -mno-longcalls
24676 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
24677 translate direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine
24678 that the target of a direct call is in the range allowed by the
24679 call instruction. This translation typically occurs for calls to
24680 functions in other source files. Specifically, the assembler
24681 translates a direct "CALL" instruction into an "L32R" followed by a
24682 "CALLX" instruction. The default is -mno-longcalls. This option
24683 should be used in programs where the call target can potentially be
24684 out of range. This option is implemented in the assembler, not the
24685 compiler, so the assembly code generated by GCC still shows direct
24686 call instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the
24687 actual instructions. Note that the assembler uses an indirect call
24688 for every cross-file call, not just those that really are out of
24689 range.
24690
24691 zSeries Options
24692
24693 These are listed under
24694
24696 This section describes several environment variables that affect how
24697 GCC operates. Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes
24698 to use when searching for various kinds of files. Some are used to
24699 specify other aspects of the compilation environment.
24700
24701 Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
24702 -B, -I and -L. These take precedence over places specified using
24703 environment variables, which in turn take precedence over those
24704 specified by the configuration of GCC.
24705
24706 LANG
24707 LC_CTYPE
24708 LC_MESSAGES
24709 LC_ALL
24710 These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
24711 localization information which allows GCC to work with different
24712 national conventions. GCC inspects the locale categories LC_CTYPE
24713 and LC_MESSAGES if it has been configured to do so. These locale
24714 categories can be set to any value supported by your installation.
24715 A typical value is en_GB.UTF-8 for English in the United Kingdom
24716 encoded in UTF-8.
24717
24718 The LC_CTYPE environment variable specifies character
24719 classification. GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries
24720 in a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that
24721 contain quote and escape characters that are otherwise interpreted
24722 as a string end or escape.
24723
24724 The LC_MESSAGES environment variable specifies the language to use
24725 in diagnostic messages.
24726
24727 If the LC_ALL environment variable is set, it overrides the value
24728 of LC_CTYPE and LC_MESSAGES; otherwise, LC_CTYPE and LC_MESSAGES
24729 default to the value of the LANG environment variable. If none of
24730 these variables are set, GCC defaults to traditional C English
24731 behavior.
24732
24733 TMPDIR
24734 If TMPDIR is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
24735 files. GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
24736 compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for
24737 example, the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the
24738 compiler proper.
24739
24740 GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
24741 Setting GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG is nearly equivalent to passing
24742 -fcompare-debug to the compiler driver. See the documentation of
24743 this option for more details.
24744
24745 GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
24746 If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
24747 names of the subprograms executed by the compiler. No slash is
24748 added when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram,
24749 but you can specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
24750
24751 If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is not set, GCC attempts to figure out an
24752 appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it is invoked with.
24753
24754 If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
24755 tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
24756
24757 The default value of GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is prefix/lib/gcc/ where
24758 prefix is the prefix to the installed compiler. In many cases
24759 prefix is the value of "prefix" when you ran the configure script.
24760
24761 Other prefixes specified with -B take precedence over this prefix.
24762
24763 This prefix is also used for finding files such as crt0.o that are
24764 used for linking.
24765
24766 In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
24767 directories to search for header files. For each of the standard
24768 directories whose name normally begins with /usr/local/lib/gcc
24769 (more precisely, with the value of GCC_INCLUDE_DIR), GCC tries
24770 replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
24771 alternate directory name. Thus, with -Bfoo/, GCC searches foo/bar
24772 just before it searches the standard directory /usr/local/lib/bar.
24773 If a standard directory begins with the configured prefix then the
24774 value of prefix is replaced by GCC_EXEC_PREFIX when looking for
24775 header files.
24776
24777 COMPILER_PATH
24778 The value of COMPILER_PATH is a colon-separated list of
24779 directories, much like PATH. GCC tries the directories thus
24780 specified when searching for subprograms, if it cannot find the
24781 subprograms using GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.
24782
24783 LIBRARY_PATH
24784 The value of LIBRARY_PATH is a colon-separated list of directories,
24785 much like PATH. When configured as a native compiler, GCC tries
24786 the directories thus specified when searching for special linker
24787 files, if it cannot find them using GCC_EXEC_PREFIX. Linking using
24788 GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
24789 libraries for the -l option (but directories specified with -L come
24790 first).
24791
24792 LANG
24793 This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.
24794 One way in which this information is used is to determine the
24795 character set to be used when character literals, string literals
24796 and comments are parsed in C and C++. When the compiler is
24797 configured to allow multibyte characters, the following values for
24798 LANG are recognized:
24799
24800 C-JIS
24801 Recognize JIS characters.
24802
24803 C-SJIS
24804 Recognize SJIS characters.
24805
24806 C-EUCJP
24807 Recognize EUCJP characters.
24808
24809 If LANG is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
24810 compiler uses "mblen" and "mbtowc" as defined by the default locale
24811 to recognize and translate multibyte characters.
24812
24813 Some additional environment variables affect the behavior of the
24814 preprocessor.
24815
24816 CPATH
24817 C_INCLUDE_PATH
24818 CPLUS_INCLUDE_PATH
24819 OBJC_INCLUDE_PATH
24820 Each variable's value is a list of directories separated by a
24821 special character, much like PATH, in which to look for header
24822 files. The special character, "PATH_SEPARATOR", is target-
24823 dependent and determined at GCC build time. For Microsoft Windows-
24824 based targets it is a semicolon, and for almost all other targets
24825 it is a colon.
24826
24827 CPATH specifies a list of directories to be searched as if
24828 specified with -I, but after any paths given with -I options on the
24829 command line. This environment variable is used regardless of
24830 which language is being preprocessed.
24831
24832 The remaining environment variables apply only when preprocessing
24833 the particular language indicated. Each specifies a list of
24834 directories to be searched as if specified with -isystem, but after
24835 any paths given with -isystem options on the command line.
24836
24837 In all these variables, an empty element instructs the compiler to
24838 search its current working directory. Empty elements can appear at
24839 the beginning or end of a path. For instance, if the value of
24840 CPATH is ":/special/include", that has the same effect as
24841 -I. -I/special/include.
24842
24843 DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT
24844 If this variable is set, its value specifies how to output
24845 dependencies for Make based on the non-system header files
24846 processed by the compiler. System header files are ignored in the
24847 dependency output.
24848
24849 The value of DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT can be just a file name, in which
24850 case the Make rules are written to that file, guessing the target
24851 name from the source file name. Or the value can have the form
24852 file target, in which case the rules are written to file file using
24853 target as the target name.
24854
24855 In other words, this environment variable is equivalent to
24856 combining the options -MM and -MF, with an optional -MT switch too.
24857
24858 SUNPRO_DEPENDENCIES
24859 This variable is the same as DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT (see above),
24860 except that system header files are not ignored, so it implies -M
24861 rather than -MM. However, the dependence on the main input file is
24862 omitted.
24863
24864 SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH
24865 If this variable is set, its value specifies a UNIX timestamp to be
24866 used in replacement of the current date and time in the "__DATE__"
24867 and "__TIME__" macros, so that the embedded timestamps become
24868 reproducible.
24869
24870 The value of SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH must be a UNIX timestamp, defined as
24871 the number of seconds (excluding leap seconds) since 01 Jan 1970
24872 00:00:00 represented in ASCII; identical to the output of
24873 @command{date +%s} on GNU/Linux and other systems that support the
24874 %s extension in the "date" command.
24875
24876 The value should be a known timestamp such as the last modification
24877 time of the source or package and it should be set by the build
24878 process.
24879
24881 For instructions on reporting bugs, see
24882 <http://bugzilla.redhat.com/bugzilla>.
24883
24885 1. On some systems, gcc -shared needs to build supplementary stub code
24886 for constructors to work. On multi-libbed systems, gcc -shared
24887 must select the correct support libraries to link against. Failing
24888 to supply the correct flags may lead to subtle defects. Supplying
24889 them in cases where they are not necessary is innocuous.
24890
24892 gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7), cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1),
24893 dbx(1) and the Info entries for gcc, cpp, as, ld, binutils and gdb.
24894
24896 See the Info entry for gcc, or
24897 <http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html>, for contributors
24898 to GCC.
24899
24901 Copyright (c) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24902
24903 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
24904 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
24905 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
24906 Invariant Sections being "GNU General Public License" and "Funding Free
24907 Software", the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with the
24908 Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below). A copy of the license is
24909 included in the gfdl(7) man page.
24910
24911 (a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
24912
24913 A GNU Manual
24914
24915 (b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
24916
24917 You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
24918 software. Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
24919 funds for GNU development.
24920
24921
24922
24923gcc-9.2.1 2019-08-27 GCC(1)